DREYFUS BASIC U S GOVERNMENT MONEY MARKET FUND
485BPOS, 1996-06-28
Previous: BUCKLE INC, S-8, 1996-06-28
Next: DREYFUS BASIC MONEY MARKET FUND INC, 485BPOS, 1996-06-28



                                                             File Nos. 33-46503
                                                                       811-6606

                      SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION
                            Washington, D.C. 20549

                                   FORM N-1A

REGISTRATION STATEMENT UNDER THE SECURITIES ACT OF 1933                [ X ]

     Pre-Effective Amendment No.                                       [  ]
   

     Post-Effective Amendment No. 7                                    [ X ]
    

                                    and/or

REGISTRATION STATEMENT UNDER THE INVESTMENT COMPANY ACT OF 1940        [ X ]
   

     Amendment No. 7                                                   [ X ]
    


                       (Check appropriate box or boxes.)

                Dreyfus BASIC U.S. Government Money Market Fund
              (Exact Name of Registrant as Specified in Charter)


           c/o The Dreyfus Corporation
           200 Park Avenue, New York, New York          10166
           (Address of Principal Executive Offices)     (Zip Code)


     Registrant's Telephone Number, including Area Code: (212) 922-6000
   

                             Mark N. Jacobs, Esq.
    

                                200 Park Avenue
                           New York, New York 10166
                    (Name and Address of Agent for Service)


It is proposed that this filing will become effective (check appropriate box)

           immediately upon filing pursuant to paragraph (b)
     ----
   

      X    on July 1, 1996 pursuant to paragraph (b)
     ----
    

           60 days after filing pursuant to paragraph (a)(i)
     ----
           on     (date)      pursuant to paragraph (a)(i)
     ----
           75 days after filing pursuant to paragraph (a)(ii)
     ----
           on     (date)      pursuant to paragraph (a)(ii) of Rule 485
     ----

If appropriate, check the following box:

           this post-effective amendment designates a new effective date for a
           previously filed post-effective amendment.
     ----
   

     Registrant has registered an indefinite number of shares of its
benificial interest under the Securities Act of 1933 pursuant to
Section 24(f) of the Investment Company Act of 1940.  Registrant's Rule 24f-2
Notice for the fiscal year ended February 29, 1996 was filed on or about
April 29, 1996.
    

                Dreyfus BASIC U.S. Government Money Market Fund
                 Cross-Reference Sheet Pursuant to Rule 495(a)


Items in
Part A of
Form N-1A      Caption                                       Page
_________      _______                                       ____

   1           Cover Page                                     Cover

   2           Synopsis                                       4

   3           Condensed Financial Information                6

   4           General Description of Registrant              7

   5           Management of the Fund                         9

   5(a)        Management's Discussion of Fund's Performance  *

   6           Capital Stock and Other Securities             17

   7           Purchase of Securities Being Offered           10

   8           Redemption or Repurchase                       13

   9           Pending Legal Proceedings                      *


Items in
Part B of
Form N-1A
- ---------

   10          Cover Page                                     Cover

   11          Table of Contents                              Cover

   12          General Information and History                *

   13          Investment Objectives and Policies             B-2

   14          Management of the Fund                         B-7

   15          Control Persons and Principal                  B-12
               Holders of Securities

   16          Investment Advisory and Other                  B-12
               Services

_____________________________________

NOTE:  * Omitted since answer is negative or inapplicable.

                Dreyfus BASIC U.S. Government Money Market Fund
           Cross-Reference Sheet Pursuant to Rule 495(a) (continued)


Items in
Part B of
Form N-1A      Caption                                        Page
_________      _______                                        _____

   17          Brokerage Allocation                           B-21

   18          Capital Stock and Other Securities             B-19

   19          Purchase, Redemption and Pricing               B-14, B-16,
               of Securities Being Offered                    B-20

   20          Tax Status                                     *

   21          Underwriters                                   B-15

   22          Calculations of Performance Data               B-22

   23          Financial Statements                           B-34


Items in
Part C of
Form N-1A
_________

   24          Financial Statements and Exhibits              C-1

   25          Persons Controlled by or Under                 C-3
               Common Control with Registrant

   26          Number of Holders of Securities                C-3

   27          Indemnification                                C-3, C-4

   28          Business and Other Connections of              C-4
               Investment Adviser

   29          Principal Underwriters                         C-11

   30          Location of Accounts and Records               C-14

   31          Management Services                            C-14

   32          Undertakings                                   C-14


_____________________________________

NOTE:  * Omitted since answer is negative or inapplicable.

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------
   

COMBINED PROSPECTUS                                             JULY 1, 1996
                     DREYFUS BASIC MONEY MARKET FUND, INC.
                DREYFUS BASIC U.S. GOVERNMENT MONEY MARKET FUND
    

- --------------------------------------------------------------------------
   

        DREYFUS BASIC MONEY MARKET FUND, INC. AND DREYFUS BASIC U.S.
GOVERNMENT MONEY MARKET FUND (EACH, A "FUND" AND COLLECTIVELY, THE "FUNDS")
ARE EACH OPEN-END, DIVERSIFIED, MANAGEMENT INVESTMENT COMPANIES KNOWN AS
MONEY MARKET MUTUAL FUNDS. EACH FUND'S INVESTMENT OBJECTIVE IS TO PROVIDE YOU
WITH AS HIGH A LEVEL OF CURRENT INCOME AS IS CONSISTENT WITH THE PRESERVATION
OF CAPITAL AND THE MAINTENANCE OF LIQUIDITY. EACH FUND SEEKS TO MAINTAIN A
STABLE NET ASSET VALUE OF $1.00 PER SHARE AND IS DESIGNED TO BENEFIT
INVESTORS WHO DO NOT ENGAGE IN FREQUENT TRANSACTIONS IN FUND SHARES.
    
   

        YOU CAN PURCHASE OR REDEEM SHARES BY TELEPHONE USING DREYFUS
TELETRANSFER.
    

        THE DREYFUS CORPORATION PROFESSIONALLY MANAGES EACH FUND'S PORTFOLIO.
        AN INVESTMENT IN EACH FUND IS NEITHER INSURED NOR GUARANTEED BY THE
U.S. GOVERNMENT. THERE CAN BE NO ASSURANCE THAT EITHER FUND WILL BE ABLE TO
MAINTAIN A STABLE NET ASSET VALUE OF $1.00 PER SHARE.
DREYFUS BASIC MONEY MARKET FUND, INC. (THE "MONEY FUND") INVESTS IN
SHORT-TERM MONEY MARKET OBLIGATIONS INCLUDING U.S. GOVERNMENT SECURITIES,
CERTIFICATES OF DEPOSIT AND OTHER DOMESTIC AND FOREIGN BANK OBLIGATIONS,
REPURCHASE AGREEMENTS, COMMERCIAL PAPER, AND OTHER SHORT-TERM CORPORATE
OBLIGATIONS, AS MORE FULLY DESCRIBED HEREIN.
DREYFUS BASIC U.S. GOVERNMENT MONEY MARKET FUND (THE "GOVERNMENT MONEY FUND")
INVESTS IN U.S. GOVERNMENT SECURITIES AND REPURCHASE AGREEMENTS IN RESPECT OF
U.S. GOVERNMENT SECURITIES.
        EACH FUND IS A SEPARATE ENTITY WITH A SEPARATE PORTFOLIO. THE
OPERATIONS AND RESULTS OF ONE FUND ARE UNRELATED TO THOSE OF THE OTHER FUND.
THIS COMBINED PROSPECTUS HAS BEEN PREPARED FOR YOUR CONVENIENCE TO PROVIDE
YOU THE OPPORTUNITY TO CONSIDER TWO INVESTMENT CHOICES IN ONE DOCUMENT.
        THIS PROSPECTUS SETS FORTH CONCISELY INFORMATION ABOUT EACH FUND THAT
YOU SHOULD KNOW BEFORE INVESTING. IT SHOULD BE READ AND RETAINED FOR FUTURE
REFERENCE.
   

        THE STATEMENT OF ADDITIONAL INFORMATION, DATED JULY 1, 1996, WHICH
MAY BE REVISED FROM TIME TO TIME, PROVIDES A FURTHER DISCUSSION OF CERTAIN
AREAS IN THIS PROSPECTUS AND OTHER MATTERS WHICH MAY BE OF INTEREST TO SOME
INVESTORS. IT HAS BEEN FILED WITH THE SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION AND
IS INCORPORATED HEREIN BY REFERENCE. FOR A FREE COPY, WRITE TO THE FUND AT
144 GLENN CURTISS BOULEVARD, UNIONDALE, NEW YORK 11556-0144, OR CALL
1-800-645-6561. WHEN TELEPHONING, ASK FOR OPERATOR 144.
    

        MUTUAL FUND SHARES ARE NOT DEPOSITS OR OBLIGATIONS OF, OR GUARANTEED
OR ENDORSED BY, ANY BANK, AND ARE NOT FEDERALLY INSURED BY THE FEDERAL
DEPOSIT INSURANCE CORPORATION, THE FEDERAL RESERVE BOARD, OR ANY OTHER
AGENCY.
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------
THESE SECURITIES HAVE NOT BEEN APPROVED OR DISAPPROVED BY THE SECURITIES AND
EXCHANGE COMMISSION OR ANY STATE SECURITIES COMMISSION NOR HAS THE SECURITIES
AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION OR ANY STATE SECURITIES COMMISSION PASSED UPON THE
ACCURACY OR ADEQUACY OF THIS PROSPECTUS. ANY REPRESENTATION TO THE CONTRARY
IS A CRIMINAL OFFENSE.
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------
                             TABLE OF CONTENTS
   

             FEE TABLE.........................................            4
             CONDENSED FINANCIAL INFORMATION...................            5
             YIELD INFORMATION.................................            6
             DESCRIPTION OF THE FUNDS..........................            7
             MANAGEMENT OF THE FUNDS...........................            9
             HOW TO BUY SHARES.................................            10
             SHAREHOLDER SERVICES..............................            11
             HOW TO REDEEM SHARES..............................            13
             SHAREHOLDER SERVICES PLAN.........................            15
             DIVIDENDS, DISTRIBUTIONS AND TAXES................            15
             GENERAL INFORMATION...............................            17
             APPENDIX..........................................            19
    

        Page 2
        [This Page Intentionally Left Blank]
        Page 3
<TABLE>
   



                                             FEE TABLE
                                                                                                           GOVERNMENT
                                                                                                 MONEY       MONEY
      SHAREHOLDER TRANSACTION EXPENSES                                                            FUND       FUND
<S>                                                           <C>            <C>            <C>   <C>      <C>
         Exchange Fee.............................................................                $5.00     $5.00
        Account Closeout Fee.....................................................                 $5.00     $5.00
      ANNUAL FUND OPERATING EXPENSES
      (as a percentage of average daily net assets)
        Management Fees (after expense reimbursement)............................                 .33%       .28%
        Other Expenses...........................................................                 .12%       .17%
        Total Fund Operating Expenses (after expense reimbursement)..............                 .45%       .45%
      EXAMPLE (applicable to each Fund)                        1 YEAR    3 YEARS          5 YEARS        10 YEARS
        You would pay the following expenses
        on a $1,000 investment, assuming (1) 5%
        annual return and (2) redemption at the
        end of each time period..............                 $10            $19            $30            $62
</TABLE>
    


- --------------------------------------------------------------------------
        THE AMOUNTS LISTED IN THE EXAMPLE SHOULD NOT BE CONSIDERED AS
REPRESENTATIVE OF PAST OR FUTURE EXPENSES AND ACTUAL EXPENSES MAY BE GREATER
OR LESS THAN THOSE INDICATED. MOREOVER, WHILE THE EXAMPLE ASSUMES A 5% ANNUAL
RETURN, EACH FUND'S ACTUAL PERFORMANCE WILL VARY AND MAY RESULT IN AN ACTUAL
RETURN GREATER OR LESS THAN 5%.
- --------------------------------------------------------------------------
   

        The purpose of the foregoing table is to assist you in understanding
the costs and expenses borne by each Fund and investors, the payment of which
will reduce investors' annual return. The Dreyfus Corporation has agreed,
with respect to each Fund, that, until such time as it gives investors at
least 90 days' notice to the contrary, if in any fiscal year of the Fund
certain Fund expenses, including the management fee, exceed .45 of 1% of the
value of the Fund's average net assets for the fiscal year, such Fund may
deduct from the payment to be made to The Dreyfus Corporation under the
Management Agreement, or The Dreyfus Corporation will bear, such excess
expense. No modification or termination of this agreement currently is
contemplated by The Dreyfus Corporation. The information in the foregoing
table does not reflect any other fee waivers or expense reimbursement
arrangements that may be in effect. The Management Fees noted above, without
reimbursement, would be .50% for each Fund and Total Fund Operating Expenses
would be .62% for the MONEY FUND, and .67% for the GOVERNMENT MONEY FUND. In
addition, unlike certain other funds in the Dreyfus Family of Funds, each
Fund will charge your account $2.00 for each redemption check you write; you
also will be charged $5.00 for each exchange made and for each redemption you
make by wire or pursuant to the Dreyfus TELETRANSFER Privilege, or if you
otherwise closeout your account. These charges will be paid to the Fund's
transfer agent and will reduce the transfer agency charges otherwise payable
by each Fund. See "Shareholder Services" and "How to Redeem Shares." In
addition, certain securities dealers, banks or other financial institutions
may charge their clients direct fees for effecting transactions in shares;
such fees are not reflected in the foregoing table. See "Management of the
Funds" and "Shareholder Services Plan."
    

       Page 4
                         CONDENSED FINANCIAL INFORMATION
        The information in the following tables has been audited by Ernst &
Young LLP, each Fund's independent auditors, whose reports thereon appear in
the Statement of Additional Information. Further financial data and related
notes as to each Fund are included in the Statement of Additional
Information, available upon request.

                           FINANCIAL HIGHLIGHTS
MONEY FUND -- Contained below is per share operating performance data for a
share of Common Stock outstanding, total investment return, ratios to average
net assets and other supplemental data for each year indicated. This
information has been derived from the MONEY FUND'S financial statements.
<TABLE>
   


                                                                                              MONEY FUND
                                                                                   FISCAL YEAR ENDED FEBRUARY 28/29,
                                                                         -----------------------------------------------------
PER SHARE DATA:                                                             1993(1)             1994        1995        1996
                                                                         ----------         ----------    --------    --------
<S>                                                                      <C>               <C>          <C>        <C>
    Net asset value, beginning of year....................               $    1.00         $   1.00     $   1.00   $   1.00
                                                                         ----------         ----------    --------    --------
    INVESTMENT OPERATIONS;
    Investment income--net ...............................                  .032               .033         .046       .058
                                                                         ----------         ----------    --------    --------
    DISTRIBUTIONS;
    Dividends from investment income-net..................                 (.032)             (.033)       (.046)     (.058)
                                                                         ----------         ----------    --------    --------
    Net asset value, end of year..........................               $  1.00           $   1.00     $   1.00   $   1.00
                                                                         ========          =========    =========  =========
TOTAL INVESTMENT RETURN...................................                  3.80%(2)           3.40%        4.73%      5.97%
RATIOS/SUPPLEMENTAL DATA:
    Ratio of expenses to average net assets ..............                    --                .10%         .18%        .31%
    Ratio of net investment income to average net assets....                3.66%(2)           3.33%        4.70%       5.82%
    Decrease reflected in above expense ratios due to
      undertakings by The Dreyfus Corporation.............                   .71%(2)            .55%         .46%        .31%
    Net Assets, end of year (000's omitted)...............             $734,349         $1,217,032   $1,623,242    $2,098,292
(1)From April 24, 1992 (commencement of operations) to February 28, 1993.
(2)Annualized.
</TABLE>
    

       Page 5
GOVERNMENT MONEY FUND -- Contained below is per share operating performance
data for a share of Beneficial Interest outstanding,
total investment return, ratios to average net assets and other supplemental
data for each year indicated. This information has been derived from the
GOVERNMENT MONEY FUND'S financial statements.
<TABLE>
   


                                                                                          GOVERNMENT MONEY FUND
                                                                                    FISCAL YEAR ENDED FEBRUARY 28/29,
                                                                         ------------------------------------------------------
PER SHARE DATA:                                                             1993(1)              1994        1995        1996
                                                                         ----------         ----------    --------    --------
<S>                                                                       <C>                 <C>          <C>          <C>
    Net asset value, beginning of year.....................               $  1.00             $  1.00      $  1.00      $  1.00
                                                                         ----------         ----------    --------    --------
    INVESTMENT OPERATIONS:
    Investment income--net ................................                  .031                .032         .046         .058
                                                                         ----------         ----------    --------    --------
    DISTRIBUTIONS;
    Dividends from investment income-net...................                 (.031)              (.032)       (.046)      (.058)
                                                                         ----------         ----------    --------    --------
    Net asset value, end of year...........................               $  1.00             $  1.00       $  1.00    $  1.00
                                                                         ========             =========    =========  =========
TOTAL INVESTMENT RETURN....................................                  3.69%(2)            3.30%         4.67%      5.94%
RATIOS/SUPPLEMENTAL DATA:
    Ratio of expenses to average net assets ...............                   --                  .02%         .17%        .31%
    Ratio of net investment income to average net assets ..                 3.58%(2)             3.24%        5.05%       5.79%
    Decrease reflected in above expense ratios due to
      undertakings by The Dreyfus Corporation..............                  .75%(2)               .64%        .44%        .36%
    Net Assets, end of year (000's omitted)................             $116,696              $265,691   $1,041,722  $1,366,056
(1)  From April 24, 1992 (commencement of operations) to February 28, 1993.
(2)  Annualized.
</TABLE>
    

                            YIELD INFORMATION
   

        From time to time, each Fund advertises its yield and effective
yield. Both yield figures are based on historical earnings and are not
intended to indicate future performance. It can be expected that each Fund's
yield will fluctuate substantially. A Fund's yield refers to the income
generated by an investment in such Fund over a seven-day period (which period
will be stated in the advertisement). This income is then annualized. That
is, the amount of income generated by the investment during that week is
assumed to be generated each week over a 52-week period and is shown as a
percentage of the investment. The effective yield is calculated similarly,
but, when annualized, the income earned by an investment in a Fund is assumed
to be reinvested. The effective yield will be slightly higher than the yield
because of the compounding effect of this assumed reinvestment. Each Fund's
yield and effective yield may reflect absorbed expenses pursuant to any
undertaking that may be in effect. See "Management of the Funds."
    

        Yield information is useful in reviewing a Fund's performance, but
because yields will fluctuate, such information under certain conditions may
not provide a basis for comparison with domestic bank deposits, other
investments which pay a fixed yield for a stated period of time, or other
investment companies which may use a different method of computing yield.
   

        Comparative performance information may be used from time to time in
advertising or marketing each Fund's shares, including data from Lipper
Analytical Services, Inc., Bank Rate Monitortrademark, N. Palm Beach, Florida
33408, IBC's Money Fund Reporttrademark, Morningstar, Inc. and other industry
publications.
    

        Page 6
                          DESCRIPTION OF THE FUNDS
INVESTMENT OBJECTIVE
   

        Each Fund's investment objective is to provide you with as high a
level of current income as is consistent with the preservation of capital and
the maintenance of liquidity. It cannot be changed, as to a Fund, without
approval by the holders of a majority (as defined in the Investment Company
Act of 1940, as amended (the "1940 Act")) of such Fund's outstanding voting
shares. There can be no assurance that a Fund's investment objective will be
achieved. Each Fund pursues this objective in the manner described below.
Securities in which each Fund invests may not earn as high a level of current
income as long-term or lower quality securities which generally have less
liquidity, greater market risk and more fluctuation in market value.
    

MANAGEMENT POLICIES
   

        Each Fund seeks to maintain a net asset value of $1.00 per share for
purchases and redemptions. To do so, each Fund uses the amortized cost method
of valuing its securities pursuant to Rule 2a-7 under the 1940 Act, which
Rule includes various maturity, quality and diversification requirements,
certain of which are summarized as follows. In accordance with Rule 2a-7,
each Fund is required to maintain a dollar-weighted average portfolio
maturity of 90 days or less, purchase only instruments having remaining
maturities of 13 months or less and invest only in U.S. dollar denominated
securities determined in accordance with procedures established by each
Fund's Board to present minimal credit risks and, with respect to the MONEY
FUND only, which are rated in one of the two highest rating categories for
debt obligations by at least two nationally recognized statistical rating
organizations (or one rating organization if the instrument was rated by only
one such organization), or, if unrated, are of comparable quality as
determined in accordance with procedures established by the MONEY FUND'S
Board. Moreover, the MONEY FUND will purchase only securities so rated in the
highest rating category or, if unrated, of comparable quality as determined
in accordance with such procedures. The nationally recognized statistical
rating organizations currently rating instruments of the type the MONEY FUND
may purchase are Moody's Investors Service, Inc., Standard & Poor's Ratings
Group, a division of  The McGraw-Hill Companies, Inc., Duff & Phelps Credit
Rating Co., Fitch Investors Service, L.P., IBCA Limited and IBCA Inc., and
Thomson BankWatch, Inc. and their rating criteria are described in the
"Appendix" to the Statement of Additional Information. This discussion
concerning investment ratings and rating organizations does not apply to the
GOVERNMENT MONEY FUND because it invests exclusively in U.S. Government
securities and repurchase agreements in respect thereof. For further
information regarding the amortized cost method of valuing securities, see
"Determination of Net Asset Value" in the Statement of Additional
Information. There can be no assurance that either Fund will be able to
maintain a stable net asset value of $1.00 per share.
    
   

MONEY FUND -- The MONEY FUND invests in short-term money market obligations,
including securities issued or guaranteed by the U.S. Government or its
agencies or instrumentalities, certificates of deposit, time deposits,
bankers' acceptances and other short-term obligations issued by domestic
banks, foreign subsidiaries or foreign branches of domestic banks, and
domestic and foreign branches of foreign banks, repurchase agreements, and
high grade domestic and foreign commercial paper and other short-term
corporate obligations, including those with floating or variable rates of
interest. The MONEY FUND may invest in U.S. dollar denominated obligations
issued or guaranteed by one or more foreign governments or any of their
political subdivisions, agencies or instrumentalities, including obligations
of supranational entities. See "Appendix -- Certain Portfolio Securities." In
addition, the MONEY FUND is permitted to lend portfolio securities and enter
into reverse repurchase agreements. See "Appendix -- Investment Techniques."
During normal market conditions, at least 25% of the MONEY FUND'S assets will
be invested in bank obligations. See "Investment Considerations and Risks"
below.
    

      Page 7
   
    
   

GOVERNMENT MONEY FUND-- The GOVERNMENT MONEY FUND invests in securities
issued or guaranteed as to principal and interest by the U.S. Government or
its agencies or instrumentalities, and repurchase agreements in respect of
such securities. See "Appendix -- Certain Portfolio Securities."
    
   

INVESTMENT CONSIDERATIONS AND RISKS
    
   

GENERAL -- Each Fund is designed to benefit investors who do not engage in
frequent redemptions or exchanges of the Fund's shares. Because charges may
apply to redemptions and exchanges of Fund shares, neither Fund may be an
appropriate investment for an investor who intends to engage frequently in
such transactions.
    
   

        Each Fund will attempt to increase yield by trading to take advantage
of short-term market variations. This policy is expected to result in high
portfolio turnover but should not adversely affect a Fund since neither Fund
usually pays brokerage commissions when it purchases portfolio securities.
The value of the portfolio securities held by each Fund will vary inversely
to changes in prevailing interest rates. Thus, if interest rates have
increased from the time a security was purchased, such security, if sold,
might be sold at a price less than its purchase cost. Similarly, if interest
rates have declined from the time a security was purchased, such security, if
sold, might be sold at a price greater than its purchase cost. In either
instance, if the security was purchased at face value and held to maturity,
no gain or loss would be realized.
    
   

        Dividends and distributions attributable to interest from direct
obligations of the United States and paid by the GOVERNMENT MONEY FUND to
individuals currently are not subject to personal income tax in most states.
Dividends and distributions attributable to interest from other securities in
which the GOVERNMENT MONEY FUND may invest, such as repurchase agreements,
however, may be subject to state tax. See "Dividends, Distributions and
Taxes."
    
   

FOREIGN SECURITIES -- Since the MONEY FUND'S portfolio may contain securities
issued by foreign governments, or any of their political subdivisions,
agencies or instrumentalities, and by foreign subsidiaries and foreign
branches of domestic banks, domestic and foreign branches of foreign banks,
and commercial paper issued by foreign issuers, the MONEY FUND may be subject
to additional investment risks with respect to such securities that are
different in some respects from those incurred by a fund which invests only
in debt obligations of U.S. domestic issuers, although such obligations may
be higher yielding when compared to the securities of U.S. domestic issuers.
Such risks include possible political and economic developments, the possible
imposition of foreign withholding taxes on interest income payable on the
securities, the possible establishment of exchange controls or the adoption
of other foreign governmental restrictions which might adversely affect the
payment of principal and interest on these securities and the possible
seizure or nationalization of foreign deposits.
    
   

BANK SECURITIES -- To the extent the MONEY FUND'S investments are
concentrated in the banking industry, the MONEY FUND will have
correspondingly greater exposure to the risk factors which are characteristic
of such investments. Sustained increases in interest rates can adversely
affect the availability or liquidity and cost of capital funds for a bank's
lending activities, and a deterioration in general economic conditions could
increase the exposure to credit losses. In addition, the value of the
investment return on the MONEY FUND'S shares could be affected by economic or
regulatory developments in or related to the banking industry, and the
effects of competition within the banking industry as well as with other
types of financial institutions. The MONEY FUND, however, will seek to
minimize its exposure to such risks by investing only in debt securities
which are determined to be of the highest quality pursuant to procedures
established by its Board.
    
   

SIMULTANEOUS INVESTMENTS -- Investment decisions for each Fund are made
independently from those of other investment companies advised by The Dreyfus
Corporation. If, however, such other investment companies desire to invest
in, or dispose of, the same securities as a Fund, available investments or
oppor-
      Page 8
tunities for sales will be allocated equitably to each investment
company. In some cases, this procedure may adversely affect the size of the
position obtained for or disposed of by a Fund or the price paid or received
by a Fund.
    

                        MANAGEMENT OF THE FUNDS
   

INVESTMENT ADVISER -- The Dreyfus Corporation, located at 200 Park Avenue,
New York, New York 10166, was formed in 1947 and serves as each Fund's
investment adviser. The Dreyfus Corporation is a wholly-owned subsidiary of
Mellon Bank, N.A., which is a wholly-owned subsidiary of Mellon Bank
Corporation ("Mellon"). As of May 31, 1996, The Dreyfus Corporation managed
or administered approximately $80 billion in assets for more than 1.7 million
investor accounts nationwide.
    
   

        The Dreyfus Corporation supervises and assists in the overall
management of the affairs of each Fund under a separate Management Agreement
with each Fund, subject to the authority of the MONEY FUND'S Board in
accordance with Maryland law, and the GOVERNMENT MONEY FUND'S Board in
accordance with Massachusetts law.
    
   

        Mellon is a publicly owned multibank holding company incorporated
under Pennsylvania law in 1971 and registered under the Federal Bank Holding
Company Act of 1956, as amended. Mellon provides a comprehensive range of
financial products and services in domestic and selected international
markets. Mellon is among the twenty-five largest bank holding companies in
the United States based on total assets. Mellon's principal wholly-owned
subsidiaries are Mellon Bank, N.A., Mellon Bank (DE) National Association,
Mellon Bank (MD), The Boston Company, Inc., AFCO Credit Corporation and a
number of companies known as Mellon Financial Services Corporations. Through
its subsidiaries, including The Dreyfus Corporation, Mellon managed more than
$237 billion in assets as of March 31, 1996, including approximately $83
billion in proprietary mutual fund assets. As of March 31, 1996, Mellon,
through various subsidiaries, provided non-investment services, such as
custodial or administration services, for more than $886 billion in assets,
including approximately $61 billion in mutual fund assets.
    
   

        Under the terms of its respective Management Agreement, each Fund has
agreed to pay The Dreyfus Corporation a monthly fee at the annual rate of .50
of 1% of the value of the Fund's average daily net assets. For the fiscal
year ended February 29, 1996, the MONEY FUND and GOVERNMENT MONEY FUND paid
The Dreyfus Corporation a monthly management fee at the effective annual rate
of .19 of 1% and .14 of 1%, respectively, of the value of such Fund's average
daily net assets pursuant to separate undertakings by The Dreyfus
Corporation. From time to time, The Dreyfus Corporation may waive receipt of
its fees and/or voluntarily assume certain expenses of a Fund, which would
have the effect of lowering that Fund's overall expense ratio and increasing
yield to investors. Neither Fund will pay The Dreyfus Corporation at a later
time for any amounts it may waive, nor will either Fund reimburse The Dreyfus
Corporation for any amounts it may assume.
    
   

        The Dreyfus Corporation has agreed, with respect to each Fund, that,
until such time as The Dreyfus Corporation gives shareholders at least 90
days' notice to the contrary, if in any fiscal year of the Fund its aggregate
expenses, exclusive of taxes, brokerage, interest on borrowings and (with the
prior written consent of the necessary state securities commissions)
extraordinary expenses, but including the management fee, exceed .45 of 1% of
the value of its average daily net assets for the fiscal year, the Fund may
deduct from the payment to be made to The Dreyfus Corporation under its
Management Agreement, or The Dreyfus Corporation will bear, such excess
expense.
    
   

        In allocating brokerage transactions, TheDreyfus Corporation seeks to
obtain the best execution of orders at the most favorable price. Subject to
this determination, The Dreyfus Corporation may consider, among other things,
the receipt of research services and/or the sale of shares of a Fund or other
funds managed, advised or administered by The Dreyfus Corporation as factors
in the selection of broker-deal-
      Page 9
ers to execute portfolio transactions for each Fund. See "Portfolio
Transactions" in the Statement of Additional Information.
    
   

        The Dreyfus Corporation may pay the Fund's distributor for
shareholder services from The Dreyfus Corporation's own assets, including
past profits but not including the management fee paid by the Fund. The
Fund's distributor may use part or all of such payments to pay securities
dealers, banks or other financial institutions in respect of these services.
    
   

DISTRIBUTOR -- The Fund's distributor is Premier Mutual Fund Services, Inc.
(the "Distributor"), located at 60 State Street, Boston, Massachusetts 02109.
The Distributor's ultimate parent is Boston Institutional Group, Inc.
    
   

TRANSFER AND DIVIDEND DISBURSING AGENT AND CUSTODIAN -- Dreyfus Transfer,
Inc., a wholly-owned subsidiary of The Dreyfus Corporation, P.O. Box 9671,
Providence, Rhode Island 02940-9671, is the Transfer and Dividend Disbursing
Agent (the "Transfer Agent") for each Fund. The Transfer Agent will receive
the $5.00 exchange fee, the $5.00 account closeout fee, the $5.00 wire and
Dreyfus TELETRANSFER  redemption fee, and the $2.00 checkwriting charge,
described below. A sufficient number of your shares will be redeemed
automatically to pay these amounts. These payments will reduce the transfer
agency fee otherwise payable by each Fund. By purchasing shares of a Fund,
you are deemed to have consented to this procedure. The Bank of New York, 90
Washington Street, New York, New York 10286, is the Custodian for each Fund.
    

                            HOW TO BUY SHARES
        Fund shares are sold without a sales charge. You may be charged a
nominal fee if you effect transactions in Fund shares through a securities
dealer, bank or other financial institution. Share certificates are issued
only upon your written request. No certificates are issued for fractional
shares. Each Fund reserves the right to reject any purchase order.
   

        The minimum initial investment is $25,000. Subsequent investments
must be at least $1,000. The initial investment must be accompanied by the
Account Application.
    
   

        You may purchase Fund shares by check or wire, or through the Dreyfus
TELETRANSFER Privilege described below. Checks should be made payable to "The
Dreyfus Family of Funds." Payments to open new accounts which are mailed
should be sent to The Dreyfus Family of Funds, P.O. Box 9387, Providence,
Rhode Island 02940-9387, together with your Account Application. For
subsequent investments, your Fund account number should appear on the check
and an investment slip should be enclosed and sent to The Dreyfus Family of
Funds, P.O. Box 105, Newark, New Jersey 07101-0105. Neither initial nor
subsequent investments should be made by third party check. Purchase orders
may be delivered in person only to a Dreyfus Financial Center. THESE ORDERS
WILL BE FORWARDED TO THE RELEVANT FUND AND WILL BE PROCESSED ONLY UPON RECEIPT
THEREBY. For the location of the nearest Dreyfus Financial Center, please
call one of the telephone numbers listed under "General Information."
    
   

        Wire payments may be made if your bank account is in a commercial
bank that is a member of the Federal Reserve System or any other bank having
a correspondent bank in New York City. Immediately available funds may be
transmitted by wire to The Bank of New York, together with the applicable
Fund's DDA# as shown below, for purchase of Fund shares in your name: DDA
#8900204419/Dreyfus BASIC Money Market Fund, Inc., or DDA #8900204427/Dreyfus
BASIC U.S. Government Money Market Fund. The wire must include your Fund
account number (for new accounts, your Taxpayer Identification Number ("TIN")
should be included instead), account registration and dealer number, if
applicable. If your initial purchase of Fund shares is by wire, please call
1-800-645-6561 after completing your wire payment to obtain your Fund account
number. Please include your Fund account number on the Account Application
and promptly mail the Account Application to the Fund, as no redemptions will
be permitted
         Page 10
until the Account Application is received. You may obtain
further information about remitting funds in this manner from your bank. All
payments should be made in U.S. dollars and, to avoid additional fees and
delays, should be drawn only on U.S. banks. A charge will be imposed if any
check used for investment in your account does not clear. Each Fund makes
available to certain large institutions the ability to issue purchase
instructions through compatible computer facilities.
    

        Shares of each Fund also may be purchased through IRA accounts and
other kinds of retirement accounts, such as Keogh Plans and SEP-IRA's,
provided the opening balance is at least $5,000. Subsequent investments in
such retirement accounts must be at least $1,000. For details, please contact
Dreyfus Retirement Services, a division of Dreyfus Service Corporation, by
calling toll free 1-800-358-5566.
        Subsequent investments also may be made by electronic transfer of
funds from an account maintained in a bank or other domestic financial
institution that is an Automated Clearing House member. You must direct the
institution to transmit immediately available funds through the Automated
Clearing House to The Bank of New York with instructions to credit your Fund
account. The instructions must specify your Fund account registration and
your Fund account number PRECEDED BY THE DIGITS "1111."
        Shares of each Fund are sold on a continuous basis at the net asset
value per share next determined after an order in proper form is received by
the Transfer Agent or other agent or entity subject to the direction of such
agents. Net asset value per share is determined as of the close of trading on
the floor of the New York Stock Exchange (currently 4:00 p.m., New York time)
on each day the New York Stock Exchange or Transfer Agent, as to the MONEY
FUND, or the New York Stock Exchange, as to the Government Money Fund, is
open for business. Net asset value per share is computed by dividing the
value of the Fund's net assets (i.e., the value of its assets less
liabilities) by the total number of shares outstanding. See "Determination of
Net Asset Value" in the Statement of Additional Information.
        Federal regulations require that you provide a certified TIN upon
opening or reopening an account. See "Dividends, Distributions and Taxes" and
the Account Application for further information concerning this requirement.
Failure to furnish a certified TIN to the Fund could subject you to a $50
penalty imposed by the Internal Revenue Service (the "IRS").
   

DREYFUS TELETRANSFER PRIVILEGE -- You may purchase shares (minimum $1,000,
maximum $150,000 per day) without charge by telephone if you have checked the
appropriate box and supplied the necessary information on the Account
Application or have filed a Shareholder Services Form with the Transfer
Agent. The proceeds will be transferred between the bank account designated
in one of these documents and your Fund account. Only a bank account
maintained in a domestic financial institution which is an Automated Clearing
House member may be so designated. The Fund may modify or terminate this
Privilege at any time. No fee is contemplated for purchases of Fund shares
pursuant to this Privilege.
    
   

        If you have selected the Dreyfus TELETRANSFER Privilege, you may
request a Dreyfus TELETRANSFER purchase of shares by telephoning
1-800-645-6561 or, if you are calling from overseas, call 516-794-5452.
    
   

                          SHAREHOLDER SERVICES
    
   

FUND EXCHANGES -- You may purchase, in exchange for shares of your Fund,
shares of certain other funds managed or administered by The Dreyfus
Corporation, to the extent such shares are offered for sale in your state of
residence. These funds have different investment objectives which may be of
interest to you. If you desire to use this service, please call
1-800-645-6561 to determine if it is available and whether any conditions are
imposed on its use. You will be charged a $5.00 fee for each exchange you
make out of your Fund. This fee will be deducted from your account and paid
to the Transfer Agent.
    
   

        To request an exchange, you must give exchange instructions to the
Transfer Agent in writing or by telephone. Before an exchange, you must
obtain and should review a copy of the current prospectus of the fund into
which the exchange is being made. Prospectuses may be obtained by calling
1-800-645-
       Page 11
6561. Except in the case of personal retirement plans, the shares
being exchanged must have a current value of at least $1,000; furthermore,
when establishing a new account by exchange, the shares being exchanged must
have a value of at least the minimum initial investment required for the fund
into which the exchange is being made. The ability to issue exchange
instructions by telephone is given to all Fund shareholders automatically,
unless you check the applicable "No" box on the Account Application,
indicating that you specifically refuse this privilege. The Telephone
Exchange Privilege may be established for an existing account by written
request, signed by all shareholders on the account, or by a separate signed
Shareholder Services Form, also available by calling 1-800-645-6561. If you
have established the Telephone Exchange Privilege, you may telephone exchange
instructions by calling 1-800-645-6561 or, if you are calling from overseas,
call 516-794-5452. See "How to Redeem Shares _ Procedures." Upon an exchange
into a new account, the following shareholder services and privileges, as
applicable and where available, will be automatically carried over to the
fund into which the exchange is made: Telephone Exchange Privilege, Check
Redemption Privilege, Wire Redemption Privilege, Telephone Redemption
Privilege, Dreyfus TELETRANSFER Privilege and the dividend/capital gain
distribution option (except for Dreyfus Dividend Sweep)  selected by the
investor.
    

        Shares will be exchanged at the next determined net asset value;
however, a sales load may be charged with respect to exchanges into funds
sold with a sales load. If you are exchanging into a fund that charges a
sales load, you may qualify for share prices which do not include the sales
load or which reflect a reduced sales load, if the shares you are exchanging
were: (a) purchased with a sales load, (b) acquired by a previous exchange
from shares of the fund purchased with a sales load, or (c) acquired through
reinvestment of dividends or distributions paid with respect to the foregoing
categories of shares. To qualify, at the time of the exchange you must notify
the Transfer Agent. Any such qualification is subject to confirmation of your
holdings through a check of appropriate records. See "Shareholder Services"
in the Statement of Additional Information. Each Fund reserves the right to
reject any exchange request in whole or in part. The availability of Fund
Exchanges may be modified or terminated at any time upon notice to
shareholders. See "Dividends, Distributions and Taxes."
DREYFUS DIVIDEND SWEEP PRIVILEGE -- Dreyfus Dividend Sweep Privilege enables
you to invest automatically dividends or dividends and capital gain
distributions, if any, paid by the Fund in shares of another fund in the
Dreyfus Family of Funds of which you are a shareholder. Shares of the other
fund will be purchased at the then-current net asset value; however, a sales
load may be charged with respect to investments in shares of a fund sold with
a sales load. If you are investing in a fund that charges a sales load, you
may qualify for share prices which do not include the sales load or which
reflect a reduced sales load. If you are investing in a fund that charges a
contingent deferred sales charge, the shares purchased will be subject to the
contingent deferred sales charge, if any, applicable to the purchased shares.
See "Shareholder Services" in the Statement of Additional Information. For
more information concerning this Privilege or to request a Dividend Options
Form, please call toll free 1-800-645-6561. You may cancel your participation
in this Privilege by mailing written notification to The Dreyfus Family of
Funds, P.O. Box 9671, Providence, Rhode Island 02940-9671. To select a new
fund after cancellation, you must submit a new Dividend Options Form.
Enrollment in or cancellation of this Privilege is effective three business
days following receipt. This Privilege is available only for existing
accounts and may not be used to open new accounts. Minimum subsequent
investments do not apply. Each Fund may modify or terminate this Privilege at
any time or charge a service fee. No such fee currently is contemplated.
           Page 12
                             HOW TO REDEEM SHARES
GENERAL
        You may request redemption of your shares at any time. Redemption
requests should be transmitted to the Transfer Agent as described below. When
a request is received in proper form, your Fund will redeem the shares at the
next determined net asset value.
        YOU WILL BE CHARGED $5.00 WHEN YOU REDEEM ALL SHARES IN YOUR ACCOUNT
OR YOUR ACCOUNT IS OTHERWISE CLOSED OUT. The fee will be deducted from your
redemption proceeds and paid to the Transfer Agent. The account closeout fee
does not apply to exchanges out of the Fund or to wire or Dreyfus TELETRANSFER
 redemptions, for each of which a $5.00 fee applies. Securities dealers,
banks and other financial institutions may charge their clients a nominal fee
for effecting redemptions of Fund shares. Any certificates representing Fund
shares being redeemed must be submitted with the redemption request. The
value of the shares redeemed may be more or less than their original cost,
depending upon the Fund's then-current net asset value.
   

        Each Fund ordinarily will make payment for all shares redeemed within
seven days after receipt by the Transfer Agent of a redemption request in
proper form, except as provided by the rules of the Securities and Exchange
Commission. HOWEVER, IF YOU HAVE PURCHASED FUND SHARES BY CHECK OR BY THE
DREYFUS TELETRANSFER PRIVILEGE AND SUBSEQUENTLY SUBMIT A WRITTEN REDEMPTION
REQUEST TO THE TRANSFER AGENT, THE REDEMPTION WILL BE EFFECTIVE AND THE
REDEMPTION PROCEEDS WILL BE TRANSMITTED TO YOU PROMPTLY UPON BANK CLEARANCE
OF YOUR PURCHASE CHECK OR DREYFUS TELETRANSFER PURCHASE ORDER, WHICH MAY TAKE
UP TO EIGHT BUSINESS DAYS OR MORE. IN ADDITION, THE FUND WILL NOT HONOR
REDEMPTION CHECKS UNDER THE CHECK REDEMPTION PRIVILEGE, AND WILL REJECT
REQUESTS TO REDEEM SHARES BY WIRE OR TELEPHONE OR PURSUANT TO THE DREYFUS
TELETRANSFER PRIVILEGE, FOR A PERIOD OF EIGHT BUSINESS DAYS AFTER RECEIPT BY
THE TRANSFER AGENT OF THE PURCHASE CHECK OR THE DREYFUS TELETRANSFER PURCHASE
ORDER AGAINST WHICH SUCH REDEMPTION IS REQUESTED. THESE PROCEDURES WILL NOT
APPLY IF YOUR SHARES WERE PURCHASED BY WIRE PAYMENT, OR IF YOU OTHERWISE HAVE
A SUFFICIENT COLLECTED BALANCE IN YOUR ACCOUNT TO COVER THE REDEMPTION
REQUEST. PRIOR TO THE TIME ANY REDEMPTION IS EFFECTIVE, DIVIDENDS ON SUCH
SHARES WILL ACCRUE AND BE PAYABLE, AND YOU WILL BE ENTITLED TO EXERCISE ALL
OTHER RIGHTS OF BENEFICIAL OWNERSHIP. Fund shares will not be redeemed until
the Transfer Agent has received your Account Application.
    
   

        Each Fund reserves the right to redeem your account at its option
upon not less than 45 days written notice if your account's net asset value
is $10,000 or less and remains so during the notice period. The $5.00 account
closeout fee would be charged in such case.
    

PROCEDURES
   

        You may redeem shares by using the regular redemption procedure
through the Transfer Agent, or, if you have checked the appropriate box and
supplied the necessary information on the Account Application or have filed a
Shareholder Services Form with the Transfer Agent, through the Check
Redemption Privilege, the Wire Redemption Privilege, the Telephone Redemption
Privilege or the Dreyfus TELETRANSFER Privilege. The Fund makes available to
certain large institutions the ability to issue redemption instructions
through compatible computer facilities. Each Fund reserves the right to
refuse any request made by wire or telephone, including requests made shortly
after a change of address, and may limit the amount involved or the number of
such requests. Each Fund may modify or terminate any redemption privilege at
any time. Shares held under Keogh Plans, IRAs or other retirement plans, and
shares for which certificates have been issued, are not eligible for the
Check Redemption, Wire Redemption, Telephone Redemption or Dreyfus
TELETRANSFER Privilege.
    

       Page 13
   

        You may redeem Fund shares by telephone if you have checked the
appropriate box on the Account Application or have filed a Shareholder
Services Form with the Transfer Agent. If you select a telephone redemption
privilege or telephone exchange privilege (which is granted automatically
unless you refuse it), you authorize the Transfer Agent to act on telephone
instructions from any person representing himself or herself to be you and
reasonably believed by the Transfer Agent to be genuine. Each Fund will
require the Transfer Agent to employ reasonable procedures, such as requiring
a form of personal identification, to confirm that instructions are genuine
and, if it does not follow such procedures, the Fund or the Transfer Agent
may be liable for any losses due to unauthorized or fraudulent instructions.
Neither the Fund nor the Transfer Agent will be liable for following
telephone instructions reasonably believed to be genuine.
    

        During times of drastic economic or market conditions, you may
experience difficulty in contacting the Transfer Agent by telephone to
request a redemption or exchange of Fund shares. In such cases, you should
consider using the other redemption procedures described herein. Use of these
other redemption procedures may result in your redemption request being
processed at a later time than it would have been if telephone redemption had
been used.
REGULAR REDEMPTION -- Under the regular redemption procedure, you may redeem
Fund shares by written request mailed to The Dreyfus Family of Funds, P.O.
Box 9671, Providence, Rhode Island 02940-9671. Redemption requests may be
delivered in person only to a Dreyfus Financial Center. THESE REQUESTS WILL
BE FORWARDED TO THE RELEVANT FUND AND WILL BE PROCESSED ONLY UPON RECEIPT
THEREBY. For the location of the nearest Dreyfus Financial Center, please
call one of the telephone numbers listed under "General Information."
Redemption requests must be signed by each shareholder, including each owner
of a joint account, and each signature must be guaranteed. The Transfer Agent
has adopted standards and procedures pursuant to which signature-guarantees
in proper form generally will be accepted from domestic banks, brokers,
dealers, credit unions, national securities exchanges, registered securities
associations, clearing agencies and savings associations, as well as from
participants in the New York Stock Exchange Medallion Signature Program, the
Securities Transfer Agents Medallion Program ("STAMP") and the Stock
Exchanges Medallion Program. If you have any questions with respect to
signature-guarantees, please call one of the telephone numbers listed under
"General Information."
        Redemption proceeds of at least $5,000 will be wired to any member
bank of the Federal Reserve System in accordance with a written
signature-guaranteed request.
   

CHECK REDEMPTION PRIVILEGE -- You may write Redemption Checks drawn on your
Fund account. Redemption Checks may be made payable to the order of any
person in the amount of $1,000 or more. Redemption Checks should not be used
to close your account. Your account will be charged $2.00 for each Redemption
Check you write. The Transfer Agent also will impose a fee for stopping
payment of a Redemption Check upon your request or if the Transfer Agent
cannot honor the Redemption Check due to insufficient funds or other valid
reason. You should date your Redemption Checks with the current date when you
write them. Please do not postdate your Redemption Checks. If you do, the
Transfer Agent will honor, upon presentment, even if presented before the
date of the check, all postdated Redemption Checks which are dated within six
months of presentment for payment, if they are otherwise in good order. The
Fund may return an unpaid Redemption Check that would draw your account
balance below $5.00 and you may be subject to extra charges. If you hold
shares in a Dreyfussponsored IRA account, you may be permitted to make
withdrawals from your IRA account using checks furnished to you by TheDreyfus
Trust Company.
    
   

WIRE REDEMPTION PRIVILEGE -- You may request by wire or telephone that
redemption proceeds (minimum $5,000) be wired to your account at a bank which
is a member of the Federal Reserve System, or a correspondent bank if your
bank is not a member. You also may direct that redemption proceeds be paid by
          Page 14
check (maximum $150,000 per day) made out to the owners of record and mailed
to your address. Redemption proceeds of less than $5,000 will be paid
automatically by check. Holders of jointly registered Fund or bank accounts
may have redemption proceeds of not more than $250,000 wired within any
30-day period. You may telephone redemption requests by calling
1-800-645-6561 or, if you are calling from overseas, call 516-794-5452. The
Statement of Additional Information sets forth instructions for transmitting
redemption requests by wire.
    
   

TELEPHONE REDEMPTION PRIVILEGE -- You may request by telephone that
redemption proceeds (maximum $150,000 per day) be paid by check and mailed to
your address. You may telephone redemption instructions by calling
1-800-645-6561 or, if you are calling from overseas, call 516-794-5452.
    
   

DREYFUS TELETRANSFER PRIVILEGE -- You may request by telephone that
redemption proceeds (minimum $1,000 per day) be transferred between your Fund
account and your bank account . Only a bank account maintained in a domestic
financial institution which is an Automated Clearing House member may be
designated. Redemption proceeds will be on deposit in your account at an
Automated Clearing House member bank ordinarily two days after receipt of the
redemption request or, at your request, paid by check (maximum $150,000 per
day) and mailed to your address. Holders of jointly registered Fund or bank
accounts may redeem through the Dreyfus TELETRANSFER Privilege for transfer
to their bank account not more than $250,000 within any 30-day period. You
will be charged a $5.00 TELETRANSFER fee for each Dreyfus TELETRANSFER
redemption, which will be deducted from your account and paid to the Transfer
Agent.
    
   

        If you have selected the Dreyfus TELETRANSFER Privilege, you may
request a Dreyfus TELETRANSFER redemption of shares by telephoning
1-800-645-6561 or, if you are calling from overseas, call 516-794-5452.
    

                           SHAREHOLDER SERVICES PLAN
        Each Fund has adopted a Shareholder Services Plan pursuant to which
the Fund reimburses Dreyfus Service Corporation, a wholly-owned subsidiary of
The Dreyfus Corporation, an amount not to exceed an annual rate of .25 of 1%
of the value of the Fund's average daily net assets for certain allocated
expenses of providing personal services and/or maintaining shareholder
accounts. The services provided may include personal services relating to
shareholder accounts, such as answering shareholder inquiries regarding the
Fund and providing reports and other information, and services related to the
maintenance of shareholder accounts.

                      DIVIDENDS, DISTRIBUTIONS AND TAXES
   

        Ordinarily, dividends are declared from net investment income on each
day the New York Stock Exchange and Transfer Agent, as to the MONEY FUND, or
the New York Stock Exchange, as to the GOVERNMENT MONEY FUND, is open for
business. Each Fund's earnings for Saturdays, Sundays and holidays are
declared as dividends on the next business day. Dividends for each Fund
usually are paid on the last calendar day of each month, and are
automatically reinvested in additional Fund shares at net asset value or, at
your option, paid in cash. If you redeem all shares in your account at any
time during the month, all dividends to which you are entitled will be paid
to you along with the proceeds of the redemption. If you are an omnibus
accountholder and indicate in a partial redemption request that a portion of
any accrued dividends to which such account is entitled belongs to an
underlying accountholder who has redeemed all shares in his or her account,
such portion of the accrued dividends will be paid to you along with the
proceeds of the redemption, after the deduction of any fees. Distributions
from net realized securities gains, if any, generally are declared and paid
once a year, but either Fund may make distributions on a more frequent basis
to comply with the distribution requirements of the Internal Revenue Code of
1986, as amended (the "Code"), in all events in a manner consistent with the
provisions of the 1940 Act. Neither Fund will
         Page 15
make distributions from net realized securities gains unless capital loss
carryovers, if any, have been utilized or have expired. You may choose whether
to receive distributions in cash or to reinvest in additional Fund shares at
net asset value. All expenses are accrued daily and deducted before
declaration of dividends to investors.
    

        Dividends derived from net investment income, together with
distributions from any net realized short-term securities gains and all or a
portion of any gains realized from the sale or other disposition of certain
market discount bonds, paid by the Fund will be taxable to U.S. shareholders
as ordinary income, whether received in cash or reinvested in additional Fund
shares. No dividend paid by a Fund will qualify for the dividends received
deduction allowable to certain U.S. corporations. Distributions from net
realized long-term securities gains of a Fund, if any, will be taxable to
U.S. shareholders as long-term capital gains for Federal income tax purposes
regardless of how long you have held your Fund shares and whether such
distributions are received in cash or reinvested in additional Fund shares.
The Code provides that the net capital gains of an individual generally will
not be subject to Federal income tax at a rate in excess of 28%. Dividends
and distributions may be subject to certain state and local taxes.
        Dividends derived from net investment income, together with
distributions from net realized short-term securities gains and all or a
portion of any gains realized from the sale or other disposition of certain
market discount bonds, paid by the Fund to a foreign investor generally are
subject to U.S. nonresident withholding taxes at the rate of 30%, unless the
foreign investor claims the benefit of a lower rate specified in a tax
treaty. Distributions from net realized long-term securities gains paid by a
Fund to a foreign investor generally will not be subject to U.S. nonresident
withholding tax. However, such distributions may be subject to backup
withholding, as described below, unless the foreign investor certifies his
non-U.S. residency status.
        Notice as to the tax status of your dividends and distributions will
be mailed to you annually. You also will receive periodic summaries of your
account which will include information as to dividends and distributions from
securities gains, if any, paid during the year. Dividends and distributions
attributable to interest from direct obligations of the United States and
paid by a Fund to individuals currently are not subject to tax in most
states. Dividends and distributions attributable to interest from other
securities in which each Fund may invest may be subject to state tax. The
GOVERNMENT MONEY FUND intends to provide shareholders with a statement which
sets forth the percentage of dividends and distributions paid by such Fund
that is attributable to interest income from direct obligations of the United
States.
   

        The exchange of shares of one fund for shares of another is treated
for Federal income tax purposes as a sale of the shares given in exchange by
the shareholder and, therefore, an exchanging shareholder may realize a
taxable gain or loss.
    

        Federal regulations generally require each Fund to withhold ("backup
withholding") and remit to the U.S. Treasury 31% of dividends and
distributions from net realized securities gains paid to a shareholder if
such shareholder fails to certify either that the TIN furnished in connection
with opening an account is correct, or that such shareholder has not received
notice from the IRS of being subject to backup withholding as a result of a
failure to properly report taxable dividend or interest income on a Federal
income tax return. Furthermore, the IRS may notify a Fund to institute backup
withholding if the IRS determines a shareholder's TIN is incorrect or if a
shareholder has failed to properly report taxable dividend and interest
income on a Federal income tax return.
       Page 16
        A TIN is either the Social Security number or employer identification
number of the record owner of the account. Any tax withheld as a result of
backup withholding does not constitute an additional tax imposed on the
record owner of the account, and may be claimed as a credit on the record
owner's Federal income tax return.
   

        Management of each Fund believes that such Fund has qualified for the
fiscal year ended February 29, 1996 as a "regulated investment company" under
the Code. Each Fund intends to continue to so qualify as long as such
qualification is in the best interests of its shareholders. Such
qualification relieves a Fund of any liability for Federal income tax to the
extent its earnings are distributed in accordance with applicable provisions
of the Code. Each Fund is subject to a non-deductible 4% excise tax, measured
with respect to certain undistributed amounts of taxable investment income
and capital gains.
    

        You should consult your tax adviser regarding specific questions as
to Federal, state or local taxes.
                             GENERAL INFORMATION
MONEY FUND -- The MONEY FUND was incorporated under Maryland law on March 17,
1992, and commenced operations on April 24, 1992. The MONEY FUND is
authorized to issue 3 billion shares of Common Stock, par value $.001 per
share. Each share has one vote.
   

        Unless otherwise required by the 1940 Act, ordinarily it will not be
necessary for the MONEY FUND to hold annual meetings of shareholders. As a
result, MONEY FUND shareholders may not consider each year the election of
Directors or the appointment of auditors. However, pursuant to the MONEY
FUND'S By-Laws, the holders of at least 10% of the shares outstanding and
entitled to vote may require the Fund to hold a special meeting of
shareholders for purposes of removing a Director from office and for any
other purpose. MONEY FUND shareholders may remove a Director by the
affirmative vote of a majority of the MONEY FUND'S outstanding voting shares.
In addition, the Board of Directors will call a meeting of shareholders for
the purpose of electing Directors if, at any time, less than a majority of
the Directors then holding office have been elected by shareholders.
    

GOVERNMENT MONEY FUND -- The GOVERNMENT MONEY FUND was organized as an
unincorporated business trust under the laws of the Commonwealth of
Massachusetts pursuant to an Agreement and Declaration of  Trust (the "Trust
Agreement") dated September 12, 1990, and commenced operations on April 24,
1992. The GOVERNMENT MONEY FUND is authorized to issue an unlimited number of
shares of Beneficial Interest, par value $.001 per share. Each share has one
vote.
   

        Under Massachusetts law, shareholders could, under certain
circumstances, be held personally liable for the obligations of the GOVERNMENT
 MONEY FUND. However, the Trust Agreement disclaims shareholder liability for
acts or obligations of the GOVERNMENT MONEY FUND and requires that notice of
such disclaimer be given in each agreement, obligation or instrument entered
into or executed by the Fund or a Trustee. The Trust Agreement provides for
indemnification from the GOVERNMENT MONEY FUND'S property for all losses and
expenses of any shareholder held personally liable for the obligations of the
Fund. Thus, the risk of a shareholder incurring financial loss on account of
shareholder liability is limited to circumstances in which the GOVERNMENT
MONEY FUND itself would be unable to meet its obligations, a possibility
which management believes is remote. Upon payment of any liability incurred
by the GOVERNMENT MONEY FUND, the shareholder paying such liability will be
entitled to reimbursement from the general assets of the Fund. The GOVERNMENT
MONEY FUND intends to conduct its operations in such a way as to avoid, as
far as possible, ultimate liability of the shareholders for liabilities of
the Fund. As discussed under "Management of the Funds" in the Statement of
Additional Information, the GOVERNMENT MONEY FUND ordinarily will not hold
shareholder meetings; however, shareholders under certain circumstances may
have the right to call a meeting of shareholders for the purpose of voting to
remove Trustees.
    

       Page 17
BOTH FUNDS -- Although each Fund is offering only its own shares, it is
possible that one Fund might become liable for any misstatement in this
Prospectus about the other Fund. The respective Boards of the Funds have
considered this factor in approving the use of this single combined
Prospectus.
   

        The Transfer Agent maintains a record of your ownership and will send
confirmations and statements of account. Each Fund sends an annual and
semi-annual financial report to all its shareholders.
    

        Shareholder inquiries may be made by writing to your Fund at 144
Glenn Curtiss Boulevard, Uniondale, New York 11556-0144, or by calling toll
free 1-800-645-6561; in New York City, call 1-718-895-1206; outside the U. S.
and Canada, call 516-794-5452.
   
    

         Page 18
                              APPENDIX
INVESTMENT TECHNIQUES
   

BORROWING MONEY -- The MONEY FUND may borrow money, including in connection
with the entry into reverse repurchase agreements described below, provided
that it maintains continuous asset coverage (that is, total assets including
borrowings, less liabilities exclusive of borrowings) of 300% of the amount
borrowed. The GOVERNMENT MONEY FUND may borrow money, but only for temporary
or emergency (not leveraging) purposes, in an amount up to 15% of the value
of its total assets (including the amount borrowed) valued at the lesser of
cost or market, less liabilities (not including the amount borrowed) at the
time the borrowing is made. While borrowings exceed 5% of a Fund's total
assets, the Fund will not make any additional investments.
    
   

REVERSE REPURCHASE AGREEMENTS -- The MONEY FUND may enter into reverse
repurchase agreements with banks, brokers or dealers. Reverse repurchase
agreements involve the transfer by the MONEY FUND of an underlying debt
instrument in return for cash proceeds based on a percentage of the value of
the security. At an agreed upon future date, the MONEY FUND repurchases the
security, at principal, plus accrued interest. As a result of these
transactions, the MONEY FUND is exposed to greater potential fluctuations in
the value of its assets and its net asset value per share. These transactions
will be subject to interest costs which may or may not be recovered by
appreciation of the securities purchased; in certain cases, interest costs on
the money borrowed may exceed the return received on the securities
purchased. The MONEY FUND'S Board has considered the risks to the MONEY FUND
and its shareholders which may result from the entry into reverse repurchase
agreements and has determined that the entry into such agreements is
consistent with the MONEY FUND'S investment objective and management
policies.
    
   

FORWARD COMMITMENTS -- The MONEY FUND may purchase securities on a forward
commitment or when-issued basis, which means that delivery and payment take
place a number of days after the date of the commitment to purchase. The
payment obligation and the interest rate receivable on a forward commitment
or when-issued security are fixed when the MONEY FUND enters into the
commitment, but the MONEY FUND does not make payment until it receives
delivery from the counterparty. The MONEY FUND will commit to purchase such
securities only with the intention of actually acquiring the securities, but
the Fund may sell these securities before the settlement date if it is deemed
advisable. The MONEY FUND will not accrue income in respect of a security
purchased on a forward commitment basis prior to its stated delivery date. A
segregated account of the MONEY FUND consisting of cash, cash equivalents or
U.S. Government securities or other high quality liquid debt securities at
least equal at all times to the amount of the forward commitments will be
established and maintained at the MONEY FUND'S custodian bank.
    
   

LENDING PORTFOLIO SECURITIES -- The MONEY FUND may lend securities from its
portfolio to brokers, dealers and other institutional investors needing to
borrow securities to complete certain transactions.  The MONEY FUND continues
to be entitled to payments in amounts equal to the interest or other
distributions payable on the loaned securities which affords the MONEY FUND
an opportunity to earn interest on the amount of the loan and on the loaned
securities' collateral. Loans of portfolio securities may not exceed 331/3%
of the value of the MONEY FUND'S total assets, and the MONEY FUND will
receive collateral consisting of cash, U.S. Government securities or
irrevocable letters of credit which will be maintained at all times in an
amount equal to at least 100% of the current market value of the loaned
securities. Such loans are terminable at any time upon specified notice. The
MONEY FUND might experience risk of loss if the institution with which it has
engaged in a portfolio loan transaction breaches its agreement with the MONEY
FUND.
    

       Page 19
PORTFOLIO SECURITIES
   
    
   

U.S. GOVERNMENT SECURITIES -- Securities issued or guaranteed by the U.S.
Government or its agencies or instrumentalities include U.S. Treasury
securities, which differ in their interest rates, maturities and times of
issuance. Some obligations issued or guaranteed by U.S. Government agencies
and instrumentalities are supported by the full faith and credit of the U.S.
Treasury; others by the right of the issuer to borrow from the Treasury;
others by discretionary authority of the U.S. Government to purchase certain
obligations of the agency or instrumentality; and others only by the credit
of the agency or instrumentality. These securities bear fixed, floating or
variable rates of interest. Interest may fluctuate based on generally
recognized reference rates or the relationship of rates. While the U.S.
Government provides financial support to such U.S. Government-sponsored
agencies or instrumentalities, no assurance can be given that it will always
do so, since it is not so obligated by law.
    
   

REPURCHASE AGREEMENTS -- In a repurchase agreement, the Fund buys, and the
seller agrees to repurchase, a security at a mutually agreed upon time and
price (usually within seven days). The repurchase agreement thereby
determines the yield during the purchaser's holding period, while the
seller's obligation to repurchase is secured by the value of the underlying
security. Repurchase agreements could involve risks in the event of a default
or insolvency of the other party to the agreement, including the possible
delays or restrictions upon the Fund's ability to dispose of the underlying
securities. The Fund may enter into repurchase agreements with certain banks
or non-bank dealers.
    
   

BANK OBLIGATIONS -- The MONEY FUND may purchase certificates of deposit, time
deposits, bankers' acceptances and other short-term obligations issued by
domestic banks, foreign subsidiaries or foreign branches of domestic banks
and domestic and foreign branches of foreign banks. With respect to such
securities issued by foreign subsidiaries or foreign branches of domestic
banks, and domestic and foreign branches of foreign banks, the MONEY FUND may
be subject to additional investment risks that are different in some respects
from those incurred by a fund which invests only in debt obligations of U.S.
domestic issuers. See "Description of the Funds -- Investment Considerations
and Risks -- Foreign Securities."
    

        Certificates of deposit are negotiable certificates evidencing the
obligation of a bank to repay funds deposited with it for a specified period
of time.
   

        Time deposits are non-negotiable deposits maintained in a banking
institution for a specified period of time (in no event longer than seven
days) at a stated interest rate.
    

        Bankers' acceptances are credit instruments evidencing the obligation
of a bank to pay a draft drawn on it by a customer. These instruments reflect
the obligation both of the bank and of the drawer to pay the face amount of
the instrument upon maturity. The other short-term obligations may include
uninsured, direct obligations bearing fixed, floating or variable interest
rates.
   

COMMERCIAL PAPER -- The MONEY FUND may purchase commercial paper consisting
of short-term, unsecured promissory notes issued to finance short-term credit
needs. The commercial paper purchased by the MONEY FUND will consist only of
direct obligations issued by domestic and foreign entities. The other
corporate obligations in which the MONEY FUND may invest consist of high
quality, U.S. dollar denominated short-term bonds and notes (including
variable amount master demand notes) issued by domestic and foreign
corporations, including banks.
    
   

FLOATING AND VARIABLE RATE OBLIGATIONS -- The MONEY FUND may purchase
floating and variable rate demand notes and bonds, which are obligations
ordinarily having stated maturities in excess of 13 months, but which permit
the holder to demand payment of principal at any time, or at specified
intervals not exceeding 13 months, in each case upon not more than 30 days'
notice. Variable rate demand notes include master demand notes which are
obligations that permit the MONEY FUND to invest fluctuating amounts, at
varying
        Page 20
rates of interest, pursuant to direct arrangements between the MONEY FUND, as
lender, and the borrower. These obligations permit daily changes in
the amount borrowed. Because these obligations are direct lending
arrangements between the lender and borrower, it is not contemplated that
such instruments generally will be traded, and there generally is no
established secondary market for these obligations, although they are
redeemable at face value, plus accrued interest. Accordingly, where these
obligations are not secured by letters of credit or other credit support
arrangements, the MONEY FUND'S right to redeem is dependent on the ability of
the borrower to pay principal and interest on demand.
    

PARTICIPATION INTERESTS -- The MONEY FUND may purchase from financial
institutions participation interests in securities in which the Fund may
invest. A participation interest gives the MONEY FUND an undivided interest
in the security in the proportion that the Fund's participation interest
bears to the total principal amount of the security. These instruments may
have fixed, floating or variable rates of interest, with remaining maturities
of 13 months or less. If the participation interest is unrated, or has been
given a rating below that which is permissible for purchase by the MONEY FUND,
 the participation interest will be backed by an irrevocable letter of credit
or guarantee of a bank, or the payment obligation otherwise will be
collateralized by U.S. Government securities, or, in the case of unrated
participation interests, The Dreyfus Corporation must have determined that
the instrument is of comparable quality to those instruments in which the
MONEY FUND may invest. For certain participation interests, the MONEY FUND
will have the right to demand payment, on not more than seven days' notice,
for all or any part of the Fund's participation interest in the security, plus
accrued interest. As to these instruments, the MONEY FUND intends to exercise
its right to demand payment only upon a default under the terms of the
security, as needed to provide liquidity to meet redemptions, or to maintain
or improve the quality of its investment portfolio.
ILLIQUID SECURITIES -- The MONEY FUND may invest up to 10% of the value of
its net assets in securities as to which a liquid trading market does not
exist, provided such investments are consistent with the Fund's investment
objective. Such securities may include securities that are not readily
marketable, such as certain securities that are subject to legal or
contractual restrictions on resale, and repurchase agreements providing for
settlement in more than seven days after notice. By investing in these
securities, the MONEY FUND is subject to a risk that should the Fund desire
to sell them when a ready buyer is not available at a price the Fund deems
representative of their value, the value of the Fund's net assets could be
adversely affected.
        NO PERSON HAS BEEN AUTHORIZED TO GIVE ANY INFORMATION OR TO MAKE ANY
REPRESENTATIONS OTHER THAN THOSE CONTAINED IN THIS PROSPECTUS AND IN EACH
FUND'S OFFICIAL SALES LITERATURE IN CONNECTION WITH THE OFFER OF SUCH FUND'S
SHARES, AND, IF GIVEN OR MADE, SUCH OTHER INFORMATION OR REPRESENTATIONS MUST
NOT BE RELIED UPON AS HAVING BEEN AUTHORIZED BY A FUND. THIS PROSPECTUS DOES
NOT CONSTITUTE AN OFFER IN ANY STATE IN WHICH, OR TO ANY PERSON TO WHOM, SUCH
OFFERING MAY NOT LAWFULLY BE MADE.
         Page 21
[This Page Intentionally Left Blank]
         Page 22
[This Page Intentionally Left Blank]
         Page 23
DREYFUS
Combined
Prospectus for
BASIC Money Market Fund, Inc.
BASIC U.S. Government
Money Market
Fund
(LION LOGO)

Registration Mark

Copy Rights1996 Dreyfus Service Corporation
                                      123/124p070396






                    DREYFUS BASIC MONEY MARKET FUND, INC.
                DREYFUS BASIC U.S. GOVERNMENT MONEY MARKET FUND
                            COMBINED PART B
                   (STATEMENT OF ADDITIONAL INFORMATION)
   

                            JULY 1, 1996
    


   

     This Statement of Additional Information, which is not a prospectus,
supplements and should be read in conjunction with the current combined
Prospectus of Dreyfus BASIC Money Market Fund, Inc. (the "Money Fund") and
Dreyfus BASIC U.S. Government Money Market Fund (the "Government Money
Fund")(collectively, the "Funds"), dated July 1, 1996, as it may be revised
from time to time.  To obtain a copy of the Funds' Prospectus, please write
to the Funds at 144 Glenn Curtiss Boulevard, Uniondale, New York
11556-0144, or call the following numbers:
    

           Call Toll Free 1-800-645-6561
           In New York City -- Call 1-718-895-1206
           Outside the U.S. and Canada -- Call 516-794-5452

     The Dreyfus Corporation (the "Manager") serves as each Fund's
investment adviser.

     Premier Mutual Fund Services, Inc. (the "Distributor") is the
distributor of each Fund's shares.

     Each Fund is a separate entity with a separate portfolio.  The
operations and investment results of one Fund are unrelated to those of the
other Fund.  This combined Statement of Additional Information has been
prepared for an investor's convenience to provide each investor the
opportunity to consider two investment choices in one document.

                          TABLE OF CONTENTS
                                                                 Page

   

Investment Objective and Management Policies . . . . . . . . . .    B-2
Management of the Funds. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .    B-7
Management Agreements. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .    B-12
Purchase of Shares . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .    B-14
Shareholder Services Plan  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .    B-15
Redemption of Shares . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .    B-16
Shareholder Services . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .    B-18
Determination of Net Asset Value . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .    B-20
Portfolio Transactions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .    B-21
Dividends, Distributions and Taxes . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .    B-21
Yield Information. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .    B-22
Information About the Funds. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .    B-22
Transfer and Dividend Disbursing Agent, Custodian,
  Counsel and Independent Auditors . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .    B-23
Appendix . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .    B-24
Financial Statements
  Money Fund . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .    B-26
  Government Money Fund. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .    B-34
Reports of Independent Auditors. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .    B-42, B-43
    


            INVESTMENT OBJECTIVE AND MANAGEMENT POLICIES
   

     The following information supplements and should be read in
conjunction with the sections in the Funds' Prospectus entitled
"Description of the Funds" and "Appendix."
    

Portfolio Securities
   

     Repurchase Agreements.  Each Fund's custodian or sub-custodian will
have custody of, and will hold in a segregated account, securities acquired
by such Fund under a repurchase agreement.  Repurchase agreements are
considered by the staff of the Securities and Exchange Commission to be
loans by the Fund entering into them.  In an attempt to reduce the risk of
incurring a loss on a repurchase agreement, the Funds will enter into
repurchase agreements only with domestic banks with total assets in excess
of $1 billion dollars, or primary government securities dealers reporting
to the Federal Reserve Bank of New York, with respect to securities of the
type in which the Fund may invest or government securities, and will
require that additional securities be deposited with it if the value of the
securities purchased should decrease below resale price.
    
   

The following applies only to the Money Fund.
    

     Bank Obligations.  Domestic commercial banks organized under Federal
law are supervised and examined by the Comptroller of the Currency and are
required to be members of the Federal Reserve System and to have their
deposits insured by the Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation (the "FDIC").
Domestic banks organized under state law are supervised and examined by
state banking authorities but are members of the Federal Reserve System
only if they elect to join.  In addition, state banks whose certificates of
deposit ("CDs") may be purchased by the Money Fund are insured by the FDIC
(although such insurance may not be of material benefit to the Fund,
depending upon the principal amount of the CDs of each bank held by the
Fund) and are subject to Federal examination and to a substantial body of
Federal law and regulation.  As a result of Federal or state laws and
regulations, domestic banks, among other things, generally are required to
maintain specified levels of reserves, limited in the amounts which they
can loan to a single borrower and subject to other regulations designed to
promote financial soundness.  However, not all of such laws and regulations
apply to the foreign branches of domestic banks.
   

     Obligations of foreign subsidiaries or foreign branches of domestic
banks, and domestic and foreign branches of foreign banks, such as CDs and
time deposits ("TDs"), may be general obligations of the parent banks in
addition to the issuing branch, or may be limited by the terms of specific
obligations and governmental regulation.  Such obligations are subject to
different risks than are those of domestic banks.  These risks include
foreign economic and political developments, foreign governmental
restrictions that may adversely affect payment of principal and interest on
the obligations, foreign exchange controls and foreign withholding and
other taxes on interest income.  These foreign branches and subsidiaries
are not necessarily subject to the same or similar regulatory requirements
that apply to domestic banks, such as mandatory reserve requirements, loan
limitations, and accounting, auditing and financial recordkeeping
requirements.  In addition, less information may be publicly available
about a foreign branch of a domestic bank or about a foreign bank than
about a domestic bank.
    

     Obligations of United States branches of foreign banks may be general
obligations of the parent bank in addition to the issuing branch, or may be
limited by the terms of a specific obligation and by Federal or state
regulation as well as governmental action in the country in which the
foreign bank has its head office.  A domestic branch of a foreign bank with
assets in excess of $1 billion may be subject to reserve requirements
imposed by the Federal Reserve System or by the state in which the branch
is located if the branch is licensed in that state.

     In addition, Federal branches licensed by the Comptroller of the
Currency and branches licensed by certain states ("State Branches") may be
required to:  (1) pledge to the regulator, by depositing assets with a
designated bank within the state, a certain percentage of their assets as
fixed from time to time by the appropriate regulatory authority; and (2)
maintain assets within the state in an amount equal to a specified
percentage of the aggregate amount of liabilities of the foreign bank
payable at or through all of its agencies or branches within the state.
The deposits of Federal and State Branches generally must be insured by the
FDIC if such branches take deposits of less than $100,000.
   

     In view of the foregoing factors associated with the purchase of CDs
and TDs issued by foreign branches of domestic banks, or by foreign
branches or domestic branches of foreign banks, the Manager carefully
evaluates such investments on a case-by-case basis.
    
   
    
   

     Foreign Government Obligations; Securities of Supranational Entities.
The Money Fund may invest in obligations issued or guaranteed by one or
more foreign governments or any of their political subdivisions, agencies
or instrumentalities that are determined by the Manager to be of comparable
quality to the other obligations in which the Money Fund may invest.  Such
securities also include debt obligations of supranational entities.
Supranational entities include international organizations designated or
supported by governmental entities to promote economic reconstruction or
development and international banking institutions and related government
agencies.  Examples include the International Bank for Reconstruction and
Development (the World Bank), the European Coal and Steel Community, the
Asian Development Bank and the InterAmerican Development Bank.
    
   

     Illiquid Securities.  Where a substantial market of qualified
institutional buyers develops for certain restricted securities purchased
by the Money Fund pursuant to Rule 144A under the Securities Act of 1933,
as amended, the Fund intends to treat such securities as liquid securities
in accordance with procedures approved by the Money Fund's Board.  Because
it is not possible to predict with assurance how the market for restricted
securities pursuant to Rule 144A will develop, the Money Fund's Board has
directed the Manager to monitor carefully the Money Fund's investments in
such securities with particular regard to trading activity, availability of
reliable price information and other relevant information.  To the extent
that, for a period of time, qualified institutional buyers cease purchasing
such restricted securities pursuant to Rule 144A, the Money Fund's
investment in such securities may have the effect of increasing the level
of illiquidity in its portfolio during such period.
    
   

Management Policies
    
   

     The following applies only to the Money Fund.
    

     Reverse Repurchase Agreements.  The Money Fund may enter into reverse
repurchase agreements.  The Money Fund will maintain in a segregated
custodial account cash, cash equivalents or U.S. Government securities or
other high quality liquid debt securities equal to the aggregate amount of
its reverse repurchase obligations, plus accrued interest, in certain
cases, in accordance with releases promulgated by the Securities and
Exchange Commission.  The Securities and Exchange Commission views reverse
repurchase agreement transactions as collateralized borrowings by the Fund,
and, pursuant to the Investment Company Act of 1940, as amended (the "1940
Act"), the Money Fund must maintain continuous asset coverage (that is,
total assets including borrowings, less liabilities exclusive of
borrowings) of 300% of the amount borrowed.  If the 300% asset coverage
should decline as a result of market fluctuations or other reasons, the
Money Fund may be required to sell some of its portfolio holdings within
three days to reduce the debt and restore 300% asset coverage, even though
it may be disadvantageous from an investment standpoint to sell securities
at that time.
   

     Forward Commitments.  Securities purchased on a forward commitment or
when-issued basis are subject to changes in value (generally changing in
the same way, i.e., appreciating when interest rates decline and
depreciating when interest rates rise) based upon the public's perception
of the creditworthiness of the issuer and changes, real or anticipated, in
the level of interest rates.  Securities purchased on a forward commitment
or when-issued basis may expose the Money Fund to risks because they may
experience such fluctuations prior to their actual delivery.  Purchasing
securities on a when-issued basis can involve the additional risk that the
yield available in the market when the delivery takes place actually may be
higher than that obtained in the transaction itself.  Purchasing securities
on a forward commitment or when-issued basis when the Money Fund is fully
or almost fully invested may result in greater potential fluctuation in the
value of the Money Fund's net assets and its net asset value per share.
    
   

     Lending Portfolio Securities.  In connection with its securities
lending transactions, the Money Fund may return to the borrower and/or a
third party which is unaffiliated with the Fund, and which is acting as a
"placing broker," a part of the interest earned from the investment of
collateral received for securities loaned.
    

     The Securities and Exchange Commission currently requires that the
following conditions must be met whenever portfolio securities are loaned
by the Money Fund:  (1) the Fund must receive at least 100% cash collateral
from the borrower; (2) the borrower must increase such collateral whenever
the market value of the securities rises above the level of such
collateral; (3) the Fund must be able to terminate the loan at any time;
(4) the Fund must receive reasonable interest on the loan, as well as any
interest or other distributions payable on the loaned securities, and any
increase in market value; and (5) the Fund may pay only reasonable
custodian fees in connection with the loan.  These conditions may be
subject to future modification.

Investment Restrictions
   

     Money Fund.  The Money Fund has adopted investment restrictions
numbered 1 through 7 as fundamental policies, which cannot be changed
without approval by the holders of a majority (as defined in the 1940 Act)
of the Money Fund's outstanding voting shares.  Investment restrictions
numbered 8 through 14 are not fundamental policies and may be changed by
vote of a majority of the Money Fund's Board members at any time.  The
Money Fund may not:
    

     1.  Borrow money, except to the extent the Fund maintains continuous
asset coverage (that is, total borrowings, less liabilities exclusive of
borrowings) of 300% of the amount borrowed.

     2.  Purchase or sell real estate, real estate investment trust
securities, commodities or commodity contracts, or oil and gas interests,
except that the Fund may purchase or sell futures contracts, including
those relating to indices, and options on futures contracts and indices.

     3.  Act as underwriter of securities of other issuers, except to the
extent the Fund may be deemed an underwriter under the Securities Act of
1933, as amended, by virtue of disposing of portfolio securities.

     4.  Make loans to others, except through the purchase of debt
obligations or the entry into repurchase agreements.  However, the Fund may
lend its portfolio securities in an amount not to exceed 33-1/3% of the
value of its total assets.  Any loans of portfolio securities will be made
according to guidelines established by the Securities and Exchange
Commission and the Fund's Board.

     5.  Invest more than 5% of its assets in the obligations of any single
issuer, except that up to 25% of the value of the Fund's total assets may
be invested without regard to any such limitation.

     6.  Invest less than 25% of its total assets in securities issued by
banks or invest more than 25% of its assets in the securities of issuers in
any other industry, provided that there shall be no limitation on the
purchase of obligations issued or guaranteed by the U.S. Government, its
agencies or instrumentalities.  Notwithstanding the foregoing, for
temporary defensive purposes the Fund may invest less than 25% of its
assets in bank obligations.

     7.  Issue any senior security (as such term is defined in Section
18(f) of the 1940 Act), except to the extent that the activities permitted
in Investment Restriction Nos. 1, 2 and 10 may be deemed to give rise to a
senior security.

     8.  Purchase common stocks, preferred stocks, warrants or other equity
securities, or purchase corporate bonds or debentures, state bonds,
municipal bonds or industrial revenue bonds (except through the purchase of
debt obligations referred to above and in the Prospectus).

     9.  Invest in securities of other investment companies, except as they
may be acquired as part of a merger, consolidation or acquisition of
assets.

     10. Pledge, hypothecate, mortgage or otherwise encumber its assets,
except to the extent necessary to secure permitted borrowings and to the
extent related to the deposit of assets in escrow in connection with
portfolio transactions, such as in connection with writing covered options
and the purchase of securities on a when-issued or forward commitment basis
and collateral and initial or variation margin arrangements with respect to
options, futures contracts, including those relating to indices, and
options on futures contracts or indices.

     11. Sell securities short or purchase securities on margin.

     12. Write or purchase put or call options or combinations thereof.

     13. Enter into repurchase agreements providing for settlement in more
than seven days after notice or purchase securities which are illiquid, if,
in the aggregate, more than 10% of the value of its net assets would be so
invested.

     14. Invest in companies for the purpose of exercising control.

                                * * *
   

     Government Money Fund.  The Government Money Fund has adopted
investment restrictions numbered 1 through 6 as fundamental policies, which
cannot be changed without approval by the holders of a majority (as defined
in the 1940 Act) of the Government Money Fund's outstanding voting shares.
Investment restrictions numbered 7 through 12 are not fundamental policies
and may be changed by vote of a majority of the Government Money Fund's
Board members at any time.  The Government Money Fund may not:
    

     1.  Borrow money, except for temporary or emergency (not leveraging)
purposes in an amount up to 15% of the value of the Fund's total assets
(including the amount borrowed) based on the lesser of cost or market, less
liabilities (not including the amount borrowed) at the time the borrowing
is made.  While borrowings exceed 5% of the value of the Fund's total
assets, the Fund will not make any additional investments.

     2.  Purchase or sell real estate, real estate investment trust
securities, commodities or commodity contracts, or oil and gas interests,
except that the Fund may purchase or sell futures contracts, including
those relating to indices, and options on futures contracts or indices.

     3.  Act as underwriter of securities of other issuers.

     4.  Make loans to others, except through the purchase of debt
obligations or the entry into repurchase agreements.

     5.  Invest more than 25% of its assets in the securities of issuers in
any single industry, provided that there shall be no limitation on the
purchase of obligations issued or guaranteed by the U.S. Government, its
agencies or instrumentalities.

     6.  Issue any senior security (as such term is defined in Section
18(f) of the 1940 Act), except to the extent the activities permitted in
Investment Restriction Nos. 1, 2 and 9 may be deemed to give rise to a
senior security.

     7.  Purchase common stocks, preferred stocks, warrants or other equity
securities, or purchase corporate bonds or debentures, state bonds,
municipal bonds or industrial revenue bonds.

     8.  Invest in securities of other investment companies, except as they
may be acquired as part of a merger, consolidation or acquisition of
assets.

     9.  Pledge, hypothecate, mortgage or otherwise encumber its assets,
except to the extent necessary to secure permitted borrowings.

     10. Sell securities short or purchase securities on margin.

     11. Write or purchase put or call options or combinations thereof.

     12. Enter into repurchase agreements providing for settlement in more
than seven days after notice or purchase securities which are illiquid, if,
in the aggregate, more than 10% of its net assets would be so invested.

                                    * * *

     With respect to each Fund, if a percentage restriction is adhered to
at the time of investment, a later increase or decrease in percentage
resulting from a change in values or assets will not constitute a violation
of such restriction.

     Each Fund may make commitments more restrictive than the respective
restrictions listed above so as to permit the sale of such Fund's shares in
certain states.  Should a Fund determine that a commitment is no longer in
the best interests of the Fund and its shareholders, such Fund reserves the
right to revoke the commitment by terminating the sale of its shares in the
state involved.


                          MANAGEMENT OF THE FUNDS
   

     Board members and officers of each Fund, together with information as
to their principal business occupations during at least the last five
years, are shown below.  Each Board member who is deemed to be an
"interested person" of the Funds, as defined in the 1940 Act, is indicated
by an asterisk.
    
   

Board Members of each Fund
    
   

*DAVID W. BURKE, Board Member.  Chairman of the Broadcasting Board of
     Governors, an independent board within the United States Information
     Agency, since August 1995.  From August 1994 to August 1995, Mr. Burke
     was a Consultant to the Manager and, from October 1990 to August 1994,
     he was Vice President and Chief Administrative Officer of the Manager.
     From 1977 to 1990, Mr. Burke was involved in the management of
     national television news, as Vice President and Executive Vice
     President of ABC News, and subsequently as President of CBS News.  He
     is 60  years old and his address is Box 654, Eastham, Massachusetts
     02642.
    
   

*JOSEPH S. DiMARTINO, Chairman of the Board.  Since January 1995, Chairman
     of the Board of various funds in the Dreyfus Family of Funds.  For
     more than five years prior thereto, he was President, a director and,
     until August 1994, Chief Operating Officer of the Manager and
     Executive Vice President and a director of Dreyfus Service
     Corporation, a wholly-owned subsidiary of the Manager and, until
     August 24, 1994, the Fund's distributor.  From August 1994 to December
     31, 1994, he was a director of Mellon Bank Corporation.  He is
     Chairman of the Board of the Noel Group, Inc., a trustee of Bucknell
     University; and a director of the Muscular Dystrophy Association,
     HealthPlan Services Corporation, Belding Heminway Company, Inc.,
     Curtis Industries, Inc. and Staffing Resources, Inc.  He is 52 years
     old and his address is 200 Park Avenue, New York, New York 10166.
    
   

DIANE DUNST, Board Member.  Since January 1992, President of Diane Dunst
     Promotion, Inc., a full service promotion agency.  From January 1989
     to January 1992, Director of Promotion Services, Lear's Magazine.
     From 1985 to January 1989, she was Sales Promotion Manager of ELLE
     Magazine.  She is 56 years old and her address is 1172 Park Avenue,
     New York, New York 10128.
    
   

ROSALIND GERSTEN JACOBS, Board Member.  Director of Merchandise and
     Marketing for Corporate Property Investors, a real estate investment
     company.  From 1974 to 1976, she was owner and manager of a
     merchandise and marketing consulting firm.  Prior to 1974, she was a
     Vice President of Macy's, New York.  She is 71 years old and her
     address is c/o Corporate Property Investors, 305 East 47th Street, New
     York, New York 10017.
    
   

JAY I. MELTZER, Board Member.  Physician engaged in private practice
     specializing in internal medicine.  He is also a member of the
     Advisory Board of the Section of Society and Medicine, College of
     Physicians and Surgeons, Columbia University and a Clinical Professor
     of Medicine, Department of Medicine, Columbia University College of
     Physicians and Surgeons.  He is 67 years old and his address is 903
     Park Avenue, New York, New York 10021.
    
   

DANIEL ROSE, Board Member.  President and Chief Executive Officer of Rose
     Associates, Inc., a New York based real estate development and
     management firm.  He is also Chairman of the Housing Committee of The
     Real Estate Board of New York, Inc., and a Trustee of Corporate
     Property Investors, a real estate investment company.  He is 66 years
     old and his address is c/o Rose Associates, Inc., 200 Madison Avenue,
     New York, New York 10016.
    
   

WARREN B. RUDMAN, Board Member.  Since January 1993, Partner in the law
     firm Paul, Weiss, Rifkind, Wharton & Garrison.  Mr. Rudman has served
     as a director of Collins & Aikman, a manufacturing company, since June
     1995, Chubb Corporation, since January 1993, and Raytheon Company,
     since September 1993.  From January 1981 to January 1993, Mr. Rudman
     served as a United States Senator from the State of New Hampshire.
     Since 1988, Mr. Rudman has served as a trustee of Boston College, and
     since 1986, as a member of the Senior Advisory Board of the Institute
     of Politics of the Kennedy School of Government at Harvard University.
     He also serves as Deputy Chairman of the President's Foreign
     ntelligence Advisory Board.  He is 66 years old and his address is c/o
     Paul, Weiss, Rifkind, Wharton & Garrison, 1615 L Street, N.W., Suite
     1300, Washington D.C. 20036.
    
   

SANDER VANOCUR, Board Member.  Since January 1992, President of Old Owl
     Communications, a full-service communications firm.  Since November
     1989, Mr. Vanocur has served as a Director of the Damon Runyon-Walter
     Winchell Cancer Research Fund.  Also, since January 1994, Mr. Vanocur
     has served as a Visiting Professional Scholar at the Freedom Forum
     First Amendment Center at Vanderbilt University.  From June 1986 to
     December 1991, he was a Senior Correspondent of ABC News and, from
     October 1977 to December 31, 1991, he was Anchor of the ABC News
     program "Business World," a weekly business program on the ABC
     television network.  He is 68 years old and his address is 2928 P
     Street, N.W., Washington, D.C. 20007.
    
   

     For so long as each Fund's plan described in the section captioned
"Shareholder Services Plan" remains in effect, the Board members of each
Fund who are not "interested persons" of such Fund, as defined in the 1940
Act, will be selected and nominated by the Board members who are not
"interested persons" of such Fund.
    
   

     Ordinarily, meetings of shareholders for the purpose of electing Board
members will not be held unless and until such time as less than a majority
of the Board members holding office have been elected by shareholders, at
which time the Board members then in office will call a shareholders'
meeting for the election of Board members. Under the 1940 Act, shareholders
of record of not less than two-thirds of the outstanding shares of the Fund
may remove a Board member through a declaration in writing or by vote cast
in person or by proxy at a meeting called for that purpose.  Board members
of each Fund are required to call a meeting of shareholders for the purpose
of voting upon the question of removal of any such Board member when
requested in writing to do so by the shareholders of record of not less
than 10% of such Fund's outstanding shares.
    
   

     Each Fund typically pays its Board members an annual retainer and a
per meeting fee and reimburses them for their expenses.  The Chairman of
the Board receives an additional 25% of such compensation.  Emeritus Board
members are entitled to receive an annual retainer and a per meeting fee of
one-half the amount paid to them as Board members.  The aggregate amount of
fees and expenses paid to Board members by each Fund for the fiscal year
ended February 29, 1996, and by all other funds in the Dreyfus Family of
Funds for which such person is a Board member (the number of which is set
forth in parenthesis next to each Board member's total compensation) for
the year ended December 31, 1995, were as follows:
    
   

                                                            Total
                                                        Compensation from
                                   Aggregate                Fund and Fund
     Name of Board              Compensation from         Complex Paid
      Member                         Fund*              to Board Member

David W. Burke                                             $253,654 (52)

     Money Fund                       $2,750
     Government Money Fund            $2,750

Joseph S. DiMartino                                        $448,618 (94)

     Money Fund                       $3,438
     Government Money Fund            $3,438

Diane Dunst                                                $39,000 (10)

     Money Fund                       $2,750
     Government Money Fund            $2,750

Rosalind Gersten Jacobs                                    $92,500 (20)

     Money Fund                       $2,750
     Government Money Fund            $2,750

Jay I. Meltzer                                             $37,500 (10)

     Money Fund                       $2,750
     Government Money Fund            $2,750

Daniel Rose                                                $80,250 (22)

     Money Fund                       $2,750
     Government Money Fund            $2,750

Warren B. Rudman                                           $85,500 (18)

     Money Fund                       $2,750
     Government Money Fund            $2,750

Sander Vanocur                                             $79,750 (22)

     Money Fund                       $2,750
     Government Money Fund            $2,750
_______________________________
*  Amount does not include reimbursed expenses for attending Board meetings,
   which amounted to $8,334 and $2,334 for all Board members of the Money Fund
   and Government Money Fund, respectively, as a group.
    
   
    
   
    

Officers of each Fund
   

MARIE E. CONNOLLY, President and Treasurer.  President, Chief Executive
     Officer and a director of the Distributor and an officer of other
     investment companies advised or administered by the Manager.  From
     December 1991 to July 1994, she was President and Chief Compliance
     Officer of Funds Distributor, Inc., the ultimate parent of which is
     Boston Institutional Group, Inc.  Prior to December 1991, she served
     as Vice President and Controller, and later as Senior Vice President,
     of The Boston Company Advisors, Inc.  She is 38 years old.
    

JOHN E. PELLETIER, Vice President and Secretary.  Senior Vice President and
     General Counsel of the Distributor and an officer of other investment
     companies advised or administered by the Manager.  From February 1992
     to July 1994, he served as Counsel for The Boston Company Advisors,
     Inc.  From August 1990 to February 1992, he was employed as an
     Associate at Ropes & Gray.  He is 32 years old.

FREDERICK C. DEY, Vice President and Assistant Treasurer.  Senior Vice
     President of the Distributor and an officer of other investment
     companies advised or administered by the Manager.  From 1988 to August
     1994, he was manager of the High Performance Fabric Division of
     Springs Industries Inc.  He is 34 years old.

ERIC B. FISCHMAN, Vice President and Assistant Secretary.  Associate
     General Counsel of the Distributor and an officer of other investment
     companies advised or administered by the Manager.  From September 1992
     to August 1994, he was an attorney with the Board of Governors of the
     Federal Reserve System.  He is 31 years old.
   

ELIZABETH BACHMAN, Vice President and Assistant Secretary.  Assistant Vice
     President of the Distributor and an officer of other investment
     companies advised or administered by the Manager.  She is 26 years
     old.
    

JOSEPH F. TOWER, III, Assistant Treasurer.  Senior Vice President,
     Treasurer and Chief Financial Officer of the Distributor and an
     officer of other investment companies advised or administered by the
     Manager.  From July 1988 to August 1994, he was employed by The Boston
     Company, Inc. where he held various management positions in the
     Corporate Finance and Treasury areas.  He is 34 years old.

JOHN J. PYBURN, Assistant Treasurer.  Assistant Treasurer of the
     Distributor, and an officer of other investment companies advised or
     administered by the Manager.  From 1984 to July 1994, he was Assistant
     Vice President in the Mutual Fund Accounting Department of the
     Manager.  He is 61 years old.
   

MARGARET PARDO, Assistant Secretary.  Legal Assistant with the Distributor
     and officer of other investment companies advised or administered by
     the Manager.  From June 1992 to April 1995, she was a Medical
     Coordination Officer at ORBIS International.  Prior to June 1992, she
     worked as Program Coordinator at Physicians World Communications
     Group.  She is 27 years old.
    

     The address of each officer of the Fund is 200 Park Avenue, New York,
New York 10166.
   

     Board members and officers, as a group, owned less than 1% of each
Fund's shares outstanding on June 21, 1996.
    


                        MANAGEMENT AGREEMENTS

     The following information supplements and should be read in
conjunction with the section in the Funds' Prospectus entitled "Management
of the Funds."
   

     The Manager provides management services pursuant to separate
Management Agreements (respectively, the "Agreement") with each Fund, each
of which is dated August 24, 1994.  As to each Fund, the Agreement is
subject to annual approval by (i) such Fund's Board or (ii) vote of a
majority (as defined in the 1940 Act) of such Fund's outstanding voting
securities, provided that in either event the continuance also is approved
by a majority of the Board members who are not "interested persons" (as
defined in the 1940 Act) of the Fund or the Manager, by vote cast in person
at a meeting called for the purpose of voting on such approval.  Each
Fund's Agreement was approved by such Fund's shareholders on August 3,
1994, and was last approved by the Fund's Board, including a majority of
such Fund's Board members who are not "interested persons" (as defined in
the 1940 Act) of the Fund or the Manager, at a meeting held on February 7,
1996.  As to each Fund, the Agreement is terminable without penalty, on 60
days' notice, by such Fund's Board or by vote of the holders of a majority
of such Fund's shares, or, on not less than 90 days' notice, by the
Manager.  Each Agreement will terminate automatically, as to the relevant
Fund, in the event of its assignment (as defined in the 1940 Act).
    
   

     The following persons are officers and/or directors of the Manager:
Howard Stein, Chairman of the Board and Chief Executive Officer; W. Keith
Smith, Vice Chairman and a director; Christopher M. Condron, President,
Chief Operating Officer and a director; Stephen E. Canter, Vice Chairman--
Chief Investment Officer and a director; Lawrence S. Kash, Vice Chairman--
Distribution and a director; Philip L. Toia, Vice Chairman--Operations and
Administration and a director; William T. Sandalls, Jr., Senior Vice
President and Chief Financial Officer; Elie M. Genadry, Vice President--
Institutional Sales; William F. Glavin, Jr. Vice President--Corporate
Development; Mark N. Jacobs, Vice President, General Counsel and Secretary;
Patrice M. Kozlowski, Vice President--Corporate Communications; Mary Beth
Leibig, Vice President--Human Resources; Jeffrey N. Nachman, Vice
President--Mutual Fund Accounting; Andrew S. Wasser, Vice President--
Information Systems; Elvira Oslapas, Assistant Secretary; and Mandell L.
Berman, Frank V. Cahouet, Alvin E. Friedman, Lawrence M. Greene and Julian
M. Smerling, directors.
    

     The Manager manages each Fund's portfolio of investments in accordance
with the stated policies of such Fund, subject to the approval of the
Fund's Board.  The Manager is responsible for investment decisions, and
provides each Fund with portfolio managers who are authorized by its Board
to execute purchases and sales of securities.  The portfolio managers of
each Fund are Patricia A. Larkin, Jr., Bernard Kiernan and Garitt Kono.
The Manager also maintains a research department with a professional staff
of portfolio managers and securities analysts who provide research services
for each Fund as well as for other funds advised by the Manager.  All
purchases and sales are reported for the respective Board's review at the
meeting subsequent to such transactions.

     The Manager maintains office facilities on behalf of each Fund and
furnishes statistical and research data, clerical help, accounting, data
processing, bookkeeping and internal auditing and certain other required
services to each Fund.  The Manager also may make such advertising and
promotional expenditures, using its own resources, as it from time to time
deems appropriate.
   

     All expenses incurred in the operation of a Fund are borne by such
Fund, except to the extent specifically assumed by the Manager.  The
expenses borne by each Fund include:  organizational costs, taxes,
interest, brokerage fees and commissions, if any, fees of Board members who
are not officers, directors, employees or holders of 5% or more of the
outstanding voting securities of the Manager, Securities and Exchange
Commission fees, state Blue Sky qualification fees, advisory fees, charges
of custodians, transfer and dividend disbursing agents' fees, certain
insurance premiums, industry association fees, outside auditing and legal
expenses, costs of maintaining the Fund's existence, costs of independent
pricing services, costs attributable to investor services (including,
without limitation, telephone and personnel expenses), costs of
shareholders' reports and corporate meetings, costs of preparing and
printing prospectuses and statements of additional information for
regulatory purposes and for distribution to existing shareholders, and any
extraordinary expenses.
    
   

     As compensation for the Manager's services, each Fund has agreed to
pay the Manager a monthly management fee at the annual rate of .50 of 1% of
the value of such Fund's average daily net assets.  All fees and expenses
are accrued daily and deducted before the declaration of dividends to
shareholders.  For the fiscal year ended February 28, 1994, no management
fee was paid by either Fund pursuant to separate undertakings by the
Manager.  For the fiscal year ended February 28, 1995, the management fees
payable by the Money Fund and the Government Money Fund amounted to
$8,169,685 and $2,035,026, respectively, which fees were reduced by
$7,482,518 and $1,789,390, respectively, pursuant to separate undertakings
by the Manager, resulting in net fees of $687,167 paid by the Money Fund
and $245,636 paid by the Government Money Fund.  For the fiscal year ended
February 29, 1996, the management fees payable by the Money Fund and the
Government Money Fund amounted to $9,747,085 and $6,266,897, respectively,
which fees were reduced by $5,960,272 and $4,484,591, respectively,
pursuant to separate undertakings by the Manager, resulting in net fees of
$3,786,813 paid by the Money Fund and $1,782,306 paid by the Government
Money Fund for fiscal 1996.
    

     The Manager has agreed that if in any fiscal year a Fund's aggregate
expenses, exclusive of taxes, brokerage, interest on borrowings and (with
the prior written consent of the necessary state securities commissions)
extraordinary expenses, but including the management fee, exceed the
expense limitation of any state having jurisdiction over the Fund, such
Fund may deduct from the payment to be made to the Manager under its
Agreement, or the Manager will bear, such excess expense to the extent
required by state law.  Such deduction or payment, if any, will be
estimated daily, and reconciled and effected or paid, as the case may be,
on a monthly basis.

     The aggregate of the fees payable to the Manager is not subject to
reduction as the value of the Funds' respective net assets increases.


                         PURCHASE OF SHARES

     The following information supplements and should be read in
conjunction with the section in the Funds' Prospectus entitled "How to Buy
Shares."
   

     The Distributor.  The Distributor serves as each Fund's distributor on
a best efforts basis pursuant to an agreement which is renewable annually.
The Distributor also acts as distributor for the other funds in the Dreyfus
Family of Funds and for certain other investment companies.  In some
states, certain financial institutions effecting transactions in Fund
shares may be required to register as dealers pursuant to state law.
    

     Using Federal Funds.  Dreyfus Transfer, Inc., each Fund's transfer and
dividend disbursing agent (the "Transfer Agent"), or the investor's Fund
may attempt to notify the investor upon receipt of checks drawn on banks
that are not members of the Federal Reserve System as to the possible delay
in conversion into Federal Funds and may attempt to arrange for a better
means of transmitting the money.  If the investor is a customer of a
securities dealer, bank or other financial institution and his order to
purchase a Fund's shares is paid for other than in Federal Funds, the
securities dealer, bank or other financial institution acting on behalf of
its customer, will complete the conversion into, or itself advance, Federal
Funds generally on the business day following receipt of the customer
order.  The order is effective only when so converted and received by the
Transfer Agent.  An order for the purchase of a Fund's shares placed by an
investor with sufficient Federal Funds or cash balance in his brokerage
account with a securities dealer, bank or other financial institution will
become effective on the day that the order, including Federal Funds, is
received by the Transfer Agent.

     Transactions Through Securities Dealers.  Each Fund's shares may be
purchased and redeemed through securities dealers which may charge a
nominal transaction fee for such services.  Some dealers will place the
respective Fund's shares in an account with their firm.  Dealers also may
require that the customer not take physical delivery of stock certificates;
the customer not request redemption checks to be issued in the customer's
name; fractional shares not be purchased; monthly income distributions be
taken in cash; or other conditions.
   

     No sales charge is imposed by either the Fund or the Distributor,
although investment dealers, banks and other institutions may make
reasonable charges to investors for their services.  The services provided
and the applicable fees are established by each dealer or other institution
acting independently of the respective Fund.  Each Fund has been given to
understand that these fees may be charged for customer services including,
but not limited to, same-day investment of client funds; same-day access to
client funds; advice to customers about the status of their accounts, yield
currently being paid or income earned to date; provision of periodic
account statements showing security and money market positions; other
services available from the dealer, bank or other institution; and
assistance with inquiries related to their investment.  Any such fees will
be deducted monthly from the investor's account, which on smaller accounts
could constitute a substantial portion of distributions.  Small, inactive,
long-term accounts involving monthly service charges may not be in the best
interest of investors.  Investors should be aware that they may purchase
shares of either Fund directly from such Fund without imposition of any
maintenance or service charges, other than those already described herein.
    
   

     Dreyfus TeleTransfer Privilege.  Dreyfus TeleTransfer purchase orders
may be made at any time.  Purchase orders received by 4:00 P.M., New York
time, on any business day that the Transfer Agent and the New York Stock
Exchange are open for business will be credited to the shareholder's Fund
account on the next bank business day following such purchase order.
Purchase orders made after 4:00 P.M., New York time, on any business day
the Transfer Agent and the New York Stock Exchange are open for business,
or orders made on Saturday, Sunday or any Fund holiday (e.g., when the New
York Stock Exchange is not open for business), will be credited to the
shareholder's Fund account on the second bank business day following such
purchase order.  To qualify to use the Dreyfus TeleTransfer Privilege, the
initial payment for purchase of Fund shares must be drawn on, and
redemption proceeds paid to, the same bank and account as are designated on
the Account Application or Shareholder Services Form on file.  If the
proceeds of a particular redemption are to be wired to an account at any
other bank, the request must be in writing and signature-guaranteed.  See
"Redemption of Shares--Dreyfus TeleTransfer Privilege."
    

     Reopening an Account.  An investor may reopen an account with a
minimum investment of $10,000 without filing a new Account Application
during the calendar year the account is closed or during the following
calendar year, provided the information on the old Account Application is
still applicable.


                      SHAREHOLDER SERVICES PLAN

     The following information supplements and should be read in
conjunction with the section in the Funds' Prospectus entitled "Shareholder
Services Plan."

     Each Fund has adopted a Shareholder Services Plan (the "Plan")
pursuant to which the Fund reimburses Dreyfus Service Corporation for
certain allocated expenses of providing personal services and/or
maintaining shareholder accounts.  The services provided may include
personal services relating to shareholder accounts, such as answering
shareholder inquiries regarding the Fund and providing reports and other
information, and services related to the maintenance of shareholder
accounts.
   

     A quarterly report of the amounts expended under the Plan, and the
purposes for which such expenditures were incurred, must be made to the
Fund's Board for its review.  In addition, the Plan provides that material
amendments of the Plan must be approved by the Fund's Board members who are
not "interested persons" (as defined in the 1940 Act) of the Fund and have
no direct or indirect financial interest in the operation of the Plan by
vote cast in person at a meeting called for the purpose of considering such
amendments.  The Plan is subject to annual approval by such vote of the
Board members cast in person at a meeting called for the purpose of voting
on the Plan.  The Plan was last so approved by each Fund's Board on May 8,
1996.  The Plan is terminable at any time by vote of a majority of the
Board members who are not "interested persons" and have no direct or
indirect financial interest in the operation of the Plan.
    
   

     For the fiscal year ended February 29, 1996, $1,276,493 was charged to
the Money Fund and $1,133,516 was charged to the Government Money Fund
under each Fund's Plan.
    


                       REDEMPTION OF SHARES

     The following information supplements and should be read in
conjunction with the section in the Funds' Prospectus entitled "How to
Redeem Shares."
   

     Check Redemption Privilege.  An investor may indicate on the Account
Application, Shareholder Services Form or by later written request that the
investor's Fund provide Redemption Checks ("Checks"), drawn on the
investor's Fund account.  Checks will be sent only to the registered
owner(s) of the account and only to the address of record.  The Account
Application, Shareholder Services Form or later written request must be
manually signed by the registered owner(s).  Checks may be made payable to
the order of any person in an amount of $1,000 or more.  When a Check is
presented to the Transfer Agent for payment, the Transfer Agent, as the
investor's agent, will cause the Fund to redeem a sufficient number of
shares in the investor's account to cover the amount of the Check and the
$2.00 charge.  Dividends are earned until the Check clears.  After
clearance, a copy of the Check will be returned to the investor.  Investors
generally will be subject to the same rules and regulations that apply to
checking accounts, although election of this Privilege creates only a
shareholder-transfer agent relationship with the Transfer Agent.
    

     If the amount of the Check, plus any applicable charges, is greater
than the value of the shares in an investor's account, the Check will be
returned marked insufficient funds.  Checks should not be used to close an
account.
   

     Wire Redemption Privilege.  By using this Privilege, the investor
authorizes the Transfer Agent to act on wire or telephone redemption
instructions from any person representing himself or herself to be the
investor, and reasonably believed by the Transfer Agent to be genuine.  An
investor will be charged a $5.00 fee for each wire redemption from either
Fund, which will be deducted from the investor's account and paid to the
Transfer Agent.  Ordinarily, each Fund will initiate payment for shares
redeemed pursuant to this Privilege on the next business day after receipt
by the Transfer Agent of a redemption request in proper form.  Redemption
proceeds ($5,000 minimum) will be transferred by Federal Reserve wire only
to the commercial bank account specified by the investor on the Account
Application or Shareholder Services Form, or to a correspondent bank if the
investor's bank is not a member of the Federal Reserve System.  Fees
ordinarily are imposed by such bank and usually are borne by the investor.
Immediate notification by the correspondent bank to the investor's bank is
necessary to avoid a delay in crediting the funds to the investor's bank
account.
    

     Investors with access to telegraphic equipment may wire redemption
requests to the Transfer Agent by employing the following transmittal code
which may be used for domestic or overseas transmissions:

                                                Transfer Agent's
     Transmittal Code                           Answer Back Sign

         144295                                 144295 TSSG PREP

     Investors who do not have direct access to telegraphic equipment may
have the wire transmitted by contacting a TRT Cables operator at 1-800-654-
7171, toll free.  Investors should advise the operator that the above
transmittal code must be used and should also inform the operator of the
Transfer Agent's answer back sign.

     To change the commercial bank or account designated to receive wire
redemption proceeds, a written request must be sent to the Transfer Agent.
This request must be signed by each shareholder, with each signature
guaranteed as described below under "Share Certificates; Signatures."
   

     Dreyfus TeleTransfer Privilege.  Investors should be aware that if
they have also selected the Dreyfus TeleTransfer Privilege, any request for
a wire redemption will be effected as a Dreyfus TeleTransfer transaction
through the Automated Clearing House ("ACH") system unless more prompt
transmittal specifically is requested.  Redemption proceeds will be on
deposit in the investor's account at an ACH member bank ordinarily two
business days after receipt of the redemption request.  Investors will be
charged a $5.00 fee for each redemption made pursuant to this Privilege,
which will be deducted from the investor's account and paid to the Transfer
Agent.  See "Purchase of Shares--Dreyfus TeleTransfer Privilege."
    

     Share Certificates; Signatures.  Any certificates representing Fund
shares to be redeemed must be submitted with the redemption request.
Written redemption requests must be signed by each investor, including each
owner of a joint account, and each signature must be guaranteed.
Signatures on endorsed certificates submitted for redemption also must be
guaranteed.  The Transfer Agent has adopted standards and procedures
pursuant to which signature-guarantees in proper form generally will be
accepted from domestic banks, brokers, dealers, credit unions, national
securities exchanges, registered securities associations, clearing agencies
and savings associations, as well as from participants in the New York
Stock Exchange Medallion Signature Program, the Securities Transfer Agents
Medallion Program ("STAMP") and the Stock Exchanges Medallion Program.
Guarantees must be signed by an authorized signatory of the guarantor and
"Signature-Guaranteed" must appear with the signature.  The Transfer Agent
may request additional documentation from corporations, executors,
administrators, trustees or guardians.  For more information with respect
to signature-guarantees, please call one of the telephone numbers listed on
the cover.
   

     Redemption Commitment.  Each Fund has committed itself to pay in cash
all redemption requests by any shareholder of record, limited in amount
during any 90-day period to the lesser of $250,000 or 1% of the value of
such Fund's net assets at the beginning of such period.  Such commitment is
irrevocable without the prior approval of the Securities and Exchange
Commission.  In the case of requests for redemption in excess of such
amount, each Fund's Board reserves the right to make payments in whole or
in part in securities (which may include non-marketable securities) or
other assets in case of an emergency or any time a cash distribution would
impair the liquidity of such Fund to the detriment of its existing
shareholders.  In such event, the securities would be valued in the same
manner as such Fund's portfolio is valued.  If the recipient sold such
securities, brokerage charges would be incurred.
    

     Suspension of Redemptions.  The right of redemption with respect to a
Fund may be suspended or the date of payment postponed (a) during any
period when the New York Stock Exchange is closed (other than customary
weekend and holiday closings), (b) when trading in the market such Fund
ordinarily utilizes is restricted, or when an emergency exists as
determined by the Securities and Exchange Commission so that disposal of
such Fund's investments or determination of its net asset value is not
reasonably practicable, or (c) for such other periods as the Securities and
Exchange Commission by order may permit to protect such Fund's
shareholders.

   

                        SHAREHOLDER SERVICES
    
   

     The following information supplements and should be read in
conjunction with the section in the Funds' Prospectus entitled "Shareholder
Services."
    
   

     Fund Exchanges.  Shares of other funds purchased by exchange will be
purchased on the basis of relative net asset value per share as follows:
    

     A.  Exchanges for shares of funds that are offered without a sales
         load will be made without a sales load.

     B.  Shares of funds purchased without a sales load may be exchanged
         for shares of other funds sold with a sales load, and the
         applicable sales load will be deducted.

     C.  Shares of funds purchased with a sales load may be exchanged
         without a sales load for shares of other funds sold without a
         sales load.

     D.  Shares of funds purchased with a sales load, shares of funds
         acquired by a previous exchange from shares purchased with a sales
         load and additional shares acquired through reinvestment of
         dividends or distributions of any such funds (collectively
         referred to herein as "Purchased Shares") may be exchanged for
         shares of other funds sold with a sales load (referred to herein
         as "Offered Shares"), provided that, if the sales load applicable
         to the Offered Shares exceeds the maximum sales load that could
         have been imposed in connection with the Purchased Shares (at the
         time the Purchased Shares were acquired), without giving effect to
         any reduced loads, the difference will be deducted.

     To accomplish an exchange under item D above, shareholders must notify
the Transfer Agent of their prior ownership of fund shares and their
account number.

     To request an exchange, an investor must give exchange instructions to
the Transfer Agent in writing, by wire or by telephone.  The ability to
issue exchange instructions by telephone is given to all Fund shareholders
automatically, unless the investor checks the applicable "No"  box on the
Account Application, indicating that the investor specifically refuses this
Privilege.  By using the Telephone Exchange Privilege, the investor
authorizes the Transfer Agent to act on telephonic instructions from any
person representing himself or herself to be the investor, and reasonably
believed by the Transfer Agent to be genuine.  Telephone exchanges may be
subject to limitations as to the amount involved or the number of telephone
exchanges permitted.  Shares issued in certificate form are not eligible
for telephone exchange.

     To establish a personal retirement plan by exchange, shares of the
fund being exchanged must have a value of at least the minimum initial
investment required for the fund into which the exchange is being made.
For Dreyfus-sponsored Keogh Plans, IRAs and IRAs set up under a Simplified
Employee Pension Plan ("SEP-IRAs") with only one participant, the minimum
initial investment is $750.  To exchange shares held in corporate plans,
403(b)(7) Plans and SEP-IRAs with more than one participant, the minimum
initial investment is $100 if the plan has at least $2,500 invested among
the funds in the Dreyfus Family of Funds.  To exchange shares held in
personal retirement plans, the shares exchanged must have a current value
of at least $100.
   

     The Fund Exchanges service is available to shareholders resident in
any state in which shares of the fund being acquired may legally be sold.
Shares may be exchanged only between accounts having identical names and
other identifying designations.
    
   

     Shareholder Services Forms and prospectuses of the other funds may be
obtained by calling toll free 1-800-645-6561.  Each Fund reserves the right
to reject any exchange request in whole or in part.  The Fund Exchanges
service may be modified or terminated at any time upon notice to
shareholders.
    
   

     Dreyfus Dividend Sweep.  Dreyfus Dividend Sweep allows investors to
invest on the payment date their dividends or dividends and capital gain
distributions, if any, from a Fund in shares of another fund in the Dreyfus
Family of Funds of which the investor is a shareholder.  Shares of other
funds purchased pursuant to this privilege will be purchased on the basis
of relative net asset value per share as follows:
    
   

     A.  Dividends and distributions paid by a fund may be invested without
         imposition of a sales load in shares of other funds that are
         offered without a sales load.
    
   

     B.  Dividends and distributions paid by a fund which does not charge a
         sales load may be invested in shares of other funds sold with a
         sales load, and the applicable sales load will be deducted.
    
   

     C.  Dividends and distributions paid by a fund which charges a sales
         load may be invested in shares of other funds sold with a sales
         load (referred to herein as "Offered Shares"), provided that, if
         the sales load applicable to the Offered Shares exceeds the
         maximum sales load charged by the fund from which dividends or
         distributions are being swept, without giving effect to any
         reduced loads, the difference will be deducted.
    
   

     D.  Dividends and distributions paid by a fund may be invested in
         shares of other funds that impose a contingent deferred sales
         charge ("CDSC") and the applicable CDSC, if any, will be imposed
         upon redemption of such shares.

    

                     DETERMINATION OF NET ASSET VALUE

     The following information supplements and should be read in
conjunction with the section in the Funds' Prospectus entitled "How to Buy
Shares."

     Amortized Cost Pricing.  The valuation of each Fund's portfolio
securities is based upon their amortized cost which does not take into
account unrealized capital gains or losses.  This involves valuing an
instrument at its cost and thereafter assuming a constant amortization to
maturity of any discount or premium, regardless of the impact of
fluctuating interest rates on the market value of the instrument.  While
this method provides certainty in valuation, it may result in periods
during which value, as determined by amortized cost, is higher or lower
than the price the respective Fund would receive if it sold the instrument.

     Each Fund's Board has established, as a particular responsibility
within the overall duty of care owed to its Fund's investors, procedures
reasonably designed to stabilize such Fund's price per share as computed
for purposes of sales and redemptions at $1.00.  Such procedures include
review of the relevant Fund's portfolio holdings at such intervals as
deemed appropriate, to determine whether such Fund's net asset value
calculated by using available market quotations or market equivalents devi-
ates from $1.00 per share based on amortized cost.  In such review,
investments for which market quotations are readily available will be
valued at the most recent bid price or yield equivalent for such securities
or for securities of comparable maturity, quality and type, as obtained
from one or more of the major market makers for the securities to be
valued.  Other investments and assets will be valued at fair value as
determined in good faith by the relevant Board.

     The extent of any deviation between a Fund's net asset value based
upon available market quotations or market equivalents and $1.00 per share
based on amortized cost will be examined by its Board.  If such deviation
exceeds 1/2 of 1%, the Board will consider what actions, if any, will be
initiated.  In the event the Board determines that a deviation exists which
may result in material dilution or other unfair results to investors or
existing shareholders, it has agreed to take such corrective action as it
regards as necessary and appropriate, including:  selling portfolio
instruments prior to maturity to realize capital gains or losses or to
shorten average portfolio maturity; withholding dividends or paying dis-
tributions from capital or capital gains; redeeming shares in kind; or es-
tablishing a net asset value per share by using available market quotations
or market equivalents.

     New York Stock Exchange Closings.  The holidays (as observed) on which
the New York Stock Exchange is closed currently are:  New Year's Day,
Presidents' Day, Good Friday, Memorial Day, Independence Day, Labor Day,
Thanksgiving and Christmas.


                         PORTFOLIO TRANSACTIONS

     Portfolio securities ordinarily are purchased directly from the issuer
or an underwriter or a market maker for the securities.  Ordinarily, no
brokerage commissions are paid by a Fund for such purchases.  Purchases
from underwriters of portfolio securities include a concession paid by the
issuer to the underwriter and the purchase price paid to market makers for
securities may include the spread between the bid and asked price.  Neither
Fund has paid brokerage commissions to date.

     Transactions are allocated to various dealers by the respective Fund's
portfolio managers in their best judgment.  The primary consideration is
prompt and effective execution of orders at the most favorable price.
Subject to that primary consideration, dealers may be selected for
research, statistical or other services to enable the Manager to supplement
its own research and analysis with the views and information of other
securities firms.

     Research services furnished by brokers through which a Fund effects
securities transactions may be used by the Manager in advising other funds
it advises and, conversely, research services furnished to the Manager by
brokers in connection with other funds the Manager advises may be used by
the Manager in advising such Fund.  Although it is not possible to place a
dollar value on these services, it is the opinion of the Manager that the
receipt and study of such services should not reduce the overall expenses
of its research department.


                    DIVIDENDS, DISTRIBUTIONS AND TAXES

     The following information supplements and should be read in
conjunction with the section in the Funds' Prospectus entitled "Dividends,
Distributions and Taxes."

     Ordinarily, gains and losses from portfolio transactions will be
treated as capital gain or loss.  However, all or a portion of any gain
realized from the sale or other disposition of certain market discount
bonds will be treated as ordinary income under Section 1276 of the Internal
Revenue Code of 1986, as amended.

     Any fee imposed by the Fund and paid by an investor in connection with
an exchange or redemption of Fund shares may result in a capital loss to
such investor.  In general, such loss will be treated as a short-term
capital loss if the shares were held for one year or less, or a long-term
capital loss if the shares were held for more than one year.


                           YIELD INFORMATION

     The following information supplements and should be read in
conjunction with the section in the Funds' Prospectus entitled "Yield
Information."
   

     For the seven-day period ended February 29, 1996, the yield of the
Money Fund was 5.09% and its effective yield was 5.22%.  For the same
seven-day period, the yield of the Government Money Fund was 5.06% and its
effective yield was 5.19%.  Each Fund's yield and effective yield reflect
the waiver of a portion of the management fee by the Manager without which
the yield and effective yield for the seven-day period ended February 29,
1996 would have been, for the Money Fund, 4.89% and 5.01%, respectively,
and, for the Government Money Fund, 4.89% and 5.01%, respectively.  Yield
is computed in accordance with a standardized method which involves
determining the net change in the value of a hypothetical pre-existing Fund
account having a balance of one share at the beginning of a seven calendar
day period for which yield is to be quoted, dividing the net change by the
value of the account at the beginning of the period to obtain the base per-
iod return, and annualizing the results (i.e., multiplying the base period
return by 365/7).  The net change in the value of the account reflects the
value of additional shares purchased with dividends declared on the
original share and any such additional shares and fees that may be charged
to shareholder accounts, in proportion to the length of the base period and
the Fund's average account size, but does not include realized gains and
losses or unrealized appreciation and depreciation.  Effective yield is
computed by adding 1 to the base period return (calculated as described
above), raising that sum to a power equal to 365 divided by 7, and
subtracting 1 from the result.
    

     Yields fluctuate and are not necessarily representative of future
results.  Investors should remember that yield is a function of the type
and quality of the instruments in the portfolio, portfolio maturity and
operating expenses.  An investor's principal in a Fund is not guaranteed.
See "Determination of Net Asset Value" for a discussion of the manner in
which each Fund's respective price per share is determined.
   

     From time to time, advertising material for the Funds may include
biographical information relating to their portfolio managers and may refer
to, or include commentary by a portfolio manager relating to investment
strategy, asset growth, current or past business, political, economic or
financial conditions and other matters of general interest to investors.
    


                       INFORMATION ABOUT THE FUNDS

     The following information supplements and should be read in
conjunction with the section in the Funds' Prospectus entitled "General
Information."

     Each Fund share has one vote and, when issued and paid for in
accordance with the terms of the offering, is fully paid and non-
assessable.  Fund shares are of one class and have equal rights as to
dividends and in liquidation.  Shares have no preemptive, subscription or
conversion rights and are freely transferable.

     Each Fund sends annual and semi-annual financial statements to
shareholders.


         TRANSFER AND DIVIDEND DISBURSING AGENT, CUSTODIAN, COUNSEL
                         AND INDEPENDENT AUDITORS
   

     Dreyfus Transfer, Inc., a wholly-owned subsidiary of the Manager, P.O.
Box 9671, Providence, Rhode Island 02940-9671, serves as the transfer and
dividend disbursing agent for each Fund.  Under a separate transfer agency
agreement with each Fund, the Transfer Agent arranges for the maintenance
of shareholder account records for the Fund, the handling of certain
communications between shareholders and the Fund and the payment of
dividends and distributions payable by the Fund.  For these services, the
Transfer Agent receives a monthly fee computed on the basis of the number
of shareholder accounts it maintains for the Fund during the month, and is
reimbursed for certain out-of-pocket expenses.  For the period from
December 1, 1995 (effective date of transfer agency agreement) through
February 29, 1996, the Money Fund and Government Money Fund paid the
Transfer Agent $55,321 and $26,672, respectively.  The Bank of New York, 90
Washington Street, New York, New York 10286, is each Fund's custodian.
Neither the Transfer Agent nor The Bank of New York has any part in
determining the investment policies of either Fund or which securities are
to be purchased or sold by a Fund.
    

     Stroock & Stroock & Lavan, 7 Hanover Square, New York, New York 10004-
2696, as counsel for each Fund, has rendered its opinion as to certain
legal matters regarding the due authorization and valid issuance of the
shares of being sold pursuant to the Funds' Prospectus.

     Ernst & Young LLP, 787 Seventh Avenue, New York, New York 10019,
independent auditors, have been selected as auditors of each Fund.

                             APPENDIX


     This Appendix is applicable only to eligible investments of the Money
Fund.


     Description of the highest commercial paper, bond and other short- and
long-term rating categories assigned by Standard & Poor's Ratings Group
("S&P"), Moody's Investors Service, Inc. ("Moody's"), Fitch Investors
Service, L.P. ("Fitch"), Duff & Phelps Credit Rating Co. ("Duff"), IBCA
Limited and IBCA Inc. ("IBCA") and Thomson BankWatch, Inc. ("BankWatch").


Commercial Paper and Short-Term Ratings

     The designation A-1 by S&P indicates that the degree of safety
regarding timely payment is either overwhelming or very strong.  Those
issues determined to possess overwhelming safety characteristics are
denoted with a plus sign (+) designation.

     The rating Prime-1 (P-1) is the highest commercial paper rating
assigned by Moody's.  Issuers of P-1 paper must have a superior capacity
for repayment of short-term promissory obligations, and ordinarily will be
evidenced by leading market positions in well established industries, high
rates of return on funds employed, conservative capitalization structures
with moderate reliance on debt and ample asset protection, broad margins in
earnings coverage of fixed financial charges and high internal cash
generation, and well established access to a range of financial markets and
assured sources of alternate liquidity.

     The rating Fitch-1 (Highest Grade) is the highest commercial paper
rating assigned by Fitch.  Paper rated Fitch-1 is regarded as having the
strongest degree of assurance for timely payment.

     The rating Duff-1 is the highest commercial paper rating assigned by
Duff.  Paper rated Duff-1 is regarded as having very high certainty of
timely payment with excellent liquidity factors which are supported by
ample asset protection.  Risk factors are minor.

     The designation A1 by IBCA indicates that the obligation is supported
by a very strong capacity for timely repayment.  Those obligations rated
A1+ are supported by the highest capacity for timely repayment.

     The rating TBW-1 is the highest short-term obligation rating assigned
by BankWatch.  Obligations rated TBW-1 are regarded as having the strongest
capacity for timely repayment.

Bond and Long-Term Ratings

     Bonds rated AAA by S&P are considered by S&P to be the highest grade
obligations and possess an extremely strong capacity to pay principal and
interest.

     Bonds rated Aaa by Moody's are judged by Moody's to be of the best
quality.  Bonds rated Aa by Moody's are judged by Moody's to be of high
quality by all standards and, together with the Aaa group, they comprise
what are generally known as high-grade bonds.

     Bonds rated AAA by Fitch are judged by Fitch to be strictly high-
grade, broadly marketable, suitable for investment by trustees and
fiduciary institutions and liable to but slight market fluctuation other
than through changes in the money rate.  The prime feature of an AAA bond
is a showing of earnings several times or many times interest requirements,
with such stability of applicable earnings that safety is beyond reasonable
question whatever changes occur in conditions.

     Bonds rated AAA by Duff are considered by Duff to be of the highest
credit quality.  The risk factors are negligible, being only slightly more
than U.S. Treasury debt.

     Obligations rated AAA by IBCA have the lowest expectation of
investment risk.  Capacity for timely repayment of principal and interest
is substantial, such that adverse changes in business, economic or
financial conditions are unlikely to increase investment risk
significantly.

     IBCA also assigns a rating to certain international and U.S. banks.
An IBCA bank rating represents IBCA's current assessment of the strength of
the bank and whether such bank would receive support should it experience
difficulties.  In its assessment of a bank, IBCA uses a dual rating system
comprised of Legal Ratings and Individual Ratings.  In addition, IBCA
assigns banks Long- and Short-Term Ratings as used in the corporate ratings
discussed above.  Legal Ratings, which range in gradation from 1 through 5,
address the question of whether the bank would receive support provided by
central banks or shareholders if it experienced difficulties, and such
ratings are considered by IBCA to be a prime factor in its assessment of
credit risk.  Individual Ratings, which range in gradations from A through
E, represent IBCA's assessment of a bank's economic merits and address the
question of how the bank would be viewed if it were entirely independent
and could not rely on support from state authorities or its owners.

     In addition to its ratings of short-term obligations, BankWatch
assigns a rating to each issuer it rates, in gradations of A through E.
BankWatch examines all segments of the organization, including, where
applicable, the holding company, member banks or associations, and other
subsidiaries.  In those instances where financial disclosure is incomplete
or untimely, a qualified rating (QR) is assigned to the institution.
BankWatch also assigns, in the case of foreign banks, a country rating
which represents an assessment of the overall political and economic
stability of the country in which the bank is domiciled.


 
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>



DREYFUS BASIC MONEY MARKET FUND, INC.
STATEMENT OF INVESTMENTS                                                                                 FEBRUARY 29, 1996
                                                                                                     PRINCIPAL
NEGOTIABLE BANK CERTIFICATES OF DEPOSIT-26.2%                                                          AMOUNT         VALUE
                                                                                                      ________       ________
<S>                                                                                           <C>                <C>

Bank of Tokyo Ltd. (London)
    5.31%-5.80%, 3/8/96-5/7/96..............................................                  $     38,000,000   $ 37,999,692
Bank of Tokyo Ltd. (Yankee)
    5.22%, 8/26/96..........................................................                         7,000,000      7,000,000
Bayerische Vereinsbank AG (Yankee)
    5.38%, 1/29/97-2/24/97..................................................                         65,000,000    65,000,000
Berliner Handels-und Frankforter Bank (Yankee)
    5.57%, 2/5/97...........................................................                         50,000,000    50,000,000
Dai-Ichi Kangyo Bank Ltd. (London)
    5.30%-5.33%, 4/9/96-5/8/96..............................................                         15,000,000    15,000,860
Dai-Ichi Kangyo Bank Ltd. (Yankee)
    5.49%-5.60%, 4/17/96-4/29/96............................................                         75,000,000    75,004,134
Mitsubishi Bank Ltd. (London)
    5.52%, 4/23/96..........................................................                         30,000,000    30,000,580
Mitsubishi Bank Ltd. (Yankee)
    5.83%, 3/6/96...........................................................                         20,000,000    20,000,039
Sanwa Bank Ltd. (London)
    5.85%, 3/5/96...........................................................                         35,000,000    35,000,073
Sanwa Bank Ltd. (Yankee)
    5.30%-5.61%, 4/4/96-4/29/96.............................................                         65,000,000    65,002,548
Sumitomo Bank Ltd. (London)
    5.28%, 5/2/96...........................................................                         15,000,000    15,001,528
Sumitomo Bank Ltd. (Yankee)
    5.30%-5.70%, 4/2/96-5/7/96..............................................                         85,000,000    85,004,421
SwedBank (Yankee)
    5.27%, 7/31/96..........................................................                         50,000,000    50,000,000
                                                                                                                      _______
TOTAL NEGOTIABLE BANK CERTIFICATES OF DEPOSIT
    (cost $550,013,875).....................................................                                    $ 550,013,875
                                                                                                                      =======
BANKERS' ACCEPTANCE-.4%
Bank of Tokyo Ltd. (Yankee)
    5.80%, 3/18/96
    (cost $9,972,942).......................................................                   $     10,000,000 $   9,972,942
                                                                                                                      =======
COMMERCIAL PAPER-12.9%
Bankers Trust New York Corp.
    5.42%-5.81%, 3/15/96-7/8/96.............................................                   $     49,000,000  $ 48,474,808
Chrysler Financial Corp.
    5.28%, 4/29/96..........................................................                         25,000,000    24,786,125
General Motors Acceptance Corp.
    5.57%-5.76%, 3/15/96-3/20/96............................................                         75,000,000    74,797,334
Lehman Brothers Holdings Inc.
    5.32%, 4/8/96...........................................................                         15,000,000    14,916,558

DREYFUS BASIC MONEY MARKET FUND, INC.
STATEMENT OF INVESTMENTS (CONTINUED)                                                                      FEBRUARY 29, 1996
                                                                                                     PRINCIPAL
COMMERCIAL PAPER (CONTINUED)                                                                           AMOUNT         VALUE
                                                                                                       ________      ________

Merrill Lynch & Co. Inc.
    5.18%-5.57%, 3/29/96-7/29/96............................................                   $     40,000,000  $ 39,409,908
Spintab AB
    5.42%-5.90%, 4/11/96-4/19/96............................................                         68,786,000    68,308,802
                                                                                                                      _______
TOTAL COMMERCIAL PAPER (cost $270,693,535)..................................                                    $ 270,693,535
                                                                                                                      =======
CORPORATE NOTES-17.4%
Bear Stearns Companies Inc.
    5.40%-5.56%, 6/10/96-11/18/96 (a).......................................                   $     75,000,000  $ 75,000,000
Comerica Bank
    5.40%, 7/26/96 (a)......................................................                         30,000,000    29,999,644
General Electric Capital Corp.
    5.40%-5.53%, 3/29/96-5/15/96 (a)........................................                         80,000,000    79,997,947
Lehman Brothers Holdings Inc.
    5.50%-5.70%, 5/16/96-1/6/97 (a).........................................                         75,000,000    75,000,000
Merrill Lynch & Co. Inc.
    5.38%-5.60%, 4/22/96-2/13/97 (a)........................................                         55,000,000    54,997,317
PHH Corp.
    5.45%, 6/27/96 (a)......................................................                         50,000,000    49,995,346
                                                                                                                      _______
TOTAL CORPORATE NOTES (cost $364,990,254)...................................                                    $ 364,990,254
                                                                                                                      =======
PROMISSORY NOTES-4.6%
Goldman Sachs Group L.P.
    5.17%-5.88%, 3/11/96-9/25/96 (b,c)
    (cost $96,000,000)......................................................                   $     96,000,000  $ 96,000,000
                                                                                                                      =======
SHORT-TERM BANK NOTES-16.7%
Banc One Milwaukee
    5.37%, 2/6/97 (a).......................................................                   $     48,000,000  $ 47,982,674
Bank of America NT & SA
    5.08%, 1/24/97..........................................................                         50,000,000    50,010,852
Bank of New York Co. Inc.
    5.51%, 6/13/96..........................................................                         25,000,000    25,000,000
Comerica Bank
    5.36%, 2/14/97 (a)......................................................                         50,000,000    49,967,281
First National Bank of Boston
    5.81%, 6/5/96...........................................................                         10,000,000    10,000,000
First National Bank of Boston
    5.47%-5.48%, 5/10/96-6/21/96 (a)........................................                         88,500,000    88,499,753
NBD Bank, NA
    6.42%, 4/26/96..........................................................                         25,000,000    25,000,000
Society National Bank
    6.48%, 4/25/96..........................................................                         23,500,000    23,497,316

DREYFUS BASIC MONEY MARKET FUND, INC.
STATEMENT OF INVESTMENTS (CONTINUED)                                                                    FEBRUARY 29, 1996
                                                                                                     PRINCIPAL
SHORT-TERM BANK NOTES (CONTINUED)                                                                     AMOUNT          VALUE
                                                                                                      ________       ________

Society National Bank
    5.37%, 2/14/97 (a)......................................................                  $     30,000,000   $ 29,966,086
                                                                                                                      _______
TOTAL SHORT-TERM BANK NOTES
    (cost $349,923,962).....................................................                                    $ 349,923,962
                                                                                                                      =======
U.S. GOVERNMENT AGENCIES-20.5%
Federal Farm Credit Banks
Floating Rate Notes
    5.34%, 11/25/96 (a).....................................................                  $     50,000,000    $49,975,465
Federal Home Loan Banks
Floating Rate Notes
    5.83%, 1/31/97 (a)......................................................                         5,000,000      5,000,000
Federal National Mortgage Association
Floating Rate Notes
    5.34%-5.85%, 6/20/96-1/21/98 (a)........................................                       375,000,000    374,824,572
                                                                                                                      _______
TOTAL U.S. GOVERNMENT AGENCIES (cost $429,800,037)..........................                                    $ 429,800,037
                                                                                                                      =======
TIME DEPOSITS-.3%
Berliner Handels-und Frankforter Bank (Grand Cayman)
    5.50%, 3/1/96
    (cost $6,334,000).......................................................                 $       6,334,000    $ 6,334,000
                                                                                                                      =======
TOTAL INVESTMENTS (cost $2,077,728,605).............................        99.0%                              $2,077,728,605
                                                                           =====                                      =======
CASH AND RECEIVABLES (NET)..........................................          1.0%                             $   20,563,759
                                                                           =====                                      =======
NET ASSETS..........................................................        100.0%                             $2,098,292,364
                                                                           =====                                      =======
NOTES TO STATEMENT OF INVESTMENTS:
    (a)  Variable interest rate - subject to periodic change.
    (b)  Securities restricted as to public resale. These securities were
    acquired from 9/11/95 to 2/12/96 at a cost of par value. At February 29,
    1996, the aggregate value of these securities is $96 million,
    representing approximately 4.6% of net assets and are valued at amortized
    cost.
    (c)  These notes were acquired for investment, not with the intent to
    distribute or sell.




</TABLE>


See notes to financial statements.
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>

DREYFUS BASIC MONEY MARKET FUND, INC.
STATEMENT OF ASSETS AND LIABILITIES                                                                 FEBRUARY 29, 1996
<S>                                                                                            <C>             <C>
ASSETS:
    Investments in securities, at value-Note 1(a)...........................                                   $2,077,728,605
    Cash....................................................................                                        5,731,001
    Interest receivable.....................................................                                       15,490,133
    Prepaid expenses........................................................                                          201,636
                                                                                                                      _______
                                                                                                                2,099,151,375
LIABILITIES:
    Due to The Dreyfus Corporation and subsidiaries.........................                   $     383,154
    Accrued expenses and other liabilities..................................                         475,857         859,011
                                                                                                      ______         _______
NET ASSETS..................................................................                                  $2,098,292,364
                                                                                                                     =======
REPRESENTED BY:
    Paid-in capital.........................................................                                  $2,098,639,684
    Accumulated net realized (loss) on investments..........................                                        (347,320)
                                                                                                                    _______
NET ASSETS at value applicable to 2,098,639,684 shares outstanding
    (3 billion shares of $.001 par value Common Stock authorized)...........                                  $2,098,292,364
                                                                                                                     =======
NET ASSET VALUE, offering and redemption price per share
    ($2,098,292,364 / 2,098,639,684 shares).................................                                         $1.00
                                                                                                                       ===

</TABLE>
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>

STATEMENT OF OPERATIONS                                                                       YEAR ENDED FEBRUARY 29, 1996
<S>                                                                                            <C>              <C>
INVESTMENT INCOME:
    INTEREST INCOME.........................................................                                    $ 119,514,902
    EXPENSES:
      Management fee-Note 2(a)..............................................                   $  9,747,085
      Shareholder servicing costs-Note 2(b).................................                      1,705,883
      Registration fees.....................................................                        270,779
      Custodian fees........................................................                        155,908
      Professional fees.....................................................                         68,720
      Prospectus and shareholders' reports..................................                         47,842
      Directors' fees and expenses-Note 2(c)................................                         29,792
                                                                                                     ______
            TOTAL EXPENSES..................................................                     12,026,009
      Less-reduction in management fee due
          to undertakings-Note 2(a).........................................                      5,960,272
                                                                                                      ______
            NET EXPENSES....................................................                                        6,065,737
                                                                                                                      _______
INVESTMENT INCOME-NET.......................................................                                      113,449,165
NET REALIZED (LOSS) ON INVESTMENTS-Note 1(b)................................                                         (131,085)
                                                                                                                      _______
NET INCREASE IN NET ASSETS RESULTING FROM OPERATIONS........................                                    $ 113,318,080
                                                                                                                      =======

</TABLE>

See notes to financial statements.
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>

DREYFUS BASIC MONEY MARKET FUND, INC.
STATEMENT OF CHANGES IN NET ASSETS
                                                                                                    YEAR ENDED
                                                                                   ______________________________________
                                                                                        FEBRUARY 28,      FEBRUARY 29,
                                                                                          1995               1996
                                                                                         _________          _________
<S>                                                                               <C>                   <C>
OPERATIONS:
    Investment income-net...............................................          $      76,813,860     $ 113,449,165
    Net realized (loss) on investments..................................                   (126,050)         (131,085)
                                                                                           ________           _______
      NET INCREASE IN NET ASSETS RESULTING FROM OPERATIONS..............                 76,687,810       113,318,080
                                                                                           ________           _______
DIVIDENDS TO SHAREHOLDERS FROM;
    Investment income-net...............................................                (76,813,860)     (113,449,165)
                                                                                           ________           _______
CAPITAL STOCK TRANSACTIONS ($1.00 per share):
    Net proceeds from shares sold.......................................              2,588,359,537     2,618,953,833
    Dividends reinvested................................................                 71,571,677       106,821,314
    Cost of shares redeemed.............................................             (2,253,594,949)    (2,250,593,463)
                                                                                           ________           _______
      INCREASE IN NET ASSETS FROM CAPITAL STOCK TRANSACTIONS............                406,336,265       475,181,684
                                                                                           ________           _______
          TOTAL INCREASE IN NET ASSETS..................................                406,210,215       475,050,599
NET ASSETS:
    Beginning of year...................................................              1,217,031,550     1,623,241,765
                                                                                           ________           _______
    End of year.........................................................            $ 1,623,241,765   $ 2,098,292,364
                                                                                           ========           =======




</TABLE>










See notes to financial statements.

DREYFUS BASIC MONEY MARKET FUND, INC.
FINANCIAL HIGHLIGHTS
    Referece is made to page 5 of the Fund's Prospectus, dated July 1, 1996

DREYFUS BASIC MONEY MARKET FUND, INC.
NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
NOTE 1-SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES:
    Dreyfus BASIC Money Market Fund, Inc. (the "Fund") is registered under
the Investment Company Act of 1940 ("Act") as a diversified open-end
management investment company. The Fund's investment objective is to provide
investors with as high a level of current income as is consistent with the
preservation of capital and the maintenance of liquidity. The Dreyfus
Corporation ("Manager") serves as the Fund's investment adviser. The Manager
is a direct subsidiary of Mellon Bank, N.A. Premier Mutual Fund Services,
Inc. (the "Distributor") acts as the distributor of the Fund's shares, which
are sold to the public without a sales charge.
    It is the Fund's policy to maintain a continuous net asset value per
share of $1.00; the Fund has adopted certain investment, portfolio valuation
and dividend and distribution policies to enable it to do so. There is no
assurance, however, that the Fund will be able to maintain a stable net asset
value of $1.00.
    (A) PORTFOLIO VALUATION: Investments are valued at amortized cost, which
has been determined by the Fund's Board of Directors to represent the fair
value of the Fund's investments.
    (B) SECURITIES TRANSACTIONS AND INVESTMENT INCOME: Securities
transactions are recorded on a trade date basis. Realized gain and loss from
securities transactions are recorded on the identified cost basis. Interest
income is recognized on the accrual basis. Cost of investments represents
amortized cost.
    (C) DIVIDENDS TO SHAREHOLDERS: It is the policy of the Fund to declare
dividends daily from investment income-net. Such dividends are paid monthly.
Dividends from net realized capital gain, if any, are normally declared and
paid annually, but the Fund may make distributions on a more frequent basis
to comply with the distribution requirements of the Internal Revenue Code. To
the extent that net realized capital gain can be offset by capital loss
carryovers, it is the policy of the Fund not to distribute such gain.
    (D) FEDERAL INCOME TAXES: It is the policy of the Fund to continue to
qualify as a regulated investment company, if such qualification is in the
best interests of its shareholders, by complying with the applicable
provisions of the Internal Revenue Code, and to make distributions of taxable
income sufficient to relieve it from substantially all Federal income and
excise taxes.
    The Fund has an unused capital loss carryover of approximately $273,000
available for Federal income tax purposes to be applied against future net
securities profits, if any, realized subsequent to February 29, 1996. The
carryover does not include net realized securities losses from November 1,
1995 through February 29, 1996, which are treated, for Federal income tax
purposes, as arising in fiscal 1997. If not applied, $90,000 of the carryover
expires in fiscal 2002, $126,000 expires in fiscal 2003 and $57,000 expires
in fiscal 2004.
    At February 29, 1996, the cost of investments for Federal income tax
purposes was substantially the same as the cost for financial reporting
purposes (see the Statement of Investments).

DREYFUS BASIC MONEY MARKET FUND, INC.
NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (CONTINUED)

NOTE 2-MANAGEMENT FEE AND OTHER TRANSACTIONS WITH AFFILIATES:
    (A) Pursuant to a management agreement ("Agreement") with the Manager,
the management fee is computed at the annual rate of .50 of 1% of the average
daily value of the Fund's net assets and is payable monthly. The Agreement
provides for an expense reimbursement from the Manager should the Fund's
aggregate expenses, exclusive of taxes, brokerage, interest on borrowings and
extraordinary expenses, exceed the expense limitation of any state having
jurisdiction over the Fund for any full fiscal year. The most stringent state
expense limitation applicable to the Fund presently requires reimbursement of
expenses in any full fiscal year that such expenses (exclusive of certain
expenses as described above) exceed 2 1\2% of the first $30 million, 2% of the
next $70 million and 1 1\2% of the excess over $100 million of the average
value of the Fund's net assets in accordance with California "blue sky"
regulations. However, the Manager had undertaken from March 1, 1995 through
January 4, 1996 to waive receipt of the management fee payable to it by the
Fund, to the extent that the Fund's aggregate expenses (exclusive of certain
expenses as described above) exceed specified annual percentages of the
Fund's average daily net assets. The Manager has currently undertaken from
January 5, 1996 through June 30, 1996, to reduce the management fee paid by
the Fund, to the extent that the Fund's aggregate annual expenses (exclusive
of certain expenses as described above) exceed an annual rate of .45 of 1% of
the average daily value of the Fund's net assets. The reduction in management
fee, pursuant to the undertakings, amounted to $5,960,272 for the year ended
February 29, 1996.
    The Manager may modify the existing undertaking provided that the Fund's
shareholders are given 90 days prior notice.
    Effective December 1, 1995, the Fund compensates Dreyfus Transfer, Inc.,
a wholly-owned subsidiary of the Manager, under a transfer agency agreement
for providing personnel and facilities to perform transfer agency services
for the Fund. Such compensation amounted to $55,321 for the period from
December 1, 1995 through February 29, 1996.
    (B) Pursuant to the Fund's Shareholder Services Plan, the Fund reimburses
Dreyfus Service Corporation, a wholly-owned subsidiary of the Manager, an amount
not to exceed an annual rate of .25 of 1% of the value of the Fund's average
daily net assets for certain allocated expenses of providing personal services
and/or maintaining shareholder accounts. The services provided may include
personal services relating to shareholder accounts, such as answering
shareholder inquiries regarding the Fund and providing reports and other
information, and services related to the maintenance of shareholder accounts.
During the year ended February 29, 1996, the Fund was charged an aggregate of
$1,276,493 pursuant to the Shareholder Services Plan.
    (C) Each director who is not an "affiliated person" as defined in the Act
receives from the Fund an annual fee of $1,500 and an attendance fee of $250
per meeting. The Chairman of the Board receives an additional 25% of such
compensation.


DREYFUS BASIC MONEY MARKET FUND, INC.
REPORT OF ERNST & YOUNG LLP, INDEPENDENT AUDITORS
SHAREHOLDERS AND BOARD OF DIRECTORS
DREYFUS BASIC MONEY MARKET FUND, INC.
    We have audited the accompanying statement of assets and liabilities of
Dreyfus BASIC Money Market Fund, Inc., including the statement of
investments, as of February 29, 1996, and the related statement of operations
for the year then ended, the statement of changes in net assets for each of
the two years in the period then ended, and financial highlights for each of
the years indicated therein. These financial statements and financial
highlights are the responsibility of the Fund's management. Our responsibility
 is to express an opinion on these financial statements and financial
highlights based on our audits.
    We conducted our audits in accordance with generally accepted auditing
standards. Those standards require that we plan and perform the audit to
obtain reasonable assurance about whether the financial statements and
financial highlights are free of material misstatement. An audit includes
examining, on a test basis, evidence supporting the amounts and disclosures
in the financial statements. Our procedures included confirmation of
securities owned as of February 29, 1996 by correspondence with the custodian.
 An audit also includes assessing the accounting principles used and
significant estimates made by management, as well as evaluating the overall
financial statement presentation. We believe that our audits provide a
reasonable basis for our opinion.
    In our opinion, the financial statements and financial highlights
referred to above present fairly, in all material respects, the financial
position of Dreyfus BASIC Money Market Fund, Inc. at February 29, 1996, the
results of its operations for the year then ended, the changes in its net
assets for each of the two years in the period then ended, and the financial
highlights for each of the indicated years, in conformity with generally
accepted accounting principles.

                              [Ernst and Young LLP signature logo]

New York, New York
March 29, 1996



<TABLE>
<CAPTION>



DREYFUS BASIC U.S. GOVERNMENT MONEY MARKET FUND
STATEMENT OF INVESTMENTS                                                                               FEBRUARY 29, 1996


                                                                         ANNUALIZED
                                                                          YIELD ON
                                                                          DATE OF                  PRINCIPAL
U.S. TREASURY BILLS-6.0%                                                  PURCHASE                   AMOUNT          VALUE
                                                                           ______                    _______       _________
    <S>                                                                    <C>                     <C>           <C>
    8/22/96....................................................            5.83 %                  $65,000,000   $63,271,116
    3/6/97.....................................................            5.23                     20,000,000    18,994,956
                                                                                                                  __________
TOTAL U.S. TREASURY BILLS (cost $82,266,072)...................                                                  $82,266,072
                                                                                                                 ===========
U.S. GOVERNMENT AGENCIES-97.4%
Federal Farm Credit Banks, Floating Rate Notes
    3/7/96.....................................................            5.50% (a)               $60,000,000   $59,999,291
    9/16/96....................................................            5.32 (a)                 10,000,000    10,004,496
    9/30/96....................................................            5.55 (a)                  5,000,000     5,000,000
    11/22/96...................................................            5.33 (a)                 25,000,000    24,982,474
    12/6/96....................................................            5.33 (a)                 60,000,000    59,951,293
    12/30/96...................................................            5.33 (a)                 50,000,000    49,944,453
    5/23/97....................................................            5.40 (a)                 24,000,000    24,096,826
    6/13/97....................................................            5.39 (a)                 19,500,000    19,483,692
    7/25/97....................................................            5.33 (a)                 50,000,000    49,973,245
    8/14/97....................................................            5.35 (a)                 75,000,000    74,982,975
    9/15/97....................................................            5.38 (a)                 20,000,000    19,985,567
    1/30/98....................................................            5.59 (a)                 50,000,000    49,945,805
    6/8/98.....................................................            5.50 (a)                 50,000,000    50,000,000
Federal Home Loan Banks, Discount Note
    3/1/96.....................................................            5.30                     14,575,000    14,575,000
Federal Home Loan Banks, Floating Rate Notes
    7/8/96.....................................................            5.30 (a)                 10,000,000     9,999,431
    11/7/96....................................................            5.46 (a)                 25,000,000    24,996,642
    12/19/96...................................................            5.75 (a)                 16,000,000    16,000,000
    1/24/97....................................................            5.38 (a)                 50,000,000    49,972,134
    1/31/97....................................................            5.67 (a)                 23,000,000    23,027,588
    2/3/97.....................................................            5.35 (a)                10,000,000     10,034,554
    3/6/97.....................................................            5.22 (a)                25,000,000     24,994,075
Federal Home Loan Mortgage Corp., Discount Note
    4/23/96....................................................            6.28                     16,000,000    15,860,787
Federal Home Loan Mortgage Corp., Floating Rate Note
    6/30/98....................................................            5.78 (a)                 10,000,000     9,961,903
Federal National Mortgage Association, Discount Note
    4/15/96....................................................            6.31                     45,000,000    44,665,875
Federal National Mortgage Association, Floating Rate Notes
    6/3/96.....................................................            5.42 (a)                 25,000,000    24,997,219
    10/7/96....................................................            5.47 (a)                 18,000,000    18,031,259
    2/14/97....................................................            5.85 (a)                 10,000,000    10,000,000
    2/18/97....................................................            5.74 (a)                 31,000,000    31,014,135

DREYFUS BASIC U.S. GOVERNMENT MONEY MARKET FUND
STATEMENT OF INVESTMENTS (CONTINUED)                                                                        FEBRUARY 29, 1996
                                                                          ANNUALIZED
                                                                           YIELD ON
                                                                            DATE OF              PRINCIPAL
U.S. GOVERNMENT AGENCIES (CONTINUED)                                       PURCHASE               AMOUNT           VALUE
                                                                           ________              _________      ____________

Federal National Mortgage Association, Floating Rate Notes (continued)
    3/27/97....................................................            5.30%(a)                $5,000,000    $5,000,000
    4/4/97.....................................................            4.91 (a)                50,000,000    49,974,415
    4/11/97....................................................            5.29 (a)                20,000,000    19,989,800
    6/20/97....................................................            5.27 (a)                20,000,000    20,016,716
    6/20/97....................................................            5.46 (a)               100,000,000    99,987,842
    7/24/97....................................................            5.36 (a)                25,000,000    25,000,000
    6/19/98....................................................            5.45 (a)               100,000,000    99,957,846
    6/29/98....................................................            5.47 (a)               100,000,000    99,957,850
Student Loan Marketing Association, Floating Rate Notes
    3/20/96....................................................            5.18 (a)                 1,000,000     1,000,024
    11/1/96....................................................            5.07 (a)                14,600,000    14,618,365
    12/20/96...................................................            5.11 (a)                25,000,000    25,000,000
    1/23/97....................................................            5.07 (a)                13,905,000    13,928,351
    1/23/97....................................................            5.06 (a)                10,000,000    10,016,753
    1/27/98....................................................            5.82 (a)                20,000,000    19,865,830
                                                                                                                  __________
TOTAL U.S. GOVERNMENT AGENCIES (cost $1,330,794,511)...........                                                $1,330,794,511
                                                                                                                 ===========
TOTAL INVESTMENTS
    (cost $1,413,060,583)...........................        103.4%                                            $1,413,060,583
                                                            ======                                           ===============
LIABILITIES, LESS CASH AND RECEIVABLES..............        (3.4%)                                          $    (47,004,329)
                                                            ======                                             ==============
NET ASSETS..........................................        100.0%                                            $1,366,056,254
                                                            ======                                            ==============
NOTE TO STATEMENT OF INVESTMENTS;
    (a)  Variable interest rate-subject to periodic change.


</TABLE>


See notes to financial statements.

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>


DREYFUS BASIC U.S. GOVERNMENT MONEY MARKET FUND
STATEMENT OF ASSETS AND LIABILITIES                                                                   FEBRUARY 29, 1996
ASSETS:
    <S>                                                                                        <C>            <C>
    Investments in securities, at value-Note 1(a)...........................                                  $1,413,060,583
    Cash....................................................................                                       6,280,579
    Interest receivable.....................................................                                      11,232,987
    Prepaid expenses........................................................                                         158,465
                                                                                                               _____________
                                                                                                               1,430,732,614
LIABILITIES:
    Due to The Dreyfus Corporation and subsidiaries.........................                     $441,643
    Payable for investment securities purchased.............................                   63,978,831
    Accrued expenses and other liabilities..................................                      255,886         64,676,360
                                                                                                 ________     ______________
NET ASSETS..................................................................                                  $1,366,056,254
                                                                                                               _____________
REPRESENTED BY:
    Paid-in capital.........................................................                                  $1,366,056,464
    Accumulated net realized (loss) on investments..........................                                           (210)
                                                                                                               _____________
NET ASSETS at value applicable to 1,366,056,464 shares outstanding
    (unlimited number of $.001 par value shares of Beneficial
    Interest authorized)....................................................                                 $1,366,056,254
                                                                                                             ===============
NET ASSET VALUE, offering and redemption price per share
    ($1,366,056,254 / 1,366,056,464 shares).................................                                         $1.00
                                                                                                                      =====

</TABLE>



See notes to financial statements.
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>


DREYFUS BASIC U.S. GOVERNMENT MONEY MARKET FUND
STATEMENT OF OPERATIONS                                                                        YEAR ENDED FEBRUARY 29, 1996
<S>                                                                                              <C>             <C>
INVESTMENT INCOME:
    INTEREST INCOME.........................................................                                     $76,467,239
    EXPENSES:
      Management fee-Note 2(a)..............................................                     $6,266,897
      Shareholder servicing costs-Note 2(b).................................                      1,415,057
      Registration fees.....................................................                        405,413
      Custodian fees........................................................                        101,465
      Professional fees.....................................................                         47,128
      Prospectus and shareholders' reports..................................                         46,094
      Trustees' fees and expenses-Note 2(c).................................                         27,174
      Miscellaneous.........................................................                         19,747
                                                                                               _____________
            TOTAL EXPENSES..................................................                     8,328,975
      Less-reduction in management fee due to
          undertakings-Note 2(a)............................................                     4,484,591
                                                                                               ____________
            NET EXPENSES....................................................                                       3,844,384
                                                                                                                  _________
INVESTMENT INCOME-NET.......................................................                                      72,622,855
NET REALIZED GAIN ON INVESTMENTS-Note 1(b)..................................                                         100,431
                                                                                                                ___________
NET INCREASE IN NET ASSETS RESULTING FROM OPERATIONS........................                                     $72,723,286
                                                                                                               =============


</TABLE>

See notes to financial statements.

<TABLE>
<CAPTION>


DREYFUS BASIC U.S. GOVERNMENT MONEY MARKET FUND
STATEMENT OF CHANGES IN NET ASSETS
                                                                                                       YEAR ENDED
                                                                                              _____________________________
                                                                                              FEBRUARY 28,     FEBRUARY 29,
                                                                                                  1995            1996
                                                                                                ___________     ____________
<S>                                                                                             <C>            <C>
OPERATIONS:
    Investment income-net...............................................                        $20,545,262    $ 72,622,855
    Net realized gain (loss) on investments.............................                           (96,907)         100,431
                                                                                                ___________     ____________
      NET INCREASE IN NET ASSETS RESULTING FROM OPERATIONS..............                         20,448,355        72,723,286
                                                                                                ___________     ____________
DIVIDENDS TO SHAREHOLDERS FROM;
    Investment income-net...............................................                       (20,545,262)      (72,622,855)
                                                                                                ___________     ____________
BENEFICIAL INTEREST TRANSACTIONS ($1.00 per share):
    Net proceeds from shares sold.......................................                       1,427,941,614   1,786,037,880
    Dividends reinvested................................................                         18,991,741       68,115,281
    Cost of shares redeemed.............................................                       (670,805,165)  (1,529,919,393)
                                                                                                ___________     ____________
      INCREASE IN NET ASSETS FROM BENEFICIAL INTEREST TRANSACTIONS......                         776,128,190     324,233,768
                                                                                                ___________     ____________
          TOTAL INCREASE IN NET ASSETS..................................                        776,031,283      324,334,199
NET ASSETS:
    Beginning of year...................................................                        265,690,772    1,041,722,055
                                                                                                ___________     ____________
    End of year.........................................................                     $1,041,722,055   $1,366,056,254
                                                                                             ==============   ==============


</TABLE>




See notes to financial statements.


DREYFUS BASIC U.S. GOVERNMENT MONEY MARKET FUND
FINANCIAL HIGHLIGHTS
    Referece is made to page 6 of the Fund's Prospectus dated July 1, 1996.

DREYFUS BASIC U.S. GOVERNMENT MONEY MARKET FUND
NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS
NOTE 1-SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES:
    Dreyfus BASIC U.S. Government Money Market Fund (the "Fund") is
registered under the Investment Company Act of 1940 ("Act") as a diversified
open-end management investment company. The Fund's investment objective is to
provide investors with as high a level of current income as is consistent
with the preservation of capital and maintenance of liquidity. The Dreyfus
Corporation ("Manager") serves as the Fund's investment adviser. The Manager
is a direct subsidiary of Mellon Bank, N.A. Premier Mutual Fund Services,
Inc. (the "Distributor") acts as the distributor of the Fund's shares, which
are sold to the public without a sales charge.
    It is the Fund's policy to maintain a continuous net asset value per
share of $1.00; the Fund has adopted certain investment, portfolio valuation
and dividend and distribution policies to enable it to do so. There is no
assurance, however, that the Fund will be able to maintain a stable net asset
value of $1.00.
    (A) PORTFOLIO VALUATION: Investments are valued at amortized cost, which
has been determined by the Fund's Board of Trustees to represent the fair
value of the Fund's investments.
    (B) SECURITIES TRANSACTIONS AND INVESTMENT INCOME: Securities
transactions are recorded on a trade date basis. Realized gain and loss from
securities transactions are recorded on the identified cost basis. Interest
income is recognized on the accrual basis. Cost of investments represents
amortized cost.
    (C) DIVIDENDS TO SHAREHOLDERS: It is the policy of the Fund to declare
dividends daily from investment income-net. Such dividends are paid monthly.
Dividends from net realized capital gain are normally declared and paid
annually, but the Fund may make distributions on a more frequent basis to
comply with the distribution requirements of the Internal Revenue Code. To
the extent that net realized capital gain can be offset by capital loss
carryovers, it is the policy of the Fund not to distribute such gain.
    (D) FEDERAL INCOME TAXES: It is the policy of the Fund to continue to
qualify as a regulated investment company, if such qualification is in the
best interests of its shareholders, by complying with the applicable
provisions of the Internal Revenue Code, and to make distributions of taxable
income sufficient to relieve it from substantially all Federal income and
excise taxes.
    The Fund has an unused capital loss carryover of $210 available for
Federal income tax purposes to be applied against future net securities
profits, if any, realized subsequent to February 29, 1996. If not applied,
the carryover expires in fiscal 2003.
    At February 29, 1996, the cost of investments for Federal income tax
purposes was substantially the same as the cost for financial reporting
purposes (see the Statement of Investments).
DREYFUS BASIC U.S. GOVERNMENT MONEY MARKET FUND
NOTES TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (CONTINUED)
NOTE 2-MANAGEMENT FEE AND OTHER TRANSACTIONS WITH AFFILIATES:
    (A) Pursuant to a management agreement ("Agreement") with the Manager,
the management fee is computed at the annual rate of .50 of 1% of the average
daily value of the Fund's net assets and is payable monthly. The Agreement
provides for an expense reimbursement from the Manager should the Fund's
aggregate expenses, exclusive of taxes, brokerage, interest on borrowings and
extraordinary expenses, exceed the expense limitation of any state having
jurisdiction over the Fund for any full fiscal year. The most stringent state
expense limitation applicable to the Fund presently requires reimbursement of
expenses in any full fiscal year that such expenses (exclusive of certain
expenses as described above) exceed 2 1\2% of the first $30 million, 2% of
the next $70 million and 1 1\2% of the excess over $100 million of the average
value of the Fund's net assets in accordance with California "blue sky"
regulations. The Manager had undertaken from March 1, 1995 through
January 19, 1996 to reduce the management fee paid by the Fund, to the
extent that the Fund's aggregate annual expenses (exclusive of certain
expenses as described above) exceeded specified annual percentages of the
Fund's average daily net assets. The Manager has currently undertaken from
January 20, 1996 through June 30, 1996 to reduce the management fee paid
by the Fund, to the extent that the Fund's aggregate annual expenses
(exclusive of certain expenses as described above) exceed an annual rate of
 .45 of 1% of the average daily value of the Fund's net assets. The reduction
in management fee, pursuant to the undertakings, amounted to $4,484,591 for
the year ended February 29, 1996.
    The Manager may modify the existing undertaking provided that the Fund's
shareholders are given 90 days prior notice.
    (B) Pursuant to the Fund's Shareholder Services Plan, the Fund reimburses
Dreyfus Service Corporation, a wholly-owned subsidiary of the Manager, an
amount not to exceed an annual rate of .25 of 1% of the value of the Fund's
average daily net assets for certain allocated expenses of providing personal
services and/or maintaining shareholder accounts. The services provided may
include personal services relating to shareholder accounts, such as answering
shareholder inquiries regarding the Fund and providing reports and other
information, and services related to the maintenance of shareholder accounts.
During the year ended February 29, 1996, the Fund was charged an aggregate of
$1,133,516 pursuant to the Shareholder Services Plan.
    Effective December 1, 1995, the Fund compensates Dreyfus Transfer, Inc.,
a wholly-owned subsidiary of the Manager, under a transfer agency agreement
for providing personnel and facilities to perform transfer agency services
for the Fund. Such compensation amounted to $26,672 for the period from
December 1, 1995 through February 29, 1996.
    (C) Each trustee who is not an "affiliated person" as defined in the Act
receives from the Fund an annual fee of $1,500 and an attendance fee of $250
per meeting. The Chairman of the Board receives an additional 25% of such
compensation.


DREYFUS BASIC U.S. GOVERNMENT MONEY MARKET FUND
REPORT OF ERNST & YOUNG LLP, INDEPENDENT AUDITORS
SHAREHOLDERS AND BOARD OF TRUSTEES
DREYFUS BASIC U.S. GOVERNMENT MONEY MARKET FUND
    We have audited the accompanying statement of assets and liabilities of
Dreyfus BASIC U.S. Government Money Market Fund, including the statement of
investments, as of February 29, 1996, and the related statement of operations
for the year then ended, the statement of changes in net assets for each of
the two years in the period then ended, and financial highlights for each of
the years indicated therein. These financial statements and financial
highlights are the responsibility of the Fund's management. Our
responsibility is to express an opinion on these financial statements and
financial highlights based on our audits.
    We conducted our audits in accordance with generally accepted auditing
standards. Those standards require that we plan and perform the audit to
obtain reasonable assurance about whether the financial statements and
financial highlights are free of material misstatement. An audit includes
examining, on a test basis, evidence supporting the amounts and disclosures
in the financial statements. Our procedures included confirmation of
securities owned as of February 29, 1996 by correspondence with the custodian
and brokers. An audit also includes assessing the accounting principles used
and significant estimates made by management, as well as evaluating the
overall financial statement presentation. We believe that our audits provide
a reasonable basis for our opinion.
    In our opinion, the financial statements and financial highlights
referred to above present fairly, in all material respects, the financial
position of Dreyfus BASIC U.S. Government Money Market Fund, at February 29,
1996, the results of its operations for the year then ended, the changes in
its net assets for each of the two years in the period then ended, and the
financial highlights for each of the indicated years, in conformity with
generally accepted accounting principles.
                              [Ernst & Young LLP signature logo]
New York, New York
March 29, 1996



                DREYFUS BASIC U.S. GOVERNMENT MONEY MARKET FUND


                           PART C. OTHER INFORMATION
                           _________________________


Item 24.   Financial Statements and Exhibits. - List
_______    _________________________________________

     (a)   Financial Statements:

                Included in Part A of the Registration Statement
   

                     Condensed Financial Information for the period from
                     April 24, 1992 (commencement of operations) to February
                     28, 1993 and for the three fiscal years ended February
                     28, 1995 and February 29, 1996.
    

                Included in Part B of the Registration Statement:
   

                     Statement of Investments--February 29, 1996.
    
   

                     Statement of Assets and Liabilities--February 29, 1996.
    
   

                     Statement of Operations--year ended February 29, 1996.
    
   

                     Statement of Changes in Net Assets--for each of the
                     years ended February 28, 1995 and February 29, 1996.
    

                     Notes to Financial Statements.
   

                     Report of Ernst & Young LLP, Independent Auditors, dated
                     March 29, 1996.

    





All Schedules and financial information, for which provision is made in the
applicable accounting regulations of the Securities and Exchange Commission,
are either omitted because they are not required under the related
instructions, they are inapplicable, or the required information is
presented in the financial statements or notes thereto which are included in
Part B of the Registration Statement.


Item 24.   Financial Statements and Exhibits. - List (continued)
_______    _____________________________________________________

  (b)      Exhibits:
   

  (1)      Amended and Restated Agreement and Declaration of Trust is
           incorporated by reference to Exhibit (1)(b) of Post-Effective
           Amendment No. 5 to the Registration Statement on Form N-1A, filed
           on May 20, 1994.
    
   

  (2)      Fund's By-Laws, as amended, are incorporated by reference to
           Exhibit (2) of Post-Effective Amendment No. 5 to the Registration
           Statement on Form N-1A, filed on May 20, 1994.
    

  (4)      Fund's Specimen Share certificate - Incorporated by reference to
           Exhibit (4) of Pre-Effective Amendment No. 1 to the Fund's
           Registration Statement on Form N-1A, filed on May 4, 1992.
   

  (5)      Management Agreement is incorporated by reference to Exhibit (5)
           of Post-Effective Amendment No. 6 to the Registration Statement on
           Form N-1A, filed on June 21, 1995.
    
   

  (6)(a)   Distribution Agreement is incorporated by reference to Exhibit
           (6)(a) of Post-Effective Amendment No. 6 to the Registration
           Statement on Form N-1A, filed on June 21, 1995.
    
   

  (6)(b)   Forms of Service Agreement are incorporated by reference to
           Exhibit (6)(b) of Post-Effective Amendment No. 5 to the
           Registration Statement on Form N-1A, filed on May 20, 1994.
    
   

  (8)      Custody Agreement is incorporated by reference to Exhibit (8)(a)
           of Post-Effective Amendment No. 5 to the Registration Statement on
           Form N-1A, filed on May 20, 1994.
    
   

  (9)      Shareholder Services Plan is incorporated by reference to Exhibit
           (9) of Post-Effective Amendment No. 6 to the Registration on Form
           N-1A, filed on June 21, 1995.
    
   

  (10)     Opinion and consent of Registrant's counsel.
    

  (11)     Consent of Ernst & Young LLP, Independent Auditors.
   
  (14)     Model Retirement Plan.
    
   
  (16)     Schedule of Computation of Performance Datais incorporated by
           reference to Exhibit (16) of Post-Effective Amendment No. 5 to the
           Registration Statement on Form N-1A, filed on May 20, 1994.
    
   

  (17)     Financial Data Schedule.

    

Item 24.   Financial Statements and Exhibits. - List (continued)
_______    _____________________________________________________

           Other Exhibits
           ______________

                (a)  Powers of Attorneyare incorporated by reference to
                     Item 24(a) of Post-Effective Amendment No. 5 to the
                     Registration Statement on Form N-1A, filed on
                     May 18, 1994.

                (b)  Certificate of Secretary are incorporated by reference to
                     Item 24(b) of Post-Effective Amendment No. 5 to the
                     Registration Statement on Form N-1A, filed on
                     May 18, 1994.

Item 25.   Persons Controlled by or under Common Control with Registrant.
_______    ______________________________________________________________

           Not Applicable

Item 26.   Number of Holders of Securities.
_______    ________________________________
   

                  (1)                            (2)

                                             Number of Record
               Title of Class                Holders as of June 21, 1996
               ______________                _____________________________

               Shares of Beneficial Interest           11,680
               (Par Value $.001)

    

Item 27.    Indemnification
_______     _______________

         Reference is made to Article EIGHTH Amended and Restated
         Declaration of Trust of the Fund, filed as Exhibit 1 to the Fund's
         Registration Statement filed under the Securities Act of 1933 on
         May 4, 1992.  The application of these provisions is limited by
         Article VIII of the Fund's By-Laws which were filed as Exhibit 2 to
         the Fund's Post-Effective Amendment No. 5 filed on May 20, 1994,
         and by the following undertaking set forth in the rules promulgated
         by the Securities and Exchange Commission.

 Item 27.    Indemnification (continued)
_______     _______________

            Insofar as indemnification for liabilities arising under the
            Securities Act of 1933 may be permitted to trustees, officers
            and controlling persons of the Registrant pursuant to the
            foregoing provisions, or otherwise, the Registrant has been
            advised that in the opinion of the Securities and Exchange
            Commission such indemnification is against public policy as
            expressed in such Act and is, therefore, unenforceable.  In the
            event that a claim for indemnification against such liabilities
            (other than the payment by the Registrant of expenses incurred
            or paid by a trustee, officer or controlling person of the
            Registrant in the successful defense of any action, suit or
            proceeding) is asserted by such director, officer or controlling
            person in connection with the securities being registered, the
            Registrant will, unless in the opinion of its counsel the matter
            has been settled by controlling precedent, submit to a court of
            appropriate jurisdiction the question whether such
            indemnification by it is against public policy as expressed in
            such Act and will be governed by the final adjudication of such
            issue.

         Reference is also made to the Distribution Agreement attached as
         Exhibit (6) hereto.

Item 28.    Business and Other Connections of Investment Adviser.
_______     ____________________________________________________

            The Dreyfus Corporation ("Dreyfus") and subsidiary companies
            comprise a financial service organization whose business
            consists primarily of providing investment management services
            as the investment adviser, manager and distributor for sponsored
            investment companies registered under the Investment Company Act
            of 1940 and as an investment adviser to institutional and
            individual accounts.  Dreyfus also serves as sub-investment
            adviser to and/or administrator of other investment companies.
            Dreyfus Service Corporation, a wholly-owned subsidiary of
            Dreyfus, serves primarily as a registered broker-dealer of
            shares of investment companies sponsored by Dreyfus and of other
            investment companies for which Dreyfus acts as investment
            adviser, sub-investment adviser or administrator.  Dreyfus
            Management, Inc., another wholly-owned subsidiary, provides
            investment management services to various pension plans,
            institutions and individuals.


(b)
                                                             Positions and
Name and principal        Positions and offices with         offices with
business address          the Distributor                    Registrant
__________________        ___________________________        _____________

Marie E. Connolly+        Director, President, Chief         President and
                          Executive Officer and Compliance   Treasurer
                          Officer

Joseph F. Tower, III+     Senior Vice President, Treasurer   Assistant
                          and Chief Financial Officer        Treasurer

John E. Pelletier+        Senior Vice President, General     Vice President
                          Counsel, Secretary and Clerk       and Secretary

Frederick C. Dey++        Senior Vice President              Vice President
                                                             and Assistant
                                                             Treasurer

Eric B. Fischman++        Vice President and Associate       Vice President
                          General Counsel                    and Assistant
                                                             Secretary

Paul Prescott+            Vice President                     None

Elizabeth Bachman++       Assistant Vice President           Vice President
                                                             and Assistant
                                                             Secretary

Mary Nelson+              Assistant Treasurer                None

John J. Pyburn++          Assistant Treasurer                Assistant
                                                             Treasurer

Jean M. O'Leary+          Assistant Secretary and            None
                          Assistant Clerk

John W. Gomez+            Director                           None

William J. Nutt+          Director                           None




________________________________
 +   Principal business address is One Exchange Place, Boston, Massachusetts
     02109.
++   Principal business address is 200 Park Avenue, New York, New York 10166.

 Item 30.    Location of Accounts and Records
            ________________________________

            1.  First Data Investor Services Group, Inc.,
                a subsidiary of First Data Corporation
                P.O. Box 9671
                Providence, Rhode Island 02940-9671

            2.  The Bank of New York
                90 Washington Street
                New York, New York 10286

            3.  Dreyfus Transfer, Inc.
                P.O. Box 9671
                Providence, Rhode Island 02940-9671

            4.  The Dreyfus Corporation
                200 Park Avenue
                New York, New York 10166

Item 31.    Management Services
_______     ___________________

            Not Applicable

Item 32.    Undertakings
________    ____________
   

  (1)       To call a meeting of shareholders for the purpose of voting upon
            the question of removal of a trustee or trustees when requested
            in writing to do so by the holders of at least 10% of the
            Registrant's outstanding shares of beneficial interest and in
            connection with such meeting to comply with the provisions of
            Section 16(c) of the Investment Company Act of 1940 relating to
            shareholder communications.
    

  (2)       To furnish each person to whom a prospectus is delivered with a
            copy of the Fund's latest Annual Report to Shareholders, upon
            request and without charge.

                                  SIGNATURES
                                ---------------

     Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933 and the
Investment Company Act of 1940, the Registrant certifies that it meets all of
the requirements for effectiveness of this Amendment to the Registration
Statement pursuant to Rule 485(b) under the Securities Act of 1933 and has duly
caused this Amendment to the Registration Statement to be signed on its behalf
by the undersigned, thereunto duly authorized, in the City of New York, and
State of New York on the 26th day of June, 1996.

                    DREYFUS BASIC U.S. GOVERNMENT MONEY MARKET FUND

            BY:     /s/Marie E. Connolly*
                    ___________________________________________
                    MARIE E. CONNOLLY, PRESIDENT

          Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Act of 1933, this
Amendment to the Registration Statement has been signed below by the following
persons in the capacities and on the dates indicated.

        Signatures                      Title                          Date
__________________________       _______________________________     _________

/s/Marie E. Connolly*            President and Treasurer             06/26/96
______________________________   (Principal Executive,
Marie E. Connolly                Financial and Accounting Officer)

/s/David W. Burke*               Trustee                             06/26/96
______________________________
David W. Burke

/s/Joseph S. DiMartino*          Trustee                             06/26/96
______________________________
Joseph S. DiMartino

/s/Diane Dunst*                  Trustee                             06/26/96
______________________________
Diane Dunst

/s/Rosalind Gersten Jacobs*      Trustee                             06/26/96
______________________________
Rosalind Gersten Jacobs

/s/Jay I. Meltzer*               Trustee                             06/26/96
______________________________
Jay I. Meltzer

/s/Daniel Rose*                  Trustee                             06/26/96
______________________________
Daniel Rose

/s/Warren B. Rudman*             Trustee                             06/26/96
______________________________
Warren B. Rudman

/s/Sander Vanocur*               Trustee                             06/26/96
______________________________
Sander Vanocur


*BY:      ______________________
          Eric B. Fischman,
          Attorney-in-Fact


 

              Dreyfus BASIC U.S. Government Money Market Fund


                                EXHIBIT INDEX


Exhibit No.

24(b)(10)                 Opinion and Consent of Registrant's Counsel

24(b)(11)                 Consent of Ernst & Young LLP

24(b)(14)                 Model Retirement Plan

24(b)(17)                 Financial Data Schedule

 





                    Stroock & Stroock & Lavan
                      Seven Hanover Square
                 New York, New York  10004-2594




                                                      EXHIBIT 10

April 30, 1992



Dreyfus BASIC U.S. Government Money Market Fund
144 Glenn Curtiss Boulevard
Uniondale, New York  11556-0144

Gentlemen:

We have acted as counsel to Dreyfus BASIC U.S. Government Money
Market Fund (the "Fund") in connection with the preparation of a
Registration Statement on Form N-1A, Registration No. 33-46503
(the "Registration Statement"), covering shares of beneficial
interest (the "Shares") of the Fund.

We have examined copies of the Agreement and Declaration of Trust
and By-Laws of the Fund, the Registration Statement and such
other documents, records, papers, statutes and authorities as we
deemed necessary to form a basis for the opinion hereinafter
expressed.  In our examination of such material, we have assumed
the genuineness of all signatures and the conformity to original
documents of all copies submitted to us.  As to various questions
of fact material to such opinion, we have relied upon statements
and certificates of officers and representatives of the Fund and
others.

Attorneys involved in the preparation of this opinion are
admitted only to the bar of the State of New York.  As to various
questions arising under the laws of the Commonwealth of
Massachusetts, we have relied on the opinion of Messrs. Ropes &
Gray, a copy of which is attached hereto.  Qualifications set
forth in their opinion are deemed incorporated herein.

Based upon the foregoing, we are of the opinion that the Shares
of the Fund to be issued in accordance with the terms of the
offering as set forth in the Prospectus included as part of the
Registration Statement, when so issued and paid for, will
constitute validly authorized and issued Shares, fully paid and
non-assessable by the Fund.

We hereby consent to the filing of this opinion as an exhibit to
the Registration Statement and to the reference to us in the
Prospectus included in the Registration Statement, and to the
filing of this opinion as an exhibit to any application made by
or on behalf of the Fund or any Distributor or dealer in
connection with the registration and qualification of the Fund or
its Shares under the securities laws of any state or
jurisdiction.  In giving such permission, we do not admit hereby
that we come within the category of persons whose consent is
required under Section 7 of the Securities Act of 1933 or the
rules and regulations of the Securities and Exchange Commission
thereunder.

Very truly yours,

/s/ Stroock & Stroock & Lavan

STROOCK & STROOCK & LAVAN
                           ROPES & GRAY
                     ONE INTERNATIONAL PLACE
                BOSTON, MASSACHUSETTS 02110-2624


                                   April 30, 1992




Stroock & Stroock & Lavan
Seven Hanover Square
New York, New York 10004

Gentlemen:

     We are furnishing this opinion in connection with the
proposed offer and sale from time to time by Dreyfus BASIC U.S.
Government Money Market Fund (the "Trust") of an indefinite
number of shares of beneficial interest (the "Shares") of the
Trust pursuant to the Trust's Registration Statement on Form N-1A
under the Securities Act of 1933, as amended.

     We are familiar with the action taken by the Trustees of the
Trust to authorize the issuance of the Shares.  We have examined
the Trust's records of Trustee action, its By-Laws and its
Agreement and Declaration of Trust, as amended to date, on file
at the office of the Secretary of State of The Commonwealth of
Massachusetts.  We have examined copies of such Registration
Statement in the form filed with the Securities and Exchange
Commission, and such other documents as we deem necessary for the
purposes of this opinion.

     We assume that, upon sale of the Shares, the Trust will
receive the net asset value thereof.  We also assume that, in
connection with any offer and sale of the Shares, the Trust will
take proper steps to effect compliance with applicable federal
and state laws regulating offerings and sales of securities.

     Based upon the foregoing, we are of the opinion that the
Trust is authorized to issue an unlimited number of Shares, and
that, when the Shares are issued and sold and the authorized
consideration therefor is received by the Trust, they will be
validly issued, fully paid and nonassessable by the Trust.

     The Trust is an entity of the type commonly known as a
"Massachusetts business trust".  Under Massachusetts law,
shareholders could, under certain circumstances, be held
personally liable for the obligations of the Trust.  However, the
Agreement and Declaration of Trust disclaims shareholder
liability for acts or obligations of the Trust and requires that
notice of such disclaimer be given in each agreement, obligation
or instrument entered into or executed by the Trust or the
Trustees.  The Agreement and Declaration of Trust provides for
indemnification out of the Trust property for all loss and
expense of any shareholder held personally liable for the
obligations of the Trust.  Thus, the risk of a shareholder
incurring financial loss on account of shareholder liability is
limited to circumstances in which the Trust itself would be
unable to meet its obligations.

     We consent to the filing of this opinion as an exhibit to
the aforesaid Registration Statement.

                                   Sincerely,

                                   /s/ Ropes & Gray

                                   Ropes & Gray












                    CONSENT OF INDEPENDENT AUDITORS


We consent to the reference to our firm under the captions "Condensed
Financial Information" and "Transfer and Dividend Disbursing Agent, Custodian,
Counsel and Independent Auditors" and to the use of our report dated March 29,
1996, in this Registration Statement (Form N-1A 33-46503) of Dreyfus BASIC U.S.
Government Money Market Fund.




                                               ERNST & YOUNG LLP


New York, New York
June 25, 1996



 


                                ADOPTION AGREEMENT
                            DREYFUS STANDARDIZED/PAIRED
                      PROTOTYPE MONEY PURCHASE PLAN AND TRUST

                                 PLAN NUMBER 01001
                            IRS SERIAL NUMBER D262551a


The Employer named in Section I.A. below hereby establishes or restates a Money
Purchase Plan ("Plan") and Trust, consisting of such sums as shall be paid to
the Trustee(s) under the Plan, the investments thereof and earnings thereon.
The terms of the Plan and Trust are set forth in this Adoption Agreement and
the applicable provisions of the Dreyfus Prototype Defined Contribution Plan,
Basic Plan Document No. 01, and the Dreyfus Trust Agreement, both as amended
from time to time, which are hereby adopted and incorporated herein by
reference.


I.  BASIC PROVISIONS

     A.   Employer's Name:           [....]

                   Address:          [....]

     B.   Employer is a ( ) corporation; ( ) S corporation;
          ( ) partnership; ( ) sole proprietor; ( ) other.

     C.   Employer's Tax ID Number:

     D.   Employer's fiscal year:       [....]

     E.   Plan Name:

     F.   If this is a new Plan, the Effective Date of the Plan:

          If this is an amendment and restatement of an existing Plan, enter
          the date originally adopted [....].  The effective date of this
          amended Plan is [....].

     G.   The Trustee shall be:

          ( )  The Dreyfus Trust Company

          ( )  Other:           (Name)     [....]
                          (Address)  [....]
                          (Address)  [....]
                          (Phone #)  [....]

     H.   Anniversary Date:

     I.   Plan Year shall mean the 12-consecutive-month period commencing on
          [....] and ending on [....].

     J.   Service with the following predecessor employer(s) shall be credited
          for purposes of vesting and eligibility:   [Note:  Such Service must
          be provided if the adopting Employer maintains the plan of the
          predecessor employer].

     K.   The following employer(s) associated with the Employer under Section
          414(b), (c), (m) or (o) of the Internal Revenue Code ("Code") shall
          be Participating Employers in the Plan:

     L.   Are all employers associated with the Employer under Section 414(b),
          (c), (m) or (o) of the Code participating in the Plan?

                     ( )  Yes ( )  No


II.  HOURS OF SERVICE

     Hours of Service under the Plan will be determined for all Employees on
     the basis of the method selected below:

     ( )  On the basis of actual hours for which an Employee is paid or
          entitled to payment.

     ( )  On the basis of days worked.  An Employee will be credited with ten
          (10) Hours of Service for any day such Employee would be credited
          with at least one (1) Hour of Service during the day under the Plan.

     ( )  On the basis of weeks worked.  An Employee will be credited with
          forty-five (45) Hours of Service for any week such Employee would be
          credited with at least one (1) Hour of Service during the week under
          the Plan.

     ( )  On the basis of semi-monthly payroll periods.  An Employee will be
          credited with ninety-five (95) Hours of Service for any semi-monthly
          payroll period such Employee would be credited with at least one (1)
          Hour of Service under the Plan.

     ( )  On the basis of months worked.  An Employee will be credited with one
          hundred ninety (190) Hours of Service for any month such Employee
          would be credited with at least one (1) Hour of Service under the
          Plan.

     ( )  On the basis of elapsed time.


III.  ELIGIBLE EMPLOYEES

     All Employees shall be Eligible Employees, except:

     ( )  Employees included in a unit of Employees covered by a collective
bargaining agreement between the Employer and employee representatives, if
retirement benefits were the subject of good faith bargaining.  For this
purpose, the term "employee representatives" does not include any organization
more than half of whose members are Employees who are owners, officers, or
executives of the Employer.

     ( )  Employees who are nonresident aliens and who receive no earned income
          from the Employer which constitutes income from sources within the
          United States.

Note:           The term Employee includes all employees of the Employer and any
                employer required to be aggregated with the Employer under
                Section 414(b), (c), (m) or (o) of the Code, and individuals
                considered employees of any such  employer under Section 414(n)
                or (o) of the Code.

          If the Employer adopts Sponsor's paired defined contribution plan
          number 01003, 01004 or 01006 or paired defined benefit plan number
          02001 in addition to this Plan, the definition of "Eligible Employee"
          in all paired plans of the Employer must be identical in order for
          the Employer to be able to designate  in Section XV one of the paired
          plans to provide the required minimum allocation to each Non-Key
          Employee in the event the Plan becomes Top-Heavy.  If the definition
          of "Eligible Employee" in all paired plans of the Employer is not
          identical, Section 13.1 through 13.4 shall apply in the event the
          Plan becomes Top-Heavy.



IV.  AGE AND SERVICE REQUIREMENTS

     Each Eligible Employee shall become a Participant on the Entry Date
     coincident with or following completion of the following age and service
     requirements:

     ( )  No age or service requirement.

     ( )  The attainment of age [....] (not to exceed age 21).

     ( )  The completion of [....] (not to exceed 1, unless 100% immediate
          vesting is elected, in which case may not exceed 2) Eligibility Years
          of Service.

Note:           If the Eligibility Years of Service is or includes a fractional
                year, an Employee may not be required to complete any specified
                number of Hours of Service to receive credit for such fractional
                year.


V.  ENTRY DATE

     The Entry Date shall mean:

     ( )  Annual Entry.  The first day of the Plan Year.  [Note:  If Annual
          Entry is selected, the age and service requirements cannot exceed
          20-1/2 and 1/2 Eligibility Year of Service.  (1-1/2 Eligibility
          Years of Service for Employer Discretionary Contributions if 100%
          immediate vesting is elected).]

     ( )  Dual Entry.  The first day of the Plan Year and the first day of the
          seventh month of the Plan Year.

     ( )  Quarterly Entry.  The first day of the Plan Year and the first day
          of the fourth, seventh and tenth months of the Plan Year.

     ( )  Monthly Entry.  The first day of the Plan Year and the first day of
          each following month of the Plan Year.


VI.  COMPENSATION

     A.   Except for purposes of "annual additions" testing under Section 415
          of the Code, Compensation shall mean all of each Participant's:

     ( )  Information required to be reported under Sections 6041, 6051, and
          6052 of the Code.  (Wages, tips and other compensation box on Form
          W-2) Compensation is defined as wages as defined in Section 3401(a)
          and all other payments of compensation to the Employee by the
          Employer (in the course of the Employer's trade or business) for
          which the Employer is required to furnish the Employee a written
          statement under Sections 6041(d) and 6051(a)(3) of the Code.
Compensation must be determined without regard to any rules under Section
3401(a) that limit the remuneration included in wages based on the nature or
location of the employment or services performed (such as the exception for
agricultural labor in Section 3401(a)(2) of the Code).  This definition of
Compensation shall exclude amounts paid or reimbursed by the Employer for
moving expenses incurred by an Employee, but only to the extent that at the
time of the payment it is reasonable to believe that these amounts are
deductible by the Employee under Section 217 of the Code.

     ( )  Section 3401(a) wages.  Compensation is defined as wages within the
          meaning of Section 3401(a) of the Code for purposes of income tax
          withholding at the source but determined without regard to any rules
          that limit the remuneration included in wages based on the nature or
          location of the employment or the services performed (such as the
          exception for agricultural labor in Section 3401(a)(2) of the Code).

     ( )  Section 415 safe-harbor compensation.  Compensation is defined as
          wages, salaries, and fees for professional services and other amounts
          received (without regard to whether or not an amount is paid in cash)
          for personal services actually rendered in the course of employment
          with the Employer to the extent that the amounts are includible in
          gross income (including, but not limited to, commissions paid
          salesmen, compensation for services on the basis of a percentage of
          profits, commissions on insurance premiums, tips, bonuses, fringe
          benefits, and reimbursements or other expense allowances under a non-
          accountable plan (as described in Section 1.62-2(c)), and excluding
          the following:

                (a)  Employer contributions to a plan of deferred compensation
                     which are not includible in the Employee's gross income for
                     the taxable year in which contributed, or Employer
                     contributions under a simplified employee pension plan
                     described in Section 408(k), or any distributions from a
                     plan of deferred compensation regardless of whether such
                     amounts are includible in the gross income of the Employee;

                (b)  Amounts realized from the exercise of a nonqualified stock
                     option, or when restricted stock (or property) held by the
                     Employee either becomes freely transferable or is no longer
                     subject to a substantial risk of forfeiture;


                (c)  Amounts realized from the sale, exchange or other
                     disposition of stock acquired under a qualified stock
                     option; and

                (d)  Other amounts which receive special tax benefits, such as
                     premiums for group-term life insurance (but only to the
                     extent that the premiums are not includible in the gross
                     income of the Employee), or contributions made by the
                     Employer (whether or not under a salary reduction
                     agreement) towards the purchase of an annuity contract
                     described in Section 403(b) of the Code (whether or not the
                     contributions are actually excludable from the gross income
                     of the Employee).

     which is actually paid to the Participant during the following applicable
period:

          ( )   the portion of the Plan Year in which the Employee is a
                Participant in the Plan.

          ( )   the Plan Year.

          ( )   the calendar year ending with or within the Plan Year.

          ( )   Compensation shall be reduced by all of the following items
                (even if includible in gross income): reimbursements or other
                expense allowances, fringe benefits (cash and noncash), moving
                expenses, deferred compensation and welfare benefits.

     Compensation ( ) shall; ( ) shall not include Employer contributions made
     pursuant to a salary reduction agreement with an Employee which are not
     includible in the gross income of the Employee by reason of Sections 125,
     402(e)(3), 402(h)(1)(B) or 403(b) of the Code.

     For any Self-Employed Individual covered under the Plan, Compensation
     means Earned Income.

     B.   For purposes of "annual additions" testing under Section 415 of the
          Code, Compensation for any Limitation Year shall mean all of each
          Participant's:

     ( )  Information required to be reported under Sections 6041, 6051, and
          6052 of the Code.  (Wages, tips and other compensation box on Form
          W-2) Compensation is defined as wages as defined in Section 3401(a)
          and all other payments of compensation to the Employee by the
          Employer (in the course of the Employer's trade or business) for
          which the Employer is required to furnish the Employee a written
          statement under Sections 6041(d) and 6051(a)(3) of the Code.
          Compensation must be determined without regard to any rules under
          Section 3401(a) that limit the remuneration included in wages based
          on the nature or location of the employment or services performed
          (such as the exception for agricultural labor in Section 3401(a)(2)
          of the Code).  This definition of Compensation shall exclude amounts
          paid or reimbursed by the Employer for moving expenses incurred by
          an Employee, but only to the extent that at the time of the payment
          it is reasonable to believe that these amounts are deductible by the
          Employee under Section 217 of the Code.

     ( )  Section 3401(a) wages.  Compensation is defined as wages within the
          meaning of Section 3401(a) of the Code for purposes of income tax
          withholding at the source but determined without regard to any rules
          that limit the remuneration included in wages based on the nature or
          location of the employment or the services performed (such as the
          exception for agricultural labor in Section 3401(a)(2) of the Code).

     ( )  Section 415 safe-harbor compensation.  Compensation is defined as
          wages, salaries, and fees for professional services and other amounts
          received (without regard to whether or not an amount is paid in cash)
          for personal services actually rendered in the course of employment
          with the Employer to the extent that the amounts are includible in
          gross income (including, but not limited to, commissions paid
          salesmen, compensation for services on the basis of a percentage of
          profits, commissions on insurance premiums, tips, bonuses, fringe
          benefits, and reimbursements or other expense allowances under a non
          -accountable plan (as described in Section 1.62-2(c)), and excluding
          the following:

          (a)   Employer contributions to a plan of deferred compensation which
                are not includible in the Employee's gross income for the
                taxable year in which contributed, or Employer contributions
                under a simplified employee pension plan described in Section
                408(k), or any distributions from a plan of deferred
                compensation regardless of whether such amounts are includible
                in the gross income of the Employee;

          (b)   Amounts realized from the exercise of a nonqualified stock
                option, or when restricted stock (or property) held by the
                Employee either becomes freely transferable or is no longer
                subject to a substantial risk of forfeiture;

          (c)   Amounts realized from the sale, exchange or other disposition
                of stock acquired under a qualified stock option; and

          (d)   Other amounts which receive special tax benefits, such as
                premiums for group-term life insurance (but only to the extent
                that the premiums are not includible in the gross income of the
                Employee), or contributions made by the Employer (whether or not
                under a salary reduction agreement) towards the purchase of an
                annuity contract described in Section 403(b) of the Code
                (whether or not the contributions are actually excludable from
                the gross income of the Employee).

     which is actually paid or includible in gross income during such
     Limitation Year.

     For any Self-Employed Individual covered under the Plan, Compensation
     means Earned Income.


VII.  LIMITATION YEAR

     Limitation Year shall mean the 12-consecutive-month period:

     ( )  Identical to the Plan Year.

     ( )  Identical to the Employer's fiscal year ending with or within the
          Plan Year of reference.

     ( )  As fixed by a resolution of the Board of Directors of the Employer,
          or the Employer if no Board of Directors exists.


VIII.  NORMAL RETIREMENT AGE

     Normal Retirement Age shall mean:

     ( )  Age [....] (not to exceed 65).

     ( )  Age [....] (not to exceed 65), or the [....] (not to exceed the 5th)
          anniversary of the date the Participant commenced participation in
          the Plan, if later.


IX.  EARLY RETIREMENT AGE

     Early Retirement Age shall mean:

     ( )  There shall be no early retirement provision in this Plan.

     ( )  Age [....].

     ( )  Age [....] and [....] Years of Service.


X.  EMPLOYER CONTRIBUTIONS

     A.   Employer Contribution

          [....]% of the aggregate Compensation of Active Participants for the
          Plan Year (not to exceed 25%).

          Employer Contributions ( ) shall; ( ) shall not be integrated with
          Social Security.

                The Permitted Disparity Percentage shall be [....]%.

                The Integration Level shall be:

                     ( ) the Taxable Wage Base.

                     ( ) $[....] (a dollar amount less than the Taxable Wage
                     Base).

                     ( ) [....]% (not to exceed 100% of the Taxable Wage Base).

          Note:  The Permitted Disparity Contribution Percentage cannot exceed
          the lesser of: (i) the base contribution or (ii) the greater of 5.7%
          or the tax rate under Section 3111 (a) of the Code attributable to
          the old age insurance portion of the Social Security Act (as in
          effect on the first day of the Plan Year).  If the Integration Level
          selected above is other than the Taxable Wage Base ("TWB"), the 5.7%
          factor in the preceding sentence must be replaced by the applicable
          percentage determined from the following table.

                If the Integration Level is:                    The
                                                     Applicable
                more than              but not more than             Factor is
                     $0              X*                        5.7%
                     X*              80% of TWB                4.3%
                     80% of TWB                 Y**            5.4%

                *X = the greater of $10,000 or 20% of TWB

                **Y = any amount more than 80% of TWB, but less than 100% of TWB

     B.   Forfeitures (Do not complete if 100% immediate vesting is elected).

          Forfeitures of Employer Contributions shall be:

          ( )   Used to reduce future Employer contributions.

          ( )   Allocated to the Regular Accounts of Participants eligible to
                receive Employer Contributions in accordance with Section 3.3
                of the Plan.


XI.  VESTING SERVICE - EXCLUSIONS

     All of an Employee's years of Service with the Employer shall be counted
     to determine the vested interest of such Employee except:

     ( )  Years of Service before age 18.

     ( )  Years of Service before the Employer maintained this Plan or a
          predecessor plan.

     ( )  Years of Service before the effective date of ERISA if such Service
          would have been disregarded under the Service Break rules of the
          prior plan in effect from time to time before such date.  For this
          purpose, Service Break rules are rules which result in the loss of
          prior vesting or benefit accruals, or deny an Employee's eligibility
          to participate by reason of separation or failure to complete a
          required period of Service within a specified period of time.
 XII.  VESTING SCHEDULES

     The vested interest of each Employee (who has an Hour of Service on or
     after January 1, 1989) in his Employer-derived account balance shall be
     determined on the basis of the following schedule:

     A.   Employer Contributions.

          ( )   100% immediately vested.  [Note:  Mandatory if more than 1
                Eligibility Year of Service is required.]

          ( )   100% immediately vested after [....] (not to exceed 5) years of
                Service.

          ( )   [....]% (not less than 20%) vested for each year of Service,
                beginning with the [....] (not more than the 3rd) year of
                Service until 100% vested.

          ( )   The Top Heavy Minimum Vesting Schedule selected in B., below.

          ( )   Other: [....] (Must be at least as favorable as any one of the
                above 4 options).

     B.   Top Heavy Minimum Vesting Schedules.

          One of the following schedules will be used for years when the Plan
          is or is deemed to be Top-Heavy.

          ( )   100% immediately vested after [....] (not to exceed 3) years of
                Service.

          ( )   20% vested after 2 years of Service, plus [....]% vested (not
                less than 20%) for each additional year of Service until 100%
                vested.

                If the vesting schedule under the Plan shifts in or out of the
                Minimum Schedule above for any Plan Year because of the Plan's
                Top-Heavy status, such shift is an amendment to the vesting
                schedule and the election in Section 7.3 of the Plan applies.


 XIII.  LIFE INSURANCE

     Life insurance ( ) shall; ( ) shall not be a permissible investment.


XIV.  LOANS

     Loans ( ) shall; ( ) shall not be permitted.


XV.  TOP-HEAVY PROVISIONS

     A.   Top Heavy Status

          ( )   The provisions of Article XIII of the Plan shall always apply.

          ( )   The provisions of Article XIII of the Plan shall only apply in
                Plan Years after 1983, during which the Plan is or becomes
                Top-Heavy.

     B.   Minimum Allocation

          If the Employer has adopted Sponsor's paired defined contribution
          plan number 01003, 01004 or 01006 in addition to this Plan and the
          definition of "Eligible Employee" on all paired plans is identical,
          then the minimum allocation required by Section 13.3 will be provided
          ( ) under this Plan; (  ) under such other paired defined
          contribution plan.  If the Employer has adopted Sponsor's paired
          defined benefit plan number 02001, then Participants in this Plan (or
          another paired defined contribution plan) who are covered under the
          paired defined benefit plan shall receive the minimum Top Heavy
          benefit under the paired defined benefit plan and shall receive no
          minimum allocation.

          If a Participant in this Plan who is a Non-Key Employee is covered
          under another qualified plan maintained by the Employer, other than
          a paired plan of the Sponsor, the minimum Top Heavy allocation or
          benefit required under Section 416 of the Code shall be provided to
          such Non-Key Employee under:

          ( ) this Plan.

          ( ) the Employer's other qualified defined contribution plan.

          ( ) the Employer's qualified defined benefit plan.

          ( ) other:  ---------------------------------------

              -----------------------------------------------
                                                                            .

     C.   Determination of Present Value

          If the Employer maintains a defined benefit plan in addition to this
          Plan, and such plan fails to specify the interest rate and mortality
          table to be used for purposes of establishing present value to
          compute the Top-Heavy Ratio, then the following assumptions shall be
          used:

          Interest Rate [....]%   Mortality Table [....]


XVI. LIMITATION ON ALLOCATIONS

     If the Employer maintains or has ever maintained another qualified plan
     (other than the Sponsor's paired defined contribution plan number 01003,
     01004, or 01006 or the Sponsor's paired defined benefit plan number
     02001), in which any Participant in this Plan is (or was) a Participant
     or could possibly become a Participant, the adopting Employer must
     complete this Section.  The Employer must also complete this Section if
     it maintains a welfare benefit fund, as defined in Section 419(e) of the
     Code, or an individual medical account, as defined in Section 415(l)(2)
     of the Code, under which amounts are treated as Annual Additions with
     respect to any Participant in the Plan.  (If the Employer maintains only
     paired plans of the Sponsor this Section should not be completed.)

     (a)  If the Participant is covered under another qualified defined
          contribution plan maintained by the Employer, other than a Master or
          Prototype Plan, Annual Additions for any Limitation Year shall be
          limited to comply with Section 415(c) of the Code:

          ( )   in accordance with Sections 6.4(e) - (j) as though the other
                plan were a Master or Prototype Plan.

          ( )   by freezing or reducing Annual Additions in the other qualified
                defined contribution plan.

          ( )   other:----------------------------------------------------------



                ----------------------------------------------------------------



     (b)  If a Participant is or has ever been participant in a qualified
          defined benefit plan maintained by the Employer, the "1.0" aggregate
          limitation of Section 415(e) of the Code shall be satisfied by:

          ( )   freezing or reducing the rate of benefit accrual under the
                qualified defined benefit plan.

          ( )   freezing or reducing the Annual Additions under this Plan (or,
                if the Employer maintains more than one qualified defined
                contribution plan, as indicated in (a) above.

          ( )   other:--------------------------------------------------------


                --------------------------------------------------------------



XVII.  INVESTMENTS

     Participants ( ) shall; ( ) shall not be permitted to direct the
     investment of their Accounts in the investment options selected by the
     Employer or the Committee.


XVIII.  EMPLOYER REPRESENTATIONS

     The Employer hereby represents that:

          a.    It is aware of, and agrees to be bound by, the terms of the
                Plan.

          b.    It understands that the Sponsor will not furnish legal or tax
                advice in connection with the adoption or operation of the Plan
                and has consulted legal and tax counsel to the extent necessary.

          c.    The failure to properly fill out this Adoption Agreement may
                result in disqualification of the Plan.


XIX.  RELIANCE ON PLAN QUALIFICATION

     An Employer who has ever maintained or who later adopts any plan
     (including, after December 31, 1985, a welfare benefit fund, as defined
     in Section 419(e) of the Internal Revenue Code, which provides
     post-retirement medical benefits allocated to separate accounts for Key
     Employees, as defined in Section 419A(d)(3) of the Code, or an individual
     medical account, as defined in Section 415(l)(2) of the Code) in addition
     to this Plan (other than the Sponsor's paired defined contribution plan
     number 01003, 01004, 01005, or 01006 or the Sponsor's paired defined
     benefit plan number 02001) may not rely on the opinion letter issued by
     the National Office of the Internal Revenue Service as evidence that this
     Plan is qualified under Section 401 of the Code.  If an Employer who
     adopts or maintains multiple plans wishes to obtain reliance that his or
     her plans are qualified, application for a determination letter should be
     made to the appropriate key district office of the Internal Revenue
     Service.

     The Employer may not rely on the opinion letter issued by the National
     Office of the Internal Revenue Service as evidence that this Plan is
     qualified under Section 401 of the Code unless the terms of the Plan, as
     herein adopted or amended, that pertain to the requirements of Sections
     401(a)(4), 401(a)(17), 401(l), 401(a)(5), 410(b) and 414(s) of the Code,
     as amended by the Tax Reform Act of 1986, or later laws, (a) are made
     effective with respect to this Plan); or (b) are made effective no later
     than the first day on which the Employer is no longer entitled, under
     regulations, to rely on a reasonable, good faith interpretation of these
     requirements, and the prior provisions of the Plan constitute such a
     interpretation.


XX.  PROTOTYPE PLAN DOCUMENTS

     This Adoption Agreement may be used only in conjunction with the Dreyfus
     Prototype Defined Contribution Plan, Basic Plan Document No. 01, and the
     Dreyfus Trust Agreement both as amended from time to time.  In the event
     the Sponsor amends the Basic Plan Document or this Adoption Agreement or
     discontinues this type of plan, it will inform the Employer.  The Sponsor,
     The Dreyfus Corporation, is available to answer questions regarding the
     intended meaning of any Plan provisions, adoption of he Plan and the
     effect of an Opinion Letter, at 144 Glenn Curtiss Boulevard, Uniondale,
     New York  11556-0144 [(516) 338-3418].
 IN WITNESS WHEREOF, the Employer and the Trustee have executed this instrument
the  ________  day of __________, 19__.  If applicable, the appropriate
corporate seal has been affixed and attested to.

                          -----------------------

                          Name of Business Entity


                          ---------------------------------

                          Signature (Sole Proprietors only)


                          By: --------------------------------------
                                      ------------
                                                           Name and Title
(Corporations or Partnerships)


ATTEST:

____________________________
Secretary (Corporations only)




SEAL:


                          __________________
                          Name of Trustee(s)


                          _____________________________

                          Signature (Individual Trustee)


                          _____________________________

                          Signature (Individual Trustee)


                          By:______________________________________

                             Name and Title (Corporate Trustee only)





                              ADOPTION AGREEMENT
                            DREYFUS NONSTANDARDIZED
                    PROTOTYPE PROFIT SHARING PLAN AND TRUST

                               PLAN NUMBER 01002
                          IRS SERIAL NUMBER D362552a

The Employer named in Section I.A. below hereby establishes or restates a
Profit Sharing Plan ("Plan") and Trust, consisting of such sums as shall be
paid to the Trustee(s) under the Plan, the investments thereof and earnings
thereon.  The terms of the Plan and Trust are set forth in this Adoption
Agreement and the applicable provisions of the Dreyfus Prototype Defined
Contribution Plan, Basic Plan Document No. 01, and the Dreyfus Trust
Agreement, both as amended from time to time, which are hereby adopted and
incorporated herein by reference.


I.   BASIC PROVISIONS

     A.   Employer's Name:         [....]

          Address:            [....]

     B.   Employer is a ( ) corporation; ( ) S Corporation;
          ( ) partnership; ( ) sole proprietor;
          ( ) other: [....]

     C.   Employer's Tax ID Number:

     D.   Employer's fiscal year:

     E.   Plan Name:

     F.   If this is a new Plan, the Effective Date of the Plan is:

          If this is an amendment and restatement of an existing Plan, enter
          the  original Effective Date [....].  The effective date of this
          amended Plan is [....].


      G.   The Trustee shall be:

          ( ) The Dreyfus Trust Company

          ( ) Other:     (Name)    [....]
                    (Address) [....]
                    (Address) [....]
                    (Phone #) [....]

     H.   The first Plan Year shall be [....] through [....].  Thereafter,
          the Plan Year shall mean the 12-consecutive-month period
          commencing on [....] and ending on [....].

     I.   Service with the following predecessor employer(s):

          shall be credited for purposes of: [ ] eligibility; [ ] vesting.

          Note: Such Service must be credited if the adopting Employer
          maintains the plan of the predecessor employer.

     J.   The following employer(s) aggregated with the Employer under
          Sections 414(b), (c), (m) or (o) of the Internal Revenue Code
          ("Code") shall be Participating Employers in the Plan: [....]

     K.   Are all employers aggregated with the Employer under Sections
          414(b), (c), (m) or (o) of the Code participating in this Plan?

                    ( ) Yes      ( ) No


II.  HOURS OF SERVICE

     A. For Eligibility Purposes.

     Hours of Service under the Plan will be determined for all Employees on
     the basis of the method selected below:

     ( )  On the basis of actual hours for which an Employee is paid or
          entitled to payment.

     ( )  On the basis of days worked.  An Employee will be credited with
          ten (10) Hours of Service for any day such Employee would be
          credited with at least one (1) Hour of Service during the day
          under the Plan.

     ( )  On the basis of weeks worked.  An Employee will be credited with
          forty-five (45) Hours of Service for any week such Employee would
          be credited with at least one (1) Hour of Service during the week
          under the Plan.

     ( )  On the basis of semi-monthly payroll periods.  An Employee will be
          credited with ninety-five (95) Hours of Service for any
          semi-monthly payroll period such Employee would be credited with
          at least one (1) Hour of Service under the Plan.

     ( )  On the basis of months worked.  An Employee will be credited with
          one hundred ninety (190) Hours of Service for any month such
          Employee would be credited with at least one (1) Hour of Service
          under the Plan.

     ( )  On the basis of elapsed time.

     B. For Vesting Purposes.

     Hours of Service under the Plan will be determined for all Employees on
     the basis of the method selected below:

     ( )  On the basis of actual hours for which an Employee is paid or
          entitled to payment.

     ( )  On the basis of days worked.  An Employee will be credited with
          ten (10) Hours of Service for any day such Employee would be
          credited with at least one (1) Hour of Service during the day
          under the Plan.

     ( )  On the basis of weeks worked.  An Employee will be credited with
          forty-five (45) Hours of Service for any week such Employee would
          be credited with at least one (1) Hour of Service during the week
          under the Plan.

     ( )  On the basis of semi-monthly payroll periods.  An Employee will be
          credited with ninety-five (95) Hours of Service for any
          semi-monthly payroll period such Employee would be credited with
          at least one (1) Hour of Service under the Plan.

     ( )  On the basis of months worked.  An Employee will be credited with
          one hundred ninety (190) Hours of Service for any month such
          Employee would be credited with at least one (1) Hour of Service
          under the Plan.

     ( )  On the basis of elapsed time.


III. ELIGIBLE EMPLOYEES

     All Employees shall be Eligible Employees, except:

     ( )  Employees included in a unit of Employees covered by a collective
          bargaining agreement between the Employer and employee
          representatives, if retirement benefits were the subject of good
          faith bargaining.  For this purpose, the term "employee
          representatives" does not include any organization more than half
          of whose members are Employees who are owners, officers, or
          executives of the Employer.

     ( )  Employees who are nonresident aliens and who receive no earned
          income from the Employer which constitutes income from sources
          within the United States.

     ( )  Employees included in the following classification(s):

     ( )  Employees of the following employers aggregated with the Employer
          under Sections 414(b), (c), (m) or (o) of the Code:

     ( )  Individuals required to be considered Employees under Section
          414(n) of the Code.

     ( )  Employees who, subject to determination by the Committee that such
          election will not affect the plan's qualification, make a one-time
          irrevocable election not to participate in the Plan for purposes
          of the following:

          [ ]  Employer Discretionary Contributions.

          [ ]  Elective Deferrals/Thrift Contributions/Combined
               Contributions.

     Note:     The term Employee includes all employees of the Employer and
               any employer required to be aggregated with the Employer
               under Sections 414(b), (c), (m) or (o) of the Code, and
               individuals considered employees of any such employer under
               Section 414(n) or (o) of the Code.

IV.  AGE AND SERVICE REQUIREMENTS

     Each Eligible Employee shall become a Participant on the Entry Date
     coincident with or following completion of the following requirements:

     Age:      ( )  No age requirement.

               ( )  The attainment of age [....] (not to exceed age 21).

     Service:  ( )   No service requirement.

               ( )  For Employer Discretionary Contributions only -- The
                    completion of [....] (not to exceed 1 unless 100%
                    immediate vesting is elected, in which case, may not
                    exceed 2)  Eligibility Years of Service. If the
                    Eligibility Years of Service is or includes a fractional
                    year, an Employee shall not be required to complete any
                    specific number of Hours of Service to receive credit
                    for such fractional year.

               If more than 1 Eligibility Year of Service is required,
               Participants must be 100% immediately vested.

               ( )  For all other contributions -- The completion of [....]
                    (not to exceed 1) Eligibility Year of Service.

                              AND

     Effective
     Date:          ( )  Each Eligible Employee who is employed on the
                         Effective Date shall become a Participant on the
                         Effective Date.  Each Eligible Employee employed
                         after the Effective Date shall become a Participant
                         on the Entry Date coincident with or following
                         completion of the age and service requirements
                         specified above.

               ( )  Each Eligible Employee who is employed on the effective
                    date of this amended plan shall become a Participant as
                    of such date.  Each Eligible Employee employed after the
                    effective date shall become a Participant on the entry
                    date coincident with or following completion of the age
                    and service requirements specified above.
 V.   ELIGIBILITY YEARS OF SERVICE

     A.   For Employer Discretionary Contributions, in order to be credited
          with an Eligibility Year of Service, an Employee shall complete
          [....] (not to exceed 1,000) Hours of Service.

          Note: Not applicable if elapsed time method of crediting service
          for eligibility purposes is elected.

     B.   For all other contributions, in order to be credited with an
          Eligibility Year of Service, an Employee shall complete [....]
          (not to exceed 1,000) Hours of Service.

          Note: Not applicable if elapsed time method of crediting service
          for eligibility purposes is elected.

          Note: In the case of an Employee in the Maritime Industry, for
          purposes of Eligibility Years of Service, refer to Section 1.24 of
          the Plan.


VI.  ENTRY DATE

     The Entry Date shall mean:

     ( )  For the first Plan Year only, the initial Entry Date shall be_____


          _______;

     thereafter:

     ( )  Annual Entry.  The first day of the Plan Year. [Note:  If Annual
          Entry is selected, the age and service requirements cannot exceed
          20-1/2 and 1/2 Eligibility Year of Service.]

     ( )  Dual Entry.  The first day of the Plan Year and the first day of
          the seventh month of the Plan Year.

     ( )  Quarterly Entry.  The first day of the Plan Year and the first day
          of the fourth, seventh and tenth months of the Plan Year.

     ( )  Monthly Entry.  The first day of the Plan Year and the first day
          of each following month of the Plan Year.

     ( )  Other: _________________________________________________________

         ___________(Note: Eligible Employees must commence
     participation no later than the earlier of:  a) the beginning of the
     Plan Year after meeting the age and service requirements, or b) 6
     months after the date the Employee meets the age and service
     requirements).


VII. COMPENSATION

     A.   Except for purposes of "annual additions" testing under Section
          415 of the Code, Compensation shall mean all of each
          Participant's:

     ( )  Information required to be reported under Sections 6041, 6051, and
          6052 of the Code.  (Wages, tips and other compensation box on Form
          W-2) Compensation is defined as wages as defined in Section
          3401(a) and all other payments of compensation to the Employee by
          the Employer (in the course of the Employer's trade or business)
          for which the Employer is required to furnish the Employee a
          written statement under Sections 6041(d) and 6051(a)(3) of the
          Code.  Compensation must be determined without regard to any rules
          under Section 3401(a) that limit the remuneration included in
          wages based on the nature or location of the employment or
          services performed (such as the exception for agricultural labor
          in Section 3401(a)(2) of the Code).  This definition of
          Compensation shall exclude amounts paid or reimbursed by the
          Employer for moving expenses incurred by an Employee, but only to
          the extent that at the time of the payment it is reasonable to
          believe that these amounts are deductible by the Employee under
          Section 217 of the Code.

     ( )  Section 3401(a) wages.  Compensation is defined as wages within
          the meaning of Section 3401(a) of the Code for purposes of income
          tax withholding at the source but determined without regard to any
          rules that limit the remuneration included in wages based on the
          nature or location of the employment or the services performed
          (such as the exception for agricultural labor in Section
          3401(a)(2) of the Code).

     ( )  Section 415 safe-harbor compensation.  Compensation is defined as
          wages, salaries, and fees for professional services and other
          amounts received (without regard to whether or not an amount is
          paid in cash) for personal services actually rendered in the
          course of employment with the Employer to the extent that the
          amounts are includible in gross income (including, but not limited
          to, commissions paid salesmen, compensation for services on the
          basis of a percentage of profits, commissions on insurance
          premiums, tips, bonuses, fringe benefits, and reimbursements or
          other expense allowances under a nonaccountable plan (as described
          in Section 1.62-2(c)), and excluding the following:

          (a)  Employer contributions to a plan of deferred compensation
               which are not includible in the Employee's gross income for
               the taxable year in which contributed, or Employer
               contributions under a simplified employee pension plan
               described in Section 408(k), or any distributions from a plan
               of deferred compensation regardless of whether such amounts
               are includible in the gross income of the Employee;

          (b)  Amounts realized from the exercise of a nonqualified stock
               option, or when restricted stock (or property) held by the
               Employee either becomes freely transferable or is no longer
               subject to a substantial risk of forfeiture;

          (c)  Amounts realized from the sale, exchange or other disposition
               of stock acquired under a qualified stock option; and

          (d)  Other amounts which receive special tax benefits, such as
               premiums for group-term life insurance (but only to the
               extent that the premiums are not includible in the gross
               income of the Employee), or contributions made by the
               Employer (whether or not under a salary reduction agreement)
               towards the purchase of an annuity contract described in
               Section 403(b) of the Code (whether or not the contributions
               are actually excludable from the gross income of the
               Employee).

     which is actually paid to the Participant during  the following
     applicable period:

          ( )  the portion of the Plan Year in which the Employee is a
               Participant in the Plan.

          ( )  the Plan Year.

          ( )  the calendar year ending with or within the Plan Year.

     ( )  Compensation shall be reduced by all of the following items (even
          if includible in gross income):  reimbursements or other expense
          allowances, fringe benefits (cash and noncash), moving expenses,
          deferred compensation and welfare benefits.

     Compensation ( ) shall; ( ) shall not include Employer contributions
     made pursuant to a salary reduction agreement with an Employee which
     are not includible in the gross income of the Employee by reason of
     Sections 125, 402(e)(3), 402(h)(1)(B) or 403(b) of the Code.

     If the Employer's contributions to the Plan are not allocated on an
     integrated basis, the following may be excluded from the definition of
     Compensation selected above for any year in which the Plan is not Top
     Heavy:

          ( )  bonuses

          ( )  overtime

          ( )  commissions

          ( )  amounts in excess of $ [....]

          ( )  [....]

     For any Self-Employed Individual covered under the Plan, Compensation
     means Earned Income.

     B.   For purposes of "annual additions" testing under Section 415 of
          the Code, Compensation for any Limitation Year shall mean all of
          each Participant's:

     ( )  Information required to be reported under Sections 6041, 6051 and
          6052 of the Code.  (Wages, tips and other compensation box on Form
          W-2) Compensation is defined as wages as defined in Section
          3401(a) and all other payments of compensation to the Employee by
          the Employer (in the course of the Employer's trade or business)
          for which the Employer is required to furnish the Employee a
          written statement under Sections 6041(d) and 6051(a)(3) of the
          Code.  Compensation must be determined without regard to any rules
          under Section 3401(a) that limit the remuneration included in
          wages based on the nature or location of the employment or
          services performed (such as the exception for agricultural labor
          in Section 3401(a)(2) of the Code).  This definition of
          Compensation shall exclude amounts paid or reimbursed by the
          Employer for moving expenses incurred by an Employee, but only to
          the extent that at the time of the payment it is reasonable to
          believe that these amounts are deductible by the Employee under
          Section 217 of the Code.

     ( )  Section 3401(a) wages.  Compensation is defined as wages within
          the meaning of Section 3401(a) of the Code for purposes of income
          tax withholding at the source but determined without regard to any
          rules that limit the remuneration included in wages based on the
          nature or location of the employment or the services performed
          (such as the exception for agricultural labor in Section
          3401(a)(2) of the Code).

     ( )  Section 415 safe-harbor compensation.  Compensation is defined as
          wages, salaries, and fees for professional services and other
          amounts received (without regard to whether or not an amount is
          paid in cash) for personal services actually rendered in the
          course of employment with the Employer to the extent that the
          amounts are includible in gross income (including, but not limited
          to, commissions paid salesmen, compensation for services on the
          basis of a percentage of profits, commissions on insurance
          premiums, tips, bonuses, fringe benefits, and reimbursements or
          other expense allowances under a nonaccountable plan (as described
          in Section 1.62-2(c)), and excluding the following:

          (a)  Employer contributions to a plan of deferred compensation
               which are not includible in the Employee's gross income for
               the taxable year in which contributed, or Employer
               contributions under a simplified employee pension plan
               described in Section 408(k), or any distributions from a plan
               of deferred compensation regardless of whether such amounts
               are includible in the gross income of the Employee;

          (b)  Amounts realized from the exercise of a nonqualified stock
               option, or when restricted stock (or property) held by the
               Employee either becomes freely transferable or is no longer
               subject to a substantial risk of forfeiture;

          (c)  Amounts realized from the sale, exchange or other disposition
               of stock acquired under a qualified stock option; and

          (d)  Other amounts which receive special tax benefits, such as
               premiums for group-term life insurance (but only to the
               extent that the premiums are not includible in the gross
               income of the Employee), or contributions made by the
               Employer (whether or not under a salary reduction agreement)
               towards the purchase of an annuity contract described in
               Section 403(b) of the Code (whether or not the contributions
               are actually excludable from the gross income of the
               Employee).

     which is actually paid or includible in gross income during such
     Limitation Year.

     For any Self-Employed Individual covered under the Plan, Compensation
     means Earned Income.


VIII.     LIMITATION YEAR

     Limitation Year shall mean the twelve (12) consecutive-month period:

     ( )  Identical to the Plan Year.

     ( )  Identical to the Employer's fiscal year ending with or within the
          Plan Year of reference.

     ( )  As fixed by a resolution of the Board of Directors of the
          Employer, or the Employer if no Board of Directors exists.


IX.  NORMAL RETIREMENT AGE

     Normal Retirement Age shall mean:

     ( )  Age [....] (not to exceed 65).

     ( )  Age [....] (not to exceed 65), or the [....] (not to exceed the
          5th) anniversary of the date the Participant commenced
          participation in the Plan, if later.


X.   EARLY RETIREMENT AGE

     Early Retirement Age shall mean:

     ( )  There shall be no early retirement provision in this Plan.

     ( )  Age [....].

     ( )  Age [....] and [....] Years of Service.



XI.  EMPLOYER AND EMPLOYEE CONTRIBUTIONS

     A.   Types and allocation of Contributions

          1.   Employer Discretionary Contributions

               ( )  Not permitted.

               ( )  Permitted.

                    ( )  An amount fixed by appropriate action of the
                         Employer.

                    ( )  [....]% of Compensation of Participants for the
                         Plan Year (not to exceed 15%).

                    ( )  [....]% of Compensation of Participants for the
                         Plan Year, plus an additional amount fixed by
                         appropriate action of the Employer (in total not to
                         exceed 15%).

               Employer Discretionary Contributions ( ) shall; ( ) shall not
               be integrated with Social Security.

                    If integrated with Social Security:

                    a.   ( )  The Permitted Disparity Percentage shall be
                              [....]%.

                    b.   ( )  The Permitted Disparity Percentage shall be
                              determined annually by appropriate action of
                              the Employer.

                    c.   ( )  The Integration Level shall be:

                              ( )  the Taxable Wage Base.

                              ( )  $____________(a dollar amount less than
                                   the Taxable Wage Base).

                              ( )  ___% (not to exceed 100% of the Taxable
                                   Wage Base).

                    Note:     The Permitted Disparity Percentage cannot
                              exceed the lesser of: (i) the base
                              contribution, or (ii) the greater of 5.7% or
                              the tax rate under Section 3111(a) of the Code
                              attributable to the old age insurance portion
                              of the Old Age, Survivors and Disability
                              Income provisions of the Social Security Act
                              (as in effect on the first day of the Plan
                              Year).  If the Integration Level selected
                              above is other than the Taxable Wage Base
                              ("TWB"), the 5.7% factor in the preceding
                              sentence must be replaced by the applicable
                              percentage determined from the following
                              table.


                         If the Integration Level is:
                         ____________________________
                                                  The Applicable
                         more than but not more than   Factor is
                         _______________________________________
                         $0             X*             5.7%
                         X*             80% of TWB     4.3%
                         80% of TWB     Y**            5.4%

                         *X = the greater of $10,000 or 20% of TWB

                         **Y = any amount more than 80% of TWB, but less
                               than 100% of TWB

          Allocation of Employer Discretionary Contributions.

               In order to share in the allocation of Employer Discretionary
               Contributions (and forfeitures, if forfeitures are
               reallocated to Participants) an Active Participant:

               ( )  Need not be employed on the last day of the Plan Year.

               ( )  Must be employed on the last day of the Plan Year,
                    unless the Participant terminates employment on account
                    of:

                    ( )  Death.

                    ( )  Disability.

                    ( )  Attainment of Early Retirement Age.

                    ( )  Attainment of Normal Retirement Age.

                    ( )  Employer approved leave of absence.

               ( )  Must have ( ) 501 Hours of Service; ( ) [....] Hours of
                    Service (cannot exceed 1,000). (Note: Not applicable if
                    elapsed time method of crediting service is elected.

          2.   Elective Deferrals

               ( )  Not permitted.

               ( )  Permitted.

               A Participant may elect to have his or her Compensation
               reduced by:

               ( )  An amount not in excess of [....]% of Compensation
                    [cannot exceed the dollar limitation of Section 402(g)
                    of the Code for the calendar year].
               ( )  An amount not in excess of $[....] of Compensation
                    [cannot exceed the dollar limitation of Section 402(g)
                    of the Code for the calendar year].

               ( )  An amount not to exceed the dollar limitation of Section
                    402(g) of the Code for the calendar year.

               ( )  An amount not in excess of (Note: The percent for the
                    Highly Compensated Employee cannot exceed the percent
                    for the Non-Highly Compensated Employee):

                         _______% of Compensation [cannot exceed the dollar
                         limitation of Section 402(g) of the Code for the
                         calendar year] for each Highly Compensated
                         Employee; and

                         ________% of Compensation [cannot exceed the dollar
                         limitation of Section 402(g) of the Code for the
                         calendar year] for each Non-Highly Compensated
                         Employee.

               A Participant may elect to commence Elective Deferrals the
               next pay period following: [....] (enter date or period -- at
               least once each calendar year).

               A Participant may modify the amount of Elective Deferrals as
               of [....] (enter date or period -- at least once each
               calendar year).

               A Participant ( ) may; ( ) may not base Elective Deferrals on
               cash bonuses that, at the Participant's election, may be
               contributed to the CODA or received by the Participant in
               cash.  Such election shall be effective as of the next pay
               period following [....] or as soon as administratively
               feasible thereafter.

               Participants who claim Excess Elective Deferrals for the
               preceding calendar year must submit their claims in writing
               to the plan administrator by [....] (enter date between March
               1 and April 15).

               A Participant ( ) may; ( ) may not elect to recharacterize
               Excess Contributions as Thrift Contributions.  (Note:
               Available only if Thrift Contributions are permitted.)

               Participants who elect to recharacterize Excess Contributions
               for the preceding Plan Year as Thrift Contributions must
               submit their elections in writing to the Committee by [....]
               (enter date no later than 2-1/2 months after close of Plan
               Year).

          3.   Thrift Contributions

               ( )  Not permitted.
               ( )  Permitted.

                    Participants shall be permitted to make Thrift
                    Contributions from [....]% (not less than 1) to [....]%
                    (not more than 10) of their total aggregate
                    Compensation.

                    A Participant may elect to commence Thrift Contributions
                    the next pay period following [....] (enter date or
                    period--at least once each calendar year).

                    The Change Date for a Participant to modify the amount
                    of Thrift Contributions shall be as of [....] (enter
                    date or period -- at least once each calendar year).

          4.   Elective Deferrals and Thrift Contributions, combined
               ("Combined Contributions")

               ( )  Not Permitted.

               ( )  Permitted.

                    A Participant may elect to make Combined Contributions
                    which do not exceed [....]% of Compensation.  (Note:
                    Elective Deferrals can not exceed the dollar limitation
                    of Section 402(g) of the Code for the calendar year).

                    A Participant may elect to commence contributions the
                    next pay period following: (enter date or period -- at
                    least once each calendar year).

                    A  Participant may modify his amount  of Combined
                    Contributions as of [....] (enter date or period -- at
                    least once each calendar year).

                    A Participant ( ) may; ( ) may not base Elective
                    Deferrals on cash bonuses that, at the Participant's
                    election, may be contributed to the CODA or received by
                    the Participant in cash.  Such election shall be
                    effective as of the next pay period following [....] or
                    as soon as administratively feasible thereafter.

                    Participants who claim Excess Elective Deferrals for the
                    preceding calendar year must submit their claims in
                    writing to the plan administrator by [....] (enter date
                    between March 1 and April 15).

                    A Participant ( ) may; ( ) may not elect to
                    recharacterize Excess Contributions as Thrift
                    Contributions.

                    Participants who elect to recharacterize Excess
                    Contributions for the preceding Plan Year as Thrift
                    Contributions must submit their elections in writing to
                    the Committee by [....] (enter date no later than 2-1/2
                    months after close of the Plan Year).

          5.   Matching Contributions

               ( )  Not permitted.

               ( )  Permitted.

                    ( )  The Employer shall or may (in the event that the
                         Matching Contribution amount is within the
                         discretion of the Employer) make Matching
                         Contributions to the Plan with respect to (any one
                         or a combination of the following may be selected):

                         ( )  Elective Deferrals.

                         ( )  Thrift Contributions.

                         ( )  Combined Contributions.

                    Such Matching Contributions will be made on behalf of:



                         ( )  All Participants who make such
                              contribution(s).

                         ( )  All Participants who are Non-Highly
                              Compensated Employees who make such
                              contribution(s).

                    The amount of such Matching Contributions made on behalf
                    of each such Participant shall be:

                    (i)  Elective Deferrals (any one or a combination of the
                         following may be selected) -

                         ( )  An amount or percentage fixed by appropriate
                              action of the Employer.

                         ( )  [....]% of the Elective Deferrals.

                         ( )  [....]% of the first [....]% of Compensation
                              contributed as an Elective Deferral, plus

                              [....]% of the next [....]% of Compensation
                              contributed as an Elective Deferral, plus

                              [....]% of the next [....]% of Compensation
                              contributed as an Elective Deferral.

                         The Employer shall not match Elective Deferrals as
                         provided above in excess of $[....] or in excess of
                         [....]% of the Participant's Compensation.
                         The Employer shall not match Elective Deferrals
                         made by the following class(es) of Employees:
                         [....]

               (ii) Thrift Contributions (any one or a combination of the
                    following may be selected)-

                         ( )  An amount or percentage fixed by appropriate
                              action of the Employer.

                         ( )  $[....] for each dollar of Thrift
                              Contributions.

                         ( )  [....]% of the Thrift Contributions.

                         ( )  [....]% of the first [....]% of Compensation
                              contributed, plus [....]% of the next [....]%
                              of Compensation contributed, plus [....]% of
                              the remaining Compensation contributed.

                         The Employer shall not match Thrift Contributions
                         as provided above in excess of $[....] or in excess
                         of [....]% of the Participant's Compensation.

                         The Employer shall not match Thrift Contributions
                         made by the following class(es) of Employees: [...]


               (iii)     Combined Contributions (any one or a combination of
                         the following may be selected).

                         ( )  An amount fixed by appropriate action of the
                              Employer.

                         ( )  [....]% of Combined Contributions.

                         ( )  [....]% of Elective Deferrals, plus [....]% of
                              Thrift contributions.

                         ( )  [....]% of the first [....]% of Compensation
                              contributed, plus [....]% of the next [....]%
                              of Compensation contributed, plus [....]% of
                              the remaining Compensation contributed.

                    The Employer shall not match Combined Contributions as
                    provided above in excess of $[....] or in excess of
                    [....]% of the Participant's Compensation.

                    The Employer shall not match Combined Contributions made
                    by the following class(es) of Employees:  [....]

               Matching Contributions shall be made each:

                    ( )  Payroll period.
                    ( )  Month.

                    ( )  Quarter.

                    ( )  Plan Year.

               Allocation of Matching Contributions --

               In order to share in the allocation of Matching Contributions
               (and forfeitures, if forfeitures are reallocated to
               participants) a Participant:

                    ( )  Must be employed on the last day of the payroll
                         period.

                    ( )  Must be employed on the last day of the Month.

                    ( )  Must be employed on the last day of the Quarter.

                    ( )  Must be employed on the last day of the Plan Year.

                    unless the Participant terminates employment on account
                    of:

                         ( )  Death.

                         ( )  Disability.

                         ( )  Attainment of Early Retirement Age.

                         ( )  Attainment of Normal Retirement Age.

                         ( )  Employer approved leave of absence.

                    ( )  Must have ( ) 501 Hours of Service; ( ) [....]
                         Hours of Service (cannot exceed 1,000).  Note: Not
                         applicable if elapsed time method of crediting
                         service is elected.

          6.   Qualified Matching Contributions

                    ( )  Not permitted.

                    ( )  Permitted.

                         ( )  The Employer shall or may (in the event that
                              the Qualified Matching Contribution amount is
                              within the discretion of the Employer) make
                              Qualified Matching Contributions.

                    Qualified Matching Contributions will be made on behalf
                    of:
                    ( )  All Participants who make Elective Deferrals.

                    ( )  All Participants who are Non-Highly Compensated
                         Employees and who make Elective Deferrals.

                    The amount of such Qualified Matching Contributions made
                    on behalf of each Participant shall be (any one or a
                    combination of the following may be selected):

                    ( )  An amount or percentage fixed by appropriate action
                         by the Employer.

                    ( )  [....]% of the Elective Deferrals.

               The Employer shall not match Elective Deferrals as provided
               above in excess of $[....] or in excess of [....]% of the
               Participant's Compensation.

          7.   Qualified Nonelective Contributions

               ( )  Not permitted.

               ( )  The Employer shall have the discretion to contribute
                    Qualified Nonelective Contributions for any Plan Year in
                    an amount to be determined each year by the Employer.

                    Qualified Nonelective Contributions will be made on
                    behalf of (select as appropriate):

                    ( )  All Eligible Employees.

                    ( )  All Participants who make Elective Deferrals.

                    ( )  All Participants who are Non-Highly Compensated
                         Employees and who make Elective Deferrals.

                    ( )  All Participants who are Non-Highly Compensated
                         Employees.

                    ( )  All Non-Key Employees.

     B.   Forfeitures (Do not complete if 100% immediate vesting is
          elected).

          Forfeitures of Employer Discretionary Contributions, Matching
          Contributions or Excess Aggregate Contributions shall be:

          ( )  Allocated to participants in the manner provided in Sections
               4.2 and 4.7(d)(2) of the Plan.

          ( )  Used to reduce:

               ( )  any future Employer contributions.

               ( )  Plan expenses.

     C.   Contributions Not Limited by Net Profits

          Indicate for each type of Employer contribution allowed under the
          Plan whether such contributions are to be limited to Net Profits
          of the Employer for the taxable year of the Employer ending with
          or within the Plan Year:

               ( )  Yes  ( )  No   Employer Discretionary Contributions

               ( )  Yes  ( )  No   Elective Deferrals

               ( )  Yes  ( )  No   Qualified Nonelective Contributions

               ( )  Yes  ( )  No   Matching Contributions

               ( )  Yes  ( )  No   Qualified Matching Contributions.


XII. DISTRIBUTIONS AND IN-SERVICE WITHDRAWALS

     A.   Accounts shall be distributable upon a Participant's separation
          from service, death, or Total and Permanent Disability, and, in
          addition:

          ( )  Termination of the Plan without establishment or maintenance
               of a successor plan.

          ( )  The disposition to an entity that is not an Affiliated
               Employer of substantially all of the assets used by the
               Employer in a trade or business, but only if the Employer
               continues to maintain the Plan and only with respect to
               participants who continue employment with the acquiring
               corporation.

          ( )  Upon attainment of the Plan's Normal Retirement Age.

          ( )  The disposition to an entity that is not an Affiliated
               Employer of the Employer's interest in a subsidiary, but only
               if the Employer continues to maintain the Plan and only with
               respect to Participants who continue employment with such
               subsidiary.

          ( )  Vested portion of Employer Discretionary Contributions on
               account of a Participant's financial hardship to the extent
               permitted by Section 4.9 of the Plan.

          ( )  Vested portion of Employer Matching Contributions on account
               of a Participant's financial hardship to the extent permitted
               by Section 4.9 of the Plan.

     B.   In addition to A above, Elective Deferrals, Qualified Nonelective
          Contributions and Qualified Matching Contributions (as applicable)
          and income allocable to such amounts shall be distributable:

          ( )  Upon the Participant's attainment of age 59-1/2.

          ( )  On account of a Participant's financial hardship, to the
               extent permitted by Section 4.9 of the Plan (Elective
               Deferrals Only).

     C.   In-service withdrawals from a Participant's: ( ) Employer
          Discretionary Contribution Account; ( ) Matching Contribution
          Account; ( ) Transfer Account, if any ( ) shall; ( ) shall not be
          permitted upon the attainment of age 59-1/2.  (Permitted only if the
          Plan is not integrated with Social Security and a Participant's
          Employer Discretionary Contribution Account and Matching
          Contribution Accounts are 100% vested at time of distribution.)

     D.   Distribution of benefits upon separation of service, retirement or
          death of a Participant ( ) shall; ( ) shall not be subject to the
          Automatic Annuity rules of Section 8.2 of the Plan.

     E.   (Complete only if the Plan is not subject to the Automatic Annuity
          rules of Section 8.2.)  Check the appropriate optional forms of
          benefit that shall be available under the Plan (if left blank, the
          provisions of Section 8.6(a) of this Plan shall apply):

               [ ]  Single lump sum payment.

               [ ]  Installment payments pursuant to Section 8.6(a) of the
                    Plan.

     F.   The following optional forms of benefit shall be available in
          addition to the optional forms of benefit available under Section
          8.6 of the Plan (Note:  If the Plan is not subject to the
          Automatic Annuity rules of Section 8.2 and the Participant is
          permitted to select an annuity as an optional form of benefit,
          then the Automatic Annuity rules of Section 8.2 shall apply to
          such participant):
- -------------------------------------------------------------------------







          [Note:  If the Plan is an amendment and restatement of an existing
          Plan, optional forms of benefit protected under Section 411(d)(6)
          of the Code may not be eliminated, unless permitted by IRS
          Regulations Sections 1.401(a)-(4) and 1.411(d)-4].


XIII.     VESTING SERVICE

     In order to be credited with a year of Service for vesting purposes, a
     Participant shall complete [....] (not to exceed 1,000) Hours of
     Service.  (Not applicable if elapsed time method of crediting service
     for vesting purposes is elected).

     Note: In the case of Employees in the Maritime Industry, for purposes
     of a year of Service, refer to Section 1.56 of the Plan.


XIV. VESTING SERVICE - EXCLUSIONS

     All of an Employee's years of Service with the Employer shall be
     counted to determine the vested interest of such Employee except:

     ( )  Years of Service before age 18.

     ( )  Years of Service before the Employer maintained this Plan or a
          predecessor plan.

     ( )  Years of Service before the effective date of ERISA if such
          Service would have been disregarded under the Service Break rules
          of the prior plan in effect from time to time before such date.
          For this purpose, Service Break rules are rules which result in
          the loss of prior vesting or benefit accruals, or deny an
          Employee's eligibility to participate by reason of separation or
          failure to complete a required period of Service within a
          specified period of time.


XV.  VESTING SCHEDULES

     The vested interest of each Employee (who has an Hour of Service on or
     after January 1, 1989) in his Employer-derived account balance shall be
     determined on the basis of the following schedules:

     A.  Employer Discretionary Contributions.

          ( )  100% immediately vested.  [Note:  Mandatory if more than 1
               Eligibility Year of Service is required.]

          ( )  100% immediately vested after [....] (not to exceed 5) years
               of Service.

          ( )  [....]% (not less than 20%) vested for each year of Service,
               beginning with the [....] (not more than the 3rd) year of
               Service until 100% vested.

          ( )  Other:  [....] (Must be at least as favorable as any one of
               the above 3 options).

               AND

          ( )  Effective Date Vesting.  Each Employee who is a Participant
               on the Effective Date shall be 100% immediately vested.

     B.   Matching Contributions.

          ( )  100% immediately vested.  [Note:  Mandatory if more than 1
               Eligibility Year of Service is required.]

          ( )  100% immediately vested after [....] (not to exceed 5) years
               of Service.

          ( )  [....]% (not less than 20%) vested for each year of Service,
               beginning with the [....] (not more than the 3rd) year of
               Service until 100% vested.

          ( )  Other:  [....] (Must be at least as favorable as any one of
               the above 3 options).

               AND

          ( )  Effective Date Vesting.  Each Employee who is a Participant
               on the Effective Date shall be 100% immediately vested.

     C.   Top Heavy Minimum Vesting Schedules.

          One of the following schedules will be used for years when the
          Plan is or is deemed to be Top-Heavy.

          ( )  100% immediately vested after [....] (not to exceed 3) years
               of Service.

          ( )  20% vested after 2 years of Service, plus [....]% vested (not
               less than 20%) for each additional year of Service until 100%
               vested.

          ( )  Other: [....]  (Note: must be at least as favorable as either
               of the two schedules in this Section C).

          If the vesting schedule under the Plan shifts in or out of the
          Minimum Schedule above for any Plan Year because of the Plan's
          Top-Heavy status, such shift is an amendment to the vesting
          schedule and the election in Section 7.3 of the Plan applies.


XVI. LIFE INSURANCE

     Life insurance ( ) shall; ( ) shall not be a permissible investment.


XVII.     LOANS

     Loans ( ) shall; ( ) shall not be permitted.


XVIII.  TOP-HEAVY PROVISIONS

     A.  Top Heavy Status

          ( )  The provisions of Article XIII of the Plan shall always
               apply.

          ( )  The provisions of Article XIII of the Plan shall only apply
               in Plan Years after 1983, during which the Plan is or becomes
               Top-Heavy.

     B.  Minimum Allocations

          If a Participant in this Plan who is a Non-Key Employee is covered
          under another qualified plan maintained by the Employer, the
          minimum Top Heavy allocation or benefit required under Section 416
          of the Code shall be provided to such Non-key Employee under:

               ( )  this Plan.

               ( )  the Employer's other qualified defined contribution
                    plan.

               ( )  the Employer's qualified defined benefit plan.

     C.  Determination of Present Value

          If the Employer maintains a defined benefit plan in addition to
          this Plan, and such plan fails to specify the interest rate an
          mortality table to be used for purposes of establishing present
          value to compute the Top-Heavy Ratio, then the following
          assumptions shall be used:

               Interest Rate: [....]%

               Mortality Table: [....]


XIX. LIMITATION ON ALLOCATIONS

          If the adopting Employer maintains or has ever maintained another
          qualified plan in which any Participant in this Plan is (or was) a
          Participant or could possibly become a Participant, the adopting
          Employer must complete this Section.  The Employer must also
          complete this Section if it maintains a welfare benefit fund, as
          defined in Section 419(e) of the Code, or an individual medical
          account, as defined in Section 415(l)(2) of the Code, under which
          amounts are treated as Annual Additions with respect to any
          Participant in the Plan.

          (a)  If the Participant is covered under another qualified defined
               contribution plan maintained by the Employer, other than a
               Master or Prototype Plan, Annual Additions for any Limitation
               Year shall be limited to comply with Section 415(c) of the
               Code:

               ( )  in accordance with Sections 6.4(e) - (j) as though the
                    other plan were a Master or Prototype Plan.

               ( )  by freezing or reducing Annual Additions in the other
                    qualified defined contribution plan.

               ( )  other________________________________________________




          (b)  If a Participant is or has ever been a Participant in a
               qualified defined benefit plan maintained by the Employer,
               the "1.0" aggregate limitation of Section 415(e) of the Code
               shall be satisfied by:

               ( )  freezing or reducing the rate of benefit accrual under
                    the qualified defined benefit plan.

               ( )  freezing or reducing the Annual Additions under this
                    Plan (or, if the Employer maintains more than one
                    qualified defined contribution plan, as indicated in (a)
                    above).

               ( )  other:______________________________________




XX.  INVESTMENTS

     ( )  Participants ( ) shall; ( ) shall not be permitted to direct the
          investment of their Accounts in the investment options selected by
          the Employer or the Committee.

     ( )  Investment of participant Accounts shall be directed consistent
          with rules and procedures established by the Committee.  Such
          rules shall be applied to all Participants in a uniform and
          nondiscriminatory basis.


XXI. TRANSFERS

     Transfers pursuant to Section 10.3 of the Plan ( ) shall; ( ) shall not
     be permitted.

     If permitted, indicate additional prior plan provisions, if applicable:
     [....].


XXII.     ROLLOVERS

     Rollovers pursuant to Section 10.3 of the Plan ( ) shall; ( ) shall not
     be permitted.


XXIII.    EMPLOYER REPRESENTATIONS

     The Employer hereby represents that:

          a.   It is aware of, and agrees to be bound by, the terms of the
               Plan.

          b.   It understands that the Sponsor will not furnish legal or tax
               advice in connection with the adoption or operation of the
               Plan and has consulted legal and tax counsel to the extent
               necessary.

          c.   The failure to properly fill out this Adoption Agreement may
               result in disqualification of the Plan.


XXIV.     RELIANCE ON PLAN QUALIFICATION

     The adopting Employer may not rely on an opinion letter issued by the
     National Office of the Internal Revenue Service as evidence that the
     Plan is qualified under Section 401 of the Code.  In order to obtain
     reliance with respect to plan qualification, the Employer must apply to
     the appropriate key district office of the Internal Revenue Service for
     a determination letter.


XXV. PROTOTYPE PLAN DOCUMENTS

     This Adoption Agreement may be used only in conjunction with the
     Dreyfus Prototype Defined Contribution Plan, Basic Plan Document
     No. 01, and the Dreyfus Trust Agreement both as amended from time to
     time.  In the event the Sponsor amends the Basic Plan Document or this
     Adoption Agreement or discontinues this type of plan, it will inform
     the Employer.  The Sponsor, The Dreyfus Corporation, is available to
     answer questions regarding the intended meaning of any Plan provisions,
     adoption of the Plan and the effect of an Opinion Letter at 144 Glenn
     Curtiss Boulevard, Uniondale, New York  11556-0144 [(516) 338-3418].
      IN WITNESS WHEREOF, the Employer and the Trustee have executed this
instrument the  _______________________day of __________________

           , 19__.  If applicable, the appropriate corporate seal has been
affixed and attested to.


                              _______________________


                              Name of Business Entity

                              _______________________________


                              Signature(Sole Proprietors only)

                              By:_________________________________



                              Name and Title (Corporations or Partnerships)

     ATTEST:


     ____________________________
     Secretary (Corporations only)

     SEAL:

                         ____________________
                         Name(s) of Trustee(s)


                         _____________________________


                         Signature (Individual Trustee)


                         _____________________________


                         Signature (Individual Trustee)

                         By:_________________________________



                         Name and Title (Corporate Trustee only)




                            ADOPTION AGREEMENT
                        DREYFUS STANDARDIZED/PAIRED
                  PROTOTYPE PROFIT SHARING PLAN AND TRUST

                             PLAN NUMBER 01003
                        IRS SERIAL NUMBER D262553a

The Employer named in Section I.A. below hereby establishes or restates a
Profit Sharing Plan ("Plan") and Trust, consisting of such sums as shall be
paid to the Trustee(s) under the Plan, the investments thereof and earnings
thereon.  The terms of the Plan and Trust are set forth in this Adoption
Agreement and the applicable provisions of the Dreyfus Prototype Defined
Contribution Plan, Basic Plan Document No. 01, and the Dreyfus Trust
Agreement, both as amended from time to time, which are hereby adopted and
incorporated herein by reference.


I.   BASIC PROVISIONS

     A.   Employer's Name:   [....]

          Address:      [....]

     B.   The Employer is a ( ) corporation; ( ) S Corporation; ( )
          partnership;
          ( ) sole proprietor; ( ) other: [.....]

     C.   Employer's Tax ID Number:

     D.   Employer's fiscal year:

     E.   Plan Name:

     F.   If this is a new Plan, the Effective Date of the Plan is:

          If this is an amendment and restatement of an existing Plan, enter
          the original Effective Date [....].  The effective date of this
          amended Plan is [....].

     G.   The Trustee shall be:

          ( ) The Dreyfus Trust Company.

          ( ) Other:    (Name)    [....]
                   (Address) [....]
                   (Address) [....]
                   (Phone #) [....]

     H.   The first Plan Year shall be [....] through [....].  Thereafter,
          the Plan Year shall mean the 12-consecutive-month period
          commencing on [....] and ending on [....].

     I.   Service with the following predecessor employer(s) shall be
          credited for purposes of vesting and eligibility:  [Note:  Such
          Service must be provided if the adopting Employer maintains the
          plan of the predecessor employer].

     J.   The following employer(s) aggregated with the Employer under
          Sections 414(b), (c), (m) or (o) of the Internal Revenue Code
          ("Code") shall be Participating Employers in the Plan: [....]

     K.   Are all employers aggregated with the Employer under Sections
          414(b), (c), (m) or (o) of the Code participating in the Plan?

               ( )  Yes  ( )  No


II.  HOURS OF SERVICE

     Hours of Service under the Plan will be determined for all Employees on
     the basis of the method selected below:

     ( )  On the basis of actual hours for which an Employee is paid or
          entitled to payment.

     ( )  On the basis of days worked.  An Employee will be credited with
          ten (10) Hours of Service for any day such Employee would be
          credited with at least one (1) Hour of Service during the day
          under the Plan.

     ( )  On the basis of weeks worked.  An Employee will be credited with
          forty-five (45) Hours of Service for any week such Employee would
          be credited with at least one (1) Hour of Service during the week
          under the Plan.

     ( )  On the basis of semi-monthly payroll periods.  An Employee will be
          credited with ninety-five (95) Hours of Service for any semi-
          monthly payroll period such Employee would be credited with at
          least one (1) Hour of Service under the Plan.

     ( )  On the basis of months worked.  An Employee will be credited with
          one hundred ninety (190) Hours of Service for any month such
          Employee would be credited with at least one (1) Hour of Service
          under the Plan.

     ( )  On the basis of elapsed time.


III. ELIGIBLE EMPLOYEES

     All Employees shall be Eligible Employees, except:

     ( )  Employees included in a unit of Employees covered by a collective
          bargaining agreement between the Employer and employee
          representatives, if retirement benefits were the subject of good
          faith bargaining.  For this purpose, the term "employee
          representatives" does not include any organization more than half
          of whose members are Employees who are owners, officers, or
          executives of the Employer.

     ( )  Employees who are nonresident aliens and who receive no earned
          income from the Employer which constitutes income from sources
          within the United States.

     Note:     The term Employee includes all Employees of the Employer and
               any employer required to be aggregated with the Employer
               under Sections 414(b), (c), (m) or (o) of the Code, and
               individuals considered employees of any such employer under
               Section 414(n) or (o) of the Code.

          If the Employer adopts Sponsor's paired defined contribution plan
          number 01001, 01004, 01005 or 01006 or paired defined benefit plan
          number 02001 in addition to this Plan, the definition of "Eligible
          Employee" in all paired plans of the Employer must be identical in
          order for the Employer to be able to designate in Section XV one
          of the paired plans to provide the required minimum allocation to
          each Non-Key Employee in the event the Plan becomes Top-Heavy.  If
          the definition of "Eligible Employee" in all paired plans of the
          Employer is not identical, Section 13.1 through 13.4 shall apply
          in the event the Plan becomes Top-Heavy.


IV.  AGE AND SERVICE REQUIREMENTS

     Each Eligible Employee shall become a Participant on the Entry Date
     coincident with or following completion of the following requirements:

     Age:      ( ) No age requirement.

               ( ) The attainment of age [....] (not to exceed age 21).

     Service:  ( ) No service requirement.

               ( ) For Employer Discretionary Contributions only -- the
                   completion of [....] (not to exceed 1 unless 100%
                   immediate vesting is elected, in which case, may not
                   exceed 2) Eligibility Years of Service.  [Note:  If more
                   than 1 Eligibility Year of Service is required,
                   Participants must be 100% immediately vested.  If the
                   Eligibility Years of Service is or includes a fractional
                   year, an Employee may not be required to complete any
                   specified number of Hours of Service to receive credit
                   for such fractional year.]

               ( ) For all other contributions -- the completion of [....]
                   (not to exceed 1) Eligibility Year of Service.


V.   ENTRY DATE

     The Entry Date shall mean:
     ( )  For the first Plan Year only, the initial Entry Date shall be
          [....];

     thereafter:

     ( )  Annual Entry.  The first day of the Plan Year.  [Note: If Annual
          Entry is selected, the age and service requirements cannot exceed
          20-1/2 and 1/2 Eligibility Year of Service.]

     ( )  Dual Entry.  The first day of the Plan Year and the first day of
          the seventh month of the Plan Year.

     ( )  Quarterly Entry.  The first day of the Plan Year and the first day
          of the fourth, seventh and tenth months of the Plan Year.

     ( )  Monthly Entry.  The first day of the Plan Year and the first day
          of each following month of the Plan Year.


VI.  COMPENSATION

     A.   Except for purposes of "annual additions" testing under Section
          415 of the Code, Compensation shall mean all of each
          Participant's:

     ( )  Information required to be reported under Sections 6041, 6051 and
          6052 of the Code.  (Wages, tips and other compensation box on Form
          W-2) Compensation is defined as wages as defined in Section
          3401(a) and all other payments of compensation to the Employee by
          the Employer (in the course of the Employer's trade or business)
          for which the Employer is required to furnish the Employee a
          written statement under Sections 6041(d) and 6051(a)(3) of the
          Code.  Compensation must be determined without regard to any rules
          under Section 3401(a) that limit the remuneration included in
          wages based on the nature or location of the employment or
          services performed (such as the exception for agricultural labor
          in Section 3401(a)(2) of the Code).  This definition of
          Compensation shall exclude amounts paid or reimbursed by the
          Employer for moving expenses incurred by an Employee, but only to
          the extent that at the time of the payment it is reasonable to
          believe that these amounts are deductible by the Employee under
          Section 217 of the Code.

     ( )  Section 3401(a) wages.  Compensation is defined as wages within
          the meaning of Section 3401(a) of the Code for purposes of income
          tax withholding at the source but determined without regard to any
          rules that limit the remuneration included in wages based on the
          nature or location of the employment or the services performed
          (such as the exception for agricultural labor in Section
          3401(a)(2) of the Code).

     ( )  Section 415 safe-harbor compensation.  Compensation is defined as
          wages, salaries, and fees for professional services and other
          amounts received (without regard to whether or not an amount is
          paid in cash) for personal services actually rendered in the
          course of employment with the Employer to the extent that the
          amounts are includible in gross income (including, but not limited
          to, commissions paid salesmen, compensation for services on the
          basis of a percentage of profits, commissions on insurance
          premiums, tips, bonuses, fringe benefits, and reimbursements or
          other expense allowances under a nonaccountable plan (as described
          in Section 1.62-2(c)), and excluding the following:

          (a)  Employer contributions to a plan of deferred compensation
               which are not includible in the Employee's gross income for
               the taxable year in which contributed, or Employer
               contributions under a simplified employee pension plan
               described in Section 408(k), or any distributions from a plan
               of deferred compensation regardless of whether such amounts
               are includible in the gross income of the Employee;

          (b)  Amounts realized from the exercise of a nonqualified stock
               option, or when restricted stock (or property) held by the
               Employee either becomes freely transferable or is no longer
               subject to a substantial risk of forfeiture;

          (c)  Amounts realized from the sale, exchange or other disposition
               of stock acquired under a qualified stock option; and

          (d)  Other amounts which receive special tax benefits, such as
               premiums for group-term life insurance (but only to the
               extent that the premiums are not includible in the gross
               income of the Employee), or contributions made by the
               Employer (whether or not under a salary reduction agreement)
               towards the purchase of an annuity contract described in
               Section 403(b) of the Code (whether or not the contributions
               are actually excludable from the gross income of the
               Employee).

     which is actually paid to the Participant during the following
     applicable period:

          ( )  the portion of the Plan Year in which the Employee is a
               Participant in the Plan.

          ( )  the Plan Year.

          ( )  the calendar year ending with or within the Plan Year.

     ( )  Compensation shall be reduced by all of the following items (even
          if includible in gross income):  reimbursements or other expense
          allowances, fringe benefits (cash and noncash), moving expenses,
          deferred compensation and welfare benefits.

     Compensation ( ) shall; ( ) shall not include Employer contributions
     made pursuant to a salary reduction agreement with an Employee which
     are not includible in the gross income of the Employee by reason of
     Sections 125, 402(e)(3), 402(h)(1)(B) or 403(b) of the Code.
     For any Self-Employed Individual covered under the Plan, Compensation
     means Earned Income.

     B.   For purposes of "annual additions" testing under Section 415 of
          the Code, Compensation for any Limitation Year shall mean all of
          each Participant's:

     ( )  Information required to be reported under Sections 6041, 6051, and
          6052 of the Code.  (Wages, tips and other compensation box on Form
          W-2) Compensation is defined as wages as defined in Section
          3401(a) and all other payments of compensation to the Employee by
          the Employer (in the course of the Employer's trade or business)
          for which the Employer is required to furnish the Employee a
          written statement under Sections 6041(d) and 6051(a)(3) of the
          Code.  Compensation must be determined without regard to any rules
          under Section 3401(a) that limit the remuneration included in
          wages based on the nature or location of the employment or
          services performed (such as the exception for agricultural labor
          in Section 3401(a)(2) of the Code).  This definition of
          Compensation shall exclude amounts paid or reimbursed by the
          Employer for moving expenses incurred by an Employee, but only to
          the extent that at the time of the payment it is reasonable to
          believe that these amounts are deductible by the Employee under
          Section 217 of the Code.

     ( )  Section 3401(a) wages.  Compensation is defined as wages within
          the meaning of Section 3401(a) of the Code for purposes of income
          tax withholding at the source but determined without regard to any
          rules that limit the remuneration included in wages based on the
          nature or location of the employment or the services performed
          (such as the exception for agricultural labor in Section
          3401(a)(2) of the Code).

     ( )  Section 415 safe-harbor compensation.  Compensation is defined as
          wages, salaries, and fees for professional services and other
          amounts received (without regard to whether or not an amount is
          paid in cash) for personal services actually rendered in the
          course of employment with the Employer to the extent that the
          amounts are includible in gross income (including, but not limited
          to, commissions paid salesmen, compensation for services on the
          basis of a percentage of profits, commissions on insurance
          premiums, tips, bonuses, fringe benefits, and reimbursements or
          other expense allowances under a nonaccountable plan (as described
          in Section 1.62-2(c)), and excluding the following:

          (a)  Employer contributions to a plan of deferred compensation
               which are not includible in the Employee's gross income for
               the taxable year in which contributed, or Employer
               contributions under a simplified employee pension plan
               described in Section 408(k), or any distributions from a plan
               of deferred compensation regardless of whether such amounts
               are includible in the gross income of the Employee;

          (b)  Amounts realized from the exercise of a nonqualified stock
               option, or when restricted stock (or property) held by the
               Employee either becomes freely transferable or is no longer
               subject to a substantial risk of forfeiture;

          (c)  Amounts realized from the sale, exchange or other disposition
               of stock acquired under a qualified stock option; and

          (d)  Other amounts which receive special tax benefits, such as
               premiums for group-term life insurance (but only to the
               extent that the premiums are not includible in the gross
               income of the Employee), or contributions made by the
               Employer (whether or not under a salary reduction agreement)
               towards the purchase of an annuity contract described in
               Section 403(b) of the Code (whether or not the contributions
               are actually excludable from the gross income of the
               Employee).

     which is actually paid or includible in gross income during such
     Limitation Year.

     For any Self-Employed Individual covered under the Plan, Compensation
     means Earned Income.


VII. LIMITATION YEAR

     Limitation Year shall mean the twelve (12) consecutive-month period:

     ( )  Identical to the Plan Year.

     ( )  Identical to the Employer's fiscal year ending with or within the
          Plan Year of reference.

     ( )  As fixed by a resolution of the Board of Directors of the
          Employer, or the Employer if no Board of Directors exists.

VIII.     NORMAL RETIREMENT AGE

     Normal Retirement Age shall mean:

     ( )  Age [....] (not to exceed 65).

     ( )  Age [....] (not to exceed 65), or the [....] (not to exceed the
          5th) anniversary of the date the Participant commenced
          participation in the Plan, if later.


IX.  EARLY RETIREMENT AGE

     Early Retirement Age shall mean:

     ( )  There shall be no early retirement provision in this Plan.

     ( )  Age [....].
     ( )  Age [....] and [....] Years of Service.


X.   EMPLOYER AND EMPLOYEE CONTRIBUTIONS

     A.   Types and allocation of Contributions

          1.   Employer Discretionary Contributions

               ( ) Not permitted.

               ( ) Permitted.

                   ( )  An amount fixed by appropriate action of the
                        Employer.

                   ( )  [....]% of Compensation of Participants for the
                        Plan Year (not to exceed 15%).

               Employer Discretionary Contributions ( ) shall; ( ) shall not
               be integrated with Social Security.

               If integrated with Social Security:

                   a.   ( )  The Permitted Disparity Percentage shall be
                             [....]%.

                   b.   ( )  the Permitted Disparity Percentage shall be
                             determined annually by appropriate action of
                             the Employer.

                   c.   ( )  The Integration Level shall be:

                             ( )  the Taxable Wage Base.

                             ( )  $____(a dollar amount less than the
                                  Taxable Wage Base).

                             ( )  _____(not to exceed 100% of the
                                  Taxable Wage Base).

                   Note:          The Permitted Disparity Percentage cannot
                                  exceed the lesser of: (i) the base
                                  contribution, or (ii) the greater of 5.7%
                                  or the tax rate under Section 3111(a) of
                                  the Code attributable to the old age
                                  insurance portion of the Old Age,
                                  Survivors and Disability Insurance
                                  provisions of the Social Security Act (as
                                  in effect on the first day of the Plan
                                  Year).  If the Integration Level selected
                                  above is other than the Taxable Wage Base
                                  ("TWB"), the 5.7% factor in the preceding
                                  sentence must be replaced by the
                                  applicable percentage determined from the
                                  following table.

                   If the Integration
                   Level is:
                   ________                              The Applicable
                   more than      but not more than  Factor is
                   _________      ______________________________________
                   $0                 X*                 5.7%
                   X*                 80% of TWB         4.3%
                   80% of TWB         Y*                 5.4%

                   * X = the greater of $10,000 or 20% of TWB

                   ** Y = any amount more than 80% of TWB, but less than
                          100% of TWB

          2.   Elective Deferrals

               ( ) Not permitted.

               ( ) Permitted.

               A Participant may elect to have his or her Compensation
               reduced by:

                   ( )  An amount not in excess of [....]% of Compensation
                        [cannot exceed the dollar limitation of Section
                        402(g) of the Code for the calendar year].

                   ( )  An amount not in excess of $[....] of Compensation
                        [cannot exceed the dollar limitation of Section
                        402(g) of the Code for the calendar year].

               A Participant may elect to commence Elective Deferrals the
               next pay period following: [....] (enter date or period -- at
               least once each calendar year).

               A Participant may modify the amount of Elective Deferrals as
               of: [....] (enter date or period -- at least once each
               calendar year).

               A Participant ( ) may; ( ) may not base Elective Deferrals on
               cash bonuses that, at the Participant's election, may be
               contributed to the CODA or received by the Participant in
               cash.  Such election shall be effective as of the next pay
               period following [....] or as soon as administratively
               feasible thereafter.

               Participants who claim Excess Elective Deferrals for the
               preceding calendar year must submit their claims in writing
               to the plan administrator by [....] (enter date between March
               1 and April 15).

          3.   Matching Contributions

               ( ) Not  permitted.

               ( ) Permitted.

                   ( )  The Employer shall or may (in the event that the
                        Matching Contribution amount is within the
                        discretion of the Employer) make Matching
                        Contributions to the Plan on behalf of:

                        ( )  All Participants who make Elective Deferrals.

                        ( )  All Participants who are Non-Highly
                             Compensated Employees and who make Elective
                             Deferrals.

               The amount of such Matching Contributions made on behalf of
               each such Participant shall be (any one or a combination of
               the following may be selected):

                   ( )  An amount or percentage of Elective Deferrals fixed
                        by appropriate action of the Employer.

                   ( )  [....]% of the Elective Deferrals.

               The Employer shall not match Elective Deferrals as provided
               above in excess of $[....] or in excess of [....]% of the
               Participant's Compensation.

               Matching Contributions shall be made during each:

                   ( )  Payroll period.

                   ( )  Month.

                   ( )  Quarter.

                   ( )  Plan Year.

          4.   Qualified Nonelective Contributions

               ( ) Not permitted.

               ( ) The Employer shall have the discretion to contribute
                   Qualified Nonelective Contributions for any Plan Year in
                   an amount to be determined each year by the Employer.

               ( ) Shall be made in an amount equal to [....]% of each
                   Participant eligible to receive Qualified Nonelective
                   Contributions.

               Qualified Nonelective Contributions will be made on behalf
               of:
                   ( )  All Participants who make Elective Deferrals.

                   ( )  All Participants who are Non-Highly Compensated
                        Employees and who make Elective Deferrals.

     B.   Forfeitures (Do not complete if 100% immediate vesting is
          elected).

          Forfeitures of Employer Discretionary Contributions, Matching
          Contributions or Excess Aggregate Contributions shall be:

          ( )  Allocated to Participants in the manner provided in Sections
               4.2 and 4.7(d) of the Plan.

          ( )  Used to reduce future Employer contributions.

     C.   Contributions Not Limited by Net Profits

          Indicate for each type of Employer contribution allowed under the
          Plan whether such contributions are to be limited to Net Profits
          of the Employer for the taxable year of the Employer ending with
          or within the Plan Year.

          ( )  Yes ( )  No   Employer Discretionary Contributions

          ( )  Yes ( )  No   Elective Deferrals

          ( )  Yes ( )  No   Qualified Nonelective Contributions

          ( )  Yes ( )  No   Matching Contributions


XI.  DISTRIBUTIONS AND IN-SERVICE WITHDRAWALS

     A.   Accounts shall be distributable upon a Participant's separation
          from service, death, or Total and Permanent Disability, as defined
          in the Plan, and, in addition:

          ( )  Termination of the Plan without establishment or maintenance
               of a successor plan.

          ( )  The disposition to an entity that is not an Affiliated
               Employer of substantially all of the assets used by the
               Employer in a trade or business, but only if the Employer
               continues to maintain the Plan and only with respect to
               Participants who continue employment with the acquiring
               corporation.

          ( )  The disposition to an entity that is not an Affiliated
               Employer of the Employer's interest in a subsidiary, but only
               if the Employer continues to maintain the Plan and only with
               respect to Participants who continue employment with such
               subsidiary.

          ( )  Upon attainment of the Plan's Normal Retirement Age.

     B.   In Addition to A above, Elective Deferrals and Qualified
          Nonelective Contributions (as applicable) and income allocable to
          such amounts shall be distributable:

          ( )  Upon the Participant's attainment of age 59-1/2.

          ( )  On account of a Participant's financial hardship, to the
               extent permitted by Section 4.9 of the Plan (Elective
               Deferrals Only).

     C.   In-service withdrawals from a Participant's: ( ) Employer
          Discretionary Contribution Account; ( ) Matching Contribution
          Account; ( ) Transfer Account, if any ( ) shall; ( ) shall not be
          permitted upon the attainment of age 59-1/2.  (Permitted only if Plan
          is not integrated with Social Security and a Participant's
          Employer Discretionary Contribution Account and Matching
          Contribution Accounts are 100% vested at time of distribution.)

     D.   Distribution of benefits upon retirement or death of a Participant
          ( ) shall;   ( ) shall not be subject to the Automatic Annuity
          rules of Sections 8.2 of the Plan.


XII. VESTING SERVICE - EXCLUSIONS

     All of an Employee's years of Service with the Employer shall be
     counted to determine the vested interest of such Employee except:

     ( )  Years of Service before age 18.

     ( )  Years of Service before the Employer maintained this Plan or a
          predecessor plan.

     ( )  Years of Service before the effective date of ERISA if such
          Service would have been disregarded under the Service Break rules
          of the prior plan in effect from time to time before such date.
          For this purpose, Service Break rules are rules which result in
          the loss of prior vesting or benefit accruals, or deny and
          Employee's eligibility to participate by reason of separation or
          failure to complete a required period of Service within a
          specified period of time.


XIII.     VESTING SCHEDULES

     The vested interest of each Employee (who has an Hour of Service on or
     after January 1, 1989) in his Employer-derived account balance shall be
     determined on the basis of the following schedules:

     A.   Employer Discretionary Contributions.

          ( )  100% immediately vested.  [Note: Mandatory if more than 1
               Eligibility Year of Service is required.]

          ( )  100% immediately vested after [....] (not to exceed 5) years
               of Service.

          ( )  [....]% (not less than 20%) vested for each year of Service,
               beginning with the [....] (not more than the 3rd) year of
               Service until 100% vested.

          ( )  Other:  [....] (Must be at least as favorable as any one of
               the above 3 options).

     B.   Matching Contributions.

          ( )  100% immediately vested.  [Note: Mandatory if more than 1
               Eligibility Year of Service is required.]

          ( )  100% immediately vested after [....] (not to exceed 5) years
               of Service.

          ( )  [....]% (not less than 20%) vested for each year of Service,
               beginning with the [....] (not more than the 3rd) year of
               Service until 100% vested.

          ( )  Other:  [....] (Must be at least as favorable as any one of
               the above 3 options).

     C.   Top Heavy Minimum Vesting Schedules.

          One of the following schedules will be used for years when the
          Plan is or is deemed to be Top-Heavy.

          ( )  100% immediately vested after [....] (not to exceed 3) years
               of Service.

          ( )  20% vested after 2 years of Service, plus [....]% vested (not
               less than 20%) for each additional year of Service until 100%
               vested.

          ( )  Other: [....]  (Note: Must be at least as favorable as either
               of the two schedules in this Section C).

          If the vesting schedule under the Plan shifts in or out of the
          Minimum Schedule above for any Plan Year because of the Plan's
          Top-Heavy status, such shift is an amendment to the vesting
          schedule and the election in Section 7.3 of the Plan applies.


XIV. LIFE INSURANCE

     Life insurance ( ) shall; ( ) shall not be a permissible investment.


XV.  LOANS
     Loans ( ) shall; ( ) shall not be permitted.


XVI. TOP-HEAVY PROVISIONS

     A.   Top Heavy Status

          ( )  The provisions of Article XIII of the Plan shall always
               apply.

          ( )  The provisions of Article XIII of the Plan shall only apply
               in Plan Years after 1983, during which the Plan is or becomes
               Top-Heavy.

     B.   Minimum Allocation

          If the Employer has adopted Sponsor's paired defined contribution
          plan number 01001, 01004 or 01005 in addition to this Plan, then
          the minimum allocation required by Section 13.3 will be provided (
          ) under this Plan; ( ) under such other paired defined
          contribution plan.  If the Employer has adopted Sponsor's paired
          defined benefit plan number 02001, then Participants in this Plan
          (or another paired defined contribution plan) who are covered
          under the paired defined benefit plan shall receive the top-heavy
          minimum benefit under the paired defined benefit plan and shall
          receive no minimum allocation.

          If a Participant in this Plan who is a Non-Key Employee is covered
          under another qualified plan maintained by the Employer, other
          than a paired plan of the Sponsor, the minimum Top Heavy
          allocation or benefit required under Section 416 of the Code shall
          be provided to such Non-Key Employee under:

          ( )  this Plan.

          ( )  the Employer's other qualified defined contribution plan.

          ( )  the Employer's qualified defined benefit plan.

          ( )  other: _______________________________________.



     C.   Determination of Present Value

          If the Employer maintains a defined benefit plan in addition to
          this Plan, and such plan fails to specify the interest rate and
          mortality table to be used for purposes of establishing present
          value to compute the Top-Heavy Ratio, then the following
          assumptions shall be used:

          Interest Rate [....]%   Mortality Table  [....]





XVII.     LIMITATION ON ALLOCATIONS

     If the Employer maintains or has ever maintained another qualified plan
     (other than the Sponsor's paired defined contribution plan number
     01001, 01004, 01005, or 01006 or the Sponsor's paired defined benefit
     plan number 02001), in which any Participant in this Plan is (or was) a
     Participant or could possibly become a Participant, the adopting
     Employer must complete this Section.  The Employer must also complete
     this Section if it maintains a welfare benefit fund, as defined in
     Section 419(e) of the Code, or an individual medical account, as
     defined in Section 415(l)(2) of the Code, under which amounts are
     treated as Annual Additions with respect to any Participant in the
     Plan.  (If the Employer maintains only paired plans of the Sponsor this
     Section should not be completed.)

     (a)  If a Participant is covered under another qualified defined
          contribution plan maintained by the Employer, other than a Master
          or Prototype Plan, Annual Additions for any Limitation Year shall
          be limited to comply with Section 415(c) of the Code:

          ( )  in accordance with Section 6.4 (e) - (j) as though the other
               plan were a Master or Prototype Plan.

          ( )  by freezing or reducing Annual Additions in the other
               qualified defined contribution plan.

          ( )  other: _______________________________________________.




     (b)  If a Participant is or has ever been a participant in a qualified
          defined benefit plan maintained by the Employer, the "1.0"
          aggregate limitation of Section 415(e) of the Code shall be
          satisfied by:

          ( )  freezing or reducing the rate of benefit accrual under the
               qualified defined benefit plan.

          ( )  freezing or reducing the Annual Additions under this Plan
               (or, if the Employer maintains more than one qualified
               defined contribution plan, as indicated in (a) above).

          ( )  other: _______________________________________________.





XVIII.    INVESTMENTS

     Participants ( ) shall; ( ) shall not be permitted to direct the
     investment of their Accounts in the investment options selected by the
     Employer or the Committee.

XIX. EMPLOYER REPRESENTATIONS

     The Employer hereby represents that:

     a.   It is aware of, and agrees to be bound by, the terms of the Plan.

     b.   It understands that the Sponsor will not furnish legal or tax
          advice in connection with the adoption or operation of the Plan
          and has consulted legal and tax counsel to the extent necessary.

     c.   The failure to properly fill out this Adoption Agreement may
          result in disqualification of the Plan.


XX.  RELIANCE ON PLAN QUALIFICATION

     An Employer who has ever maintained or who later adopts any plan
     (including, after December 31, 1985, a welfare benefit fund, as defined
     in Section 419(e) of the Code which provides post-retirement medical
     benefits allocated to separate accounts for Key Employees, as defined
     in Section 419A(d)(3) of the Code, or an individual medical account, as
     defined in Section 415(l)(2) of the Code) in addition to this Plan
     (other than the Sponsor's paired defined contribution plan number
     01001, 01004, or 01005, or the Sponsor's paired defined benefit plan
     number 02001), may not rely on the opinion letter issued by the
     National Office of the Service as evidence that this Plan is qualified
     under Section 401 of the Code.  If an Employer who adopts or maintains
     multiple plans wishes to obtain reliance that his or her plans are
     qualified, application for a determination letter should be made to the
     appropriate key district office of the Internal Revenue Service.

     The Employer may not rely on the opinion letter issued by the National
     Office of the Internal Revenue Service as evidence that this Plan is
     qualified under Section 401 of the Code unless the terms of the Plan,
     as herein adopted or amended, that pertain to the requirements of
     Sections 401(a)(4), 401(a)(17), 401(l), 401(a)(5), 410(b) and 414(s) of
     the Code, as amended by the Tax Reform Act of 1986, or later laws, (a)
     are made effective retroactively to the first day of the first Plan
     Year beginning after December 31, 1988 (or such later date on which
     these requirements first become effective with respect to this Plan);
     or (b) are made effective no later than the first day on which the
     Employer is no longer entitled, under regulations, to rely on a
     reasonable, good faith interpretation of these requirements, and the
     prior provisions of the Plan constitute such an interpretation.


XXI. PROTOTYPE PLAN DOCUMENTS

     This Adoption Agreement may be used only in conjunction with the
     Dreyfus Prototype Defined Contribution Plan, Basic Plan Document No.
     01, and the Dreyfus Trust Agreement both as amended from time to time.
     In the event the Sponsor amends the Basic Plan Document or this
     Adoption Agreement or discontinues this type of plan, it will inform
     the Employer.  The Sponsor, The Dreyfus Corporation is available to
     answer questions regarding the intended meaning of any Plan provisions,
     adoption of the Plan and the effect of an Opinion Letter, at 144 Glenn
     Curtiss Boulevard, Uniondale, New York 11556-0144 [(516) 338-3418].

IN WITNESS WHEREOF, the Employer and the Trustee executed this instrument
the ____day of __________, 19__.  If applicable, the appropriate corporate
seal has been affixed and attested to.


                   _______________________

                   Name of Business Entity


                   _________________________________


                   Signature (Sole Proprietors only)


                   By: ____________________________________________


                       Name and Title (Corporations or Partnerships)


ATTEST:


____________________________


Secretary (Corporations only)


SEAL:

                   __________________
                   Name of Trustee(s)


                   _____________________________


                   Signature (Individual Trustee)


                   _____________________________


                   Signature (Individual Trustee)


                   By:  _______________________________________


                        Name and Title (Corporate Trustee only)





                            ADOPTION AGREEMENT
                        DREYFUS STANDARDIZED/PAIRED
                  PROTOTYPE TARGET BENEFIT PLAN AND TRUST

                             PLAN NUMBER 01004
                        IRS SERIAL NUMBER D262554a


The Employer named in Section I.A. below hereby establishes or restates a
Target Benefit Plan ("Plan") and Trust, consisting of such sums as shall be
paid to the Trustee(s) under the Plan, the investments thereof and earnings
thereon.  The terms of the Plan and Trust are set forth in this Adoption
Agreement and the applicable provisions of the Dreyfus Prototype Defined
Contribution Plan, Basic Plan Document No. 01, and the Dreyfus Trust
Agreement, both as amended from time to time, which are hereby adopted and
incorporated herein by reference.


I.   BASIC PROVISIONS

     A.   Employer's Name:            [....]

               Address:           [....]

     B.   The Employer is a ( ) corporation; ( ) S Corporation; ( )
partnership; ( ) Sole Proprietor; ( ) Other: [....]

     C.   Employer's Tax ID Number:   [....]

     D.   Employer's fiscal year:     [....]

     E.   Plan Name:    [....]

     F.   If this is a new Plan, the Effective Date of the Plan is:

          If this is an amendment and restatement of an existing Plan, enter
          the original Effective Date [....].  The effective date of this
          amended Plan is [....].

     G.   The Trustee shall be:

               ( )  The Dreyfus Trust Company

               ( )  Other:        (Name)   [....]
                             (Address)[....]
                             (Address)[....]
                             (Phone #)[....]

     H.   Anniversary Date:  [....]

     I.   Plan Year shall mean the 12-consecutive-month period commencing on
          ______ /________and ending on ______/_______.
     J.Service with the following predecessor employer(s) shall be credited
          for purposes of vesting and eligibility: [....]
          Note:    Such Service must be provided if the adopting Employer
                   maintains the plan of the predecessor employer.

     K.   The following employer(s) aggregated with the Employer under
          Section 414(b), (c), (m) or (o) of the Internal Revenue Code
          ("Code") shall be Participating Employers in the Plan: [....]

     L.   Are all employers associated with the Employer under Section
          414(b), (c), (m) or (o) of the Code participating in the Plan?

               ( ) Yes  ( )  No


II.  HOURS OF SERVICE

     Hours of Service under the Plan will be determined for all Employees on
     the basis of the method selected below:

     ( )  On the basis of actual hours for which an Employee is paid or
          entitled to payment.

     ( )  On the basis of days worked.  An Employee will be credited with
          ten (10) Hours of Service for any day such Employee would be
          credited with at least one (1) Hour of Service during the day
          under the Plan.

     ( )  On the basis of weeks worked.  An Employee will be credited with
          forty-five (45) Hours of Service for any week such Employee would
          be credited with at least one (1) Hour of Service during the week
          under the Plan.

     ( )  On the basis of semi-monthly payroll periods.  An Employee will be
          credited with ninety-five (95) Hours of Service for any
          semi-monthly payroll period such Employee would be credited with
          at least one (1) Hour of Service under the Plan.

     ( )  On the basis of months worked.  An Employee will be credited with
          one hundred ninety (190) Hours of Service for any month such
          Employee would be credited with at least one (1) Hour of Service
          under the Plan.

     ( )  On the basis of elapsed time.


III. ELIGIBLE EMPLOYEES

     All Employees shall be Eligible Employees, except:

     ( )  Employees included in a unit of Employees covered by a collective
          bargaining agreement between the Employer and employee
          representatives, if retirement benefits were the subject of good
          faith bargaining and if two percent or less of the Employees of
          the Employer who are covered pursuant to that agreement are
          professionals as defined in Section 1.410(b)-9 of the Income Tax
          Regulations.  For this purpose, the term "employee
          representatives" does not include any organization more than half
          of whose members are Employees who are owners, officers, or
          executives of the Employer.

     ( )  Employees who are nonresident aliens and who receive no earned
          income from the Employer which constitutes income from sources
          within the United States.

     Note:     The term Employee includes all Employees of the Employer and
               any employer required to be aggregated with the Employer
               under Section 414(b), (c), (m) or (o) of the Code, and
               individuals considered employees of any such employer under
               Section 414(n) or (o) of the Code.

          If the Employer adopts Sponsor's paired defined contribution plan
          number 01001, 01003, 01005 or 01006 or paired defined benefit plan
          number 02001 in addition to this Plan, the definition of "Eligible
          Employee" in all paired plans of the Employer must be identical in
          order for the Employer to be able to designate in Section XV one
          of the paired plans to provide the required minimum allocation to
          each Non-Key Employee in the event the Plan becomes Top-Heavy.  If
          the definition of "Eligible Employee" in all paired plans of the
          Employer is not identical, Section 13.1 through 13.4 shall apply
          in the event the Plan becomes Top-Heavy.



IV.  AGE AND SERVICE REQUIREMENTS

     Each Eligible Employee shall become a Participant on the Entry Date
     coincident with or following completion of the following age and
     service requirements:

     ( )  No age or service requirement.

     ( )  The attainment of age [....] (not to exceed age 21).

     ( )  The completion of [....] (not to exceed 1, unless 100% immediate
          vesting is elected, in which case, may not exceed 2) Eligibility
          Years of Service.  [Note:  If more than 1 Eligibility Year of
          Service is required, Participants must be 100% immediately vested.
          If the Eligibility Years of Service is or includes a fractional
          year, an Employee may not be required to complete any specified
          number of Hours of Service to receive credit for such fractional
          year.


V.   ENTRY DATE

     The Entry Date shall mean:

     ( )  Annual Entry.  The first day of the Plan Year.  Note:  If Annual
          Entry is selected, the age and service requirements cannot exceed
          20-1/2 and 1/2 Eligibility Year of Service.  (1-1/2 Eligibility Years
          of Service for Employer Discretionary Contributions if 100% immediate
          vesting is elected.)

     ( )  Dual Entry.  The first day of the Plan Year and the first day of
          the seventh month of the Plan Year.

     ( )  Quarterly Entry.  The first day of the Plan Year and the first day
          of the fourth, seventh and tenth months of the Plan Year.

     ( )  Monthly Entry.  The first day of the Plan Year and the first day
          of each following month of the Plan Year.


 VI.  COMPENSATION

     Compensation shall mean all of each Participant's:

     ( )  Information required to be reported under Sections 6041, 6051,and
          6052 of the Code.  (Wages, tips and other compensation box on Form
          W-2) Compensation is defined as wages as defined in Section
          3401(a) and all other payments of compensation to the Employee by
          the Employer (in the course of the Employer's trade or business)
          for which the Employer is required to furnish the Employee a
          written statement under Sections 6041(d) and 6051(a)(3) of the
          Code.  Compensation must be determined without regard to any rules
          under Section 3401(a) that limit the remuneration included in
          wages based on the nature or location of the employment or
          services performed (such as the exception for agricultural labor
          in Section 3401(a)(2) of the Code).  This definition of
          Compensation shall exclude amounts paid or reimbursed by the
          Employer for moving expenses incurred by an Employee, but only to
          the extent that at the time of the payment it is reasonable to
          believe that these amounts are deductible by the Employee under
          Section 217 of the Code.

     ( )  Section 3401(a) wages.  Compensation is defined as wages within
          the meaning of Section 3401(a) of the Code for purposes of income
          tax withholding at the source but determined without regard to any
          rules that limit the remuneration included in wages based on the
          nature or location of the employment or the services performed
          (such as the exception for agricultural labor in Section
          3401(a)(2) of the Code).

     ( )  Section 415 safe-harbor compensation.  Compensation is defined as
          wages, salaries, and fees for professional services and other
          amounts received (without regard to whether or not an amount is
          paid in cash) for personal services actually rendered in the
          course of employment with the Employer to the extent that the
          amounts are includible in gross income (including, but not limited
          to, commissions paid salesmen, compensation for services on the
          basis of a percentage of profits, commissions on insurance
          premiums, tips, bonuses, fringe benefits, and reimbursements or
          other expense allowances under a nonaccountable plan (as described
          in Section 1.62-2(c)), and excluding the following:

          (a)  Employer contributions to a plan of deferred compensation
               which are not includible in the Employee's gross income for
               the taxable year in which contributed, or Employer
               contributions under a simplified employee pension plan
               described in Section 408(k), or any distributions from a plan
               of deferred compensation regardless of whether such amounts
               are includible in the gross income of the Employee;

          (b)  Amounts realized from the exercise of a nonqualified stock
               option, or when restricted stock (or property) held by the
               Employee either becomes freely transferable or is no longer
               subject to a substantial risk of forfeiture;
          (c)  Amounts realized from the sale, exchange or other disposition
               of stock acquired under a qualified stock option; and

          (d)  Other amounts which receive special tax benefits, such as
               premiums for group-term life insurance (but only to the
               extent that the premiums are not includible in the gross
               income of the Employee), or contributions made by the
               Employer (whether or not under a salary reduction agreement)
               towards the purchase of an annuity contract described in
               Section 403(b) of the Code (whether or not the contributions
               are actually excludable from the gross income of the
               Employee).

     which is actually paid to the Participant during

          ( )  the Plan Year.

          ( )  the calendar year ending with or within the Plan Year.

     ( )  Compensation shall be reduced by all of the following items (even
          if includible in gross income):  reimbursements or other expense
          allowances, fringe benefits (cash and noncash), moving expenses,
          deferred compensation and welfare benefits.

     Compensation ( ) shall; ( ) shall not include Employer contributions
     made pursuant to a salary reduction agreement with an Employee which
     are not includible in the gross income of the Employee by reason of
     Sections 125, 402(e)(3), 402(h)(1)(B) or 403(b) of the Code.

     For any Self-Employed Individual covered under the Plan, Compensation
     means Earned Income.



VII. LIMITATION YEAR

     Limitation Year shall mean the 12-consecutive-month period:

     ( )  Identical to the Plan Year.

     ( )  Identical to the Employer's fiscal year ending with or within the
          Plan Year of reference.

     ( )  As fixed by a resolution of the Board of Directors of the
          Employer, or the Employer if no Board of Directors exists.


VIII.     NORMAL RETIREMENT AGE

     Normal Retirement Age shall mean:

     ( )  Age [....] (not to exceed 65).

     ( )  The later of:
          ( )  (i) age [....] (not to exceed 65), or

          ( )  (ii)the [....] (not to exceed 5th) anniversary of the
               participation commencement date.  If, for Plan Years
               beginning before January 1, 1988, normal retirement age was
               determined with reference to the anniversary of the
               participation commencement date (more than 5 but not to
               exceed 10 years), the anniversary date for Participants who
               first commenced participation under the Plan before the first
               Plan Year beginning on or after January 1, 1988, shall be the
               earlier of (A) the tenth anniversary of the date the
               Participant commenced participation in the plan (or such
               anniversary as had been elected by the Employer, if less than
               10) or (B) the fifth anniversary of the first Plan Year
               beginning on or after January 1, 1988.  The participation
               commencement date is the first day of the first Plan Year in
               which the Participant commenced participation in the Plan.

 IX.  EARLY RETIREMENT AGE

     Early Retirement Age shall mean:

     ( )  There shall be no early retirement provision in this Plan.

     ( )  Age [....].

     ( )  Age [....] and [....] Years of Service.


X.   EMPLOYER CONTRIBUTIONS

     A.   Employer Contributions

          For each Plan Year the Employer will contribute for each
          Participant who either completes more than 500 Hours of Service
          (if the Plan utilizes the elapsed time method in lieu of counting
          Hours of Service, the completion of either 91 consecutive calendar
          days or 3 consecutive calendar months may be substituted for 500
          Hours of Service) during the Plan Year or is employed on the last
          day of the Plan Year the annual Employer contribution calculated
          below.  The annual Employer contribution necessary to fund the
          Stated Benefit with respect to a Participant will be determined
          each year as follows:

          Step 1:  If the Participant has not yet reached Normal Retirement
          Age, calculate the present value of the Stated Benefit by
          multiplying the Stated Benefit by the factor that is the product
          of: i) the applicable factor in Table I (if attained (current) age
          is less than 65) or Table IA (if attained age is greater than or
          equal to 65), multiplied by (ii) the applicable factor in Table
      III.  If the Participant is at or beyond Normal Retirement Age,
calculate the present value of the Stated Benefit by multiplying the Stated
Benefit by the factor in Table IV corresponding to that Normal Retirement
Age.

          Step 2:  Calculate the excess, if any, of the amount determined in
          Step 1 over the Theoretical Reserve (see below).

          Step 3:  Amortize the result in Step 2 by multiplying it by the
          applicable factor from Table II.  For the Plan Year in which the
          Participant attains Normal Retirement Age and for any subsequent
          Plan Year, the applicable fact is 1.0.

          For purposes of this Section, the Theoretical Reserve is
          determined according to (i) and (ii) below:

               (i) Initial Theoretical Reserve.  A Participant's
                   Theoretical Reserve as of the last day of  the
                   Participant's  first year of projected participation
                   (year 1) is zero.  However, if this Plan is a prior safe
                   harbor plan with a stated benefit formula that takes
                   into account Plan Years prior to the first Plan Year
                   this Plan satisfies the safe harbor in Regulations
                   Section 1.401(a)(4)-8(b)(3)(C), the initial Theoretical
                   Reserve is determined as follows:

                   (A)  Calculate as of the last day of the Plan Year
                   immediately preceding year 1 the present value of the
                   Stated Benefit, using the actuarial assumptions, the
                   provisions of the Plan, and the Participant's
                   Compensation as of such date.  For a Participant who is
                   beyond Normal Retirement Age during year 1, the Stated
                   Benefit will be determined using the actuarial
                   assumptions, the provisions of the Plan, and the
                   Participant's Compensation as of such date, except that
                   the straight life annuity factor used in that
                   determination will be the factor applicable for the
                   Participant's Normal Retirement Age.

                   (B)  Calculate as of the last day of the Plan Year
                   immediately preceding year 1 the present value of future
                   Employer contributions, i.e., the contributions due each
                   Plan Year using the actuarial assumptions, the
                   provisions of the Plan (disregarding those provisions of
                   the Plan providing for the limitations of Section 415 of
                   the Code or the minimum contributions under Section 416
                   of the Code), and the Participant's Compensation as of
                   such date, beginning with year 1 through the end of the
                   Plan Year in which the Participant attains Normal
                   Retirement Age.

                   (C)  Subtract the amount determined in (B) from the
                   amount determined in (A).

               (ii)Accumulate the initial Theoretical Reserve determined in
                   (i) and the Employer contribution (as limited by Section
                   415 of the Code, but without regard to any required
                   minimum contributions under Section 416 for each Plan
                   Year beginning in year 1 up through the last day of the
                   current Plan Year (excluding contributions(s) (if any)
                   for the current Plan Year) using the Plan's interest
                   assumption in effect for each such year.  In any Plan
                   Year following the Plan Year in which the Participant
                   attains Normal Retirement Age, the accumulation is
                   calculated assuming an interest rate of 0%.

          For purposes of determining the level of annual Employer
          contribution necessary to fund the Stated Benefit, the
          calculations in (i) and (ii) above will be made as of the last day
          of each Plan Year, on the basis of the Participant's age on the
          Participant's last birthday, using the interest rate in effect on
          the last day of the prior Plan Year.

          For purposes of determining the annual Employer contribution
          necessary to fund the Stated Benefit, the interest rate will be:

               (  )     7.50%
               (  )     8.00%
               (  )     8.50%


          TABLE I:  Present value factors (See * below)
          _______                         _____________
     Number of years              Interest Rate

     ________________             _____________


     from attained age
        to age 65*                7.50%         8.00%         8.50%
        __________                _____         ______        _____
           1                 7.868         7.589         7.326
           2                 7.319         7.027         6.752
           3                 6.808         6.506         6.223
           4                 6.333         6.024         5.736
           5                 5.891         5.578         5.286
           6                 5.480         5.165         4.872
           7                 5.098         4.782         4.491
           8                 4.742         4.428         4.139
           9                 4.412         4.100         3.815
          10                 4.104         3.796         3.516
          11                 3.817         3.515         3.240
          12                 3.551         3.255         2.986
          13                 3.303         3.014         2.752
          14                 3.073         2.790         2.537
          15                 2.859         2.584         2.338
          16                 2.659         2.392         2.155
          17                 2.474         2.215         1.986
          18                 2.301         2.051         1.831
          19                 2.140         1.899         1.687
          20                 1.991         1.758         1.555
          21                 1.852         1.628         1.433
          22                 1.723         1.508         1.321
          23                 1.603         1.396         1.217
          24                 1.491         1.293         1.122
          25                 1.387         1.197         1.034
          26                 1.290         1.108         0.953
          27                 1.200         1.026         0.878
          28                 1.116         0.950         0.810
          29                 1.039         0.880         0.746
          30                 0.966         0.814         0.688
          31                 0.899         0.754         0.634
          32                 0.836         0.698         0.584
          33                 0.778         0.647         0.538
          34                 0.723         0.599         0.496
          35                 0.673         0.554         0.457
          36                 0.626         0.513         0.422
          37                 0.582         0.475         0.389
          38                 0.542         0.440         0.358
          39                 0.504         0.407         0.330
          40                 0.469         0.377         0.304
          41                 0.436         0.349         0.280
          42                 0.406         0.323         0.258
          43                 0.377         0.299         0.238
          44                 0.351         0.277         0.219
          45                 0.327         0.257         0.202

     *    If a Participant's attained age is at or above 65 but still below
          the Participant's Normal Retirement Age, use Table IA.
     Note:                   These factors are based on the UP-1984
                             Mortality Table.
           TABLE IA:  Present value factors for Participants below Normal
          _________
          Retirement Age (to be used only when attained age is greater than,
          or equal to, 65.)

      Number of years        Interest Rate
      from age 65 to         ______________
        attained age         7.50%    8.00%     8.50%
        ____________         ______   _______   ______
          0             8.458         8.196          7.949
          1             9.092         8.852          8.625
          2             9.774         9.560          9.358
          3             10.507        10.325         10.153
          4             11.295        11.151         11.016
          5             12.143        12.043         11.953
          6             13.053        13.006         12.969
          7             14.032        14.047         14.071
          8             15.085        15.170         15.267
          9             16.216        16.384         16.565
          10            17.432        17.695         17.973
          11            18.740        19.110         19.500
          12            20.145        20.639         21.158
          13            21.656        22.290         22.956
          14            23.280        24.073         24.907
          15            25.026        25.999         27.025

     Note:     These factors are based on the UP-1984 Mortality Table.

          TABLE II:  Amortization factors
          _________
     Number of years
     from attained age       Interest Rate

     __________________      ______________
         to Normal
       Retirement Age             7.50%         8.00%         8.50%
       _______________            _____         ______        ______
           1                 0.5181        0.5192        0.5204
           2                 0.3577        0.3593        0.3609
           3                 0.2777        0.2796        0.2184
           4                 0.2299        0.2139        0.2339
           5                 0.1982        0.2003        0.2024
           6                 0.1756        0.1778        0.1801
           7                 0.1588        0.1611        0.1634
           8                 0.1458        0.1482        0.1506
           9                 0.1355        0.1380        0.1405
          10                 0.1272        0.1297        0.1323
          11                 0.1203        0.1229        0.1255
          12                 0.1145        0.1171        0.1198
          13                 0.1096        0.1123        0.1151
          14                 0.1054        0.1082        0.1110
          15                 0.1018        0.1046        0.1075
          16                 0.0986        0.0988        0.1018
          17                 0.0958        0.0988        0.1018
          18                 0.0934        0.0964        0.0994
          19                 0.0912        0.0943        0.0974
          20                 0.0893        0.0924        0.0956
          21                 0.0876        0.0908        0.0940
          22                 0.0861        0.0893        0.0925
          23                 0.0847        0.0879        0.0912
          24                 0.0835        0.0867        0.0901
          25                 0.0823        0.0857        0.0890
          26                 0.0813        0.0847        0.0881
          27                 0.0804        0.0838        0.0872
          28                 0.0795        0.0830        0.0865
          29                 0.0788        0.0822        0.0858
          30                 0.0781        0.0816        0.0851
          31                 0.0774        0.0810        0.0846
          32                 0.0768        0.0804        0.0840
          33                 0.0763        0.0804        0.0836
          34                 0.0758        0.0794        0.0831
          35                 0.0753        0.0790        0.0827
          36                 0.0749        0.0786        0.0824
          37                 0.0745        0.0783        0.0820
          38                 0.0742        0.0779        0.0817
          39                 0.0739        0.0776        0.0815
          40                 0.0736        0.0774        0.0812
          41                 0.0733        0.0771        0.0810
          42                 0.0730        0.0769        0.0808
          43                 0.0728        0.0767        0.0806
          44                 0.0726        0.0765        0.0804
          45                 0.0724        0.0763        0.0802
           TABLE III:  Factors to be multiplied by those in Table I.
           ________
           Normal
         Retirement          Interest Rate

         ___________         ______________
            Age                   7.50%         8.00%         8.50%
            ____                  ______        _____         ______
          80                 0.206              0.194              0.184
          79                 0.231              0.219              0.207
          78                 0.258              0.246              0.234
          77                 0.289              0.276              0.263
          76                 0.322              0.309              0.296
          75                 0.359              0.346              0.333
          74                 0.400              0.387              0.374
          73                 0.446              0.432              0.419
          72                 0.495              0.482              0.469
          71                 0.549              0.537              0.525
          70                 0.609              0.597              0.586
          69                 0.674              0.664              0.653
          68                 0.745              0.736              0.728
          67                 0.822              0.816              0.810
          66                 0.907              0.904              0.900
          65                 1.000              1.000              1.000
          64                 1.101              1.106              1.110
          63                 1.212              1.221              1.231
          62                 1.332              1.348              1.363
          61                 1.464              1.486              1.509
          60                 1.606              1.637              1.669
          59                 1.761              1.802              1.844
          58                 1.929              1.982              2.036
          57                 2.111              2.177              2.246
          56                 2.309              2.390              2.475
          55                 2.523              2.622              2.726

     Note:     These factors are based on the UP-1984 Mortality Table.
      TABLE IV:  Factors for Participants who are at or beyond Normal
     _________
     Retirement Age.

           Normal                 Interest Rate

           _______                ______________
         Retirement
            Age                   7.50%         8.00%    8.50%
            ___                   ______        _____    ______
          80                 5.151              5.053         4.959
          79                 5.370              5.264         5.162
          78                 5.591              5.476         5.366
          77                 5.814              5.690         5.572
          76                 6.039              5.905         5.777
          75                 6.266              6.122         5.985
          74                 6.494              6.339         6.192
          73                 6.721              6.556         6.398
          72                 6.947              6.771         6.603
          71                 7.171              7.983         6.804
          70                 7.392              7.192         7.003
          69                 7.610              7.399         7.198
          68                 7.825              7.601         7.389
          67                 8.037              7.801         7.577
          66                 8.248              7.999         7.764
          65                 8.458              8.196         7.949
          64                 8.666              8.390         8.131
          63                 8.870              8.581         8.311
          62                 9.072              8.770         8.485
          61                 9.270              8.954         8.657
          60                 9.463              9.133         8.825
          59                 9.651              9.307         8.986
          58                 9.834              9.477         9.143
          57                 10.012             9.461         9.295
          56                 10.186             9.801         9.442
          55                 10.354             9.955         9.585

     Note:     These factors are based on the UP-1984 Mortality Table.

     B.   Nonintegrated Benefit Formula

     (  ) Flat Benefit

     Each Participant's Stated Benefit is equal to _____% of Average
     Annual Compensation (reduced pro rate for the Participant's years of
     projected participation less that 25) payable annually as a straight
     life annuity beginning at Normal Retirement Age.

     (  ) Unit Credit

     Each Participant's Stated Benefit is equal to _____% of Average Annual
     Compensation multiplied by the Participant's  years of projected
     participating up to a maximum of ______ (no less than 25), payable
     annually as a straight life annuity beginning at Normal Retirement Age.
     The first day of the first Plan Year taken into account under this
     Stated Benefit formula will be ________.
     (  ) Step Rate

     Each Participant's Stated Benefit will be payable annually as a
     straight life annuity beginning at Normal Retirement Age, in an amount
     equal to _____percent of Average Annual Compensation (R1) per year
     for the first _____years  of the Participant's  years of projected
     participation (y) and ____percent (R2) of Average Annual Compensation
     per year for the next _____years of the Participant's  years of
     projected participation (such that the total years of projected
     participation taken into account under R1 and R2 is not less than 33).

     If y is less that 33, R2 will be not less than:


          (R1) - (25 - y)
          _______________
              33 - y

     (but in no case less than 0),

     and not greater than:  (R1) (44 - y).
                             _____________
                                33 - y

     For purposes of determining a Participant's Stated Benefit, a
     Participant's years of projected participation under the Plan is the
     sum of (1) and (2), where (1) is the number of years during which the
     Participant benefited under this Plan beginning with the latest of: (a)
     the first Plan Year in which the Participant benefited under the Plan,
     (b) the first Plan Year taken into account in the Stated Benefit
     formula, and (c) any Plan Year immediately following a Plan Year in
     which the Plan did not satisfy the safe harbor for target benefit plans
     in Regulations Section 1.401(a)(4)-8(b)(3), and ending with the last
     day of the current Plan Year, and (2) is the number of years, if any,
     subsequent to the current Plan Year through the end of the Plan Year in
     which the Participant attains Normal Retirement Age.

     For purposes of this definition of Years of Projected Participation, if
     this Plan is a prior safe harbor plan, the Plan is deemed to satisfy
     the safe harbor for target benefit plans in Regulations Section
     1.401(a)(4)-8(b)(3) and a Participant is treated as benefiting under
     the Plan in any Plan Year beginning prior to January 1, 1994.

     A prior safe harbor plan is a plan that (1) was adopted and in effect
     on September 19, 1991, (2) which on that date contained a stated
     benefit formula that took into account service prior to that date, and
     (3) satisfied the applicable nondiscrimination requirements for target
     benefit plans for those prior years.  For purposes of determining
     whether a plan satisfies the applicable nondiscrimination requirements
     for target benefit plans for Plan Years beginning before January 1,
     1994, no amendments after September 19, 1991, other than amendments
     necessary to satisfy Section 401(l) of the Code, will be taken into
     account.

     For purposes of this Section, Average Annual Compensation means the
     average of a Participant's annual Compensation, as defined in Article
     VI of the Plan, over the three (3) consecutive plan year period ending
     in the current year or in any prior year that produces the highest
     average.  If the Participant has less than three (3) years of
     participation in this Plan, Compensation is averaged over the
     Participant's total period of participation.

     C.  Integrated Benefit Formula

     Subject to the overall permitted disparity limit below, each
     Participant's  Stated Benefit under the Plan is a straight life annuity
     commencing at Normal Retirement Age in an amount:

     [EXCESS BENEFIT PLAN]

     (  ) Unit Benefit

     Equal to the sum of (a) and (b) below:

          (a) ______% (base benefit percentage) times Average Annual
          Compensation up to the Integration Level for the Plan Year times
          the Participant's  years of projected participation plus a benefit
          equal to ____% (excess benefit percentage, not to exceed the
          base benefit percentage by more than the Maximum Excess Allowance)
          times Average Annual Compensation in excess of the Integration
          Level for the Plan Year times the Participant's  years of
          projected participation.  The maximum number of  years of
          projected participation taken into account under this paragraph
          (a) will be __________(may not be less than 25 and may not exceed
          35).  However, the number of  years of projected participation
          taken into account in the preceding sentence for any Participant
          may not exceed the Participant's Cumulative Permitted Disparity
          Limit.

     The Participant's Cumulative Permitted Disparity Limit is equal to 35
     minus: (1) the number of years the Participant benefited under this
     Plan prior to the Participant's first year of projected participation,
     and (2) the number of years  credited to the Participant for allocation
     or accrual purposes under one or more qualified plans or simplified
     employee pension plans (whether or not terminated) ever maintained by
     the Employer) other than years counted in (1) above or counted toward a
     Participant's years of projected participation). For purposes of
     determining the Participant's Cumulative Permitted Disparity Limit, all
     Plan Years ending in the same calendar year are treated as the same
     year.

     (b) ____% (not to exceed the excess benefit percentage) times Average
     Annual Compensation for each year of projected participation after the
     period taken into account under paragraph (a).  (If the number of years
     of projected participation taken into account under paragraph (a) is
     less than 35 (as modified by the Participant's Cumulative Permitted
     Disparity Limit), then for each year of projected participation after
     the period taken into account under  paragraph (a) up to and including
     the 35th year of participation (as modified by the Participant's
     Cumulative Permitted Disparity Limit), this percentage will be equal to
     the excess benefit percentage.)  The maximum number of years of
     projected participation taken into account under this paragraph will be

________________________________________________________________________.


     The Maximum Excess Allowance is equal to the lesser of:  (1) the base
     benefit percentage, or (2) the applicable factor determined from Tables
     I or II in Section B below.

     Overall permitted disparity limit:  Notwithstanding paragraphs (a) and
     (b) above, for any Plan Year this Plan benefits any Participant who
     benefits under another qualified plan or simplified employee pension
     maintained by the Employer that provides for permitted disparity (or
     imputes permitted disparity), the Stated Benefit for all Participants
     under this Plan will be equal to the excess benefit percentage above
     times the Participant's total Average Annual Compensation times the
     Participant's years of projected participation under the Plan up to the
     maximum  years of projected participation taken into account in
     paragraphs (a) and (b).

     (  ) Flat Benefit

     Equal to ___% times Average Annual Compensation up to the Integration
     Level for the Plan Year (base benefit percentage) plus a benefit equal
     to ____% (excess benefit percentage) (not to exceed the base benefit
     percentage by more than the Maximum Excess Allowance) times Average
     Annual Compensation in excess of the Integration Level for the Plan
     Year.

     The Maximum Excess Allowance is equal to the lesser of:  (1) the base
     benefit percentage, or (2) 35 times the applicable factor determined
     from Tables I or II in Section B below.

     For a Participant with less than 35 years of projected participation,
     the base benefit percentage and the excess benefit percentage will be
     reduced by being multiplied by a fraction, the numerator of which is
     the Participant's  years of projected participation, and the
     denominator of which is 35.

     Cumulative permitted disparity reduction:  If the number of the
     Participant's cumulative permitted disparity years exceeds 35, the
     excess benefit percentage will be reduced as provided below.  A
     Participant's cumulative permitted disparity years consists of the sum
     of:  (1) the Participant's  years of projected Participation (up to
     35), (2) the number of years the Participant benefited or is treated as
     having benefited under this Plan prior to the Participant's first year
     of projected participation, to the Participant's first year of
     projected participation, and (3) the number of years credited to the
     Participant for allocation or accrual purposes under  one or more
     qualified plans or simplified employee pension plans (whether or not
     terminated) ever maintained by the employer (other than years counted
     in (1) or (2) above.)  For purposes of determining the Participant's
     Cumulative Permitted Disparity Limit, all Plan Years ending in the same
     calendar year are treated as the same year.

     If the cumulative permitted disparity reduction is applicable, the
     excess benefit percentage will  be reduced as follows:

     (A)  Subtract the Participant's base benefit percentage from the
     participant's excess benefit percentage, (after modification in
     accordance with the paragraph preceding this cumulative permitted
     disparity reduction).

     (B)  Multiply the result determined in (A) by a fraction (not less than
     0), the numerator of which is 35 minus the sum of the years in (2) and
     (3) above, and the denominator of which is 35.

     (C)  The Participant's excess benefit percentage is equal to the sum of
     the result in (B) and the Participant's base benefit percentage, as
     otherwise modified.

     Overall permitted disparity limit:  Notwithstanding the above, for any
     Plan Year this Plan benefits any Participant who benefits under another
     qualified plan or simplified employee pension plan maintained by the
     Employer that provides for permitted disparity, (or imputes permitted
     disparity), the  Stated Benefit for all Participants under this Plan
     will be equal to the excess benefit percentage entered into the benefit
     formula above multiplied by the Participant's total Average Annual
     Compensation under the Plan (prorated for years of projected
     participation less than 35).

     [OFFSET PLAN]

     (  ) Unit Credit

     Equal to the sum of (a) and (b) below:

     (a)  ____% (gross benefit percentage) times Average Annual
     Compensation for the Plan Year times the Participant's  years of
     projected participation offset by ______% (not to exceed the
     Maximum Offset Allowance) times Final Average Compensation up to the
     Offset Level times the Participant's total years of projected
     participation.  The maximum number of years of projected participation
     taken into account under this paragraph will be ______(may not be
     less than 25 and may not exceed 35).  However, the number of years of
     projected participation taken into account in the preceding sentence
     for any Participant may not exceed the Participant's Cumulative
     Permitted Disparity Limit.  The Participant's Cumulative Permitted
     Disparity Limit is equal to 35 minus:  (1) the number of years the
     Participant benefited under this Plan prior to the Participant's first
     year of projected participation, and (2) the number of years  credited
     to the Participant for allocation or accrual purposes under one or more
     qualified plans or simplified employee pension plans (whether or not
     terminated) ever maintained by the Employer (other than years counted
     in (1) above or counted toward a Participant's  years of projected
     participation).  For purposes of determining the Participant's
     Cumulative Permitted Disparity Limit, all Plan Years ending in the same
     calendar year are treated as the same year.

     (b)  ___% (not to exceed the gross benefit percentage) times Average
     Annual Compensation for each year of projected participation after the
     period set forth in paragraph (a).  (If the number of years of
     projected participation set forth in  paragraph (a) is less than 35 (as
     modified by the Participant's Cumulative Permitted Disparity Limit),
     then for each year of projected participation after the period set
     forth  under paragraph (a) up to and including the 35th year of
     projected participation (as modified by the Participant's Cumulative
     Permitted Disparity Limit), this percentage will be equal to the gross
     benefit percentage.)  The maximum number of years of projected
     participation taken into account under this paragraph will be ______.



     The maximum offset allowance will not exceed the lesser of:  (1) the
     applicable factor from Tables I or II below, and (2) one-half of the
     gross benefit percentage, multiplied by a fraction (not to exceed one),
     the numerator of which is the Participant's Average Annual
     Compensation, and the denominator of which is the Participant's Final
     Average Compensation up to the Offset Level.

     Overall permitted disparity limit:  Notwithstanding the preceding
     paragraphs (a) and (b), for any Plan Year this Plan benefits any
     Participant who benefits under another qualified plan or simplified
     employee pension plan maintained by the Employer that provides for
     permitted disparity (or imputes permitted disparity), the  Stated
     Benefit for all Participants under this Plan will be equal to the gross
     benefit percentage above (without regard to the offset) times the
     Participant's total Average Annual Compensation times the Participant's
     years of projected participation under the Plan up to the maximum of
     years of projected participation taken into account  in paragraphs (a)
     and (b).

     (  ) Flat Benefit

     Equal to ____% times Average Annual Compensation offset by _____%
     (not to exceed the Maximum Offset Allowance) times Final Average
     Compensation up to the Offset Level.

     The Maximum Offset Allowance will not exceed the lesser of:  (1) the
     applicable factor from Tables I or II, multiplied by 35, and (2) one-
     half of the gross benefit percentage, multiplied by a fraction (not to
     exceed one), the numerator of which is the Participant's Average Annual
     Compensation, and the denominator of which is the Participant's Final
     Average Compensation up to the Offset Level.

     For a Participant with less that 35  years of projected participation,
     both the gross benefit percentage and the offset percentage will be
     reduced by being multiplied by a fraction, the numerator of which is
     the number of the Participant's years of projected participation, and
     the denominator of which is 35.

     Cumulative permitted disparity reduction:  If the number of the
     Participant's cumulative permitted disparity years exceeds 35, the
     gross benefit percentage and the offset will be further reduced as
     provided below.  A Participant's cumulative permitted disparity years
     consist of the sum of:  (1) the Participant's  years of projected
     participation (up to 35), (2) the number of years the Participant
     benefited or is treated as having benefited under this Plan prior to
     the Participant's first year of projected participation, to the
     Participant's first year of projected participation, and (3) the number
     of years credited to the Participant for allocation or accrual purposes
     under  one or more qualified plans or simplified employee pension plans
     (whether or not terminated) ever maintained by the Employer (other than
     years counted in (1) or (2) above.  For purposes of determining the
     Participant's Cumulative Permitted Disparity Limit, all Plan Years
     ending in the same calendar year are treated as the same year.

     If the cumulative permitted disparity reduction is applicable, the
     gross benefit percentage and the offset will be reduced as follows:

     (A)  The offset will be reduced by multiplying it by a fraction (not
          less than 0), the numerator of which is 35 minus the sum of the
          years in (2) and (3) above, and the denominator of which is 35.

     (B)  The gross benefit percentage will be reduced by the number of
          percentage points by which the offset was reduced in (A) above.

     Overall permitted disparity limit:  Notwithstanding the above, for any
     Plan Year this Plan benefits any Participant who benefits under another
     qualified plan or simplified employee pension plan maintained by the
     Employer that provides for permitted disparity (or imputes permitted
     disparity), the Stated Benefit for all Participants under this Plan
     will be equal to the gross benefit percentage entered in the benefit
     formula above (without regard to the offset) multiplied by the
     Participant's total Average Annual Compensation under the Plan
     (prorated for years of projected participation less than 35).

     The applicable factor is the factor derived from the applicable
     table(s) below based on the Normal Retirement Age under the Plan.  If
     the Employer elects as an Integration Level (or Offset Level) option 4
     or option 5 below, Table II will apply.  Otherwise, Table I will apply.

     Normal Retirement Age        TABLE I  TABLE II
     ______________________       ________  _______
          65                 0.5200   0.4160
          64                 0.4856   0.3884
          63                 0.4504   0.3603
          62                 0.4160   0.3328
          61                 0.3816   0.3052
          60                 0.3464   0.2771
          59                 0.3296   0.2636
          58                 0.3120   0.2496
          57                 0.2944   0.2355
          56                 0.2776   0.2220
          55                 0.2600   0.2080

     The Integration Level (or Offset Level) for each Plan Year for each
     Participant will be an amount equal to:

     (1) (  ) such Participant's Covered Compensation for the Plan Year.

     (2) (  ) the greater of $10,000 or one-half of the Covered Compensation
     of any individual who attains social security retirement age during the
     calendar year in which the Plan Year begins.

     (3) (  ) $_____(a single dollar amount not to exceed the greater of
     $10,000 or one-half of Covered Compensation of any individual who
     attains social security retirement age during the calendar year in
     which the Plan Year begins).

     (4) (  ) $ _____(a single dollar amount that exceeds the greater of
     $10,000 or one-half of Covered Compensation of any individual who
     attains social security retirement age during the calendar year in
     which the Plan Year begins, but not to exceed the greater of $25,450 or
     150% of the Covered Compensation of an individual attaining social
     security retirement age in the current Plan Year).

     (5) (  ) a uniform percentage equal to ____% (greater than 100
     percent but not greater than 150 percent of each Participant's Covered
     Compensation for the current year, and in no event in excess of the
     Taxable Wage Base).

     Definitions
     ___________
     1.   A Participant's years of projected participation under the Plan is
     the sum of  (1) and (2), where (1) is the number of years during which
     the Participant benefited under this Plan beginning with the latest of:
     (a) the first Plan Year in which the Participant benefited under the
     Plan, (b) the first Plan Year taken into account in the stated benefit
     formula, and (c) any Plan Year immediately following a Plan Year in
     which the Plan did not satisfy  the safe harbor for target benefit
     plans in Regulations Section 1.401(a)(4)-8(b)(3), and ending with the
     last day of the current Plan Year and (2) is the number of years if,
     any, subsequent to the current Plan Year through the end of the Plan
     Year in which the Participant attains Normal Retirement Age.

          For purposes of this definition of years of projected
          participation, if this Plan is a prior safe harbor plan the Plan
          is deemed to satisfy the safe harbor for target benefit plans in
          Regulation Section 1.401(a)(4)-8(b)(3) and a Participant is
          treated as benefiting under the Plan in any Plan Year beginning
          prior to January 1, 1994.

          A prior safe harbor plan is a plan that (1) was adopted and in
          effect on September 19, 1991, (2) which on that date contained a
          stated benefit formula that took into account service prior to
          that date and (3) satisfied the applicable nondiscrimination
          requirements for target benefit plans for those prior years.  For
          purposes of determining whether a plan satisfies the applicable
          nondiscrimination requirements for target benefit plans for Plan
          Years beginning before January 1, 1994, no amendments after
          September 19,1991, other than amendments necessary to satisfy
          Section 401(l) of the Code, will be taken into account.

     2.   Average Annual Compensation.  Average Annual Compensation is the
     average of a Participant's annual Compensation as defined in
     Section VI of the Plan, over the three-consecutive Plan Year
     period ending in either the current year or any prior year that
     produces the highest average.  If the Participant has less than
     three  years of participation in this Plan, Compensation is
     averaged over the Participant's total period of participation.

     3.   Covered Compensation.  A Participant's Covered Compensation for a
     Plan Year is the average (without indexing) of the Taxable Wage Bases
     in effect for each calendar year during the 35-year period ending with
     the last day of the calendar year in which the Participant attains (or
     will attain) social security retirement age.

     In determining a Participant's Covered Compensation for a Plan Year,
     the Taxable Wage Base in effect for the current Plan Year and any
     subsequent Plan Year will be assumed to be the same as the Taxable Wage
     Base in effect as of the beginning of the Plan Year for which the
     determination is being made.  Covered Compensation will be determined
     based on the year designated by the Employer in the last paragraph of
     X.C.5. of the Adoption Agreement below.

     A Participant's Covered Compensation for a Plan Year before the 35-year
     period ending with the last day of the calendar year in which the
     Participant attains social security retirement age is the Taxable Wage
     Base in effect as of the beginning of the Plan Year.  A Participant's
     Covered Compensation for a Plan Year after such 35-year period is the
     Participant's Covered Compensation for the Plan Year during which the
     35-year period ends.

     4.   Taxable Wage Base.  Taxable Wage Base is the contribution and
     benefit base in effect under Section 230 of the Social Security Act at
     the beginning of the Plan Year.

     5.    Final Average Compensation. (Offset plans only)  A Participant's
     Final Average Compensation is the average of the Participant's annual
     Compensation, as defined in Section VI above, from the Employer for the
     three-consecutive year period ending with or within the Plan Year.  If
     a Participant's entire period of employment with the Employer is less
     than three consecutive years, Compensation is averaged on an annual
     basis over the Participant's entire period of employment.  Compensation
     for any year in excess of the Taxable Wage Base in effect at the
     beginning of such year will not be taken into account.

     Covered compensation will be determined based on the following year:

     (  ) current year.

     (  ) _________year (may be the Covered Compensation for a Plan Year
earlier than the current Plan Year, provided the earlier Plan Year is the
same for all Participants and is not earlier that the later of (A) the Plan
Year that begins 5 years before the current Plan Year, and (B) the Plan Year
beginning in 1989.  If the Plan Year entered is more than five years prior
to the current Plan Year, the Participant's Covered Compensation will be
that determined under the Covered Compensation table for the Plan Year five
years prior to the current Plan Year).

   D. Forfeitures

     Forfeitures of Employer Contributions, if any, shall be used to reduce
     future Employer Contributions.


XI.  VESTING SERVICE - EXCLUSIONS

   All of an Employee's years of Service with the Employer shall be counted
   to determine the vested interest of such Employee except:

   ( )       Years of Service before age 18.

   ( )       Years of Service before the Employer maintained this Plan or a
             predecessor plan.

   ( )       Years of Service before the effective date of ERISA if such
             Service would have been disregarded under the Service Break
             rules of the prior plan in effect from time to time before such
             date.  For this purpose, Service Break rules are rules which
             result in the loss of prior vesting or benefit accruals, or
             deny an Employee's eligibility to participate by reason of
             separation or failure to complete a required period of Service
             within a specified period of time.

XII. VESTING SCHEDULES

   The vested interest of each Employee (who has an Hour of Service on or
   after January 1, 1989) in his Employer-derived account balance shall be
   determined on the basis of the following schedule:

   A.     Employer Contributions.

     ( )  100% immediately vested.  [Note:  Mandatory if more than 1
          Eligibility Year of Service is required.]

     ( )  100% immediately vested after [....] (not to exceed 5) years of
          Service.

     ( )  [....]% (not less than 20%) vested for each year of Service,
          beginning with the [....] (not more than the 3rd) year of Service
          until 100% vested.

     ( )  The Top Heavy Minimum Vesting Schedule selected in B., below.

     ( )  Other:  [....] (Note: Must be at least as favorable as any one of
          the above 4 options).

   B.     Top Heavy Minimum Vesting Schedules.

     One of the following schedules will be used for years when the Plan is
     or is deemed to be Top-Heavy.

     ( )  100% immediately vested after [....] (not to exceed 3) years of
          Service.

     ( )  20% vested after 2 years of Service, plus [....]% vested (not less
          than 20%) for each additional year of Service until 100% vested.

     ( )  Other: [....]  (Note: Must be at least as favorable as any one of
          the above two options.

     If the vesting schedule under the Plan shifts in or out of the Minimum
     Schedule above for any Plan Year because of the Plan's Top-Heavy
     status, such shift is an amendment to the vesting schedule and the
     election in Section 7.3 of the Plan applies.




XIII.     LIFE INSURANCE

   Life insurance ( ) shall; ( ) shall not be permitted.


XIV. LOANS

   Loans ( ) shall; ( ) shall not be permitted.


XV.  TOP-HEAVY PROVISIONS

   A.     Top Heavy Status

   ( )    The provisions of Article XIII of the Plan shall always apply.

   ( )    The provisions of Article XIII of the Plan shall only apply in
          Plan Years after 1983, during which the Plan is or becomes
          Top-Heavy.

   B.     Minimum Allocation

     If the Employer has adopted Sponsor's paired defined contribution plan
     number 01001, 01003, 01005 or 01006 in addition to this Plan and the
     definition of "Eligible Employee" in all paired plans is identical,
     then the minimum allocation required by Section 13.3 will be provided
     (  ) under this Plan; (  ) under such other paired defined contribution
     plan.  If the Employer has adopted Sponsor's paired defined benefit
     plan number 02001, then Participants in this Plan (and another paired
     defined contribution plan, if any) shall receive the Top Heavy minimum
     benefit contribution under the paired defined benefit plan and shall
     receive no minimum allocation.

     If a Participant in this Plan who is a Non-Key Employee is covered
     under another qualified plan maintained by the Employer, other than a
     paired plan of the Sponsor, the minimum Top Heavy allocation or benefit
     required under Section 416 of the Code shall be provided to such
     Non-Key Employee under:

     ( )  this Plan.

     ( )  the Employer's other qualified defined contribution plan.

     ( )  the Employer's qualified defined benefit plan.

     ( ) other: _________________________________________.




   C.     Determination of Present Value

     If the Employer maintains a defined benefit plan in addition to this
     Plan, and such plan fails to specify the interest rate and mortality
     table to be used for purposes of establishing present value to compute
     the Top-Heavy Ratio, then the following assumptions shall be used:

     Interest Rate [....]%      Mortality Table [....]%


XVI. LIMITATION ON ALLOCATIONS

   If the Employer maintains or has ever maintained another qualified plan
   (other than the Sponsor's paired defined contribution plan number 01001,
   01003, 01005, 01006 or the Sponsor's paired defined benefit plan number
   02001), in which any Participant in this Plan is (or was) a Participant
   or could possibly become a Participant, the Employer must complete this
   Section.  The Employer must also complete this Section if it maintains a
   welfare benefit fund, as defined in Section 419(e) of the Code, or an
   individual medical account, as defined in Section 415(l)(2) of the Code,
   under which amounts are treated as Annual Additions with respect to any
   Participant in the Plan.  (If the Employer maintains only paired plans of
   the Sponsor this Section should not be completed.)

   (A)    If a Participant is covered under another qualified defined
          contribution plan maintained by the Employer, other than a Master
          or Prototype Plan, Annual Additions for any Limitation Year shall
          be limited to comply with Section 415(c) of the Code:

     ( )  in accordance with Sections 6.4(e) - (j) as though the other plan
          were a Master or Prototype Plan.

     ( )  by freezing or reducing Annual Additions in the other qualified
          defined contribution plan.

     ( )  other: _________________________________________________________




   (B)    If a Participant is or has ever been a participant in a qualified
          defined benefit plan maintained by the Employer, the "1.0"
          aggregate limitation of Section 415(e) of the Code shall be
          satisfied by:

     ( )  freezing or reducing the rate of benefit accrual under the
          qualified defined benefit plan.

     ( )  freezing or reducing the Annual Additions under this Plan (or, if
          the Employer maintains more than one qualified defined
          contribution plan, as indicated in (A) above).

     ( )  other: ________________________________________


          ________________________________________________




XVII.     INVESTMENTS

   Participants ( ) shall; ( ) shall not be permitted to direct the
   investment of their Accounts in the investment options selected by the
   Employer or the Committee.


XVIII.    EMPLOYER REPRESENTATIONS

   The Employer hereby represents that:

   A.     It is aware of, and agrees to be bound by, the terms of the Plan.

   B.     It understands that the Sponsor will not furnish legal or tax
          advice in connection with the adoption or operation of the Plan
          and has consulted legal and tax counsel to the extent necessary.

   C.     The failure to properly fill out this Adoption Agreement may
          result in disqualification of the Plan.


XIX.  RELIANCE ON PLAN QUALIFICATION

   An Employer who has ever maintained or who later adopts any plan
   (including, after December 31, 1985, a welfare benefit fund, as defined
   in Section 419(e) of the Code, which provides post-retirement medical
   benefits allocated to separate accounts for Key Employees, as defined in
   Section 419A(d)(3) of the Code, or an individual medical account, as
   defined in Section 415(l)(2) of the Code) in addition to this Plan (other
   than the Sponsor's paired defined contribution plan number 01001, 01003,
   01005, 01006 or the Sponsor's paired defined benefit plan number 02001),
   may not rely on the opinion letter issued by the National Office of the
   Internal Revenue Service as evidence that this Plan is qualified under
   Section 401 of the Internal Revenue Code.  If an Employer who adopts or
   maintains multiple plans wishes to obtain reliance that his or her plans
   are qualified, application for a determination letter should be made to
   the appropriate key district office of the Internal Revenue Service.

   The Employer may not rely on the opinion letter issued by the National
   Office of the Internal Revenue Service as evidence that this Plan is
   qualified under Section 401 of the Code unless the terms of the Plan, as
   herein adopted or amended, that pertain to the requirements of Sections
   401(a)(4), 401(a)(17), 401(l), 401(a)(5), 410(b) and 414(s) of the Code,
   as amended by the Tax Reform Act of 1986, or later laws, (a) are made
   effective retroactively to the first day of the first Plan Year beginning
   after December 31, 1988 (or such later date on which these requirements
   first become effective with respect to this Plan); or (b) are made
   effective no later than the first day on which the Employer is no longer
   entitled, under regulations, to rely on a reasonable, good faith
   interpretation of these requirements, and the prior provisions of the
   Plan constitute such an interpretation.


XX.  PROTOTYPE PLAN DOCUMENTS

   This Adoption Agreement may be used only in conjunction with the Dreyfus
   Prototype Defined Contribution Plan, Basic Plan Document No. 01, and the
   Dreyfus Trust Agreement both as amended from time to time.  In the event
   the Sponsor amends the Basic Plan Document or this Adoption Agreement or
   discontinues this type of plan, it will inform the Employer.  The
   Sponsor, The Dreyfus Corporation is available to answer questions
   regarding the intended meaning of any Plan provisions, adoption of the
   Plan and the effect of an Opinion Letter, at 666 Old Country Road, Garden
   City, New York 11530 [(516) 296-3418].
 IN WITNESS WHEREOF, the Employer and the Trustee have executed this
instrument the ______day of ______, 19__.  If applicable, the appropriate
corporate seal has been affixed and attested to.


                       _______________________


                       Name of Business Entity


                       _________________________________


                       Signature (Sole Proprietors only)


                       By:____________________________________________


                         Name and Title (Corporations or Partnerships)


ATTEST:

____________________________
Secretary (Corporations only)

SEAL:


                       __________________
                       Name of Trustee(s)


                       ______________________________


                       Signature (Individual Trustee)


                       _____________________________


                       Signature (Individual Trustee)


                       By:______________________________________


                          Name and Title (Corporate Trustee only)



                            ADOPTION AGREEMENT
                DREYFUS EASY STANDARDIZED/PAIRED PROTOTYPE
                            MONEY PURCHASE PLAN

                             PLAN NUMBER 01005
                        IRS SERIAL NUMBER D262555a


The Employer named in section I.A. below hereby establishes or restates a
Money Purchase Plan ("Plan") and Custodial Account appointing The Dreyfus
Trust Company as the custodian ("Custodian") under the related custodial
agreement ("Custodial Agreement").  The Custodial Account shall consist of
such sums as shall be paid to the Custodian, the investments thereof and
earnings thereon.  The terms of the Plan are set forth in this Adoption
Agreement and the applicable provisions of the Dreyfus Prototype Defined
Contribution Plan, Basic Plan Document No. 01, and the Dreyfus Custodial
Agreement, both as amended from time to time, which are hereby adopted and
incorporated herein by reference.


I.   EMPLOYER DATA

     A.   Employer's Name:   [....]

               Address: [....]

     B.   The Employer is a ( ) partnership; ( ) sole proprietor.

     C.   If this is a new Plan, the Effective Date of the Plan is: [....]

     D.   If this is an amendment and restatement of an existing Plan, enter
          name of Plan [....] and date adopted [....].  The effective date
          of the amended Plan is: [....]


II.  ELIGIBILITY

     Each Eligible Employee will be eligible to participate in this Plan,
     except the following:

     ( )  Employees who have not attained the age of [....] (not to exceed
          age 21).

     ( )  Employees who have not completed [....] Eligibility Years of
          Service.  (May not exceed 2 years).

     NOTE:  The term Employee includes all employees of the Employer and any
     employer required to be aggregated with the Employer under Section
     414(b), (c), (m) or (o) of the Internal Revenue Code ("Code"), and
     individuals considered employees of any such employer under Section
     414(n) or (o) of the Code.

     If the Employer adopts Sponsor's paired defined contribution plan
     number 01003, 01004 or 01006 or paired defined benefit plan number
     02001 in addition to this Plan, the definition of "Eligible Employee"
     in all paired plans of the Employer must be identical in order for the
     Employer to be able to designate in Section VI one of the paired plans
     to provide the required minimum allocation to each Non-Key Employee in
     the event the Plan becomes Top-Heavy.  If the definition of "Eligible
     Employee" in all paired plans of the Employer is not identical, Section
     13.1 through 13.4 shall apply in the event the Plan becomes Top-Heavy.

III. NORMAL RETIREMENT AGE

     Normal Retirement Age shall mean age 59-1/2.


IV.  EMPLOYER CONTRIBUTIONS

     The Plan shall not be integrated with Social Security and the
     Employer's contribution will be [....]% (not to exceed 25% of the
     aggregate Compensation of Active Participants for the Plan Year).


V.   VESTING

     Vesting shall be full and immediate.

VI.  TOP-HEAVY RULE

     A.   Top Heavy Status

          The Top-Heavy provisions of Article XIII shall always apply.

     B.   Minimum Allocation

          If the Employer has adopted Sponsor's paired defined contribution
          plan number 01003, 01004, or 01006 in addition to this Plan and
          the definition of "Eligible Employee" in all paired plans is
          identical, then the minimum allocation required by Section 13.3
          will be provided ( ) under this Plan; ( ) under such other paired
          defined contribution plan.  If the Employer has adopted Sponsor's
          paired defined benefit plan number 02001, then Participants in
          this Plan (or another paired defined contribution plan) who are
          covered under the paired defined benefit plan shall receive the
          minimum top heavy benefit under the paired defined benefit plan
          and shall receive no minimum allocation.

          If a Participant in this Plan who is a Non-key Employee is covered
          under another qualified plan maintained by the Employer, other
          than a paired plan of the Sponsor, the minimum top heavy
          allocation or benefit required under Section 416 of the Code shall
          be provided to such Non-Key Employee under:

          ( )  this Plan.

          ( )  the Employer's other qualified defined contribution plan.
          ( )  the Employer's qualified defined benefit plan.

          ( )  other:_________________________________________






     C.   Determination of Present Value

          If the Employer maintains a defined benefit plan in addition to
          this Plan and such plan fails to specify the interest rate and
          mortality table to be used for purposes of establishing present
          value to compute the Top-Heavy Ratio, then the following
          assumptions shall be used:

          Interest Rate [....]%      Mortality Table [....]%


VII. LIMITATIONS ON ALLOCATIONS

     If the Employer maintains or has ever maintained another qualified plan
     (other than the Sponsor's paired defined contribution plan numbers
     01003, 01004, 01006, or the Sponsor's paired defined benefit plan
     number 02001), in which any Participant in this Plan is (or was) a
     Participant or could possibly become a Participant, the following
     provision(s) must apply.  The Employer must also complete this Section
     if it maintains a welfare benefit fund, as defined in Section 419(e) of
     the Code, or an individual medical account, as defined in Section
     415(l)(2) of the Code, under which amounts are treated as Annual
     Additions with respect to any Participant in the Plan.

     (a)  If the Participant is covered under another qualified defined
          contribution plan maintained by the Employer other than a Master
          or Prototype Plan, Annual Additions for any Limitation Year shall
          be limited to comply with Section 415(c) of the Code:

          ( )  in accordance with Sections 6.4(e) - (j) as though the other
               plan were a Master or Prototype Plan.

          ( )  by freezing or reducing Annual Additions in the other
               qualified defined contribution plan.

          ( )  other: -----------------------------------------------






     (b)  If a Participant is or has ever been a participant in a qualified
          defined benefit plan maintained by the Employer, the "1.0"
          aggregate limitation of Section 415(e) of the Code shall be
          satisfied by:

          ( )  freezing or reducing the rate of benefit accrual under the
               qualified defined benefit plan.

          ( )  freezing or reducing the Annual Additions under this Plan
               (or, if the Employer maintains more than one qualified
               defined contribution plan, as indicated in (a) above).

          ( )  other: __________________________________________________








VIII.     INVESTMENTS

     In accordance with the provisions of the Custodial Agreement, the
     Employer hereby directs the Custodian to invest the assets of the Fund
     as indicated per the attached Participant's Plans Detail form.

IX.  EMPLOYER REPRESENTATIONS

     The Employer hereby represents that:

     a.   It is aware of, and agrees to be bound by, the terms of the Plan.

     b.   It understands that the Sponsor will not furnish legal or tax
          advice in connection with the adoption or operation of the Plan
          and has consulted legal and tax counsel to the extent necessary.

     c.   The failure to properly fill out this Adoption Agreement may
          result in disqualification of the Plan.


X.   RELIANCE ON PLAN QUALIFICATION

     An Employer who has ever maintained or who later adopts any plan
     (including, after December 31, 1985, a welfare benefit fund, as defined
     in Section 419 (e) of the Code, which provides post-retirement medical
     benefits allocated to separate accounts for Key Employees, as defined
     in Section 419A(d)(3), or an individual medical account, as defined in
     Section 415(l)(2) of the Code) in addition to this Plan (other than the
     Sponsor's paired defined contribution plan number 01003, 01004, or
     01006 or the Sponsor's paired defined benefit plan number 02001), may
     not rely on the opinion letter issued by the National Office of the
     Internal Revenue Service as evidence that this Plan is qualified under
     Section 401 of the Internal Revenue Code.  If the Employer who adopts
     or maintains multiple plans wishes to obtain reliance that his or her
     plan(s) are qualified, application for a determination letter should be
     made to the appropriate Key District Director of Internal Revenue.

     The Employer may not rely on the opinion letter issued by the National
     Office of the Internal Revenue Service as evidence that this Plan is
     qualified under Section 401 of the Code unless the terms of the Plan,
     as herein adopted or amended, that pertain to the requirements of
     Sections 401(a)(4), 401(a)(17), 401(l), 401(a)(5), 410(b) and 414(s) of
     the Code, as amended by the Tax Reform Act of 1986, or later laws, (a)
     are made effective retroactively to the first day of the first Plan
     Year beginning after December 31, 1988 (or such later date on which
     these requirements first become effective with respect to this Plan);
     or (b) are made effective no later than the first day on which the
     Employer is no longer entitled, under regulations, to rely on a
     reasonable, good faith interpretation of these requirements, and the
     prior provisions of the Plan constitute such an interpretation.

XI.  PROTOTYPE PLAN DOCUMENTS

     This Adoption Agreement may be used only in conjunction with the
     Dreyfus Prototype Defined Contribution Plan, Basic Plan Document No.
     01, and the Dreyfus Custodial Agreement both as amended from time to
     time.  In the event the Sponsor amends the Basic Plan Document or this
     Adoption Agreement or discontinues this type of plan, it will inform
     the Employer.  The Sponsor, The Dreyfus Corporation is available to
     answer questions regarding the intended meaning of any Plan provisions,
     adoption of the Plan and the effect of an Opinion Letter, at 144 Glenn
     urtiss Boulevard, Uniondale, New York  11556 [(516) 338-3418].
 XII. EMPLOYER ACCEPTANCE

By signing the Application you acknowledge that you have received and read
the Fund(s) current prospectus(es), the Dreyfus Easy Standardized/Paired
Retirement Plan and the attached Custodial Agreement.  You accept the terms
of the Plan and Custodial Agreement and you appoint The Dreyfus Trust
Company to be Custodian.




___________________               ____________


Employer's Signature              Date


XIII.     CUSTODIAN'S ACCEPTANCE


By signing here, The Dreyfus Trust Company accepts this Adoption Agreement
and its appointment as Custodian of your Dreyfus Easy Standardized/Paired
Retirement Plan.  The Adoption Agreement will be maintained by The Dreyfus
Trust Company.



_________________________                             ______


The Dreyfus Trust Company                             Date
Custodian


                             ADOPTION AGREEMENT
                         DREYFUS STANDARDIZED/PAIRED
                          PROTOTYPE DEFINED BENEFIT
                           PENSION PLAN AND TRUST

                              PLAN NUMBER 02001
                         IRS SERIAL NUMBER C224399a


The Employer named in section I,A. below hereby establishes or restates a
Defined Benefit Pension Plan ("Plan") and Trust, consisting of such sums as
shall be paid to the Trustee(s) under the Plan, the investments thereof and
earnings thereon.  The terms of the Plan and Trust are set forth in this
Adoption Agreement and the applicable provisions of the Dreyfus Prototype
Defined Benefit Plan, Basic Plan Document No. 02, and the Dreyfus Trust
Agreement, both as amended from time to time, which are hereby adopted and
incorporated herein by reference.



I.   BASIC PROVISIONS

     A.    Employer's Name:    [. . . .]

                Address:  [. . . .]

     B.    Employer is a (  ) corporation; (  ) S corporation;
           (  ) partnership; (  ) sole proprietor; (  ) other.

     C.    Employer's Tax ID Number:     [. . . .]

     D.    Employer's Fiscal Year:  [. . . .]

     E.    Plan name:     [. . . . ]

     F.    Effective date of Plan:  [. . . .]

           If this is an amendment and restatement of an existing Plan, enter
           the date originally adopted [. . . .].  The effective date of this
           amended Plan is [. . . .].
      G.    The Trustee shall be:

                (  ) The Dreyfus Trust Co.

                (  ) Other:         (Name)    [. . . .]
                               (Address) [. . . .]
                               (Phone #) [. . . .]

     H.    Anniversary Date:   [. . . .]

     I.    Plan Year shall mean the 12 consecutive month period commencing on
           _____________  / ______________ and ending on  _____ /___________.

     J.    Service with the following predecessor employer(s) shall be credited
           for purposes of vesting and eligibility:  [. . . .]  [Note:  Such
           Service must be provided if the adopting Employer maintains the plan
           of the predecessor employer].

     K.    The following employer(s) associated with the Employer under section
           414(b), (c), (m) or (o) of the Internal Revenue Code ("Code") shall
           be Participating Employers in the Plan:  [. . . .]

     L.    Are all employers associated with the Employer under section 414(b),
           (c), (m) or (o) of the Code participating in the Plan?:

                     (  ) Yes  (  ) No


II.  HOURS OF SERVICE

     Hours of Service under the Plan will be determined for all Employees on
     the basis of the method selected below:

     (  )  On the basis of actual hours for which an Employee is paid or
           entitled to payment.

     (  )  On the basis of days worked.  An Employee will be credited with 10
           Hours of Service for any day such Employee would be credited with
           at least one Hour of Service during the day under the Plan.

     (  )  On the basis of weeks worked.  An Employee will be credited with 45
           Hours of Service for any week such Employee would be credited with
           at least one Hour of Service during the week under the Plan.

     (  )  On the basis of semi-monthly payroll periods.  An Employee will be
           credited with 95 Hours of Service for any semi-monthly payroll
           period such Employee would be credited with at least one Hour of
           Service under the Plan.

     (  )  On the basis of months worked.  An Employee will be credited with
           190 Hours of Service for any month such Employee would be credited
           with at least one Hour of Service under the Plan.

     (  )  On the basis of elapsed time.


III. ELIGIBLE EMPLOYEES

     All Employees shall be Eligible Employees, except:

     (  )  Employees included in an unit of Employees covered by a collective
           bargaining agreement between the Employer and employee
           representatives, if retirement benefits were the subject of good
           faith bargaining and if two percent or less of the Employees of the
           Employer covered by that Agreement are professionals as defined in
           section 1.410(b)-9 of the Income Tax Regulations.  For this purpose,
           the term "employee representatives" does not include any
           organization more than half of whose members are Employees who are
           owners, officers, or executives of the Employer.

     (  )  Employees who are nonresident aliens (within the meaning of section
           7701(b)(1)(B) of the Code) and who receive no earned income (within
           the meaning of section 911(d)(2) of the Code) from the Employer
           which constitutes income from sources within the United States
           (within the meaning of section 861(a)(3) of the Code).

           Note:  The term Employee includes all Employees of the Employer and
           any employer required to be aggregated with the Employer under
           section 414(b), (c), (m) or (o) of the Code, and individuals
           considered employees of any such employer under section 414(n) or
           (o) of the Code.

           Note:  If the Employer adopts Sponsor's paired defined contribution
           plan number 01001, 01003, 01004, 01005 or 01006 in addition to this
           Plan, the definition of "Eligible Employee" in all paired plans of
           the Employer must be identical in order for the Employer to be able
           to provide the minimum benefit to each Non-key Employee in the event
           the Plan becomes Top-Heavy under this Plan and no minimum allocation
           under the paired defined contribution plan or plans is provided in
           Section XVIII.
IV.  AGE AND SERVICE REQUIREMENTS

     Each Eligible Employee shall become a Participant on the Entry Date
     coincident with or following completion of the following age and service
     requirements:

           (  ) No age or service requirement.

           (  ) The attainment of age [. . . .] (not to exceed age 21).

           (  ) The completion of [. . . .] (not to exceed 2) Eligibility
                Years of Service.  [Note:  If more than 1 Eligibility Year
                of Service is required, Participants must be 100% immediately
                vested.  If the Eligibility Years of Service is or includes a
                fractional year, an Employee may not be required to complete
                any specified number of Hours of Service to receive credit for
                such fractional year.]


V.   ENTRY DATE

     The Entry Date shall mean:

           (  ) Annual Entry.  The first day of the Plan Year.  [Note:  If
                Annual Entry is selected, the age and service requirements
                cannot exceed 20-1/2 and 1/2 Eligibility Year of Service (or
                1-1/2 Eligibility Years of Service if 100% immediate vesting
                is elected).]

           (  ) Dual Entry.  The first day of the Plan Year and the first day
                of the seventh month of the Plan year.

           (  ) Quarterly Entry.  The first day of the Plan Year and the first
                day of the fourth, seventh and tenth months of the Plan Year.

           (  ) Monthly Entry.  The first day of the Plan year and the first
                day of each following month of the Plan Year.


VI.  COMPENSATION

     A.    Except for purposes of "annual additions" testing under section 415
           of the Code, Compensation shall mean all of each Participant's

           (  ) Information required to be reported under sections 6041 and
           6051 of the Code.  (Wages, tips and other compensation box on Form
           W-2) Compensation is defined as wages as defined in section 3401(a)
           of the Code and all other payments of compensation to the Employee
           by the Employer (in the course of the Employer's trade or business)
           for which the Employer is required to furnish the Employee a written
           statement under sections 6041(d) and 6051(a)(3) of the Code.
           Compensation must be determined without regard to any rules under
           section 3401(a) of the Code that limit the remuneration included in
           wages based on the nature or location of the employment or services
           performed (such as the exception for agricultural labor in section
           3401(a)(2) of the Code).  This definition of Compensation shall
           exclude amounts paid or reimbursed by the Employer for moving
           expenses incurred by an Employee, but only to the extent that at the
           time of the payment it is reasonable to believe that these amounts
           are deductible by the Employee under section 217 of the Code.

           (  ) Section 3401(a) wages.  Compensation is defined as wages within
           the meaning of section 3401(a) of the Code for purposes of income
           tax withholding at the source but determined without regard to any
           rules that limit the remuneration included in wages based on the
           nature or location of the employment or the services performed (such
           as the exception for agricultural labor in section 3401(a)(2) of the
           Code).

           (  ) Section 415 safe-harbor compensation.  Compensation is defined
           as wages, salaries, and fees for professional services and other
           amounts received (without regard to whether or not an amount is paid
           in cash) for personal services actually rendered in the course of
           employment with the Employer to the extent that the amounts are
           includible in gross income (including, but not limited to,
           commissions paid salesmen, compensation for services on the basis
           of a percentage of profits, commissions on insurance premiums, tips,
           bonuses, fringe benefits, and reimbursements or other expense
           allowances under a non-accountable plan (as described in Section
           1.62-2(c)), and excluding the following:

                (a)  Employer contributions to a plan of deferred compensation
           which are not includible in the Employee's gross income for the
           taxable year in which contributed, or Employer contributions under
           a simplified employee pension plan described in section 408(k) of
           the Code, or any distributions from a plan of deferred compensation
           regardless of whether such amounts are includible in the gross
           income of the Employee;

                (b)  Amounts realized from the exercise of a non-qualified
           stock option, or when restricted stock (or property) held by the
           Employee either becomes freely transferable or is no longer subject
           to a substantial risk of forfeiture;

                (c)  Amounts realized from the sale, exchange or other
           disposition of stock acquired under a qualified stock option; and

                (d)  Other amounts which receive special tax benefits, such as
           premiums for group-term life insurance (but only to the extent that
           the premiums are not includible in the gross income of the
           Employee), or contributions made by the Employer (whether or not
           under a salary reduction agreement) towards the purchase of an
           annuity contract described in section 403(b) of the Code (whether
           or not the contributions are actually excludable from the gross
           income of the Employee).

           which is actually paid or made available to the Participant during

           (  ) the Plan Year

           (  ) the calendar year ending with or within the Plan Year

           (  ) ____________________ (must be determined on the basis of any
                consecutive period ending within the Plan Year which is at
                least 12 months in duration and applied uniformly to all
                Employees in the Plan).

           For employees whose date of hire is less than 12 months before the
           end of the 12-month period designated, Compensation will be
           determined over the Plan Year.

     (  )  Compensation shall be reduced by all of the following items (even
           if includible in gross income):  reimbursements or other expense
           allowances, fringe benefits (cash and noncash), moving expenses,
           deferred compensation and welfare benefits.

     Compensation (  ) shall; (  ) shall not include Employer contributions
     made pursuant to a salary reduction agreement with an Employee which are
     not includible in the gross income of the Employee by reason of sections
     125, 402(e)(3), 402(h) or 403(b) of the Code.

     For any Self-Employed Individual covered under the Plan, Compensation
     means Earned Income.

     Average Compensation shall mean the average of a Participant's
     Compensation for the highest [. . . .] (not less than 3 nor more than 5)
     consecutive Plan Years.  If a Participant's entire period of Service for
     the Employer is less than three consecutive years, Compensation is
     averaged on an annual basis over the Participant's entire period of
     Service.

     B.    For purposes of "annual additions" testing under section 415 of the
           Code, Compensation for any Limitation Year shall mean all of each
           Participant's:

           (  ) Information required to be reported under sections 6041 and
           6051 of the Code.  (Wages, tips and other compensation box on Form
           W-2) Compensation is defined as wages as defined in section 3401(a)
           of the Code and all other payments of compensation to the Employee
           by the Employer (in the course of the Employer's trade or business)
           for which the Employer is required to furnish the Employee a written
           statement under sections 6041(d) and 6051(a)(3) of the Code,
           determined without regard to any rules under section 3401(a) of the
           Code that limit the renumeration included in wages based on the
           nature or location of the employment or services performed (such as
           the exception for agricultural labor in section 3401(a)(2) of the
           Code).  This definition of Compensation shall exclude amounts paid
           or reimbursed by the Employer for moving expenses incurred by an
           Employee, but only to the extent that at the time of the payment it
           is reasonable to believe that these amounts are deductible by the
           Employee under section 217 of the Code.

           (  ) Section 3401(a) wages.  Compensation is defined as wages within
           the meaning of section 3401(a) of the Code for purposes of income
           tax withholding at the source but determined without regard to any
           rules that limit the remuneration included in wages based on the
           nature or location of the employment or the services performed (such
           as the exception for agricultural labor in section 3401(a)(2) of the
           Code).

           (  ) Section 415 safe-harbor compensation.  Compensation is defined
           as wages, salaries, and fees for professional services and other
           amounts received (without regard to whether or not an amount is paid
           in cash) for personal services actually rendered in the course of
           employment with the Employer to the extent that the amounts are
           includible in gross income (including, but not limited to,
           commissions paid salesmen, compensation for services on the basis
           of a percentage of profits, commissions on insurance premiums, tips,
           bonuses, fringe benefits, and reimbursements or other expense
           allowances under a non-accountable plan (as described in section
           1.62-2(c) of the regulations), and excluding the following:

                (a)  Employer contributions to a plan of deferred compensation
           to the extent that, before the application of the section 415
           limitations to that plan, the contributions are not includible in
           the Employee's gross income for the taxable year in which
           contributed, or Employer contributions under a simplified employee
           pension plan described in section 408(k) of the Code, or any
           distributions from a plan of deferred compensation regardless of
           whether such amounts are includible in the gross income of the
           Employee;

                (b)  Amounts realized from the exercise of a non-qualified
           stock option, or when restricted stock (or property) held by the
           Employee either becomes freely transferable or is no longer subject
           to a substantial risk of forfeiture;

                (c)  Amounts realized from the sale, exchange or other
           disposition of stock acquired under a qualified stock option; and

                (d)  Other amounts which receive special tax benefits, such as
           premiums for group-term life insurance (but only to the extent that
           the premiums are not includible in the gross income of the
           Employee), or contributions made by the Employer (whether or not
           under a salary reduction agreement) towards the purchase of an
           annuity contract described in section 403(b) of the Code (whether
           or not the contributions are actually excludable from the gross
           income of the Employee);

           which is actually paid or includible in gross income during such
           Limitation Year.

           Note:     Section 415 safe-harbor compensation is determined
                     without regard to the exclusions from gross income in
                     sections 931 and 933 of the Code.  A similar rule is to
                     be applied in determining the compensation of Self-
                     Employed individuals.

           For any Self-Employed Individual covered under the Plan,
           Compensation means Earned Income.


VII. LIMITATION YEAR

     Limitation Year shall mean the 12-consecutive-month period:

           (  ) Identical to the Plan Year.

           (  ) Identical to the Employer's fiscal year ending with or within
                the Plan Year of reference.

           (  ) As fixed by a resolution of the Board of Directors of the
                Employer, or the Employer if no Board of Directors exists.


VIII.      NORMAL RETIREMENT AGE

           Normal Retirement Age shall mean:

           (  ) Age [. . . .] (not to exceed 65)

           (  ) The later of:

                (i) age __________ (not to exceed 65) or
                (ii) the _________ (not to exceed 5th) anniversary of

           the participation commencement date.  If, for Plan Years beginning
           before January 1, 1988, Normal Retirement Age was determined with
           reference to the anniversary of the participation commencement date
           (more than 5 but not to exceed 10 years), the anniversary date for
           Participants who first commenced participation under the Plan before
           the first Plan Year beginning on or after January 1,1988, shall be
           the earlier of (A) the tenth anniversary of the date the Participant
           commenced participation in the Plan (or such anniversary as had been
           elected by the Employer, if less than 10) or (B) the fifth
           anniversary of the first day of the first Plan Year beginning on or
           after January 1, 1988.  The participation commencement date is the
           first day of the first Plan Year in which the Participant commenced
           participation in the Plan.

           The suspension of benefit rules in section 5.7 of the plan will
           apply to:

           (   )          all Participants in the Plan.

           (   )          only those Participants described in section 5.7 of
                          the Plan whose benefits, if actuarially increased,
                          would exceed the limitations of section 415 of the
                          Code.


IX.  EARLY RETIREMENT DATE

     Early Retirement Date shall mean the first day of any month following:

           (  ) There shall be no early retirement provision in this Plan.

           (  ) Age [. . . .].

           (  ) Age [. . . .] and [. . . .] years of Service.

     [Note:  Early Retirement Age cannot be more than 10 years before Normal
     Retirement Age.]

     The suspension of benefit rules in section 5.7 of the Plan will apply to:

     (   )           all Participants in the Plan.

     (   )           only those Participants described in section 5.7 of the
                     Plan whose benefits, if actuarially increased, would
                     exceed the limitations of section 415 of the Code.



X.   VESTED TERMINATION DATE

     A Participant who terminates employment with a vested interest may elect
     to commence payment of his vested benefits as of the first day of any
     month following:

     (  )  termination of employment (no age requirement).

     (  )  attainment of age [. . . .].  (Should not be less than the age
           required for Early Retirement, if any).


XI.  RETIREMENT BENEFITS

     A.    Annual Retirement Benefit Formula.

     Subject to the overall permitted disparity limit below, the current
     benefit formula under the Plan will be an amount payable at Normal
     Retirement Age equal to:

     Integrated-Excess Benefit Formula

           (  ) Fixed Benefit - [. . . .]% of Average Compensation up to the
                Integration Level for the Plan Year ("Base Benefit
                Percentage"), plus [. . . .]% of Average Compensation in excess
                of the Integration Level for the Plan Year ("Excess Benefit
                Percentage").

                Note:  The Excess Benefit Percentage may not exceed the Base
                Benefit Percentage by more than the lesser of (i) the Base
                Benefit Percentage or (ii) the product of 35 times the
                applicable factor determined from Table I or II in Section XI,
                B. below.

                If a Participant begins receiving benefits at an age other than
                Normal Retirement Age, the Participant's benefit will be
                determined in accordance with section 5.3 of the Plan.

                For Participants who are projected to have earned less than 35
                years of Service under this Plan as of the end of the Plan Year
                in which they attain Normal Retirement Age (or current age, if
                later), the Base Benefit Percentage and the Excess Benefit
                Percentage will be reduced by multiplying them by a fraction,
                the numerator of which is the number of years of Service the
                Participant is projected to have earned under this Plan as of
                the end of the Plan Year in which the Participant attains
                Normal Retirement Age (or current age, if later),  and the
                denominator of which is 35.

                Cumulative permitted disparity adjustment: If the number of the
                Participant's cumulative permitted disparity years exceeds 35,
                the Participant's benefit will be further adjusted as provided
                below. A Participant's cumulative disparity years consist of
                the sum of: (1) the total years of Service a Participant is
                projected to have earned under this Plan by the end of the Plan
                Year containing the Participant's Normal Retirement Age, and
                subsequent years of Service, if any, (the total not to exceed
                35), and (2) the number of years credited to the Participant
                for purposes of the benefit formula or the accrual method under
                the Plan under one or more other qualified plans or simplified
                employee pensions (whether or not terminated) ever maintained
                by the Employer (other than years counted in (1)), and not
                including any years credited to the Participant under such
                other qualified plans or simplified employee pensions after the
                Participant has earned 35 years of Service under this Plan).
                For purposes of determining the Participant's cumulative
                permitted disparity limit, all years ending in the same
                calendar year are treated as the same year.

                If this cumulative disparity adjustment is applicable, the
                Participant's benefit will be increased as follows:

                (A)  Subtract the Participant's Base Benefit Percentage from
                     the Participant's Excess Benefit Percentage (after
                     modification in accordance with the paragraphs preceding
                     this cumulative disparity adjustment).

                (B)  Divide the result in (A) by the Participant's years of
                     Service under the Plan projected to the later of Normal
                     Retirement Age or current age, not to exceed 35 years of
                     Service.

                (C)  Multiply the result in (B) by the number of years by which
                     the Participant's Cumulative Disparity Years exceed 35.

                (D)  Add the result in (C) to the Participant's Base Benefit
                     Percentage determined prior to this cumulative disparity
                     adjustment.

                Overall permitted disparity limit:  For any Plan Year this Plan
                benefits any Participant who benefits under another qualified
                plan or simplified employee pension maintained by the Employer
                that provides for permitted disparity (or imputes permitted
                disparity), the benefit for each Participant under this Plan
                will be equal to the Base Benefit Percentage times the
                Participant's Average Compensation.  For Participants who are
                projected to have earned less than 35 years of Service under
                this Plan as of the end of the Plan Year in which they attain
                Normal Retirement Age, (or current age, if later), the
                percentage in the preceding sentence will be multiplied by a
                fraction (not more than one), the numerator of which is the
                number of the Participant's years of Service the Participant
                is projected to have earned under this Plan as of the end of
                the Plan Year in which the Participant attains Normal
                Retirement Age (or current age, if later), and the denominator
                of which is 35.  If this paragraph is applicable, this Plan
                will have a Fresh-Start Date on the last day of the Plan Year
                preceding the Plan Year in which this paragraph is first
                applicable.  In addition, if in any subsequent Plan Year this
                Plan no longer benefits any Participant who also benefits under
                another qualified plan or simplified employee pension
                maintained by the Employer that provides for permitted
                disparity (or imputes permitted disparity), this Plan will have
                a Fresh-Start Date on the last day of the Plan Year preceding
                the Plan Year in which this paragraph is no longer applicable.
                For purposes of determining the Participant's overall permitted
                disparity limit, all years ending in the same calendar year are
                treated as the same year.

           (  ) Unit Benefit -  the sum of (a) and (b) below:  (a) [. . . .]%
                of Average Compensation up to the Integration Level for the
                Plan Year ("Base Benefit Percentage"), times years of Service
                plus [. . . .]% of Average Compensation in excess of the
                Integration Level for the Plan Year ("Excess Benefit
                Percentage") times years of Service.  The maximum number of
                years of Service which may be taken into account for this
                purpose shall be [. . . .] (not to exceed 35).

                If the Participant's benefit after the latest Fresh-Start Date
                is determined under the fraction accrual rule, or the Plan
                satisfies section 411(b)(1)(F) of the Code, the maximum number
                of years of Service during which permitted disparity is taken
                into account under this formula may not be less than 25.

                The number of years of Service taken into account under
                paragraph (a) for any Participant will not exceed the
                Participant's cumulative permitted disparity limit. The
                Participant's cumulative permitted disparity limit is equal to
                35 minus the number of years credited to the Participant for
                purposes of the benefit formula or the accrual method under the
                plan under one or more qualified plans or simplified employee
                pensions (whether or not terminated) ever maintained by the
                Employer, other than years for which a Participant earned a
                year of Service under the benefit formula in paragraph (a). For
                purposes of determining the Participant's cumulative permitted
                disparity limit, all years ending in the same calendar year are
                treated as the same year.  If the Participant's cumulative
                permitted disparity limit is less than the period of years
                specified in paragraph (a), then for years after the
                Participant reaches the cumulative permitted disparity limit
                and through the end of the period specified in paragraph (a),
                the Participant's benefit will be equal to the Excess Benefit
                Percentage, or, if the Participant's benefit after the latest
                Fresh-Start Date is not accrued under the fractional accrual
                rule and the plan does not satisfy section 411(b)(1)(f) of the
                code, 133 1/3 percent of the Base Benefit Percentage, if
                lesser, times Average Compensation.


                (b) [....] (not to exceed the lesser of: (1) the Excess Benefit
                Percentage, and (2) 133 1/3 percent of the Base Benefit
                Percentage, times Average Compensation for each year of Service
                after the number of years of Service taken into account in
                paragraph (a).  If, however, benefits after the latest Fresh
                Start Date are accrued under the fractional accrual rule or the
                Plan satisfies section 411(b)(1)(f) of the Code, then for each
                year of Service after the years of Service taken into account
                in paragraph (a), this percentage will be equal to the Excess
                Benefit Percentage. The maximum number of years of Service
                taken into account under this paragraph (b) will be [....] (if
                benefits after the latest Fresh-Start Date are accrued under
                the fractional accrual rule or the Plan satisfies section
                411(b)(1)(f) of the Code, the number of years entered must be
                no less than 35 minus the number of years of Service taken into
                account in paragraph (a)).

                For purposes of the preceding paragraph(s), the Maximum Excess
                Allowance is, with respect to benefits under the Plan for any
                year of Service, the lesser of (1) the Base Benefit Percentage
                or (2) the applicable factor determined from Table I or II in
                section B below.

                If a Participant begins receiving benefits at an age other
                than Normal Retirement Age, the Participant's benefit will be
                determined in accordance with section 5.3 of the Plan.

                Overall permitted disparity limit: For any Plan Year this Plan
                benefits any Participant who benefits under another qualified
                plan or simplified employee pension maintained by the Employer
                that provides for permitted disparity (or imputes permitted
                disparity), the benefit for each Participant under this Plan
                will be equal to the Base Benefit Percentage times the
                Participant's Average Compensation. If this paragraph is
                applicable, this Plan will have a Fresh-Start Date on the last
                day of the Plan Year preceding the Plan Year in which this
                paragraph is first applicable. In addition, if in any
                subsequent Plan Year this Plan no longer benefits any
                Participant who also benefits under another qualified plan or
                simplified employee pension maintained by the Employer that
                provides for permitted disparity (or imputes permitted
                disparity), this Plan will have a Fresh-Start Date on the last
                day of the Plan Year preceding the Plan Year in which this
                paragraph is no longer applicable.  For purposes of determining
                the Participant's overall permitted disparity limit, all years
                ending in the same calendar year are treated as the same year.

     Integrated-Offset Benefit Formula

           (  ) Fixed Benefit - [.....]% (Gross Benefit Percentage) times
                Average Compensation offset by [....]% (Offset Percentage --
                not to exceed the Maximum Offset Allowance) times Final Average
                Compensation up to the offset level.  The Offset Percentage
                for any Participant shall not exceed one-half of the Gross
                Benefit Percentage, multiplied by a fraction (not to exceed
                one), the numerator of which is the Participant's Average
                Compensation, and the denominator of which is the Participant's
                Final Average Compensation up to the offset level.

                The Maximum Offset Allowance will not exceed the lesser of (1)
                the applicable factor from Table I or II in section B. below,
                multiplied by 35, and (2) one-half of the Gross Benefit
                Percentage.

                If a Participant begins receiving benefits at an age other
                than Normal Retirement Age, the Participant's benefit will be
                determined in accordance with section 5.3 of the Plan.

                For Participants who are projected to have earned less than 35
                years of Service under this Plan as of the end of the Plan Year
                in which they attain Normal Retirement Age (or the current age,
                if later), both the Gross Benefit Percentage and the Offset
                Percentage will be reduced by multiplying them by a fraction,
                the numerator of which is the number of years of Service the
                Participant is projected to have earned under this Plan as of
                the end of the Plan Year in which the Participant attains
                Normal Retirement Age (or the current age, if later), and the
                denominator of which is 35.

                Cumulative permitted disparity adjustment:  If the number of
                the Participant's cumulative permitted disparity years exceeds
                35, the Offset Percentage will be further adjusted as provided
                below.  A Participant's cumulative permitted disparity years
                consist of the sum of:   (1) the total years of Service a
                Participant is projected to have earned under this Plan by the
                end of the Plan Year containing the Participant's Normal
                etirement Age and subsequent years of Service, if any, (the
                total not to exceed 35), and (2) the number of years credited
                to the Participant for purposes of the benefit formula or the
                accrual method under the plan under one or more other qualified
                plans or simplified employee pensions maintained by the
                Employer (other than years counted in (1), and not including
                any years credited to the Participant under such other
                qualified plans or simplified employee pensions after the
                Participant has earned 35 years of Service under this Plan).
                For purposes of determining the Participant's cumulative
                permitted disparity limit, all years ending in the same
                calendar year are treated as the same year.

                If this cumulative permitted disparity adjustment is
                applicable, the Offset Percentage will be further adjusted as
                follows:

                (A)  Divide the Offset Percentage (after modification in
                     accordance with the paragraphs preceding this cumulative
                     permitted disparity adjustment) by the Participant's years
                     of Service under this Plan projected to the later of
                     Normal Retirement Age or current age, not to exceed 35
                     years of Service.

                (B)  Multiply the result in (A) by the number of years by which
                     the Participant's cumulative permitted disparity years
                     exceed 35.

                (C)  Subtract the result in (B) from the Offset Percentage
                     determined prior to this cumulative permitted disparity
                     adjustment.


                Overall permitted disparity limit:  For any Plan Year this Plan
                benefits any Participant who benefits under another qualified
                plan or simplified employee pension maintained by the Employer
                that provides for permitted disparity (or imputes permitted
                disparity), the benefit for all Participants under this Plan
                will be equal to a percentage that is equal to the Gross
                Benefit Percentage minus the Offset Percentage, times the
                Participant's Average Compensation.  For Participants who are
                projected to have earned less than 35 years of Service under
                this Plan as of the end of the Plan Year in which they attain
                Normal Retirement Age, (or current age, if later), the
                percentage in the preceding sentence will be multiplied by a
                fraction (not more than one), the numerator of which is the
                Service the Participant is projected to have earned under this
                Plan as of the end of the Plan Year in which the Participant
                attains Normal Retirement Age (or current age, if later), and
                the denominator of which is 35.  If this paragraph is
                applicable, this Plan will have a Fresh-Start Date on the last
                day of the Plan Year preceding the Plan Year in which this
                paragraph is first applicable.  In addition, if in any
                subsequent Plan Year this Plan no longer benefits any
                Participant who also benefits under another qualified plan or
                simplified employee pension maintained by the Employer that
                provides for permitted disparity (or imputes disparity), this
                Plan will have a Fresh-Start Date on the last day of the Plan
                Year preceding the Plan Year in which this paragraph is no
                longer applicable.  For purposes of determining the
                Participant's overall permitted disparity limit, all years
                ending in the same calendar year are treated as the same year


           (  ) Unit Benefit - The sum of (a) and (b): (a) [....]% (Gross
                Benefit Percentage) of Average  Compensation times years of
                Service offset by [. . . .]% (Offset Percentage -- not to
                exceed the Maximum Offset Allowance) times Final Average
                Compensation up to the offset level times each year of Service.
                The Offset Percentage for any Participant shall not exceed one-
                half of the Gross Benefit Percentage, multiplied by a fraction
                (not to exceed one), the numerator of which is the
                Participant's Average Compensation, and the denominator of
                which is the Participant's Final Average Compensation up to the
                offset level.  The maximum number of years of Service taken
                into account under this paragraph will be [....] (may not
                exceed 35.)  If the Participant's benefit after the latest
                Fresh-Start Date is determined under the fractional accrual
                rule in section 1.0 of the Plan, the maximum number of years
                of Service during which permitted disparity is taken into
                account under this formula may not be less than 25.


                The number of years of Service taken into account under
                paragraph (a) for any Participant may not exceed the
                Participant's cumulative permitted disparity limit.  The
                Participant's cumulative permitted disparity limit is equal to
                35 minus the number of years credited to the Participant for
                purposes of the benefit formula or the accrual method under the
                plan under one or more qualified plans or simplified employee
                pensions (whether or not terminated) ever maintained by the
                Employer, other than years for which a Participant earned a
                year of Service under the benefit formula in paragraph (a). For
                purposes of determining the Participant's cumulative permitted
                disparity limit, all years ending in the same calendar year are
                treated as the same year.  If the Participant's cumulative
                disparity limit is less than the period of years specified in
                paragraph (a), then for years after the Participant reaches the
                cumulative permitted disparity limit and through the end of the
                period specified in paragraph (a), the Participant's benefit
                will be equal to the Gross Benefit Percentage, or, if the
                Participant's benefit after the latest Fresh-Start Date is not
                accrued under the fractional accrual rule and the Plan does not
                satisfy section 411(b)(1)(f) of the Code, 133 1/3 percent of
                the Gross Benefit Percentage reduced by the Offset Percentage
                if lesser, times Average Compensation.


                (b)  [....]% (not to exceed the lesser of: (l) the Gross
                Benefit Percentage, and (2) 133 1/3 percent of the Gross
                Benefit Percentage reduced by the Offset Percentage, times
                Average Compensation for each year of Service after the number
                of years of Service taken into account in paragraph (a). If
                however, benefits after the latest Fresh-Start Date are accrued
                under the fractional accrual rule or the Plan satisfies section
                411(b)(1)(f) of the Code, then for each year of Service after
                the years of Service taken into account in paragraph (a), this
                percentage will be equal to the Gross Benefit Percentage.  The
                maximum number of years of Service taken into account under
                this paragraph (b) will be [....] (if benefits after the latest
                Fresh-Start Date are accrued under the fractional accrual rule
                or the Plan satisfies section 411(b)(1)(f) of the Code, the
                number of years entered must be no less than 35 minus the
                number of years of Service taken into account in paragraph
                (a)).

                For purposes of the preceding paragraph(s), the Maximum Offset
                Allowance will not exceed the lesser of (1) the applicable
                factor from Table I or II in section B below, or (2) one-half
                of the Gross Benefit Percentage.

                If a Participant begins receiving benefits at an age other than
                Normal Retirement Age, the Participant's benefit will be
                determined in accordance with section 5.3 of the Plan.

                Overall permitted disparity limit:  For any Plan Year this Plan
                benefits any Participant who benefits under another qualified
                plan or simplified employee pension maintained by the Employer
                that provides for permitted disparity (or imputes permitted
                disparity), the benefit for all Participants under this Plan
                will be equal to the Gross Benefit Percentage minus the Offset
                Percentage, times the Participant's total Average Compensation.
                If this paragraph is applicable, this Plan will have a Fresh-
                Start Date on the last day of the Plan Year preceding the Plan
                Year in which this paragraph is first applicable.  In addition,
                if in any subsequent Plan Year this Plan no longer benefits any
                Participant who also benefits under another qualified plan or
                simplified employee pension maintained by the Employer that
                provides for permitted disparity (or imputed permitted
                disparity) this Plan will have a Fresh-Start Date on the last
                day of the Plan Year preceding the Plan Year in which this
                paragraph is no longer applicable.  For purposes of determining
                the Participant's overall permitted disparity limit, all years
                ending in the same calendar year are treated as the same year


     Non-Integrated Benefit Formula

           (  ) Fixed Benefit - [. . . .]% of Average Compensation.  such
                benefit shall be reduced pro-rata for years of Participation
                less than [. . . .] years.

           (  ) Unit Benefit - [. . . .]% of Average Compensation times years
                of Participation.

           (  ) Unit Benefit (past/future) - [. . . .]% of Average Compensation
                times years of Participation before the Effective Date, plus
                [. . ..]% of Average Compensation times years of Participation
                after the Effective Date.

     Minimum/Maximum Benefit

     Notwithstanding the benefit formula specified above:

           (  ) The minimum annual retirement benefit, if any, shall be at
                least $ [. . . ]

           (  ) The maximum annual retirement benefit shall be $ [. . . .]

     B.    Applicable Factor.

           The Applicable Factor is determined from the appropriate table below
           based on the Normal Retirement Age  under the Plan, as specified
           above (without regard to any years of Participation requirement.)
           If the Plan's Standard Form of Retirement Income, as specified below
           is other than a life annuity, the factor determined from the
           appropriate table below must be multiplied by the following
           adjustment factor:  life annuity, 10 years guaranteed -- .90; life
           annuity and 50% survivor benefit -- .80; life annuity and 100%
           survivor benefit -- .666.

           If the Integration Level under the Plan is either option 4 or 5 in
           Section XI, C. below, the appropriate table is Table II.  Otherwise,
           the appropriate table shall be Table I.

                                   TABLE I

     Plan's Normal
     Retirement Age  Participant's Social Security Retirement Age

                          65        66        67

           65             .75       .70       .65
           64             .70       .65       .60
           63             .65       .60       .55
           62             .60       .55       .50
           61             .55       .50       .475
           60             .50       .475      .45
           59             .475      .45       .425
           58             .45       .425      .40
           57             .425      .40       .375
           56             .40       .375      .344
           55             .375      .344      .316


                                  TABLE II

     Plan's Normal
     Retirement Age  Participant's Social Security Retirement Age

                          65        66        67

           65             .60       .56       .52
           64             .56       .52       .48
           63             .52       .48       .44
           62             .48       .44       .40
           61             .44       .40       .38
           60             .40       .38       .36
           59             .38       .36       .34
           58             .36       .34       .32
           57             .34       .32       .30
           56             .32       .30       .2752
           55             .30       .2752     .2528

     If a Participant begins receiving benefits before Normal Retirement Age
     or, in the case of a fixed benefit plan (whether excess or offset),
     before the Participant has completed 35 years of Participation, the
     Participant's benefit will be determined in accordance with Section 5.7
     of the Plan.


     C.    Integration Level - the Integration Level (or offset level) for each
           Plan Year for each Participant shall be:

     (  )  1.   The Participant's Covered Compensation for the Plan Year.

     (  )  2.   The greater of $10,000 or one-half of the Covered Compensation
                of any person who attains Social Security Retirement Age during
                the calendar year in which the Plan Year begins.

     (  )  3.   $________ (a single dollar amount not to exceed the greater of
                $10,000 or one-half of Covered Compensation of any person who
                attains Social Security Retirement Age during the calendar year
                in which the Plan Year begins.)

     (  )  4.   $________ (a single dollar amount that exceeds the greater of
                $10,000 or one-half of Covered Compensation of any person who
                attains Social Security Retirement Age during the calendar year
                in which the Plan Year begins, but not to exceed the greater
                of $25,450 or 150% of the Covered Compensation of an individual
                attaining Social Security Retirement Age in the current Plan
                Year.)

     (  )  5.   A uniform percentage equal to ________% (greater than 100
                percent but not greater than 150 percent of each Participant's
                Covered Compensation for the current year, and in no event in
                excess of the Taxable Wage Base (for excess plans), or Final
                Average Compensation (for offset plans).)

     Covered Compensation will be determined based on the following year:

     [   ]           current Plan Year

     [   ]           __________ Plan Year (may be Covered Compensation for a
                     Plan Year earlier than the current Plan Year, provided the
                     earlier Plan Year is the same for all Employees and is not
                     earlier than the later of (A) the Plan Year that begins
                     5 years before the current Plan Year, and (B) the Plan
                     Year beginning in 1989.  If the Plan Year entered is more
                     than five years prior to the current Plan Year, the
                     Participant's Covered Compensation will be that determined
                     under the Covered Compensation table for the Plan Year
                     five years prior to the current Plan Year.

     D.    Participation.

           For benefit accrual purposes, Participation shall not include:

           (  ) employment prior to the original effective date of the Plan.

           (  ) employment prior to the date the Participant gained membership
                in the Plan.

           (  ) employment other than as an Eligible Employee.

           (  ) with respect to Participants who were not Eligible Employees
                under the Plan prior to the first Plan Year beginning on or
                after January 1, 1988 because their employment began within 5
                years of their Normal Retirement Date, employment prior to
                becoming a Participant.

     E.    Standard Form of Retirement Income:

           (  ) Life annuity

           (  ) Life annuity, 10 years guaranteed

           (  ) Life annuity and 50% survivor benefit

           (  ) Life annuity and 100% survivor benefit

     F.    Actuarial Equivalent.

           For purposes of determining the Actuarial Equivalent, of any
           benefit, the following mortality and interest rate assumptions shall
           be used:

           Interest rate -     Pre-retirement:          [. . . .]%
                               Post-retirement:         [. . . .]%

           (must be between 7 1/2% and 8 1/2% if the Plan provides for
           permitted disparity under section 401(l) of the Code.

           Mortality table:  [. . . .]

           (must be standard mortality table as described in section
           1.401(a)(4)-12 of the Income Tax regulations if the Plan provides
           for permitted disparity under section 401(l) of the Code.

     G.    Fresh Start Rule.

           The formula with wear-away and formula with extended wear-away
           Fresh-Start rules below take into account an Employee's past service
           in determining the Employee's benefit accruals under the Plan:
           either of these Fresh-Start rules may cause the Plan to fail to
           satisfy the safe harbor for past service in section
           1.401(a)(4)-5(a)(3) of the Income Tax Regulations.

           The Accrued Benefit of each Participant in the Fresh-Start Group
           under the Plan will be equal to:

           (  ) 1. Formula with wear-away -- the greater of:

           (a)  the Participant's Frozen Accrued Benefit, if any, and

           (b)  the Participant's Accrued Benefit determined with respect to
                the current benefit formula as applied to the Participant's
                total years of Service under the Plan.

           (  ) 2. Formula without wear-away -- the sum of:

           (a)  the Participant's Frozen Accrued Benefit, if any, and

           (b)  the Participant's Accrued Benefit determined with respect to
                the current benefit formula as applied to the Participant's
                years of Service beginning after the Fresh-Start Date.

           If, however, the Participant's benefit under the Plan is accrued
           under the fractional accrual rule or the 3 percent accrual rule or
           if this Plan satisfies the safe harbor for insurance contract plans
           in Income Tax Regulations section 1.401(a)(4)-3(b)(7), this formula
           without wear-away will not apply, and the Participant's accrued
           benefit will be determined in accordance with the formula with
           wear-away above.

           (  ) 3. Formula with extended wear-away -- the greater of the
           accrued benefit determined for the Participant under the formula
           with wear-away or the formula without wear-away above.

           If, however, the Participant's benefit under the Plan is accrued
           under the 3 percent accrual rule the formula with extended wear-away
           will not apply, and the Participant's Accrued Benefit will be
           determined in accordance with the formula with wear-away above.

     Definition of Fresh-Start Group. The Fresh-Start Group consists of all
     Participants who have Accrued Benefits as of the Fresh-Start Date and
     have at least one Hour of Service with the Employer after that date.
     However, if designated below, the Fresh-Start Group shall be limited to:

     ( )   Section 401(a)(17) Participants (may be elected only with respect
           to a Tax Reform Act of 1986 (TRA '86) Fresh-Start Date and with
           respect to an Omnibus Budget Reconciliation Act of 1993 (OBRA '93)
           Fresh-Start Date). A TRA '86 Fresh-Start Date means a Fresh-Start
           Date that is not earlier than the last day of the last Plan Year
           beginning before the first Plan Year beginning on or after January
           1, 1989 (the statutory effective date), and not later than the last
           day of the last Plan Year beginning before the first Plan Year
           beginning on or after January 1, 1994 (the regulatory effective
           date). An OBRA '93 Fresh-Start Date means the last day of the last
           Plan Year beginning before the first Plan Year beginning on or after
           January 1, 1994.

     ( )   Members of an acquired group of employees

           An acquired group of employees means employees of a prior employer
           who become employed by the Employer in a transaction between the
           Employer and the prior employer that is a stock or asset
           acquisition, merger, or other similar transaction involving a change
           in the employer of the employees of the trade or business on or
           before [  /  / ] (enter a date no later than the end of the
           transition period defined in section 410(b)(6)(c)(ii) of the Code,
           if the date selected is after February 10, 1993). The date in the
           preceding sentence will be the Fresh-Start Date with respect to
           members of the acquired group described below.

           The acquired group consists of: ___________________________________
           ___________________________________________________________________
           ___________________________________________________________________


     ( )   Employees with a Frozen Accrued Benefit that is attributable to
           assets and liabilities transferred to the Plan as of a Fresh Start
           Date in connection with the transfer and for whom the current
           formula is different from the formula used to determine the Frozen
           Accrued Benefit.

           The Fresh Start Date in connection with the transfer is: [  /  /]

           (must be the date as of which the Employees begin accruing benefits
           under the Plan).

           The group of employees with a Frozen Accrued Benefit that is
           attributable to assets and liabilities transferred to the Plan is:
           ___________________________________________________________________
           ___________________________________________________________________
           ___________________________________________________________________


     H.    Frozen Accrued Benefit

           If elected by the Employer below, each Participant's Frozen Accrued
           Benefit will be adjusted in accordance with the following fraction:

           [   ]  Old Compensation fraction

           [   ]  New Compensation fraction

           [   ]  Reconstructed Compensation fraction  (may be selected only
           if the latest Fresh-Start Date is before the first day of the first
           Plan Year beginning on or after January 1, 1994.)

           For purposes of calculating a Participant's "Reconstructed
           Compensation", the selected year will be the Plan Year beginning in
           (the selected year must begin after the latest Fresh-Start Date):

           (  )  1989

           (  )  1990

           (  )  1991

           (  )  1992

           (  )  1993

           (  )  1994

           (  )  Alternative adjustment

           (  )  Special adjustment for section 401(a)(17) Participants


XII. QUALIFIED JOINT AND SURVIVOR ANNUITY

     The survivor annuity of the Qualified Joint and Survivor Annuity shall
     be equal to

     (  ) 50%        (  ) 66-2/3%        (  ) 100%

     of the annuity payable during the joint lives of the Participant and the
     Participant's spouse.


XIII.      LIFE INSURANCE

           Life insurance (  ) shall; (  ) shall not be a permissible
           investment.


XIV. PRE-RETIREMENT DEATH BENEFIT

If the Plan is not funded with life insurance, the pre-retirement death
benefit shall be:

     (  )  the Qualified Pre-retirement Survivor Annuity (the required spousal
           benefit) only.

     (  )  The Actuarial Value of the Participant's Accrued Benefit.  If the
           Participant's Spouse is the Beneficiary, such benefit shall be
           offset by the Actuarial Value of the Qualified Pre-retirement
           Survivor Annuity.

If the Plan is funded with life insurance, the face amount of the policies
purchased will be [. . . .] (not to exceed 100) times the Participant's
anticipated monthly retirement benefit.


XV.  VESTING SERVICE-EXCLUSIONS

     All of an Employee's years of Service with the Employer shall be counted
     to determine the vested interest of such Employee except:

           (  ) Years of Service before age 18.

           (  ) Years of Service before the Employer maintained this Plan or
                a predecessor plan.

           (  ) Years of Service before the effective date of ERISA if such
                Service would have been disregarded under the Service Break
                rules of the prior plan in effect from time to time before such
                date.  For this purpose, Service Break rules are rules which
                result in the loss of prior vesting or benefit accruals, or
                deny an Employee's eligibility to participate by reason of
                separation or failure to complete a required period of Service
                within a specified period of time.


XVI. VESTING SCHEDULES

     The vested interest of each Employee in his Employer-derived Accrued
     Benefit shall be determined on the basis of the following schedule:

           (  ) 100% immediately vested.  [Note:  Mandatory if more than 1
                eligibility Year of Service is required.]

           (  ) 100% immediately vested after [. . . .] (not to exceed 3) years
                of Service.

           (  ) 20% vested after 2 years of Service, plus [. . . .]% vested
                (not less than 20%) for each additional year of Service until
                100% vested.


XVII.      EXCESS ASSETS

           Following a complete termination of the Plan by the Employer, any
           assets which remain after provisions have been made to satisfy all
           liabilities of the Plan to Participants and Beneficiaries

           (  ) shall revert to the Employer in cash.

           (  ) shall be allocated among Participants on a uniform and
                non-discriminatory basis, subject to the limitation on benefits
                of Section 8.1 of the Plan.


     Note:  If this is an amendment and restatement of an existing Plan which
     did not previously provide for a reversion, an election that excess
     assets revert to the Employer shall not be effective before the end of
     the 5th calendar year following the date of this Adoption Agreement.


XVIII.     TOP-HEAVY PROVISIONS

     A.    Top Heavy Status

           (  ) The provisions of Article XV of the Plan shall always apply.

           (  ) The provisions of Article XV of the Plan shall only apply in
                Plan Years after 1983, during which the Plan is or becomes
                Top-Heavy.

     B.    Minimum Benefit

           If the Employer has adopted Sponsor's paired defined contribution
           plan number 01001, 01003, 01004, 01005 and/or 01006 in addition to
           this Plan and the definition of "Eligible Employee" in all paired
           plans is identical, then Non-Key Employees who are Participants in
           this Plan shall receive the minimum Top Heavy benefit accrued under
           this Plan and shall receive no minimum allocation under the paired
           defined contribution plan or plans.

           If a Participant in this Plan who is a Non-Key Employee is covered
           under another qualified plan maintained by the Employer, other than
           a paired plan of the Sponsor, the minimum top heavy allocation or
           benefit required under section 416 of the Code shall be provided to
           such Non-Key Employee under:

           (  ) this Plan.

           (  ) the Employer's qualified defined contribution plan.

     C.    Determination of Present Value

           For purposes of establishing present value to compute the Top-Heavy
           Ratio, any benefit shall be discounted only for mortality and
           interest based on the following:

     (  )  Interest Rate [....]%  (must be between 7 1/2% and 8 1/2% if the
           plan provides for permitted disparity under section 401(l) of the
           Code.

           Mortality table:  [....] (must be standard mortality table as
           described in section 1.401(a)(4)-12 of the Income Tax regulations
           if the Plan provides for permitted disparity under section 401(l)
           of the Code.

           (  ) The Interest Rate(s) and Mortality Table specified under
                Section 1.2 of the Plan

     D.    Valuation Date

           For purposes of computing the Top-Heavy Ratio, the Valuation Date
           shall be one of the following:

                (  ) the first day of the Plan Year

                (  ) the last day of the Plan Year

                (  ) [....]

           [Note:  The date selected must be the same date used for computing
           Plan costs for minimum funding, regardless of whether a valuation
           is performed that year.]


XIX. LIMITATION ON BENEFITS

     If the Employer maintains or has ever maintained another qualified plan
     (other than the Sponsor's paired defined contribution plan number 01001,
     01003, 01004, 01005 and/or 01006) in which any Participant in this Plan
     is (or was) a Participant or could possibly become a Participant, the
     adopting Employer must complete this Section.  The Employer must also
     complete this Section if it maintains a welfare benefit fund, as defined
     in section 419(e) of the Code, or an individual medical account, as
     defined in section 415(1)(2) of the Code, under which amounts are treated
     as Annual Additions with respect to any Participant in the Plan.  (If the
     Employer maintains only paired plans of the Sponsor this Section should
     not be completed.)


     (a)   If a Participant is, or ever has been, covered under another
           qualified defined benefit plan maintained by the Employer, annual
           benefits shall be limited to comply with section 415(b) of the Code:

           (  ) by freezing or reducing Annual Benefits under this Plan.

           (  ) by freezing or reducing Annual Benefits in the other qualified
                defined benefit plan.

     (b)   If a Participant is, or has ever been, a participant in one or more
           qualified defined contributions plans maintained by the Employer,
           the "1.0" aggregate limitation of section 415(e) of the Code shall
           be satisfied by:

           (  ) freezing or reducing Annual Benefits under this Plan.

           (  ) freezing or reducing the Annual Additions under the defined
                contribution plan or plans.


XX.  PRE-TERMINATION RESTRICTIONS

     The pre-termination restrictions in Section 8.3 of the Plan will be
     effective [ /  / ] (no later than the first day of the 1994 Plan Year).


XXI. EMPLOYER REPRESENTATIONS

           The Employer hereby represents that:

                a.   It is aware of, and agrees to be bound by, the terms of
                     the Plan.

                b.   It understands that the Sponsor will not furnish legal or
                     tax advice in connection with the adoption or operation
                     of the Plan and has consulted legal and tax counsel to the
                     extent necessary.

                c.   The failure to properly fill out this Adoption Agreement
                     may result in disqualification of the Plan.


XXII. RELIANCE ON PLAN QUALIFICATION

      An Employer who has ever maintained or who later adopts any plan
      (including, after December 31, 1985, a welfare benefit fund, as defined
      in section 419(e) of the Code, which provides post-retirement medical
      benefits allocated to separate accounts for Key Employees, as defined in
      section 419(d)(3) of the Code, or an individual medical account, as
      defined in section 415(1)(2) of the Code) in addition to this Plan (other
      than the Sponsor's paired defined contribution plan number 01001, 01003,
      01004, 01005 or 01006 may not rely on the opinion letter issued by the
      National Office of the Internal Revenue Service as evidence that this
      Plan is qualified under section 401 of the Code.  If an Employer who
      adopts or maintains multiple plans wishes to obtain reliance that his or
      her plans are qualified, application for a determination letter should
      be made to the appropriate key district office of the Internal Revenue
      Service.

      In addition, the Employer may rely upon the opinion letter issued by the
      national Office of the Internal Revenue Service only if the plan adopted
      by the Employer satisfies one of the safe-harbors provided in regulations
      under section 401(a)(26) of the Code with respect to its prior benefit
      structure or is deemed to satisfy section 401(a)(26) under such
      regulations.

      If the Employer wishes to obtain reliance that its plan is qualified, the
      Employer may request a determination from the appropriate Key District
      Director with regard to its prior benefit structure.

      The Employer may not be entitled to rely on the opinion letter issued by
      the National Office in certain other circumstances, which are specified
      in the opinion letter issued with respect to the Plan or in section 6 of
      Revenue Procedure 89-9, as amended.



XXIII. PROTOTYPE PLAN DOCUMENTS

       This Adoption Agreement may be used only in conjunction with the Dreyfus
       Prototype Defined Benefit Plan, Basic Plan Document No. 02, and the
       Dreyfus Trust Agreement all as amended from time to time.  In the event
       the Sponsor amends the Basic Plan Document or this Adoption Agreement or
       discontinues this type of plan, it will inform the Employer.  The
       Sponsor, Dreyfus Corporation, is available to answer questions regarding
       the intended meaning of any Plan provisions, adoption of the Plan and
       the effect of an opinion letter,
       at:__________________________________________________________________
       _____________________________________________________________________.

IN WITNESS WHEREOF, the Employer and the Trustee have executed this instrument
the _____  day of _____ , 19__.  If applicable, the appropriate corporate seal
has been affixed and attested to.


                          _____________________________________
                          Name of Business Entity


                          ______________________________________
                          Signature (Sole Proprietors only)


                          By:___________________________________
                               Name and Title
                               (Corporations or Partnerships)


ATTEST:


_____________________________
Secretary (Corporations Only)


                          __________________________________________
                          Name of Trustee(s)



                          __________________________________________
                          Signature (Individual Trustee)



                          __________________________________________
                          Signature (Individual Trustee)


                          By:_______________________________________

                             Name and Title (Corporate Trustee only)


                             ADOPTION AGREEMENT
                           DREYFUS NONSTANDARDIZED
                          PROTOTYPE DEFINED BENEFIT
                           PENSION PLAN AND TRUST

                              PLAN NUMBER 02002
                         IRS SERIAL NUMBER C324414a


The Employer named in section I,A. below hereby establishes or restates a
Defined Benefit Pension Plan ("Plan") and Trust, consisting of such sums as
shall be paid to the Trustee(s) under the Plan, the investments thereof and
earnings thereon.  The terms of the Plan and Trust are set forth in this
Adoption Agreement and the applicable provisions of the Dreyfus Prototype
Defined Benefit Plan, Basic Plan Document No. 02, and the Dreyfus Trust
Agreement, both as amended from time to time, which are hereby adopted and
incorporated herein by reference.



I.   BASIC PROVISIONS

     A.    Employer's Name:    [. . . .]

                Address:  [. . . .]

     B.    Employer is a (  ) corporation; (  ) S corporation; (  )
           partnership; (  ) sole proprietor; (  ) other.

     C.    Employer's Tax ID Number:     [. . . .]

     D.    Employer's Fiscal Year:  [. . . .]

     E.    Plan name:     [. . . . ]

     F.    Effective Date of Plan:  [. . . .]

           If this is an amendment and restatement of an existing Plan,
           enter the date originally adopted [. . . .].  The effective date
           of this amended Plan is [. . . .].


     G.    The Trustee shall be:

                (  ) The Dreyfus Trust Co.

                (  ) Other:    (Name)    [. . . .]
                          (Address) [. . . .]
                          (Phone #) [. . . .]

     H.    Anniversary Date:   [. . . .]

     I.    Plan Year shall mean the 12 consecutive month period commencing
           on ___________ /___________  and ending on _________ /_________.

     J.    Service with the following predecessor employer(s) shall be
           credited for purposes of vesting and eligibility:  [. . . .]
           [Note:  Such Service must be provided if the adopting Employer
           maintains the plan of the predecessor employer].

     K.    The following employer(s) associated with the Employer under
           section 414(b), (c), (m) or (o) of the Internal Revenue Code
           ("Code") shall be Participating Affiliates in the Plan:  [. . ..]

     L.    Are all employers associated with the Employer under section
           414(b), (c), (m) or (o) of the Code participating in the Plan?:

                     (  ) Yes  (  ) No


II.  HOURS OF SERVICE

     Hours of Service under the Plan will be determined for all Employees
     on the basis of the method selected below:

     (  )  On the basis of actual hours for which an Employee is paid or
           entitled to payment.

     (  )  On the basis of days worked.  An Employee will be credited with
           10 Hours of Service for any day such Employee would be credited
           with at least one Hour of Service during the day under the Plan.

     (  )  On the basis of weeks worked.  An Employee will be credited with
           45 Hours of Service for any week such Employee would be credited
           with at least one Hour of Service during the week under the Plan.

     (  )  On the basis of semi-monthly payroll periods.  An Employee will
           be credited with 95 Hours of Service for any semi-monthly payroll
           period such Employee would be credited with at least one Hour of
           Service under the Plan.

     (  )  On the basis of months worked.  An Employee will be credited with
           190 Hours of Service for any month such Employee would be
           credited with at least one Hour of Service under the Plan.

     (  )  On the basis of elapsed time.


III. ELIGIBLE EMPLOYEES

     All Employees shall be Eligible Employees, except:

           (  ) Employees included in an unit of Employees covered by a
                collective bargaining agreement between the Employer and
                employee representatives, if retirement benefits were the
                subject of good faith bargaining and if two percent or less
                of the Employees of the Employer covered by the Agreement
                are professionals as defined in section 1.410(b)-9 of the
                Income Tax Regulations.  For this purpose, the term
                "employee representatives" does not include any organization
                more than half of whose members are Employees who are
                owners, officers, or executives of the Employer.

           (  ) Employees who are nonresident aliens (within the meaning of
                section 7701(b)(1)(B) of the Code and who receive no earned
                income (within the meaning of section 911(d)(2) of the Code)
                from the Employer which constitutes income from sources
                within the United States (within the meaning of section
                861(a)(3) of the Code).

           (  ) Employees included in the following job classifications
                [. . . .]

           (  ) Employees of the following employers aggregated under
                section 414(b), (c), (m) or (o) of the Code [. . . .]

           (  ) Individuals required to be considered Employees under
                section 414(n) of the Code.

     Note:  The term Employee includes all Employees of the Employer and
     any employer required to be aggregated with the Employer under section
     414(b), (c), (m) or (o) of the Code, and individuals considered
     employees of any such employer under section 414(n) or (o) of the
     Code.


IV.  AGE AND SERVICE REQUIREMENTS

     Each Eligible Employee shall become a Participant on the Entry Date
     coincident with or following completion of the following age and
     service requirements:

           (  ) No age or service requirement.

           (  ) The attainment of age [. . . .] (not to exceed age 21).

           (  ) The completion of [. . . .] (not to exceed 2) Eligibility
                Years of Service.
                [Note:  If more than 1 Eligibility Year of Service is
                required, Participants must be 100% immediately vested.  If
                the Eligibility Years of Service is or includes a fractional
                year, an Employee may not be required to complete any
                specified number of Hours of Service to receive credit for
                such fractional year.]

           AND

           (  ) Effective Date entry.  Each Eligible Employee who is
                employed on the Effective Date shall become a Participant on
                the effective date.  Each Eligible Employee employed after
                the Effective Date shall become a Participant on the Entry
                Date coincident with or following completion of the age and
                service requirements specified above.


V.   ELIGIBILITY YEARS OF SERVICE

     In order to be credited with an Eligibility Year of Service, an
     Employee shall complete [. . . .] (not to exceed 1,000) Hours of
     Service.  (Not applicable if elapsed time method of crediting service
     is elected.)


VI.  ENTRY DATE

     The Entry Date shall mean:

           (  ) Annual Entry.  The fist day of the Plan Year.  [Note:  If
                Annual Entry is selected, the age and service requirements
                cannot exceed 20-1/2 and 1/2 Eligibility Year of Service (or
                1-1/2 Eligibility Years of Service if 100% immediate vesting
                is elected).]

           (  ) Dual Entry.  The first day of the Plan Year and the first
                day of the seventh month of the Plan year.


           (  ) Quarterly Entry.  The first day of the Plan Year and the
                first day of the fourth, seventh and tenth months of the
                Plan Year.


           (  ) Monthly Entry.  The first day of the Plan year and the first
                day of each following month of the Plan Year.


VII. COMPENSATION

     A.    Except for purposes of "annual additions" testing under Section
           415 of the Code, Compensation shall mean all of each
           Participant's

           (  ) Information required to be reported under sections 6041 and
           6051 of the Code.  (Wages, tips and other compensation box on
           Form W-2) Compensation is defined as wages as defined in section
           3401(a) of the Code and all other payments of compensation to the
           Employee by the Employer (in the course of the Employer's trade
           or business) for which the Employer is required to furnish the
           Employee a written statement under sections 6041(d) and
           6051(a)(3) of the Code.  Compensation must be determined without
           regard to any rules under section 3401(a) of the Code that limit
           the remuneration included in wages based on the nature or
           location of the employment or services performed (such as the
           exception for agricultural labor in section 3401(a)(2) of the
           Code).  This definition of Compensation shall exclude amounts
           paid or reimbursed by the Employer for moving expenses incurred
           by an Employee, but only to the extent that at the time of the
           payment it is reasonable to believe that these amounts are
           deductible by the Employee under section 217 of the Code.

           (  ) Section 3401(a) wages.  Compensation is defined as wages within
           the meaning of section 3401(a) of the Code for purposes of income
           tax withholding at the source but determined without regard to
           any rules that limit the remuneration included in wages based on
           the nature or location of the employment or the services
           performed (such as the exception for agricultural labor in
           section 3401(a)(2) of the Code).

           (  ) Section 415 safe-harbor compensation.  Compensation is
           defined as wages, salaries, and fees for professional services
           and other amounts received (without regard to whether or not an
           amount is paid in cash) for personal services actually rendered
           in the course of employment with the Employer to the extent that
           the amounts are includible in gross income (including, but not
           limited to, commissions paid salesmen, compensation for services
           on the basis of a percentage of profits, commissions on insurance
           premiums, tips, bonuses, fringe benefits, and reimbursements
           or other expense allowances under a non-accountable plan (as
           described in Section 1.62-2(c)), and excluding the following:

                (a)  Employer contributions to a plan of deferred compensation
           which are not includible in the Employee's gross income for the
           taxable year in which contributed, or Employer contributions under
           a simplified employee pension plan described in section 408(k) of
           the Code, or any distributions from a plan of deferred compensation
           regardless of whether such amounts are includible in the gross
           income of the Employee; (b)  Amounts realized from the exercise of
           a non-qualified stock option, or when restricted stock (or property)
           held by the Employee either becomes freely transferable or is no
           longer subject to a substantial risk of forfeiture;

                (c)  Amounts realized from the sale, exchange or other
           disposition of stock acquired under a qualified stock option; and

                (d)  Other amounts which receive special tax benefits, such
           as premiums for group-term life insurance (but only to the extent
           that the premiums are not includible in the gross income of the
           Employee), or contributions made by the Employer (whether or not
           under a salary reduction agreement) towards the purchase of an
           annuity contract described in section 403(b) of the Code (whether
           or not the contributions are actually excludable from the gross
           income of the Employee).

           which is actually paid or made available to the Participant
           during

                ( )  the Plan Year

                ( )  the calendar year ending with or within the Plan Year

                ( )  __________________ (must be determined on the basis of
                     any consecutive period ending within the Plan Year
                     which is at least 12 months in duration and applied
                     uniformly to all Employees in the Plan).

           For Employees whose date of hire is less than 12 months before
           the end of the 12-month period designated, Compensation will be
           determined over the Plan Year.

     ( )  Compensation shall be reduced by all of the following items (even
     if includible in gross income): reimbursements or other expense
     allowances, fringe benefits (cash and noncash), money expenses,
     deferred compensation and welfare benefits.

     Compensation (  ) shall; (  ) shall not include Employer contributions
     made pursuant to a salary reduction agreement with an Employee which
     are not includible in the gross income of the Employee by reason of
     sections 125, 402(e)(3), 402(h) or 403(b) of the Code.

     If benefits under the Plan are not determined on a integrated basis,
     the following may be excluded from the definition of Compensation
     selected above (provided the Employer determines that the resulting
     definition of Compensation does not violate the nondiscrimination
     provisions of the Income Tax Regulations) for any year in which the
     Plan is not Top Heavy:

     (  )  bonuses

     (  )  overtime

     (  )  commissions

     (  )  amounts in excess of $[....]

     (  )  [.........]

     For any Self-Employed Individual covered under the Plan, Compensation
     means Earned Income.

     Average Compensation shall mean the average of a Participant's
     Compensation for the highest [. . . .] (not less than 3 nor more than
     5) consecutive Plan Years.  If a Participant's entire period of
     Service for the Employer is less than three consecutive years,
     Compensation is averaged on an annual basis over the Participant's
     entire period of Service.

     B.    For purposes of "annual additions" testing under section 415 of
           the Code, Compensation for any Limitation Year shall mean all of
           each Participant's:

           (  ) Information required to be reported under sections 6041 and
           6051 of the Code.  (Wages, tips and other compensation box on
           Form W-2) Compensation is defined as wages as defined in section
           3401(a) of the Code and all other payments of compensation to the
           Employee by the Employer (in the course of the Employer's trade
           or business) for which the Employer is required to furnish the
           Employee a written statement under sections 6041(d) and
           6051(a)(3) of the Code.  Compensation must be determined without
           regard to any rules under section 3401(a) of the Code that limit
           the remuneration included in wages based on the nature or
           location of the employment or services performed (such as the
           exception for agricultural labor in section 3401(a)(2) of the
           Code).  This definition of Compensation shall exclude amounts
           paid or reimbursed by the Employer for moving expenses incurred
           by an Employee, but only to the extent that at the time of the
           payment it is reasonable to believe that these amounts are
           deductible by the Employee under section 217 of the Code.

           (  ) Section 3401(a) wages.  Compensation is defined as wages
           within the meaning of section 3401(a) of the Code for purposes of
           income tax withholding at the source but determined without
           regard to any rules that limit the remuneration included in wages
           based on the nature or location of the employment or the services
           performed (such as the exception for agricultural labor in
           section 3401(a)(2) of the Code).

           (  ) Section 415 safe-harbor compensation.  Compensation is
           defined as wages, salaries, and fees for professional services
           and other amounts received (without regard to whether or not an
           amount is paid in cash) for personal services actually rendered
           in the course of employment with the Employer to the extent that
           the amounts are includible in gross income (including, but not
           limited to, commissions paid salesmen, compensation for services
           on the basis of a percentage of profits, commissions on insurance
           premiums, tips, bonuses, fringe benefits, and reimbursements or
           other expense allowances under a non accountable plan (as
           described in section 1.62-2(c) of the regulations), and excluding
           the following:

                (a)  Employer contributions to a plan of deferred
           compensation to the extent that, before the application of the
           section 415 limitations to that plan, the contributions are not
           includible in the Employee's gross income for the taxable year in
           which contributed, or Employer contributions under a simplified
           employee pension plan described in section 408(k) of the Code, or
           any distributions from a plan of deferred compensation regardless
           of whether such amounts are includible in the gross income of the
           Employee;

                (b)  Amounts realized from the exercise of a non-qualified
           stock option, or when restricted stock (or property) held by the
           Employee either becomes freely transferable or is no longer
           subject to a substantial risk of forfeiture;

                (c)  Amounts realized from the sale, exchange or other
           disposition of stock acquired under a qualified stock option; and

                (d)  Other amounts which receive special tax benefits, such
           as premiums for group-term life insurance (but only to the extent
           that the premiums are not includible in the gross income of the
           Employee), or contributions made by the Employer (whether or not
           under a salary reduction agreement) towards the purchase of an
           annuity contract described in section 403(b) of the Code (whether
           or not the contributions are actually excludable from the gross
           income of the Employee).

           which is actually paid or includible in gross income during such
           Limitation Year.

           Note:     Section 415 safe-harbor compensation is determined
                     without regard to the exclusions from gross income in
                     sections 931 and 933 of the Code.  A similar rule is to
                     be applied in determining the compensation of Self-
                     Employed individuals.

           For any Self-Employed Individual covered under the Plan,
           Compensation means Earned Income.


VIII. LIMITATION YEAR

      Limitation Year shall mean the 12-consecutive-month period:

           (  ) Identical to the Plan Year.

           (  ) Identical to the Employer's fiscal year ending with or
                within the Plan Year of reference.

           (  ) As fixed by a resolution of the Board of Directors of the
                Employer, or the Employer if no Board of Directors exists.


IX.  NORMAL RETIREMENT AGE

     Normal Retirement Age shall mean:

           (  ) Age [. . . .] (not to exceed 65)

           (  ) The later of:

                (i) age __________ (not to exceed 65) or
                (ii) the __________(not to exceed 5th) anniversary of

                the participation commencement date.  If, for Plan Years
                beginning before January 1, 1988, Normal Retirement Age was
                determined with reference to the anniversary of the
                participation commencement date (more than 5 but not to
                exceed 10 years), the anniversary date for Participants who
                first commenced participation under the Plan before the
                first Plan Year beginning on or after January 1,1988, shall
                be the earlier of (A) the tenth anniversary of the date the
                Participant commenced participation in the Plan (or such
                anniversary as had been elected by the Employer, if less
                than 10) or (B) the fifth anniversary of the first day of
                the first Plan Year beginning on or after January 1, 1988.
                The participation commencement date is the first day of the
                first Plan Year in which the Participant commenced
                participation in the Plan.

                The suspension of benefit rules in section 5.7 of the Plan
                will apply to:

                (   )     all Participants in the Plan.

                (   )     only those Participants described in section 5.7
                of the Plan whose benefits, if actuarially increased, would
                exceed the limitations of section 415 of the Code.


X.   EARLY RETIREMENT DATE

     Early Retirement Date shall mean the first day of any month following:

           (  ) There shall be no early retirement provision in this Plan.

           (  ) Age [. . . .].

           (  ) Age [. . . .] and [. . . .] years of Service.

     [Note:  Early Retirement Age cannot be more than 10 years before
     Normal Retirement Age.]

     The suspension of benefit rules in section 5.7 of the Plan will apply
     to:

     (   )      all Participants in the plan.

     (   )      only those Participants described in section 5.7 of the Plan
                whose benefits, if actuarially increased, would exceed the
                limitations of section 415 of the Code.




XI.  VESTED TERMINATION DATE

     A Participant who terminates employment with a vested interest may
     elect to commence payment of his vested benefits as of the first day
     of any month following:

     (  ) termination of employment (no age requirement).

     (  ) attainment of age [. . . .].  (Should not be less than the age
     required for Early Retirement, if any).



XII. RETIREMENT BENEFITS

     A.    Annual Retirement Benefit Formula.

     Subject to the overall permitted disparity limit below, the current
     benefit formula under the Plan will be an amount payable at normal
     retirement age equal to:

     Integrated-Excess Benefit Formula

           (  ) Fixed Benefit - [. . . .]% of Average Compensation up to the
                Integration Level for the Plan Year ("Base Benefit
                Percentage"), plus [. . . .]% of Average Compensation in
                excess of the Integration level for the Plan Year ("Excess
                Benefit Percentage").

                Note:  The Excess Benefit Percentage may not exceed the Base
                Benefit Percentage by more than the lesser of (i) the Base
                Benefit Percentage or (ii) the product of 35 times the
                applicable factor determined from Table I or II in Section
                XII, B. below.

                If a Participant begins receiving benefits at an age other
                than Normal Retirement Age, the Participant's benefit will
                be determined in accordance with section 5.3 of the Plan.

                For Participants who are projected to have earned less than
                35 years of Service under this Plan as of the end of the
                Plan Year in which they attain Normal Retirement Age (or
                current age, if later), the Base Benefit Percentage and the
                Excess Benefit Percentage will be reduced by multiplying
                them by a fraction, the numerator of which is the number of
                years of Service the Participant is projected to have earned
                under this Plan as of the end of the Plan Year in which the
                Participant attains Normal Retirement Age (or current age,
                if later), and the denominator of which is 35.

                Cumulative permitted disparity adjustment:  If the number of
                the Participant's Cumulative permitted disparity years
                exceeds 35, the Participant's benefit will be further
                adjusted as provided below.  A Participant's cumulative
                disparity years consist of the sum of:  (1) the total years
                of Service a Participant is projected to have earned under
                this Plan by the end of the Plan Year containing the
                Participant's Normal Retirement Age, and subsequent years of
                Service, if any, (the total not to exceed 35), and (2) the
                number of years credited to the Participant for purposes of
                the benefit formula or the accrual method under the Plan,
                under one or more other qualified plans or simplified
                employee pensions (whether or not terminated) ever
                maintained by the Employer (other than years counted in (1),
                and not including any years credited to the Participant
                under such other qualified plans or simplified employee
                pensions after the Participant has earned 35 years of
                Service under this Plan). For purposes of determining the
                Participant's cumulative permitted disparity limit, all
                years ending in the same calendar year are treated as the
                same year.

                If this cumulative disparity adjustment is applicable, the
                Participant's benefit will be increased as follows:

                (A)  Subtract the Participant's Base Benefit Percentage from
                     the Participant's Excess Benefit Percentage (after
                     modification in accordance with the paragraphs
                     preceding this cumulative disparity adjustment).


                (B)  Divide the result in (A) by the Participant's years of
                     Service under the Plan projected to the later of Normal
                     Retirement Age or current age, not to exceed 35 years
                     of Service.

                (C)  Multiply the result in (B) by the number of years by
                     which the Participant's Cumulative Disparity Years
                     exceed 35.

                (D)  Add the result in (C) to the Participant's Base Benefit
                     Percentage determined prior to this cumulative
                     disparity adjustment.

                Overall permitted disparity limit:  For any Plan Year this
                Plan benefits any Participant who benefits under another
                qualified plan or simplified employee pension maintained by
                the Employer that provides for permitted disparity (or
                imputes disparity), the benefit for each Participant under
                this Plan will be equal to the Base Benefit Percentage times
                the Participant's Average Compensation.  For Participants
                who are projected to have earned less than 35 years of
                Service under this Plan as of the end of the Plan Year in
                which they attain Normal Retirement Age, (or current age, if
                later), the percentage in the preceding sentence will be
                multiplied by a fraction (not more than one), the numerator
                of which is the number of the Participant's years of Service
                the Participant is projected to have earned under this Plan
                as of the end of the Plan Year in which the Participant
                attains Normal Retirement Age (or current age, if later),
                and the denominator of which is 35.  If this paragraph is
                applicable, this Plan will have a Fresh-Start Date on the
                last day of the Plan Year preceding the Plan Year in which
                this paragraph is first applicable.  In addition, if in any
                subsequent Plan Year this Plan no longer benefits any
                Participant who also benefits under another qualified plan
                or simplified employee pension maintained by the Employer
                that provides for permitted disparity (or imputes permitted
                disparity), this Plan will have a Fresh-Start Date on the
                last day of the Plan Year preceding the Plan Year in which
                this paragraph is no longer applicable.  For purposes of
                determining the Participant's overall permitted disparity
                limit, all years ending in the same calendar year are
                treated as the same year.

           (  ) Unit Benefit -  the sum of (a) and (b) below: (a) [. . . .]%
                of Average Compensation up to the Integration Level for the
                Plan Year ("Base Benefit Percentage"), times years of
                Service plus [. . . .]% of Average Compensation in excess of
                the Integration Level for the Plan Year ("Excess Benefit
                Percentage") times years of Service.  The maximum number of
                years of Service which may be taken into account for this
                purpose shall be [. .] (not to exceed 35).

                If the Participant's benefit after the latest Fresh-Start
                Date is determined under the fraction accrual rule or the
                Plan satisfies section 411(b)(1)(f) of the Code, the maximum
                number of years of Service during which permitted disparity
                is taken into account under this formula may not be less
                than 25.

                The number of years of Service taken into account under
                paragraph (a) for any Participant will not exceed the
                Participant's cumulative permitted disparity limit.  The
                Participant's cumulative permitted disparity limit is equal
                to 35 minus the number of years credited to the Participant
                for purposes of the benefit formula or the accrual method
                under the Plan, under one or more qualified plans or
                simplified employee pensions (whether or not terminated)
                ever maintained by the Employer other than years for which a
                Participant earned a year of Service under the benefit
                formula in paragraph (a).  For purposes of determining the
                Participant's cumulative permitted disparity limit, all
                years ending in the same calendar year are treated as the
                same year. If the Participant's cumulative permitted
                disparity limit is less than the period of years specified
                in paragraph (a), then for years after the Participant
                reaches the cumulative permitted disparity limit and through
                the end of the period specified in paragraph (a), the
                Participant's benefit will be equal to the Excess Benefit
                Percentage or, if the Participant's benefit after the latest
                Fresh-Start Date is not accrued under the Fractional accrual
                rule and the Plan does not satisfy section 411(b)(1)(f) of
                the Code, 133 1/3 percent of the Base Benefit Percentage, if
                lesser, times Average Compensation.

                (b)[...]%  (not to exceed the lesser of: (1) the Excess
                Benefit Percentage, and (2) 133 1/3 percent of the Base
                Benefit Percentage, times Average Compensation for each year
                of Service after the number of years of Service taken into
                account in the first paragraph of (a).  If, however,
                benefits after the latest Fresh-Start Date are accrued under
                he fractional accrual rule or the Plan satisfies section
                411(b)(1)(f) of the Code, then for each year of Service
                after the years of Service taken into account in paragraph
                (a), this percentage will be equal to the Excess Benefit
                Percentage.  The maximum number of years of Service taken
                into account under this paragraph will be [...] (if benefits
                after the latest Fresh-Start Date are accrued under the
                fractional accrual rule or the Plan satisfies section
                411(b)(1)(f) of the Code, the number of years entered must
                be no less than 35 minus the number of years of Service
                taken into account in paragraph (a)).

                For purposes of the preceding paragraph(s), the Maximum
                Excess Allowance is, with respect to benefits under the Plan
                for any year of Service, the lesser of (1) the Base Benefit
                Percentage or (2) the applicable factor determined from
                Table I or II in section B below.

                If a Participant begins receiving benefits at an age other
                than Normal Retirement Age, the Participant's benefit will
                be determined in accordance with section 5.3 of the Plan.

                Overall permitted disparity limit: For any Plan Year this
                Plan benefits any Participant who benefits under another
                qualified plan or simplified employee pension maintained by
                the Employer that provides for permitted disparity (or
                imputes permitted disparity), the benefit for each
                Participant under this Plan will be equal to the Base
                Benefit Percentage times the Participant's Average
                Compensation. If this paragraph is applicable, this Plan
                will have a Fresh-Start Date on the last day of the Plan
                Year preceding the Plan Year in which this paragraph is
                first applicable.  In addition, if in any subsequent Plan
                Year this Plan no longer benefits any Participant who also
                benefits under another qualified plan or simplified employee
                pension maintained by the Employer that provides for
                permitted disparity (or imputes permitted disparity), this
                Plan will have a Fresh-Start Date on the last day of the
                Plan Year preceding the Plan Year in which this paragraph is
                no longer applicable.  For purposes of determining the
                Participant's overall permitted disparity limit, all years
                ending in the same calendar year are treated as the same year.

Integrated-Offset Benefit Formula

           (  ) Fixed Benefit - [.....]% (Gross Benefit Percentage) times
                Average Compensation offset by [.....]% (Offset Percentage --
                not to exceed the Maximum Offset Allowance) times Final
                Average Compensation up to the offset level.  The Offset
                Percentage for any Participant shall not exceed one-half of the
                Gross Benefit Percentage, multiplied by a fraction (not to
                exceed one), the numerator of which is the Participant's
                Average Compensation, and the denominator of which is the
                Participant's Final Average Compensation up to the offset
                level.

                The Maximum Offset Allowance will not exceed the lesser of
                (1) the applicable factor from Table I or II in section B.
                below, multiplied by 35, and (2) one-half of the Gross Benefit
                Percentage.

                If a Participant begins receiving benefits at an age other
                than Normal Retirement Age, the Participant's benefit will
                be determined in accordance with section 5.3 of the Plan.

                For Participants who are projected to have earned less than
                35 years of Service under this Plan as of the end of the
                Plan Year in which they attain Normal Retirement Age (or the
                current age, if later), both the Gross Benefit Percentage
                and the Offset Percentage will be reduced by multiplying
                them by a fraction, the numerator of which is the number of
                years of Service the Participant is projected to have earned
                under this Plan as of the end of the Plan Year in which the
                Participant attains Normal Retirement Age (or the current
                age, if later), and the denominator of which is 35.

                Cumulative permitted disparity adjustment: If the number of
                the Participant's cumulative permitted disparity years
                exceeds 35, the Offset Percentage will be further adjusted
                as provided below. A Participants cumulative disparity years
                consist of the sum of: (l) the total years of Service a
                Participant is projected to have earned under this Plan by
                the end of the Plan Year containing the Participant's Normal
                Retirement Age and subsequent years of Service, if any, (the
                total not to exceed 35), and (2) the number of years
                credited to the Participant for purposes of the benefit
                formula or the accrual method under the plan under one or
                more other qualified plans or simplified employee pensions
                maintained by the Employer (other than years counted in (1),
                and not including any years credited to the Participant
                under such other qualified plans or simplified employee
                pension after the Participant has earned 35 years of Service
                under this Plan). For purposes of determining the
                Participant's cumulative permitted disparity limit, all
                years ending in the same calendar year are treated as the
                same year.

                If this cumulative permitted disparity adjustment is
                applicable, the Offset Percentage will be further adjusted
                as follows:

                (A)  Divide the Offset Percentage (after modification in
                     accordance with the paragraphs preceding this
                     cumulative disparity adjustment) by the Participant's
                     years of Service under this Plan projected to the later
                     of Normal Retirement Age or current age, not to exceed
                     35 years of Service.

                (B)  Multiply the result in (A) by the number of years by
                     which the Participant's cumulative permitted disparity
                     years exceed 35.

                (C)  Subtract the result in (B) from the Offset Percentage
                     determined prior to this cumulative permitted disparity
                     adjustment.

                Overall permitted disparity limit:  For any Plan Year this
                Plan benefits any Participant who benefits under another
                qualified plan or simplified employee pension maintained by
                the Employer that provides for permitted disparity (or
                imputes permitted disparity), the benefit for all
                Participants under this Plan will be equal to a percentage
                that is equal to the Gross Benefit Percentage minus the
                Offset Percentage, times the Participant's Average
                Compensation.  For Participants who are projected to have
                earned less than 35 years of Service under this Plan as of
                the end of the Plan Year in which they attain Normal
                Retirement Age, (or current age, if later), the percentage
                in the preceding sentence will be multiplied by a fraction
                (not more than one), the numerator of which is the Service
                the Participant is projected to have earned under this Plan
                as of the end of the Plan Year in which the Participant
                attains Normal Retirement Age (or current age, if later),
                and the denominator of which is 35.  If this paragraph is
                applicable, this Plan will have a Fresh-Start Date on the
                last day of the Plan Year preceding the Plan Year in which
                this paragraph is first applicable.  In addition, if in any
                subsequent Plan Year this Plan no longer benefits any
                Participant who also benefits under another qualified plan
                or simplified employee pension maintained by the Employer
                that provides for permitted disparity (or imputes permitted
                disparity), this Plan will have a Fresh-Start Date on the
                last day of the Plan Year preceding the Plan Year in which
                this paragraph is no longer applicable.  For purposes of
                determining the Participant's cumulative permitted disparity
                limit, all years ending in the same calendar year are
                treated as the same year.

           (  ) Unit Benefit - The sum of (a) and (b):  (a) [. .]% (Gross
                Benefit Percentage) of Average Compensation times years of
                Service offset by [. .]% (Offset Percentage not to exceed
                the Maximum Offset Allowance) times Final Average Annual
                Compensation up to the offset level times each year of
                Service.  The Offset Percentage for any Participant shall
                not exceed one-half of the Gross Benefit Percentage,
                multiplied by a fraction (not to exceed one), the numerator
                of which is the Participant's Average Compensation, and the
                denominator of which is the Participant's Final Average
                Compensation up to the offset level.  The maximum number of
                years of Service taken into account under this paragraph
                will be [...](may not exceed 35.)  If the Participant's
                benefit after the latest Fresh-Start Date is determined
                under the fractional accrual rule in section 1.0 of the
                Plan, the maximum number of years of Service during which
                permitted disparity is taken into account under this formula
                may not be less than 25.


                The number of years of Service taken into account under
                paragraph (a) for any Participant may not exceed the
                Participant's cumulative permitted disparity limit. The
                participant's cumulative permitted disparity limit is equal
                to 35 minus the number of years credited to the participant
                for purposes of the benefit formula or the accrual method
                under the plan under one or more qualified plans or
                simplified employee pensions (whether or not terminated)
                ever maintained by the Employer, other than years for which
                a Participant earned a year of Service under the benefit
                formula in paragraph (a). For purposes of determining the
                Participant's cumulative permitted disparity limit, all
                years ending in the same calendar year are treated as the
                same year.  If the Participant's cumulative disparity limit
                is less than the period of years specified in paragraph (a),
                then for years after the Participant reaches the cumulative
                permitted disparity limit and through the end of the period
                specified in paragraph (a), the Participant's benefit will
                be equal to the Gross Benefit Percentage, or, if the
                Participant's benefit after the latest Fresh-Start Date is
                not accrued under the fractional accrual rule and the Plan
                does not satisfy section 411(b)(1)(f) of the Code, 133 1/3
                percent of the Gross Benefit Percentage reduced by the
                offset percentage if lesser, times Average Compensation.

                (b)[...]% (not to exceed the lesser of: (l) the Gross
                Benefit Percentage, and (2) 133 1/3 percent of the Gross
                Benefit Percentage reduced by the Offset Percentage, times
                Average Compensation for each year of Service after the
                number of years of Service taken into account in paragraph
                (a). If however, benefits after the latest Fresh-Start Date
                are accrued under the fractional accrual rule or the Plan
                satisfies section 411(b)(1)(f) of the Code, then for each
                year of Service after the years of Service taken into
                account in paragraph (a), this percentage will be equal to
                the Gross Benefit Percentage. The maximum number of years of
                Service taken into account under this paragraph (b) will be
                [...] (if benefits after the latest Fresh-Start Date are
                accrued under the fractional accrual rule or the Plan
                satisfies section 411(b)(1)(f) of the Code, the number of
                years entered must be no less than 35 minus the number of
                years of Service taken into account in paragraph (a)).

                For purposes of the preceding paragraph(s), the Maximum
                Offset Allowance will not exceed the lesser of (1) the
                applicable factor from Table I or II in section B, below, or
                (2) one-half of the Gross Benefit Percentage.

                If a Participant begins receiving benefits at an age other
                than Normal Retirement Age, the participant's benefit will
                be determined in accordance with section 5.3 of the Plan.

                Overall permitted disparity limit:  For any Plan Year this
                Plan benefits any Participant who benefits under another
                qualified plan or simplified employee pension maintained by
                the Employer that provides for permitted disparity (or
                imputes permitted disparity), the benefit for all
                Participants under this Plan will be equal to the Gross
                Benefit Percentage minus the Offset Percentage, times the
                Participant's total Average Compensation.  If this paragraph
                is applicable, this Plan will have a Fresh-Start Date on the
                last day of the Plan Year preceding the Plan Year in which
                this paragraph is first applicable.  In addition, if in any
                subsequent Plan Year this Plan no longer benefits any
                Participant who also benefits under another qualified plan
                or simplified employee pension maintained by the Employer
                that provides for permitted disparity (or imputes permitted
                disparity), this Plan will have a Fresh-Start Date on the
                last day of the Plan Year preceding the Plan Year in which
                this paragraph is no longer applicable.  For purposes of
                determining the Participant's overall permitted disparity
                limit, all years ending in the same calendar year are
                treated as the same year.

     Non-Integrated Benefit Formula

           (  ) Fixed Benefit - [. . . .]% of Average Compensation.  Such
                benefit shall be reduced pro-rata for years of Participation
                less than [. . . .] years.

           (  ) Unit Benefit - [. . . .]% of Average Compensation times
                years of Participation.

           (  ) Unit Benefit (past/future) - [. . . .]% of Average
                Compensation times years of Participation before the
                Effective Date, plus [. . ..]% of Average Compensation times
                years of Participation after the Effective Date.

     Minimum/Maximum Benefit

     Notwithstanding the benefit formula specified above:

           (  ) The minimum annual retirement benefit, if any, shall be at
                least $[....]

           (  ) The maximum annual retirement benefit shall be $[...].

     B.    Applicable Factor.

           The Applicable Factor is determined from the appropriate table
           below based on the Normal Retirement Age  under the Plan, as
           specified above (determined without regard to any years of
           Participation requirement).  If the Plan's Standard Form of
           Retirement Income, as specified below, is other than a life
           annuity, the factor determined from the appropriate table below
           must be multiplied by the following adjustment factor:  life
           annuity, 10 years guaranteed -- .90; life annuity and 50%
           survivor benefit -- .80; life annuity and 100% survivor benefit
           -- .666.

           If the Integration Level under the Plan is either option 4 or 5
           in Section XII, C. below, the appropriate table is Table II.
           Otherwise, the appropriate table shall be Table I.

                                   TABLE I

     Plan's Normal
     Retirement Age  Participant's Social Security Retirement Age
     ______________  _____________________________________________

                          65        66        67

           65             .75       .70       .65
           64             .70       .65       .60
           63             .65       .60       .55
           62             .60       .55       .50
           61             .55       .50       .475
           60             .50       .475      .45
           59             .475      .45       .425
           58             .45       .425      .40
           57             .425      .40       .375
           56             .40       .375      .344
           55             .375      .344      .316


                                  TABLE II

     Plan's Normal
     Retirement Age  Participant's Social Security Retirement Age
     ______________  ____________________________________________

                          65        66        67

           65             .60       .56       .52
           64             .56       .52       .48
           63             .52       .48       .44
           62             .48       .44       .40
           61             .44       .40       .38
           60             .40       .38       .36
           59             .38       .36       .34
           58             .36       .34       .32
           57             .34       .32       .30
           56             .32       .30       .2752
           55             .30       .2752     .2528

           If a Participant begins receiving benefits before Normal
           Retirement Age or, in the case of a fixed benefit plan (whether
           excess or offset), the Participant has completed less than 35
           years of Participation, the Participant's benefit will be
           determined in accordance with Section 5.7 of the Plan.


     C.    Integration Level - the Integration Level for each Plan Year for
           each Participant shall be:

     (  )  1.   The Participant's Covered Compensation for the Plan Year.

     (  )  2.   The greater of $10,000 or one-half of the Covered
                Compensation of any person who attains Social Security
                Retirement Age during the calendar year in which the Plan
                Year begins.

     (  )  3.   $________ (a single dollar amount not to exceed the greater
                of $10,000 or one-half of Covered Compensation of any person
                who attains Social Security Retirement Age during the
                calendar year in which the Plan Year begins.)

     (  )  4.   $________ (a single dollar amount that exceeds the greater
                of $10,000 or one-half of Covered Compensation of any person
                who attains Social Security Retirement Age during the
                calendar year in which the Plan Year begins, but not to
                exceed the greater of $25,450 or 150% of the Covered
                Compensation of an individual attaining Social Security
                Retirement Age in the current Plan Year.)

     (  )  5.   A uniform percentage equal to ________% (greater than 100
                percent but not greater than 150 percent of each
                Participant's Covered Compensation for the current year, and
                in no event in excess of the Taxable Wage Base (for excess
                plans), or Final Average Compensation (for offset plans))

     Covered Compensation will be determined based on the following year:

     [   ]           current Plan Year

     [   ]           __________ Plan Year (may be Covered Compensation for a
                     Plan Year earlier than the current Plan Year, provided
                     the earlier Plan Year is the same for all Employees and
                     is not earlier than the later of (A) the Plan Year that
                     begins 5 years before the current Plan Year, and (B)
                     the Plan Year beginning in 1989.  If the Plan Year
                     entered is more than five years prior to the current
                     Plan Year, the Participant's Covered Compensation will
                     be that determined under the Covered Compensation table
                     for the Plan Year five years prior to the current Plan
                     Year.


     D.    Participation.

           For benefit accrual purposes, Participation shall not include:

           (  ) employment prior to the original effective date of the Plan.

           (  ) employment prior to the date the Participant gained
                membership in the Plan.

           (  ) employment other than as an Eligible Employee.

           (  ) with respect to Participants who were not Eligible Employees
                under the Plan prior to the first Plan Year beginning on or
                after January 1, 1988 because their employment began within
                5 years of their Normal Retirement Date, employment prior to
                becoming a Participant.

           In order to be credited with a year of Participation, an Active
           Participant must have:  (Not applicable if elapsed time method of
           crediting service is elected.)

           (  ) 501 Hours of Service:

           (  ) [. . . .] Hours of Service (cannot exceed 1,000);

           (  ) 1,000 Hours of Service

     E.    Standard Form of Retirement Income:

           (  ) Life annuity

           (  ) Life annuity, 10 years guaranteed

           (  ) Life annuity and 50% survivor benefit

           (  ) Life annuity and 100% survivor benefit

     F.    Actuarial Equivalent.

           For purposes of determining the Actuarial Equivalent, of any
           benefit, the following mortality and interest rate assumptions
           shall be used:

           Interest rate -     Pre-retirement:          [. . . .]%
                               Post-retirement:         [. . . .]%

           (must be between 7 1/2% and 8 1/2% if the plan provides for
           permitted disparity under section 401(l) of the Code.

           Mortality table:  [. . . .]

           (must be standard mortality table as described in section
           1.401(a)(4)-12 of the Income Tax regulations if the plan provides
           for permitted disparity under section 401(l) of the Code.

     G.    Fresh Start Rule.

           The formula with wear-away and formula with extended wear-away
           Fresh-Start rules below take into account an Employee's past
           service in determining the Employee's benefit accruals under the
           Plan: either of these Fresh-Start rules may cause the Plan to
           fail to satisfy the safe harbor for past service in section
           1.401(a)(4)-5(a)(3) of the Income Tax Regulations.

           The Accrued Benefit of each Participant in the Fresh-Start Group
           under the Plan will be equal to:

           (  ) 1. Formula with wear-away -- the greater of:

           (a)  the Participant's Frozen Accrued Benefit, if any, and

           (b)  the Participant's Accrued Benefit determined with respect to
                the current benefit formula as applied to the Participant's
                total years of Service under the Plan.

           (  ) 2. Formula without wear-away -- the sum of:

           (a)  the Participant's Frozen Accrued Benefit, if any, and

           (b)  the Participant's Accrued Benefit determined with respect to
                the current benefit formula as applied to the Participant's
                years of Service beginning after the Fresh-Start Date.

           If, however, the Participant's benefit under the Plan is accrued
           under the fractional accrual rule or the 3 percent accrual rule,
           or if this Plan satisfies the safe harbor for insurance contract
           plans in Income Tax Regulations section 1.401(a)(4)-3(b)(7), this
           formula without wear-away will not apply, and the Participant's
           Accrued Benefit will be determined in accordance with the formula
           with wear-away above.

           (  ) 3. Formula with extended wear-away -- the greater of the
           Accrued Benefit determined for the Participant under the formula
           with wear-away or the formula without wear-away above.

           If, however, the Participant's benefit under the Plan is accrued
           under the 3 percent accrual rule, the formula with extended
           wear-away will not apply, and the Participant's Accrued Benefit
           will be determined in accordance with the formula with wear-away
           above.

           Definition of Fresh-Start Group. The Fresh-Start Group consists
           of all Participants who have Accrued Benefits as of the Fresh-
           Start Date and have at least one Hour of Service with the
           Employer after that date. However, if designated below, the
           Fresh-Start Group shall be limited to:

     ( )   section 401(a)(17) Participants (may be elected only with respect
           to a Tax Reform Act of 1986 (TRA '86) Fresh-Start Date and with
           respect to an Omnibus Budget Reconciliation Act of 1993 (OBRA
           '93) Fresh-Start Date). A TRA '86 Fresh-Start Date means a Fresh
           Start Date that is not earlier than the last day of the last Plan
           Year beginning before the First Plan Year beginning on or after
           January 1, 1989 (the statutory effective date), and not later
           than the last day of the last Plan Year beginning before the
           first Plan Year beginning on or after January 1, 1994 (the
           regulatory effective date). An OBRA '93 Fresh-Start Date means
           the last day of the last Plan Year beginning before the first
           Plan Year beginning on or after January 1, 1994.

     ( )   Members of an acquired group of employees

           An acquired group of employees means employees of a prior
           employer who become employed by the Employer in a transaction
           between the Employer and the prior employer that is a stock or
           asset acquisition, merger, or other similar transaction involving
           a change in the employer of the employees of the trade or
           business on or before [ / / ] (enter a date no later than the end
           of the transition period defined in section 410(b)(6)(c)(ii) of
           the Code, if the date selected is after February 10, 1993). The
           date in the preceding sentence will be the Fresh-Start Date with
           respect to members of the acquired group described below.

           The acquired group consists of: ___________________________________
           ___________________________________________________________________
           ___________________________________________________________________


     ( )   Employees with a Frozen Accrued Benefit that is attributable to
           assets and liabilities transferred to the Plan as of a Fresh-
           Start Date in connection with the transfer and for whom the
           current formula is different from the formula used to determine
           the Frozen Accrued Benefit.

     ( )   The Fresh Start Date in connection with the transfer is: [ /  / ]
           (must be the date as of which the Employees begin accruing
           benefits under the Plan).

     ( )   The group of employees with a Frozen Accrued Benefit that is
           attributable to assets and liabilities transferred to the Plan
           is: _______________________________________________________________
           ___________________________________________________________________
           ___________________________________________________________________


     H.    Frozen Accrued Benefit

           If elected by the Employer below, each Participant's Frozen
           Accrued Benefit will be adjusted in accordance with the following
           fraction:

           [   ]  Old Compensation fraction

           [   ]  New Compensation fraction

           [   ]  Reconstructed Compensation Fraction (may be selected only
           if the latest Fresh-Start Date is before the first day of the
           first Plan Year beginning after January 1, 1994).

           For purposes of calculating a Participant's "Reconstructed
           Compensation", the selected year will be the Plan Year beginning
           in (the selected year must begin after the latest Fresh-Start
           Date):

           (  )  1989

           (  )  1990

           (  )  1991

           (  )  1992

           (  )  1993

           (  )  1994

           (  )  Alternative Adjustment

           (  )  Special adjustment for section 401(a)(17) Participants.



XIII. QUALIFIED JOINT AND SURVIVOR ANNUITY

      The survivor annuity of the Qualified Joint and Survivor Annuity shall
      be equal to

     (  ) 50%        (  ) 66-2/3%        (  ) 100%

     of the annuity payable during the joint lives of the Participant and
     the Participant's spouse.


XIV. OPTIONAL FORMS OF BENEFIT

     The following optional forms of benefit shall be available in addition
     to the optional forms of benefit available under Section 9.4 of the
     Plan:

     (  ) ____________________________________________________________________
          ____________________________________________________________________





     [Note:  If the Plan is an amendment and restatement of an Existing
     Plan, optional forms of benefit protected under section 411(d)(6) of
     the Code may not be eliminated, unless permitted by IRS regulations
     sections 1.401(a)-(4) and 1.411(d)-4.]


XV.  LIFE INSURANCE


     Life insurance (  ) shall; (  ) shall not be a permissible investment.


XVI. PRE-RETIREMENT DEATH BENEFIT


If the Plan is not funded with life insurance, the pre-retirement death
benefit shall be:

     (  )  the Qualified Pre-retirement Survivor Annuity (the required
           spousal benefit) only.

     (  )  The Actuarial Value of the Participant's Accrued Benefit.  If the
           Participant's Spouse is the Beneficiary, such benefit shall be
           offset by the Actuarial Value of the Qualified Pre-retirement
           Survivor Annuity.


     If the Plan is funded with life insurance, the face amount of the
     policies purchased will be [. . . .] (not to exceed 100) times the
     Participant's anticipated monthly retirement benefit.



XVII. VESTING SERVICE


     In order to be credited with a year of Service for vesting purposes, a
     Participant shall complete [. . . .] (not to exceed 1,000) Hours of
     Service.  (Not applicable if elapsed time method of crediting service
     is elected.)


XVIII. VESTING SERVICE-EXCLUSIONS


     All of an Employee's years of Service with the Employer shall be
     counted to determine the vested interest of such Employee except:

           (  ) Years of Service before age 18.

           (  ) Years of Service before the Employer maintained this Plan or
                a predecessor plan.

           (  ) Years of Service before the effective date of ERISA if such
                Service would have been disregarded under the Service Break
                rules of the prior plan in effect from time to time before
                such date.  For this purpose, Service Break rules are rules
                which result in the loss of prior vesting or benefit
                accruals, or deny an Employee's eligibility to participate
                by reason of separation or failure to complete a required
                period of Service within a specified period of time.


XIX. VESTING SCHEDULES


     The vested interest of each Employee (who has an Hour of Service on or
     after January 1, 1989) in his Employer-derived Accrued Benefit shall
     be determined on the basis of the following schedule:

           (  ) 100% immediately vested.  [Note:  Mandatory if more than 1
                Eligibility Year of Service is required.]

           (  ) 100% immediately vested after [. . . .] (not to exceed 5)
                years of Service.

           (  ) [. . . .]% (not less than 20%) vested for each year of
                Service, beginning with the [. . . .] (not more than the
                3rd) year of Service until 100% vested.

           (  ) the Top Heavy Minimum Vesting Schedule selected in B.,
                below.

           (  ) Other:  [. . . .] (must be at least as favorable as any one
                of the above 4 options).

           AND

           (  ) Effective Date Vesting.  Each Employee who is a Participant
                on the Effective Date shall be 100% immediately vested.

     B.    Top Heavy Minimum Vesting Schedule.

           One of the following schedules will be used for years when the
           Plan is or is deemed to be Top-Heavy.

           (  ) 100% immediately vested after [. . . .] (not to exceed 3)
                years of Service.

           (  ) 20% vested after 2 years of Service, plus
                [. . . .]% vested (not less than 20%) for each additional
                year of Service until 100% vested.

           If the vesting schedule under the Plan shifts in or out of the
           Minimum Schedule above for any Plan Year because of the Plan's
           Top-Heavy status, such shift is an amendment to the vesting
           schedule and the election in Section 6.5 of the Plan applies.



XX.  LOANS


     Loans (  ) shall; (  ) shall not be permitted.



XXI. EXCESS ASSETS


     Following a complete termination of the Plan by the Employer, any
     assets which remain after provisions have been made to satisfy all
     liabilities of the Plan to Participants and Beneficiaries

           (  ) shall revert to the Employer in cash.

           (  ) shall be allocated among Participants on a uniform and
                non-discriminatory basis, subject to the limitation on
                benefits of Section 8.1 of the Plan.

     Note:  If this is an amendment and restatement of an existing Plan
     which did not previously provide for a reversion, an election that
     excess assets revert to the Employer shall not be effective before the
     end of the 5th calendar year following the date of this Adoption
     Agreement.


XVIII. TOP-HEAVY PROVISIONS

     A.    Top Heavy Status

           (  ) The provisions of Article XV of the Plan shall always apply.

           (  ) The provisions of Article XV of the Plan shall only apply in
                Plan Years after 1983, during which the Plan is or becomes
                Top-Heavy.

     B.    Minimum Benefit

           If the Employer has adopted Sponsor's paired defined contribution
           plan number 01001, 01003, 01004, 01005 and/or 01006 in addition
           to this Plan and the definition of "Eligible Employee" in all
           paired plans is identical, then Non-Key Employees who are
           Participants in this Plan shall receive the minimum Top Heavy
           benefit accrued under this Plan and shall receive no minimum
           allocation under the paired defined contribution plan or plans.

           If a Participant in this Plan who is a Non-Key Employee is
           covered under another qualified plan maintained by the Employer,
           other than a paired plan of the Sponsor, the minimum Top Heavy
           allocation or benefit required under section 416 of the Code
           shall be provided to such Non-Key Employee under:

           (  ) this Plan.

           (  ) the Employer's qualified defined contribution plan.

     C.    Determination of Present Value

           For purposes of establishing present value to compute the
           Top-Heavy Ratio, any benefit shall be discounted only for
           mortality and interest based on the following:

     (  )  Interest Rate [....]%  (must be between 7 1/2% and 8 1/2% if the
           plan provides for permitted disparity under section 401(l) of the
           Code).

           Mortality table:  [....] (must be standard mortality table as
           described in section 1/401(a)(4)-12 of the Income Tax regulations
           if the plan provides for permitted disparity under section 401(l)
           of the Code).

           (  ) The Interest Rate(s) and Mortality Table specified under
                Section 1.2 of the Plan

     D.    Valuation Date

           For purposes of computing the Top-Heavy Ratio, the Valuation Date
           shall be one of the following:

                (  ) the first day of the Plan Year

                (  ) the last day of the Plan Year

                (  ) [....]

           [Note:  The date selected must be the same date used for
           computing Plan costs for minimum funding, regardless of whether a
           valuation is performed that year.]


XIX. LIMITATION ON BENEFITS

     If the Employer maintains or has ever maintained another qualified
     plan (other than the Sponsor's paired defined contribution plan number
     01001, 01003, 01004, 01005 and/or 01006) in which any Participant in
     this Plan is (or was) a Participant or could possibly become a
     Participant, the adopting Employer must complete this Section.  The
     Employer must also complete this Section if it maintains a welfare
     benefit fund, as defined in section 419(e) of the Code, or an
     individual medical account, as defined in section 415(1)(2) of the
     Code, under which amounts are treated as Annual Additions with respect
     to any Participant in the Plan.  (If the Employer maintains only
     paired plans of the Sponsor this Section should not be completed.)

     (a)   If a Participant is, or ever has been, covered under another
           qualified defined benefit plan maintained by the Employer, annual
           benefits shall be limited to comply with section 415(b) of the
           Code:

           (  ) by freezing or reducing Annual Benefits under this Plan.

           (  ) by freezing or reducing Annual Benefits in the other
                qualified defined benefit plan.

     (b)   If a Participant is, or has ever been, a participant in one or
           more qualified defined contributions plans maintained by the
           Employer, the "1.0" aggregate limitation of section 415(e) of the
           Code shall be satisfied by:

           (  ) freezing or reducing Annual Benefits under this Plan.

           (  ) freezing or reducing the Annual Additions under the defined
                contribution plan or plans.



XX.  PRE-TERMINATION RESTRICTIONS

     The pre-termination restrictions in Section 8.3 of the Plan will be
     effective [  /  /  ] (no later than the first day of the 1994 plan
     year).



XXI. EMPLOYER REPRESENTATIONS

           The Employer hereby represents that:

                a.   It is aware of, and agrees to be bound by, the terms of
                     the Plan.

                b.   It understands that the Sponsor will not furnish legal
                     or tax advice in connection with the adoption or
                     operation of the Plan and has consulted legal and tax
                     counsel to the extent necessary.

                c.   The failure to properly fill out this Adoption
                     Agreement may result in disqualification of the Plan.



XXII. RELIANCE ON PLAN QUALIFICATION

     An Employer who has ever maintained or who later adopts any plan
     (including, after December 31, 1985, a welfare benefit fund, as
     defined in section 419(e) of the Code, which provides post-retirement
     medical benefits allocated to separate accounts for Key Employees, as
     defined in section 419(d)(3) of the Code, or an individual medical
     account, as defined in section 415(1)(2) of the Code) in addition to
     this Plan (other than the Sponsor's paired defined contribution plan
     number 01001, 01003, 01004, 01005 or 01006 may not rely on the opinion
     letter issued by the National Office of the Internal Revenue Service
     as evidence that this Plan is qualified under section 401 of the Code.

     If an Employer who adopts or maintains multiple plans wishes to obtain
     reliance that his or her plans are qualified, application for a
     determination letter should be made to the appropriate key district
     office of the Internal Revenue Service.

     In addition, the Employer may rely upon the opinion letter issued by
     the national Office of the Internal Revenue Service only if the plan
     adopted by the Employer satisfies one of the safe-harbors provided in
     regulations under section 401(a)(26) of the Code with respect to its
     prior benefit structure or is deemed to satisfy section 401(a)(26)
     under such regulations.

     If the employer wishes to obtain reliance that its plan is qualified,
     the employer may request a determination from the appropriate Key
     District Director with regard to its prior benefit structure.

     The Employer may not be entitled to rely on the opinion letter issued
     by the National Office in certain other circumstances, which are
     specified in the opinion letter issued with respect to the plan or in
     section 6 of Revenue Procedure 89-9, as amended.



XXIII. PROTOTYPE PLAN DOCUMENTS

     This Adoption Agreement may be used only in conjunction with the
     Dreyfus Prototype Defined Benefit Plan, Basic Plan Document No. 02,
     and the Dreyfus Trust Agreement all as amended from time to time.  In
     the event the Sponsor amends the Basic Plan Document or this Adoption
     Agreement or discontinues this type of plan, it will inform the
     Employer.  The Sponsor, Dreyfus Corporation, is available to answer
     questions regarding the intended meaning of any Plan provisions,
     adoption of the Plan and the effect of an opinion letter at:
     _________________________________________________________________________
     _________________________________________________________________________.




IN WITNESS WHEREOF, the Employer and the Trustee have executed this
instrument the ______ day of _____ , 19__.  If applicable, the appropriate
corporate seal has been affixed and attested to.





                          __________________________________________
                          Name of Business Entity


                          __________________________________________
                          Signature (Sole Proprietors only)


                          By:_______________________________________
                               Name and Title
                               (Corporations or Partnerships)


ATTEST:


_________________________________
Secretary (Corporations Only)




                          __________________________________________
                          Name of Trustee(s)


                          __________________________________________
                          Signature (Individual Trustee)


                          __________________________________________
                          Signature (Individual Trustee)


                          By:_______________________________________
                             Name and Title (Corporate Trustee only)



                              ADOPTION AGREEMENT
                  DREYFUS EASY STANDARDIZED/PAIRED PROTOTYPE
                              PROFIT SHARING PLAN

                               PLAN NUMBER 01006
                          IRS SERIAL NUMBER D262556a


The Employer named in section I.A. below hereby establishes or restates a
Profit Sharing Plan ("Plan") and Custodial Account appointing The Dreyfus
Trust Company as the custodian ("Custodian") under the related custodial
agreement ("Custodial Agreement").  The Custodial Account shall consist of
such sums as shall be paid to the Custodian, the investments thereof and
earnings thereon.  The terms of the Plan are set forth in this Adoption
Agreement and the applicable provisions of the Dreyfus Prototype Defined
Contribution Plan, Basic Plan Document No. 01, and the Dreyfus Custodial
Agreement, both as amended from time to time, which are hereby adopted and
incorporated herein by reference.


I.   EMPLOYER DATA

     A.    Employer's Name:         [....]

                  Address:          [....]

     B.    The Employer is a ( ) partnership; ( ) sole proprietor.

     C.    IF this is a new Plan, the Effective Date of the Plan is: [....].

     D.    If this is an amendment and restatement of an existing Plan, enter
           name of Plan [....] and date adopted [....].  The effective date
           of the amended Plan is: [....]


II.  ELIGIBILITY

     Each Eligible Employee will be eligible to participate in this Plan,
     except the following:

     ( )   Employees who have not attained the age of [....]  (not to exceed
           age 21).

     ( )   Employees who have not completed [....] Eligibility Years of
           service.  (May not exceed 2 years).

     Note:  The term Employee includes all employees of the Employer and any
     employer required to be aggregated with the Employer under Section
     414(b), (c), (m) or (o) of the Internal Revenue Code ("Code"), and
     individuals considered employees of any such employer under section
     414(n) or (o) of the Code.


III. NORMAL RETIREMENT AGE

     Normal Retirement Age shall mean age 59-1/2.


IV.  EMPLOYER CONTRIBUTIONS

     The Employer's contributions ( ) shall; ( ) shall not be made from its
     current or accumulated Net Profits.  (If left blank, contributions may
     only be made from Net Profits).

     The contribution will be an amount fixed by appropriate action of the
     Employer and shall not be integrated with Social Security.


V.   SURVIVOR ANNUITY REQUIREMENTS

     Distribution of benefits upon retirement or death of a Participant
     shall be subject to the Automatic Annuity rules of Section 8.2 of the
     Plan.


VI.  VESTING

     Vesting shall be full and immediate.


VII. TOP-HEAVY RULE

     A.    Top-Heavy Status

           The Top-Heavy provisions of Article XIII shall always apply.

     B.    Minimum Allocation

           If the Employer has adopted Sponsor's paired defined contribution
           plan number 01001, 01004 or 01005 in addition to this Plan, then
           the minimum allocation required by Section 13.3 will be provided (
           ) under this Plan; ( ) under such other paired defined
           contribution plan.  If the Employer has adopted Sponsor's paired
           defined benefit plan number 02001,  then Participants in this Plan
           (or another paired defined contribution plan) who are covered
           under the paired defined benefit plan shall receive the minimum
           top heavy benefit under the paired defined benefit plan and shall
           receive no minimum allocation.

           If a Participant in this Plan who is a Non-Key Employee is covered
           under another qualified plan maintained by the Employer, other
           than a paired plan of the Sponsor, the minimum top heavy
           allocation or benefit required under section 416 of the Code shall
           be provided to such Non-Key Employee under:

           ( )  this Plan.

           ( )  the Employer's other qualified defined contribution plan.

           ( )  the Employer's qualified defined benefit plan.

           ( )  other: ______________________________________





     C.    Determination of Present Value

           If the Employer maintains a defined benefit plan in addition to
           this Plan, and such plan fails to specify the interest rate and
           mortality table to be used for purposes of establishing present
           value to compute the Top-Heavy Ratio, then the following
           assumptions shall be used:

           Interest Rate [....]%   Mortality Table [....]%


VIII.      LIMITATIONS ON ALLOCATIONS

     If the Employer maintains or has ever maintained another qualified plan
     (other than the Sponsor's paired defined contribution plan numbers
     01001, 01004 or 01005 or the Sponsor's paired defined benefit plan
     number 02001), in which any Participant in this Plan is (or was) a
     Participant or could possibly become a Participant, the following
     provision(s) must apply.  The Employer must also complete this Section
     if it maintains a welfare benefit fund, as defined in section 419(e) of
     the Code, or an individual medical account, as defined in section
     415(l)(2) of the Code, under which amounts are treated as Annual
     Additions with respect to any Participant in the Plan.  (If the
     Employer maintains only paired plans of the Sponsor this Section should
     not be completed.)

     (a)   If the Participant is covered under another qualified defined
           contribution plan maintained by the Employer other than a Master
           or Prototype Plan, Annual Additions for any Limitation Year shall
           be limited to comply with section 415(c) of the Code:

           ( )  in accordance with Sections 6.4(e) - (j) as though the other
                plan were a Master or Prototype Plan.

           ( )  by freezing or reducing Annual Additions in the other
                qualified defined contribution plan.

           ( )  other: ________________________________________________






     (b)   If a Participant is or has ever been a participant in a qualified
           defined benefit plan maintained by the Employer, the "1.0"
           aggregate limitation of section 415(e) of the Code shall be
           satisfied by:
           ( )  freezing or reducing the rate of benefit  accrual under the
                qualified defined benefit plan.

           ( )  freezing or reducing the Annual Additions under this Plan
                (or, if the Employer maintains more than one qualified
                defined contribution plan, as indicated in (a) above):

           ( )  other: ________________________________________________







IX . INVESTMENTS

     In accordance with the provisions of the Custodial Agreement, the
     Employer hereby directs the Custodian to invest the assets of the Fund
     as indicated per the attached Participant's Plans Detail form.



X.   EMPLOYER REPRESENTATIONS

     The Employer hereby represents that:

     a.    It is aware of, and agrees to be bound by, the terms of the Plan.

     b.    It understands that the Sponsor will not furnish legal or tax
           advice in connection with the adoption or operation of the Plan
           and has consulted legal and tax counsel to the extent necessary.

     c.    The failure to properly fill out this Adoption Agreement may
           result in disqualification of the Plan.


XI.  RELIANCE ON PLAN QUALIFICATION

     An Employer who has ever maintained or who later adopts any plan
     (including, after December 31, 1985, a welfare benefit fund, as defined
     in section 419(e) of the Code, which provides post-retirement medical
     benefits allocated to separate accounts for Key Employees, as defined
     in section 419A(d)(3) of the Code, or an individual medical account, as
     defined in section 415(l)(2) of the Code) in addition of this Plan
     (other than the Sponsor's defined contribution paired plan number
     01001, 01004, or 01005 or the Sponsor's defined benefit paired plan
     number 02001) may not rely on the opinion letter issued by the National
     Office of the Internal Revenue Service as evidence that this Plan is
     qualified under section 401 of the Code.  If the Employer who adopts or
     maintains multiple plans wishes to obtain reliance that his or her
     plan(s) are qualified, application for a determination letter should be
     made to the appropriate Key District Director of Internal Revenue.

XII. PROTOTYPE PLAN DOCUMENTS

     This Adoption Agreement may be used only in conjunction with the
     Dreyfus Prototype Defined Contribution Plan, Basic Plan Document
     No. 01, and the Dreyfus Custodial Agreement both as amended from time
     to time.  In the event the Sponsor amends Basic Plan Document No. 01 or
     this Adoption Agreement or discontinues this type of plan, it will
     inform the Employer.  The Sponsor, The Dreyfus Corporation is available
     to answer questions regarding the intended meaning of any Plan
     provisions adoption of the Plan and the effect of an Opinion Letter at
     144 Glenn Curtiss Boulevard, Uniondale, New York 11556-0144 [(516)
     338-3418].

EMPLOYER ACCEPTANCE

By signing the Application you acknowledge that you have received and read
the Fund(s) current prospectus(es), the Dreyfus Easy Standardized/Paired
Retirement Plan and the attached Custodial Agreement.  You accept the terms
of the Plan and Custodial Agreement and you appoint The Dreyfus Trust
Company to be Custodian.


____________________                      _____

Employer's Signature                      Date





CUSTODIAN'S ACCEPTANCE

By signing here, The Dreyfus Trust Company accepts this Adoption Agreement
and its appointment as Custodian of your Dreyfus Easy Standardized/Paired
Retirement Plan.  The Adoption Agreement will be maintained by The Dreyfus
Trust Company.



_________________________                                    ____


The Dreyfus Trust Company                                     Date
Custodian


                              CUSTODIAL AGREEMENT

                  Dreyfus Easy Standardized/Paired Prototype

                     Defined Contribution Retirement Plans

                          Basic Plan Document No. 01

     This Custodial Agreement is for use in connection with Dreyfus Easy
Standardized/Paired Prototype Money Purchase Plan (No. 01005) or Dreyfus
Easy Standardized/Paired Prototype Profit Sharing Plan (No. 01006).  The
Employer named on the Adoption Agreement, by signing the Adoption Agreement,
hereby establishes a Custodial Agreement, and The Dreyfus Trust Company
(herein referred to as the "Custodian"), by countersigning the Adoption
Agreement, accepts the custodianship thereof upon the following conditions:

     1.    The Employer represents that the Employer is either a sole
           proprietorship or a partnership.

     2.    The Custodial Agreement is established solely for the purpose of
           holding such cash or monetary contributions made by or on behalf
           of participants in the Plan (the "Participants") as the Custodian
           may receive from time to time from the Employer, rollover
           contributions and transfers from other qualified retirement plans
           (to the extent permitted under the Plan), and investments
           purchased therewith pursuant to paragraph 5 hereof (the "Custodial
           Account").  Contributions under the Plan shall be accepted by the
           Custodian only when made through the Employer, and shall be
           accompanied by written instructions from the Employer specifying
           the Participant's account to which they are to be credited
           (including the type of contribution being made) and the
           investments to be acquired therewith.  The Custodian shall hold
           and treat the contributions made by or on behalf of each
           Participant as a separate account under the Agreement.  The
           Custodian shall have no obligation to verify the allowability or
           amount of contributions and may rely solely on the representations
           of the Employer with respect thereto.

     3.    The Custodian shall make such distributions (including transfers
           to a qualified retirement plan or an individual retirement
           account) as the Employer shall direct in writing.  Such directions
           shall specify whether the distribution is a normal distribution
           (i.e., a distribution on or after age 59-1/2), a premature
           distribution (i.e., a distribution before age 59-1/2), on account of
           the death or disability of the Participant, a return of an excess
           contribution and such other information as the Custodian may
           require in order to accurately report the nature of the
           distribution to the appropriate governmental authorities.  At no
           time shall it be possible for any part of the assets of the
           Custodial Account to be used for or diverted to purposes other
           than for the exclusive purpose of providing benefits to
           Participants and their beneficiaries and defraying the reasonable
           expenses of administering the Plan.  In connection with the making
           of any distributions, the Custodian may rely solely on the
           accuracy of all facts supplied at any time by the Employer,
           including any written designation of beneficiary.  If
           distributions are to be made in the form of a joint and survivor
           or pre-retirement survivor annuity, such instructions, shall
           specify the amount to be applied to the purchase of such an
           annuity contract from an insurance company.  In the case of a
           direction to distribute in a form other than an annuity or to a
           beneficiary other than the Participant's spouse, the Employer
           shall be deemed to certify that the directed distribution complies
           with the distribution rules applicable thereto and that where
           applicable, it has received a validly executed spousal consent to
           the distributions in the form or to the person to whom
           distribution is directed.  Prior to making any distribution, the
           Employer shall supply the Custodian with such documentation as it
           may reasonably require including documentation with respect to any
           estate or other inheritance taxes which may be due on the
           Participant's death.  In making such distributions upon death, the
           Custodian may retain a reserve for taxes and expenses in
           accordance with the rules of paragraphs 9 and 10 hereof.

     4.    The Employer shall file all beneficiary designations and changes
           thereof with the Custodian.  To be effective, any designation or
           change of designation must be received by the Custodian prior to
           the death of the Participant.  In the event that there is no such
           beneficiary designation on file with the Custodian or if all
           beneficiaries have predeceased the Participant, the Custodian
           shall make distributions to such persons and in such amounts as
           may be specified in writing by the Employer.

     5.    The amount of each contribution credited to a Participant's
           account shall be applied to the following in accordance with the
           Employer's written instructions:

           (a)  Fund Shares:  Shares of ownership in an investment company
                registered under the Investment Company Act of 1940, as
                amended, the shares of which are sponsored, managed, advised,
                subadvised or administered by The Dreyfus Corporation (the
                "Sponsor") or any of its affiliates, or shares in any other
                investment company as may from time to time be offered by the
                Sponsor (the "Fund"), in accordance with the respective
                Fund's current prospectus and which the Custodian has agreed
                to hold in the Custodial Account.  (Such shares are referred
                to herein as "Fund Shares").

           (b)  Other Investments:  Other investments allowed by law, offered
                by the Sponsor and which the Custodian has agreed in writing
                with the Sponsor to hold in the Custodial Account.  (Fund
                Shares and such other investments are referred to
                collectively as "Investments").  A receipt for each
                contribution received and showing the investment thereof and
                current status of the Custodial Account with respect to each
                Participant shall be prepared by the Custodian and delivered
                to the Employer.  All dividends and capital gain
                distributions received on the Fund Shares held by the
                Custodian in Custodial Account shall be reinvested in
                accordance with the respective Fund's current prospectus in
                such shares and credited to such Account.  The Custodian
                shall furnish the Employer with a statement of the Custodial
                Account with respect to each Participant (including a
                statement as to each Participant's account) no less
                frequently than once a calendar year which shall be deemed to
                be the sole accounting by the Custodian necessary under this
                Agreement. If the Custodian does not receive a written
                objection to such accounting from the Employer within one
                hundred eighty (180) days after the date the accounting is
                sent by the Custodian, the Custodian shall be relieved from
                all liabilities and responsibilities that may arise in
                connection with any matters covered by the accounting.

     6.    Where the Employer allows, Participants may authorize and direct
           the Custodian in writing to exchange any or all Fund Shares held
           by the Custodian on behalf of such Participant, for any other
           Fund Shares, subject to and in accordance with the terms and
           conditions of any exchange privilege, including the telephone
           privilege, offered with respect to Fund Shares.  The Employer may
           authorize an investment advisor to make such exchanges for all
           accounts maintained under the Plan, if allowed by the Sponsor,
           subject to and in accordance with such terms and conditions as may
           be agreed upon in writing from time to time by the Sponsor and the
           Custodian.  If the Employer elects the telephone exchange
           privilege or if the Employer in writing authorizes an investment
           advisor to make exchanges as described above, the Custodian shall
           be entitled to rely and act on telephone instructions reasonably
           believed by it to be genuine, received from any person directing
           the exchange of any or all Fund Shares held by the Custodian on
           behalf of the Participant for any other Fund Shares as specified
           in such telephonic instructions, provided that such Fund is
           available for sale in the state of residence of the Participant.
           The Custodian will employ reasonable procedures, such as
           requesting a form of personal identification, to confirm that
           telephonic instructions are genuine and, if it does not follow
           such procedures, it may be liable for any losses due to
           unauthorized or fraudulent instructions.  It is understood and
           agreed that the telephone exchange privilege is subject to the
           limitation specified above.  The Employer understands and agrees
           that the Custodian, any Dreyfus Fund, the Sponsor or any
           subsidiary of the Sponsor, or their respective officers and
           employees, will not be held liable and will be fully protected by
           the Employer against any loss, expense or cost (including
           attorney's fees) arising out of any telephone exchange request
           reasonably believed to be genuine.  The Employer certifies and
           agrees that the certifications, authorizations, directions and
           restrictions contained herein will continue until the Custodian
           receives written notice of any change or revocation.  The Employer
           agrees and understands that the Funds and the Custodian reserve
           the right to refuse any telephonic instructions.

     7.    The Custodian shall be compensated for its services under this
           Agreement in accordance with the fee schedule in effect from time
           to time and shall be reimbursed for its expenses.

     8.    Any income tax or other taxes of any kind whatsoever that may be
           levied or assessed upon or in respect to the Custodial Account
           shall, unless allocable to a particular Participant's Account, be
           charged proportionately to the accounts of all Participants held
           under this Agreement.  Any transfer taxes incurred in connection
           with the investment and reinvestment of the assets of the
           Custodial Account, all other administrative expenses incurred by
           the Custodian in the performance of its duties, including fees for
           legal services rendered to the Custodial Account and such
           compensation to the Custodian as may be set forth in the fee
           schedule attached to the Application as revised from time to time
           by the Custodian shall, to the extent that they are not allocable
           to a particular Participant's account under this Agreement, be
           allocated proportionately to the accounts of all Participants held
           under this Agreement.

      9.   The Employer shall at any time have the right to remove the
           Custodian by delivering to it a notice in writing to that effect
           which notice shall also designate a successor custodian.  Upon
           receipt by the Custodian of written acceptance by the successor
           custodian of its appointment, the removal of the Custodian shall
           be effective and the Custodian shall forthwith transfer and pay
           over to such successor custodian the assets of the Custodial
           Account and such records pertaining thereto as the successor
           custodian may reasonably request in writing.  The Custodian may,
           however, reserve such Fund Shares as may be required for the
           payment of all its fees, compensation, costs and expenses and for
           the payment of all liabilities of or against the assets of the
           Custodial Account or Custodian and where necessary may liquidate
           such reserved Fund Shares.  Any balances of such reserve remaining
           after the payment of all such items shall be paid over to the
           successor custodian.  Any successor custodian must meet the
           applicable requirements of the Employee Retirement Income Security
           Act of 1974, as amended ("ERISA") and the Internal Revenue Code of
           1986, as amended (the "Code").

     10.   The Custodian shall at any time have the right to resign as
           custodian under this Agreement by written notice to the Employer,
           which shall be effective 90 days after it is sent.  Upon receipt
           by the Custodian of written acceptance by a successor custodian of
           such appointment, the Custodian is authorized to act in the same
           manner as provided in paragraph 9 hereof.  In the event the
           Employer fails to appoint a successor custodian, the Custodian
           will terminate the account in a manner consistent with the Code.

     11.   The Custodian shall keep accurate and detailed accounts of all
           contributions, receipts, investments, distributions, disbursements
           and all other transactions.  The Custodian shall prepare and file
           such reports and returns as required of a custodian under ERISA or
           the Code.

     12.   The Custodian shall mail to the Employer all notices,
           prospectus(es), financial statements, proxies and proxy soliciting
           material relating to the Investments held hereunder except in
           accordance with the written instructions of the Employer.

     13.   At no time shall it be possible for the Custodian to knowingly
           engage in any transaction which is prohibited by section 4975 of
           the Code, or section 406 of ERISA.

     14.   Upon written request of the Employer, the Custodian shall return
           any contribution made by the Employer because of a mistake of
           fact; because it is conditioned upon the Plan's initial
           qualification under the Code and the Plan is determined to be
           disqualified; or because it is conditioned upon deductibility
           under section 404 of the Code and a deduction is disallowed for
           such contribution, within one year of the mistaken contribution,
           the date the initial qualification of the Plan is denied or the
           date the deduction is disallowed, respectively.  The Custodian
           shall be under no obligation to inquire as to the facts
           surrounding any requested return and may rely on the Employer's
           written representations with respect thereto.

     15.   The Custodian shall be under no duties whatsoever except such
           duties as are specifically set forth as such in this Custodial
           Agreement, and no implied covenant or obligation shall be read
           into this Custodial Agreement against the Custodian.  The Employer
           shall have the sole authority and responsibility for the
           enforcement or defense of the terms and conditions of the
           Custodial Agreement against or on behalf of any person or persons
           claiming any interest in the Custodial Account.

     16.   If the Employer is a partnership, upon the death of the last
           surviving partner, the legal representative of such partner's
           estate shall be deemed to be the Employer under this Agreement.
           Upon the death of the Employer if the Employer is a sole
           proprietorship, the legal representative of such Employer's estate
           shall be deemed to be the Employer under this Agreement.

     17.   The Custodian reserves the right to amend all or part of the terms
           of this Custodial Agreement upon written notice to the Employer in
           any manner which would not disqualify the Custodial Agreement from
           complying with sections 401 and 501 of the Code.

     18.   The Custodian may employ such agents, experts and counsel as it
           may, from time to time, deem necessary or appropriate and may
           delegate discretionary responsibilities thereto.  The reasonable
           fees and expenses of such agents, experts and counsel shall be
           charged to the Custodial Account in accordance with paragraph 8 of
           this Agreement.

     19.   The Custodian shall be liable only for its negligence or willful
           misconduct in performing or failing to perform the terms of the
           Custodial Agreement, and the Custodian shall not be liable for any
           action, or failure to act, it shall take when such action or
           failure to act is in accordance with the instructions of the
           Employer or the Sponsor, or is in accordance with the terms and
           conditions of the exchange privilege,  including the telephone
           exchange privilege, offered with respect to Fund Shares.  The
           Custodian shall not be required to give bond or security for the
           performance of its duties.  The Employer shall fully indemnify and
           hold harmless the Custodian from any liability, cost or expense
           (including attorney's fees), incurred in connection with the
           Custodial Agreement, except that which may arise from the
           negligence or willful misconduct of the Custodian.

     20.   The Employer understands that neither the Sponsor nor the
           Custodian will render legal or tax advice and states that it has
           consulted legal and tax counsel to the extent necessary.

     21.   This Custodial Agreement shall be construed, administered and
           enforced according to the law of the State of New York, except to
           the extent preempted by ERISA.  In the event of any conflict
           between the terms of the Plan and the terms of the Custodial
           Agreement, the terms of the Custodial Agreement shall control.


                             DREYFUS PROTOTYPE
                            DEFINED BENEFIT PLAN

                         BASIC PLAN DOCUMENT NO. 02
                    DREYFUS PROTOTYPE DEFINED BENEFIT PLAN
                         BASIC PLAN DOCUMENT NO. 02


                                 ARTICLE I.
                                 DEFINITIONS

1.0  "Accrued Benefit" at any time shall mean the product of the
     Standard Form of Retirement Income which would be payable at the
     Participant's Normal Retirement Date multiplied by a fraction
     the numerator of which is his years of Participation at such
     date and the denominator of which is the years of Participation
     he could have completed at Normal Retirement Date.  Such
     fraction shall not exceed one (1.0).

     When determining the Accrued Benefit, the Standard Form of
     Retirement Income is the annual benefit to which the Participant
     would be entitled if he continued to earn annually until Normal
     Retirement Date the same rate of Compensation upon which his
     Standard Form of Retirement income would be computed.  This rate
     of Compensation is computed on the basis of Compensation taken
     into account under the Plan for determining the Standard Form of
     Retirement Income.

     For Plan Years beginning before section 411 of the Code is
     applicable hereto, the Participant's Accrued Benefit shall be
     the greater of that provided by the Plan, or one-half (1/2) of
     the benefit which would have accrued had the provisions of this
     Section 1.0 been in effect.  In the event that the Accrued
     Benefit as of the effective date of section 411 of the Code is
     less than that provided by this Section 1.0, such difference
     shall be accrued in accordance with the provisions of this
     Section 1.0.

1.1  "Act" shall mean the Employee Retirement Income Security Act of
     1974, as amended.

1.2  "Actuarial Equivalent" shall mean, with respect to any benefit
     under the terms of this Plan, the actuarial present value of a
     stated benefit.  Except to the extent a Participant's benefits
     are suspended in accordance with the suspension of benefits
     rules in section 5.7  of the Plan, the amount of any form of
     benefits under the terms of this Plan will be the Actuarial
     Equivalent of the Participant's Accrued Benefit in the Standard
     Form of Retirement Income commencing at Normal Retirement Age.
     The Actuarial Equivalent shall be determined on the basis of the
     interest rate and mortality table specified in the Adoption
     Agreement.  In the case of a Plan that provides for the
     disparity permitted under section 401(l), if benefits commence
     to a Participant at an age other than Normal Retirement Age, the
     Participant's benefit will be adjusted in accordance with
     section 5.3 of the Plan.  In the event that the adopting
     Employer does not specify the interest rates and mortality
     table, actuarial equivalence shall be determined by discounting
     all future payments for interest and mortality on the basis of
     the 1971 Group Annuity Mortality Table (Unisex) without
     projection and six percent (6%) interest.


     Notwithstanding the preceding paragraph, for purposes of
     determining the amount of distribution in a form other than a
     non-decreasing annuity payable for a period of not less than the
     life of the Participant (or, in the case of a Qualified Pre
     Retirement Survivor Annuity, the life of the surviving spouse),
     actuarial equivalence will be determined on the basis of the
     mortality table specified in the Adoption Agreement, and the
     section 417 interest rate(s), if it produces a benefit greater
     than that determined under the preceding paragraph.

     The section  417 interest rate(s) are as follows: (i)  the
     "applicable PBGC interest rate" if the actuarial present value
     of the benefit (using such rate(s)) is not in excess of twenty
     five thousand dollars ($25,000); or

     (ii)  one hundred twenty percent (120% of the "applicable PBGC
     interest rate" if the actuarial present value of the benefit
     exceeds twenty five thousand dollars ($25,000) (as determined
     under clause (i) above).  In no event shall the actuarial
     present value determined under this clause (ii) be less than
     twenty five thousand dollars ($25,000).

     The "applicable PBGC interest rate" is the interest rate(s)
     which would be used (as of the first day of the Plan Year which
     contains the Annuity Starting Date) by the PBGC for a trusteed
     single-employer plan to value such benefit upon termination of
     an insufficient trusteed single-employer plan.

     The applicable PBGC interest rate limitations shall apply to
     distributions in Plan years beginning after December 31, 1984.
     Notwithstanding the preceding sentence, the applicable PBGC
     interest rate limitations shall not apply to any distributions
     commencing in Plan Years beginning before January 1, 1987, if
     such distributions were determined in accordance with the
     interest rate(s) as required by regulations section
     1.417(e)-IT(e) including the PBGC immediate interest rate).

     The applicable PBGC interest rate limitations shall not apply to
     annuity contracts distributed to or owned by a Participant prior
     to September 17, 1985, unless additional contributions are made
     under the Plan by the Employer with respect to such contracts.
     In addition, the applicable PBGC interest rate limitations shall
     not apply to annuity contracts owned by the Employer or
     distributed to or owned by Participant prior to the first Plan
     Year beginning after December 31, 1988, if the annuity contracts
     satisfied the requirements in section 1.401(a)-11T and
     1.417(e)-IT of the regulations.  The preceding sentence shall
     not apply if additional contributions are made under the Plan by
     the Employer with respect to such contracts on or after the
     beginning of the first Plan Year beginning after December 31,
     1988.

     If as a result of actuarial increases to the benefit of a
     Participant who delays commencement of benefits beyond Normal
     Retirement Age, the Accrued Benefit of such Participant would
     exceed the Code section 415 limitations under section 8.1(e) of
     the Plan for such year, immediately before the actuarial
     increase to the Participant's benefit that would cause such
     Participant's benefit to exceed the limitations of section 415
     of the Code, payment of benefits to such Participant will be
     suspended in accordance with section 5.7 of the Plan,
     if applicable; otherwise, distribution of the Participant's
     benefit will commence.

1.3  "Actuarial Value"  shall mean the value of a benefit, when
     computed on the date of such determination, on the basis of the
     actuarial assumptions used to determine Actuarial Equivalence.

1.4  "Adoption Agreement" shall mean the document executed by the
     adopting Employer which contains all the options which may be
     selected and which incorporated this Prototype Plan by
     reference.

1.5  "Affiliated Employer" shall mean any corporation which is a
     member of a controlled group of corporations (as defined in
     section 414(b) of the Code) which includes the Employer; any
     trade or business (whether or not incorporated) which is under
     common control (as defined in section 414(c) of the Code) with
     the Employer; any organization (whether or not incorporated)
     which is a member of an affiliated service group (as defined in
     section 414(m) of the Code) which includes the Employer; and any
     other entity required to be aggregated with the Employer
     pursuant to regulations under section 414(o) of the Code.

1.6  "Anniversary Date" shall mean each anniversary of the Effective
     Date, unless otherwise stated in the Adoption Agreement.

1.7  "Annuity Starting Date" shall mean the first day of the first
     period for which an amount is paid as an annuity or any other
     form.  If benefit payments in any form are suspended pursuant to
     section 5.7 of the Plan for an Employee who continues in service
     without a separation and who does not receive a benefit payment
     the recommencement of benefit payments shall be treated as a new
     Annuity Starting Date.

1.8  "Beneficiary" shall mean the person, persons, or trust
     designated by the Participant to receive benefits in the event
     of death under the terms of the Plan.

1.9  "Board of Directors" shall mean the Board of Directors of the
     Employer if the Employer is an incorporated business entity.

1.10 "Code" shall mean the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended.

1.11 "Committee" shall mean the person or persons appointed by the
     Employer to administer the Plan in accordance with Article X.
     If no such Committee is appointed, the Employer shall act as the
     Committee.

1.12 "Compensation", unless otherwise specified in the Adoption
     Agreement, shall mean, in the case of an Employee other than a
     Self-Employed Individual, his section 3401(a) wages, which are
     actually paid during the determination period.  In the case of a
     Self-Employed Individual, Compensation shall mean his Earned
     Income.  Unless otherwise specified in the Adoption Agreement,
     the determination period shall be the Plan Year.  If elected by
     the Employer in the Adoption Agreement, Compensation shall also
     include Employer contributions made pursuant to a salary
     reduction agreement with an Employee which are not currently
     includable in the gross income of the Employee by reason of the
     application of sections 125, 402(e)(3), 402(h) or 403(b) of the
     Code.

     The Compensation of a Participant who was on a military leave of
     absence or on any other authorized leave of absence without pay
     for the whole or part of a Plan Year shall be his compensation
     for the last full year worked prior to such Plan Year.

     "Average Compensation" shall, unless otherwise defined in the
     Adoption Agreement, mean the average of a Participant's
     Compensation for the three (3) consecutive Plan Years of Service
     ending in the current year or in any prior year that produce the
     highest average.  Compensation is averaged on an annual basis
     over the participant's entire period of service.

     "Covered Compensation" shall mean the average (without indexing)
     of the Taxable Wage Bases in effect for each calendar year
     during the thirty-five (35) year period ending with the calendar
     year in which the Participant attains (or will attain) Social
     Security Retirement Age.  No increase in Covered Compensation
     shall decrease a Participant's Accrued Benefit.

     In determining a Participant's Covered Compensation for a Plan
     Year, the Taxable Wage Base for all calendar years beginning
     after the first day of the Plan Year is assumed to be the same
     as the Taxable Wage Base in effect as of the beginning of the
     Plan Year for which the determination is being made.  Covered
     Compensation will be determined based on the year designated  by
     the Employer in the Adoption Agreement.

     A Participant's Covered Compensation for a Plan Year before the
     thirty-five (35) year period ending with the last day of the
     calendar year in which the Participant attains Social Security
     Retirement Age is the Taxable Wage Base in effect as of the
     beginning of the Plan Year.  A Participant's Covered
     Compensation for a Plan Year after such thirty-five (35) year
     period is the Participant's Covered Compensation for the Plan
     Year during which the 35 year period ends.

     "Final Average Compensation" shall mean the average of a
     Participant's Compensation as defined in this Section 1.12 for
     the three (3) consecutive years ending with or within the Plan
     Year.  For this purpose, Compensation in excess of the Taxable
     Wage Base of any year may not be considered.  If a Participant's
     entire period of service is less than three (3) consecutive
     years, Compensation is averaged on a annual basis over the
     Participant's entire period of service.  Compensation for any
     year in excess of the Taxable Wage Base in effect at the
     beginning of such year shall not be taken into account.  No
     increase in Final Average Compensation will decrease a
     Participant's Accrued Benefit under the Plan.


     For years beginning on or after January 1, 1989, and before
     January 1, 1994, the annual Compensation of each participant
     taken into account for determining all benefits provided under
     the Plan for any Plan Year shall not exceed $ 200,000. This
     limitation shall be adjusted by the Secretary at the same time
     and in the same manner as under section 415(d) of the Code,
     except that the dollar increase in effect on January 1 of any
     calendar year is effective for Plan Years beginning in such
     calendar year and the first adjustment to the $ 200,000
     limitation is effective on January 1, 1990.

     For years beginning on or after January 1, 1994, the annual
     compensation limit of each Participant taken into account for
     determining all benefits provided under the Plan for any
     determination period shall not exceed $ 150,000, as adjusted for
     the cost-of-living in accordance with section 401(a)(17)(b) of
     the Code. The cost-of-living adjustment in effect for a calendar
     year applies to any determination period beginning in such
     calendar year.

     If a determination period consists of fewer than 12 months, the
     annual compensation limit is an amount equal to the otherwise
     applicable annual compensation limit multiplied by a fraction,
     the numerator of which is the number of months in the short
     determination period, and the denominator of which is 12.

     In determining the Compensation of a Participant for purposes of
     this limitation, the rules of section 414(q)(6) of the Code
     shall apply, except in applying such rules, the term family
     shall include only the spouse of the Participant and any lineal
     descendants of the Participant who have not attained age 19
     before the close of the year. If, as a result of the application
     of such rules the adjusted annual compensation limitation is
     exceeded, then (except for purposes of determining the portion
     of Compensation up to the integration level if this plan
     provides for permitted disparity), the limitation shall be
     prorated among the affected individuals in proportion to each
     such individual's Compensation as determined under this section
     prior to the application of this limitation.

     If Compensation for any prior determination period is taken into
     account in determining a Participant's benefits for the current
     Plan Year, the Compensation for such prior determination period
     is subject to the applicable annual compensation limit in effect
     for that prior period. For this purpose, in determining benefits
     in Plan Years beginning on or after January 1, 1989, the annual
     compensation limit in effect for determination periods beginning
     before that date is $200,000.  In addition, in determining
     benefits in Plan Years beginning on or after January 1, 1994,
     the annual compensation limit in effect for determination
     periods beginning before that date is $150,000.

1.13 "Contract" shall mean a whole, universal or term life type
     insurance policy or an annuity contract made available and
     issued under this Plan or a predecessor Plan.

1.14 "Deferred Retirement Date" shall mean, in the case of any
     Participant who continues in employment after his Normal
     Retirement Date, the first day of any month following his actual
     retirement.

1.15 "Disability Retirement Date" shall mean the first day of any
     month following the occurrence of Participant's Permanent
     Disability.

1.16 "Early Retirement Date" shall mean the first day of any month
     following the date a Participant satisfies the age and service
     requirements, if any, for early retirement specified in the
     Adoption Agreement.  Upon reaching Early Retirement Date, a
     Participant's right to his Accrued Benefit shall be fully vested
     and nonforfeitable, notwithstanding the Plan's vesting schedule.

1.17 "Earned Income" shall mean the net earning from self-employment
     in the trade or business with respect to which the Plan is
     established, provided that personal services of the individual
     are a material income-producing factor Net earnings will be
     determined without regard to items not included in gross income
     and the deductions allocable to such items.  Net earnings are
     reduced by contributions by the Employer to a qualified plan to
     the extent deductible under section 404 of the Code.  Net
     earnings shall be determined with regard to the deduction
     allowed to the taxpayer by section 164(f) of the Code for
     taxable years beginning after December 31, 1989.

1.18 "Effective Date" shall mean the date specified in the Adoption
     Agreement.

1.19 "Eligible Employee" shall mean each Employee who is not excluded
     from eligibility to participate in the Plan under the Adoption
     Agreement.

1.20 "Eligibility Year(s) of Service" shall mean the twelve (12)
     consecutive month period commencing on an Employee's Employment
     Commencement Date and anniversaries thereof, during which the
     Employee completed at least one thousand (1,000) Hours of
     Service (or such lesser number of Hours of Service specified in
     the Adoption Agreement).

     In the case of a Participant who does not have any
     nonforfeitable right to the Accrued Benefit derived from
     Employer contributions, Eligibility Years of Service before a
     period of consecutive one (1) year Service Breaks will not be
     taken into account in computing Eligibility Years of Service if
     the number of consecutive one (1) year Service Breaks in such
     period equals or exceed the greater of five (5) or the aggregate
     number of eligibility Years of Service.  Such aggregate number
     or Eligibility Years of Service will not include any Eligibility
     Year of Service disregarded under the preceding sentence by
     reason of prior Service Breaks.

     Notwithstanding the above, if the Adoption Agreement provides
     for full and immediate vesting upon completion of the
     eligibility requirements and an Employee has incurred a one (1)
     year Service Break before satisfying the Plan's eligibility
     requirements, all Eligibility Year(s) of Service before such
     Service Break will not be taken into account.

     If the elapsed time method of crediting service is specified in
     the Adoption Agreement, an Employee shall receive credit for
     service, except for credit which may be disregarded under this
     Section or Section 2.3, for the aggregate of all time periods
     commencing on his Employment Commencement Date or Re-Employment
     Commencement Date and ending on his Severance from Service Date.
     An Employee shall also receive credit for any Period of
     Severance of less than twelve (12) months.  Fractional periods
     of a year shall be expressed in terms of days.

1.21 "Employee" shall mean an Owner-Employee, a Self-Employed
     Individual, a Shareholder-Employee or any other person employed
     by the Employer or any Affiliated Employer.

     A "leased employee" shall also be treated as an Employee.  The
     term "leased employee" means any person (other than an employee
     of the recipient employer) who pursuant to an agreement between
     the recipient employer and any other person ("leasing
     organization") has performed services for the recipient employer
     (or for the recipient employer and related persons determined in
     accordance with section 414(n)(6) of the Code) on a
     substantially full-time basis for a period of at least one year,
     and such services are of a type historically performed by
     employees in the business field of the recipient employer.
     Contributions or benefits provided a leased employee by the
     leasing organization which are attributable to services
     performed for the recipient employer shall be treated as
     provided by the recipient employer.

     Notwithstanding the preceding paragraph, a leased employee shall
     not be considered an employee of the recipient employer if:  (i)
     such employee is covered by a money purchase pension plan
     providing:  (1) a nonintegrated employer contribution rate of at
     least ten percent (10%) of compensation, as defined in section
     415(c)(3) of the code, but including amounts contributed
     pursuant to a salary reduction agreement which are excludable
     from the employee's gross income under section 125, section
     402(e)(3), section 402(h) or section 403(b) of the Code, (2)
     immediate participation, and (3) full and immediate vesting; and
     (ii) leased employees do not constitute more than twenty percent
     (20%) of the recipient employers nonhighly compensated
     workforce.

1.22 "Employer" shall mean the corporation, partnership,
     proprietorship or other business entity which shall adopt the
     Plan or any successor thereof and any participating Employer
     designated in the Adoption Agreement.

1.23 "Employment Commencement Date" shall mean the first date with
     respect to which an Employee performs an Hour of Service.

1.24 "Entry Date", unless otherwise specified in the Adoption
     Agreement, shall mean the first day of the Plan Year and the
     first day of the seventh month of the Plan Year.  The initial
     Entry Date shall not precede the original effective date of the
     Plan.

1.25 "Fresh Start Date" mean the date as defined in Section 5.8 of
     the Plan.

1.26 "Frozen Accrued Benefit" shall mean the benefit as defined in
     Section 5.8 of the Plan.

1.27 "Highly Compensated Employee" shall mean an Employee of the
     Employer described in section 414(q) of the Code and the
     regulations thereunder.

     The term Highly Compensated Employee includes Highly Compensated
     Active Employees and Highly Compensated Former Employees.

     A Highly Compensated Active Employee includes any Employee who
     performs service for the Employer during the Determination Year
     and who, during the Look-Back Year: (i) received Compensation
     from the Employer in excess of $75,000 (as adjusted pursuant to
     section 415(d) of the Code); (ii) received Compensation from the
     Employer in excess of $50,000 (as adjusted pursuant to section
     415(d) of the Code) and was a member of the top-paid group for
     such year; or (iii) was an officer of the Employer and received
     Compensation during such year that is greater than 50 percent of
     the dollar limitation in effect under section 415(b)(1)(A) of
     the Code.  The term Highly Compensated Employee also includes:
     (i) Employees who are both described in the preceding sentence
     if the term "Determination Year" is substituted for the term
     "Look-Back Year" and the Employee is one of the 100 Employees
     who received the most Compensation from the Employer during the
     Determination Year; and (ii) Employees who are 5 percent owners
     at any time during the Look-Back Year or Determination Year.

     If no officer has satisfied the Compensation requirement of
     (iii) above during either a Determination Year or Look-Back
     Year, the highest paid officer for such year shall be treated as
     a Highly Compensated Employee.

     For this purpose, the Determination Year shall be the Plan Year.
     The Look-Back Year shall be the twelve-month period immediately
     preceding the Determination Year.

     A Highly Compensated Former Employee includes any Employee who
     separated from Service (or was deemed to have separated) prior
     to the Determination Year, performs no Service for the Employer
     during the Determination Year, and was a Highly Compensated
     Active Employee for either the separation year or any
     Determination Year ending on or after the Employee's 55th
     birthday.

     If an Employee is, during a Determination Year or Look-Back
     Year, a family member or either a 5 percent owner who is an
     active or former Employee or a Highly Compensated Employee who
     is one of the 10 most Highly Compensated Employee ranked on the
     basis of Compensation paid by the Employer during such year,
     then the family member and the 5 percent owner or top-ten Highly
     Compensated Employee shall be aggregated.  In such case, the
     family member and 5 percent owner or top-ten Highly Compensated
     Employee shall be treated as a single Employee receiving
     Compensation and plan contributions or benefits equal to the sum
     of such Compensation and contributions or benefits of the family
     member and 5 percent owner or top-ten Highly Compensated
     Employee.  For purposes of this section, family member includes
     the spouse, lineal ascendants and descendants of the Employee or
     former Employee and the spouse of such lineal ascendants and
     descendants.

     The determination of who is a Highly Compensated Employee,
     including the determination of the number and identity of
     Employees in the top-paid group, the top 100 Employees, the
     number of Employees treated as officers and the Compensation
     that is considered, will be made in accordance with section
     414(g) of the Code and the regulations thereunder.

1.28 "Hour of Service":

     (a)   Each Hour of Service shall mean and include each hour for
                which an Employee is compensated by the Employer, or is
                entitled to be so compensated, for services rendered by him
                to the Employer.  These hours will be credited to the
                Employee for the computation period in which the duties are
                performed; and

     (b)   Each Hour of Service shall also mean and include each hour
                for which an Employee is compensated by the Employer, or is
                entitled to be so compensated, on account of a period of
                time during which no services are rendered by him to the
                Employer (regardless of whether the Employee shall have
                ceased to be an Employee) due to vacation, holiday,
                illness, incapacity (including disability), layoff, jury
                duty, military duty or leave of absence.  No more than five
                hundred and one (501) Hours of Service will be credited
                under this paragraph for a single computation period
                (whether or not the period occurs in a single computation
                period).  Hours under this paragraph will be calculated and
                credited pursuant to section 2530.200b-2 of the Department
                of Labor Regulations which are incorporated herein by this
                reference; and

     (c)   Each Hour of Service shall also mean and include each hour
                for which back pay, without regard to mitigation of
                damages, has been awarded or agreed to by the Employer.
                The same Hours of Service will not be credited both under
                paragraph (a) or paragraph (b), as the case may be, and
                under this paragraph (c).  These hours will be credited to
                the Employee for the computation period or periods to which
                the award or agreement pertains rather than the computation
                period in which the award, agreement or payment is made.

     Hours of Service will be credited for employment with an
     Affiliated Employer.  Hours of Service will also be credited for
     employment with a predecessor employer if the Employer maintains
     the plan of such predecessor or the Employer so elects in the
     Adoption agreement.

     Hours of Service will also be credited for any individual
     considered an Employee under sections 414(n) or 414(o) of the
     Code and the regulations thereunder.

     Solely for purposes of determining whether a Service Break, as
     defined in section 1.44, for participation and vesting purposes
     has occurred in a computation period, an individual who is
     absent from work for maternity or paternity reasons shall
     receive credit for the Hours of Service which would otherwise
     have been credited to such individual but for such absence, or
     in any case in which such hours cannot be determined, eight (8)
     Hours of Service per day of such absence.  For purposes of this
     paragraph, an absence form work for maternity or paternity
     reasons means an absence (1) by reason of the pregnancy of the
     individual, (2) by reason of the birth of a child of the
     individual, (3) by reason of the placement of chid with the
     individual in connection with the adoption of such child by such
     individual, or (4) for purposes of caring for such child for a
     period beginning immediately following such birth or placement.
     The Hours of Service credited under this paragraph shall be
     credited (1) in the computation period in which the absence
     begins if the crediting is necessary to prevent a Service Break
     in that period, or (2) in all other cases, in the following
     computation period.

     Hours of Service shall be credited on the basis of actual hours
     worked unless another method has been specified in the Adoption
     Agreement, except to determine an Employee's Employment
     Commencement Date or Re-Employment Commencement Date.

1.29 "Normal Retirement Date" shall mean the first day of the month
     following the Participant's attainment of the Normal Retirement
     Age specified in the Adoption Agreement.  Upon reaching his
     Normal Retirement Age, the Participant's right to his retirement
     benefit shall be nonforfeitable, notwithstanding the Plan's
     vesting schedule.

1.30 "Owner-Employee" shall mean a sole proprietor or a partner who
     owns more than ten percent (10%) of either the capital interest
     or profits interest of a partnership.

1.31 "Participant" shall mean any Employee who gains membership in
     this Plan and shall include the following classifications:

     (a)   "Active Participant" shall mean an Employee participating
                in the Plan.

     (b)   "Deceased Participant" shall mean a Participant who has
                 died and on whose behalf benefits are payable in
                accordance with Article VII.

     (c)   "Retired Participant" shall mean a Participant who is no
                longer an Employee, but who is entitled to benefits in
                accordance with Article V.

     (d)   "Vested Participant" shall mean a Participant who is no
                longer an Employee, but who is entitled to benefits in
                accordance with Article VI.

1.32 "Participating Employer" shall mean any Affiliated Employer
     which has adopted the Plan in accordance with Section 16.2.

1.33 "Participation" shall mean any Plan Year during which a
     Participant competes at least one thousand (1,000) Hours of
     Service (or such lesser number of Hours of Service specified in
     the Adoption Agreement) or, if the Plan is a standardized plan,
     any Plan Year beginning on or after January 1, 1990 during which
     a Participant was employed other than a Plan Year in which the
     participant is not employed on the last day and is credited with
     less than five hundred and one (501) Hours of Service.  Periods
     of employment to be excluded, if any, shall be as specified in
     the Adoption Agreement.

     All Participants who complete the required number of Hours of
     Service during a Plan Year must accrue a benefit under the Plan
     for the year, even if they terminate employment before the end
     of such year.

     If an Employee becomes an Active Participant on a date other
     than the first day of the Plan Year, a year or partial year of
     Participation shall be credited for the year of entry into the
     Plan equal to a fraction, the numerator of which shall be the
     number of Hours of Service credited to the Employee from the
     date of membership to the end of that Plan Year (or termination
     of employment, if earlier) and the denominator of which is the
     required number of Hours of Service under the Plan for a full
     year of Participation.  Such fraction shall not exceed one
     (1.0).

     A Participant shall be credited with years of Participation
     prior to a Service Break unless such years may be disregarded
     under the rules of Section 6.4 or 6.6.

     If the elapsed time method of crediting Service is specified in
     the Adoption Agreement, an Active Participant shall be credited
     with Participation for all periods of employment, except as
     specified in the Adoption Agreement and for Participation which
     may be disregarded under Section 6.4 or 6.6, for the aggregate
     for all time periods commencing on his Employment Commencement
     Date and ending on the date he retires or otherwise terminated
     employment.  Fractional periods of a year shall be expressed in
     terms of days.

1.34 "PBGC" shall mean the Pension Benefit Guaranty Corporation.

1.35 "Period of Severance" shall mean a continuous period of time
     during which the Employee is not employed by the Employer.  Such
     period begins on the Employee's Severance from Service Date and
     ends on the Employee's Re-Employment Commencement Date.

1.36 "Permanent Disability" shall mean any physical or mental
     condition that may reasonably be expected to be permanent and
     which renders the Participant incapable of continuing as an
     Employee.  In determining the nature, extent, and continuation
     of a Participant's disability, the Committee may select a
     physician to examine such Participant and render a medical
     opinion.  The final determination shall be made by the Committee
     on the basis of all of the evidence.

1.37 "Plan" shall mean this Prototype Plan, the Trust Agreement and
     Adoption Agreement of the adopting Employer, as from time to
     time amended.

1.38 "Plan Year" shall mean the calendar year, unless another twelve
     (12) consecutive month period is specified in the Adoption
     Agreement.

1.39 "Prototype Plan" shall mean the basic plan document described
     herein.

1.40 "Qualified Joint and Survivor Annuity" shall mean an immediate
     annuity, payable monthly, for the life of the Participant with a
     survivor annuity for the life of the Participant's spouse which
     is not less than fifty percent (50%) and not more than one
     hundred percent (100%) of the amount of the annuity payable
     during the joint lives of the Participant and the Participant's
     spouse and which is the Actuarial Equivalent of the Standard
     Form of Retirement Income.  The percentage of the spouse's
     survivor annuity shall be fifty percent (50%), unless a
     different percentage is specified in the Adoption Agreement.  In
     the case of a Participant without a spouse, Qualified Joint and
     Survivor Annuity shall mean an annuity, payable monthly, for the
     life of the Participant, with no survivor benefit.

1.41 "Qualified Pre-retirement Survivor Annuity" shall mean an
     annuity payable to the Participant's spouse in accordance with
     Section 9.2.

1.42 "Re-Employment Commencement Date" shall mean the first day on
     which the Employee is credited with an Hour of Service for the
     performance of duties after the first eligibility computation
     period in which the employee incurs a one (1) year Service
     Break.

     In the case of any Participant who has incurred a one (1) year
     Service Break, Eligibility Year(s) of Service before such break
     shall not be taken into account until the Participant has
     completed an Eligibility Year of Service after returning to
     employment.  Such Eligibility Year of Service will be measured
     by the twelve (12) consecutive month period beginning on the
     Employee's Re-Employment Commencement Date and, if necessary,
     subsequent twelve (12) consecutive month periods beginning on
     anniversaries of the Re-Employment Commencement Date.

1.43 "S Corporation" shall mean an Employer who has made an election
     for its taxable year of reference under section 1362(a) of the
     Code, or any other applicable section pertaining thereto.

1.44 "Self-Employed Individual" shall mean an individual who has
     Earned Income for the taxable year from the unincorporated trade
     or business or partnership with respect to which the Plan is
     established; also, an individual who would have had Earned
     Income but for the fact such trade, business or partnership had
     no net profits for the taxable year.

1.45 "Service" shall mean any Plan Year during which the Employee
     completes at least one thousand (1,000) or more Hours of Service
     (or such lesser number of Hours of Service specified in the
     Adoption Agreement).  Periods of time to be excluded, if any,
     shall be specified in the Adoption Agreement.

     Service will be credited in accordance with the rules set forth
     above for any employment, for any period of time, for any
     Affiliated Employer.  Service will also be credited for any
     individual required to be considered an Employee, for purposes
     of this Plan under section 414(n) or (o) of the Code, of the
     Employer or any Affiliated Employer.

     If the elapsed time method of crediting Service is specified in
     the Adoption Agreement, an Employee shall receive credit for
     Service, except for Service which may be disregarded under
     Section 6.4 or 6.6, for the aggregate of all time periods
     commencing on his Employment Commencement Date or Re-Employment
     Commencement Date and ending on his Severance from Service Date.
     An Employee shall also receive credit for any Period of
     Severance of less the twelve (12) consecutive months.  An
     Employee shall receive a year of Service for vesting purposes
     for each twelve (12) months of Service.  Fractional periods of a
     year shall be expressed in terms of days.

1.46 "Service Break" shall mean:

     (a)   For purposes of calculating Eligibility Years of Service,
                any twelve (12) consecutive month period commencing on an
                Employee's Employment Commencement Date or anniversaries
                thereof during which the Employee is credited with five
                hundred (500) Hours of Service or less.

     (b)   For purposes of calculating years of Service, any Plan Year
                during which the Employee is credited with five hundred
                (500) Hours of Service or less, where such Service Break
                shall be measured from the first day of such Plan Year.

     (c)   If the elapsed time method of crediting Service is
                specified in the Adoption Agreement, a Service Break shall
                mean a Period of Severance of at least twelve (12)
                consecutive months; provided, however, that in the case of
                an Employee absent for maternity or paternity reasons (as
                defined in Section 1.26), the Period of Severance shall not
                commence for this purpose until the twenty-four (24) month
                anniversary of the first date of such absence.

     (d)   However, a Service Break shall not be deemed to have
                occurred as a result of an authorized leave of absence
                granted in accordance with a uniform and non-discriminatory
                policy of the Employer, provided the Employee returns to
                employment with the Employer immediately following the end
                of such leave.  A Service Break shall also not be deemed to
                have occurred as a result of an absence due to service in
                the armed forces of the United States, provided the Member
                makes application for resumption of work with the Employer,
                following discharge, within the time specified by then
                applicable laws.

1.47 "Severance from Service Date" shall mean the earlier of

     (a)   the date on which an Employee quits, retires, is discharged
                or dies; or

     (b)   the twelve (12) month anniversary of the date an Employee
                is first absent (with or without pay) for any reason other
                than quit, retirement, discharge or death (such as
                vacation, holiday, sickness, disability, leave of absence
                or layoff).

1.48 "Shareholder-Employee" shall mean a Participant who owns (or is
     considered as owning) more than five percent (5%) of the
     outstanding stock of an S Corporation on any day during the
     taxable year of reference of such S Corporation.  In determining
     the percent of a Participant's ownership of the outstanding
     stock, the family attribution rules of section 318(a)(1) of the
     Code, or nay other applicable section of the Code pertaining
     thereto shall apply.

1.49 "Social Security Retirement Age" shall mean age sixty-five (65)
     in the case of a Participant attaining age sixty-two (62) before
     January 1, 2000 (i.e., born before January 1, 1938), age
     sixty-six (66) for a Participant attaining age sixty-two (62)
     after December 31, 1999, and before January 1, 2017 (i.e., born
     after December 31, 1937, but before January 1, 1955), and age
     sixty-seven (67) for a Participant attaining age sixty-two (62)
     after December 31, 2016 (i.e., born after December 31, 1954).

1.50 "Sponsor" shall mean the Dreyfus Corporation.

1.51 "Standard Form of Retirement Income" shall mean a benefit
     payable in accordance with the terms of the Adoption Agreement,
     beginning as of the Participant's actual retirement date.

     The Standard Form of Retirement Income of each Participant shall
     not be less than the largest periodic benefit that would have
     been payable to the Participant upon separation from Service at
     or prior to the Normal Retirement Date under the Plan exclusive
     of social security supplements, premiums on disability or term
     insurance, and the value of disability benefits not in excess of
     the Standard Form of Retirement Income.  For purposes of
     comparing periodic benefits in the same form, commencing prior
     to and at the Normal Retirement Date, the greater benefit is
     determined by converting the benefit payable at the Normal
     Retirement Date and comparing the amount of such annuity
     payments.

1.52 "Straight Life Annuity" means an annuity payable in equal
     installments for the life of the Participant that terminates
     upon the Participant's death.

1.53 "Taxable Wage Base" means the contribution and benefit base in
     effect under section 230 of the Social Security Act at the
     beginning of the Plan Year.

1.54 "Trustee" shall mean an individual or individuals or institution
     appointed by the Employer to act in accordance with the
     provisions of the Trust Agreement.


1.55 "Trust Agreement" shall mean the agreement between the Employer
     and the Trustee.

1.56 "Trust Fund" shall mean all property received by the Trustee for
     purposes of the Plan, investments thereof and earnings thereon,
     less payments made by the Trustee to carry out the Plan.
                                  ARTICLE II.
                                PARTICIPATION

2.1  Membership

     Each eligible Employee shall become a Participant on the
     Effective Date or the Entry Date coincident with or next
     following the completion of the age and Service requirements set
     forth in the Adoption Agreement.

2.2  Excluded Employees

     The Adoption Agreement may exclude Employees from Participation
     in the Plan based upon minimum age and Service requirements or
     the inclusion of such Employees in certain ineligible job
     classifications.

     In the event an Employee who is not a member of the eligible
     class of Employees becomes a member of the eligible class, such
     Employee will participate immediately if such Employee has
     satisfied the minimum age and Service requirements and would
     have otherwise previously become a Participant.

     In the event a Participant is no longer a member of an eligible
     class of Employees and becomes ineligible to participate, but
     has not incurred a Service Break, such Employee will participate
     immediately upon returning to an eligible class of Employees.
     If such Participant incurs a Service Break, eligibility to
     participate will be determined under the rules of Section 1.20
     of the Plan.

2.3  Re-Employment

     (a)   A former Participant will become a Participant immediately
                upon returning to the employ of the Employer if such former
                Participant has a nonforfeitable right to all or a portion
                of the Accrued Benefit derived from Employer contributions
                at the time of termination from Service.

     (b)   A former Participant who did not have a nonforfeitable
                right to any portion of the Accrued Benefit derived from
                Employer contributions at the time of termination from
                Service will be considered a new Employee, for eligibility
                purposes, if the number of consecutive one (1) year Service
                Breaks equal or exceed the greater of five (5) or the
                aggregate number of years of Service before such Service
                Breaks.  If such former Participant's years of Service
                before termination from Service may not be disregarded
                pursuant to the preceding sentence, such former Participant
                shall participate immediately upon re-employment.

     (c)   Any former Employee who was never a Participant and is
                re-employed as an Employee will be eligible to participate
                subject to the provisions of Section 2.1.


2.4  Change in Employment Status

     In the event that a Participant who was credited with a year of
     Service for the preceding Plan Year, at the request of the
     Employer, enters directly into the employ of any other business
     entity, such Participant shall be deemed to be an Active
     Participant.  If such Participant returns to the employ of the
     Employer or becomes eligible for benefits pursuant to Articles
     V, VI or VII, without interruption of employment with the
     Employer or other business entity, he shall be deemed not to
     have had a Service Break for such period.  However, if such
     Participant does not immediately return to the employ of the
     Employer upon his termination of employment with such other
     business entity or upon recall by the Employer, he shall be
     deemed to have terminated his employment for all purposes of the
     Plan as of the Anniversary Date following the date of transfer.

2.5  Limitation on Participation of Owner-Employees

     (a)   If this Plan provides contributions or benefits for one or
                more Owner-Employees who control both the business for
                which this Plan is established and one or more other trades
                or businesses, this Plan and the plan established for other
                trades or businesses must, when looked at as a single plan,
                satisfy sections 401(a) and (d) of the Code, for the
                Employees of this and all other trades or businesses.

     (b)   If the Plan provides contributions or benefits for one or
                more Owner-Employees who control one or more other trades
                or businesses, the Employees of the other trades or
                businesses must be included in a plan which satisfies
                sections 401(a) and (d) of the Code and which provides
                contributions and benefits not less favorable than provided
                for Owner-Employees under this Plan.

     (c)   If an individual is covered as an Owner-Employee under the
                plans of two or more trades or businesses which are not
                controlled and the individual controls a trade or business,
                then the contributions or benefits of the Employees under
                the plan of the trade or business which are controlled must
                be as favorable as those provided for him under the most
                favorable plan of the trade or business which is not
                controlled.

     For purposes of the preceding paragraphs, an Owner-Employee, or
     two or more Owner-Employees, will be considered to control a
     trade or business if the Owner-Employee, or two or more
     Owner-Employees together:

     (1)   own the entire interest in an unincorporated trade or
                business, or

     (2)   in the case of a partnership, own more than fifty percent
                (50%) of either the capital interest or the profits
                interest in the partnership.

     For purposes of the preceding paragraphs, an Owner-Employee, or
     two or more Owner-Employees, shall be treated as owning any
     interest in a partnership which is owned, directly or
     indirectly, by a partnership which such Owner-Employee, or such
     two or more Owner-Employees, are considered to control within
     the meaning of the preceding sentence.

                                ARTICLE III.
                                CONTRIBUTIONS

3.1  Employer Contributions

     The Employer intends to make contributions to the Trust Fund in
     such amounts as are actuarially determined to be required to
     provide the benefits accruing under the Plan to Participants.
     Contributions by Participants shall be neither required nor
     permitted.  The annual valuation for actuarially determining the
     contributions required shall reflect an adjustment for
     experience realized form the investment of the Trust Fund,
     mortality, turnover, forfeitures and any dividends resulting
     from any insurance company contracts, if applicable.  Any
     forfeitures shall be used to reduce contributions, and shall not
     be applied to increase benefits payable under the Plan.  Subject
     to the termination provisions of Section 16.5, the Employer
     reserves the right to reduce, suspend or discontinue its
     contributions under the Plan for any reason at any time.

3.2  Payment of Contributions

     The amount of the Employer's contribution to the Plan for each
     Plan Year shall be paid to the Trustee either in a single
     payment or in installments.  [Note:  Failure to make quarterly
     contributions required under section 412(m) of the Code will
     result in he imposition of interest on the Employer].  In order
     to ensure a deduction for each Plan Year, the total amount of
     its contributions shall be made no later than the time
     prescribed by law for filing its federal income tax return for
     the fiscal year of the Employer ending with or within such Plan
     Year, including extensions thereof.  All contributions made by
     an Employer shall be conditional upon their deductibility by the
     Employer for income tax purposes; provided, however, that no
     contributions shall be returned to the Employer except as
     otherwise provided in this Plan.

3.3  Payment of Expenses

     In addition to its contribution, the Employer shall pay all the
     administrative expenses of the Plan and all fees and retainers
     of the Plan's Trustee, actuary, consultant, administrator,
     auditors and counsel, except that any expenses directly relating
     to the investments of the Trust fund, such as taxes, brokerage
     commissions, registration charges, etc., shall always be paid
     from the Trust Fund.  In the event of the failure of the
     Employer to pay all or part of such expenses, the Trustee
     shall pay these expenses and charge the payment thereof against
     the Trust Fund.

3.4  Return of Employer Contributions

     Notwithstanding any other provisions of this Plan, contributions
     made by an Employer may be returned to such Employer if:

     (a)   the contribution was made by reason of a mistake of fact
                and is returned to the Employer within one year of the
                mistaken contribution, or

     (b)   the contributions was conditioned upon its deductibility by
                the Employer for income tax purposes, the deduction was
                disallowed and the contribution is returned to the Employer
                within one year of the disallowance of the deduction, or

     (c)   the contribution was conditioned upon the initial
                qualification of the Plan:  the Plan was submitted to the
                Internal Revenue Service for a determination as to its
                initial qualification within the time prescribed by law for
                filing the Employer's return for the taxable year in which
                the Plan was adopted or such later date as the Secretary of
                the Treasury may prescribe; the Plan received an adverse
                determination, and the contribution is returned to the
                Employer within one year of the date of the adverse
                determination.

     The amount which may be returned to the Employer in the excess
     of the amount contributed over the amount that would have been
     contributed had there not occurred the circumstance causing the
     excess.  Earnings attributable to the excess contributions may
     not be returned to the Employer, but losses thereto shall reduce
     the amount to be so returned.
                                  ARTICLE IV.
                              RETIREMENT DATES

4.1  Retirement Date

     Whenever reference is made in the Plan to retirement or a
     retirement date, it shall mean the Normal, Early, Deferred or
     Disability Retirement Date, whichever applies to the Participant
     involved.

4.2  Normal Retirement Date

     Upon reaching his Normal Retirement Age, an Active Participant's
     right to his retirement benefit shall be nonforfeitable.  Such
     an Active Participant shall, subject to the provisions of
     Section 4.6, have the right to retire as of his Normal
     Retirement Date.  If the Employer enforces a mandatory
     retirement date, the Normal Retirement Date is the earlier of
     that mandatory date or the date specified in the Adoption
     Agreement.

4.3  Deferred Retirement Date

     An Active Participant may continue his employment after his
     Normal Retirement Date, in which event he shall continue as an
     Active Participant and, subject to the provisions of Section
     4.6, retire as of his Deferred Retirement Date.  However, the
     Employer may, subject to the provisions of Section 4.7, retire a
     Participant on the first day of any month following his Normal
     Retirement Date.

4.4  Early Retirement Date

     A Participant shall, subject to the provisions of section 4.6,
     have the right to retire as of his Early Retirement Date.  A
     Participant who has satisfied the service requirements for early
     retirement shall be entitled to elect early retirement upon
     completion of the age requirement.

4.5  Disability Retirement Date

     An Active Participant, who has suffered a Permanent Disability,
     may retire on his Disability Retirement Date.

     As a condition of his continuing to receive any disability
     retirement income, the Committee shall have the right to require
     any Participant who is in receipt of a monthly disability
     retirement income to be re-examined by a physician of its choice
     not more often than once in each calendar year to determine if
     he continues to be disabled.

4.6  Application for Retirement

     As a prerequisite to the commencement of a retirement benefit
     hereunder, a Participant otherwise entitled thereto shall file
     with the Committee an application for such benefit at least
     thirty-one (31) days prior to the Participant's retirement date.

4.7  Age Discrimination in Employment Act

     Notwithstanding any other provision of this Plan, the Employer,
     in accordance with the provisions of the Age Discrimination in
     Employment Act, shall have no right to compel a Participant to
     retire, except as otherwise provided in this Section, if in the
     calendar year or the preceding calendar year, the Employer may
     retire a Participant who for the two (2) year period prior to
     retirement is employed in a bona fide executive or high policy
     making position if (1) he has attained age sixty-five (65); (2)
     he has attained Normal Retirement Date and (3) his annual
     retirement benefit from the pension, profit-sharing, savings or
     deferred compensation plans maintained by the Employer equals,
     in the aggregate, at least $44,000.  This Section shall be
     deemed to be automatically amended to reflect any subsequent
     Federal legislation or regulations.
                                  ARTICLE V.
                             RETIREMENT BENEFITS

     Except as otherwise provided in the Adoption Agreement and this
     Prototype Plan the provisions of this Article V shall apply with
     respect to the Plan Years, and benefits attributable to Plan
     Years, beginning after December 31, 1988.

5.1  Normal Retirement Benefit

     A Participant shall be entitled to receive as of his Normal
     Retirement Date a monthly Standard Form of Retirement Income
     equal to one-twelfth (1/12th) of the annual retirement benefit
     determined in accordance with the benefit formula elected by the
     Employer in the Adoption agreement.

5.2  Deferred Retirement Benefit

     Effective with the first day of the Plan Year beginning on or
     after January 1, 1988, a Participant shall be entitled to
     receive as of his Deferred Retirement Date a monthly Standard
     Form of Retirement Income equal to one-twelfth (1/12th) of the
     greater of (i) the amount of his annual retirement benefit
     determined as of his Deferred Retirement Date in accordance with
     the Benefit formula elected by the Employer in the Adoption
     Agreement, or (ii) the Actuarial Equivalent of his Normal
     Retirement Benefit determined under section 5.1 above.  The
     monthly retirement benefit so determined for a Participant who
     remains in employment after Normal Retirement Age shall be
     offset by the Actuarial Equivalent of the total of any
     distributions required by Section 9.5 which are made by the
     close of the Plan Year.

5.3  Early Retirement Benefit

     An Active Participant who has satisfied the age and service
     requirements for early retirement shall be entitled to receive
     as of his Normal Retirement Date a monthly Standard Form of
     Retirement income equal to one-twelfth (1/12th) of his Accrued
     Benefit.  Alternatively, such Participant may elect that the
     Early Retirement Benefit commence on the Participant's Early
     Retirement Date or on the first day of any following month prior
     to his Normal Retirement Date.  If the Participant so elects to
     have benefits commence prior to his Normal Retirement Date, his
     annual retirement benefit shall be an amount equal to his
     Accrued Benefit payable at Normal Retirement Date reduced by
     one-fifteenth (1/15th) for each of the first five (5) years,
     one-thirtieth (1/30th) for each of the next five (5) years, and
     actuarially reduced for each additional year by which the
     Participant's Annuity Starting Date precedes his Normal
     Retirement Date.

     If benefits commence to a Participant at a time other than
     Normal Retirement Age, the Participant's Accrued Benefit will be
     multiplied by a fraction, the numerator of which is the annual
     factor that corresponds to the age at which benefits commence to
     the Participant in the Standard Form of Retirement Income, and
     the denominator of which is the annual factor that corresponds
     to the Normal Retirement Age under the Plan in the Standard Form
     of Retirement Income.

     If benefits commence to the Participant in a form other than the
     Standard Form of Retirement Income, the product in the preceding
     paragraph will be actuarially adjusted in accordance with the
     provisions of section 1.2 of the Plan.

     If this Plan has had a Fresh-Start, the limitations in the
     preceding paragraphs will be applied only to the Participant's
     accruals for years for which the Plan provides for the disparity
     permitted under section 401(1) of the Code.  All benefit
     accruals for years for which the Plan does not provide for the
     disparity permitted under section 401(1) of the Code will be
     actuarially adjusted in accordance with the provisions of
     section 1.2 of the Plan.

     The annual factor is the factor derived from the applicable in
     table(s) below based on the Normal Retirement Age under the
     Plan, as specified in the Adoption Agreement (determined without
     regard to any years of Participation requirement), and the
     Standard Form of Retirement Income, as specified in the Adoption
     Agreement. If the Employer elects as an integration level in the
     Adoption Agreement option 4 or 5, the following Table II shall
     apply. Otherwise, the following Table I shall apply.

                                   TABLE I

     Plan's Normal
     Retirement Age       Participant's Social Security Retirement Age
     _______________      ____________________________________________

                          65        66        67

           65             .75       .70       .65
           64             .70       .65       .60
           63             .65       .60       .55
           62             .60       .55       .50
           61             .55       .50       .475
           60             .50       .475      .45
           59             .475      .45       .425
           58             .45       .425      .40
           57             .425      .40       .375
           56             .40       .375      .344
           55             .375      .344      .316


                                  TABLE II

     Plan's Normal
     Retirement Age  Participant's Social Security Retirement Age
     ______________  ____________________________________________

                          65        66        67

           65             .60       .56       .52
           64             .56       .52       .48
           63             .52       .48       .44
           62             .48       .44       .40
           61             .44       .40       .38
           60             .40       .38       .36
           59             .38       .36       .34
           58             .36       .34       .32
           57             .34       .32       .30
           56             .32       .30       .2752
           55             .30       .2752     .2528


5.4  Disability Retirement Benefit

     An Active Participant who has suffered a Permanent Disability shall be
     entitled to receive during the period of his disability, with the
     first payment to be made on his Disability Retirement Date, a monthly
     Standard Form of Retirement Income which shall be equal to his Accrued
     Benefit payable at his Normal Retirement Date, reduced by
     one-fifteenth (1/15th) for each of the first five (5) years,
     one-thirtieth (1/30th) for each of the next five (5) years, and
     actuarially reduced for each additional year by which his Disability
     Retirement Date precedes his Normal Retirement Date.

     If it is subsequently determined that such Participant is no longer
     disabled, he shall not be entitled to further benefits as a result of
     such disability, and he shall only be entitled to such other benefits
     as may be provided under the terms of the Plan for which he was
     eligible as of his Disability Retirement Date, reduced by the
     disability retirement benefits paid.  If such Participant returns to
     the employ of the Employer immediately following the termination of
     his Permanent Disability, he shall resume the classification of an
     Active Participant, and his employment with the Employer shall not be
     deemed interrupted.

     A Participant, who has severed employment prior to his Permanent
     Disability, will not be entitled to any benefits under this Section
     5.4.

5.5  Distribution of Retirement Benefits

     Distribution of any benefits payable under this Section shall be paid
     in accordance with the provisions of Article IX.

5.6  Death Benefits

     If a Participant dies prior to his Annuity Starting Date, the
     provisions of Article VII shall apply.

5.7  Suspension of Benefits

     (1)  As elected by the Employer in the Adoption Agreement, normal or
     early retirement benefits will be suspended for each calendar month
     during which the Employee completes at least 40 Hours of Service with
     the Employer as defined in section 203(a)(3)(B) of the Employee
     Retirement Income Security Act of 1974, as amended ("Section
     203(a)(3)B Service").  Consequently, the amount of benefits which are
     paid later than Normal Retirement Age will be computed as if the
     Employee had been receiving benefits since Normal Retirement Age.

     (2)  Resumption of payment.  If benefit payments have been suspended,
     payments shall resume not later than the first day of the third
     calendar month after the calendar month in which the Employee ceases
     to be employed in section 203(a)(3)(B) service.  The initial payment
     upon resumption shall include the payment scheduled to occur in the
     calendar month when payments resume and any amounts withheld during
     the period between the cessation of section 203(a)(3)(B) service and
     the resumption of payments.

     (3)  Notification.  No payment shall be withheld by the Plan pursuant
     to this section unless the Plan notifies the Employee by personal
     delivery or first class mail during the first calendar month or
     payroll period in which the Plan withholds payment that his or her
     benefits are suspended.  Such notification shall contain a description
     of the specific reasons why benefit payments are being suspended, a
     description of the plan provision relating to the suspension of
     payments, a copy of such provisions, and a statement to the effect
     that applicable Department of Labor regulations may be found in
     section 2530.203-3 of the Code of Federal Regulations.

     In addition, the notice shall inform the Employee of the Plan's
     procedures for affording a review of the suspension of benefits.
     Requests for such reviews may be considered in accordance with the
     claims procedure adopted by the plan pursuant to the section 503 of
     the Employment Retirement Income Security Act of 1974, as amended, and
     applicable regulations.

     (4)  Amount suspended.

           (a)  Life annuity.  In the case of benefits payable periodically
                on a monthly basis for as long as a life (or lives)
                continues, such as a straight life annuity or a Qualified
                Joint and Survivor Annuity, an amount equal to the portion
                of a monthly benefit payment derived from Employer
                contributions.

           (b)  Other benefit forms.  In the case of a benefit payable in a
                form other than the form described in subsection (a) above,
                an amount of the Employer-provided portion of benefit
                payments for a calendar month in which the Employee is
                employed in section 203(a)(3)(B) service, equal to the
                lesser of:

                (i)  The amount of benefits which would have been payable to
                     the Employee if he had been receiving monthly benefits
                     under the Plan since actual retirement based on a
                     straight life annuity commencing at actual retirement
                     age;

                (ii) The actual amount paid or scheduled to be paid to the
                     Employee for such month.  Payments which are scheduled
                     to be paid less frequently than monthly may be
                     converted to monthly payments for purposes of the above
                     sentence.

     (5)   This section does not apply to the minimum benefit to which the
           Participant is entitled under the top-heavy rules of Article  XV.

5.8  Frozen Accrued Benefit


     A Participant's Frozen Accrued Benefit is the amount of the
     Participant's Accrued Benefit determined in accordance with the
     provisions of the Plan applicable in the year containing the latest
     Fresh-Start Date, determined as if the Participant terminated
     employment with the Employer as of the latest Fresh-Start Date, (or
     the date the Participant actually terminated employment with the
     Employer, if earlier), without regard to any amendment made to the
     Plan after that date other than amendments recognized as effective as
     of or before the date under section 401(b) of the Code or section
     1.401(a)(4)-11(g) of the regulations. If the Participant has not had a
     Fresh-Start Date, the Participant's Frozen Accrued Benefit will be
     zero.

     If, as of the Participant's latest Fresh-Start Date, the amount of a
     Participant's Frozen Accrued Benefit was limited by the application of
     section 415 of the Code, the Participant's Frozen Accrued Benefit will
     be increased for years after the latest Fresh-Start Date to the extent
     permitted under section 415(d)(l) of the Code. In addition, the Frozen
     Accrued Benefit of a Participant whose Frozen Accrued Benefit includes
     the Top-Heavy minimum benefits provided in section 15.3 of the Plan,
     will be increased to the extent necessary to comply with the average
     compensation requirement of section 416(c)(l)(D)(i) of the Code.

     If: (l) the Plan's Standard Form of Retirement Income in effect on the
     Participant's latest Fresh-Start Date is not the same as the Standard
     Form of Retirement Income under the Plan after the Participant's
     latest Fresh-Start Date and/or (2) the Normal Retirement Age for any
     Participant on that date was greater than the Normal Retirement Age
     for that Participant under the Plan after such latest Fresh-Start
     Date, the Frozen Accrued Stated Benefit will be expressed as an
     actuarially equivalent benefit in the Standard Form of Retirement
     Income under the Plan after the latest Fresh-Start Date, commencing at
     the Participant's Normal Retirement Age under the Plan in effect after
     the latest Fresh-Start Date.

     If the Plan provides a new optional form of benefit with respect to a
     Participant's Frozen Accrued Benefit, such new optional form of
     benefit will be provided with respect to each Participant's entire
     Accrued Benefit (i.e., Accrued both before and after the Fresh-Start
     Date).  In addition, if this Plan is a unit credit plan, with respect
     to plan years beginning after the latest Fresh-Start Date, the current
     benefit formula will provide each Participant in the Fresh-Start group
     a benefit of not less than .5% of the Participant's average annual
     Compensation times the participant's years of Service after the latest
     Fresh-Start Date. If this is a flat benefit plan, then, with respect
     to Plan Years beginning after the Plan's latest Fresh-Start Date, the
     current benefit formula will provide each Participant a benefit of not
     less than 25% of the Participant's average annual Compensation. If a
     participant will have less than 50 years of Service after the latest
     Fresh-Start Date through the year the Participant attains Normal
     Retirement Age (or current age, if later), then such minimum
     percentage will be reduced by multiplying it by the following ratio:

                           Participant's years of
                  Service after the latest Fresh-Start Date
                                     50

     Definition of Fresh-Start Date. Fresh-Start Date generally means the
     last day of a Plan Year preceding a Plan Year for which any amendment
     of the Plan that directly or indirectly affects the amount of a
     Participant's benefit determined under the current benefit formula
     (such as an amendment to the definition of Compensation used in the
     current benefit formula or a change in the Normal Retirement Age of
     the Plan) is made effective. However, if under the Adoption Agreement
     the Fresh-Start group is limited to an acquired group of employees, or
     a group of employees with a Frozen Accrued Benefit attributable to
     assets and liabilities transferred to the Plan, the Fresh Start Date
     will be the date designated in the Adoption Agreement.  If this Plan
     has had a Fresh-Start for all Participants, and in a subsequent Plan
     Year is aggregated for purposes of section 401(a)(4) of the Code with
     another Plan that did not make the same Fresh-Start, this Plan will
     have a Fresh-Start on the last day of the Plan Year preceding the Plan
     Year during which the plans are first aggregated.

5.9  Adjustments to Frozen Accrued Benefit

     (a)   If elected by the Employer in the Adoption Agreement, the
           provisions of sections 5.9(b) through (i) below will apply to
           adjust each Participant's Frozen Accrued Benefit determined as of
           the latest Fresh-Start Date under the Plan, if, as of that date,
           the Plan contained a benefit formula under which the
           Participant's Accrued Benefit could be determined with reference
           to Compensation earned by the Participant in years beginning
           after the latest Fresh-Start Date occurring before the first Plan
           Year beginning on or after January 1, 1994.

     (b)   If a Fresh-Start group fails to satisfy the minimum coverage
           requirements of section 410(b) of the Code for any Plan Year, the
           provisions of this section 5.9 will not apply for that year or
           any subsequent year.

           A Fresh-Start group is deemed to satisfy the minimum coverage
           requirements of section 410(b) of the Code for any Plan Year if
           any one of the following requirements is satisfied:

           1.   the Fresh-Start group satisfied the minimum coverage
                requirements of section 410(b) of the Code for the first
                five Plan Years beginning after the Fresh-Start Date;

           2.   the Fresh-Start group satisfied the ratio percentage test of
                section 1.410(b)-2(b)(2) of the Regulations as of the Fresh
                Start Date;

           3.   the Fresh-Start group consists of an acquired group of
                employees that satisfied the minimum coverage requirements
                of section 410(b) of the Code (determined without regard to
                any of the special rules pertaining to certain dispositions
                or acquisitions provided in section 410(b)(6)(c)) of the
                Code as of the Fresh-Start Date; or

           4.   the Fresh-Start Date with respect to the Fresh-Start group
                occurs before the first day of the first Plan Year beginning
                on or after January 1, 1994.

     (c)   Unit Credit Plans -- with respect to Plan Years beginning after
           the latest Fresh-Start Date, the current benefit formula will
           provide each Participant in the Fresh-Start group a benefit of
           not less than .5% of the Participant's Average Compensation times
           the Participant's years of Service after the latest Fresh-Start
           Date.

     (d)   Flat Benefit Plans -- with respect to Plan Years beginning after
           the Plan's latest Fresh-Start Date, the current benefit formula
           will provide each Participant a benefit of not less than 25% of
           the Participant's Average Compensation.  If a Participant will
           have less than 50 years of Service under the Plan after the
           latest Fresh-Start Date through the year the Participant attains
           Normal Retirement Age (or current age, if later), then such
           minimum percentage will be reduced by multiplying it by the
           following ratio:


                           Participant's years of
                  Service after the latest Fresh-Start Date
                                     50

     (e)   The minimum benefit in sections 5.9 (h) through (j) below take
           into account an Employee's past Service in determining the
           Employee's Accrued Benefit under the Plan and may cause the Plan
           to fail to satisfy the safe harbor for past service in section
           1.401(a)(4)-5(a)(3) of the regulations.

     (f)   If this Plan was a defined benefit excess plan as of the latest
           Fresh-Start Date, each Participant's Frozen Accrued Benefit will
           be increased, to the extent necessary, if any, so that the Base
           Benefit Percentage, as defined in the Adoption Agreement,
           determined with reference to all years of Service as of the
           latest Fresh-Start Date, is not less than 50 percent of the
           Excess Benefit Percentage, as defined in the Adoption Agreement,
           as of the latest Fresh-Start Date, determined with reference to
           all years of Service as of the latest Fresh-Start Date. For this
           purpose, a defined benefit excess plan is a defined benefit plan
           under which the rate at which Employer-provided benefits are
           determined with respect to Average Compensation above the
           Integration Level under the Plan is greater than the rate at
           which employer-provided benefits are determined with respect
           to Average Compensation at or below the Integration Level.

     (g)   If this Plan was a PIA offset plan as of the latest Fresh-Start
           Date, the offset applied to determine the Frozen Accrued Benefit
           of each Participant in the Fresh-Start group will be decreased,
           to the extent necessary, if any, so that it does not exceed 50
           percent of the benefit determined without applying the offset,
           taking into account all years of Service as of the latest
           Fresh-Start Date. For this purpose, a PIA offset plan is a Plan
           that applies the Plan's benefit rates uniformly regardless of an
           Employee's Compensation, but that reduces an Employee's benefit
           by a stated percentage of the Employee's primary insurance amount
           under the Social Security Act.

     (h)   In the case of a Plan other than a Plan described in Sections
           5.9(h) and 5.9(i) above, the Frozen Accrued Benefit of each
           Participant in the Fresh-Start Date will be increased, to the
           extent necessary, if any, in a manner that is economically
           equivalent to the adjustment required under Sections 5.9 (h) and
           (i).

     (i)   If elected by the Employer in the Adoption Agreement, the Frozen
           Accrued Benefit (as adjusted under Sections 5.9 (h) through (j)
           above, as applicable) of each Participant other than section
           401(a)(17) Participants in the Fresh-Start group will be adjusted
           in accordance with one of the methods set forth in Section 5.9(l)
           below.  The Frozen Accrued Benefit of all section 401(a)(17)
           Participants will be determined in accordance with the special
           adjustment applicable to section 401(a)(17) Participants in
           Section 5.9(m).

                A section 401(a)(17) Participant includes a Tax Reform Act
                of 1986 (TRA '86) section 401(a)(17) Participant as well as
                an Omnibus Budget Reconciliation Act of 1993 (OBRA '93)
                section 401(a)(17) Participant. A TRA '86 section 401(a)(17)
                Participant means a Participant whose Accrued Benefit as of
                a date on or after the first day of the first Plan Year
                beginning on or after January 1, 1989, is based on
                Compensation for a year beginning prior to the TRA '86
                statutory effective date that exceeded $ 200,000. An OBRA
                '93 section 401(a)(17) Participant means a Participant whose
                Accrued Benefit as of a date on or after the first day of
                the first Plan Year beginning on or after January 1, 1994,
                is based on Compensation for a year beginning prior to the
                first day of the first Plan Year beginning on or after
                January 1, 1994, that exceeded $ 150,000.

     (j)   The Frozen Accrued Benefit of each Participant in the Fresh-Start
           group other than section 401(a)(17) Participants will be adjusted
           in accordance with one of the following methods, as elected by
           the Employer in the Adoption Agreement:

                Old Compensation fraction: The Frozen Accrued Benefit of
                each Participant in the Fresh-Start group, as adjusted in
                Sections 5.9 (e) through (g) above, as fraction (not less
                than 1), the numerator of which is the Participant's
                Compensation for the current Plan Year, using the same
                definition and Compensation formula used in determining the
                Participant's Frozen Accrued Benefit, and the denominator of
                which is the Participant's Compensation as of the latest
                Fresh-Start Date, determined in the same manner as the
                numerator.

                New Compensation fraction: The Frozen Accrued Benefit of
                each Participant in the Fresh-Start group, as adjusted in
                Sections 5.9 (e) through (g) above, as applicable, will be
                multiplied by a fraction (not less than 1), the numerator of
                which is the Participant's Average Compensation, as defined
                in section 1.12 of the Plan, for the current Plan Year, and
                the denominator is the participant's Average Compensation as
                of the latest Fresh-Start Date, determined in the same
                manner as the numerator.

                Reconstructed Compensation fraction: The Frozen Accrued
                Benefit of each Participant in the Fresh-Start group, as
                adjusted in Sections 5.9 (e) through (g) above, as
                applicable, will be multiplied by a fraction (not less than
                1), the numerator of which is the Participant's Average
                Compensation, as defined in Section 1.12 of the Plan, for
                the current Plan Year, and the denominator of which is the
                Participant's reconstructed compensation as of the Fresh-
                Start Date.

                A Participant's "reconstructed compensation" will be equal
                to the Participant's Average Compensation, as defined in
                section 1.12 of the Plan, for the Plan Year elected by the
                Employer in the Adoption Agreement multiplied by a fraction,
                the numerator of which is the Participant's Compensation for
                the Plan Year ending on the latest Fresh-Start Date
                determined using the same Compensation definition and
                Compensation formula used to determine the Participant's
                Frozen Accrued Benefit, and the denominator of which is the
                Participant's Compensation for the selected year, determined
                in the same manner as the numerator.

                For purposes of calculating a Participant's "reconstructed
                compensation", the selected year will be the Plan Year
                elected by the Employer in the Adoption Agreement.

     (k)   Alternative Adjustment: In lieu of applying the old compensation
           fraction or new compensation fraction described in section
           5.9(l), if the Employer elects, a Participant's adjusted Accrued
           Benefit will be determined by substituting the Participant's
           Compensation (as defined in section  of the Plan) for the current
           Plan Year determined under the same Compensation formula and
           underlying definition of Compensation used to determine the
           Frozen Accrued Benefit of each Participant in the Fresh-Start
           group.

                If elected by the Employer in the Adoption Agreement, the
                Frozen Accrued Benefit of each section 401(a)(17)
                Participant in the Fresh-Start group will be adjusted in
                accordance with the following method:


                Section 401(A)(17) Participants Who Are OBRA '93 Section
                401(A)(17) Participants Only:

                (1)  Determine the Frozen Accrued Benefit of each OBRA '93
                     section 401(a)(17) Participant as of the last day of
                     the Plan Year beginning before January 1, 1994.

                (2)  Adjust the amount in step 1 by multiplying it by the
                     following fraction (not less than 1). The numerator of
                     the fraction is the average compensation of the OBRA
                     '93 section 401(a)(17) employee determined for the
                     current year (as limited by section 401(a)(17)), using
                     the same definition and Compensation formula in effect
                     as of the last day of the last Plan Year beginning
                     before January 1, 1994. The denominator of the fraction
                     is the Participant's Average Compensation for the last
                     day of the last Plan Year beginning before January 1,
                     1994. Using the definition and Compensation formula in
                     effect as of the last day of the last Plan Year
                     beginning before January 1, 1994.

                Section 401(A)(17) Participants Who Are Both TRA '86 Section
                401(A)(17) Participants and OBRA '93 Section 401(A)(17)
                Participants:

                (1)  Determine each TRA '86 section 401(a)(17) Participant's
                     Frozen Accrued Benefit as of the last day of the last
                     Plan Year beginning before January 1, 1989.

                (2)  Adjust the amount in step 1 up through the last day of
                     the last Plan Year beginning before the first Plan Year
                     beginning on or after January 1, 1994, by multiplying
                     it by the following fraction (not less than 1). The
                     numerator of the fraction is the TRA '86 section
                     401(a)(17) Participant's Average Compensation
                     determined for the current year (as limited by section
                     401(a)(17)), using the same definition and Compensation
                     formula in effect as of the last day of the last Plan
                     Year beginning before January 1, 1989. The denominator
                     of the fraction is the Participant's Average
                     Compensation for the last day of the Plan Year
                     beginning before January 1, 1989, using the definition
                     and Compensation formula in effect as of the last day
                     of the last Plan Year beginning before January 1, 1989.

                (3)  Determine the TRA '86 section 401(a)(17) Participant's
                     Frozen Accrued Benefit as of the last day of the last
                     Plan Year beginning before January 1, 1994.

                (4)  Subtract the amount determined in step 2 from the
                     amount determined in step 1.

                (5)  Adjust the amount in step 4 by multiplying it by the
                     following fraction (not less than 1). The numerator of
                     the fraction is the TRA '86 section 401(a)(17)
                     Participant's Average Compensation determined for the
                     current year (as limited by section 401(a)(17)), using
                     the same definition and Compensation formula in effect
                     as of the last day of the last Plan Year beginning
                     before January 1, 1994. The denominator of the fraction
                     is the Participant's Average Compensation for the last
                     day of the Plan Year beginning before January 1, 1994,
                     using the definition and Compensation formula in effect
                     as of the last day of the last Plan Year beginning
                     before January 1, 1994.

                (6)  Adjust the amount in step 1 by multiplying it by the
                     following fraction (not less than 1). The numerator of
                     the fraction is the TRA '86 section 401(a)(17)
                     Participant's Average Compensation for the current year
                     (as limited by section 401(a)(17)), using the same
                     definition of Compensation and Compensation formula in
                     effect as of the last day of the last Plan Year
                     beginning before January 1, 1989. The denominator of
                     the fraction is the Participant's Average Compensation
                     for the last day of the last Plan Year beginning before
                     January 1, 1989, using the definition and Compensation
                     formula in effect as of the last day of the last Plan
                     Year beginning before January 1, 1989.

                (7)  Add the amounts determined in step 5, and the greater
                     of steps 6 or 2.

                                ARTICLE VI.
                     TERMINATION OF EMPLOYMENT BENEFITS

6.1  Vested Termination Benefit

     If an Active Participant terminates his employment with the Employer,
     or with any other business entity pursuant to Section 2.4, prior to
     qualifying for any other benefits pursuant to the provisions of the
     Plan, and prior to the satisfaction of the vesting requirement set
     forth in the Adoption Agreement, his Participation hereunder shall
     cease and no benefits shall be payable from the Plan.

     If however, an Active Participant terminates his employment after the
     satisfaction of the vesting requirements set forth in the Adoption
     Agreement, he shall become a Vested Participant.  Such Vested
     Participant shall be entitled to receive a Standard Form of Retirement
     Income, beginning as of his Normal Retirement Date, equal to the
     vested percentage, as determined in accordance with the schedule set
     forth in the Adoption Agreement, of the Participant's Accrued Benefit.

     A Vested Participant who terminates employment after meeting the
     Service requirement but before meeting the age requirement for Early
     Retirement may also elect to retire on the first day of any month
     following Early Retirement Age.  Any other Vested Participant may
     elect to commence payment of his benefits on the first day of any
     month preceding his Normal Retirement Date and after his vested
     Termination Date as specified in the Adoption Agreement.  Such benefit
     shall be equal to his Accrued Benefit payable at Normal Retirement
     Date reduced by one-fifteenth (1/15th) for each of the next five (5)
     years, one thirtieth (1/30th) for each of the next five (5) years and
     actuarially reduced for each additional year by which the commencement
     date of the Vested Benefit precedes his Normal Retirement Date.

6.2  Distribution of Vested Interest

     As a prerequisite to the commencement of a Vested Termination Benefit
     hereunder, a Participant otherwise entitled thereto shall file with
     the Committee an application for such benefit at least thirty-one (31)
     days prior to the Participant's Vested Termination Date.  Distribution
     of any benefit payable under this Section shall be paid pursuant to
     the provisions of Article IX.

6.3  Death of a Vested Member

     If a Vested Participant dies prior to his Annuity Starting Date, the
     provisions of Article VII shall apply.

6.4  Vesting of a Participant

     In order to determine the Vested Percentage of a Participant who has
     incurred a Service Break, the following rules will apply:

     (a)   A former Participant who had a nonforfeitable right to all or a
           portion of the Accrued Benefit derived from Employer
           contributions at the time of the Participant's termination of
           employment will receive credit for all years of Service prior to
           a Service Break upon completing a year of Service after returning
           to the employ of the Employer.

     (b)   In the case of a Participant who has five (5) or more consecutive
           one (1) year Service Breaks, the Participant's pre-break Service
           will count in vesting of the Employer-derived Accrued Benefit
           only if (i) such Participant has any nonforfeitable interest in
           the Accrued Benefit attributable to Employer contributions at the
           time of separation from service, or (ii) upon returning to
           Service the number of consecutive one (1) year Service Breaks is
           less than the number of years of Service.

6.5  Amendment of Vesting Provisions

     If the Plan's vesting schedule set forth in the Adoption Agreement is
     amended or the Plan is amended in any way that directly or indirectly
     affects the computation of a Participant's nonforfeitable percentage,
     or if the Plan is deemed amended by an automatic change to or from a
     top-heavy vesting schedule, each Participant with at least three (3)
     years of Service with the Employer may elect within a reasonable
     period after the adoption of the amendment or change, to have his
     nonforfeitable percentage computed under the Plan without regard to
     such amendment or change.  For Participants who do not have at least
     one Hour of Service in any Plan Year beginning on or after January 1,
     1989, the preceding sentence shall be applied by substituting "five
     (5) years of Service "for "three (3) years of Service."  The period
     during which the election may be made shall commence with the date the
     amendment is adopted and shall end on the latest of:  (1) sixty (60)
     days after the amendment is adopted; (2) sixty (60) days after the
     amendment becomes effective; or (3) sixty (60) days after the
     Participant is issued written notice of the amendment by the Employer
     or the Committee.

6.6  Forfeitures

     (a)   If a Participant terminates employment with the Employer and the
           Actuarial Value of the Participant's vested Accrued Benefit
           derived form Employer and Employee contributions is not greater
           than $3,500, the Employee shall receive a distribution of the
           Actuarial Value of the entire vested portion of such Accrued
           Benefit, and the nonvested portion will be treated as a
           forfeiture. For purposes of this Section 6.6, if the Actuarial
           Value of a Participant's vested Accrued Benefit is zero, the
           Participant shall be deemed to have received a distribution of
           such vested Accrued Benefit.

     (b)   If a Participant terminates employment with the Employer, (and
           the present value of the Employee's vested Accrued Benefit
           exceeds $3,500), and elects (with his or her spouse's consent) in
           accordance with Section 9.2 to receive the Actuarial Value of his
           or her vested Accrued Benefit, the nonvested portion will be
           treated as a forfeiture.  If the Participant elects to have
           distributed an amount that is less than the entire vested portion
           of the Accrued Benefit derived from Employer contributions, the
           part of the nonvested portion that will be treated as a
           forfeiture is the total nonvested portion multiplied by a
           fraction, the numerator of which is the amount of the
           distribution attributable to Employer contributions and the
           denominator of which is the total Actuarial Value of the vested
           Employer derived Accrued Benefit.

     (c)   If a Participant receives a distribution pursuant to the Section
           6.6 and resumes employment covered under the Plan, the
           Participant shall have the right to restore his or her
           Employer-provided Accrued Benefit (including all optional forms
           of benefit and subsidies relating to such benefits), to the
           extent forfeited, upon the repayment to the Plan of the full
           amount of the distribution plus interest compounded annually at
           the rate of (i) five percent (5%) from the date of distribution
           to the date of repayment or to the last day of the Plan Year
           beginning on or after January 1, 1987, if earlier, (ii) and one
           hundred twenty percent (120%) of the federal mid-term rate (as in
           effect under section 1274 of the Code for the first month of a
           Plan Year) from the first day of the Plan Year beginning on or
           after January 1, 1987 or the date of distribution, if later.
           Such repayment must be made before the earlier of (i) five (5)
           years after the Participant's Re-Employment Commencement Date or
           (ii) the date the Participant incurs five (5) consecutive one
           year Service Breaks following the day of distribution.  If an
           Employee is deemed to receive a distribution pursuant to this
           Section, and the Employee resumes employment covered under this
           Plan before the date he incurs five (5) consecutive one year
           Service Breaks, upon the reemployment of such Employee, the
           Employer-provided Accrued Benefit will be restored to the amount
           on the date of such deemed distribution.

     (d)   Any forfeitures under this Plan shall be used to reduce Employer
           contributions, and shall not be applied to increase benefits
           payable under the Plan.

                                ARTICLE VII.
                               DEATH BENEFITS

7.1  Pre-Retirement Without Life Insurance:

     (a)   Plan funded without life insurance:

           The death benefit payable under this Plan upon the death of a
           Participant prior to his Annuity Starting Date shall be the
           Qualified Pre-retirement Survivor Annuity plus, if applicable,
           any other incidental death benefit provided in the Adoption
           Agreement.  Upon the death of an Active or Retired Participant
           prior to his Annuity Starting Date, the death benefit shall be
           determined on the basis of the Participant's entire Accrued
           Benefit.  Upon the death of a Vested Participant prior to his
           Annuity Starting Date, the death benefit shall be determined on
           the basis of the Participant's vested Accrued Benefit.

     (b)   Plan funded with life insurance:

           If a Participant dies prior to his Annuity Starting Date, the
           Participant's surviving spouse shall be entitled to a Qualified
           Pre-retirement Survivor Annuity plus the proceeds of insurance
           policies purchased on he Participant's life; provided that any
           death benefit in addition to the Qualified Pre-retirement
           Survivor Annuity shall be reduced to the extent necessary so that
           the sum of such additional benefit and the Actuarial Value of the
           Qualified Pre-retirement Survivor Annuity does not exceed one
           hundred (100) times the Participant's anticipated monthly benefit
           or such lesser multiple specified in the Adoption Agreement.  If
           the Participant dies prior to his Annuity Starting Date and has
           no surviving spouse or his surviving spouse is not his
           Beneficiary, his Beneficiary shall be entitled only to the
           proceeds of insurance policies purchased on the Participant's
           life.

           If a Participant should die before the issuance of a contract in
           accordance with the terms of this Plan, the death benefit payable
           shall be equal to the amount of premiums that would have been
           paid to purchase the contract, plus the Actuarial Value of his
           Accrued Benefit, if any.

           Upon the death of an Active or Retired Participant prior to his
           Annuity Starting Date, the death benefit shall be determined on
           the basis of the Participant's entire Accrued Benefit.  Upon the
           death of a Vested Participant prior to his Annuity Starting Date,
           the death benefit shall be determined on the basis of the
           Participant's vested Accrued Benefit.

7.2  Designation of Beneficiary

     Each Participant shall have the right, by written notice to the
     Committee, to designate or to change his Beneficiary.  However, any
     designation (or change of designation) of a Beneficiary must be
     consented to by the Participant's Spouse pursuant to a Qualified
     election under 9.2, if such Beneficiary is not the Participant's
     Spouse.

7.3  Distribution of Death Benefit

     Notwithstanding any other provision of the Plan, after receipt by the
     Committee of due notice of the death of the Participant, any benefit
     payable under this Article shall be paid in accordance with Article
     IX.

7.4  Payment on Beneficiary's Death

     If the Beneficiary should die while in receipt of benefits hereunder,
     benefits payable following the Beneficiary's death, if any, shall be
     paid to the legal representative of such Beneficiary's estate.

7.5Post-Retirement Death Benefit

     Upon the death of a Participant after his Annuity Starting Date, any
     payment of benefits to the Beneficiary after the Participant's death
     shall be governed by the terms of the form of benefit under which
     payments were being made.

                                ARTICLE VIII.
                           LIMITATIONS ON BENEFITS

8.1  Maximum Retirement Benefit

     (a)   The Annual Benefit otherwise payable to a Participant at any time
           will not exceed the Maximum Permissible Amount.  If the benefit
           the Participant would otherwise accrue in a Limitation Year would
           produce an Annual Benefit in excess of the Maximum Permissible
           Amount, the rate of accrual will be reduced so that the Annual
           Benefit will equal the Maximum Permissible Amount.  This
           limitation is deemed satisfied if the Annual Benefit payable to a
           Participant is not more than one thousand dollars ($1,000)
           multiplied by the Participant's number of years of Service or
           parts thereof (not to exceed then (10)) with the Employer and the
           Employer has not at any time maintained a defined contribution
           plan, a welfare benefit plan as defined in section 419(e) of the
           Code, or an individual medical account as defined in section
           415(1)(2) of the Code maintained by the Employer, or a simplified
           Employee pension, as defined in section 408(k) of the Code,
           maintained by the Employer, in which such Participant
           participated.

     (b)   If a Participant has made nondeductible Employee contributions
           under the terms of this Plan, the amount of such contributions is
           treated as an Annual Addition to a qualified defined contribution
           plan.

     (c)   If a Participant is, or has ever been, covered under more than
           one defined benefit plan maintained by the Employer, the sum of
           the Participant's Annual Benefits from all such plans may not
           exceed the Maximum Permissible Amount.  The Employer will elect
           in the Adoption Agreement the method by which the plans will meet
           this limitation.

     (d)   If the Employer maintains, or at any time maintained, one or more
           qualified defined contribution plans covering any Participant in
           this Plan, a welfare benefit fund, as defined in section 419(e)
           of the Code, or an individual medical account as defined in
           section 415(1)(2) of the Code maintained by the Employer, or a
           simplified Employee pension, as defined in section 408(k) of the
           Code, maintained by the Employer, that the sum of the
           Participant's Defined Contribution Fraction and Defined Benefit
           Fraction will not exceed one (1.0) in any Limitation Year.  The
           Employer will choose in the Adoption Agreements the method by
           which the plans will meet this limitation.

     (e)   In the case of an individual who was a Participant in one or more
           defined benefit plans of the Employer as of the first day of the
           first Limitation Year beginning after December 31, 1986, the
           application of the limitations of this Section 8.1 shall not
           cause the maximum Permissible Amount for such individual under
           all such defined benefit plans to be less than the individual's
           Current Accrued Benefit.  The preceding sentence applies only if
           such defined benefit plans met the requirements of section 415 of
           the Code, for all limitation years beginning before January 1,
           1987.

     (f)   For purposes of this Section 8.1 and Article XVII, the following
           definitions shall apply.

           (1)  "Annual Additions"  shall mean the sum of the following
                amounts credited to the Participant's account for the
                Limitation Year:

                (A)  Employer contributions;

                (B)  Employee contributions; and

                (C)  forfeitures.

                     Amounts allocated, after March 31, 1984, to an
                     individual medical account, as defined in section
                     415(1)(2) of the Code, which is part of a pension or
                     annuity plan maintained by the Employer, are treated as
                     Annual Additions to a defined contribution plan.  Also,
                     amounts derived from contributions paid or accrued
                     after December 31, 1985, in taxable years ending after
                     such date, which are attributable to post-retirement
                     medical benefits allocated to the separate account of a
                     Key Employee, as defined in section 419A(d)(3) of the
                     Code, under a welfare benefit fund, as defined in
                     section 419(e) of the Code, maintained by the Employer,
                     are treated as Annual Additions to a defined
                     contribution plan.  Also, allocations under a
                     simplified Employee pension are treated as Annual
                     Additions to a defined contribution plan.

           (2)  "Annual Benefit" shall mean a retirement benefit payable
                under the Plan which is payable annually in the form of a
                straight life annuity.  Except as provided below, a benefit
                payable in a form other than a straight life annuity must be
                adjusted to an actuarially equivalent straight life annuity
                before applying the limitations of this Section.  The
                interest rate assumption used to determine actuarial
                equivalence will be the greater of the interest rate
                specified in Section 1.2 of this Plan or five percent (5%).
                The Annual Benefit does not include any benefits
                attributable to Employee contributions or rollover
                contributions, or the assets transferred from a qualified
                plan that was not maintained by the Employer.  No actuarial
                adjustment to the benefit is required for (a) the value of a
                Qualified Joint and Survivor Annuity, (b) the value of
                benefits that are not directly related to retirement
                benefits (such as the qualified disability benefit,
                pre-retirement death benefits and post-retirement medical
                benefits) and (c) the value of post-retirement
                cost-of-living increases made in accordance with Section
                415(d) of the Code and section 1.415-3(c)(2)(iii) of the
                Federal Income Tax Regulations.

           (3)  "Compensation", unless otherwise specified in the Adoption
                Agreement, shall mean, in the case of an Employee other than
                a Self-Employed Individual, his section 3401(a) wages, which
                are actually paid or includable in gross income during the
                Limitation Year.  In the case of a Self-Employed Individual,
                Compensation shall mean his Earned Income.

           (4)  "Current Accrued Benefit" shall mean a Participant's Accrued
                Benefit under the Plan, determined as if the Participant had
                separated form service as of the close of the last
                Limitation Year beginning before January 1, 1987, when
                expressed as an Annual Benefit within the meaning of section
                415(b)(2) of the Code.  In determining the amount of a
                Participant's Current Accrued Benefit, the following shall
                be disregarded:

                (i)  any change in the terms and conditions of the Plan
                     after May 5, 1986; and

                (ii) any cost-of-living adjustments occurring after May 5,
                     1986.

           (5)  "Defined Benefit Dollar Limitation" shall mean ninety
                thousand dollars ($90,000).  Effective on January 1, 1988,
                and each January thereafter, the ninety thousand dollar
                ($90,000) limitation above will be automatically adjusted by
                multiplying such limit by the cost-of-living adjustment
                factor prescribed by the Secretary of the Treasury under
                section 415(d) of the Code in such manner as the Secretary
                shall prescribe.  The new limitation will apply to
                Limitation Years ending within the calendar year of the date
                of the adjustment.

           (6)  "Defined Benefit Fraction" shall mean a fraction, the
                numerator of which is the sum of the Participant's Projected
                Annual Benefit under all the defined benefit plans (whether
                or not terminated) maintained by the Employer, and the
                denominator of which is the lesser of one hundred
                twenty-five percent (125%) of the dollar limitation
                determined for the Limitation Year under sections 415(b) and
                (d) of the Code and in accordance with Section 8.1(f)(11)
                below or one hundred forty percent (140%) of the Highest
                Average Compensation, including adjustments under section
                415(b) of the Code.

                Notwithstanding the above, if the Participant was a
                Participant as of the first day of the first Limitation Year
                beginning after December 31, 1986, in one or more defined
                benefit plans maintained by the Employer which were in
                existence on May 6, 1986, the denominator of this fraction
                will not be less than one hundred twenty-five percent (125%)
                of the sum of the annual benefits under such plans which the
                Participant had accrued as of the close of the last
                Limitation Year beginning before January 1, 1987,
                disregarding any changes in the terms and conditions of the
                plans after May 5, 1986.  The preceding sentence applies
                only if the defined benefit plans individually and in the
                aggregate satisfied the requirements of section 415 of the
                Code for all Limitation Years beginning before January 1,
                1987.

           (7)  "Defined Contribution Fraction" shall mean a fraction the
                numerator of which is the sum of the Annual Additions to the
                Participant's account under all the defined contribution
                plans (whether or not terminated) maintained by the Employer
                for the current and all prior Limitation years (including
                the Annual Additions attributable to the Participant's
                nondeductible voluntary contributions to this and all the
                defined benefit plans (whether or not terminated) maintained
                by the Employer and the Annual Additions attributable to all
                welfare benefit funds, as defined in section 419(e) of the
                Code or individual medical accounts, as defined in section
                415(1)(2) of the Code, or a simplified employee pension, as
                defined in section 408(k) of the Code, maintained by the
                Employer), and the denominator of which is the sum of the
                Maximum Aggregate Amounts for the current and all prior
                Limitation Years of Service with the Employer (regardless of
                whether a defined contribution plan was maintained by the
                Employer).

                The Maximum Aggregate Amount in any Limitation Year is the
                lesser of one hundred twenty-five percent (125%) of the
                dollar limitation determined under Sections 415(b) and (d)
                of the Code in effect under section 415(c)(1)(A) of the Code
                or thirty-five percent (35%) of the Participant's
                Compensation for such year.

                If the Employee was a Participant as of the first day of the
                first Limitation Year beginning after December 31, 1986, in
                one or more defined contribution plans maintained by the
                Employer which were in existence on May 6, 1986, the
                numerator of this fraction will be adjusted if the sum of
                this fraction and the Defined Benefit Fraction would
                otherwise exceed one (1.0) times under the terms of this
                Plan.  Under the adjustment, an amount equal to the product
                of (a) the excess of the sum of the fractions over 1.0 times
                (b) the denominator of this fraction will be
                permanently subtracted from the numerator of this fraction.
                The adjustment is calculated using the fractions as they
                would be computed as of the end of the last Limitation Year
                beginning before January 1, 1987, and disregarding any
                changes in the terms and condition of the Plans made after
                May 5, 1986, but using the limitation of section 415 of the
                Code applicable to the first Limitation Year beginning on or
                after January 1, 1987.

                     The Annual Additions for any Limitation Year beginning
                     before January 1, 1987 shall not be recomputed to treat
                     all Employee contributions as Annual Additions.

           (8)  "Employer" shall mean the Employer that adopts this Plan,
                and all members of a controlled group of corporations (as
                defined in section 414(b) of the Code, as modified by
                section 415(h)), commonly controlled trades or businesses
                (as defined ins section 414(c) as modified by section
                415(h)), affiliated service groups (as defined in section
                414(m)) of which the adopting Employer is a part, or any
                other entity required to be aggregated with the adopting
                Employer pursuant to regulations under section 414(o).

           (9)  "Highest Average Compensation" shall mean the average
                Compensation for the three (3) consecutive years of Service
                with the Employer that produces the highest average.  A Year
                of Service with the Employer is the twelve (12) consecutive
                month period identical to the Plan Year.

           (10) "Limitation Year" shall mean the calendar year, unless
                another twelve (12) consecutive month period is elected in
                the Adoption Agreement.  All qualified plans maintained by
                the Employer must use the same Limitation Year.  If the
                Limitation year is changed by amendment, the new Limitation
                year must begin on a date within the Limitation Year in
                which the amendment is made.

           (11) "Maximum Permissible Amount":

                (A)  Effective as of the first day of the first Plan Year
                     beginning on or after January 1, 1987, the lesser of
                     the Defined Benefit Dollar limitation or one hundred
                     percent (100%) of the Participant's Highest Average
                     Compensation.

                (B)  If the Participant has less than ten (10) Years of
                     Participation (as defined in Section 8.1(f)(13) of the
                     Plan) with the Employer, the Defined Benefit Dollar
                     Limitation is reduced by one-tenth (1/10th) for each
                     Year of Participation (or part thereof) less then ten
                     (10).  If the Participant has less than ten (10) years
                     of Service with the Employer, the Compensation
                     limitation is reduced by one-tenth (1/10th) for each
                     year of Service (or part thereof) less than ten (10).
                     The adjustments of this paragraph (b) shall be applied
                     in the denominator of the Defined Benefit Fraction
                     based upon years of Service.  Years of Service shall
                     include future years occurring before the Participant's
                     Normal Retirement Age.  Such future years shall include
                     the year which contains the date the Participant
                     reaches Normal Retirement Age, only if it can be
                     reasonably anticipated that the Participant will
                     receive a year of Service for such year.

                (C)  If the annual benefit of the Participant commences
                     before the Participant's Social Security Retirement
                     Age, but on or after age sixty-two (62), the Defined
                     Benefit Dollar Limitation as reduced above, if
                     necessary, shall be determined as follows:

                     (i)  If a Participant's Social Security Retirement Age
                          is sixty-five (65), the dollar limitation for
                          benefits commencing on or after age sixty-two (62)
                          is determined by reducing the Defined Benefit
                          Dollar Limitation by five-ninths of one percent
                          (.556%) for each month by which benefits commence
                          before the month in which the Participant attains
                          age sixty-five (65).

                     (ii) If a Participant's Social Security Retirement Age
                          is greater than sixty-five (65), the dollar
                          limitation for benefits commencing on or after age
                          sixty-two (62) is determined by reducing the
                          defined benefit dollar limitation by five-ninths
                          of one percent (.556%) for each of the first
                          thirty-six (36) months and five-twelfths of one
                          percent (.556%) for each of the additional months
                          (up to twenty-four (24) months) by which benefits
                          commence before the month of the Participant's
                          Social Security Retirement Age.

                (D)  If the annual benefit of a Participant commences prior
                     to age sixty-two (62), the Defined Benefit Dollar
                     Limitation shall be the Actuarial Equivalent of an
                     annual benefit beginning at age sixty-two (62), as
                     determined above, reduced for each month by which
                     benefits commence before the month in which the
                     Participant attains age sixty-two (62).  To determine
                     actuarial equivalence, the interest rate assumption is
                     the greater of the rate specified in Section 1.12 or
                     five percent (5%).  Any decrease in the Defined Benefit
                     Dollar Limitation determined in accordance with this
                     paragraph (d) shall not reflect any mortality decrement
                     to the extent that benefits will not be forfeited upon
                     the death of the Participant.

                (E)  If the annual benefit of a Participant commences after
                     the Participant's Social Security Retirement Age, the
                     Defined Benefit Dollar Limitation as reduced in
                     paragraph (b) above, if necessary, shall be adjusted so
                     that it is the Actuarial Equivalent of an annual
                     benefit of such dollar limitation beginning at the
                     Participant's Social Security Retirement Age.  To
                     determine actuarial equivalence, the interest rate
                     assumption used is the lesser of the rate specified in
                     Section 1.2 or five percent (5%).

           (12) "Projected Annual Benefit" shall mean the Annual Benefit as
                defined in subsection (2) above, to which the Participant
                would be entitled under the terms of the Plan assuming:

                (A)  the Participant will continue employment until the
                     Normal Retirement Date under the Plan (or current
                     date,if later) and

                (B)  the Participant's Compensation for the current
                     Limitation Year and all other relevant factors used to
                     determine benefits under the Plan will remain constant
                     for all future Limitation Years.

           (13) "Year of Participation" shall mean a year of Participation
                (as defined in Article I) (computed to fractional parts of a
                year).  A Participant who is permanently and totally
                 disabled within the meaning of section 415(c)(3)(C)(i) of
                the Code for an accrual computation period shall receive a
                Year of Participation with respect to that period.  In
                addition, for a Participant to receive a Year of
                Participation (or part thereof) for a Plan Year, the Plan
                must be established no later than the last day of such
                accrual computation period.  In no event will more than one
                Year of Participation be credited for any twelve (12) month
                period.

8.2  Limitations Applicable to Twenty-Five (25) Highest Paid Employees

     (a)   Prior to the date the pre-termination restrictions in section 8.3
           of the Plan are effective, Employer contributions on behalf of
           any of the twenty-five (25) highest paid Employees at the time
           the Plan is established and whose anticipated annual benefit
           exceeds fifteen hundred dollars ($1,500) will be restricted as
           provided in paragraph (b) upon the occurrence of the following
           conditions:

           (1)  The Plan is terminated within ten (10) years after its
                establishment, or

           (2)  The benefits of such highest paid Employee become payable
                within ten (10) years after the establishment of the Plan.

                If (2) above is applicable, the restrictions shall remain in
                effect until the expiration of the ten (10) year period or,
                if later, the date on which the Full Current Costs have been
                funded for the first time.

     (b)   Employer contributions (or funds attributable thereto) which may
           be used for the benefit of an Employee described in paragraph (a)
           shall not exceed the greater of twenty thousand dollars
           ($20,000), or twenty percent (20%) of the first fifty thousand
           dollars ($50,000) of the Employee's Annual Compensation
           multiplied by the number of years between the date of
           establishment of the Plan and:

           (1)  If (a)(1) applies, the date of termination of the Plan, or

           (2)  If (a)(2) applies, the date the benefits become payable.

     (c)   If the Plan is amended so as to increase the benefit actually
           payable in the event of the subsequent termination of the Plan,
           or the subsequent discontinuance of contributions thereunder,
           then the provisions of the above paragraphs shall be applied to
           the Plan as so changed as if it were a new plan established on
           the date of the change.  The original group of twenty-five (25)
           Employees (as described in (a) above will continue to have the
           limitation in (b) apply as if the Plan had not been changed.  The
           restrictions relating to the change of Plan should apply to
           benefits or funds for each of the twenty-five (25) highest paid
           Employees on the effective date of the change except that such
           restrictions need not apply with respect to any Employee in this
           group from whom the normal annual pension or annuity provided by
           Employer contributions prior to that date or during the ensuing
           ten (10) years, based on his rate of Annual Compensation on that
           date, could not exceed fifteen hundred dollars ($1,500).

           The Employer contributions which may be used for the benefit of
           the new group of twenty-five (25) Employees will be limited to
           the greater of:

           (1)  The Employer contributions (or funds attributable thereto)
                which would have been applied to provide the benefits for
                the Employee if the previous plan had been continued without
                change;

           (2)  Twenty thousand dollars ($20,000); or

           (3)  The sum of (A) the Employer contributions (or funds
                attributable thereto) which would have been applied to
                provide benefits for the Employee under the previous plan if
                it had been terminated the day before the effective date of
                the change and (B) an amount computed by multiplying the
                number of years for which the current costs of the Plan
                after that date are met by (i) twenty percent (20%) or his
                Annual Compensation, or (ii) ten thousand dollars ($10,000),
                whichever is smaller.

     (d)   Notwithstanding the above limitations, the following limitation
           will apply if they would result in a greater amount of Employer
           contributions to be used for the benefit of the restricted
           Employee:

           (1)  In the case of a substantial owner (as defined in section
                4022(b)(5) of the Act), a dollar amount which equals the
                present value of the benefit guaranteed for such Employee
                under section 4022 of the Act, or if the Plan has not
                terminated, the present value of the benefit that would be
                guaranteed if the Plan terminated on the date the benefit
                commences, determined in accordance with regulation of the
                PBGC; and

           (2)  In the case of other restricted Employees, a dollar amount
                which equals the present value of the maximum benefit
                described in section 4022(b)(3)(B) of the Act (determined on
                the earlier of the date the Plan terminates or the date
                benefits commence and determined in accordance with
                regulations of the PBGC) without regard to any other
                limitations in section 4022 of the Act.

     (e)   The provisions of this Section 8.2 shall not restrict the full
           payment of the Standard Form of Retirement Income payable under
           the Plan or the full payment of an optional form of retirement
           benefit in an amount not in excess of the Standard Form of
           Retirement Income while the Plan is in effect and (1) its Full
           Current Costs are met or (2) the aggregate of all payments in
           excess of the restricted amounts payable to all Participants who
           are among the affected twenty-five (25) highest paid Employees
           does not exceed the aggregate of all Employer contributions
           already made to the Plan in the current Plan Year.

     (f)   The provisions of this Section 8.2 shall not restrict the payment
           of a lump sum distribution if the Participant enters into an
           agreement to repay any amount which may be required to be repaid
           under this Section 8.2 upon a plan termination or failure to meet
           Full Current Costs within ten (10) years of its establishment or
           amendment increasing benefits, as applicable, and the Participant
           deposits with an acceptable depository property having a fair
           market value equal to one hundred twenty-five percent (125%) of
           the amount which would be repayable had the Plan terminated on
           the date of the lump sum distribution.  If the market value of
           the property held by the depository falls below one hundred ten
           percent (110%) of the amount which would be repayable if the Plan
           were then to terminate, additional property necessary to bring
           the value of the property held by the depository up to one
           hundred twenty-five percent (125%) of such amount will be
           deposited.

     (g)   If this Plan terminates at a time when the value of Plan assets
           is not less than the present value of all Accrued Benefits
           (whether or not nonforfeitable) distributions of assets to each
           Participant equal to the present value of the Participant's
           Accrued Benefit will not be discriminatory if the formula for
           computing benefits as of the date of termination is not
           discriminatory.  All present values and the value of Plan assets
           will be computed using assumptions satisfying section 4044 of the
           Act.

     (h)   For purposes of this Section 8.2:

           (1)  "Full current costs" of the Plan means the normal cost of
                the Plan, as defined in IRS Regulations Section 1.404(a)-6
                for all years since the effective date of the Plan, plus
                interest on any unfunded liability during such period.

           (2)  "Annual Compensation" means an Employee's average regular
                annual Compensation, or such average Compensation over the
                last five (5) years, or such Employee's last annual
                Compensation if such Compensation is reasonably similar to
                his average regular annual Compensation for the five (5)
                preceding years.


8.3  Additional Restrictions

     For Plan Years beginning on or after the date set forth in the
     Adoption Agreement, benefits distributed to any of the 25 most highly
     compensated active and highly compensated former Employees with the
     greatest Compensation in the current or any prior year are restricted
     such that the annual payments are no greater than an amount equal to
     the payment that would be made on behalf of the Employee under a
     straight life annuity that is the Actuarial Equivalent of the sum of
     the Employee's Accrued Benefit, the Employee's other benefits under
     the Plan (other than a social security supplement, within the meaning
     of section 1.411(a)-7(c)(4)(ii) of the Income Tax Regulations), and
     the amount the Employee is entitled to receive under a social security
     supplement.

     The preceding paragraph shall not apply if: (1) after payment of the
     benefit to an Employee described in the preceding paragraph, the value
     of Plan assets equals or exceeds 110% of the value of current
     liabilities, as defined in section 412(1)(7) of the Code, (2) the
     value of the benefits for an Employee described above is less than 1%
     of the value of current liabilities before distribution, or (3) the
     value of the benefits payable under the Plan to an Employee described
     above does not exceed $3,500.

     For purposes of this section, "benefit" includes loans in excess of
     the amount set forth in section 72(p)(2)(A) of the Code, any periodic
     income, any withdrawal values payable to a living Employee, and any
     death benefits not provided for by insurance on the Employee's life.

     The pre-termination restrictions in section 8.3 of the Plan will be
     effective as elected in the Adoption Agreement (no later than the
     first day of the 1994 Plan Year).

     An Employee's otherwise restricted benefit may be distributed in full
     to the affected Employee if prior to receipt of the restricted amount,
     the Employee enters into a written agreement with the Plan
     Administrator to secure repayment to the Plan of the restricted
     amount.  The restricted amount is the excess of the amounts
     distributed to the Employee (accumulated with reasonable interest)
     over the amounts that could have been distributed to the Employee as a
     straight life annuity (accumulated with reasonable interest).  The
     Employee may secure repayment of the restricted amount upon
     distribution by: (1) entering into an agreement for promptly
     depositing in escrow with an acceptance depository property having a
     fair market value equal to at least 125 percent of the restricted
     amount, (2) providing a bank letter of credit in amount equal to at
     least 100 percent of the restricted amount, or (3) posting a bond
     equal to at least 100 percent of the restricted amount.  If the
     Employee elects to post bond, the bond will be furnished by an
     insurance company, bonding company or other surety for federal bonds.

     The escrow arrangement may provide that an Employee may withdraw
     amounts in excess of 125 percent of the restricted amount.  If the
     market value of the property in an escrow account falls below 110
     percent of the remaining restricted amount, the Employee must deposit
     additional property to bring the value of the property held by the
     depository up to 125 percent of the restricted amount.  The escrow
     arrangement may provide that an Employee may have the right to receive
     any income from the property placed in escrow subject to the
     Employee's obligation to deposit additional property, as set forth in
     the preceding sentence.

     A surety or bank may release any liability on a bond or letter of
     credit in excess of 100 percent of the restricted amount.

     If the Plan Administrator certifies to the depository, surety or bank
     that the Employee (or the Employee's estate) is no longer obligated to
     repay any restricted amount, a depository may redeliver to the
     Employee any property held under an escrow agreement, and a surety or
     bank may release any liability on an Employee's bond or letter of
     credit.


                                  ARTICLE IX.
                             PAYMENT OF BENEFITS

9.1  Commencement of Benefits

     The following provisions shall be applicable for determining when the
     distribution of benefits shall be made:

     (a)   If the Actuarial Value of a Participant's vested Accrued Benefit
           exceeds (or at the time of any prior distribution exceeded)
           $3,500, the Participant must consent to any distribution of such
           Accrued Benefit prior to the date the Participant has attained
           the later of Normal Retirement Age or age sixty-two (62).  The
           consent of the Participant's spouse shall also be required if
           such distribution is made in any form other than a Qualified
           Joint and Survivor Annuity.  The consent of the Participant and,
           if applicable, the Participant's spouse to any such distribution
           shall be obtained in writing within the ninety (90) day period
           ending on the Annuity Starting Date.  The Committee shall provide
           the Participant with a written explanation of the material
           features and relative values of he optional forms of benefit
           available under the Plan.  Such notice shall also notify the
           Participant of the right to defer distribution until Normal
           Retirement Age (or age sixty-two (62), if later), and shall be
           provided during the period beginning ninety (90) days before and
           ending thirty (30) days before the Annuity Starting Date.

           Notwithstanding the foregoing, only the Participant need consent
           to the commencement of a distribution in the form of a Qualified
           Joint and Survivor Annuity while the Accrued Benefit is
           immediately distributable.  Neither the consent of the
           Participant nor the Participant's spouse shall be required to the
           extent that a distribution is required to satisfy section
           401(a)(9) or section 415 of the Code.

           An Accrued Benefit is immediately distributable if any part of
           the Accrued Benefit could be distributed to the Participant (or
           surviving spouse) before the Participant attains (or would have
           attained if not deceased) the later of Normal Retirement Age or
           age 62.

           For purposes of determining the applicability of the foregoing
           consent requirements to distributions made before the first day
           of the first Plan Year beginning after December 31, 1988, the
           Participant's vested Accrued Benefit shall not include amounts
           attributable to accumulated deductible Employee contributions
           within the meaning of section 72(o)(5)(B) of the Code.

     (b)   Unless the Participant elects otherwise, in the event of the
           retirement or termination of employment of a Participant, the
           Committee shall determine the exact date on which payment of
           benefits shall commence, but such date shall be no later than the
           sixtieth (60th) day after the close of the Plan Year in which the
           latest of the following events occurs:

                (1)  the Participant reaches his Normal Retirement Age (or
                     age sixty-five (65), if earlier),

                (2)  the tenth (10th) anniversary of the year in which the
                     Participant commenced participation in the Plan, or

                (3)  the Participant terminates employment with the
                     Employer.

           The failure of a Participant or surviving spouse to consent to a
           distribution shall be deemed to be an election to defer
           commencement of benefit distributions sufficient to satisfy this
           Section.

           Neither the consent of the Participant nor the Participant's
           spouse shall be required to the extent a distribution is
           necessary to satisfy section 401(a)(9) or section 415 of the
           Code.

           If, however, such Participant's termination occurred after he had
           satisfied the Service requirements, if any, for an Early
           Retirement Benefit, he may elect to have such benefit commence on
           a date prior to his Normal Retirement Date, provided an
           application is filed with the Committee at least sixty (60) days
           prior to the earlier commencement date.

           Employer-derived benefits shall be paid only in the event of
           death, disability, termination of employment or retirement.

9.2  Automatic Annuity Requirements

     (a)   Applicability of Automatic Annuity Requirements.

     The provisions of this Section shall take precedence over any
     conflicting provision in this Plan and shall apply to any Participant
     who is credited with at least one (1) Hour of Service with the
     Employer on or after August 23, 1984, and such other Participants as
     provided in Section 9.3.

     Qualified Joint and Survivor Annuity.  Unless an optional form of
     benefit is selected pursuant to a Qualified Election within the ninety
     (90) day period ending on the Annuity Starting Date, a married
     Participant's Vested Accrued Benefit shall be paid in the form of a
     Qualified Joint and Survivor Annuity and an unmarried Participant's
     Vested Accrued Benefit shall be paid in the form of a single life
     annuity.  The Participant may elect to have such annuity distributed
     upon attainment of the Earliest Retirement Age.

     Qualified Pre-retirement Survivor Annuity.  Unless an optional form of
     benefit is selected within the election Period pursuant to a Qualified
     Election, if a Participant dies after the Earliest Retirement Age, the
     Participant's Surviving Spouse (if any) shall receive the same benefit
     that would be payable if the Participant had retired with an immediate
     Qualified Joint and Survivor Annuity on the day before the
     Participant's date of death.

     Unless an optional form of benefit is selected within the Election
     Period pursuant to a Qualified Election, if a Participant dies on or
     before the Earliest Retirement Age, the Participant's Surviving Spouse
     (if any) shall receive the same benefit that would be payable if the
     Participant had:

     (i)   separated form service on the date of death (or date of
           separation from service, if earlier),

     (ii)  survived to the Earliest Retirement Age,

     (iii)retired with an immediate Qualified Joint and Survivor
           Annuity at the Earliest Retirement Age, and

     (iv)  died on the day after the Earliest Retirement Age.

     Notwithstanding the above, a Surviving Spouse shall begin to receive
     payments at the Earliest Retirement Age, unless such Surviving Spouse
     elects a later date.  The Actuarial Value of benefits which commence
     later than the date on which payments would have been made to the
     surviving spouse under a Qualified Joint and Survivor Annuity in
     accordance with this provision shall be adjusted to reflect the
     delayed payment.

     Subject to the provisions of Section 9.1(a), a surviving spouse will
     begin to receive payments at the Earliest Retirement Age.  Benefits
     commencing after the Earliest Retirement Age will be the Actuarial
     Equivalent of the Benefit to which the surviving spouse would have
     been entitled if benefits had commenced at the Earliest Retirement Age
     under an immediate Qualified Joint and Survivor Annuity.

     The benefit payable to the Surviving Spouse shall be attributable to
     Employee contributions in the same proportion as the Accrued Benefit
     derived from Employee contributions is to the total Accrued Benefit of
     the Participant.

     Definitions.  For purposes of this Section 9.2, the following words
     shall have the following meanings:

     (i)   "Earliest Retirement Age" shall mean the earliest date on which,
           under the Plan, the Participant could elect to receive
           retirement benefits.

     (ii)  "Election Period" shall mean the period which begins on the first
           day of the Plan Year in which the Participant attains age
           thirty-five (35) and ends on the date of the Participant's death.

           If a Participant separates from service prior to the first day of
           the Plan Year in which age thirty-five (35) is attained, with
           respect to benefits accrued prior to separation, the Election
           Period shall begin on the date of separation.

           A Participant who will not yet attain age thirty-five (35) as of
           the end of any current Plan Year may make a special Qualified
           Election to waive the Qualified Pre-retirement Survivor Annuity
           for the period beginning on the date of such election and ending
           on the first day of the Plan Year in which the Participant will
           attain age thirty-five (35).  Such election shall not be valid
           unless the Participant receives a written explanation of the
           Qualified Pre-retirement Survivor Annuity in such terms as are
           comparable to the explanation required under Section 9.2(b).
           Qualified Pre-retirement Survivor Annuity coverage will be
           automatically reinstated as of the first day of the Plan Year in
           which the Participant attains age thirty-five (35).  Any new
           waiver on or after such date shall be subject to the full
           requirements of this Section 9.2.

     (iii)"Qualified Election" shall mean a Participant's waiver of a
           Qualified Joint and Survivor annuity or a Qualified
           Pre-retirement Survivor Annuity.  Any such waiver must be
           consented to in writing by the Participant's Spouse.  The
           Spouse's consent must: designate a specific alternate Beneficiary
           (including any class of Beneficiaries or any contingent
           Beneficiaries, which may not be changed without spousal consent)
           or expressly permit designations by the Participant without any
           further spousal consent; acknowledge the effect of the election;
           and be witnessed by a member of the Committee or a Notary Public.
           Additionally, a Participant's waiver of the Qualified Joint and
           Survivor Annuity shall not be effective unless the election
           designates a form of benefit payment which may not be changed
           without spousal consent (or the Spouse expressly permits
           designations by the Participant without any further spousal
           consent).  Notwithstanding this consent requirement, if the
           Participant establishes to the satisfaction of a member of the
           Committee that there is no Spouse or the Spouse cannot be
           located, a waiver will be deemed a Qualified Election.  Any
           spousal consent (of deemed spousal consent) obtained under this
           provision will be valid only with respect to such Spouse.  A
           consent that permits designations by the Participant without
           further consent by such Spouse must acknowledge that the Spouse
           has the right to limit consent to a specific Beneficiary and,
           where applicable, a specific form of benefit, and that the Spouse
           voluntarily elects to relinquish either or both of such rights.
           A revocation of a prior consent may be made by a Participant
           without the consent of the Spouse at any time before the
           commencement of benefits.  The number of revocations shall not be
           limited.  No consent obtained under this provision shall be valid
           unless the Participant has received notice as provided in
           paragraph (b) below.

     (iv)  "Spouse (Surviving Spouse)" shall mean the Spouse or Surviving
           Spouse of the Participant, provided that a former spouse will be
           treated as the Spouse or Surviving Spouse to the extent provided
           under a qualified domestic relations order as described in
           section 414(p) of the Code.

     (v)   "Vested Accrued Benefit" shall mean the value of the
           Participant's vested Accrued Benefit derived from Employer and
           Employee contributions (including rollovers).  The provisions of
           this Section shall apply to a Participant who is vested in
           amounts attributable to Employer contributions, Employee
           contributions (or both) at the time of death or distribution.

     (b)   Notice Requirements.

     Qualified Joint and Survivor Annuity.  In the case of a Qualified
     Joint and Survivor Annuity as described above the Committee shall
     provide each Participant a written explanation of:  (i) the terms and
     conditions of a Qualified Joint and Survivor Annuity; (ii) the
     Participant's right to make and the effect of an election to waive the
     Qualified Joint and Survivor Annuity form of benefit; (iii) the rights
     of a Participant's Spouse; (iv) the right to make, and the effect of,
     a revocation of a previous election to waive the Qualified Joint and
     Survivor Annuity; and (v) the relative values of the various optional
     forms of benefit under the Plan.

     Qualified Pre-retirement Survivor Annuity.  In the case of a Qualified
     Pre-retirement Survivor Annuity as described above, the Committee
     shall provide each Participant with a written explanation of the
     Qualified Pre-retirement Survivor Annuity in such terms and in such
     manner as would be comparable to the explanation provided for meeting
     the requirement applicable to explaining a Qualified Joint and
     Survivor Annuity within whichever of the following periods ends last:

     (i)   The period beginning on the first day of the Plan Year in which
           the Participant attains age thirty-two (32) and ending with the
           close of the Plan Year preceding the Plan Year in which the
           Participant attains age thirty-five (35).

     (ii)  A reasonable period ending after a Participant enters the Plan.

     (iii)A reasonable period after this Section 9.2 first applies to a
           Participant.

     (iv)  A reasonable period ending after the Plan ceases to "fully
           subsidize" the cost of the Qualified Pre-retirement Survivor
           Annuity.

     For purposes of applying the preceding paragraph, a reasonable period
     ending after the enumerated events described in (ii), (iii) and (iv)
     is the end of the two (2) year period beginning one year prior to the
     date the applicable event occurs, and ending one year after that date.

     Notwithstanding the foregoing, notice must be provided within a
     reasonable period ending after termination of employment in the case
     of a Participant who terminates employment before attaining age 35.
     Such notice shall be provided within the two (2) year period beginning
     one year prior to termination and ending one year after termination.
     If such a Participant thereafter returns to employment with the
     Employer, the applicable period for such Participant shall be
     redetermined.

     Notwithstanding the above, the respective notices prescribed herein
     need not be given to a Participant if this Plan "fully subsidizes" the
     costs of a Qualified Joint and Survivor Annuity or Qualified
     Pre-retirement Survivor Annuity and the Participant cannot elect
     another form of benefit or designate a non-spouse Beneficiary.  For
     purposes of the foregoing, a Plan fully subsidizes the costs of a
     benefit if under the Plan no increase in cost or decrease in benefits
     to the Participant may result from the Participant's failure to elect
     another benefit.  Prior to the time the Plan allows the Participant to
     waive the Qualified Pre-retirement Survivor Annuity, the Plan may not
     charge the Participant for the cost of such benefit by reducing the
     Participant's benefits under the Plan or by any other method.

9.3  Transitional Rules Applicable to Joint and Survivor Annuities

     (a)   Any living Participant not receiving benefits on August 23, 1984,
           who would otherwise not receive the benefits prescribed by
           Section 9.2 must be given the opportunity to elect to have
           section 9.2 apply if such Participant is credited with at least
           one (1) Hour of Service under this Plan or a predecessor Plan in
           a Plan Year beginning on or after January 1, 1976, and such
           Participant had at least ten (10) years of Service when he or she
           terminated employment.

     (b)   Any living Participant not receiving benefits on August 23, 1984
           who was credited with at least one (1) Hour of Service under this
           Plan or a predecessor Plan on or after September 2, 1974, and who
           is not otherwise credited with any Service in a Plan Year
           beginning on or after January 1, 1976, must be given the
           opportunity to have his or her benefits paid in the manner set
           forth in paragraph (d) below.

     (c)   The respective opportunities to elect (as described in paragraphs
           (a) and (b) above) must be afforded to the appropriate
           Participants during the period commencing on August 23, 1984, and
           ending on the date benefits would otherwise commence to said
           Participants.

     (d)   Any Participant who has elected pursuant to paragraph (b) above
           and any Participant who does not elect under paragraph (a) above
           or who meets the requirements of paragraph (a) except that such
           Participant does not have at least ten (10) years of Service when
           he or she terminates employment shall have his or her benefits
           distributed in accordance with all of the following requirements
           if benefits would have been payable in the form of a life
           annuity.

           (1)  Qualified Joint and Survivor Annuity.  If benefits in the
                form of a life annuity become payable to a married
                Participant who:

                     (i)  Begins to receive payments under the Plan on or
                          after Normal Retirement Age; or

                     (ii) Dies on or after Normal Retirement Age while still
                          working for the Employer; or

                     (iii)Begins to receive payments on or after the
                          Qualified Early Retirement Age; or

                     (iv) Separates from service on or after attaining
                          Normal Retirement Age (or the Qualified Early
                          Retirement Age) and after satisfying the
                          eligibility requirements for the payment of
                          benefits under the Plan and thereafter dies before
                          beginning to receive such benefits; then such
                          benefits will be received under this Plan in the
                          form of a Qualified Joint and Survivor Annuity,
                          unless the Participant has elected otherwise
                          during the election period which shall begin at
                          least six (6) months before the Participant
                          attains Qualified Early Retirement Age and end not
                          more than ninety (90) days before the commencement
                          of benefits.  Any election hereunder will be in
                          writing and may be changed by the Participant,
                          with the consent of his or her spouse, at any item
                          during the election period.

           (2)  Election of Early Survivor Annuity.  A Participant who is
                employed after attaining the Qualified Early Retirement Age
                will be given the opportunity to elect, during the election
                period, to have a survivor annuity payable on death.  If the
                Participant elects the survivor annuity, payments under such
                annuity must not be less than the payments which would have
                been made to the spouse under Qualified Joint and Survivor
                Annuity if the Participant had retired on the day before his
                or her death.  Any election under this provision will be in
                writing and may be changed by the Participant, with the
                consent of his or her spouse, at any time.  The election
                period begins on the later of (1) the ninetieth (90th) day
                before the Participant attains the Qualified Early
                Retirement Age, or (2) the date on which Participation
                begins, and ends on the date the Participant terminates
                employment.

           (3)  Definitions.  For purposes of this Section 9.3(d):

                     (i)  "Qualified Joint and Survivor Annuity" shall mean
                          an annuity for the life of the Participant with a
                          survivor annuity for the life of his Spouse as
                          described in Section 9.2.

                     (ii) Qualified Early Retirement Age shall mean the
                          latest of:

                          (A)  the earliest date, under the Plan, on which
                               the Participant may elect to receive
                               retirement benefits,

                          (B)  the first day of the one hundred twentieth
                               (120th) month beginning before the
                               Participant reaches Normal Retirement Age, or

                          (C)  the date the Participant begins
                               participation.

9.4  Other Forms and Methods of Payment of Benefits

     The Standard Form of Retirement Income shall be the applicable form of
     Automatic Annuity under Section 9.2.  In lieu of the Automatic
     Annuity, a Participant or Beneficiary may elect any one of the
     optional forms of distribution set forth below or specified in the
     Adoption Agreement, subject to the provisions of Section 9.5.  Each
     optional form of distribution shall be the Actuarial Equivalent of the
     Participant's Standard Form of Retirement income.  Any such election
     by a Participant must be accompanied by the written consent of his
     spouse (consistent with the requirements for a Qualified Election
     under Section 9.2).

     The available form of distribution shall be:

     (i)   a lump sum distribution.

     (ii)  a joint and 100% survivor annuity.

     (iii)a single life annuity.

     (iv)  a single life annuity contract, with 10 years guaranteed.

     (v)   installments payable monthly, quarterly, semi-annually or
           annually.

     At the Committee's discretion, any benefits payable under the Plan may
     be paid directly from the Trust Fund in cash, or through the purchase
     of an annuity contract from an insurance company selected by the
     Committee.

9.5  Required Payment of Benefits

     (a)   Subject to Section 9.2, Automatic Annuity Requirements, the
           requirements of this Section shall apply to any distribution of a
           Participant's interest and will take precedence over any
           inconsistent provisions of this Plan.  Unless otherwise
           specified, the provisions of this Section apply to calendar years
           beginning after December 31, 1984.

           All distributions required under this Section shall be determined
           and made in accordance with the Proposed Income Tax Regulations
           under section 401(a)(9) of the Code, including the minimum
           distribution incidental benefit requirement of section
           1.401(a)(9)-2 of the Proposed Income Tax Regulations.

     (b)   Required Beginning Date.  The entire interest of a Participant
           must be distributed or begin to be distributed no later than the
           Participant's required beginning date.

     (c)   Limits on Distribution Periods.  As of the first distribution
           calendar year, distributions, if not made in a single-sum, may
           only be made over one of the following periods (or a combination
           thereof):

           (i)  the life of the Participant,

           (ii) the life of the Participant and a designated Beneficiary,

           (iii)a period certain not extending beyond the life expectancy of
                the Participant, or

           (iv) a period certain not extending beyond the joint and last
                survivor expectancy of the Participant and a designated
                Beneficiary.

     Any annuity contract purchased and distributed to a Participant or his
     Beneficiary shall comply with the requirements of this Plan, and shall
     be made and endorsed as nontransferable.

     (d)   Determination of amount to be distributed each year.

           (i)  If the Participant's interest is to be paid in the form of
                annuity distributions under the Plan, payments under the
                annuity shall satisfy the following requirements:

                (A)  the annuity distributions must be paid in periodic
                     payments made at intervals not longer than one year;

                (B)  the distribution period must be over a life (or lives)
                     or over a period certain not longer than a life
                     expectancy (or joint life and survivor expectancy)
                     described in section 401(a)(9)(A)(ii) or section
                     401(a)(9)(B)(iii) of the Code, whichever is applicable;

                (C)  the life expectancy (or joint life and last survivor
                     expectancy) for purposes of determining the period
                     certain shall be determined without recalculation of
                     life expectancy;

                (D)  once payments have begun over a period certain, the
                     period certain may not be lengthened even if the period
                     certain is shorter than the maximum permitted;

                (E)  payments must either be nonincreasing or increase only
                     as follows:

                     (1)  with any percentage increase in a specified and
                          generally recognized cost-of-living index;

                     (2)  to the extent of the reduction to the amount of
                          the Participant's payments to provide for survivor
                          benefit upon death, but only if the Beneficiary
                          whose life was being used to determine the
                          distribution period described in subparagraph (C)
                          above dies and the payments continue otherwise in
                          accordance with that subparagraph over the life of
                          the Participant;

                     (3)  to provide cash refunds of Employee contributions
                          upon the Participant's death; or

                     (4)  because of an increase in benefits under the Plan.

                (F)  If the annuity is a life annuity (or a life annuity
                     with a period certain not exceeding 20 years), the
                     amount which must be distributed on or before the
                     Participant's required beginning date (or, in the case
                     of distributions after the death of the Participant,
                     the date distributions are required to begin pursuant
                     to paragraph (e) below) shall be the payment which is
                     required for one payment interval.  The second payment
                     need not be made until the end of the next payment
                     interval even if that payment interval ends in the next
                     calendar year.  Payment intervals are the periods for
                     which payments are received, e.g., bimonthly, monthly,
                     semi-annually, or annually.

                     If the annuity is a period certain annuity without a
                     life contingency (or is a life annuity with a period
                     certain exceeding 20 years) periodic payments for each
                     distribution calendar year shall be combined and
                     treated as an annual amount.  The amount which must be
                     distributed by the Participant's required beginning
                     date (or, in the case of distributions after the death
                     of the Participant, the date distributions are required
                     to begin pursuant to paragraph (e) below) is the annual
                     amount for the first distribution calendar year.  The
                     annual amount for other distribution calendar years,
                     including the annual amount for the calendar year in
                     which the Participant's required beginning date (or the
                     date distributions are required to begin pursuant to
                     paragraph (e) below) occurs, must be distributed on or
                     before December 31 of the calendar year for which the
                     distribution is required.

           (ii) Annuities purchased after December 31, 1988, are subject to
                the following additional conditions:

                (A)  Unless the Participant's spouse is the
                     designatedBeneficiary, if the Participant's interest is
                     being distributed in the form of a period certain
                     annuity without a life contingency, the period certain
                     as of the beginning of the first distribution calendar
                     year may not exceed the applicable period determined
                     using the table set forth in Q&A A-5 of section
                     1.401(a)(9)-2 of the Proposed Income Tax Regulations.

                (B)  If the Participant's interest is being distributed in
                     the form of a joint and survivor annuity for the joint
                     lives of the Participant and a nonspouse Beneficiary,
                     annuity payments to be made on or after the
                     Participant's required beginning date to the designated
                     Beneficiary after the Participant's death must not at
                     any time exceed the applicable percentage of the
                     annuity payment for such period that would have been
                     payable to the Participant using the table set forth in
                     Q&A A-6 of section 1.401(a)(9)-2 of the Proposed Income
                     Tax Regulations.

           (iii)Transitional rule.  If payments under an annuity which
                complies with paragraph (d)(i) above begin prior to January
                1, 1989, the minimum distribution requirements in effect as
                of July 27, 1987, shall apply to distributions from this
                Plan, regardless of whether the annuity form of payment is
                irrevocable.  This transitional rule also applies to
                deferred annuity contracts distributed to or owned by the
                Employee prior to January 1, 1989, unless additional
                contributions are made under the Plan by the Employer with
                respect to such contract.

           (iv) If the form of distribution is an annuity made in accordance
                with this paragraph (d), any additional benefits accruing to
                the Participant after his or her required beginning date
                shall be distributed as a separate and identifiable
                component of the annuity beginning with the first payment
                interval ending in the calendar year immediately following
                the calendar year in which such amount accrues.

           (v)  Any part of the Participant's interest which is in the form
                of an individual account shall be distributed in a manner
                satisfying the requirements of section 401(a)(9) of the Code
                and regulations thereunder.

     (e)   Death Distribution Provisions.

           (i)  Distribution beginning before death.  If the Participant
                dies after distribution of his or her interest has begun,
                the remaining portion of such interest will continue to be
                distributed at least as rapidly as under the method of
                distribution being used prior to the Participant's death.

           (ii) Distribution beginning after death.  If the Participant dies
                before distribution of his or her interest begins,
                distribution of the Participant's entire interest shall be
                completed by December 31 of the calendar year containing the
                fifth anniversary of the Participant's death except to the
                extent that an election is made to receive distributions in
                accordance with (A) or (B) below:

                (A)  if any portion of the Participant's interest is payable
                     to a designated Beneficiary, distributions may be made
                     over the life of over a period certain not greater than
                     the life expectancy of the designated Beneficiary
                     commencing on or before December 31 of the calendar
                     year immediately following the calendar year in which
                     the Participant died;

                (B)  if the designated Beneficiary is the Participant's
                     surviving spouse, the date distributions are required
                     to begin in accordance with (A) above shall not be
                     earlier than the later of (1) December 31 of the
                     calendar year immediately following the calendar year
                     in which the Participant died and (2) December 31 of
                     the calendar year in which the Participant would have
                     attained age seventy and one-half (70-1/2).

                If the Participant has not made an election pursuant to this
                paragraph (e)(ii) by the time of his or her death, the
                Participant's designated Beneficiary must elect the method
                of distribution no later than the earlier of (1) December 31
                of the calendar year in which distributions would be
                required to begin under this section, or (2) December 31 of
                the calendar year which contains the fifth anniversary of
                the date of death of the Participant.  If the Participant
                has no designated Beneficiary, or if the designated
                Beneficiary does not elect a method of distribution,
                distribution of the Participant's entire interest must be
                completed by December 31 of the calendar year containing the
                fifth anniversary of the Participant's death.

           (iii)For purposes of paragraph (e)(ii) above, if the surviving
                spouse dies after the Participant, but before payments to
                such spouse begin, the provisions of paragraph (e)(ii), with
                the exception of paragraph (B) therein, shall be applied as
                if the surviving spouse were the Participant.

           (iv) For purposes of this paragraph (e), any amount paid to a
                child of the Participant will be treated as if it had been
                paid to the surviving spouse if the amount becomes payable
                to the surviving spouse when the child reaches the age of
                majority.

           (v)  For the purposes of this paragraph (e), distribution of a
                Participant's interest is considered to begin on the
                Participant's required beginning date (or, if paragraph
                (e)(iii) above is applicable, the date distribution is
                required to begin to the surviving spouse pursuant to
                paragraph (e)(ii) above).  If distribution in the form of an
                annuity described in paragraph (d) above irrevocably
                commences to the Participant before the required beginning
                date, the date distribution is considered to begin is the
                date distribution actually commences.

     (f)   Definitions.

           (i)  Designated Beneficiary.  The individual who is designated as
                the beneficiary under the Plan in accordance with section
                401(a)(9) of the Code and the regulations thereunder.

           (ii) Distribution calendar year.  A calendar year for which a
                minimum distribution is required.  For distributions
                beginning before the Participant's death, the first
                distribution calendar year is the calendar year which
                contains the Participant's required beginning date.  For
                distribution beginning after the Participant's death, the
                first distribution calendar year is the calendar year in
                which distributions are required to begin pursuant to
                paragraph (e) above.

           (iii)Life expectancy.  The life expectancy (or joint and last
                survivor expectancy) calculated using the attained age of
                the Participant (or designated Beneficiary) as of the
                Participant's (or designated Beneficiary's) birthday in the
                applicable calendar year.  The applicable calendar year
                shall be the first distribution calendar year.  If annuity
                payments commence before the required beginning date, the
                applicable calendar year is the year such payments commence.
                Life expectancy and joint and last survivor expectancy are
                computed by use of the expected return multiples in Tables V
                and VI of section 1.72-9 of the Income Tax Regulations.

     (g)   Required beginning date.

           (i)  General rule.  The required beginning date of a Participant
                is the first day of April of the calendar year following the
                calendar year in which the Participant attains age seventy
                and one-half (70-1/2).

           (ii) Transitional rule.  The required beginning date of a
                Participant who attains age seventy and one-half (70-1/2)
                before January 1, 1988, shall be determined in accordance
                with (A) or (B) below:

                (B)  Five Percent Owners.  The required beginning date of a
                     Participant who is a five percent (5%) owner during any
                     year beginning after December 31, 1979, is the first
                     day of April following the later of:

                     (1)  the calendar year in which the Participant attains
                          age seventy and one-half (70-1/2), or

                     (2)  the earlier of the calendar year with or within
                          which ends the Plan Year in which the Participant
                          becomes a five percent (5%) owner, or the calendar
                          year in which the Participant retires.  The
                          required beginning date of a Participant who is
                          not a five percent (5%) owner who attains age
                          seventy and one-half (70-1/2) during 1988 and who
                          has not retired as of January 1, 1989, is April 1,
                          1990.

           (iii)Five percent (5%) owner.  A Participant is treated as a five
                percent (5%) owner for purposes of this Section if such
                Participant is a five percent (5%) owner as defined in
                section 416(i) of the Code (determined in accordance with
                section 416 but without regard to whether the Plan is
                Top-Heavy) at any time during the Plan Year ending with or
                within the calendar year in which such owner attains age
                sixty-six and one-half (66-1/2) or any subsequent Plan Year.

           (iv) Once distributions have begun to a five percent (5%) owner
                under this Section, they must continue to be distributed,
                even if the Participant ceases to be a five percent (5%)
                owner in a subsequent year.

           Transitional Rule.  Notwithstanding the above requirements and
           subject to the requirement of Section 9.2, distribution on behalf
           of any Employee, including a five percent (5%) owner, may be made
           in accordance with all of the following requirements (regardless
           of when such distribution commences):

           (a)  The distribution by the Plan is one which would not have
                disqualified such Plan under section 401(a)(9) of the Code
                as in effect prior to amendment by the Deficit Reduction Act
                of 1984.

           (b)  The distribution is in accordance with a method of
                distribution designated by the Employee whose interest in
                the trust is being distributed or, if the Employee is
                deceased, by a Beneficiary of such Employee;

           (c)  Such designation was in writing, was signed by the Employee
                or Beneficiary, and was made before January 1, 1984;

           (d)  The Employee had accrued a benefit under the Plan as of
                December 31, 1983; and

           (e)  The method of distribution designated by the Employee or the
                Beneficiary specifies the form of the distribution, the time
                at which distribution will commence, the period over which
                distributions will be made and in the case of any
                distribution upon the Employee's death, the Beneficiaries of
                the Employee listed in order of priority.  Unless paid to a
                Surviving Spouse under a Qualified Joint and Survivor
                Annuity, the method of distribution selected must assure
                that at least fifty percent (50%) of the present value of
                the amount available for distribution is paid within the
                life expectancy of the Participant.

           A distribution upon death will not be covered by this transition
           rule unless the information in the designation contains the
           required information described above with respect to the
           distributions to be made upon the death of the Employee.

           For any distribution which commences before January 1, 1984, but
           continues after December 31, 1983, the Employee, or the
           Beneficiary, to whom such distribution is being made, will be
           presumed to have designated the method under which the
           distribution is being made if the method of distribution was
           specified in writing and the distribution satisfies the
           requirement in subparagraphs (a) through (e) above.

           If a designation is revoked, the subsequent distribution must
           satisfy the requirements of section 401(a)(9) of the Code and the
           regulations thereunder.  If a designation is revoked subsequent
           to the date distributions are required to begin, the trust must
           distribute by the end of the calendar year following the calendar
           year in which the revocation occurs the total amount not yet
           distributed which would have been required to have been
           distributed to satisfy section 401(a)(9) of the Code and the
           regulation thereunder, but for the section 242(b)(2) election.
           For calendar years beginning after December 31, 1988, such
           distributions must meet the minimum distribution incidental
           benefit requirements in section 1.401(a)(9)-2 of the Proposed
           Income Tax Regulations.  Any changes in the designation will be
           considered to be a revocation of the designation.  However, the
           mere substitution or addition of another Beneficiary (one not
           named in the designation) under the designation will not be
           considered to be a revocation of the designation so long as such
           substitution or addition does not alter the designation, directly
           or indirectly (for example, by altering the relevant measuring
           life).  The rules of Q&A J-2 and J-3 of Proposed Income Tax
           Regulations section 1.401(a)(9)-1 shall apply to rollovers and
           transfers form one plan to another.

9.6  Certain Distributions

     In the event a distribution made to or on behalf of a Participant
     prior to the attainment of age fifty-nine and one-half (59-1/2), would
     be subject to the ten percent (10%) penalty tax set forth in section
     72(t) or 72(m)(5) of the Code, the Participant may, within sixty (60)
     days of the distribution date, request that the distribution be
     transferred to another qualified retirement plan or an Individual
     Retirement Account as a rollover contribution, if the distribution
     satisfies the requirements of section 402(c)(5) of the Code.

9.7  No Duplication of Benefits

     In the determination of the amount of any benefit to which a
     Participant is entitled in accordance with the provisions of this
     Plan, adjustments shall be made to reflect any amounts previously paid
     under the provisions of this Plan.

9.8  Direct Rollovers

     (a) This section applies to distributions made on or after January 1,
     1993.  Notwithstanding any provision of the Plan to the contrary that
     would otherwise limit a distributee's election under this part, a
     distributee may elect, at the time and in the manner prescribed by the
     Plan Administrator, to have any portion of an eligible rollover
     distribution, that is equal to at least $500, paid directly to an
     eligible retirement plan specified by the distributee in a direct
     rollover.

     (b) Eligible rollover distribution:  An eligible rollover distribution
     is any distribution of all or any portion of the balance to the credit
     of the distributee, except that an eligible rollover distribution does
     not include: any distribution that is one of a series of substantially
     equal periodic payments (not less frequently than annually) made for
     the life (or life expectancy) of the distributee or the joint lives
     (or joint life expectancies) of the distributee and the distributee's
     designated beneficiary, or for a specified period of ten years or
     more; any distribution to the extent such distribution is required
     under section 401(a)(9) of the Code; and the portion of any
     distribution that is not includable in net unrealized appreciation
     with respect to Employer securities; and any other distribution(s)
     that is reasonably expected to total less than $200 during a year.

     (c) Eligible retirement plan: An eligible retirement plan is an
     individual retirement account described in section 408(a) of the Code,
     an individual retirement annuity described in section 408(b) of the
     Code, and annuity plan described in section 403(a) of the Code, or a
     qualified plan described in section 401(a) of the Code, that accepts
     the distributee's eligible rollover distribution.  However, in the
     case of an eligible rollover distribution to the Surviving Spouse, an
     eligible retirement plan is an individual retirement account or
     individual retirement annuity.

     (d) Distributee:  A distributee includes an Employee or former
     Employee.  In addition, the Employee's or former Employee's surviving
     spouse and the Employee's or former Employee's spouse or former spouse
     who is the alternate payee under a qualified domestic relations order,
     as defined in section 414(p) of the Code, are distributee's with
     regard to the interest of the spouse or former spouse.

     (e) Direct rollover:  A direct rollover is a payment of the Plan to
     the eligible retirement plan specified by the distributee.



                                  ARTICLE X.
                                THE COMMITTEE

10.1 Creation of a Committee

     The Employer may appoint a person or persons to act as the Committee
     and serve at its pleasure. If no such Committee is appointed, the
     Employer shall act as the Committee.  The Employer shall notify the
     Trustee of the appointment of the original members of the Committee
     and of each change in the membership of the Committee.  Vacancies in
     the Committee shall be filled by the Employer.

10.2 Committee Action

     In the event that the Employer appoints such person or persons to act
     as the Committee, such Committee shall act by a majority of its
     members at a meeting or in writing without a meeting.  A member of the
     Committee who is also a Participant of the Plan shall not vote or act
     as a member of the Committee upon any matter relating solely to his
     rights or benefits under the Plan.

10.3 Authorized Signatory

     Except as otherwise provided in section 10.10, the Committee may
     designate a person or persons who shall be authorized to sign any
     document in the name of the Committee.  The Trustee shall be fully
     protected in relying upon any notice, instruction or certification
     from the Committee or executed pursuant to the provisions of this
     Section.

10.4 Powers and Duties

     The Committee shall have such powers and duties as are necessary for
     the proper administration of the Plan, including but not limited to
     the power to make decisions with respect to the application and
     interpretation of the Plan.  The Committee shall be empowered to
     establish rules and regulations for the transactions of its business
     and for the administration of the Plan.  The determinations of the
     Committee with respect to the interpretation, application, or
     administration of the Plan shall be final, binding, and conclusive
     upon each person or party interested or concerned.

10.5 Non-Discrimination

     Where provisions of this Plan are at the discretion of the Committee,
     all Participants shall be treated in an uniform and non-discriminatory
     manner.


10.6 Records and Reports

     The Committee shall maintain such records as may be necessary for
     proper administration of the Plan and shall be responsible for
     supplying all information and reports to the Internal Revenue Service
     and Department of Labor as required by law.  Employees may examine
     those records pertaining directing to them.

10.7 Reliance on Professional Advice

     The Committee shall be entitled to rely conclusively on the advice or
     opinion of any consultant, accountant, or attorney and such persons
     may also act in their respective professional capacities as advisors
     to the Employer.

10.8 Payment of Expenses

     All expenses of administration may be paid out of the Trust Fund
     unless paid by the Employer.  Such expenses shall include any expenses
     incident to the duties of the Committee, including, but not limited
     to, fees of consultants, accountants, and attorneys, and other costs
     of administering the Plan.  Until paid, the expenses shall constitute
     a liability of the Trust Fund.  However, the Employer may reimburse
     the Trust Fund for any administration expense incurred.  Any
     administration expense paid to the Trust Fund as a reimbursement shall
     not be considered an Employer contribution.

10.9 Limitation of Liability

     The Committee must discharge its duties solely in the interest of the
     Participants and their Beneficiaries.  The Committee must carry out
     its duties with the care, skill, prudence and diligence under
     circumstances then prevailing that a prudent man acting in a like
     capacity and familiar with such matters would use in the conduct of an
     enterprise of like character and with like aims.  The Committee,
     however, shall not be liable for any acts or decisions based on the
     advice or opinion of any consultant, accountant or attorney employed
     by the Committee in their respective professional capacities as
     advisors to the Employer, provided, however, that the Committee did
     not violate its general fiduciary duty in selecting or retaining such
     advisor.

10.10 Payment Certification to Trustee

     The Committee shall provide written instruction to the Trustee with
     respect to all payment which become due under the terms of the Plan
     and shall direct the Trustee to make such payments from the Trust
     Fund.  All orders, requests and instructions by the Committee to the
     Trustee shall be in writing and signed by an authorized member of the
     Committee.

     The Trustee shall act and shall be fully protected in acting in
     accordance with such orders, requests and instructions.

10.11 Claims Procedure

     A Participant or Beneficiary ("Claimant") may file a written claim for
     benefits with the Committee.  If the Committee decides that a Claimant
     is not entitled to all or any part of the benefits claimed, it shall,
     within ninety (90) days of receipt of such claim, inform the claimant
     in writing of its determination; the reasons for its determination,
     including specific references to the pertinent Plan provisions; and
     the Plan's review representative shall be permitted to review
     pertinent documents and within sixty (60) days after receipt of the
     notice of denial of claim to request to appear personally before it or
     to submit such further information or comments to the Committee as
     will, in the Claimant's opinion establish his right to such benefits.
     The Committee will render its final decision with the specific reason
     therefor in writing and will transmit it to the claimant by certified
     mail within sixty (60) days (or one hundred twenty (120) days, if
     special circumstances require an extension of time and the claimant is
     given written notice within the initial sixty (60) day period) of any
     such appearance.  If the final decision is not made within such
     period, it will be considered denied.  If, upon review of a request
     for benefits hereunder, the Committee finds the Participant ineligible
     for such benefits, it shall inform the Participant in writing the
     reason or reasons for such denial.  In the event any Participant or
     Beneficiary disagrees with the conclusions of the Committee, the
     Committee must reconsider their decision based on the facts and
     evidence presented to them by the Participant or Beneficiary.
     Further, the Committee must substantiate in writing to any Participant
     or Beneficiary who disagrees with the amount of his benefit the method
     under which the benefit computations were made.

                                 ARTICLE XI.
                     PARTICIPANT VOLUNTARY CONTRIBUTIONS

11.1 Voluntary Contributions

     Effective for Plan Years beginning after the Plan Year in which this
     Plan is adopted by the Employer, Employee contributions shall not be
     permitted under this Plan.  Employee contributions for Plan Years
     beginning after December 31, 1986 shall be limited so as to meet the
     nondiscrimination test of section 401(m) of the Code.

11.2 Accounting Procedures

     The Committee shall maintain a separate Participant Voluntary
     Contribution Account for Employee contributions made prior to such
     time.  Such Account shall be fully vested and nonforfeitable at all
     times.  On the basis of each annual valuation of the Trust Fund, as
     provided for in the Trust Agreement, the Participant Voluntary
     Contribution Accounts of all Participants shall be adjusted to reflect
     the effects of income, realized and unrealized gains and losses on
     securities and expenses.  Such adjustment shall be based upon the
     proportion that the total of all Participant Voluntary Contribution
     Accounts as of the last preceding Anniversary Date bears to the total
     market value of the Trust Fund.  Each Participant shall then have his
     Participant Voluntary Contribution Account adjusted in proportion to
     all such Participant Voluntary Contribution Accounts.

11.3 Withdrawals

     (a)   A Participant may make withdrawals from the Participant Voluntary
           Contribution Account which results from his own contributions at
           such time as the Committee shall designate, but not more than
           quarterly during a Plan Year provided that no single withdrawal
           shall be less than the total amount in such Account or five
           hundred dollars ($500), whichever is less, and the aggregate
           withdrawals by a Participant prior to his separation from service
           may never exceed the smaller of the actual amount he has
           contributed or the adjusted value of the Participant Voluntary
           Contribution Account resulting from his own contributions.

     (b)   Distribution or withdrawals form a Participant's Voluntary
           Contribution Account shall be paid in accordance with the
           provisions of Article IX, including the requirement of the
           written consent of the Participant's spouse to any withdrawal.

     (c)   No portion of a Participant's Accrued Benefit derived form
           Employer contributions shall be forfeitable solely as a result of
           a Participant's withdrawal of voluntary contributions.


11.4 Transfers From Other Trusts

     The Committee may, in its discretion, direct the Trustee to accept a
     rollover contribution described in sections 402(a)(5), 403(a)(4) or
     408(a)(3)(A)(ii) of the Code or a direct transfer of funds from a
     qualified retirement plan, provided that, in the opinion of counsel
     for the Employer, the transfer will not jeopardize the tax exempt
     status of the Plan or create adverse tax consequences to the Employer.
     The committee shall exercise such discretion in a uniform and
     non-discriminatory manner.  A transfer or rollover contribution may be
     made on behalf of an Employee eligible to participate in the Plan who
     has not met the age and service requirements, if any, for
     participation.  Such an Employee shall become a Participant on the
     date the Trustee accepts the rollover contribution or transfer for all
     purposes, except that no Employer or Employee contributions shall be
     made by or on behalf of such Employee and such Employee shall not
     share in Plan forfeitures until he has completed the age and service
     requirements for participation.  A rollover contribution or transfer
     shall be maintained in a Participant's Rollover Account, provided that
     the Committee shall maintain a separate accounting for the amount
     transferred and its share of the income.

                                 ARTICLE XII.
                             INSURANCE CONTRACTS

     The Employer may elect in the Adoption Agreement to have the
     provisions of this Article XII apply.

12.1 Trustee To Procure Contracts

     If this Plan is to be funded partially with life insurance contracts,
     the Trustee, upon his applications, shall procure a contract on the
     whole, universal or term life plan on the life of a Participant who is
     insurable as a standard risk, or who is not insurable as a standard
     risk but with respect to whom the Committee shall have elected to pay
     substandard rates in accordance with Section 12.2 hereof.  The
     contract shall provide a life insurance benefit, payable on the death
     of the Participant prior to his Normal Retirement Date, equal to a
     multiple limited to one hundred (100) times the amount of anticipated
     monthly normal retirement benefit to which such Participant is
     entitled as calculated pursuant to Section 5.1.  The multiple shall be
     set forth in the Adoption Agreement.

12.2 Substandard Lives

     If a Participant is not insurable as a standard risk but may
     nevertheless be eligible for insurance coverage at an extra rating
     because of excess mortality hazards, the Committee, in its discretion,
     may agree to pay the substandard rate required to obtain the full
     amount of the death benefits herein above set forth.  In determining
     whether or not to pay such substandard rates, the Committee shall not
     discriminate and shall accord uniform treatment to all of its
     Participants in a similar situation.  The Committee shall notify the
     Trustee of its decision in each such case.

     The Trustee, upon his application, shall either procure an annuity on
     the life of each Participant who is not insurable or who is insurable
     only at substandard rates and with respect to whom the Committee shall
     not have elected to pay substandard rates in accordance with this
     Section; or shall purchase no annuity on the life of such Participant,
     whichever course of action shall be dictated by the Committee.  If the
     choice shall be the purchase of an annuity, the annual premium
     therefore shall not exceed the annual premium that would have been
     paid for a whole life policy covering such Participant had he been
     insurable as a standard risk.  Such annuity shall provide a benefit in
     the event of death prior to his Normal Retirement Date at least equal
     to the cash value of such annuity or the sum of the premiums paid,
     whichever is greater.  If the choice shall be the purchase of no
     annuity, then the annual contributions on behalf of such Participant,
     determined pursuant to Section 3.1, shall be those required to provide
     the benefits to which he shall be entitled, form time to time, without
     reference to any annuity on his life, and the entire amount of such
     contributions shall be deposited to his account in the Trust Fund.


12.3 Rules Applicable To Contracts

     The following rules shall be applicable to the acquisition, handling
     or disposition of any contract:

     (a)   Each such whole or universal life insurance contract shall
           contain a provision permitting the purchase at retirement of any
           additional income to which the Participant shall be entitled
           pursuant to Article V.

     (b)   Each application for a contract and the contracts themselves,
           shall nominate and designate the Trustee as sole owner, with the
           right reserved to said Trustee to exercise any right or option
           contained therein, subject to the terms and provisions of this
           Plan.  All such contracts shall be held by the Trustee.

     (c)   The Trustee shall be designated in the contracts to receive the
           proceeds maturing by reason of the death of the Participant to
           pay death benefits pursuant to Article VII to the Deceased
           Participant's Beneficiary or Beneficiaries.

     (d)   The Trustee shall arrange, where possible, that all contracts
           issued under this Plan shall bear the same premium due date.

     (e)   All whole or universal life insurance contracts acquired for the
           purpose of this Plan shall contain guaranteed cash values and as
           uniform basic options as it is possible to obtain.

     (f)   Each whole or universal life insurance contract shall provide in
           the event of lapse for non-payment of premiums that its value
           will be applied in accordance with contract provisions to provide
           reduced paid-up benefits.

     (g)   Each contract, if and only if issued by a company selling
           policies on a participating basis, shall provide that the
           dividend plan shall be premium reduction.  Any dividend payable
           upon maturity of the contract shall be payable in cash to the
           Trustee.

     (h)   Any payments by the insurer on account of credits such as
           dividends, experience rating credits, or surrender or
           cancellation credits shall be applied, within the taxable year of
           the Employer in which received or within the next succeeding
           taxable year, toward the next premiums due before any further
           Employer contributions are so applied.

12.4 Increases or Decreases in Benefits

     If the anticipated normal retirement benefit of a Participant is
     increased, the Trustee shall take the necessary action to increase the
     Participant's benefits to become effective on the Anniversary Date
     next following or coinciding with such increase, to the extent
     required by increase or accumulation of prior increases; provided,
     however, that no increase in the benefit of a Participant shall be
     recognized by the purchase of additional contracts unless and until
     the increase or an accumulation of increases shall be sufficient in
     amount to require provision for a minimum of ten dollars ($10) per
     month of additional retirement benefit.

     If the anticipated normal retirement benefit of a Participant is
     decreased, the Trustee shall take the necessary action, to become
     effective on the next succeeding Anniversary Date, to decrease the
     benefits provided by contract for such Participant to the extent
     required by such decrease or accumulation of decreases, provided,
     however, that reduction in the amount of contracts unless and until
     the decrease or accumulation of decreases shall be sufficient in
     amount to cause a reduction of a minimum of ten dollars ($10) per
     month in retirement benefits.  If any portion of the value of the
     contracts shall be released, the Trustee shall retain such released
     amount toward the payment of premiums due in the current or succeeding
     years.

     In no event, however, shall increases in benefits occurring within
     five (5) years of the Normal Retirement Date of any Participant be
     reflected by the purchase of additional contracts, nor shall decreases
     in anticipated benefits be reflected by the reduction in the amount of
     contracts.

12.5 Deferred Retirement

     If a Participant should continue in the employ of the Employer beyond
     his Normal Retirement Date in accordance with Section 4.3, the Trustee
     shall convert the contracts on the life of such Participant to reduced
     paid-up contracts under the provision of such contracts relating to
     default in premium payment so that, subject to the terms and
     conditions of the provision for the purchase of additional retirement
     benefits, a deferral of such Participant's retirement benefits can be
     accomplished until his actual retirement.  Upon actual retirement, the
     Trustee shall make application to the insurance company to obtain for
     such Participant the retirement benefits to which he may be then
     entitled.  In lieu of such action, the Trustee may direct the
     insurance company to pay the cash value of the contracts on the life
     of such Participant to the Trustee for distribution pursuant to
     Article IX.

     If term life insurance has been purchased and if the Participant
     should continue in the employ of the Employer beyond his Normal
     Retirement Date in accordance with Section 4.3, the Committee shall
     have the right to direct that the Trustee continue the term life
     contracts on the life of such Participant

12.6 Premium Continuation

     The Trustee shall pay any premiums which become due on contracts
     purchased on the life of a Participant who has left the employ of the
     Employer for reasons other than retirement, death or disability until
     it can be determined that such Participant has incurred a Service
     Break or it has been decided to distribute to the terminated
     Participant his benefit.

12.7 Conflicts With Plan Terms

     In the event of any conflict between the terms of this Plan and the
     terms of any insurance contract issued hereunder, the Plan provisions
     shall control.


                                 ARTICLE XIII.
                             GENERAL PROVISIONS

13.1 No Right of Continued Employment

     Neither the establishment of the Plan nor the making of contributions
     by the Employer, nor any action of the Employer or the Committee shall
     be held or construed to confer upon any person any legal right to be
     continued as an Employee.  The Employer expressly reserves the right
     to discharge any Employee whenever the interest of the Employer may so
     require.

13.2 Non-Alienation of Interest

     No benefit or interest available hereunder will be subject to
     assignment or alienation, either voluntarily or involuntarily.  The
     preceding sentence shall not apply to loans made to the Participant
     under the Plan, or domestic relations orders which are determined by
     the Committee to be a qualified domestic relations orders, as defined
     in section 414(p) of the Code, or were entered before January 1, 1985.

13.3 Incompetence of Participants and Beneficiaries

     If the Committee deems any person incapable of receiving benefits to
     which he is entitled by reason of minority, illness, infirmity, or
     other incapacity, it may direct the Trustee to make payment directly
     for the benefit of such person to a legal representative of such
     person.  Such payment shall, to the extent thereof, discharge all
     liability of the Employer, the Committee, the Trustee and the Fund.

13.4 Separate Employer Trusts Maintained

     Except as provided in section 16.2, the Plan of each Employer which
     adopts this Prototype Plan and corresponding Trust Agreement as part
     of its Plan shall be administered separately from those of any other
     Employer.

13.5 Governing Law

     The Plan shall be administered, construed and enforced to the state
     wherein the Trustee maintains its principal place of business, except
     to the extent preempted by the Act.

13.6 Severability

     Should any provision of the Plan or rules and regulations adopted
     thereunder be deemed or held to be unlawful or invalid for any reason,
     such fact shall not adversely affect the other provisions unless such
     invalidity shall render impossible or impractical the functioning of
     the Plan.  In such case, the appropriate parties shall immediately
     adopt a new provision to take the place of the illegal or invalid
     provision.

13.7 Gender and Number

     The masculine pronoun wherever used shall include the feminine pronoun
     and the singular shall include the plural and the plural shall include
     the singular, wherever appropriate to the context.

13.8 Titles and Headings

     The titles and headings of the respective Articles and Sections in
     this instrument are inserted merely for convenience and shall be given
     no legal effect.

13.9 Counterparts as Original

     The Plan has been prepared in counterparts each of which so prepared
     shall be construed an original and such counterparts shall together
     constitute one and the same instrument.

13.10 Failure of Employer's Plan to Qualify

     The use of this Prototype Plan and corresponding Trust Agreement shall
     be available only to the Plans of Employers which meet the
     requirements of section 401(a) of the Code.  If the Employer's Plan
     fails to attain or retain qualification, such Plan shall no longer
     participate in the Prototype Plan and will be considered an
     individually designed Plan.

13.11 Exclusive Benefit

     Except as otherwise provided in this Plan, at no time shall any part
     of the corpus or income of the Fund be used for or diverted to
     purposes other than for the exclusive benefit of the Participants and
     their Beneficiaries and defraying reasonable expenses of the Plan.

13.12 Proper Payee

     The records of the Committee at the time of death of any person
     entitled to any benefits hereunder shall be conclusive as to the
     identity of the proper payee and of the amounts payable.  Payment made
     in accordance with such facts shall constitute a complete discharge of
     any and all obligations hereof.  In the event any amount shall become
     payable to any person or estate, the Committee shall mail written
     notice to such person's last known address as shown in the Employer's
     records.  If such person or his personal representative does not
     present himself to the Committee within one year after the mailing of
     such notice, then the Committee may distribute any amounts due to one
     or more of the spouse, blood relatives and adopted children of such
     person.  Any action of the Committee under this Section shall be final
     and conclusive upon all persons.  Any person who receives any
     distribution under this Section shall be the absolute owner thereof,
     regardless of whether such person had been a Participant, a
     Beneficiary or the personal representative of any Participant
     hereunder.  If a benefit is forfeited because the Participant or
     Beneficiary cannot be found, such benefit will be reinstated if a
     claim is made by the Participant or Beneficiary.



                                 ARTICLE XIV.
                                    LOANS

14.1 Loans to Participants

     If permitted under the Adoption Agreement, the Committee, in its
     discretion, may authorize and direct the Trustee to grant loans to
     Participants and Beneficiaries in accordance with written rules
     established by the Committee.  Such loans:

     (a)   Shall not exceed the lesser of:

           (1)  fifty thousand dollars ($50,000) reduced by the excess, if
                any, of (i) the highest outstanding balance of loans form
                the Plan during the one (1) years period ending on the day
                before the date on which such loan was made, over (ii) the
                outstanding balance of loans from the Plan on the date such
                loan was made, or

           (2)  the greater of (i) ten thousand dollars ($10,000), or (ii)
                one-half (1/2) of the Actuarial Value of the Participant's
                or Beneficiary's vested interest under the Plan.

                However, if the Participant is an affected Employee under
                the pre-termination restriction in section 8.3 of the plan,
                the total of all the affected Employee's outstanding loans
                will not exceed the amount that such affected Employee would
                be entitled to under the pre-termination restrictions.  For
                this purpose, all plans of the Employer and Affiliated
                Employers shall be treated as a single plan;

     (b)   Shall be evidenced by a promissory note, secured by an assignment
           of a portion of the Actuarial Value of the Participant's or
           Beneficiary's vested interest in the Plan.  Effective for loans
           granted or renewed after October 18, 1989, the portion of a
           Participant's or Beneficiary's vested interest which may be used
           as security for a loan hereunder shall not exceed fifty percent
           (50%);

     (c)   Shall bear a reasonable rate of interest, as determined by the
           Committee to be a rate of interest commensurate with the interest
           rates charged by persons in the business of lending money for
           loans which would be made under similar circumstances; and

     (d)   Shall require substantially level repayments of principal and
           interest (with repayments made no less frequently than quarterly)
           over a period not to exceed five (5) years.  Any such loan shall
           be nonrenewable except that if the loan was originally granted
           for a period of less than five (5) years, then the same may be
           renewed, in the discretion of the Committee, for a period of time
           equal to the difference between five (5) years and the duration
           of the original loan.  The five (5) year repayment period shall
           not apply to any loan used to acquire any dwelling unit which
           within a reasonable period of time is to be used (to be
           determined at the time the loan is made) as the principal
           residence of the Participant.

     The written consent of the Participant's spouse (consistent with the
     requirements for a Qualified Election under Section 9.2) must be
     obtained within the 90-day period ending on the date the Participant's
     vested interest is used as security for the loan.  Such consent shall
     thereafter be binding with respect to the consenting spouse or any
     subsequent spouse.  However, a new consent shall be required if the
     Participant's vested interest is used for renegotiation, extension,
     renewal or other revision of the loan.

14.2 Transactions Treated as Loans

     The following transactions shall be treated as loans hereunder:

     (a)   If a Participant or Beneficiary assigns or pledges (or agrees to
           assign or pledge) any portion of his interest in the Plan, such
           portion shall be treated as a loan from the Plan to the
           Participant or Beneficiary.

     (b)   Any amount received as a loan from an insurance contract
           purchased under the provisions of this Plan, if applicable (or
           any assignment or pledge with respect to such contract), shall be
           treated as a loan under the Plan.

14.3 Provisions to be Applied in a Uniform and Nondiscriminatory Manner

     In deciding whether or not to grant any request for a loan hereunder,
     the Committee shall be guided by procedure and criteria designed to
     assure that uniformity is applied to all Participants and
     Beneficiaries under similar circumstances and that the granting of
     such approval does not result in discrimination prohibited by the
     Code.

14.4 Satisfaction of Loan

     In the event of default, foreclosure on the note and attachment of the
     security will not occur until a distributable event occurs under the
     terms of the Plan.

     If spousal consent (consistent with the requirements for a Qualified
     Election under Section 9.2) has been obtained, then, notwithstanding
     any other provision of the Plan, the portion of the Participant's
     vested interest in the Plan used as security for a loan shall be taken
     into account for purposes of determining the amount of the benefits
     payable at the time of death or distribution, but only if the
     reduction is used as repayment of the loan.

14.5 Loans to Owner-Employees or Shareholder-Employees

     No loan shall be granted to an Owner-Employee or Shareholder-Employee
     unless an exemption has been obtained for such loan from the Secretary
     of Labor under section 408 of the Act (and such loan is exempt from
     the excise tax imposed under section 4975 of the Code).

                             ARTICLE XV.
                        TOP-HEAVY PROVISIONS

     As specified in the Adoption Agreement, the provisions of this Article
     XV will either (1) always supersede any conflicting provisions in the
     Plan or (2) only supersede such conflicting provisions in any Plan
     Year beginning after 1983, during which the Plan is or becomes
     Top-Heavy.

15.1 Definitions

     For purposes of this Article and Article XVII, the following words
     shall have the following meanings:

     (a)   "Compensation" shall mean Compensation as defined in Article I.
           For any Plan Year beginning before January 1, 1989, only the
           first two hundred thousand dollars ($200,000) of a Participant's
           Compensation shall be taken into account for purposes of
           determining the Top-Heavy minimum accrued benefit.

     (b)   "Determination Date" shall mean (1) the last day of the preceding
           Plan Year, or (2) in the case of the first Plan Year, the last
           day of such Plan Year.

     (c)   "Employer" shall mean the Employer and all Affiliated Employers.

     (d)   "Key Employee" shall mean any Employee or former Employee (and
           the Beneficiaries of such Employee) who at any time during the
           Plan Year containing the Determination Date and the four (4)
           preceding Plan Years was:

           (1)  An officer of the Employer if such individual's annual
                Compensation exceeds fifty percent (50%) of the dollar
                limitation under section 415(b)(1)(A) of the Code (provided
                that the number of employees treated as officers shall be no
                more than fifty (50) or, if fewer, the greater of three (3)
                employees of ten percent (10%) of all employees);

           (2)  An owner (or considered an owner under section 318 of the
                Code) of at least a one-half of one percent (.5%) interest
                and one of the ten (10) largest interests in the Employer if
                such individual's Compensation exceeds one hundred percent
                (100%) of such dollar limitation under section 415(c)(1)(A)
                of the Code;

           (3)  A five percent (5%) owner of the Employer; or

           (4)  A one percent (1%) owner of the Employer who has an annual
                Compensation of more than one hundred fifty thousand dollars
                ($150,000).

           For this purpose, annual Compensation means Compensation as
           defined in section 415(c)(3) of the Code, but including amounts
           excludable from the Employee's gross income by reason of sections
           125, 402(e)(3), 402(h)(1)(B), or 403(b) of the Code.  The
           determination of who is a Key Employee will be made in accordance
           with section 416(i)(1) of the Code and the regulations thereunder.

     (e)   "Non-Key Employee" shall mean any Employee who is not a Key
           Employee.

     (f)   "Permissive Aggregation Group" shall mean the Required
           Aggregation Group of plans plus any other plan or plans of the
           Employer which, when considered as a group with the Required
           Aggregation Group, would continue to satisfy the requirements of
           sections 401(a)(4) and 410 of the Code.

     (g)   "Present Value" shall be based upon the interest rates and
           mortality table used under Section 1.2, unless otherwise
           specified in the Adoption Agreement.

     (h)   "Required Aggregation Group" shall mean (1) each qualified plan
           of the Employer in which at least one (1) Key Employee
           participates or participated in any time during the determination
           period (regardless of whether the Plan terminated), and (2) any
           other qualified plan of the Employer which enables a plan
           described in (1) to meet the requirements of sections 401(a)(4)
           and 410 of the Code.

     (i)   "Super Top-Heavy":  For any Plan Year after 1983, this Plan is
           Super Top-Heavy if the Top-Heavy Ratio for the Plan, under the
           Required Aggregation Group or the Permissive Aggregation Group,
           as applicable, exceeds ninety percent (90%).

     (j)   "Top-Heavy Plan":  For any Plan Year beginning after 1983, this
           Plan is Top-Heavy if any of the following conditions exist:

           (1)  If the Top-Heavy Ratio for this Plan exceeds sixty percent
                (60%) and this Plan is not part of any Required Aggregation
                Group or Permissive Aggregation Group of plans.

           (2)  If this Plan is a part of a Required Aggregation Group of
                plans, but not part of a Permissive Aggregation Group, and
                the Top-Heavy Ratio for the group of plans exceeds sixty
                percent (60%), or

           (3)  If this Plan is a part of a Required Aggregation Group of
                plans and part of a Permissive Aggregation Group, and the
                Top-heavy Ratio for the group of plans exceeds sixty percent
                (60%).

     (k)   "Top-Heavy Ratio":

           (1)  If the Employer maintains one or more defined benefit plans
                and the Employer has not maintained any defined contribution
                plans (including any simplified employee pension plan) which
                during the five (5) year period ending on the Determination
                Date has or has had account balances, the Top-Heavy Ratio
                for this Plan alone or for the Required or Permissive
                Aggregation Group as appropriate is a fraction, the
                numerator of which is the sum of the present values of
                accrued benefits of all Key Employees as of the
                Determination Date (including any part of any accrued
                benefit distributed in the five (5) year period ending on
                the Determination Date), and the denominator of which is the
                sum of the present value of Accrued Benefits (including any
                part of any Accrued Benefit distributed in the five (5) year
                period ending on the Determination Date), determined in
                accordance with section 416 of the Code and the regulations
                thereunder.  Both the numerator and the denominator of the
                Top-Heavy Ratio are increased to reflect any contribution
                not actually made as of the Determination Date, but which is
                required to be taken into account on that date under section
                416 of the Code and the regulations thereunder.

           (2)  If the Employer maintains one or more defined benefit plans
                and the Employer maintains or has maintained one or more
                defined contribution plans (including any simplified
                employee pension plan) which during the five (5) year period
                ending on the Determination Date has or has had any account
                balances, the Top-Heavy Ratio for any Required or Permissive
                Aggregation group as appropriate is a fraction, the
                numerator of which is the sum of the present value of
                Accrued Benefits under the aggregate defined benefit plan or
                plans for all Key Employees, determined in accordance with
                (a) above and the sum of account balances under the
                aggregated defined contribution plan or plans, for all Key
                Employees as of the Determination Date and the denominator
                of which is the sum of the present values of accrued
                benefits under the aggregated defined benefit plan or plans,
                determined in accordance with (a) above, for all
                Participants and the sum of the account balances under the
                aggregated defined contribution plan or plans for all
                Participants as of the Determination Date, all determined in
                accordance with section 416 of the Code and the regulations
                thereunder.  The account balances under a defined
                contribution plan in both the numerator and denominator of
                the Top-Heavy Ratio are increased for any distribution of an
                account balance made in the five (5) year period ending on
                the Determination Date.

           (3)  For purposes of (1) and (2) above, the value of account
                balances and the present value of accrued benefits will be
                determined as of the most recent Valuation Date that falls
                within or ends with the twelve (12) month period ending on
                the Determination Date, except as provided in section 416 of
                the Code and the regulations thereunder for the first and
                second Plan Years of a defined benefit plan.  The account
                balances and accrued benefits of a Participant (1) who is
                not a key Employee but who was a Key Employee in a prior
                year, or (2) who has not been credited with at least one
                Hour of Service for any Employer maintaining the Plan at any
                time during the five (5) year period ending on the
                Determination Date will be disregarded.  The calculation of
                the Top-Heavy Ratio, and the extent to which distributions,
                rollovers, and transfers are taken into account will be made
                in accordance with section 416 of the Code and the
                regulations thereunder.  Deductible Employee contributions
                will not be taken into account for purposes of computing the
                Top-Heavy Ratio.

                When aggregating plans, the value of account balances and
                accrued benefits will be calculated with references to the
                Determination Dates that fall within the same calendar year.

           (4)  Solely for the purpose of determining if the Plan, or any
                other plan included in a Required Aggregation Group of which
                this Plan is a part, is Top-Heavy (within the meaning of
                section 416(g) of the Code) the accrued benefit of a Non-Key
                Employee shall be determined under (a) the method, if any,
                that uniformly applies for accrual purposes under all plans
                maintained by the Employer, or (b) if there is no such
                method, as if such benefit accrued not more rapidly than the
                slowest accrual rate permitted under the fractional accrual
                rate of section 411(b)(1)(C) of the Code.

     (1)   "Valuation Date" shall mean the last day of the Plan Year, unless
           a different date is elected by the Employer in the Adoption
           Agreement and is the day on which account balances and Accrued
           Benefits are valued for purposes of calculating the Top-Heavy
           Ratio.

15.2 Vesting Schedules

     For any Plan Year in which this Plan is Top-Heavy, one of the Top
     Heavy minimum vesting schedules as elected by the Employer in the
     Adoption Agreement will automatically apply to the Plan.  The Top
     Heavy minimum vesting schedule applies to all benefits within the
     meaning of section 411(a)(7) of the Code except those attributable to
     Employee contributions, including benefits accrued before the
     effective date of section 416 and benefits accrued before the Plan
     became Top-Heavy.  Further, no reduction in vested benefits may occur
     in the event the Plan's status as Top-Heavy changes for any Plan Year.
     However, this Section does not apply to the Accrued Benefits of any
     Employee who does not have an Hour of Service after the Plan has
     initially become Top-Heavy and such Employee's Accrued Benefits
     attributable to Employer contributions will be determined without
     regard to this Section.

15.3 Minimum Accrued Benefit

     (a)   Notwithstanding any other provision in this Plan, except
           paragraphs (b), (c) and (d) below, for any Plan Year beginning
           after December 31, 1983 in which this Plan is Top-Heavy ("Top
           Heavy Plan Years"), each Participant who is a Non-Key Employee
           and has completed one thousand (1,000) Hours of Service will
           accrue a benefit (to be provided solely by Employer contributions
           and expressed as a life annuity (without regard to ancillary
           benefits) commencing at his Normal Retirement Date) of not less
           than two percent (2%) of his average Compensation for five (5)
           consecutive years for which the Participant had the highest
           average Compensation.  The aggregate Compensation for the years
           during such five-year period in which the Participant was
           credited with a year of Service will be divided by the number of
           such years in order to determine Average Annual Compensation.  If
           the Plan credits Participation on the elapsed time basis, all
           Participation in Top-Heavy Plan Years shall be used to determine
           the Top-Heavy minimum accrual.

                The minimum accrual is determined without regard to any
                Social Security contribution.  The minimum accrual applies
                even though under other Plan provisions the Non-Key Employee
                would not otherwise be entitled to receive an accrual, or
                would have received a lesser accrual for the year because
                (1) the Non-Key Employee fails to make mandatory
                contributions to the Plan (2) the Non-Key Employee's
                Compensation is less than a stated amount, (3) the Non-Key
                Employee is not employed on the last day of the accrual
                computation period, or (4) the Plan is integrated with
                Social Security.


     (b)   No additional benefit accruals shall be provided pursuant to (a)
           above to the extent that the total accruals on behalf of the
           Participant attributable to Employer contributions will provide a
           benefit expressed as a life annuity commencing at the Normal
           Retirement Date that equals or exceeds twenty percent (20%) of
           the Participant's average Compensation for the five (5)
           consecutive years for which the Participant had the highest
           average Compensation.

     (c)   If the Plan is Top Heavy, but is not Super Top-Heavy, each
           Participant who is a Non-Key Employee shall receive the minimum
           accrual under (a) above, except that "three percent (3%)" shall
           be substituted for "two percent (2%)" and "thirty percent (30%)"
           shall be substituted for "twenty percent (20%)" in (b) above.

     (d)   The provisions in (a) above shall not apply to any Participant to
           the extent that the Participant is covered under any other
           qualified plan or plans of the Employer other than a paired plan
           of the Sponsor Adoption Agreement that the minimum Top Heavy
           allocation or benefit will be met in the other plan or plans.

     (e)   The Minimum Accrued Benefit required (to the extent required to
           be nonforfeitable under the provisions of Section 15.2) may not
           be forfeited under section 411(a)(3)(B) or 411(a)(3)(D) of the
           Code.

     (f)   All accruals of Employer derived benefit, whether or not
           attributable to years for which the Plan is Top-Heavy, may be
           used in computing whether the minimum accrual requirements of
           paragraph (d) above are satisfied.

15.4 Adjustment For Benefit Other Than Life Annuity

     If the form of benefit is other than a single life annuity, the
     Employee must receive an amount that is the Actuarial Equivalent of
     the minimum single life annuity benefit.  If the benefit commences at
     a date other than at the Normal Retirement Date, the Employee must
     receive at least an amount that is the Actuarial Equivalent of the
     minimum single life annuity benefit commencing at the Normal
     Retirement Date.

15.5 Adjustment to Defined Benefit Fraction and Defined Contribution
     Fraction under Section 8.1

     If the Plan is Super Top-Heavy, then "one hundred percent (100%)"
     shall be substituted for "one hundred twenty-five percent (125%)" in
     the denominator of the Defined Benefit Fraction and the Defined
     Contribution Fraction under Section 8.1.


                                 ARTICLE XVI.
                          AMENDMENT AND TERMINATION

16.1 Amendment

     (a)   The Employer expressly recognizes the authority of the Sponsor to
           amend this Plan and Trust from time to time, and the Employer
           shall be deemed to consent to any such amendment.  The Employer
           shall receive a written instrument indicating the amendment of
           the Plan and Trust and such amendment shall become effective as
           of the effective date of such instrument.

     (b)   The Employer reserves the right to amend the Plan at any time.
           Except for (1) changes to the choice of options in the Adoption
           Agreement, (2) amendments stated in the Adoption Agreement which
           allow the Plan to satisfy section 415 of the Code or to avoid
           duplication of minimums under section 416 of the Code because of
           the required aggregation of multiple plans, or (3) amendments
           published by the Internal Revenue Service which specifically
           provide that their adoption will not cause the Plan to be treated
           as individually designed, an Employer will no longer participate
           in the Prototype Plan and will be considered to have an
           individually designed plan if it amends the Plan.

     (c)   Notwithstanding anything in this Plan to the contrary, no
           amendment shall:

           (1)  Increase the responsibility of the Trustee without the
                Trustee's written consent;

           (2)  Decrease a Participant's Accrued Benefit, except to the
                extent permitted by section 412(c)(8) of the Code;

           (3)  In the case of an Employee who is a Participant as of the
                later of the date such amendment is adopted or the date it
                become effective, decrease the nonforfeitable percentage
                (determined as of such date) of such Employee's right to his
                Employer-derived account balance below his non-forfeitable
                percentage computed under the Plan without regard to such
                amendment;

           (4)  Violate the exclusive benefit rule of Section 13.11.

     For purposes of this paragraph, a Plan amendment which has the effect
     of (1) eliminating or reducing an Early Retirement Benefit or a
     retirement-type subsidy, or (2) eliminating an optional form of
     benefit, with respect to benefits attributable to Service before the
     amendment shall be treated as decreasing a Participant's Accrued
     Benefit.  In the case of a retirement-type subsidy, the preceding
     sentence shall apply only with respect to a Participant who satisfies
     (either before or after the amendment) the preamendment conditions for
     the subsidy.  In general, a retirement-type subsidy is a subsidy that
     continues after retirement, but does not include a qualified
     disability benefit, a medical benefit, a social security supplement, a
     death benefit (including life insurance), or a plant shutdown benefit
     (that does not continue after retirement age).  Furthermore, if the
     vesting schedule of a Plan is amended, in the case of an Employee who
     is a Participant as of the later of the date such amendment is adopted
     or the date it becomes effective, the nonforfeitable percentage
     (determined as of such date) of such Employee's Employer-provided
     accrued benefit will not be less than the percentage computed under
     the Plan without regard to such amendment.

16.2 Participating Employers

     (a)   With the consent of the adopting Employer and Trustee, and by
           duly authorized action, any Affiliated Employer may adopt this
           Plan and become a Participating Employer.  Unless the context
           clearly indicates otherwise the work "Employer" shall be deemed
           to include each Participating Employer as related to its adoption
           of the Plan.

     (b)   Each such Participating Employer shall be required to select the
           same Adoption Agreement provisions as those selected by the
           Employer, and to sue the same Trustee as the Employer.

     (c)   The Trustee may, but shall not be required to, commingle, hold
           and invest as one Trust Fund all contributions made by
           Participating Employers, as well as all increments thereof.

     (d)   With respect to its relations with the Trustee and Committee for
           the purposes of this Plan, each Participating Employer shall be
           deemed to have irrevocably designated the Employer as its agent.
           Amendment of this Plan at any time when there shall be a
           Participating Employer shall only be by written action of the
           adopting Employer and such amendment shall be binding upon each
           Participating Employer.

     (e)   Any Participating Employer may, at any time, by written notice to
           the Trustee in such form as is acceptable to the Trustee,
           discontinue its participation in the Plan and discontinue all
           contributions hereunder.  The Trustee shall thereafter transfer,
           deliver and assign Fund assets to the Participants of such
           Participating Employer to such successor trustee as shall have
           been designated by such Participating Employer, in the event that
           it has established a separated plan for its Employees.  If no
           successor trustee is designated, the Trustee shall retain such
           assets for the Employees of said Participating Employer pursuant
           to the provisions of this Plan.

16.3 Amended and Restated Plans

     If this Plan is an amendment and restatement of an existing plan
     ("Existing Plan") the following provisions shall apply:

     (a)   Each Employee who was a Participant in the Existing Plan
           immediately prior to the Effective Date shall become a
           Participant in this Plan on the Effective Date.

     (b)   All years of service credited for vesting service under the
           Existing Plan shall be credited as years of Service under this
           Plan.  The amendment and restatement shall not reduce the vested
           interest of a Participant in the Existing Plan, and any change in
           the vesting schedule shall be subject to the provisions of
           Section 6.5.

     (c)   The amendment and restatement shall not reduce a Participant's
           accrued benefit of the Existing Plan and shall not eliminate any
           optional form of benefit of the Existing Plan.

     (d)   Any beneficiary designation in effect under the Existing Plan
           immediately before the amendment and restatement shall be deemed
           to be a valid Beneficiary designation under this Plan, to the
           extent consistent with Section 9.2.

16.4 Plan Merger and Consolidation or Transfer of Plan Assets

     In the event of any merger or consolidation with, or transfer of
     assets or liabilities to, any other plan, each Participant of the Plan
     shall (if the Plan then terminated) be entitled to receive an amount
     immediately after such merger, consolidation or transfer which is
     equal to or greater than the amount he would have been entitled to
     receive immediately before the merger, consolidation or transfer (if
     the Plan had then terminated).

16.5 Termination

     While the Plan and Trust Fund are intended to be permanent, they may
     be terminated at any time at the discretion of the Employer; provided,
     however, that, except as provided in  Section 3.4, no action may be
     taken to render it possible, at any time prior to the satisfaction of
     all expenses and all liabilities with respect to Participants and
     their Beneficiaries, for any part of the corpus or income of the Trust
     Fund to be used for or diverted to purposes other than the Plan and
     for the payment of the expenses of the Trust Fund including any
     expenses incurred in effectuating the termination of the Plan and
     Trust Fund.  In the event of the termination of the Plan and Trust
     Fund or upon partial termination, the rights of all affected
     Participants to benefits accrued, to the extent funded, as of the date
     of such termination or partial termination shall be one hundred
     percent (100%) vested and nonforfeitable.  The Committee shall
     allocate the Trust Fund in accordance with section 4044 of the Act to
     the extent of the sufficiency of such funds.  However, if necessary to
     prevent prohibited discrimination under section 401(a)(4) of the Code,
     then the allocation of assets under section 4044 of the Act shall be
     reallocated to the extent necessary to avoid such discrimination.

     Written notification of a complete termination shall be given to each
     affected Participant and Beneficiary and the Trustee setting forth the
     termination date.  If the Plan is subject to Title IV of the Act, the
     Committee shall also comply with the plan termination requirements of
     Title IV.  The Trustee, after reserving an amount from the Trust Fund
     sufficient to pay expenses and charges, including the payment of all
     expenses incurred in effectuating such termination, such as the fees
     and retainers of the Plan's Trustees, actuary, accountant, custodian,
     administrator, counsel, and other specialists, shall distribute the
     assets of the Trust Fund in accordance with the directions of the
     Committee which instructions shall be in accordance with Article IX.

     Unless otherwise elected in the Adoption Agreement, any assets of this
     Plan which remain after provisions have been made to satisfy all
     liabilities of this Plan to Participants shall be allocated among
     Participants on a uniform and nondiscriminatory basis, subject to the
     limitations of Section 8.1.  However, to the extent such allocation
     would result in prohibited discrimination or violate any other
     provision of law, the excess assets shall revert to the Employer.

     Except as provided by law, an Employer shall have no liability in
     respect of payments or benefits under the Plan and each Participant or
     Beneficiary shall look solely to the Trust Fund for any payments or
     benefits under the Plan.  The liability of the Trustee with respect
     thereto shall be limited to the amounts held by the Trustee in the
     Trust Fund.



                                 ARTICLE XVII.
                           PAIRED PLAN PROVISIONS

     The provisions of this Article are applicable only if the Employer
     adopts a set of Dreyfus paired plans.  Paired plans are a combination
     of standardized form plans, so designed that if any single plan or
     combination of plans is adopted by an Employer, each plan by itself,
     or the plans together, will meet the antidiscrimination rules set
     forth in section 401(a)(4) of the Code, the contribution and benefit
     limits set forth in section 415 of the Code and the Top-Heavy
     provisions set forth in section 416 of the Code.


17.1 Compliance with Section 415(e) of the Code

     If the Employer also maintains one or two of Sponsor's paired defined
     contribution plans, the "1.0" aggregate limitation of section 415(e)
     of the Code on contributions and benefits will be met by freezing or
     reducing the rate of benefit accruals under this Plan.

17.2 Adjustment of Combined Plan Fractions under Section 415 of the Code
     for Top-Heavy Ratio In Excess of Ninety Percent (90%).

     In any Plan Year in which the Plan becomes Super Top-Heavy, the
     denominators of the Defined Benefit Fraction and Defined Contribution
     fraction (both as defined in section 8.1 of the Plan) shall be
     computed using one hundred percent (100%) of the dollar limitation
     instead of one hundred twenty-five percent (125%).

17.3 Top Heavy Minimum Benefits and Contributions

     (a)   When the paired plans are Top-Heavy, but are not Super Top-Heavy,
           the Top-Heavy requirements set forth in Article XV shall apply,
           except that "three percent (3%)" shall be substituted for "two
           percent (2%)" in determining the Top-Heavy minimum benefit under
           Section 15.3(a) and that the cumulative accrued benefit shall not
           exceed 30%.  Each Non-Key Employee who is a Participant in both
           this Plan and a paired defined contribution pan shall be entitled
           only to this minimum top heavy benefit accrual and shall not be
           entitled to any Top-Heavy minimum allocation under the paired
           defined contribution plan or plans.

     (b)   When the paired plans are Super Top-Heavy, the Top Heavy
           requirements of Article XV shall apply.  Each Non-Key Employee
           who is a Participant in both this Plan and a paired defined
           contribution plan shall be entitled only to this minimum top
           heavy benefit accrual and shall not be entitled to any Top-Heavy
           minimum allocation under the paired defined contribution plan or
           plans.

17.4 Integration of Paired Plans

     If the Employer adopts paired plans, only one may allocate
     contributions or determine benefits on an integrated basis.

                    DREYFUS PROTOTYPE DEFINED BENEFIT PLAN

                              TABLE OF CONTENTS

                                                                        Page

ARTICLE I.  DEFINITIONS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  1

1.0  "Accrued Benefit". . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  1
1.1  "Act". . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  1
1.2  "Actuarial Equivalent" . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  1
1.3  "Actuarial Value". . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  3
1.4  "Adoption Agreement" . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  3
1.5  "Affiliated Employer". . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  3
1.6  "Anniversary Date" . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  3
1.7  "Annuity Starting Date". . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  3
1.8  "Beneficiary". . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  3
1.9  "Board of Directors" . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  3
1.10 "Code" . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  3
1.11 "Committee". . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  4
1.12 "Compensation" . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  4
1.13 "Contract" . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  6
1.14 "Deferred Retirement Date" . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  6
1.15 "Disability Retirement Date" . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  6
1.16 "Early Retirement Date". . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  6
1.17 "Earned Income". . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  6
1.18 "Effective Date" . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  6
1.19 "Eligible Employee". . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  6
1.20 "Eligibility Year(s) of Service" . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  6
1.21 "Employee" . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  7
1.22 "Employer" . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  8
1.23 "Employment Commencement Date" . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  8
1.24 "Entry Date" . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  8
1.25 "Fresh Start Date" . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  8
1.26 "Frozen Accrued Benefit" . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  8
1.27 "Highly Compensated Employee". . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  8
1.28 "Hour of Service". . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  9
1.29 "Normal Retirement Date" . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10
1.30 "Owner-Employee" . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11
1.31 "Participant". . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11
1.32 "Participating Employer" . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11
1.33 "Participation". . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 11
1.34 "PBGC" . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12
1.35 "Period of Severance". . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12
1.36 "Permanent Disability" . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12
1.37 "Plan" . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12
1.38 "Plan Year". . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12
1.39 "Prototype Plan" . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12
1.40 "Qualified Joint and Survivor Annuity" . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 12
1.41 "Qualified Pre-retirement Survivor Annuity". . . . . . . . . . . . . 12
1.42 "Re-Employment Commencement Date". . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13
1.43 "S Corporation". . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13
1.44 "Self-Employed Individual" . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13
1.45 "Service". . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13
1.46 "Service Break". . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14
1.47 "Severance from Service Date". . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14
1.48 "Shareholder-Employee" . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14
1.49 "Social Security Retirement Age" . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15
1.50 "Sponsor". . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15
1.51 "Standard Form of Retirement Income" . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15
1.52 "Straight Life Annuity". . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15
1.53 "Taxable Wage Base". . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15
1.54 "Trustee". . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15
1.55 "Trust Agreement". . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15
1.56 "Trust Fund" . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 15

ARTICLE II.  PARTICIPATION. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16

2.1  Membership . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16
2.2  Excluded Employees . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16
2.3  Re-Employment. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16
2.4  Change in Employment Status. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 17
2.5  Limitation on Participation of Owner-Employees . . . . . . . . . . . 17

ARTICLE III.  CONTRIBUTIONS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 19

3.1  Employer Contributions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 19
3.2  Payment of Contributions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 19
3.3  Payment of Expenses. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 19
3.4  Return of Employer Contributions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 19

ARTICLE IV.  RETIREMENT DATES . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 21

4.1  Retirement Date. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 21
4.2  Normal Retirement Date . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 21
4.3  Deferred Retirement Date . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 21
4.4  Early Retirement Date. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 21
4.5  Disability Retirement Date . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 21
4.6  Application for Retirement . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22
4.7  Age Discrimination in Employment Act . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22

ARTICLE V.  RETIREMENT BENEFITS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 23

5.1  Normal Retirement Benefit. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 23
5.2  Deferred Retirement Benefit. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 23
5.3  Early Retirement Benefit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 23
5.4  Disability Retirement Benefit. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 26
5.5  Distribution of Retirement Benefits. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 26
5.6  Death Benefits . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 26
5.7  Suspension of Benefits . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 26
5.8  Frozen Accrued Benefit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 28
5.9  Adjustments to Frozen Accrued Benefit. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 29

ARTICLE VI.  TERMINATION OF EMPLOYMENT BENEFITS . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35

6.1  Vested Termination Benefit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35
6.2  Distribution of Vested Interest. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35
6.3  Death of a Vested Member . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35
6.4  Vesting of a Participant . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 36
6.5  Amendment of Vesting Provisions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 36
6.6  Forfeitures. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 36

ARTICLE VII.  DEATH BENEFITS. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 38

7.1  Pre-Retirement Without Life Insurance. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 38
7.2  Designation of Beneficiary . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 39
7.3  Distribution of Death Benefit. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 39
7.4  Payment on Beneficiary's Death . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 39
7.5  Post-Retirement Death Benefit. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 39

ARTICLE VIII.  LIMITATIONS ON BENEFITS. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 40

8.1  Maximum Retirement Benefit . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 40
8.2  Limitations Applicable to Twenty-Five (25) Highest Paid Employees. . 46
8.3  Additional Restrictions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 49

ARTICLE IX.  PAYMENT OF BENEFITS. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 51

9.1  Commencement of Benefits . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 51
9.2  Automatic Annuity Requirements . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 52
9.3  Transitional Rules Applicable to Joint and Survivor Annuities. . . . 56
9.4  Other Forms and Methods of Payment of Benefits . . . . . . . . . . . 58
9.5  Required Payment of Benefits . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 59
9.6  Certain Distributions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 66
9.7  No Duplication of Benefits . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 66
9.8  Direct Rollovers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 66

ARTICLE X.  THE COMMITTEE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 68

10.1 Creation of a Committee. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 68
10.2 Committee Action . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 68
10.3 Authorized Signatory . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 68
10.4 Powers and Duties. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 68
10.5 Non-Discrimination . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 68
10.6 Records and Reports. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 69
10.7 Reliance on Professional Advice. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 69
10.8 Payment of Expenses. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 69
10.9 Limitation of Liability. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 69
10.1 Payment Certification to Trustee . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 69
10.1 Claims Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 70

ARTICLE XI.  PARTICIPANT VOLUNTARY CONTRIBUTIONS. . . . . . . . . . . . . 71

11.1 Voluntary Contributions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 71
11.2 Accounting Procedures. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 71
11.3 Withdrawals. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 71
11.4 Transfers From Other Trusts. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 72

ARTICLE XII.  INSURANCE CONTRACTS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 73

12.1 Trustee To Procure Contracts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 73
12.2 Substandard Lives. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 73
12.3 Rules Applicable To Contracts. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 74
12.4 Increases or Decreases in Benefits . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 75
12.5 Deferred Retirement. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 75
12.6 Premium Continuation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 76
12.7 Conflicts With Plan Terms. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 76

ARTICLE XIII.  GENERAL PROVISIONS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 77

13.1 No Right of Continued Employment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 77
13.2 Non-Alienation of Interest . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 77
13.3 Incompetence of Participants and Beneficiaries . . . . . . . . . . . 77
13.4 Separate Employer Trusts Maintained. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 77
13.5 Governing Law. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 77
13.6 Severability . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 77
13.7 Gender and Number. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 78
13.8 Titles and Headings. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 78
13.9 Counterparts as Original . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 78
13.1 Failure of Employer's Plan to Qualify. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 78
13.1 Exclusive Benefit. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 78
13.1 Proper Payee . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 78

ARTICLE XIV.  LOANS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 80

14.1 Loans to Participants. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 80
14.2 Transactions Treated as Loans. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 81
14.3 Provisions to be Applied in a Uniform and Nondiscriminatory Manner . 81
14.4 Satisfaction of Loan . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 81
14.5 Loans to Owner-Employees or Shareholder-Employees. . . . . . . . . . 81

ARTICLE XV. TOP-HEAVY PROVISIONS. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 83

15.1 Definitions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 83
15.2 Vesting Schedules. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 86
15.3 Minimum Accrued Benefit. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 87
15.4 Adjustment For Benefit Other Than Life Annuity . . . . . . . . . . . 88
15.5 Adjustment to Defined Benefit Fraction and
       Defined Contribution Fraction under Section 8.1. . . . . . . . . . 88

ARTICLE XVI.  AMENDMENT AND TERMINATION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 89

16.1 Amendment. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 89
16.2 Participating Employers. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 90
16.3 Amended and Restated Plans . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 91
16.4 Plan Merger and Consolidation or Transfer of Plan Assets . . . . . . 91
16.5 Termination. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 91

ARTICLE XVII.  PAIRED PLAN PROVISIONS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 93

17.1 Compliance with Section 415(e) of the Code . . . . . . . . . . . . . 93
17.2 Adjustment of Combined Plan Fractions under
       Section 415 of the Code for Top-Heavy
       Ratio In Excess of Ninety Percent (90%). . . . . . . . . . . . . . 93
17.3 Top Heavy Minimum Benefits and Contributions . . . . . . . . . . . . 93
17.4 Integration of Paired Plans. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 94






                               DREYFUS PROTOTYPE



                          BASIC PLAN DOCUMENT NO. 01

                  DREYFUS PROTOTYPE DEFINED CONTRIBUTION PLAN


TABLE OF CONTENTS

                DEFINITIONS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   1
           1.1  "Account" . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   1
           1.2  "Act" . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   1
           1.3  "Actual Deferral Percentage". . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   1
           1.4  "Adoption Agreement". . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   1
           1.5  "Affiliated Employer" . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   1
           1.6  "Anniversary Date". . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   1
           1.7  "Annuity Starting Date" . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   1
           1.8  "Average Actual Deferral Percentage". . . . . . . . . . .   1
           1.9  "Average Contribution Percentage" . . . . . . . . . . . .   2
           1.10 "Beneficiary" or "Beneficiaries". . . . . . . . . . . . .   2
           1.11 "Board of Directors"  . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   2
           1.12 "CODA". . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   2
           1.13 "Code". . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   2
           1.14 "Committee" . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   2
           1.15 "Compensation". . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   2
           1.16 "Contribution Percentage" . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   4
           1.17 "Contribution Percentage Amounts" . . . . . . . . . . . .   4
           1.18 "Early Retirement Age". . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   4
           1.19 "Earned Income" . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   4
           1.20 "Easy Retirement Plan". . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   4
           1.21 "Effective Date". . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   4
           1.22 "Elective Deferrals". . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   5
           1.23 "Eligible Employee" . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   5
           1.24 "Eligibility Year(s) of Service". . . . . . . . . . . . .   5
           1.25 "Employee". . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   6
           1.26 "Employer". . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   7
           1.27 "Employment Commencement Date". . . . . . . . . . . . . .   7
           1.28 "Entry Date". . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   7
           1.29 "Excess Aggregate Contributions". . . . . . . . . . . . .   7
           1.30 "Excess Contributions". . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   7
           1.31 "Excess Elective Deferrals" . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   7
           1.32 "Family Member" . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   7
           1.33 "Fund". . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   7
           1.34 "Highly Compensated Employee" . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   7
           1.35 "Hour of Service" . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .   9
           1.36 "Integration Level" . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  10
           1.37 "Matching Contribution" . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  10
           1.38 "Net Profits" . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  10
           1.39 "Non-Highly Compensated Employee" . . . . . . . . . . . .  10
           1.40 "Normal Retirement Age" . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  10
           1.41 "Owner-Employee". . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  11
           1.42 "Participant" . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  11
           1.43 "Participating Employer". . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  12
           1.44 "Period of Severance" . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  12
           1.45 "Plan". . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  12
           1.46 "Plan Year" . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  12
           1.47 "Prototype Plan". . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  12
           1.48 "Qualified Matching Contributions". . . . . . . . . . . .  12
           1.49 "Qualified Nonelective Contributions" . . . . . . . . . .  12
           1.50 "ReEmployment Commencement Date". . . . . . . . . . . . .  12
           1.51 "Regular Account" . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  13
           1.52 "S-Corporation" . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  13
           1.53 "Self-Employed Individual". . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  13
           1.54 "Service" . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  13
           1.55 "Service Break" . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  14
           1.56 "Severance from Service Date" . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  14
           1.57 "Shareholder-Employee". . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  14
           1.58 "Sponsor" . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  15
           1.59 "Taxable Wage Base" . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  15
           1.60 "Thrift Contributions". . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  15
           1.61 "Total and Permanent Disability". . . . . . . . . . . . .  15
           1.62 "Trustee" or "Custodian". . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  15
           1.63 "Trust Agreement" or "Custodial Agreement". . . . . . . .  15
           1.64 "Valuation Date". . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  15
           1.65 "Voluntary Contributions" . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  16
           PARTICIPATION. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  16
           2.1  Membership. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  16
           2.2  Excluded Employees. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  16
           2.3  Reemployment. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  16
           2.4  Change in Employment Status . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  17
           2.5  Limitations on Participation of Owner-Employees . . . . .  17
     CONTRIBUTIONS AND CREDITS TO MONEY PURCHASE PLANS. . . . . . . . . .  18
           3.1  Employer Contributions. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  18
           3.2  Forfeitures . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  18
           3.3  Credit to Participants. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  19
     CONTRIBUTIONS AND CREDITS TO PROFIT SHARING PLANS. . . . . . . . . .  21
           4.1  Limits on Employer Contributions. . . . . . . . . . . . .  21
           4.2  Forfeitures . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  22
           4.3  Employer Discretionary Contributions. . . . . . . . . . .  22
           4.4  401(k) Cash or Deferred Arrangements ("CODA")/Thrift
                Contributions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  25
           4.5  Maximum Amount of Elective Deferrals. . . . . . . . . . .  28
           4.6  Average Actual Deferral Percentage Tests. . . . . . . . .  29
           4.7  Average Contribution Percentage Tests . . . . . . . . . .  34
           4.8  Non-Hardship Withdrawals. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  38
           4.9  Distribution on Account of Financial Hardship . . . . . .  39
           4.10 Special Distribution Rules. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  42
     CONTRIBUTIONS AND CREDITS TO TARGET BENEFIT PLANS. . . . . . . . . .  42
     CONTRIBUTION AND ALLOCATION LIMITS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  43
           6.1  Timing of Contributions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  43
           6.2  Deductibility of Contributions. . . . . . . . . . . . . .  43
           6.3  Return of Employer Contributions. . . . . . . . . . . . .  43
           6.4  Limitation on Allocations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  44
           6.5  Separate Accounts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  53
           6.6  Valuation . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  53
           6.7  Segregation of Former Participant's Account . . . . . . .  54
           VESTING. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  54
           7.1  Vested Interest . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  54
           7.2  Vesting of a Participant. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  55
           7.3  Amendment of Vesting Provisions . . . . . . . . . . . . .  55
           7.4  Forfeitures. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 56
           BENEFITS ON RETIREMENT AND SEPARATION FROM SERVICE . . . . . . .57
           8.1 Commencement of Benefits.  . . . . .  . .  . . . . .  .  . .57
           8.2 Automatic Annuity Requirements . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .60
           8.3  Profit Sharing Plans: Exception from Automatic Annuity
                Requirements. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  64
           8.4  Transitional Rules Applicable to Joint and Survivor Annuities 64
           8.5  Required Payment of Benefits. . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  66
           8.6  Available Forms of Distribution . . . . . . . . . . . . .  73
           8.7  Certain Distributions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  73
           8.8  Forfeitures . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  74
           DEATH BENEFITS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  74
           9.1  Payment to Beneficiary. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  74
           9.2  Method of Payment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  74
           PARTICIPANT CONTRIBUTIONS; ROLLOVERS . . . . . . . . . . . . .  75
           10.1 Voluntary Contributions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  75
           10.2 Voluntary Tax-Deductible Contributions. . . . . . . . . .  75
           10.3 Transfers From Other Trusts . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  76
           INSURANCE POLICIES . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  77
           11.1 Policy Procurement. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  77
           11.2 Rules and Regulations . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  77
           11.3 Transfer of Policies. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  78
           11.4 Payment Upon Death. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  79
           11.5 Plan Provisions Control . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  79
           LOANS. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  79
           12.1 Loans to Participants . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  79
           12.2 Provisions to be Applied in a Uniform and Nondiscriminatory
                 Manner . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  81
           12.3 Satisfaction of Loan. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  81
           12.4 Loans to Owner-Employees or Shareholder-Employees . . . .  81
           TOP-HEAVY PROVISIONS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  82
           13.1 Definitions . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  82
           13.2 Vesting Schedules . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  85
           13.3 Minimum Allocation. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  86
           13.4 Adjustment to Defined Benefit Fraction and Defined Contribution
                Fraction under section 6.4. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  87
           THE COMMITTEE. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  87
           14.1 Creation of a Committee . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  87
           14.2 Committee Action. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  87
           14.3 Authorized Signatory. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  88
           14.4 Powers and Duties . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  88
           14.5 Nondiscrimination . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  88
           14.6 Records and Reports . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  88
           14.7 Reliance on Professional Advice . . . . . . . . . . . . .  88
           14.8 Payment of Expenses . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  88
           14.9 Limitation of Liability . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  89
           14.10     Payment Certification to Trustee . . . . . . . . . .  89
           14.11     Claims Procedure . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  89
           GENERAL PROVISIONS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  90
           15.1 No Right of Continued Employment. . . . . . . . . . . . .  90
           15.2 Nonalienation of Interest . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  90
           15.3 Incompetence of Participants and Beneficiaries. . . . . .  90
           15.4 Unclaimed Benefits. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  91
           15.5 Separate Employer Trusts Maintained . . . . . . . . . . .  91
           15.6 Governing Law . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  91
           15.7 Severability. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  91
           15.8 Gender and Number . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  91
           15.9 Titles and Headings . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  92
           15.10     Failure of Employer's Plan to Qualify. . . . . . . .  92
           15.11     Exclusive Benefit. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  92
           15.12     Action by Employer . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  92
           AMENDMENT AND TERMINATION. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  92
           16.1 Amendment . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  92
           16.2 Termination and Partial Termination . . . . . . . . . . .  93
           16.3 Plan Merger and Consolidation or Transfer of Plan Assets.  94
           16.4 Amended and Restated Plans. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  94
           16.5 Participating Employers . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  95
           PAIRED PLAN PROVISIONS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  96
           17.1 Compliance With Section 415(e) of the Code. . . . . . . .  96
           17.2 Adjustment of Combined Plan Fractions Under Section 415 of the
                Code for Top-Heavy Ratio in Excess of Ninety Percent (90%) 96
           17.3 Top-Heavy Minimum Benefits and Contributions. . . . . . .  96
           17.4 Integration of Paired Plans . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .  97


                   DREYFUS PROTOTYPE DEFINED CONTRIBUTION PLAN
                          BASIC PLAN DOCUMENT NO. 01


                                  ARTICLE I.
                                  DEFINITIONS

1.1  "Account" shall mean any one of the accounts maintained by the Committee
     for each Participant in accordance with Section 6.5.

1.2  "Act" shall mean the Employee Retirement Income Security Act of 1974, as
     amended.

1.3  "Actual Deferral Percentage" shall mean the ratio (expressed as a
      percentage) of Elective Deferrals (including Excess Elective Deferrals),
     Qualified Matching Contributions, and Qualified Nonelective Contributions
     paid over to the Fund on behalf of an Eligible Participant for the Plan
     Year to the Eligible Participant's Compensation for the Plan Year.  The
     Actual Deferral Percentage of an Eligible Participant who does not make
     an Elective Deferral, and who does not receive an allocation of a
     Qualified Matching Contribution or a Qualified Nonelective Contribution,
     is zero.

1.4  "Adoption Agreement" shall mean the document executed by the adopting
     Employer which contains all the options which may be selected and which
     incorporates this Prototype Plan by reference.

1.5  "Affiliated Employer" shall mean any corporation which is a member of a
     controlled group of corporations (as defined in section 414(b) of the
     Code) which includes the Employer; any trade or business (whether or not
     incorporated) which is under common control (as defined in section 414(c)
     of the Code) with the Employer; any organization (whether or not
     incorporated) which is a member of an affiliated service group (as defined
     in section 414(m) of the Code) which includes the Employer; and any other
     entity required to be aggregated with the Employer pursuant to regulations
     under section 414(o) of the Code.

1.6  "Anniversary Date" unless otherwise defined in the Adoption Agreement,
     shall mean the first day of the Plan Year.  If the initial Plan Year is
     less than a 12 month period, the Anniversary Date shall mean the first day
     of the 12 consecutive month period designated as the Plan Year in the
     Adoption Agreement.

1.7  "Annuity Starting Date" shall mean the first day of the first period for
     which an amount is paid as an annuity or any other form.

1.8  "Average Actual Deferral Percentage" shall mean the average (expressed as
     a percentage) of the Actual Deferral Percentages of the Eligible
     Participants in a group.

1.9  "Average Contribution Percentage" shall mean the average (expressed as a
     percentage) of the Contribution Percentages of the Eligible Participants
     in a group.

1.10 "Beneficiary" or "Beneficiaries" shall mean one or more persons designated
     as such by a Participant to receive his interest in the Fund in the event
     of the death of the Participant.

1.11 "Board of Directors" shall mean the Board of Directors of the Employer if
     the Employer is an incorporated business entity.

1.12 "CODA" shall mean a cash or deferred arrangement qualified under section
      401(k) of the Code.

1.13 "Code" shall mean the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended.

1.14 "Committee" shall mean the person or persons appointed by the Employer to
     administer the Plan in accordance with Article XIV.  If the Plan is an
     Easy Retirement Plan or if no such Committee is appointed by the Employer,
     the Employer shall act as the Committee.

1.15 "Compensation", unless otherwise specified in the Adoption Agreement,
     shall mean, in the case of an Employee other than a Self-Employed
     Individual, his wages as defined in section 3401(a) of the Code and all
     other payments of compensation to the Employee by the Employer (in the
     course of the Employer's trade or business) for which the Employer is
     required to furnish the Employee a written statement under sections
     6041(d) and 6051(a)(3) of the Code, determined without regard to any rules
     under section 3401(a) of the Code that limit the remuneration included in
     wages based on the nature or location of the employment or the services
     performed, which are actually paid during the applicable period.  In the
     case of a Self-Employed Individual, Compensation shall mean his Earned
     Income.  Unless otherwise specified in the Adoption Agreement, the
     applicable period shall be the Plan Year.  If elected by the employer in
     the Adoption Agreement, Compensation shall also include Employer
     contributions made pursuant to a salary reduction agreement with an
     Employee which are not currently includible in the gross income of the
     Employee by reason of the application of sections 125,  402(e)(3),
     402(h)(1)(B) or 403(b) of the Code.  Compensation shall include Excess
     Contributions which are recharacterized in accordance with Section 4.6(d)
     to the extent that Elective Deferrals are included in Compensation.

     Solely for purposes of determining Actual Deferral Percentages and
     Contribution Percentages, Compensation, if the Plan is a non-standardized
     plan, shall be determined without regard to any exclusions which may be
     elected in the Adoption Agreement.  Solely for purposes of determining
     Actual Deferral Percentages and Contribution Percentages, the applicable
     period for determining the amount of an Employee's Compensation shall be
     limited to the period during which the Employee was an Eligible
     Participant.

     For Plan Years beginning on or after January 1, 1989, annual Compensation
     shall not include amounts in excess of $200,000, as adjusted by the
     Secretary of the Treasury at the same time and in the same manner as under
     section 415(d) of the Code except that the dollar increases in effect on
     January 1 of any calendar year is effective for Plan Years beginning in
     such calendar year and the first adjustment to the $200,000 limitation is
     effective on January 1, 1990.

     For Plan Years beginning on or after January 1, 1994, the annual
     Compensation of each Participant taken into account for determining all
     benefits provided under the Plan for any Plan Year shall not exceed
     $150,000, as adjusted for increases in the cost-of-living in accordance
     with section 401(a)(17)(B) of the Code.  The cost-of-living adjustment in
     effect for a calendar year applies to the applicable period beginning in
     such calendar year.

     If an applicable period consists of fewer than 12 months, the annual
     Compensation limit is an amount equal to the otherwise applicable annual
     Compensation limit multiplied by a fraction, the numerator of which is the
     number of months in the short applicable period, and the denominator of
     which is 12.

     In determining Compensation for purposes of the annual Compensation limit,
     the family member rules of Section 414(q)(6) of the Code shall apply
     except that in applying such rules, the term "family" shall include only
     the Employee's spouse and any lineal descendants who have not attained age
     19 before the close of the Plan Year.  If, as a result of the application
     of such family member rule the  annual compensation limit is exceeded,
     then (except for purposes of determining the portion of Compensation up
     to the Integration Level if this Plan is integrated with Social Security),
     the  annual compensation limit shall be prorated among the affected
     individuals in proportion to each such individual's Compensation as
     determined under this Section prior to the application of such limitation.

     If Compensation for any prior applicable period is taken into account in
     determining a Participant's allocations for the current Plan Year, the
     Compensation for such prior applicable period is subject to the applicable
     annual Compensation limit in effect for that prior period.  For this
     purpose, in determining allocations in Plan Years beginning on or after
     January 1, 1989, the annual Compensation limit in effect for applicable
     periods beginning before that date is $200,000.  In addition, in
     determining allocations in Plan Years beginning on or after January 1,
     1994, the annual Compensation limit in effect for applicable periods
     beginning before that date is $150,000.

1.16 "Contribution Percentage" shall mean the ratio (expressed as a percentage)
     of an Eligible Participant's Contribution Percentage Amounts to the
     Eligible Participant's Compensation for the Plan Year.

1.17 "Contribution Percentage Amounts" shall mean the sum of the Thrift
     Contributions (including amounts recharacterized in accordance with
     Section 4.6(d)), Voluntary Contributions and Matching Contributions under
     the Plan on behalf of an Eligible Participant for the Plan Year.  Such
     Contribution Percentage Amounts shall not include Matching Contributions
     that are forfeited either to correct Excess Aggregate Contributions or
     because the contributions to which they relate are Excess Elective
     Deferrals, Excess Contributions, or Excess Aggregate Contributions.  Such
     Contribution Percentage Amounts shall include forfeitures of Excess
     Aggregate Contributions or Matching Contributions allocated to the
     Eligible Participant's Employer Matching Contribution Account, which shall
     be taken into account in the year in which such forfeiture is allocated.

1.18 "Early Retirement Age" shall mean the date a Participant satisfies the age
     and service requirements for early retirement, if any, specified in the
     Adoption Agreement.  Upon reaching his Early Retirement Age, a
     Participant's right to his account balance shall be nonforfeitable,
     notwithstanding the Plan's vesting schedule.  If a Participant separates
     from service before satisfying the age requirement for early retirement,
     but has satisfied the service requirement, the Participant will be
     entitled to elect to receive an early retirement benefit upon satisfaction
     of such age requirement.

1.19 "Earned Income" shall mean the annual net earnings from self-employment
     in the trade or business with respect to which the Plan is established,
     provided that personal services of the individual are a material
     income-producing factor.  Net earnings will be determined without regard
     to items not included in gross income and the deductions allocable to such
     items.  Net earnings are reduced by contributions by the Employer to a
     qualified plan to the extent deductible under section 404 of the Code.
     Net earnings shall be determined with regard to the deduction allowed to
     the Employer by section 164(f) of the Code for taxable years beginning
     after December 31, 1989.

1.20 "Easy Retirement Plan" shall mean a Plan established under Dreyfus Easy
     Standardized/Paired Prototype Money Purchase Retirement Plan No. 01005,
     Dreyfus Easy Standardized/Paired Prototype Profit Sharing Retirement Plan
     No. 01006, or Dreyfus Standardized/Paired Prototype Defined Benefit Plan
     No. 02001.

1.21 "Effective Date" shall mean the date specified in the Adoption Agreement.

1.22 "Elective Deferrals" shall mean any Employer contributions made to the
     Plan at the election of the Participant, in lieu of cash compensation, and
     shall include contributions made pursuant to a salary reduction agreement
     or other deferral mechanism.  With respect to any taxable year, a
     Participant's Elective Deferrals are the sum of all Employer contributions
     made on behalf of such Participant pursuant to an election to defer under
     any CODA, any simplified employee pension cash or deferred arrangement as
     described in section 402(h)(1)(B), any eligible deferred compensation plan
     under section 457, any plan as described under section 501(c)(18), and any
     Employer contributions made on behalf of a Participant for the purchase
     of an annuity contract under section 403(b) pursuant to a salary reduction
     agreement.  Elective Deferrals shall not include any deferrals properly
     distributed as an Excess Amount pursuant to Section 6.4(d).

1.23 "Eligible Employee" shall mean each Employee who is not excluded from
     eligibility to participate in the Plan under the Adoption Agreement.  If
     the Plan is an Easy Retirement Plan, Eligible Employee shall mean each
     Employee who is not (i) included in a unit of Employees covered by a
     collective bargaining agreement between the Employer and employee
     representatives, if retirement benefits were the subject of good faith
     bargaining, or (ii) a nonresident alien who received no income from the
     Employer which constitutes income from sources within the United States.
     For purposes of the preceding sentence, "employee representatives" does
     not include any organization more than half of whose members are Employees
     who are owners, officers, or executives of the Employer.

1.24 "Eligibility Year(s) of Service" shall mean the twelve (12) consecutive
     month period commencing on an Employee's Employment Commencement Date and
     anniversaries thereof, during which the Employee worked at least one
     thousand (1,000) Hours of Service (or such lesser number of Hours of
     Service specified in the Adoption Agreement).

     In the case of an Employee in the maritime industry whose compensation is
     determined based on days of service, 125 days of service shall be treated
     as 1,000 Hours of Service (or such lesser number of Hours of Service as
     specified in the Adoption Agreement).  For purposes of the preceding
     sentence "maritime industry" shall mean that industry in which Employees
     perform duties on board commercial, exploratory, service or other vessels
     moving on the high seas, inland waterways, Great Lakes, coastal zones,
     harbors and noncontiguous areas, or on offshore ports, platforms or other
     similar sites.

     In the case of a Participant, who does not have any nonforfeitable right
     to the account balance derived from Employer contributions, Eligibility
     Year(s) of Service before a period of consecutive one (1) year Service
     Breaks will not be taken into account in computing Eligibility Years of
     Service, if the number of consecutive one (1) year Service Breaks in such
     period equals or exceeds the greater of five (5) or the aggregate number
     of Eligibility Years of Service before such break.  Such aggregate number
     of Eligibility Years of Service will not include any Eligibility Year of
     Service disregarded under the preceding sentence by reason of prior
     Service Breaks.

     Notwithstanding the above, if the Adoption Agreement provides for full and
     immediate vesting upon completion of the eligibility requirements and an
     Employee has incurred a one (1) year Service Break before satisfying the
     Plan's eligibility requirements, all Eligibility Year(s) of Service before
     such Service Break will not be taken into account.

     If the elapsed time method of crediting service is specified in the
     Adoption Agreement, an Employee shall receive credit for Service, except
     for credit which may be disregarded under this Section or Section 2.3, for
     the aggregate of all time periods commencing on his Employment
     Commencement Date or Re-Employment Commencement Date and ending on his
     Severance from Service Date.  An Employee shall also receive credit for
     any Period of Severance of less than twelve (12) months.  Fractional
     periods of a year shall be expressed in terms of days.

1.25       "Employee" shall mean an Owner-Employee, a Self-Employed Individual,
           a Shareholder-Employee and any other person employed by the Employer
           or any Affiliated Employer.

     A "leased employee" shall also be treated as an Employee.  The term
     "leased employee" means any person (other than an employee of the
     recipient employer) who pursuant to an agreement between the recipient
     employer and any other person ("leasing organization") has performed
     services for the recipient employer (or for the recipient employer and
     related persons determined in accordance with section 414(n)(6) of the
     Code) on a substantially full-time basis for a period of at least one
     year, and such services are of a type historically performed by employees
     in the business field of the recipient employer.  Contributions or
     benefits provided a leased employee by the leasing organization which are
     attributable to services performed for the recipient employer shall be
     treated as provided by the recipient employer.

     Notwithstanding the preceding paragraph, a leased employee shall not be
     considered an employee of the recipient employer if: (i) such employee is
     covered by a money purchase pension plan providing (1) a nonintegrated
     employer contribution rate of at least ten percent (10%) of compensation,
     as defined in section 415(c)(3) of the Code, but including amounts
     contributed pursuant to a salary reduction agreement which are excludable
     from the employee's gross income under section 125, section 402(a)(8),
     section 402(h) or section 403(b) of the Code, (2) immediate participation,
     and (3) full and immediate vesting; and (ii) leased employees do not
     constitute more than twenty percent (20%) of the recipient employer's
     non-highly compensated workforce.

1.26 "Employer" shall mean the corporation, partnership, proprietorship or
     other business entity which shall adopt the Plan or any successor thereof.

1.27 "Employment Commencement Date" shall mean the first date with respect to
     which an Employee performs an Hour of Service.

1.28 "Entry Date", unless otherwise specified in the Adoption Agreement, shall
     mean the first day of the Plan Year and the first day of the seventh month
     of the Plan Year.  The initial Entry Date shall not precede the original
     effective date of the Plan.

1.29 "Excess Aggregate Contributions" shall mean, with respect to any Plan
     Year, the excess of the aggregate Contribution Percentage Amounts taken
     into account in computing the numerator of the Contribution Percentage,
     actually made on behalf of Highly Compensated Employees for such Plan
     Year, over the maximum Contribution Percentage Amounts permitted by the
     Average Contribution Percentage tests of Section 4.7 (determined by
     reducing contributions made on behalf of Highly Compensated Employees in
     order of their Contribution Percentages, beginning with the highest of
     such percentages).

1.30 "Excess Contributions" shall mean, with respect to any Plan Year, the
     excess of the aggregate amount of Elective Deferrals, Qualified
     Nonelective Contributions, and Qualified Matching Contributions actually
     taken into account in computing the Actual Deferral Percentage of Highly
     Compensated Employees for such Plan Year, over the maximum amount of such
     contributions permitted under the Average Actual Deferral Percentage tests
     of Section 4.6 (determined by reducing contributions made on behalf of
     Highly Compensated Employees in order of their Actual Deferral
     Percentages, beginning with the highest of such percentages).

1.31 "Excess Elective Deferrals" shall mean a Participant's Elective Deferrals
     for a taxable year in excess of the adjusted dollar limitation of section
     402(g) of the Code.

1.32 "Family Member" shall, with respect to a five percent (5%) owner or top
     ten Highly Compensated Employee described in section 414(q)(6)(A) of the
     Code, include the spouse and lineal ascendants and descendants of an
     Employee or former Employee and the spouses of such lineal ascendants and
     descendants.  The determination of who is a Family Member will be made in
     accordance with section 414(q) of the Code.

1.33 "Fund" shall mean all property received by the Trustee or Custodian for
     purposes of the Plan, investments thereof and earnings thereon, less
     payments made by the Trustee to carry out the Plan.

1.34 "Highly Compensated Employee" shall include highly compensated active
      employees and highly compensated former employees.

     A highly compensated active employee includes any Employee who performs
     services for the Employer or any Affiliated Employer during the
     determination year and who, during the look-back year:  (i) received
     Compensation from the Employer or any Affiliated Employer in excess of
     $75,000 (as adjusted pursuant to section 415(d) of the Code); (ii)
     received Compensation from the Employer or any Affiliated Employer in
     excess of $50,000 (as adjusted pursuant to section 415(d) of the Code) and
     was a member of the top-paid group for such year; or (iii) was an officer
     of the Employer or any Affiliated Employer and received Compensation
     during such year that is greater than fifty percent (50%) of the dollar
     limitation in effect under section 415(b)(1)(A) of the Code.  The term
     Highly Compensated Employee also includes:  (i) an Employee who is
     described in the preceding sentence if the term "determination year" is
     substituted for the term "look-back year" and the Employee is one of the
     100 most highly compensated Employees of the Employer or any Affiliated
     Employer during the Plan Year; and (ii) an Employee who is a five percent
     (5%) owner of the Employer or any Affiliated Employer at any time during
     the look-back year or determination year.

     If no officer has satisfied the compensation requirement of (iii) above
     during either a determination year or look-back year, the highest paid
     officer for such year shall be treated as a Highly Compensated Employee.

     For this purpose, the determination year shall be the Plan Year, and the
     look-back year shall be the twelve (12) month period immediately preceding
     the determination year unless the Employer has elected to use the calendar
     year ending with or within the determination year as the look-back year
     for purposes of its employee benefit plans.  If the Employer has so
     elected to use such calendar year as the look-back year for its employee
     benefit plans, the determination year shall be the "lag period," if any,
     by which the applicable determination year extends beyond such calendar
     year.

     A highly compensated former employee includes any Employee who terminated
     employment (or was deemed to have terminated) prior to the determination
     year, performs no service for the Employer or any Affiliated Employer
     during the determination year, and was a highly compensated active
     employee for either the separation year or any determination year ending
     on or after the Employee's 55th birthday.

     If an Employee is, during a determination year or look-back year, a Family
     Member of either a five percent (5%) owner who is an active or former
     Employee or a Highly Compensated Employee who is one of the 10 most Highly
     Compensated Employees of the Employer or any Affiliated Employer during
     such year, then the Family Member and the five percent (5%) owner or
     top-10 Highly Compensated Employee shall be aggregated.  The Family Member
     and five percent (5%) owner or top-10 Highly Compensated Employee shall
     be treated as a single Employee receiving Compensation and Plan
     contributions equal to the sum of Compensation and contributions of the
     Family Member and five percent (5%) owner or top-10 Highly Compensated
     Employee.

     The determination of who is a Highly Compensated Employee, including the
     determinations of the number and identify of employees in top-paid group,
     the top 100 employees, the number of employees treated as officers and the
     compensation that is considered, will be made in accordance with section
     414(q) of the Code and the regulations thereunder.

1.35 "Hour of Service" shall mean:

     (a)   Each hour for which an Employee is compensated by the Employer, or
           is entitled to be so compensated, for services rendered by him to the
           Employer.  These hours will be credited to the Employee for the
           computation period in which the duties are performed; and

     (b)   Each hour for which an Employee is compensated by the Employer, or
           is entitled to be so compensated, on account of a period of time
           during which no services are rendered by him to the Employer
           (regardless of whether the Employee shall have ceased to be an
           Employee) due to vacation, holiday, illness, incapacity (including
           disability), layoff, jury duty, military duty or leave of absence.
           No more than five hundred and one (501) Hours of Service shall be
           credited pursuant to this subparagraph (b) on account of any single
           continuous period during which an Employee renders no services to the
           Employer (whether or not such period occurs in a single computation
           period).  Hours under this paragraph will be calculated and credited
           pursuant to section 2530.200b-2 of the Department of Labor
           Regulations which are incorporated herein by this reference; and
     (c)   Each hour for which back pay, without regard to mitigation of
           damages, has been awarded or agreed to by the Employer.  The same
           Hours of Service shall not be credited both under subparagraph (a)
           or subparagraph (b), whichever shall be applicable, and also under
           this subparagraph (c).  The hours will be credited to the Employee
           for the computation period or periods to which the award or agreement
           pertains rather than the computation period in which the award,
           agreement or payment is made.

           Hours of Service will be credited for employment with an Affiliated
           Employer.  Hours of Service will also be credited for employment with
           a predecessor employer if the Employer maintains the plan of such
           predecessor or the Employer so elects in the Adoption Agreement.

           Hours of Service will also be credited for any individual considered
           an Employee under sections 414(n) or 414(o) of the Code or the
           regulations thereunder.

           Solely for purposes of determining whether a Service Break, as
           defined in Section 1.54, for participation and vesting purposes has
           occurred in a computation period, an individual who is absent from
           work for maternity or paternity reasons shall receive credit for the
           Hours of Service which would otherwise have been credited to such
           individual but for such absence, or in any case in which such hours
           cannot be determined, eight (8) Hours of Service per day of such
           absence.  For purposes of this paragraph, an absence from work for
           maternity or paternity reasons means an absence (1) by reason of the
           pregnancy of the individual, (2) by reason of a birth of a child of
           the individual, (3) by reason of the placement of the child with the
           individual in connection with the adoption of such child by such
           individual, or (4) for purposes of caring for such child for a period
           beginning immediately following such birth or placement.  The Hours
           of Service credited under this paragraph shall be credited (1) in the
           computation period in which the absence begins if the crediting is
           necessary to prevent a Service Break in that period, (2) in all other
           cases, in the following computation period.

           Hours of Service shall be credited on the basis of actual hours
           worked unless another method has been specified in the Adoption
           Agreement.  Hours of Service shall not be counted if the elapsed time
           method is specified in the Adoption Agreement, except to determine
           an Employee's Employment Commencement Date or Re-Employment
           Commencement Date.

1.36 "Integration Level" shall mean the Taxable Wage Base or such lesser amount
     elected by the Employer in the Adoption Agreement.

1.37 "Matching Contribution" shall mean Employer contributions made to this
     Plan or any other defined contribution plan by reason of Thrift
     Contributions or Elective Deferrals under this Plan.

1.38 "Net Profits" shall mean current and accumulated earnings of the Employer
     before Federal and State taxes and contributions to this and any other
     qualified plan.

1.39 "Non-Highly Compensated Employee" shall mean an Employee of the Employer
     who is neither a Highly Compensated Employee nor a Family Member.

1.40 "Normal Retirement Age" shall mean the age specified in the Adoption
     Agreement.  Upon reaching his Normal Retirement Age, the Participant's
     right to his retirement benefit shall be nonforfeitable, notwithstanding
     the Plan's vesting schedule.  In the event the Employer imposes a
     mandatory normal retirement age, the Normal Retirement Age may not exceed
     such mandatory normal retirement age.

     Notwithstanding any other provision of this Plan, the Employer, in
     accordance with the provisions of the Age Discrimination in Employment
     Act, shall have no right to compel a Participant to retire, except as
     otherwise provided herein, if in the calendar year or the preceding
     calendar year, the Employer has twenty (20) or more employees for each
     work day in each of twenty (20) or more calendar weeks.  The Employer may
     retire a Participant who for the two (2) year period prior to retirement
     is employed in a bona fide executive or high policy-making position if (1)
     he has attained age sixty-five (65); (2) he has attained his Normal
     Retirement Date; and (3) his annual retirement benefit from the pension,
     profit sharing, savings or deferred compensation plans maintained by the
     Employer equals, in the aggregate, at least forty-four thousand dollars
     ($44,000).  This Section shall be deemed to be automatically amended to
     reflect any subsequent Federal legislation or regulations.

1.41 "Owner-Employee" shall mean a sole proprietor or a partner who owns more
     than ten percent (10%) of either the capital interest or profits interest
     of a partnership.

1.42 "Participant" shall mean an Eligible Employee who enters the Plan pursuant
     to Section 2.1 of the Plan.

     (a)   "Active Participant" shall mean a Participant who is credited with
           one  thousand (1,000) or more Hours of Service (or such lesser number
           of Hours of Service specified in the Adoption Agreement) in the Plan
           Year.  Unless otherwise specified in the Adoption Agreement, it is
           not necessary that the Participant be employed on the last day of the
           Plan Year in order to be deemed an Active Participant and share in
           the Employer contribution, if any.  If the elapsed time method of
           crediting service is specified in the Adoption Agreement, Active
           Participant shall include all Participants, unless otherwise
           specified in the Adoption Agreement.

           Notwithstanding the foregoing paragraph, if the Plan is a
           standardized plan, "Active Participant" shall mean, for each Plan
           Year beginning on or after January 1, 1990, each Participant other
           than a Participant who is not employed on the last day of the Plan
           Year and is credited with  more than 500 Hours of Service in the Plan
           Year. If the elapsed time method of crediting service is specified
           in the Adoption Agreement, "Active Participant" shall mean all
           Participants.

           If the elapsed time method of crediting Hours of Service is specified
           in the Adoption Agreement, Active Participant shall mean a
           Participant who is credited with three (3) consecutive calendar
           months of service.

     (b)   "Eligible Participant" shall mean an Employee who is eligible under
           the terms of the Plan to make Thrift Contributions, Elective
           Deferrals or Elective Deferrals and Thrift Contributions, combined
           ("Combined Contributions") made on his behalf.

1.43 "Participating Employer" shall mean any Affiliated Employer which has
     adopted the Plan in accordance with Section 16.5.

1.44 "Period of Severance" shall mean a continuous period of time during which
     the Employee is not employed by the Employer.  Such period begins on the
     Employee's Severance from Service Date and ends on the Employee's
     Re-Employment Commencement Date.

1.45 "Plan" shall mean this Prototype Plan, the Trust Agreement or Custodial
     Agreement and the Adoption Agreement of the adopting Employer, as from
     time to time amended.

1.46 "Plan Year" shall mean the calendar year, unless another twelve (12)
     consecutive month period is specified in the Adoption Agreement.

1.47 "Prototype Plan" shall mean the basic plan document described herein.

1.48 "Qualified Matching Contributions" shall mean Employer contributions to
     the Plan which are allocated to Participants' accounts by reason of
     Elective Deferrals, which are at all times subject to the distribution and
     nonforfeitability requirements of section 401(k) of the Code.

1.49 "Qualified Nonelective Contributions" shall mean Employer contributions
     (other than Matching Contributions or Qualified Matching Contributions)
     which are allocated to Eligible Participants' accounts, which such
     Participants may not elect to receive in cash until distributed from the
     Plan and, which are at all times subject to the distribution and
     nonforfeitability requirements of section 401(k) of the Code.

1.50 "ReEmployment Commencement Date" shall mean the first day on which the
     Employee is credited with an Hour of Service for the performance of duties
     after the first eligibility computation period in which the Employee
     incurs a one (1) year Service Break.

     In the case of any Participant who has a one (1) year Service Break,
     Eligibility Year(s) of Service before such break will not be taken into
     account until the Employee has completed one (1) Eligibility Year of
     Service after returning to employment.  Such Eligibility Year of
     Service shall be measured by the twelve (12) consecutive month period
     beginning on the Employee's Reemployment Commencement Date and, if
     necessary, subsequent twelve (12) consecutive month periods beginning on
     anniversaries of the Re-Employment Commencement Date.

     If a former Participant completes an Eligibility Year of Service in
     accordance with this provision, such Participant's participation will be
     reinstated as of the Re-Employment Commencement Date.

1.51 "Regular Account" shall mean the account to which Employer contributions
     are credited with respect to the Dreyfus prototype money purchase and
     target benefit plans (Plan Numbers 01001, 01004, and 01005).

1.52 "S-Corporation" shall mean an Employer who has made an election for its
     taxable year of reference under section 1362(a) of the Code, or any other
     applicable section pertaining thereto.

1.53 "Self-Employed Individual" shall mean an individual who has Earned Income
     for the taxable year from the unincorporated trade, or business or
     partnership with respect to which the Plan is established; also, an
     individual who would have had Earned Income but for the fact such trade,
     business or partnership had no net profits for the taxable year.

1.54 "Service" shall mean any twelve (12) consecutive month period identical
     to the Plan Year during which the Employee completes at least one thousand
     (1,000) or more Hours of Service (or such lesser number of Hours of
     Service specified in the Adoption Agreement).  Periods of time to be
     excluded, if any, shall be stipulated in the Adoption Agreement.

     In the case of Employees in the Maritime Industry, 125 days of service
     shall be treated as 1,000 Hours of Service (or such lesser number of hours
     of Service as specified in the Adoption Agreement).

     Service will be credited in accordance with the rules set forth above for
     any employment, for any period of time, for any Affiliated Employer.
     Service will also be credited for any individual required to be considered
     an Employee, for purposes of this Plan under section 414(n) or (o) of the
     Code, of the Employer or any Affiliated Employer.

     If the elapsed time method of crediting service is specified in the
     Adoption Agreement, an Employee shall receive credit for Service, except
     for Service which may be disregarded under Sections 7.2(b), for the
     aggregate of all time periods commencing on his Employment Commencement
     Date or Re-Employment Commencement Date and ending on his Severance from
     Service Date.  An Employee shall also receive credit, for vesting
     purposes, for any Period of Severance of less than twelve (12) consecutive
     months.  An Employee will receive a year of Service for vesting purposes
     for each twelve (12) months of Service.  Fractional periods of a year
     shall be expressed in terms of days.

1.55 "Service Break" shall mean:

     (a)For purposes of calculating Eligibility Years of Service, any twelve
     (12) consecutive month period commencing on an Employee's Employment
     Commencement Date or anniversaries thereof during which the Employee is
     credited with five hundred (500) Hours of Service or less.  In the case
     of Employees in the Maritime Industry, 62 days of service or less.

     (b)   For purposes of calculating years of Service, any Plan Year during
     which the Employee is credited with five hundred (500) Hours of Service
     or less, where such Service Break shall be measured from the first day of
     such Plan Year.  In the case of Employees in the Maritime Industry, 62
     days of service or less.

     (c)   If the elapsed time method of crediting service is specified in the
     Adoption Agreement, a Service Break shall mean a Period of Severance of
     at least twelve (12) consecutive months; provided, however, that in the
     case of an Employee absent for maternity or paternity reasons (as defined
     in Section 1.35), the Period of Severance shall not commence for this
     purpose until the twenty-four (24) month anniversary of the first date of
     such absence.

     (d)   A Service Break shall not be deemed to have occurred as a result of
     absence due to service in the armed forces of the United States, provided
     the Employee makes application for resumption of work with the Employer
     following discharge, within the time specified by then applicable laws.

1.56 "Severance from Service Date" shall mean the earlier of

     (a)   the date on which an Employee quits, retires, is discharged or dies;
     or
     (b)   the twelve (12) month anniversary of the date an Employee is first
     absent (with or without pay) for reason other than quit, retirement,
     discharge or death (such as vacation, holiday, sickness, disability, leave
     of absence or layoff).

1.57 Shareholder-Employee" shall mean a Participant who owns (or is considered
     as owning) more than five percent (5%) of the outstanding stock of an
     S-Corporation on any day during the taxable year of reference of such
     S-Corporation.  In determining the percent of a Participant's ownership
     of the outstanding stock, the family attribution rules of section
     318(a)(1) of the Code, or any other applicable section of the Code
     pertaining thereto shall apply.

1.58 "Sponsor" shall mean The Dreyfus Corporation.

1.59 "Taxable Wage Base" shall mean, except for purposes of Article V, the
     contribution and benefit base in effect under Section 230 of the Social
     Security Act at the beginning of the Plan Year.

1.60 "Thrift Contributions" shall mean contributions made by a Participant
     which are included in the Participant's gross income in the year in which
     made.

1.61 "Total and Permanent Disability" shall mean the inability to engage in any
     substantial gainful activity by reason of any medically determinable
     physical or mental impairment that can be expected to result in death or
     which has lasted or can be expected to last for a continuous period of not
     less than twelve (12) months.  The permanence and degree of such
     impairment shall be supported by medical evidence satisfactory to the
     Committee.

1.62 "Trustee" or "Custodian" shall mean the individual or individuals, or
     institution appointed in the Adoption Agreement by the Employer to act in
      accordance with the provisions of the Trust Agreement or Custodial
      Agreement.

     If the contributions will be made to a Custodian, references herein to the
     "Trustee" shall be deemed to refer to the "Custodian" and the term "Trust
     Fund" shall be deemed to refer to the "Custodial Account."

1.63 "Trust Agreement" or "Custodial Agreement" shall mean:

     (a)   for "Trust Agreement" shall mean the agreement between the Employer
     and the Trustee if the Plan is established under Dreyfus
     Standardized/Paired Prototype Money Purchase Plan No. 01001, Dreyfus
     Nonstandardized Prototype Profit Sharing Plan No. 01002, Dreyfus
     Standardized/Paired Prototype Profit Sharing Plan No. 01003, or Dreyfus
     Standardized/Paired Prototype Target Benefit Pension Plan No. 01004.

     (b)   for "Custodial Agreement" shall mean the agreement between the
     Employer and the Custodian under which the Plan is funded if the Plan is
     established under Dreyfus Easy Standardized/Paired Prototype Money
     Purchase Retirement Plan No. 01005 or Dreyfus Easy Standardized/Paired
     Prototype Profit Sharing Retirement Plan No. 01006.  Such Plans are
     hereinafter referred to as "Easy Retirement Plans."

1.64 "Valuation Date" shall mean the last day of the Plan Year and such other
     dates as may be determined by the Committee.

1.65 "Voluntary Contributions" shall mean contributions previously made by a
     Participant which were included in the Participant's gross income in the
     year in which made.



                                  ARTICLE II.
                                 PARTICIPATION

2.1  Membership

     Each Eligible Employee shall become a Participant on the Effective Date
     or the Entry Date coincident with or next following the completion of the
     age and service requirements set forth in the Adoption Agreement.

2.2  Excluded Employees

     The Adoption Agreement may exclude Employees from participation in the
     Plan based upon minimum age and service requirements or the inclusion of
     such Employees in certain ineligible classifications.

     In the event an Employee who is not a member of the eligible class of
     Employees becomes a member of the eligible class, such Employee will
     participate immediately if such Employee has satisfied the minimum age and
     service requirements and would otherwise have previously become a
     Participant.

     In the event a Participant is no longer a member of an eligible class of
     Employees and becomes ineligible to participate, but has not incurred a
     Service Break, such Employee will participate immediately upon returning
     to an eligible class of Employees.  If such Participant incurs a Service
     Break, eligibility to participate will be determined under the rules of
     Section 1.24 of the Plan.

2.3  Reemployment

     (a)   A former Participant will become a Participant immediately upon
     returning to the employ of the Employer if such former Participant had a
     nonforfeitable right to all or a portion of the account balance derived
     from Employer contributions at the time of termination from service.

     (b)   A former Participant who did not have a nonforfeitable right to any
     portion of the account balance derived from Employer contributions at the
     time of termination from service will be considered a new Employee, for
     eligibility purposes, if the number of consecutive one (1) year Service
     Breaks equal or exceed the greater of five (5) or the aggregate number of
     years of Service before such Service Breaks.  If such former Participant's
     years of Service before termination from service may not be disregarded
     pursuant to the preceding sentence, such former Participant shall
     participate immediately upon reemployment.

     (c)   Any former Employee who was never a Participant and is reemployed as
     an Employee will be eligible to participate subject to the provisions of
     Section 2.1.

2.4  Change in Employment Status

     In the event that a Participant who was credited with a year of Service
     for the preceding Plan Year, at the request of the Employer, enters
     directly into the employ of any other business entity, such Participant
     shall be deemed to be an Active Participant.  If such Participant returns
     to the employ of the Employer or becomes eligible for benefits pursuant
     to Articles VIII or IX, without interruption of employment with the
     Employer or other business entity, he shall be deemed not to have had a
     Service Break for such period.  However, if such Participant does not
     immediately return to the employ of the Employer upon his termination of
     employment with such other business entity or upon recall by the Employer,
     he shall be deemed to have terminated his employment for all purposes of
     the Plan as of the Anniversary Date following the date of transfer.
2.5  Limitations on Participation of Owner-Employees

     Notwithstanding the above, Plans which allow Owner-Employees to
     participate must satisfy the following additional requirements:

     (a)   If this Plan provides contributions or benefits for one or more
     Owner-Employees who control both the business for which this Plan is
     established and one or more other trades or businesses, this Plan and the
     plan established for other trades or businesses must, when looked at as
     a single plan, satisfy sections 401(a) and (d) of the Code for the
     Employees of this and all other trades or businesses.

     (b)   If the Plan provides contributions or benefits for one or more
     Owner-Employees who control one or more other trades or businesses the
     employees of the other trades or businesses  must be included in a plan
     which satisfies sections 401(a) and (d) of the Code and which provides
     contributions and benefits not less favorable than provided for
     Owner-Employees under this Plan.

     (c)   If an individual is covered as an Owner-Employee under the plans of
     two or more trades or businesses which are not controlled and the
     individual controls a trade or business, then the contributions or
     benefits of the employees under the plan of the trades or businesses which
     are controlled must be as favorable as those provided for him under the
     most favorable plan of the trade or business which is not controlled.

           For purposes of the preceding paragraphs, an Owner-Employee, or two
     or more Owner-Employees, will be considered to control a trade or business
     if the Owner-Employee, or two or more Owner-Employees together:

           (1)  own the entire interest in an unincorporated trade or business,
                or

           (2)  in the case of a partnership, own more than fifty percent (50%)
                of either the capital interest or the profits interest in the
                partnership.

           For purposes of the preceding sentence, an Owner-Employee, or two or
           more Owner-Employees shall be treated as owning any interest in a
           partnership which is owned, directly or indirectly, by a partnership
           which such Owner-Employee, or such two or more Owner-Employees, are
           considered to control within the meaning of the preceding sentence.



                                 ARTICLE III.
               CONTRIBUTIONS AND CREDITS TO MONEY PURCHASE PLANS

                  (The provisions of this Article shall apply
                  only with respect to Money Purchase Plans)

3.1  Employer Contributions
     For each Plan Year the Employer's contribution to the Fund shall be
     determined in accordance with the Adoption Agreement.  Such contribution
     shall not exceed an amount equal to twenty-five percent (25%) of each
     Participant's Compensation.

3.2  Forfeitures

     Unless otherwise specified in the Adoption Agreement, any forfeitures
     which occur will reduce Employer contributions for the next Plan Year.
     If the Adoption Agreement specifies that forfeitures are to be allocated
     to the Accounts of other Participants, the Plan shall continue to be
     designed to qualify as a money purchase pension plan for purposes of
     sections 401(a), 402, 412 and 417 of the Code.



3.3  Credit to Participants

     (a)   If the Plan is not integrated with Social Security, the Employer's
     contribution (as specified in the Adoption Agreement) for any Plan Year
     (and any forfeitures, if forfeitures are allocated to Active Participants
     in accordance with Section 3.2) shall be allocated to the Regular Account
     of each Active Participant in the ratio in which each Active Participant's
     Compensation for the Plan Year bears to that of all Active Participants
     for such Plan Year.

     (b)   If the Plan is integrated with Social Security:

           (i)   Subject to the overall permitted disparity limits, if under
           Article XIII, the Plan is Top-Heavy for the Plan Year and the minimum
           Top-Heavy contribution is made under the Plan, then Employer
           Discretionary Contributions plus forfeitures shall be allocated to
           the Account of each Participant who either completes more than 500
           Hours of Service during the Plan Year or is employed on the last day
           of the Plan Year as follows:

                Step One: Contributions and forfeitures will be allocated to
                each Participant's Account in the ratio that each Participant's
                total Compensation bears to all Participants' total
                Compensation, but not in excess of 3% of each Participant's
                Compensation.

                Step Two: Any contributions and forfeitures remaining after the
                allocation in Step One will be allocated to each Participant's
                Account in the ratio that each Participant's Compensation for
                the Plan Year in excess of the integration level bears to the
                excess compensation of all Participants, but not in excess of
                3% of each Participant's Compensation.  For purposes of this
                Step Two, in the case of any Participant who has exceeded the
                Cumulative Permitted Disparity Limit described below, such
                Participant's total Compensation for the Plan Year will be taken
                into account.
                Step Three:    Any contributions and forfeitures remaining after
                the allocation in Step Two will be allocated to each
                Participant's Account in the ratio that the sum of each
                Participant's total Compensation and Compensation in excess of
                the Integration Level bears to the sum of all Participants'
                total Compensation and Compensation in excess of the Integration
                Level; however, the allocation cannot exceed the product of (a)
                the Permitted Disparity Percentage specified in the Adoption
                Agreement multiplied by (b) each Participant's total
                Compensation and Compensation in excess of the Integration
                Level.  For purposes of this Step Three, in the case of any
                Participant who has exceeded the Cumulative Permitted Disparity
                Limit described below, two times such Participant's total
                Compensation for the Plan Year will be taken into account.

                Step Four:     Any remaining Employer contributions or
                forfeitures will be allocated to each Participant's Account in
                the ratio that each Participants's total Compensation for the
                Plan Year bears to all Participants' total Compensation for that
                year.

           The Integration Level shall be equal to the Taxable Wage Base or such
           lesser amount elected by the Employer in the Adoption Agreement.

           (ii) Subject to the overall permitted disparity limits, if the Plan
           is not Top Heavy for the Plan Year, Employer Discretionary
           Contributions plus forfeitures shall be allocated to the Account of
           each Participant who either completes more than 500 Hours of Service
           during the Plan Year or is employed on the last day of the Plan Year
           as follows:

                Step One: Contributions and forfeitures will be allocated to
                each Participant's Account in the ratio that the sum of each
                Participant's total Compensation and Compensation in excess of
                the Integration Level bears to the sum of all Participants'
                total Compensation and Compensation in excess of the Integration
                Level; however, the allocation cannot exceed the product of (a)
                the Permitted Disparity Percentage specified in the Adoption
                Agreement multiplied by (b) each Participant's total
                Compensation and Compensation in excess of the Integration
Level.  For purposes of this Step One, in the case of any Participant who has
exceeded the Cumulative Permitted Disparity Limit described below, two times
such Participant's total Compensation for the Plan Year will be taken into
account.

                Step Two: Any remaining Employer contributions or forfeitures
                will be allocated to each Participant's Account in the ratio
                that each Participants' total Compensation for the Plan Year
                bears to all Participants' total Compensation for that year.

           The Integration Level shall be equal to the Taxable Wage Base or such
           lesser amount elected by the Employer in the Adoption Agreement.
     Overall Permitted Disparity Limit

           Annual Overall Permitted Disparity Limit: Notwithstanding section
           4.3(b)(i) and (ii) above, for any Play Year this Plan benefits any
           Participant who benefits under another qualified plan or simplified
           employee pension, as defined in section 408(k) of the Code,
           maintained by the Employer that provides for permitted disparity (or
           imputes disparity), Employer contributions and forfeitures will be
           allocated to the Account of each Participant who either completes
           more than 500 Hours of Service during the Plan Year or is employed
           on the last day of the Plan Year in the ratio that such Participant's
           total Compensation bears to the total Compensation of all
           Participants.

           Cumulative Permitted Disparity Limit:  Effective for Plan Years
           beginning on or after January 1, 1995, the Cumulative Permitted
           Disparity Limit for a Participant is 35 total cumulative permitted
           disparity years.  Total cumulative permitted years means the number
           of years credited to the Participant for allocation or accrual
           purposes under this Plan, any other qualified plan or simplified
           employer pension plan (whether or not terminated) ever maintained by
           the Employer.  For purposes of determining the Participant's
           cumulative permitted disparity limit, all years ending in the same
           calendar year are treated as the same year.  If the Participant has
           not benefited under a defined benefit or target benefit plan for any
           year beginning on or after January 1, 1994, the Participant has no
           cumulative disparity limit.



                                  ARTICLE IV.
               CONTRIBUTIONS AND CREDITS TO PROFIT SHARING PLANS

               (The provisions of this Article shall apply only
                     with respect to Profit Sharing Plans)

4.1  Limits on Employer Contributions

     Employer contributions for each Plan Year (including, if applicable,
     Elective Deferrals) shall be determined in accordance with the Adoption
     Agreement, but shall not exceed the maximum amount which shall constitute
     an allowable deduction under section 404(a) of the Code.  Unless otherwise
     specified in the Adoption Agreement, Employer contributions may only be
     made out of Net Profits.  If the Adoption Agreement provides that one or
     more Employer contributions may be made without regard to Net Profits, the
     Plan shall continue to be designed to qualify as a profit sharing plan for
     purposes of the Code.

4.2  Forfeitures

     Unless otherwise specified in the Adoption Agreement, forfeitures, if any,
     will be allocated to Participants' Accounts in the following manner:
     Forfeitures of Employer Discretionary Contribution will be allocated in
     the same manner as are such contributions.  Forfeitures of Matching
     Contributions will be allocated to the Matching Contribution Account in
     the ratio that the Matching Contribution for each Participant bears to the
     sum of all the Matching Contributions for all Participants.

4.3  Employer Discretionary Contributions

     The following provisions shall apply if the Employer has elected in the
     Adoption Agreement to make Employer Discretionary Contributions.

     (a)   If the Plan is not integrated with Social Security, the Employer
     Discretionary Contribution for any Plan Year (and any forfeitures, if
     forfeitures are reallocated to Active Participants in accordance with
     Section 4.2) shall be allocated to the Employer Discretionary Contribution
     Account established for each Active Participant in the ratio in which each
     Active Participant's Compensation for the Plan Year bears to that of all
     Active Participants for such Plan Year.

     (b)   If the Plan is integrated with Social Security:

           (i)  Subject to the overall permitted disparity limits,if under
           Article XIII, the Plan is Top-Heavy for the Plan Year and the minimum
           Top-Heavy contribution is made under the Plan, then Employer
           Discretionary Contributions plus forfeitures shall be allocated to
           the Account of each Participant who either completes more than 500
           Hours of Service during the Plan Year or is employed on the last day
           of the Plan Year as follows:

                Step One: Contributions and forfeitures will be allocated to
                each Participant's Account in the ratio that each Participant's
                total Compensation bears to all Participants' total
                Compensation, but not in excess of 3% of each Participant's
                Compensation.

                Step Two: Any contributions and forfeitures remaining after the
                allocation in Step One will be allocated to each Participant's
                Account in the ratio that each Participant's Compensation for
                the Plan Year in excess of the integration level bears to the
                excess compensation of all Participants, but not in excess of
                3% of each Participant's Compensation.  For purposes of this
                Step Two, in the case of any Participant who has exceeded the
                Cumulative Permitted Disparity Limit described below, such
                Participant's total Compensation for the Plan Year will be taken
                into account.

                Step Three:    Any contributions and forfeitures remaining after
                the allocation in Step Two will be allocated to each
                Participant's Account in the ratio that the sum of each
                Participant's total Compensation and Compensation in excess of
                the Integration Level bears to the sum of all Participants'
                total Compensation and Compensation in excess of the Integration
                Level; however, the allocation cannot exceed the product of (a)
                the Permitted Disparity Percentage specified in the Adoption
                Agreement multiplied by (b) each Participant's total
                Compensation and Compensation in excess of the Integration
                Level.  For purposes of this Step Three, in the case of any
                Participant who has exceeded the Cumulative Permitted Disparity
                Limit described below, two times such Participant's total
                Compensation for the Plan Year will be taken into account.

                Step Four:     Any remaining Employer contributions or
                forfeitures will be allocated to each Participant's Account in
                the ratio that each Participants's total Compensation for the
                Plan Year bears to all Participants' total Compensation for that
                year.

           The Integration Level shall be equal to the Taxable Wage Base or such
           lesser amount elected by the Employer in the Adoption Agreement.

           (ii) Subject to the overall permitted disparity limits,if the Plan
           is not Top- Heavy for the Plan Year, Employer Discretionary
           Contributions plus forfeitures shall be allocated to the Account of
           each Participant who either completes more than 500 Hours of Service
           during the Plan Year or is employed on the last day of the Plan Year
           as follows:

                Step One: Contributions and forfeitures will be allocated to
                each Participant's Account in the ratio that the sum of each
                Participant's total Compensation and Compensation in excess of
                the Integration Level bears to the sum of all Participants'
                total Compensation and Compensation in excess of the Integration
                Level; however, the allocation cannot exceed the product of (a)
                the Permitted Disparity Percentage specified in the Adoption
                Agreement multiplied by (b) each Participant's total
                Compensation and Compensation in excess of the Integration
                Level.  For purposes of this Step One, in the case of any
                Participant who has exceeded the Cumulative Permitted Disparity
                Limit described below, two times such Participant's total
                Compensation for the Plan Year will be taken into account.

                Step Two: Any remaining Employer contributions or forfeitures
                will be allocated to each Participant's Account in the ratio
                that each Participant's total Compensation for the Plan Year
                bears to all Participants' total Compensation for that year.

           The Integration Level shall be equal to the Taxable Wage Base or such
           lesser amount elected by the Employer in the Adoption Agreement.

           Overall Permitted Disparity Limits

           Annual Overall Permitted Disparity Limit: Notwithstanding section
           4.3(b)(i) and (ii) above, for any Plan Year this Plan benefits any
           Participant who benefits under another qualified plan or simplified
           employee pension, as defined in section 408(k) of the Code,
           maintained by the Employer that provides for permitted disparity (or
           imputes disparity), Employer contributions and forfeitures will be
           allocated to the Account of each Participant who either completes
           more than 500 Hours of Service during the Plan Year or who is
           employed on the last day of the Plan Year in the ratio that such
           Participant's total Compensation bears to the total Compensation of
           all Participants.

           Cumulative Permitted Disparity Limit:  Effective for Plan Years
           beginning on or after January 1, 1995, the Cumulative Permitted
           Disparity Limit for a Participant is 35 total cumulative permitted
           disparity years.  Total cumulative permitted years means the number
           of years credited to the Participant for allocation or accrual
           purposes under this Plan, any other qualified plan or simplified
           employer pension plan (whether or not terminated) ever maintained by
           the Employer.  For purposes of determining the Participant's
           cumulative permitted disparity limit, all years ending in the same
           calendar year are treated as the same year.  If the Participant has
           not benefited under a defined benefit or target benefit plan for any
           year beginning on or after January 1, 1994, the Participant has no
           cumulative disparity limit.

4.4  401(k) Cash or Deferred Arrangements ("CODA")/Thrift Contributions

     (1)   Elective Deferrals

           If elected in the Adoption Agreement, the Employer may make
           contributions under a CODA.

           (a)  Allocation of Deferrals.  The Employer shall contribute and
           allocate to each Participant's Elective Deferral Account an amount
           equal to the amount of a Participant's Elective Deferrals.

                (1)  Elective Deferrals Pursuant to a Salary Reduction
                Agreement.  To the extent provided in the Adoption Agreement,
                a Participant may elect to have Elective Deferrals made under
                this Plan.  Elective Deferrals shall include both single-sum and
                continuing contributions made pursuant to a salary reduction
                agreement.

                     (i)  Commencement of Elective Deferrals.  A Participant
                          shall be afforded a reasonable period at least once
                          each calendar year, as specified in the Adoption
                          Agreement, to elect to commence Elective Deferrals.
                          Such election shall become effective as soon as
                          administratively feasible, but not before the time
                          specified in the Adoption Agreement.

                     (ii) Modification and Termination of Elective Deferrals.
                          A Participant's election to commence Elective
                          Deferrals shall remain in effect until modified or
                          terminated.  A Participant shall be afforded a
                          reasonable period at least once each calendar year,
                          as specified in the Adoption Agreement, to modify the
                          amount or frequency of his or her Elective Deferrals.
                          A Participant may terminate his or her election to
                          make Elective Deferrals at any time.

                (2)  Cash bonuses. If permitted in the Adoption Agreement, a
                     Participant may also base Elective Deferrals on cash
                     bonuses that, at the Participant's election, may be
                     contributed to the CODA or received by the Participant in
                     cash.  A Participant shall be afforded a reasonable period
                     at least once a year to elect to defer such amounts to the
                     CODA.  Such election shall become effective as soon as
                     administratively feasible, but not before the time
                     specified in the Adoption Agreement.

                (3)  Elective Deferrals shall be contributed and allocated to
                     the Fund as soon as practicable (but in no event later than
                     90 days) following the close of the applicable pay period.

           (2)  Thrift Contributions

                Starting for Plan Year(s) beginning January 1, 1987, if
                permitted under the Adoption Agreement, Participants may make
                Thrift Contributions which shall be allocated to a Thrift
                Account for each such Participant.

                (a)  A Participant shall always be one hundred percent (100%)
                     vested in his Thrift Account.

                (b)  Unless specified otherwise in the Adoption Agreement,
                     Thrift Contributions shall take effect on the Anniversary
                     Date coincident with or next following the Participant's
                     election to make Thrift Contributions.  Elections to change
                     the amount of the Thrift Contribution shall take effect on
                     the Change Date specified in the Adoption Agreement which
                     is coincident with or next following the date the
                     Participant's election is received by the Committee.
Notwithstanding this provision, a Participant's revocation of an election to
make Thrift Contributions shall take effect as soon as administratively
feasible.

                (c)  Thrift Contributions shall be made to the Fund as soon as
                     practicable (but in no event later than 90 days) following
                     the close of the applicable pay period.

                (d)  Notwithstanding any other provisions of this Section
                     4.4(2), distributions or withdrawals from a Participant's
                     Thrift Account shall be made in accordance with the rules
                     applicable to Voluntary Contributions under Section 10.1
                     However, if the Employer has elected to make Matching
                     Contributions with respect to Thrift Contributions, any
                     Participant who withdraws any amount from his Thrift
                     Account, shall be precluded from making Thrift
                     Contributions until the next permitted Change Date
                     specified in the Adoption Agreement which is at least six
                     (6) months after the date of withdrawal.

                (e)  Thrift Contributions shall be subject to the Contribution
                     Percentage tests and the rules applicable to Excess
                     Aggregate Contributions set forth in Section 4.7.

           (3)  Matching Contributions

                (a)  If elected by the Employer in the Adoption Agreement, the
                     Employer will make Matching Contributions to the Plan.  The
                     amount of such Matching Contributions shall be calculated
                     by reference to each eligible Participant's Elective
                     Deferrals or Thrift Contributions or Combined Contributions
                     as specified by the Employer in the Adoption Agreement.

                (b)  Separate Account.  Matching Contributions shall be
                     allocated to each eligible Participant's Employer Matching
                     Contribution Account.

                (c)  Vesting.  Matching Contributions will be vested in
                     accordance with the Employer's election in the Adoption
                     Agreement and the terms of this plan.  Notwithstanding
                     anything in the Plan to the contrary, Matching
                     Contributions shall be forfeited to the extent they relate
                     to Excess Elective Deferrals, Excess Contributions or
                     Excess Aggregate Contributions, and shall not be taken into
                     account for purposes of Section 4.7(a).

                (d)  Forfeitures.  Forfeitures of Matching Contributions other
                     than Excess Aggregate Contributions shall be made in
                     accordance with the forfeiture provisions pursuant to
                     Section 4.2 of the Plan.

                (e)  Matching Contributions shall be subject to the Contribution
                     Percentage tests and the rules applicable to Excess
                     Aggregate Contributions set forth in Section 4.7.

           (4)  Qualified Matching Contributions

                (a)  If elected by the Employer in the Adoption Agreement, the
                     Employer will make Qualified Matching Contributions to the
                     CODA.  The amount of such Qualified Matching Contributions
                     shall be calculated by reference to each eligible
                     Participant's Elective Deferrals or the Elective Deferral
                     portion of Combined Contributions, as specified in the
                     Adoption Agreement.

                (b)  Separate Account.  Qualified Matching Contributions shall
                     be allocated to each Participant's Qualified Nonelective
                     Contribution Account.

                (c)  Vesting.  Qualified Matching Contributions shall be fully
                     vested and nonforfeitable at all times.

                (d)  Distributions.  Qualified Matching Contributions and income
                     allocable thereto shall be distributable only in accordance
                     with Section 4.10.

           (5)  Qualified Nonelective Contributions

                (a)  The Employer may elect to make Qualified Nonelective
                     Contributions under the Plan on behalf of Employees as
                     provided in the Adoption Agreement.

                     The Qualified Nonelective Contributions will be allocated
                     to each eligible Participant's Qualified Nonelective
                     Contribution Account in the ratio in which each eligible
                     Participant's Compensation for the Plan Year bears to the
                     total Compensation of all eligible Participants for such
                     Plan Year.

                (b)  Separate Account.  Qualified Nonelective Contributions
                     shall be allocated to each Eligible  Participant's
                     Qualified Nonelective Contribution Account.

                (c)  Vesting.  Qualified Nonelective Contributions shall be
                     fully vested and nonforfeitable at all times.

                (d)  Distributions.  Qualified Nonelective Contributions and
                     income allocable thereto shall be distributable only in
                     accordance with Section 4.10.

4.5  Maximum Amount of Elective Deferrals

     (a)   General Rule.  A Participant's Elective Deferrals are subject to any
           limitations imposed in the Adoption Agreement and any further
           limitations under the Plan.  No Participant shall be permitted to
           have Elective Deferrals made under this Plan or any other CODA
           maintained by the Employer or an Affiliated Employer, during any
           calendar year beginning after 1986, in excess of the adjusted dollar
           limitation of section 402(g) of the Code.  Other dollar limitations
           may apply under section 402(g) of the Code to the extent that a
           Participant makes Elective Deferrals to arrangements other than CODAs
           (see also sections 402(h)(1)(B), 403(b), 457, and 501(c)(18) of the
           Code).

     (b)   Distribution of Excess Elective Deferrals.  A Participant may
           allocate to the Plan any Excess Deferrals made during a calendar year
           by notifying the Committee on or before the date specified in the
           Adoption Agreement of the amount of the Excess Elective Deferrals to
           be assigned to the Plan.  A Participant shall be deemed to notify the
           Committee of any Excess Elective Deferrals that arise by taking into
           account only those Elective Deferrals made to this Plan and any other
           plans of the Employer.  Notwithstanding any other provision of the
           Plan, Excess Elective Deferrals, plus any income and minus any loss
           allocable thereto, shall be distributed no later than April 15 to
           Participants to whose accounts Excess Elective Deferrals were
           allocated for the preceding year and who claim Excess Elective
           Deferrals for such taxable year no later than the date specified in
           the Adoption Agreement.

     (c)   Determination of Income or Loss.  Excess Elective Deferrals shall be
           adjusted for income or loss for the taxable year.  Unless indicated
           otherwise by the Committee, the income or loss allocable to Excess
           Elective Deferrals is the income or loss allocable to the
           Participant's Elective Deferral Account for the taxable year
           multiplied by a fraction, the numerator of which is such
           Participant's Excess Elective Deferrals for the year and the
           denominator is the Participant's account balance attributable to
           Elective Deferrals without regard to any income or loss occurring
           during such taxable year.   If the Committee selects another method
           in order to compute the income or loss, the method selected must not
           violate the requirements of Code section 401(a)(4) and must be used
           consistently for all Plan participants and for all corrective
           distributions under the Plan for the taxable year.

4.6  Average Actual Deferral Percentage Tests

     (a)   General Rule.  The Average Actual Deferral Percentage for Eligible
           Participants who are Highly Compensated Employees for each Plan Year
           beginning on or after January 1, 1987 and the Average Actual Deferral
           Percentage for Eligible Participants who are Non-Highly Compensated
           Employees for the same Plan Year must satisfy one of the following
           tests:

           (1)  The Average Actual Deferral Percentage for Eligible Participants
                who are Highly Compensated Employees for the Plan Year shall not
                exceed the Average Actual Deferral Percentage for Eligible
                Participants who are Non-Highly Compensated Employees for the
                Plan Year multiplied by 1.25;

                or

           (2)  The Average Actual Deferral Percentage for Eligible Participants
                who are Highly Compensated Employees for the Plan Year shall not
                exceed the Average Actual Deferral Percentage for Eligible
                Participants who are Non-Highly Compensated Employees for the
                Plan Year multiplied by 2.0, provided that the Average Actual
                Deferral Percentage for Eligible Participants who are Highly
                Compensated Employees does not exceed the Average Actual
                Deferral Percentage for Eligible Participants who are Non-Highly
                Compensated Employees by more than two (2) percentage points.

                (b)  Special Rules.

                     (1)  The Actual Deferral Percentage for any Participant who
                          is a Highly Compensated Employee for the Plan Year and
                          who is eligible to have Elective Deferrals (and, if
                          applicable, Qualified Nonelective Contributions or
                          Qualified Matching Contributions, or both) allocated
                          for his account under two or more CODAs, that are
                          maintained by the Employer, shall be determined as if
                          such Elective Deferrals (and, if applicable, such
                          Qualified Nonelective Contributions and Qualified
                          Matching Contributions, or both) were made under a
                          single arrangement.  If a Highly Compensated Employee
                          participates in two or more CODAs that have different
                          Plan Years, all CODAs ending with or within the same
                          calendar year shall be treated as a single
                          arrangement.

                     (2)  In the event that this Plan satisfies the requirements
                          of sections 401(a)(4), 401(k) or 410(b) of the Code
                          only if aggregated with one or more other plans, or
                          if one or more other plans satisfy the requirements
                          of such sections of the Code only if aggregated with
                          this Plan, then this Section shall be applied by
                          determining the Actual Deferral Percentage of Eligible
                          Participants as if all such plans were a single plan.
                          For Plan Years beginning after December 31, 1989,
                          plans may be aggregated in order to satisfy section
                          401(k) of the Code only if they have the same Plan
                          Year.

                     (3)  For purposes of the Average Actual Deferral Percentage
                          of an Eligible Participant who is a 5 percent owner
                          or one of the 10 most highly-paid Highly Compensated
                          Employees, the Elective Deferrals (and, if applicable,
                          Qualified Nonelective Contributions or Qualified
                          Matching Contributions, or both) and Compensation of
                          such Participant shall include the Elective Deferrals
                          (and, if applicable, Qualified Nonelective
                          Contributions and Qualified Matching Contributions or
                          both), and Compensation for the Plan Year of Family
                          Members.  Family Members, with respect to Highly
                          Compensated Employees, shall be disregarded as
                          separate employees in determining the Actual Deferral
                          Percentage both for Eligible Participants who are
                          Non-Highly Compensated Employees and for Eligible
                          Participants who are Highly Compensated Employees.

                     (4)  Notwithstanding anything in this Plan to the contrary,
                          Qualified Nonelective Contributions and Qualified
                          Matching Contributions used to meet the Average Actual
                          Deferral Percentage tests may be made at any time
                          before the last day of the twelve (12) month period
                          immediately following the Plan Year to which the
                          contributions relate.

                     (5)  The determination and treatment of the Elective
                          Deferrals, Qualified Nonelective Contributions,
                          Qualified Matching Contributions and the Actual
                          Deferral Percentage of any Eligible Participant shall
                          satisfy such other requirements as may be prescribed
                          by the Secretary of the Treasury.

                     (6)  The Employer shall maintain adequate records to
                          demonstrate compliance with the Average Actual
                          Deferral Percentage tests, including the extent to
                          which Qualified Nonelective and Qualified Matching
                          Contributions are taken into account.

                (c)  Distribution of Excess Contributions.  Notwithstanding any
                     other provision of the Plan except Section 4.6(d) below,
                     Excess Contributions, plus any income and minus any loss
                     allocable thereto, shall be distributed no later than the
                     last day of each Plan Year to Participants to whose
                     accounts Excess Contributions were allocated for the
                     preceding Plan Year.  The amount of Excess Contributions
                     to be distributed shall be reduced by the amount of any
                     Excess Contributions recharacterized in accordance with
                     Section 4.6(d) below.  Distributions of Excess
                     Contributions shall be made to Highly Compensated Employees
                     on the basis of the respective portions of the Excess
                     Contributions attributable to each Highly Compensated
                     Employee.  Excess Contributions shall be allocated to
                     Participants who are subject to the family member
                     aggregation rules of section 414(q)(6) of the Code in the
                     manner prescribed by the regulations. [If such excess
                     amounts are not distributed or recharacterized (in
                     accordance with Section 4.6(d) below) within 2-1/2 months
                     after the last day of the Plan Year in which such excess
                     amounts arose, then section 4979 of the Code imposes a ten
                     percent (10%) excise tax on the Employer maintaining the
                     Plan with respect to such amounts.]  Excess Contributions
                     of Participants who are subject to the Family Member
                     aggregation rules described in Section 4.6(b)(3) shall be
                     allocated among the Family Members in proportion to the
                     Elective Deferrals (and amounts treated as Elective
                     Deferrals) of each Family Member that is combined to
                     determine the combined Actual Deferral Percentage.

                     (1)  Determination of Income or Loss.  Excess Contributions
                          shall be adjusted for income or loss for the Plan
                          Year.  Unless indicated otherwise by the Committee,
                          the income or loss allocable to Excess Contributions
                          is the income or loss allocable to the Participant's
                          Elective Deferrals (and, if applicable, Qualified
                          Nonelective Contributions or Qualified Matching
                          Contributions or both) for the Plan Year multiplied
                          by a fraction, the numerator of which is such
                          Participant's Excess Contributions for the year and
                          the denominator is the Participant's account balance
                          attributable to Elective Deferrals (and, if
                          applicable, Qualified Nonelective Contributions or
                          Qualified Matching Contributions or both) without
                          regard to any income or loss occurring during such
                          Plan Year.   If the Committee selects another method
                          in order to compute the income or loss, the method
                          selected must not violate the requirements of Code
                          section 401(a)(4) and must be used consistently for
                          all Plan participants and for all corrective
                          distributions under the Plan for the Plan Year.

                     (2)  Accounting for Excess Contributions.  Excess
                          Contributions shall be distributed first from the
                          Participant's account balance attributable to Elective
                          Deferrals and (to the extent used in the Average
                          Actual Deferral Percentage tests) Qualified Matching
                          Contributions in proportion to the Participant's
                          Elective Deferrals and Qualified Matching
                          Contributions for the Plan Year.  Excess Contributions
                          shall be distributed from the Participant's Qualified
                          Nonelective Contribution Account only to the extent
                          that such Excess Contributions exceed the
                          Participant's account balance attributable to Elective
                          Deferrals and Qualified Matching Contributions.

                (d)  Recharacterization of Excess Contributions.  If the Plan
                     provides for Thrift Contributions by Participants and if
                     permitted in the Adoption Agreement, each Participant to
                     whom Excess Contributions are allocable may elect, in lieu
                     of distribution under Section 4.6(c) above, that all or a
                     portion of such Excess Contributions be recharacterized as
                     Thrift Contributions no later than the later of (i) 2-1/2
                     months after the last day of the Plan Year in which such
                     excess amounts arose or (ii) October 24, 1988.
                     Recharacterization is deemed to occur no earlier than the
                     date the last Highly Compensated Employee is informed in
                     writing of the amount recharacterized and the consequences
                     thereof.

                     In no event may the amount of Excess Contributions
                     recharacterized for any Plan Year exceed the amount of
                     Elective Deferrals for such Plan Year.  Excess
                     Contributions may not be recharacterized as Thrift
                     Contributions to the extent that, in combination with the
                     Thrift Contributions actually made for the Plan Year, they
                     exceed the maximum amount of Thrift Contributions permitted
                     under the Plan (prior to the application of the
                     Contribution Percentage tests of Section 4.7).

                     Recharacterized Excess Contributions shall be treated as
                     Thrift Contributions for purposes of the Contribution
                     Percentage tests of Section 4.7.

                     However, no matching Employer contribution shall be made
                     with respect to Recharacterized Contributions.  In
                     addition, recharacterized Excess Contributions shall be
                     reported to the Internal Revenue Service and the
                     Participant as employee contributions in accordance with
                     such rules as the Internal Revenue Service may prescribe
                     and shall be accounted for as Voluntary Contributions for
                     purposes of sections 72 and 6047 of the Code.
                     Recharacterized Excess Contributions will be taxable to the
                     Participant for the Participant's taxable year in which the
                     Participant would have received them in cash.
                     Recharacterized Excess Contributions will be taxable to the
                     Participant for the Participant's taxable year in which the
                     Participant would have received them in cash.
                     Recharacterized Excess Contributions shall remain
                     non-forfeitable and shall continue to be treated for all
                     other purposes, including the limitations on distributions
                     of section 401(k), the deduction limitations of section 404
                     of the Code, the contribution limitations of section 415
                     of the Code and the top heavy rules of section 416 of the
                     Code, as Elective Deferrals, except that Recharacterized
                     Excess Contributions which relate to Plan Years beginning
                     before January 1, 1989 shall be treated as employee
                     contributions for purposes of section 401(k)(2) of the
                     Code.  Recharacterized Excess Contributions shall be
                     allocated to the Participant's Elective Deferral Account.

4.7  Average Contribution Percentage Tests

     (a)   General Rule.  The Average Contribution Percentage for Eligible
           Participants who are Highly Compensated Employees for each Plan Year
           beginning on or after January 1, 1987 and the Average Contribution
           Percentage for Eligible Participants who are Non-Highly Compensated
           Employees for the same Plan Year must satisfy one of the following
           tests:

           (1)  The Average Contribution Percentage for Eligible Participants
                who are Highly Compensated Employees for the Plan Year shall not
                exceed the Average Contribution Percentage for Eligible
                Participants who are Non-highly Compensated Employees for the
                Plan Year multiplied by 1.25; or

           (2)  The Average Contribution Percentage for Eligible Participants
                who are Highly Compensated Employees for the Plan Year shall not
                exceed the Average Contribution Percentage for Eligible
                Participants who are Non-highly Compensated Employees for the
                Plan Year multiplied by two (2), provided that the Average
                Contribution Percentage for Eligible Participants who are Highly
                Compensated Employees does not exceed the Average Contribution
                Percentage for Eligible Participants who are Non-highly
                Compensated Employees by more than two (2) percentage points.

     (b)   Multiple Use Test.

           (1)  Effective for Plan Years beginning on or after January 1, 1989,
                if one or more Highly Compensated Employees participate in both
                a CODA and a plan subject to the Average Contribution Percentage
                tests maintained by the Employer and the sum of the Average
                Actual Deferral Percentage and Average Contribution Percentage
                of those Highly Compensated Employees subject to either or both
                tests exceeds the "Aggregate Limit" (as defined in (2) below),
                then the Average Contribution Percentage of those Highly
                Compensated Employees who also participate in a CODA will be
                reduced (beginning with such Highly Compensated Employee whose
                Contribution Percentage is the highest) so that the limit is not
                exceeded.  The amount by which each Highly Compensated
                Employee's Contribution Percentage Amounts is reduced shall be
                treated as an Excess Aggregate Contribution.  The Average Actual
                Deferral Percentage and Average Contribution Percentage of the
                Highly Compensated Employees are determined after any
                corrections required to meet the Average Actual Deferral
                Percentage and Average Contribution Percentage tests.
                Notwithstanding the foregoing, the Multiple Use limitations of
                Section 4.7 (b) do not apply if the Average Actual Deferral
                Percentage of Eligible Participants who are Highly Compensated
                Employees does not exceed 1.25 multiplied by the Average Actual
                Deferral Percentage of all other Eligible Participants and the
                Average Contribution Percentage of Eligible Participants who are
                Highly Compensated Employees does not exceed 1.25 multiplied by
                the Average Contribution Percentage of all other Eligible
                Participants.

           (2)  For this purpose, "Aggregate Limit" shall mean the greater of
                the limit produced by (A) or (B) below:

                (A)  the sum of (i) one hundred twenty-five percent (125%) of
                     the greater of the Average Actual Deferral Percentage of
                     the Non-Highly Compensated Employees eligible to
                     participate in the CODA for the Plan Year or the Average
                     Contribution Percentage of the Non-Highly Compensated
                     Employees eligible to participate under the Plan subject
                     to section 401(m) of the Code for the Plan Year beginning
                     with or within the Plan Year of the CODA, and (ii) two (2)
                     plus the lesser of such Average Actual Deferral Percentage
                     or Average Contribution Percentage (however, this amount
                     shall not exceed two hundred percent (200%) of the lesser
                     such Average Actual Deferral Percentage or Average
                     Contribution Percentage).

                (B)  the sum of (i) one hundred twenty-five percent (125%) of
                     the lesser of the Average Actual Deferral Percentage of the
                     Non-Highly Compensated Employees eligible to participate
                     in the CODA for the Plan Year or the Average Contribution
                     Percentage of the Non-Highly Compensated Employees eligible
                     to participate under the Plan subject section 401(m) of the
                     Code for the Plan Year beginning with or within the Plan
                     Year of the CODA, and (ii) two (2) plus the greater of such
                     Average Actual Deferral Percentage or Average Contribution
                     Percentage  (however, this amount shall not exceed two
                     hundred percent (200%) of the greater of such Average
                     Actual Deferral Percentage or Average Contribution
                     Percentage).

     (c)   Special Rules.

           (1)  For purposes of this Section 4.7, the Contribution Percentage
                for any Participant who is a Highly Compensated Employee and who
                is eligible to have Contribution Percentage Amounts allocated
                to his account under two or more Plans described in section
                401(a) of the Code, or CODAs, that are maintained by the
                Employer or an Affiliated Employer, shall be determined as if
                the total of such Contribution Percentage Amounts was made under
                each Plan.  If a Highly Compensated Employee participates in two
                or more CODAs that have different Plan Years, all CODAs ending
                with or within the same calendar year shall be treated as a
                single arrangement.

           (2)  In the event that this Plan satisfies the requirements of
                sections 401(a)(4), 401(m) or 410(b) of the Code only if
                aggregated with one or more other plans, or if one or more other
                plans satisfy the requirements of such sections of the Code only
                if aggregated with this Plan, then this Section shall be applied
                by determining the Contribution Percentages of Participants as
                if all such plans were a single plan.  For Plan Years beginning
                after December 31, 1989, plans may be aggregated in order to
                satisfy section 401(m) of the Code only if they have the same
                Plan Year.

           (3)  For purposes of determining the Contribution Percentage of an
                Eligible Participant who is a 5-percent owner or one of the 10
                most highly-paid Highly Compensated Employees, the Contribution
                Percentage Amounts and Compensation of such Participant shall
                include the Contribution Percentage Amounts and Compensation for
                the Plan Year of Family Members.  Family Members, with respect
                to Highly Compensated Employees, shall be disregarded as
                separate employees in determining the Average Contribution
                Percentage both for Eligible Participants who are Non-Highly
                Compensated Employees and for Eligible Participants who are
                Highly Compensated Employees.

           (4)  For purposes of the Contribution Percentage tests, Voluntary
                Contributions and Thrift Contributions are considered to have
                been made in the Plan Year in which contributed to the Fund.
                Notwithstanding anything in this Plan to the contrary, Matching
                Contributions will be considered made for a Plan Year if
                allocated to such year and made no later than the end of the
                twelve (12) month period beginning on the day after the close
                of the Plan Year.

           (5)  The determination and treatment of the Contribution Percentage
                of any Participant shall satisfy such other requirements as may
                be prescribed by the Secretary of the Treasury.

           (6)  The Employer shall maintain adequate records to demonstrate
                compliance with the Average Contribution Percentage tests.

     (d)   Distribution of Excess Aggregate Contributions.  Notwithstanding any
           other provision of this Plan, Excess Aggregate Contributions, plus
           any income and minus any loss allocable thereto, shall be forfeited,
           if forfeitable, or if not forfeitable, distributed no later than the
           last day of each Plan Year to Participants to whose accounts such
           Excess Aggregate Contributions were allocated for the preceding Plan
           Year. [If such excess amounts are distributed more than 2-1/2 months
           after the last day of the Plan Year in which such excess amounts
           arose, then section 4979 of the Code imposes a ten percent (10%)
           excise tax on the Employer maintaining the Plan with respect to such
           amounts].  Excess Aggregate Contributions of Participants who are
           subject to the Family Member aggregation rules described in Section
           4.7(c)(3) shall be allocated among the Family Members in proportion
           to the Thrift Contributions, Voluntary Contributions, and Matching
           Contributions (or amounts treated as Matching Contributions) of each
           Family Member that is combined to determine the combined Actual
           Contribution Percentage.

           (1)  Determination of Income or Loss.  The Excess Aggregate
                Contributions shall be adjusted for income or loss for the Plan
                Year.  Unless indicated otherwise by the Committee, the income
                or loss allocable to Excess Aggregate Contributions is the
                income or loss allocable to the Participant's Voluntary
                Contribution Account, Thrift Account and Employer Matching
                Contribution Account for the Plan Year multiplied by a fraction,
                the numerator of which is such Participant's Excess Aggregate
                Contributions for the year and the denominator is the
                Participant's account balance(s) attributable to Contribution
                Percentage Amounts without regard to any income or loss
                occurring during such Plan Year.  If the Committee selects
                another method in order to compute the income or loss, the
                method selected must not violate the requirements of Code
                section 401(a)(4) and must be used consistently for all Plan
                participants and for all corrective distributions under the Plan
                for the Plan Year.

           (2)  Treatment of Forfeitures.  Forfeitures of Excess Aggregate
                Contributions shall be allocated to Participants' Accounts or
                applied to reduce Employer contributions, as elected by the
                Employer in the Adoption Agreement, under Section 4.2.  If
                forfeitures are reallocated to the accounts of Participants
                under Section 4.2, forfeitures of Excess Aggregate Contributions
                shall be allocated in the same manner as Matching Contributions,
                except that no such forfeitures shall be allocated to any Highly
                Compensated Employee.

           (3)  The determination of the Excess Aggregate Contributions shall
                be made after first determining the Excess Elective Deferrals
                pursuant to Section 4.5, and then determining the Excess
                Contributions pursuant to Section 4.6.

4.8  Non-Hardship Withdrawals

     (a)   If Employer Discretionary Contributions are not integrated with
           Social Security and a Participant's Employer Discretionary
           Contributions and Matching Contribution Accounts are 100% vested at
           the time of distribution, and if permitted by the Adoption Agreement,
           a Participant may make withdrawals from his Employer Discretionary
           Contributions and Matching Contribution Accounts, for any reason,
           after attainment of age fifty-nine and one-half (59-1/2).

     (b)   If permitted by the Adoption Agreement, a Participant may make
           withdrawals from his Elective Deferral Account or Qualified
           Nonelective Contribution Account, for any reason, after attainment
           of age fifty-nine and one-half (59-1/2).

     (c)   A withdrawal under (a) or (b) above may be made at such time as the
           Committee shall designate, but not more than quarterly during a Plan
           Year provided that no single withdrawal shall be less than five
           hundred dollars ($500) and a withdrawal by a Participant prior to his
           separation from service may never exceed the smaller of the actual
           amount contributed to the account or the adjusted value of the
           account.

     (d)   If the Plan is subject to the Automatic Annuity Rules of Section 8.2,
           the written consent of the Participant's spouse (consistent with the
           requirements for a Qualified Election under Section 8.2) must be
           obtained with respect to any withdrawal.

4.9  Distribution on Account of Financial Hardship

     (a)   If elected by the Employer in the Adoption Agreement, distributions
           may be made from a Participant's Elective Deferral, Qualified
           Nonelective Contribution Account, vested portion of the Participant's
           Employer Discretionary Contribution Account, or the vested portion
           of the Employer Matching Contribution Account on account of financial
           hardship if the distribution is necessary in light of the immediate
           and heavy financial needs of the Participant.

           Effective for Plan Years beginning on or after January 1, 1989,
           distributions on account of financial hardship with respect to
           Elective Deferrals shall be limited to the amount of the
           Participant's Elective Deferrals and income allocable to such
           contributions credited to the Participant's Elective Deferral Account
           as of the end of the last Plan Year ending before July 1, 1989;
           neither the income allocable to Elective Deferrals credited to a
           Participant's Elective Deferral Account after the end of the last
           Plan Year ending before July 1, 1989 nor a Participant's Qualified
           Non-elective Contribution Account shall be available for such
           distributions.

     (b)   A distribution on account of financial hardship shall not exceed the
           amount required to meet the immediate financial need created by the
           hardship.  With respect to the Elective Deferral Account, and the
           Qualified Nonelective Contribution Account, the determination of the
           existence of financial hardship, and the amount required to meet the
           immediate financial need created by the hardship shall be made by the
           Committee, in accordance with the criteria specified in (c) below.

           With respect to the Employer Discretionary Contribution Account and
           the Employer Matching Contribution Account, the determination of the
           existence of financial hardship, and the amount required to meet the
           immediate financial need created by the hardship shall be made by the
           Committee, in accordance with the criteria specified in (d) below.

           If the Plan is subject to the Automatic Annuity Rules of Section 8.2,
           the written consent of the Participant's spouse (consistent with the
           requirements for a Qualified Election under Section 8.2) must be
           obtained with respect to any withdrawal on account of financial
           hardship.

           The Committee shall establish written procedures specifying the
           requirements for distributions on account of hardship, including the
           forms to be submitted.  Distributions of amounts under this Section
           shall be made as soon as administratively feasible.

     (c)   (1)  Immediate and Heavy Financial Need.  Hardship distributions will
                be allowed only on account of:

           (i)  Expenses for medical care (described in section 213(d) of
                the Code) incurred by the Employee, the Employee's spouse,
                 or any dependents of the Employee (as defined in section 152
                of the Code) or necessary for these persons to obtain such care;

           (ii) Purchase (excluding mortgage payments) of a principal residence
                for the Employee;

                (iii)     Payment of tuition and related educational fees for
                          the next 12 months of post-secondary education for the
                          Employee, the Employee's spouse, children or
                          dependents;


                (iv) The need to prevent the eviction of the Employee from his
                     principal residence or foreclosure on the mortgage of the
                     Employee's principal residence; or

                (v)  Such other financial need which the Commissioner of
                     Internal Revenue, through the publication of revenue
                     rulings, notices and other documents of general
                     applicability, deems to be immediate and heavy.

           (2)  Distribution Necessary to Satisfy Financial Need.  A
                distribution shall not be made on account of a financial need
                unless all of the following requirements are satisfied:

                (i)  The distribution is not in excess of the amount of the
                     immediate and heavy financial need  (including amounts
                     necessary to pay any federal, state or local income taxes
                     or penalties reasonably anticipated to result from the
                     distribution) of the Employee;

                (ii) The Employee has obtained all distributions, other than
                     hardship distributions, and all nontaxable loans currently
                     available under all plans maintained by the Employer;

                     (iii)     Elective contributions and employee contributions
                               under this Plan and all other qualified and
                               nonqualified deferred compensation plans
                               maintained by the Employer (other than mandatory
                               contributions to a defined benefit plan) shall
                               be suspended for at least twelve (12) months
                               after receipt of the hardship distribution.  For
                               this purpose, the phrase "qualified and
                               nonqualified deferred compensation plans"
                               includes stock option, stock purchase and similar
                               plans, and cash or deferred arrangements under
                               a cafeteria plan, within the meaning of Section
                               125 of the Code.  It does not include health or
                               welfare benefit plans; and

                (iv) The Plan, and all other plans maintained by the Employer,
                     provide that the Employee may not make elective
                     contributions for the Employee's taxable year immediately
                     following the taxable year of the hardship distribution in
                     excess of the applicable limit under section 402(g) of the
                     Code for such next taxable year less the amount of such
                     Employee's elective contributions for the taxable year of
                     the hardship distribution.
                     An Employee shall not fail to be treated as an Eligible
                     Participant for purposes of the Actual Deferral Percentage
                     tests of Section 4.6 merely because his Elective Deferrals
                     are suspended in accordance with this provision.

     (d)   Immediate and Heavy Financial Need.  The determination of whether an
           immediate and heavy financial need exists shall be made by the
           Committee in a uniform and nondiscriminatory manner.  The criteria
           may include the events described in Section 4.9(c) of this plan.

     (e)   If a distribution is made pursuant to this Section when the
           Participant has a nonforfeitable right to less than 100 percent of
           his Account balance derived from contributions made by the Employer
           and the Participant may increase the nonforfeitable percentage in the
           account:

           (1)  A separate account will be established for the Participant's
                interest in the Plan as of the time of the distribution, and

           (2)  At any relevant time the Participant's nonforfeitable portion
                of the separate account will be equal to an amount ("X")
                determined by the formula:

                     X = P(AB + (R x D)) - (R x D)

     For purposes of applying the formula: P is the nonforfeitable percentage
     at the relevant time, D is the amount of the distribution and R is the
     ratio of the Account balance AB at the relevant time to the Account
     balance after distribution.

4.10 Special Distribution Rules

           Except as provided in the Adoption Agreement, Elective Deferrals,
           Qualified Nonelective Contributions, Qualified Matching Contributions
           and income allocable thereto are not distributable to the
           Participant, or the Participant's Beneficiary, in accordance with the
           Participant's or Beneficiary's election, earlier than upon separation
           from service, death, or Total and Permanent Disability.  Distribution
           (if elected in the Adoption Agreement) upon termination of the Plan
           without the establishment or maintenance of a successor plan, the
           Employer's sale of substantially all of the assets of a trade or
           business or the sale of the Employer's interest in a subsidiary may
           only be made, after March 31, 1988, in a lump sum distribution within
           the meaning of section 401(k)(10)(B) of the Code.

           Unless the Plan is a Profit Sharing Plan exempt from the Automatic
           Annuity rules of Section 8.2 pursuant to Section 8.3, all
           distributions that may be made pursuant to one or more of the
           foregoing distributable events are subject to the spousal and
           Participant consent requirements contained in sections 401(a)(11) and
           417 of the Code.



                                  ARTICLE V.
               CONTRIBUTIONS AND CREDITS TO TARGET BENEFIT PLANS


                 [All provisions regarding target benefit plan
                  contributions are in the Adoption Agreement
                   for Dreyfus Standardized Prototype Target
                           Benefit Plan No. 01004].



                                   ARTICLE VI.
                      CONTRIBUTION AND ALLOCATION LIMITS

6.1  Timing of Contributions

     Contributions under Sections 3.1, 4.1, 4.4(3), 4.4(4), 4.4(5) and 5.1
     shall be made no later than the time prescribed by law (including any
     extensions thereof) for filing the Employer's federal income tax return
     for the Plan Year for which they are made.

6.2  Deductibility of Contributions

     All contributions made by an Employer shall be conditioned upon their
     deductibility by the Employer for income tax purposes; provided, however,
     that no contributions shall be returned to an Employer except as provided
     in Section 6.3.

6.3  Return of Employer Contributions

     Notwithstanding any other provision of this Plan, contributions made by
     an Employer may be returned to such Employer if:

     (a)   the contribution was made by reason of a mistake of fact and is
           returned to the Employer within one year of the mistaken
           contribution, or

     (b)   the contribution was conditioned upon its deductibility by the
           Employer for income tax purposes, the deduction was disallowed and
           the contribution is returned to the Employer within one year after
           the disallowance of the deduction, or

     (c)   the contribution was conditioned upon initial qualification of the
           Plan, the Plan was submitted to the Internal Revenue Service for a
           determination as to its initial qualification within the time
           prescribed by law for filing the Employer's return for the taxable
           year in which the Plan was adopted or such later date as the
           Secretary of the Treasury may prescribe, the Plan received an adverse
           determination, and the contribution is returned to the Employer
           within one year after the date of the adverse determination.

     Employer contributions may be returned even if such contributions have
     been allocated to a Participant's Account which is fully or partially
     nonforfeitable and it is necessary to adjust said Account to reflect the
     return of the Employer contributions.  The amount which may be returned
     to the Employer is the excess of the amount contributed over the amount
     that would have been contributed had there not occurred the circumstances
     causing the excess.  Earnings attributable to the excess contribution may
     not be returned to the Employer, but losses thereto shall reduce the
     amount to be so returned.  Furthermore, if the withdrawal of the amount
     attributable to the excess contribution would cause the balance of the
     individual Account of any Participant to be reduced to less than the
     balance which would have been in the Account had the excess amount not
     been contributed, then the amount to be returned to the Employer shall be
     limited to avoid such reduction.

6.4  Limitation on Allocations:

     (a)   If the Participant does not participate in, and has never
           participated in another qualified plan or a welfare benefit fund, as
           defined in section 419(e) of the Code, maintained by the Employer,
           or an individual medical benefit account, as defined in section
           415(l)(2) of the Code, maintained by the Employer, or a simplified
           employee pension, as defined in section 408(k) of the Code,
           maintained by the Employer which provides an Annual Addition, the
           amount of Annual Additions which may be credited to the Participant's
           Accounts for any Limitation Year will not exceed the lesser of the
           Maximum Permissible Amount or any other limitation contained in this
           Plan.  If the Employer contribution that would otherwise be
           contributed or allocated to the Participant's Accounts would cause
           the Annual Additions for the Limitation Year to exceed the Maximum
           Permissible Amount, the amount contributed or allocated will be
           reduced so that the Annual Additions for the Limitation Year will
           equal the Maximum Permissible Amount.

     (b)   Prior to the determination of the Participant's actual Compensation
           for a Limitation Year, the Maximum Permissible Amount may be
           determined on the basis of the Participant's estimated annual
           compensation for such Limitation Year.  Such estimated annual
           compensation shall be determined on a reasonable basis and shall be
           uniformly determined for all Participants similarly situated.

     (c)   As soon as administratively feasible after the end of the Limitation
           Year, the Maximum Permissible Amount for such Limitation Year shall
           be determined on the basis of the Participant's actual Compensation
           for such Limitation Year.

     (d)   If, pursuant to Subsection (c) above or as a result of the allocation
           of forfeitures, there is an Excess Amount with respect to a
           Participant for a Limitation Year, such Excess Amount shall be
           disposed of as follows:

           (1)  First, any  deferrals made pursuant to a salary reduction
                agreement or other deferral mechanism and Thrift/Voluntary
                Employee contributions, to the extent that the return would
                reduce the Excess Amount, shall be returned to the Participant.

           (2)  Unless otherwise specified in the Adoption Agreement, if after
                the application of paragraph (1) an Excess Amount still exists,
                and the Participant is covered by the Plan at the end of the
                Limitation Year, the Excess Amount in the Participant's Accounts
                will be used to reduce Employer contributions (including any
                allocation of forfeitures) for such Participant in the next
                Limitation Year, and each succeeding Limitation Year if
                necessary.
           (3)  If after the application of paragraph (1) an Excess Amount still
                exists, and the Participant is not covered by the Plan at the
                end of the Limitation Year, the Excess Amount will be held
                unallocated in a suspense account.  The suspense account will
                be applied to reduce future Employer contributions (including
                allocation of any forfeitures) for all remaining Participants
                in the next Limitation Year, and each succeeding Limitation Year
                if necessary;

           (4)  If a suspense account is in existence at any time during the
                Limitation Year pursuant to this Section, it will not
                participate in the allocation of the Trust's investment gains
                and losses.  If a suspense account is in existence at any time
                during a particular Limitation Year, all amounts in the suspense
                account must be allocated and reallocated to Participants'
                Accounts before any Employer or any employee contributions may
                be made to the Plan for that Limitation Year.  Excess Amounts
                may not be distributed to Participants or former Participants.

     (e)   Subsections (e), (f), (g), (h), (i) and (j) apply if, in addition to
           this Plan, the Participant is covered under another qualified master
           or prototype defined contribution plan maintained by the Employer or
           a welfare benefit fund, as defined in section 419(e) of the Code,
           maintained by the Employer or an individual medical benefit account,
           as defined in section 415(l)(2) of the Code, maintained by the
           Employer, or a simplified employee pension maintained by the Employer
           which provides an Annual Addition, during any Limitation Year.  The
           Annual Additions which may be credited to a Participant's Accounts
           under this Plan for any such Limitation Year will not exceed the
           Maximum Permissible Amount reduced by the Annual Additions credited
           to a Participant's account under the other qualified  master or
           prototype defined contribution plans, welfare benefit funds,
           individual medical accounts, and simplified employee pensions for the
           same Limitation Year.  If the Annual Additions with respect to the
           Participant under other qualified master or prototype defined
           contribution plans, welfare benefit funds,  individual medical
           accounts, and simplified employee pensions maintained by the Employer
           are less than the Maximum Permissible Amount and the Employer
           contribution that would otherwise be contributed or allocated to the
           Participant's Accounts under this Plan would cause the Annual
           Additions for the Limitation Year to exceed this limitation, the
           amount contributed or allocated will be reduced so that the Annual
           Additions under such plans and welfare benefit funds for the
           Limitation Year will equal the Maximum Permissible Amount. If the
           Annual Additions with respect to the Participant under such other
           qualified master or prototype defined contribution plans, and welfare
           benefit funds, individual medical accounts, and simplified employee
           pensions in the aggregate are equal to or greater than the Maximum
           Permissible Amount, no amount will be contributed or allocated to the
           Participant's Accounts under this Plan for the Limitation Year.

     (f)   Prior to determining the Participant's actual Compensation for the
           Limitation Year, the Employer may determine the Maximum Permissible
           Amount based on the Participant's estimated annual compensation in
           the manner described in Subsection (b).

     (g)   As soon as administratively feasible after the end of the Limitation
           Year, the Maximum Permissible Amount for such Limitation Year shall
           be determined on the basis of the Participant's actual Compensation
           for such Limitation Year.

     (h)   If pursuant to Subsection (g) above or as a result of the allocation
           of forfeitures, a Participant's Annual Additions under this Plan and
           all such other plans result in an Excess Amount for a Limitation
           Year, the Excess Amount will be deemed to consist of the Annual
           Additions last allocated, except that Annual Additions attributable
           to a simplified employee pension will be deemed to have been
           allocated first, followed by Annual Additions to a welfare benefit
           fund or individual medical account, regardless of the actual
           allocation date.

     (i)   If an Excess Amount was allocated to a Participant on an allocation
           date of this Plan which coincides with an allocation date of another
           plan, the Excess Amount attributed to this Plan will be the product
           of:

           (1)  the total Excess Amount allocated as of such date, times,

           (2)  the ratio of (A) the Annual Additions allocated to the
                Participant for the Limitation Year as of such date under this
                Plan, to (B) the total Annual Additions allocated to the
                Participant for the Limitation Year as of such date under this
                Plan and all other qualified Master and Prototype defined
                contribution plans.

     (j)   Any Excess Amounts attributed to this Plan shall be disposed of as
           provided in Subsection (d).

     (k)   If the Participant is covered under another qualified defined
           contribution plan maintained by the Employer which is not a Master
           or Prototype plan, Annual Additions which may be credited to the
           Participant's Accounts under this Plan for any Limitation Year will
           be limited in accordance with Subsections (e), (f), (g), (h), (i) and
           (j) as though the other plan were a Master or Prototype plan unless
           the Employer provides other limitations in the Adoption Agreement.

     (l)   If the Employer maintains, or at any time maintained, a qualified
           defined benefit plan (other than the Sponsor's paired plan number
           02001, covering any Participant in this Plan, the sum of the
           Participant's Defined Benefit Fraction and Defined Contribution
           Fraction will not exceed one (1.0) in any Limitation Year.  Unless
           the Employer elects otherwise in the Adoption Agreement, this
           limitation will be met by freezing or reducing the rate of benefit
           accrual under the qualified defined benefit plan.
     (m)   For purposes of this Section 6.4, the following definitions shall
           apply:

           (1)  "Annual Additions" shall mean the sum of the following credited
                to a Participant's account for the Limitation Year:

                (A)  All Employer contributions,

                (B)  All forfeitures, and

                (C)  All Employee contributions.

                All excess deferrals as described in section 402(g) of the Code,
                all excess contributions as defined in section 401(k)(8)(B) of
                the Code, (including amounts recharacterized), and all excess
                aggregate contributions as defined in section 401(m)(6)(B) of
                the Code, regardless of whether such amounts are distributed or
                forfeited, shall continue to be treated as Annual Additions.

                For purposes of the above, amounts reapplied to reduce Employer
                contributions under Subsections (d) and (j) shall also be
                included as Annual Additions.

                Amounts allocated, after March 31, 1984, to an individual
                medical benefit account, as defined in section 415(l)(2) of the
                Code, which is part of a pension or annuity plan maintained by
                the Employer, are treated as Annual Additions to a defined
                contribution plan.  Also, amounts derived from contributions
                paid or accrued after December 31, 1985, in taxable years ending
                after such date, which are attributable to post-retirement
                medical benefits allocated to the separate account of a Key
                Employee, as defined in section 419A(d)(3) of the Code, under
                a welfare benefit fund, as defined in section 419(e) of the
                Code, maintained by the Employer, are treated as Annual
                Additions to a defined contribution plan, and allocations under
                a simplified employee pension.

     (2)   Unless specified otherwise in the Adoption Agreement, for purposes
           of this Section, Compensation shall have the same meaning as
           described in Section 1.15 of the Plan.  One of the following
           definitions of Compensation may be  elected by the employer in the
           Adoption Agreement.

                (1)  Information required to be reported under section 6041,
                     6051, and 6052, (Wages, Tips and Other Compensation Box on
                     Form W-2). Compensation defined as wages as defined in
                     section 3401(a) and all other payments of compensation to
                     an employee by the employer (in the course of the
                     employer's trade or business) for which the employer is
                     required to furnish the employee a written statement under
                     section 6041(d) and 6051(a)(3) of the Code.  Compensation
                     must be determined without regard to any rules under
                     section 3401(a) that limit the remuneration included in
                     wages based on the nature or location of the employment or
                     the services performed (such as the exception for
                     agricultural labor in section 3401(a)(2)).

                (2)  Section 3401(a) wages.  Compensation is defined as wages
                     within the meaning of section 3401(a) for the purposes of
                     income tax withholding at the source but determined without
                     regard to any rules that limit the remuneration included
                     in wages based on the nature or location of the employment
                     or the services performed (such as the exception for
                     agricultural labor in section 3401(a)(2).

                (3)  415 safe-harbor compensation.  Compensation is defined as
                     wages, salaries, and fees for professional services and
                     other amounts received (without regard to whether or not
                     an amount is paid in cash) for personal services actually
                     rendered int he course of employment with the employer
                     maintaining the plan to the extent that the amounts are
                     includable in gross income (including, but not limited to,
                     commissions paid salesmen, compensation for services on the
                     basis of percentage of profits, commissions on insurance
                     premiums, tips, bonuses, fringe benefits, and
                     reimbursements or other expense allowances under a
                     nonaccountable plan (as described in 1.62-2(c)), and
                     excluding the following:

                     (a)  Employer contributions to a plan of deferred
                          compensation which are not includable in the
                          employee's gross income for the taxable year in which
                          contributed, or employer contributions under a
                          simplified employee pension plan to the extent such
                          contributions are deductible by the employee, or any
                          distributions from a plan of deferred compensation;

                     (b)  Amounts realized from the exercise of a non-qualified
                          stock option, or when restricted stock (or property)
                          held by the employee either becomes freely
                          transferable or is no longer subject to a substantial
                          risk of forfeiture;

                     (c)  Amounts realized from the sale, exchange or other
                          disposition of stock acquired under a qualified stock
                          option; and

                     (d)  Other amounts which received special tax benefits, or
                          contributions made by the employer (whether or not
                          under a salary reduction agreement) towards the
                          purchase of an annuity contract described in section
                          403(b) of the Code (whether or not the contributions
                          are actually excludable from the gross income of the
                          employee).
                For any self-employed individual compensation will mean
                earned income.

                For limitation years beginning after December 31, 1991, for
                purposes of applying the limitations of this article,
                compensation for a limitation year is the compensation actually
                paid or made available during such limitation year.

                Notwithstanding the preceding sentence, compensation for a
                participant in a defined contribution plan who is permanently
                and totally disabled (as defined in section 22(e)(3) of the
                Internal Revenue Code) is the compensation such participant
                would have received for the limitation year if the participant
                had been paid at the rate of compensation paid immediately
                before becoming permanently and totally disabled; such imputed
                compensation for the disabled participant may be taken into
                account only if the participant is not a highly compensated
                employee (as defined in section 414(q) of the Code) and
                contributions made on behalf of such participant are
                nonforfeitable when made.

                (3)  "Defined Benefit Fraction" shall mean a fraction, the
                     numerator of which is the sum of the Participant's
                     Projected Annual Benefits under all the defined benefit
                     plans (whether or not terminated) maintained by the
                     Employer, and the denominator of which is the lesser of one
                     hundred twenty-five percent (125%) of the dollar limitation
                     determined for the Limitation Year under sections 415(b)
                     and (d) of the Code or one hundred forty percent (140%) of
                     the Highest Average Compensation (which shall mean the
                     average compensation for the three consecutive years of
                     Service with the Employer that produces the highest
                     average), including any adjustments under section 415(b)
                     of the Code.  A year of Service with the Employer is the
                     twelve (12) consecutive month period defined in Section
                     1.54 of the Plan.

                Notwithstanding the above, if the Participant was a Participant
                as of the first day of the first Limitation Year beginning after
                December 31, 1986, in one or more defined benefit plans
                maintained by the Employer which were in existence on May 6,
                1986, the denominator of this fraction will not be less than one
                hundred twenty five percent (125%) of the sum of the annual
                benefits under such plans which the Participant had accrued as
                of the close of the last Limitation Year beginning before
                January 1, 1987, disregarding any changes in the terms and
                conditions of the Plan after May 5, 1986.  The preceding
                sentence applies only if the defined benefit plans individually
                and in the aggregate satisfied the requirements of section 415
                of the Code for all Limitation Years beginning before January
                1, 1987.

                (4)  "Defined Contribution Fraction" shall mean a fraction, the
                     numerator of which is the sum of the Annual Additions to
                     the Participant's Account under all the defined
                     contribution plans (whether or not terminated) maintained
                     by the Employer for the current and all prior Limitation
                     Years (including the Annual Additions attributable to the
                     Participant's nondeductible Voluntary Contributions to all
                     defined benefit plans, whether or not terminated,
                     maintained by the Employer and the Annual Additions
                     attributable to all welfare benefit funds, as defined in
                     section 419(e) of  the Code, and individual medical benefit
                     accounts as defined in section 415(l)(2) of the Code, and
                     simplified employee pensions, maintained by the Employer)
                     and the denominator of which is the sum of the Maximum
                     Aggregate Amounts for the current and all prior Limitation
                     Years of Service with the Employer (regardless of whether
                     a defined contribution plan was maintained by the
                     Employer).  The Maximum Aggregate Amount in any Limitation
                     Year is the lesser of one hundred twenty-five percent
                     (125%) of the dollar limitation in effect under section
                     415(c)(1)(A) of the Code or thirty-five percent (35%) of
                     the Participant's Compensation for such year.

                If the Employee was a Participant as of the end of the first day
                of the first Limitation Year beginning after December 31, 1986,
                in one or more defined contribution plans maintained by the
                Employer which were in existence on May 6, 1986, the numerator
                of this fraction will be adjusted if the sum of this fraction
                and the Defined Benefit Fraction would otherwise exceed one
                (1.0) under the terms of this Plan.  Under the adjustment, an
                amount equal to the product of (A) the excess of the sum of the
                fractions over one (1.0) times (B) the denominator of this
                fraction, will be permanently subtracted from the numerator of
                this fraction.  The adjustment is calculated as of the end of
                the last Limitation Year beginning before January 1, 1987, and
                disregarding any changes in the terms and conditions of the Plan
                made after May 5, 1986, but using the section 415 limitation
                applicable to the first Limitation Year beginning on or after
                January 1, 1987.

                The Annual Additions for any Limitation Year beginning before
                January 1, 1987 shall not be recomputed to treat all Employee
                contributions as Annual Additions.

           (5)  "Employer" shall mean the Employer that adopts this Plan and all
                members of a controlled group of corporations (as defined in
                section 414(b) of the Code and as modified by section 415(h) of
                the Code) which includes the Employer; any trade or business
                (whether or not incorporated) which is under common control (as
                defined in section 414(c) and as modified by section 415(h) of
                the Code) with the Employer; any organization (whether or not
                incorporated) which is a member of an affiliated service group
                (as defined in section 414(m)); and any other entity required
                to be aggregated with the Employer under Section 414(o) ofthe
                Code.

           (6)  "Excess Amount" shall mean the excess of the Participant's
                Annual Additions for the Limitation Year over the Maximum
                Permissible Amount.

           (7)  "Limitation Year" shall mean the calendar year, unless another
                twelve (12) consecutive month period is elected in the Adoption
                Agreement.  All qualified plans maintained by the Employer must
                use the same Limitation Year.  If the Limitation Year is changed
                by amendment, the new Limitation Year must begin on a date
                within the Limitation Year in which the amendment is made.

           (8)  "Master or Prototype Plan" shall mean a plan the form of which
                is the subject of a favorable opinion letter from the Internal
                Revenue Service.

           (9)  "Maximum Permissible Amount" shall mean the lesser of:

                (A)  thirty-thousand dollars ($30,000) (or, if greater,
                     one-fourth (1/4th) of the defined benefit dollar limitation
                     set forth in section 415(b)(1) of the Code as in effect for
                     the Limitation Year), or

                (B)  twenty-five percent (25%) of the Participant's Compensation
                     for the Limitation Year.

                The compensation limitation referred to in paragraph (B) above
                shall not apply to any contribution for medical benefits (within
                the meaning of section 401(h) or section 419A(f)(2) of the Code)
                which is otherwise treated as an Annual Addition under section
                415(l)(1) or 419A(d)(2) of the Code.

                If a short Limitation Year is created because of an amendment
                changing the Limitation Year to a different twelve (12)
                consecutive month period, the Maximum Permissible Amount will
                not exceed the defined contribution dollar limitation set forth
                in paragraph (A) above multiplied by the following fraction:

                     Number of Months in the Short Limitation Year
                                    12

           (10) "Projected Annual Benefit" shall mean the annual retirement
                benefit (adjusted to an actuarial equivalent straight life
                annuity if such benefit is expressed in a form other than a
                straight life annuity or Qualified Joint and Survivor Annuity)
                to which the Participant would be entitled under the terms of
                the Plan assuming:

                (A)  The Participant will continue employment until the Normal
                     Retirement Date under the Plan (or current date, if later)
                     and

                (B)  the Participant's Compensation for the current Limitation
                     Year and all other relevant factors used to determine
                     benefits under the Plan will remain constant for all future
                     Limitation Years.

6.5  Separate Accounts

     The Committee shall maintain the following separate Accounts, as are
     applicable, with respect to each Participant:

     (a)   a Regular Account (as described in Article III),

     (b)   an Elective Deferral Account (as described in Article IV),

     (c)   a Qualified Nonelective Contribution Account (as described in Article
           IV),

     (d)   a Thrift Account (as described in Article IV),

     (e)   a Matching Contribution Account (as described in Article IV),

     (f)   a Voluntary Account (as described in Article X),

     (g)   a Voluntary Tax-Deductible Account (as described in Article X),

     (h)   a Rollover Account (as described in Article X),

     (i)   an Employer Discretionary Contribution Account (as described in
           Article IV), and

     (j)   a Transfer Account (as described in Article X).

     Each such Account shall be credited with the applicable contributions,
     forfeitures, earnings losses, expenses, and distributions.  The
     maintenance of separate Accounts is only for accounting purposes and a
     segregation of the Trust Fund to each Account shall not be required.

6.6  Valuation

     (a)   Except as otherwise provided in subsection (b) below, or as directed
           by the Committee subject to approval by the Trustee, the assets of
           the Trust Fund shall be valued at their current fair market value as
           of each Valuation Date, and the earnings and losses of the Trust Fund
           since the immediately preceding Valuation Date shall be allocated to
           the separate Accounts of all Participants and former Participants
           under the Plan in the ratio that the fair market value of each such
           Account as of the immediately preceding Valuation Date, reduced by
           any distributions or withdrawals therefrom since such preceding
           Valuation Date, bears to the total fair market value of all separate
           Accounts as of the immediately preceding Valuation Date, reduced by
           any distributions or withdrawals therefrom since such preceding
           Valuation Date; provided, however, that if Participant-directed
           investments have been elected in the Adoption Agreement, the earnings
           and losses of each separate Account shall be allocated solely to such
           Account.

           Notwithstanding any other provision of the Plan, the Committee may,
           in its sole discretion, on any date other than the last day of the
           Plan Year, determine the value of an Account.  If such a
           determination is made, the date of such determination shall be
           considered to be a Valuation Date.

     (b)   If the plan is an Easy Retirement Plan, the dividends, capital gain
           distributions, and other earnings or losses received on any share or
           unit of a regulated investment company or collective investment fund,
           or on any other investment, that is specifically credited to a
           Participant's separate Accounts under the Plan and/or held under the
           Custodial Agreement shall be allocated to such separate Accounts and,
           in the absence of investment directions to the contrary, immediately
           reinvested, to the extent practicable, in additional shares or units
           of such regulated investment company or collective investment fund,
           or in such other investments.

6.7  Segregation of Former Participant's Account

     The Committee may segregate any portion of a former Participant's account
     balance which is retained in the Fund after his death or separation from
     service in an interest-bearing account and debited or credited only with
     income and charges attributable directly.



                                 ARTICLE VII.
                                    VESTING

7.1  Vested Interest

     Each Participant shall at all times have a fully vested interest in his
     Elective Deferral Account, Qualified Nonelective Account, Voluntary
     Account, Voluntary Tax-Deductible Account and Thrift Account.  Each
     Participant's Regular Account, Employer Discretionary Contribution
     Account, and Employer Matching Contribution Account shall vest in
     accordance with the vesting schedule elected in the Adoption Agreement.

     If a Participant is not already fully vested in his Regular Account,
     Employer Discretionary Contribution Account, and Employer Matching
     Contributions Account, he shall become so upon reaching Normal Retirement
     Age or Early Retirement Age, or upon his death or Total and Permanent
     Disability.

7.2  Vesting of a Participant
     Except in the case of Plans subject to full and immediate vesting, a
     Participant's vested amount shall be calculated by multiplying his Regular
     Account balance, Employer Discretionary Contribution Account balance, and
     Employer Matching Contribution Account balance, if any, as determined on
     the Valuation Date following his termination of employment by his vested
     interest as determined under Section 7.1.

     In order to determine the vested interest of a Participant after a Service
     Break, the following rules shall apply:

     (a)   Subject to (b) below, a former Participant who had a nonforfeitable
           right to all or a portion of the account balance derived from
           Employer contributions at the time of the Participant's termination
           will receive credit for all years of Service prior to a Service Break
           if the Participant completes a year of Service after returning to the
           employ of the Employer.

     (b)   In the case of a Participant who have five (5) or more consecutive
           one (1) year Service Breaks, all Service after such Service Breaks
           will be disregarded for the purpose of vesting the Employer-derived
           account balance that accrued before such Service Breaks.  Such
           Participants' pre-Service Break Service will count in vesting the
           post-Service Break Employer-derived account balance only if (1) such
           Participant has any nonforfeitable interest in the account balance
           attributable to Employer contributions at the time of separation from
           service, or (2) upon returning to service the number of consecutive
           one (1) year Service Breaks is less than the number of years of
           Service.  Separate accounts will be maintained for the Participant's
           pre-Service Break and post-Service Break Employer-derived account
           balance.  Both accounts will share in the earnings and losses of the
           Fund.

7.3  Amendment of Vesting Provisions

     No amendment to the vesting provisions pursuant to Section 7.1 shall
     deprive a Participant of his nonforfeitable rights to benefits accrued to
     the date of the amendment.   Further, if the vesting provisions of the
     Plan are amended, or the Plan is amended in any way that directly or
     indirectly affects computation of a Participant's nonforfeitable
     percentage or if the Plan is deemed amended by an automatic change to or
     from a top-heavy vesting schedule, each Participant with at least three
     (3) years of Service may elect, within a reasonable period after the
     adoption of the amendment, to have his nonforfeitable percentage computed
     under the Plan without regard to such amendment.  For Participants who do
     not have at least one Hour of Service in any Plan Year beginning on or
     after January 1, 1989, the preceding sentence shall be applied by
     substituting "five (5) years of Service" for "three (3) years of Service."
     The period during which the election may be made shall commence with the
     date the amendment is adopted and shall end on the later of (1) sixty (60)
     days after the amendment is adopted; (2) sixty (60) days after the
     amendment becomes effective; or (3) sixty (60) days after the Participant
     is issued written notice of the amendment by the Employer or Committee.
     7.4   Forfeitures

     (a)   If a Participant terminates employment with the Employer and the
           value of the Participant's vested account balance derived from
           Employer and Employee contributions (other than accumulated
           deductible employee contributions) is not greater than $3,500, the
           Employee shall receive a distribution of the value of the entire
           vested portion of such account balance, and the nonvested portion
           will be treated as a forfeiture.  For purposes of this Section 7.4,
           if the value of a Participant's vested account balance is zero, the
           Participant shall be deemed to have received a distribution of such
           vested account balance.  A Participant's vested account balance shall
           not include Voluntary Tax-Deductible Contributions for Plan Years
           beginning before January 1, 1989.

     (b)   If a Participant terminates employment with the Employer, and elects
           (with his or her spouse's consent) in accordance with Article VIII
           to receive the value of his or her vested account balance, the
           nonvested portion will be treated as a forfeiture.  If the
           Participant elects to have distributed less than the entire vested
           portion of the account balance derived from Employer contributions,
           the part of the nonvested portion that will be treated as a
           forfeiture is the total nonvested portion multiplied by a fraction,
           the numerator of which is the amount of the distribution attributable
           to Employer contributions and the denominator of which is the total
           value of the vested Employer derived account balance.

     (c)   If a Participant terminates employment with the Employer but does not
           receive a distribution described in (a) or (b) above, the non-vested
           portion of his account balance will be treated as a forfeiture upon
           the occurrence of a Service Break of five (5) consecutive years.

     (d)   If a Participant who receives a distribution pursuant to this Section
           7.4 resumes employment, the Participant's Employer-derived account
           balance will be restored to the amount on the date of distribution
           if the Participant repays to the Plan the full amount of the
           distribution attributable to Employer contributions before the
           earlier of (i) five (5) years after the Participant's Re-Employment
           Commencement Date or (ii) the date the Participant incurs five (5)
           consecutive one (1) year Service Breaks following the date of
           distribution.  If a Participant is deemed to receive a distribution
           pursuant to this Section, and the Participant resumes employment
           covered under this Plan before the date the Participant incurs five
           (5) consecutive one year Service Breaks, upon the reemployment of
           such Participant, the Employer-derived account balance of the
           Participant will be restored to the amount on the date of such deemed
           distribution.



                                 ARTICLE VIII.
              BENEFITS ON RETIREMENT AND SEPARATION FROM SERVICE

8.1  Commencement of Benefits

     (a)   Any Participant who terminates employment with the Employer for any
           reason (including Total and Permanent Disability as defined in
           Section 1.61 of the Plan) shall be entitled to receive the value of
           the vested portion of his Accounts (determined as of the Valuation
           Date coincident with or immediately subsequent to his termination
           with employment) as soon as administratively feasible after the date
           of his termination of employment.  If the value of the Employee's
           vested account balance derived from Employer and Employee
           contributions (excluding, for Plan Years beginning before January 1,
           1989, accumulated Voluntary Tax-Deductible Contributions) is greater
           than (or at the time of any prior distribution was greater than)
           $3,500, then no such amount shall be distributed prior to Normal
           Retirement Age (or age sixty-two (62), if later) unless the
           Participant consents to the distribution.  If the Plan is subject to
           the Automatic Annuity rules of Section 8.2, then the consent of the
           Participant's spouse shall also be required to a distribution in any
           form other than a Qualified Joint and Survivor Annuity (as defined
           in Section 8.2).

           In the case of the Dreyfus Easy Retirement Plans (Plan Numbers 01005,
           and 01006), Participants who attain the Plan's Normal Retirement Age
           shall be entitled to receive the value of the vested portion of their
           Accounts.  With respect to the Dreyfus standardized and non-
           standardized prototype profit-sharing plans (Plan Numbers 01002 and
           01003) if permitted under the Adoption Agreement,  Participants who
           attain the Plan's Normal Retirement Age shall be entitled to receive
           the value of the vested portion of their Accounts.

           The Committee shall provide the Participant with a written
           explanation of the material features and relative values of the
           optional forms of benefit available under the Plan.  Such notice
           shall also notify the Participant of the right to defer distribution
           until a future date specified by the Participant (not permitted in
           the case of the Dreyfus Easy Retirement Plans -- Plan Numbers 01005
           and 01006) or until Normal Retirement Age (or age sixty-two (62), if
           later), and if the Plan is subject to the Automatic Annuity Rules of
           Section 8.2, shall be provided during the period beginning ninety
           (90) days before and ending thirty (30) days before the Annuity
           Starting Date.

     (b)   If the value of the Participant's vested account balance derived from
           Employer and Employee contributions (excluding, for Plan Years
           beginning before January 1, 1989, accumulated Voluntary
           Tax-Deductible Contributions) is not greater than $3,500, the
           Employee shall receive a distribution of the value of the entire
           vested portion of such account balance.  However, no such
           distribution shall be made after the Annuity Starting Date unless the
           Participant and his or her spouse (or the Participant's surviving
           spouse) consent in writing to such distribution.

     (c)   Unless the Participant elects otherwise, distribution of benefits
           shall commence no later than the sixtieth (60th) day after the close
           of the Plan Year in which the latest of the following events occurs:

           (i)  the Participant reaches his Normal Retirement Age (or age
                sixty-five (65), if earlier),

           (ii) the tenth (10th) anniversary of the year in which the
                Participant commenced participation in the Plan, or

           (iii)     the Participant terminates employment with the Employer.

           The failure of a Participant or surviving spouse to consent to a
           distribution shall be deemed to be an election to defer commencement
           of benefit distributions sufficient to satisfy this Section.

     (d)   Neither the consent of the Participant nor the Participant's spouse
           shall be required to the extent a distribution is necessary to
           satisfy section 401(a)(9) or section 415 of the Code.

     (e)   This Article applies to distribution made on or after January 1,
           1993.  Notwithstanding any provision of the plan to the contrary that
           would otherwise limit a distributee's election under this Article,
           a distributee may elect, at the time and in the manner prescribed by
           the Committee, to have any portion of an eligible rollover
           distribution paid directly to an eligible retirement plan specified
           by the distributee in a direct rollover.

            Definitions:

                (i)  Eligible rollover distribution: An eligible rollover
                     distribution is any distribution of all or any portion of
                     the balance to the credit of the distributee, except that
                     an eligible rollover distribution does not include: any
                     distribution that is one of a series of substantially equal
                     periodic payments (not less frequently than annually) made
                     for the life (or life expectancy) of the distributee or the
                     joint lives (or joint life expectancies) of the distributee
                     and the distributee's designated beneficiary, or for a
                     specified period of ten years or more; any distribution to
                     the extent such distribution is required under section
                     401(a)(9) of the Code; and the portion of any distribution
                     that is not includible in gross income (determined without
                     regard to the exclusion for net unrealized appreciation
                     with respect to employer securities).

                (ii) Eligible retirement plan: An eligible retirement plan is
                     an individual retirement account described in section
                     408(a) of the Code, an individual retirement annuity
                     described in section 408(b) of the Code, an annuity plan
                     described in section 402(a) of the Code, or a qualified
                     trust described in section 401(a) of the Code, that accepts
                     the distributee's eligible rollover distribution.  However,
                     in the case of an eligible rollover distribution to the
                     surviving spouse, an eligible retirement plan is an
                     individual retirement account or individual retirement
                     annuity.

                (iii)     Distributee:  A distributee includes an Employee or
                          former Employee.  In addition, the Employee's or
                          former Employee's surviving spouse and the Employee's
                          or former Employee's spouse or former spouse who is
                          the alternate payee under a qualified domestic
                          relations order as defined in section 414(p) of the
                          Code, are distributees with regard to the interest of
                          the spouse or former spouse.

                (iv) Direct rollover:  A direct rollover is a payment by the
                     Plan to the eligible retirement plan specified by the
                     distributee.



8.2  Automatic Annuity Requirements

     The provisions of Section 8.2 through 8.4 shall take precedence over any
     conflicting provisions in this Plan.

     (a)   Applicability of Automatic Annuity Requirements.

           Except as provided in Section 8.3 with respect to certain Profit
           Sharing Plans, the provisions of this Section shall apply to any
           Participant who is credited with at least one (1) Hour of Service
           with the Employer on or after August 23, 1984, and such other
           Participants as provided in Section 8.4.

           Qualified Joint and Survivor Annuity.  Unless an optional form of
           benefit is selected pursuant to a Qualified Election within the
           ninety (90) day period ending on the Annuity Starting Date, a married
           Participant's Vested Account Balance shall be paid in the form of a
           Qualified Joint and Survivor Annuity and an unmarried Participant's
           Vested Account Balance will be paid in the form of a life annuity.
           The Participant may elect to have such annuity distributed upon
           attainment of the Earliest Retirement Age.

           Qualified Pre-Retirement Survivor Annuity.  Unless an optional form
           of benefit has been selected within the Election Period pursuant to
           a Qualified Election, if a Participant dies before the Annuity
           Starting Date then the Participant's Vested Account Balance shall be
           paid in the form of a Qualified Pre-Retirement Survivor Annuity. The
           Surviving Spouse may elect to elect to have such annuity distributed
           within a reasonable period after the Participant's death.

           Definitions. For purposes of this Section 8.2, the following words
           shall have the following meanings:

           (i)  "Earliest Retirement Age" shall mean the earliest date on which,
                under the Plan, the Participant could elect to receive
                retirement benefits.

           (ii) "Election Period" shall mean the period which begins on the
                first day of the Plan Year in which the Participant attains age
                thirty-five (35) and ends on the date of the Participant's
                death.  If a Participant separates from service prior to the
                first day of the Plan Year in which age thirty-five (35) is
                attained, with respect to benefits accrued prior to separation,
                the Election Period shall begin on the date of separation.

                A Participant who will not yet attain age thirty-five (35) as
                of the end of any current Plan Year may make a special Qualified
                Election to waive the Qualified Pre-Retirement Survivor Annuity
                for the period beginning on the date of such election and ending
                on the first day of the plan year in which the Participant will
                attain age thirty-five (35).  Such election shall not be valid
                unless the Participant receives a written explanation of the
                Qualified Pre-Retirement Survivor Annuity in such terms as are
                comparable to the explanation required under Section 8.2(b).
                Qualified Pre-Retirement Survivor Annuity coverage will be
                automatically reinstated as of the first day of the Plan Year
                in which the Participant attains age thirty-five (35).  Any new
                waiver on or after such date shall be subject to the full
                requirements of this Section 8.2.

           (iii)     "Qualified Election" shall mean a Participant's waiver of
                     a Qualified Joint and Survivor Annuity or a Qualified
                     Pre-Retirement Survivor Annuity.  Any such waiver must be
                     consented to in writing by the Participant's Spouse.  The
                     Spouse's consent must: designate a specific Beneficiary
                     (including any class of Beneficiaries or any contingent
                     Beneficiaries, which may not be changed without spousal
                     consent) or expressly permits designations by the
                     Participant without any further spousal consent;
                     acknowledge the effect of the election; and be witnessed
                     by a member of the Committee or a Notary Public.
                     Additionally, a Participant's waiver of the Qualified Joint
                     and Survivor Annuity shall not be effective unless the
                     election designates a form of benefit payment which may not
                     be changed without spousal consent (or the Spouse expressly
                     permits designations by the Participant without any further
                     spousal consent).  Notwithstanding this consent
                     requirement, if the Participant establishes to the
                     satisfaction of a member of the Committee that there is no
                     Spouse or the Spouse cannot be located, a waiver will be
                     deemed a Qualified Election.  Any spousal consent (or
                     deemed spousal consent) obtained under this provision will
                     be valid only with respect to such Spouse.  A consent that
                     permits designations by the Participant without further
                     consent by such Spouse must acknowledge that the Spouse has
                     the right to limit consent to a specific Beneficiary and,
                     where applicable, a specific form of benefit, and that the
                     Spouse voluntarily elects to relinquish either or both of
                     such rights.  A revocation of a prior waiver may be made
                     by a Participant without the consent of the Spouse at any
                     time before the commencement of benefits.  The number of
                     revocations shall not be limited.  No consent obtained
                     under this provision shall be valid unless the Participant
                     has received notice as provided in paragraph (b) below.

           (iv) "Qualified Joint and Survivor Annuity" shall mean an immediate
                annuity for the life of the Participant with a survivor annuity
                for the life of the Spouse which is fifty percent (50%) of the
                amount of the annuity which is payable during the joint lives
                of the Participant and the Spouse and which is the amount of
                benefit which can be purchased with the Participant's Vested
                Account Balance.

           (v)  "Qualified Pre-Retirement Survivor Annuity" shall mean an
                annuity for the life of the Participant's surviving spouse
                purchased with the Participant's Vested Account Balance.

           (vi) "Spouse (Surviving Spouse)" shall mean the Spouse or Surviving
                Spouse of the Participant, provided that former spouse will be
                treated as the Spouse or Surviving Spouse to the extent provided
                under a qualified domestic relations order as described in
                section 414(p) of the Code.

           (vii)     "Vested Account Balance" shall mean the aggregate value of
                     the Participant's vested account balance derived from
                     employer and employee contributions (including rollovers),
                     whether vested before or upon death, including the proceeds
                     of insurance contracts, if any, on the Participant's life.
                     The provisions of this Section 8.2 shall apply to a
                     Participant who is vested in amounts attributable to
                     employer contributions, employee contributions (or both)
                     at the time of death or distribution.

     (b)   Notice Requirements

           Qualified Joint and Survivor Annuity.  In the case of a Qualified
           Joint and Survivor Annuity as described above, the Committee shall
           provide each Participant within the period beginning ninety (90) days
           before and ending thirty (30) days before the Annuity Starting Date
           a written explanation of:  (i) the terms and conditions of a
           Qualified Joint and Survivor Annuity; (ii) the Participant's right
           to make and the effect of an election to waive the Qualified Joint
           and Survivor Annuity form of benefit; (iii) the rights of a
           Participant's Spouse; (iv) the right to make, and the effect of, a
           revocation of a previous election to waive the Qualified Joint and
           Survivor Annuity; and (v) the right, if any, to defer the
           commencement of benefits.

           Qualified Pre-Retirement Survivor Annuity.  In the case of a
           Qualified Pre-Retirement Survivor Annuity as described above, the
           Committee shall provide each Participant with a written explanation
           of the Qualified Pre-Retirement Survivor Annuity in such terms and
           in such manner as would be comparable to the explanation provided for
           meeting the requirements applicable to explaining a Qualified Joint
           and Survivor Annuity within whichever of the following periods ends
           last:

           (i)  The period beginning on the first day of the Plan Year in which
                the Participant attains age thirty-two (32) and ending with the
                close of the Plan Year preceding the Plan Year in which the
                Participant attains age thirty-five (35).

           (ii) A reasonable period ending after a Participant enters the Plan.

           (iii)A reasonable period ending after Section 8.3 ceases to
                apply to a Profit Sharing Plan.

           (iv) A reasonable period after Section 8.2 first applies to a
                Participant.

           Notwithstanding the foregoing, notice must be provided within a
           reasonable period ending after termination of employment in the case
           of a Participant who terminates employment before attaining age 35.

           For purposes of applying the preceding paragraph, a reasonable period
           ending after the enumerated events described in (ii), (iii), and (iv)
           is the end of the two-year period beginning one year prior to the
           date the applicable event occurs, and ending one year after that
           date.  In the case of a Participant who terminates employment before
           the Plan Year in which age thirty-five (35) is attained, notice shall
           be provided within the two-year period beginning one year prior to
           termination and ending one year after termination.  If such a
           Participant thereafter returns to employment with the Employer, the
           applicable period for such Participant shall be redetermined.

           If a distribution is one to which sections 401(a)(11) and 417 of the
           Code do not apply, such distribution may commence less than 30 days
           after the notice required under section 1.411(a)-11(c) of the Income
           Tax Regulations in given, provided that:

                (1)  the Plan Administrator clearly informs the Participant that
                     the Participant has a right to a period of at least 30 days
                     after receiving the notice to consider the decision of
                     whether or not to elect a distribution (and, if applicable,
                     a particular distribution option), and

                (2)  the participant, after receiving the notice,affirmatively
                     elects a distribution.



8.3  Profit Sharing Plans: Exception from Automatic Annuity Requirements

     Unless otherwise specified in the Adoption Agreement, the provisions of
     Sections 8.2 and 8.4 shall be inoperative in the case of a Profit Sharing
     Plan if the following two (2) conditions are met: (1) the Participant
     cannot or does not elect payments in the form of a life annuity, and (2)
     on the death of the Participant, the Participant's Vested Account Balance
     (as defined in Section 8.2) will be paid to the Participant's Surviving
     Spouse (as defined in Section 8.2), but if there is no Surviving Spouse,
     or, if the Surviving Spouse has already consented in a manner conforming
     to a Qualified Election to a waiver of a Qualified Pre-Retirement Survivor
     Annuity (under Section 8.2), then to the Participant's Beneficiary.

     However, the foregoing shall not be operative with respect to a
     Participant if it is determined that this Profit Sharing Plan is a direct
     or indirect transferee of a defined benefit plan, money purchase pension
     plan (including a target benefit plan), stock bonus, or profit-sharing
     plan which is subject to the survivor annuity requirements of sections
     401(a)(11) and 417 of the Code.

8.4  Transitional Rules Applicable to Joint and Survivor Annuities

     (a)   Any living Participant not receiving benefits on August 23, 1984, who
           would otherwise not receive the benefits prescribed by Section 8.2
           must be give the opportunity to elect to have Section 8.2 apply if
           such Participant is credited with at least one (1) Hour of Service
           under this Plan or a predecessor plan in a Plan Year beginning on or
           after January 1, 1976, and such Participant had at least ten (10)
           years of Service when he or she terminated employment.

     (b)   Any living Participant not receiving benefits on August 23, 1984, who
           was credited with at least one (1) Hour of Service under this Plan
           or a predecessor Plan on or after September 2, 1974, and who is not
           otherwise credited with any Service in a Plan Year beginning on or
           after January 1, 1976, must be given the opportunity to have his or
           her benefits paid in the manner set forth in paragraph (d) below.

     (c)   The respective opportunities to elect (as described in paragraphs (a)
           and (b) above) must be afforded to the appropriate Participants
           during the period  commencing on August 23, 1984, and ending on the
           date benefits would otherwise commence to said Participants.

     (d)   Any Participant who has elected pursuant to paragraph (b) above and
           any Participant who does not elect under paragraph (a) above or who
           meets the requirements of paragraph (a) except that such Participant
           does not have at least ten (10) Years of Service when he or she
           terminates employment, shall have his or her benefits distributed in
           accordance with all of the following requirements if benefits would
           have been payable in the form of a life annuity:

           (1)  Qualified Joint and Survivor Annuity.  If benefits in the form
                of a life annuity become payable to a married Participant who:

                (i)  Begins to receive payments under the Plan on or after his
                     Normal Retirement Age; or

                (ii) Dies on or after his Normal Retirement Age while still
                     working for the Employer; or

                (iii)Begins to receive payments on or after the Qualified Early
                     Retirement Age; or

                (iv) Separates from service on or after attaining his Normal
                     Retirement Age (or the Qualified Early Retirement Age) and
                     after satisfying the eligibility requirements for the
                     payment of benefits under the Plan and thereafter dies
                     before beginning to receive such benefits;

                then such benefits shall be received under this Plan in the form
                of a Qualified Joint and Survivor Annuity, unless the
                Participant, with the consent of his or her Spouse, has elected
                otherwise during the election period which shall begin at least
                six (6) months before the Participant attains the Qualified
                Early Retirement Age (or the date the Participant begins
                participation in the Plan, if later) and end not more than
                ninety (90) days before the commencement of benefits.  Any
                election hereunder shall be in writing and may be changed by the
                Participant, with the consent of his or her Spouse, at any time
                during the election period.

           (2)  Election of Early Survivor Annuity.  A Participant who is
                employed after attaining the Qualified Early Retirement Age will
                be given the opportunity to elect, during the election period,
                to have a survivor annuity payable on death.  If the Participant
                elects the survivor annuity, payments under such annuity must
                not be less than the payments which would have been made to the
                Spouse under the Qualified Joint and Survivor Annuity if the
                Participant had retired on the day before his or her death.  Any
                election under this provision will be in writing and may be
                changed by the Participant with the consent of his or her Spouse
                at any time.  The election period begins on the later of (1) the
                ninetieth (90) day before the Participant attains the Qualified
                Early Retirement Age, or (2) the date on which participation
                begins, and ends on the date the Participant terminates
                employment.

                Notwithstanding the availability of the elections set forth
                above, in the event a Participant dies after attaining the
                Qualified Early Retirement Age while still employed by the
                Employer, but before reaching the Normal Retirement Date, the
                Participant's account balance as of the date of death shall be
                paid to the Participant's Spouse.  If the Participant is not
                married, such benefit shall be paid to the Participant's
                designated Beneficiary or, if none, to the Participant's estate.

           (3)  Definitions.  For purpose of this Section 8.4, the following
                words shall have the following meanings:

                (i)  "Qualified Joint and Survivor Annuity" shall mean an
                     annuity for the life of the Participant with a survivor
                     annuity for the life of his Spouse as described in Section
                     8.2.

                (ii) "Qualified Early Retirement Age" shall mean the latest of:


                     (A)  the earliest date, under the Plan, on which the
                          Participant may elect to receive retirement benefits;

                     (B)  the first day of the one hundred twentieth (120th)
                          month beginning before the Participant reaches his
                          Normal Retirement Age; or

                     (C)  the date on which the Participant begins
                          participation.

8.5  Required Payment of Benefits

     (a)   General Rule.  Except as otherwise provided in Section 8.2, the
           requirements of this Section shall apply to any distribution of a
           Participant's account balance and will take precedence over any
           inconsistent provisions of the Plan.  Unless otherwise specified, the
           provisions of this Section shall apply to calendar years beginning
           after December 31, 1984.

           All distributions required under this Section 8.5 shall be determined
           and made in accordance with the Income Tax Regulations under section
           401(a)(9) of the Code, including the minimum distribution incidental
           benefit requirement of section 1.401(a)(9)-2 of the regulations.

     (b)   Limits on Distribution Periods.  Distributions, if not made in a
           single-sum, may only be made over one of the following periods (or
           a combination thereof):  (1) the life of the Participant;  (2) the
           life of the Participant and a Designated Beneficiary; (3) a period
           certain not extending beyond the life expectancy of the Participant;
           or (4) a period certain not extending beyond the joint and last
           survivor expectancy of the Participant and a Designated Beneficiary.

           Any annuity contract purchased and distributed to a Participant or
           his Beneficiary shall comply with the requirements of this Plan, and
           shall be made and endorsed as nontransferable.

     (c)   Minimum Amounts to be Distributed.  If the Participant's entire
           interest is to be distributed in other than a single sum, the
           following minimum distribution rules shall apply on or after the
           Required Beginning Date:

           (i)  If a Participant's benefit is to be distributed over (1) a
                period not extending beyond the life expectancy of the
                Participant or the joint life and last survivor expectancy of
                the Participant and the Participant's Designated Beneficiary or
                (2) a period not extending beyond the life expectancy of the
                Designated Beneficiary, the amount required to be distributed
                for each calendar year, beginning with distributions for the
                first distribution calendar year, must at least equal the
                quotient obtained by dividing the Participant's benefit by the
                applicable life expectancy.

           (ii) For calendar years beginning before January 1, 1989, if the
                Participant's spouse is not the designated Beneficiary, the
                method of distribution selected must assure that at least fifty
                percent (50%) of the present value of the amount available for
                distribution is paid within the life expectancy of the
                Participant.

           (iii)     For calendar years beginning after December 31, 1988, the
                     amount to be distributed each year, beginning with
                     distributions for the first distribution calendar year
                     shall not be less than the quotient obtained by dividing
                     the Participant's benefit by the lesser of (1) the
                     applicable life expectancy or (2) if the Participant's
                     spouse is not the Designated Beneficiary, the applicable
                     divisor determined from the table set forth in Q&A-4 of
                     section 1.401 (a)(9)-2 of the Income Tax Regulations.
                     Distributions after the death of the Participant shall be
                     distributed using the applicable life expectancy in
                     paragraph (c)(i) above as the relevant divisor without
                     regard to section 1.401 (a)(9)-2 of the regulations.

           (iv) The minimum distribution required for the Participant's first
                distribution calendar year must be made on or before the
                Participant's Required Beginning Date.  The minimum distribution
                for other calendar years, including the minimum
                distribution for the distribution calendar year in which the
                Employee's Required Beginning Date occurs, must be made on or
                before December 31 of that distribution calendar year.

     (d)   Commencement of Death Benefits.  Upon the death of the Participant,
           the following distribution provisions shall take effect:

           (i)  If the Participant dies after distribution of his or her
                interest has commenced, the remaining portion of such interest
                will continue to be distributed at least as rapidly as under the
                method of distribution being used prior to the Participant's
                death.  Upon the death of the Participant's Beneficiary, any
                undistributed interest shall be paid to the legal
                representatives of such Beneficiary's estate.

           (ii) If the Participant dies before distribution of his or her
                interest commences, the Participant's entire interest will be
                distributed by December 31 of the calendar year in which falls
                the fifth anniversary of the Participant's death except to the
                extent that an election is made to receive distributions in
                accordance with (1) or (2) below:

                (1)  If any portion of the Participant's interest is payable to
                     a Designated Beneficiary, distributions may be made in
                     substantially equal installments over the life or over a
                     period certain not greater than the life expectancy of the
                     Designated Beneficiary commencing on or before December 31
                     of the calendar year immediately following the calendar
                     year in which the Participant died.

                (2)  If the Designated Beneficiary is the Participant's
                     surviving spouse, the date distributions are required to
                     begin in accordance with (1) above shall not be earlier
                     than the later of (A) December 31 of the calendar year
                     immediately following the calendar year in which the
                     Participant died and (B) December 31 of the calendar year
                     in which the Participant would have attained age seventy
                     and one-half (70-1/2).

           If the Participant has not made an election pursuant to this Section
           8.5(d)(ii) by the time of his or her death, the Participant's
           Designated Beneficiary must elect the method of distribution no later
           than the earlier of (1) December 31 of the calendar year in which
           distributions would be required to begin under this Section, or (2)
           December 31 of the calendar year which contains the fifth anniversary
           of the date of death of the Participant.  If the Participant has no
           Designated Beneficiary, or if the Designated Beneficiary does not
           elect a method of distribution, distribution of the Participant's
           entire interest must be completed by December 31 of the calendar year
           containing the fifth anniversary of the Participant's death.

           (iii)     For purposes of Section 8.5(d)(ii) above, if the surviving
                     spouse dies after the Participant, but before payments to
                     such spouse begin, the provisions of Section 8.5(d)(ii),
                     with the exception of subparagraph (2) thereof, shall be
                     applied as if the surviving spouse were the Participant.

           (iv) For purposes of this Section 8.5(d), any amount paid to a child
                of the Participant will be treated as if it had been paid to the
                Surviving Spouse if the amount becomes payable to the Surviving
                Spouse when the child reaches the age of majority.

           (v)  For purposes of this Section 8.5(d), distribution of a
                Participant's interest is considered to begin on the
                Participant's Required Beginning Date (or, if Section
                8.5(d)(iii) above is applicable, the date distribution is
                required to begin to the surviving spouse pursuant to Section
                8.5(d)(ii) above).  If distribution in the form of an annuity
                irrevocably commences to the Participant before the Required
                Beginning Date, the date distribution is considered to begin is
                the date distribution actually commences.

     (e)   Definitions. For purposes of this Section 8.5, the  following terms
           shall have the following meanings:

           (i)  Designated Beneficiary.  The individual who is designated as the
                Beneficiary under the Plan in accordance with section 401(a)(9)
                of the Code and the regulations thereunder.

           (ii) Distribution calendar year.  A calendar year for which a minimum
                distribution is required.  For distributions beginning before
                the Participant's death, the first distribution calendar year
                is the calendar year immediately preceding the calendar year
                which contains the Participant's Required Beginning Date.  For
                distributions beginning after the Participant's death, the first
                distribution calendar year is the calendar year in which
                distributions are required to begin pursuant to Section 8.5(d)
                above.

           (iii)     Life expectancy.  The life expectancy (or joint and last
                     survivor expectancy) calculated using the attained age of
                     the Participant (or Designated Beneficiary) as of the
                     Participant's (or Designated Beneficiary's) birthday in the
                     applicable calendar year.  The applicable calendar year
                     shall be the first distribution calendar year.  If annuity
                     payments commerce before the required beginning date, the
                     applicable calendar year is the year such payments
                     commence.  Life expectancy and joint and last survivor
                     expectancy are computed by use of the expected return
                     multiples in Tables V and VI of section 1.72-9 of the
                     Income Tax Regulations.

                Unless otherwise elected by the Participant (or spouse, in the
                case of distributions described in Section 8.5(d)(ii)(2) above)
                by the time distributions are required to begin, life
                expectancies shall be recalculated annually.  Such election
                shall be irrevocable as to the Participant (or spouse) and shall
                apply to all subsequent years.  The life expectancy of a
                nonspouse Beneficiary may not be recalculated.

           (iv) Participant's benefit.

                (A)  The account balance as of the last valuation date in the
                     calendar year immediately preceding the distribution
                     calendar year (valuation calendar year) increased by the
                     amount of any contributions or forfeitures allocated to the
                     account balance as of dates in the valuation calendar year
                     after the valuation date and decreased by distributions
                     made in the valuation calendar year after the valuation
                     date.

                (B)  Exception for second distribution calendar year.  For
                     purposes of paragraph (A) above, if any portion of the
                     minimum distribution for the first distribution calendar
                     year is made in the second distribution calendar year on
                     or before the Required Beginning Date, the amount of the
                     minimum distribution made in the second distribution
                     calendar year shall be treated as if it had been made in
                     the immediately preceding distribution calendar year.

           (v)  Required Beginning Date.

                (A)  General rule.  The Required Beginning Date of a Participant
                     is the first day of April of the calendar year following
                     the calendar year in which the Participant attains age
                     seventy and one-half (70-1/2).

                (B)  Transitional rules.  The Required Beginning Date of a
                     Participant who attains age seventy and one-half (70-1/2)
                     before January 1, 1988, shall be determined in accordance
                     with (1) or (2) below:

                     (1)  Non-Five percent owners.  The Required  Beginning Date
                          of a Participant who is not a five percent (5%) owner
                          is the first day of April of the calendar year
                          following the calendar year in which the later of
                          retirement or attainment of age of seventy and
                          one-half (70-1/2) occurs.

                     (2)  Five percent owners.  The required beginning date of
                          a Participant who is a five percent (5%) owner during
                          any year beginning after December 31, 1979, is the
                          first day of April following the later of:

                          (i)  the calendar year in which the Participant
                               attains age seventy and one-half (70-1/2), or

                          (ii) the earlier of the calendar year with or within
                               which ends the plan year in which the Participant
                               becomes a five percent (5%) owner, or the
                               calendar year in which the Participant retires.

                          The Required Beginning Date of a Participant who is
                          not a five percent (5%) owner who attains age seventy
                          and one-half (70-1/2) during 1988 and who has not
                          retired as of January 1, 1989, is April 1, 1990.

                (C)  Five percent owner.  A Participant is treated as a five
                     percent (5%) owner for purposes of this Section if such
                     Participant is a five percent (5%) owner as defined in
                     section 416(i) of the Code but without regard to whether
                     the Plan is top-heavy) at any time during the Plan Year
                     ending with or within the calendar year in which such owner
                     attains age sixty-six and one-half (66-1/2) or any
                     subsequent Plan Year.

                (D)  Once distributions have begun to a five percent (5%) owner
                     under this Section, they must continue to be distributed,
                     even if the Participant ceases to be a five percent (5%)
                     owner in a subsequent year.

     (f)   Transitional Rule. Notwithstanding the other requirements of this
           Section and subject to the requirements of Section 8.2, distribution
           on behalf of any Employee, including a five percent (5%) owner, may
           be made in accordance with all of the following requirements
           (regardless of when such distribution commences):

           (i)  The distribution by the trust is one which would not have
                disqualified such trust under section 401(a)(9) of the Code as
                in effect prior to amendment by the Deficit Reduction Act of
                1984.

           (ii) The distribution is in accordance with a method of distribution
                designated by the Employee whose interest in the trust is being
                distributed or, if the Employee is deceased, by a Beneficiary
                of such Employee.

           (iii)Such designation was in writing, was signed by the Employee
                or the Beneficiary, and was made before January 1, 1984.

           (iv) The Employee had accrued a benefit under the Plan as of December
                31, 1983.

           (v)  The method of distribution designated by the Employee or the
                Beneficiary specifies the time at which distribution will
                commence, the period over which distributions will be made, and
                in the case of any distribution upon the Employee's death, the
                Beneficiaries of the Employee listed in order of priority.

     A distribution upon death will not be covered by this transitional rule
     unless the information in the designation contains the required
     information described above with respect to the distributions to be made
     upon the death of the Employee.

     For any distribution which commences before January 1, 1984, but continues
     after December 31, 1983, the Employee, or the Beneficiary, to who such
     distribution is being made, will be presumed to have designated the method
     of distribution under which the distribution is being made if the method
     of distribution was specified in writing and the distribution satisfies
     the requirements in Subsections (i) through (v) above.

     If a designation is revoked, any subsequent distribution must satisfy the
     requirements of section 401(a)(9) of the Code and the regulations
     thereunder.  If a designation is revoked subsequent to the date
     distributions are required to begin, the trust must distribute by the end
     of the calendar year following the calendar year in which the revocation
     occurs the total amount not yet distributed which would have been required
     to have been distributed to satisfy section 401(a)(9) of the Code and the
     regulations thereunder, but for the election under section 242(b)(2) of
     Pub. L. No. 97-248.  For calendar years beginning after December 31, 1988,
     such distributions must meet the minimum distribution incidental benefit
     requirements in section 1.401(a)(9)-2 of the Income Tax Regulations.  Any
     changes in the designation will be considered to be a revocation of the
     designation.  However, the mere substitution or addition of another
     Beneficiary (one not named in the designation) under the designation will
     not be considered to be a revocation of the designation, so long as such
     substitution or addition does not alter the period over which
     distributions are to be made under the designation, directly or indirectly
     (for example, by altering the relevant measuring life).  The rules of Q&A
     J-2 and J-3 of Income Tax Regulations section 1.401(a)(9)-1 shall apply
     to rollovers and transfers from one plan to another.

8.6  Available Forms of Distribution

     (a)   If pursuant to Section 8.3, the Plan is a Profit Sharing Plan exempt
           from the Automatic Annuity Rules of Section 8.2, the normal form of
           distribution shall be a lump sum distribution.  Unless specified
           otherwise in the Adoption Agreement, in lieu of the lump sum
           distribution, a Participant or Beneficiary may elect to receive
           installment payments payable monthly, quarterly, semi-annually or
           annually.

     (b)   If the Plan is subject to the Automatic Annuity Rules of Section 8.2,
           the normal form of distribution shall be the applicable form of
           Automatic Annuity under Section 8.2.  In lieu of the Automatic
           Annuity, a Participant or Beneficiary may elect a lump sum
           distribution or such other available forms of distribution as are set
           forth below or as are specified in the Adoption Agreement.  Any such
           election by a Participant must be accompanied by the written consent
           of his spouse (consistent with the requirements for a Qualified
           Election under Section 8.2).

           The available forms of distribution shall be:

           (i)  a joint and 100% survivor annuity contract purchased from an
                insurance company selected by the Committee.

           (ii) a single life annuity contract purchased from an insurance
                company selected by the Committee.

           (iii)a single life annuity contract, with 10 years guaranteed,
                purchased from an insurance company selected by the Committee.

           (iv) installments payable monthly, quarterly, semi-annually or
                annually.

8.7  Certain Distributions

     In the event a distribution of an account balance made to or on behalf of
     a Participant prior to the attainment of age fifty-nine and one-half
     (59-1/2) would be subject to the ten percent (10%) penalty tax set forth
     in section 72(t) or 72(m)(5) of the Code, the Participant may, within
     sixty (60) days of the distribution date, request that the distribution
     be transferred to another qualified retirement plan or an Individual
     Retirement Account as a rollover contribution if the distribution
     satisfies the requirements of section 402(a)(5) of the Code.

8.8  Forfeitures

     Any balance in the Regular Account, Employer Discretionary Contribution
     Account or in the Employer Matching Contribution Account, if any, of a
     Participant who is separated from service, to which he is not entitled
     under the foregoing provisions, shall be forfeited and applied as provided
     in Sections 3.2 and 4.2 of this Plan, and Section X(E) of the Dreyfus
     Standardized/Paired Prototype Target Benefit Plan and Trust Adoption
     Agreement.



                                  ARTICLE IX.
                                DEATH BENEFITS

9.1  Payment to Beneficiary

     (a)   Subject to the provisions of Article VIII, upon the death of a
           Participant, such Participant's account balance shall be paid to his
           designated Beneficiary or if no such Beneficiary is designated or
           survives the Participant, to the legal representative of such
           Participant's estate.  Such payment shall commence as soon as
           practicable after the Participant's death and after the Trustee is
           given such documentation as may be required under the provisions of
           the Trust Agreement or Custodial Agreement.

     (b)   Subject to the provisions of the Custodial Agreement if the Plan is
           an Easy Retirement Plan, the Committee may prescribe the manner in
           which a Beneficiary is to be designated in writing and the Custodial
           Agreement, may prescribe the manner in which such designations shall
           be filed. Notwithstanding the foregoing, any designation (or change
           of designation) of a Beneficiary must be consented to by the
           Participant's Spouse pursuant to a Qualified Election under Section
           8.2, if such Beneficiary is not the Participant's Spouse.

9.2  Method of Payment
     Subject to the provisions of Article VIII, death benefits may be paid in
     any mode of benefit payment provided for in this Plan as elected by the
     Participant or Beneficiary, except in the event of the death of the
     Participant after payments have commenced under an annuity contract, by
     the Beneficiary.



                                  ARTICLE X.
                     PARTICIPANT CONTRIBUTIONS; ROLLOVERS

10.1 Voluntary Contributions

     (a)   Effective for Plan Years beginning January 1, 1987, non-deductible
           Voluntary Contributions shall not be permitted under this Plan.  A
           separate Account shall be maintained for Voluntary Contributions made
           prior to such time.  Such Account shall be nonforfeitable at all
           times.

     (b)   A Participant may make withdrawals from the Voluntary Account at such
           time as the Committee shall designate, but not more than quarterly
           during a Plan Year provided that no single withdrawal shall be less
           than the total amount available for withdrawal under the other
           limitations of this Section 10.1 or five hundred dollars ($500),
           whichever is less.  Notwithstanding the preceding sentence, if the
           Plan is an Easy Retirement Plan, a Participant may make such a
           withdrawal at any time.

     (c)   If the Plan is subject to the Automatic Annuity rules of Section 8.2,
           the written consent of the Participant's spouse (consistent with the
           requirements for a Qualified Election under Section 8.2) must be
           obtained with respect to any withdrawal.

     (d)   No forfeitures of amounts allocated to Participants from Employer
           contributions and earnings thereon, shall occur solely as a result
           of a Participant's withdrawal of voluntary contributions.

     (e)   Voluntary Contributions for Plan years beginning after December 31,
           1986 shall be subject to the Contribution Percentage tests and the
           rules applicable to Excess Aggregate Contributions set forth in
           Section 4.7.

10.2 Voluntary Tax-Deductible Contributions

     (a)   Voluntary Tax-Deductible Contributions (within the meaning of section
           72(o)(5)(A) of the Code) shall not be permitted under this Plan for
           taxable years beginning after December 31, 1986.  A separate
           Voluntary Tax-Deductible Account shall be established for such
           contributions made for taxable years beginning on or before December
           31, 1986.  Such Account shall be nonforfeitable at all times.
           However, no part of the Voluntary Tax-Deductible Account will be used
           to purchase life insurance or available for loans under Article XII.


     (b)   The Participant may withdraw any part of the Voluntary Tax-Deductible
           Account by making written application to the Committee.  If the Plan
           is subject to the Automatic Annuity Rules of Section 8.2, the written
           consent of the Participant's Spouse (consistent with the requirements
           of a Qualified Election under Section 8.2) must be obtained to any
           withdrawal made after the first day of the first Plan Year beginning
           on or after January 1, 1989.

10.3 Transfers From Other Trusts

     Unless specified otherwise in the Adoption Agreement, the Committee may,
     in its discretion, direct the Trustee to accept a rollover contribution
     described in sections  401(a)(31), 402(a)(5), 403(a)(4) or
     408(d)(3)(A)(ii) of the Code or a direct transfer of funds from a
     qualified retirement plan, provided that, in the opinion of counsel for
     the Employer, the transfer will not jeopardize the tax exempt status of
     the Plan or create adverse tax consequences to the Employer.  The
     Committee shall exercise such discretion in a uniform and
     nondiscriminatory manner.  A transfer or rollover contribution may be made
     on behalf of an Employee eligible to participate in the Plan who has not
     met the age and service requirements, if any, for participation.  Such an
     Employee shall become a Participant on the date the Trustee accepts the
     rollover contribution or transfer for all purposes, except that no
     employer or employee contributions shall be made by or on behalf of such
     Employee and such Employee shall not share in Plan forfeitures until he
     has completed the age and service requirements for participation and
     become a Participant.  A rollover contribution or transfer shall be
     maintained in a Participant's Rollover Account and Transfer Account,
     respectively.  Notwithstanding the preceding sentence, amounts
     attributable to voluntary deductible employee contributions shall be
     maintained in a Participant's Voluntary Tax-Deductible Account.


     A Participant may take withdrawals from the Rollover Account at such time
     as the Committee shall designate, but not more than quarterly during a
     Plan Year, provided that no single withdrawal shall be less than the total
     amount available for withdrawal or five hundred dollars ($500) whichever
     is less.  If the Plan is subject to the Automatic Annuity Rules of Section
     8.2 and the Participant is married, the request for withdrawal must be
     consented to in writing by the Participant's spouse.  Notwithstanding the
     preceding sentence, if the Plan is an Easy Retirement Plan, a Participant
     may make such a withdrawal at any time.

     Unless  indicated otherwise in the Adoption Agreement,  distributions
     shall be made from the Transfer Account upon meeting the requirements set
     forth  under Articles VIII and IX  of the Plan.  If the Plan is subject
     to the Automatic Annuity Rules of Section 8.2 and the Participant is
     married, the request for distribution must be consented to in writing by
     the Participant's spouse.

     The written consent of the Participant's spouse (consistent with the
     requirements for a Qualified Election under Section 8.2) must be obtained
     with respect to any withdrawal.



                                  ARTICLE XI.
                              INSURANCE POLICIES

11.1 Policy Procurement

     The Employer may elect in the Adoption Agreement to have the provisions
     of this Article XI apply.  If so authorized, the Committee may elect to
     provide all Active Participants with the option of having life insurance
     or annuity contracts (hereinafter referred to as "policy") purchased on
     their behalf from a legal reserve life insurance company.

11.2 Rules and Regulations

     The following rules shall be applicable to the acquisition, handling and
     disposition of any policy:

     (a)   The basic options, cash surrender values and other material features
           of all policies shall be as nearly uniform as possible.  No endowment
           policies shall be purchased.

     (b)   The Trustee shall be designated as the sole owner of any policy
           purchased hereunder.  However, all benefits, rights, privileges and
           options under such policy and any dividends or credits earned in
           insurance contracts will be allocated to the Participant's account
           balance derived from Employer contributions for whose benefit the
           contract is held.  Notwithstanding any other provision of the Plan,
           in computing the amount of the vested interest of any Participant,
           the cash surrender value of any policy shall be included in the
           Participant's account balance.  The applicable vested interest
           percentage shall be applied to this sum.  The product of this
           computation shall then constitute the Participant's vested interest.

     (c)   Payments made to any insurance company with respect to any such
           policy shall constitute an investment of the funds credited to the
           account balance of the Participant on whose behalf it was purchased
           and his account balance derived from Employer contributions shall
           accordingly be reduced by any such payments.

     (d)   If the policy or policies purchased are ordinary life insurance, the
           aggregate premiums payable with respect to such policy or policies
           may not equal or exceed fifty percent (50%) of the aggregate Employer
           contributions and forfeitures credited to such Participant's account
           balance, exclusive of investment earnings.  A Participant may upon
           consultation with the Committee and with its consent modify or
           terminate this election at any time.  If the policy purchased is term
           or universal life insurance, the phrase "twenty-five percent (25%)"
           shall be substituted for the phrase "fifty percent (50%)."  If the
           policy or policies purchased are ordinary life insurance and term
           insurance, the sum of one-half (1/2) the ordinary life premiums and
           the term premiums may not exceed twenty-five percent (25%) of the
           aggregate Employer contributions and forfeitures credited to such
           Participant's account balance, exclusive of investment earnings.  For
           purposes of these incidental insurance provisions, ordinary life
           insurance contracts are contracts with both nondecreasing death
           benefits and nonincreasing premiums.

     (e)   If a Participant is not insurable as a standard risk but may
           nevertheless be eligible for insurance coverage at an extra rating
           because of excess mortality hazards, the Committee, in its
           discretion, may agree or not agree to obtain insurance.  The
           insurance to be purchased for a substandard life shall not exceed the
           face amount that could have been purchased by the premium that would
           have been available for the purchase of insurance had the Participant
           not been rated a substandard life.  In determining whether or not to
           purchase insurance, the Committee shall not discriminate and shall
           accord uniform treatment to all of its Participants in a similar
           situation.

11.3 Transfer of Policies

     (a)   Upon the Participant's retirement, the Trustee shall, upon
           instructions from the Committee, either transfer and deliver to the
           Participant any policy held on his behalf (with such endorsements as
           the Committee may direct), convert such policy to an annuity, or
           surrender such policy, in which case the cash proceeds thereof shall
           be included as part of the account balance of such Participant and
           distributed accordingly.

     (b)   The Committee shall offer to a vested Participant any policy held in
           his behalf at a price equal to the total cash surrender value of such
           policy.  If the Participant elects to purchase such policy, the
           Trustee shall, upon instructions from the Committee, transfer
           ownership of the policy to such Participant, endorsed so as to vest
           in the transferee all right, title and interest thereto, free and
           clear of the Trust.  If the Participant declines to purchase such
           policy, the Trustee shall, upon instructions from the Committee,
           liquidate the policy for its cash surrender value; transfer the
           policy to the Participant as a distribution of benefits; or if the
           Participant has terminated employment with the Employer other than
           by reason of retirement, death or disability, place the policy on a
           paid-up basis.  The Committee may direct the Trustee to designate
           itself, if not so designated, as Beneficiary under such policy for
           the period prior to the date on which it is liquidated.

     (c)   Subject to the Qualified Joint and Survivor Annuity Rules of Section
           8.2, the contracts on a Participant's life will be converted to cash
           or an annuity or distributed to the Participant upon commencement of
           benefits.

11.4 Payment Upon Death

     Subject to the Qualified Pre-Retirement Survivor Annuity Rules of Section
     8.2, all death benefits payable under any policy held on behalf of
     a deceased Participant shall be paid to his Beneficiary.  Such benefits
     may, as the Committee shall determine, be paid either to the Trust Fund,
     in which case the cash proceeds thereof shall be included as part of
     vested account balance of such Participant and distributed accordingly,
     or directly by the insurance company to the Beneficiary pursuant to the
     settlement option in effect at the time of the Participant's death.  In
     the absence of such election, the benefits may be paid in a lump sum or
     under any other settlement option contained in such policy, as determined
     by the Committee.

11.5 Plan Provisions Control

     In the event of any conflict between the terms of this Plan and the terms
     of any policy issued hereunder, the Plan provisions shall control.



                                 ARTICLE XII.
                                     LOANS

12.1 Loans to Participants

     If permitted under the Adoption Agreement, the Committee, in its
     discretion, may authorize and direct the Trustee to grant loans to
     Participants and Beneficiaries in accordance with written rules
     established by the Committee.  Such loans:

     (a)   Shall not exceed the lesser of:

           (1)  fifty thousand dollars ($50,000) reduced by the excess, if any,
                of (i) the highest outstanding balance of loans from the Plan
                during the one (1) year period ending on the day before the date
                on which such loan was made, over (ii) the outstanding balance
                of loans from the Plan on the date such loan was made, or

           (2)  one-half (1/2) of the Participant's or Beneficiary's vested
                interest under the Plan.

                For this purpose, all plans of the Employer and Affiliated
                Employers shall be treated as a single plan.

     (b)   Shall be evidenced by a promissory note, secured by an assignment of
           a portion of the Participant's or Beneficiary's vested interest in
           the Plan, other than a Voluntary Tax-Deductible Account (effective
           for loans granted or renewed after October 18, 1989, the portion of
           a Participant's or Beneficiary's vested interest which may be used
           as security for a loan hereunder shall not exceed fifty percent
           (50%));

     (c)   Shall bear a reasonable rate of interest as determined by the
           Committee to be a rate of interest commensurate with the interest
           rates charged by persons in the business of lending money for loans
           which would be made under similar circumstances; and

     (d)   Shall require substantially level repayments of principal and
           interest (with repayments made not less frequently than quarterly)
           over a period not to exceed five (5) years.  Any such loan shall be
           nonrenewable except that if the loan was originally granted for a
           period of less than five (5) years, then the same may be renewed, in
           the discretion of the Committee, for a period of time equal to the
           difference between five (5) years and the duration of the original
           loan.  The five (5) year repayment period shall not apply to any loan
           used to acquire any dwelling unit which within a reasonable period
           of time is to be used (to be determined at the time the loan is made)
           as the principal residence of the Participant.

     If the Plan is subject to the Automatic Annuity Rules of Section 8.2, the
     written consent of the Participant's spouse (consistent with the
     requirements for a Qualified Election under Section 8.2) must be obtained
     within the ninety (90) day period ending on the date the account balance
     is used as security for the loan.  Such consent shall thereafter be
     binding with respect to the consenting spouse or any subsequent spouse.
     However, a new consent shall be required if the account balance is used
     for renegotiation, extension, renewal or other revision of the loan.

     If Participant-directed investments have been elected in the Adoption
     Agreement, loans shall be treated as an investment of one or more of the
     borrower's separate Accounts, in accordance with rules established by the
     Committee.  Repayments of principal and interest shall be allocated solely
     to the Account(s) of the borrower from which such loan was made, and any
     loss caused by non-payment or default shall be charged solely to such
     Account(s).  Otherwise, all loans hereunder shall be treated as an
     investment of the Fund.

12.2 Provisions to be Applied in a Uniform and Nondiscriminatory Manner

     In deciding whether or not to grant any request for a loan hereunder, the
     Committee shall be guided by procedures and criteria designed to assure
     that the loans shall be made available to all Participants and
     Beneficiaries on a reasonably equivalent basis and shall not be available
     to Highly Compensated Employees in an amount greater than the amount made
     available to other Employees.

12.3 Satisfaction of Loan

     In the event of default, foreclosure on the note and attachment of the
     security will not occur until a distributable event occurs under the terms
     of the Plan.

     If spousal consent (consistent with the requirements for a Qualified
     Election under Section 8.2) has been obtained, then, notwithstanding any
     other provision of the Plan, the portion of the Participant's vested
     account balance used as security for a loan shall be taken into account
     for purposes of determining the amount of the account balance payable at
     the time of death or distribution, but only if the reduction is used as
     repayment of the loan.  If less than one hundred percent (100%) of the
     Participant's vested account balance (determined without regard to the
     preceding sentence) is payable to the surviving spouse, then the account
     balance shall be adjusted by first reducing the vested account balance by
     the amount of the security used as repayment of the loan, and then
     determining the benefit payable to the surviving spouse.

12.4 Loans to Owner-Employees or Shareholder-Employees

     No loan shall be granted to an Owner-Employee or Shareholder-Employee
     unless an exemption has been obtained for such loan from the Secretary of
     Labor under Section 408 of the Act (and such loan is exempt from the
     excise tax imposed under Section 4975 of the Code).


                                  ARTICLE XIII.
                             TOP-HEAVY PROVISIONS

As specified in the Adoption Agreement, the provisions of this Article XIII
will either (1) always supersede any conflicting provisions in the Plan or (2)
only supersede such conflicting provisions in any Plan Year beginning after
1983, during which the Plan is or becomes Top-Heavy.

13.1 Definitions

     For purposes of this Article and Article XVII, the following words shall
     have the following meanings:

     (a)   "Compensation" shall mean Compensation as defined in Article I as
           limited by section 401(a)(17) of the Code.

     (b)   "Determination Date" shall mean (1) the last day of the preceding
           Plan Year, or (2) in the case of the first Plan Year of any Plan, the
           last day of such Plan Year.

     (c)   "Employer" shall mean the Employer and all Affiliated Employers.

     (d)   "Key Employee" shall mean any Employee or former Employee (and the
           Beneficiaries of such Employee) who at any time during the Plan Year
           containing the Determination Date and the four (4) preceding Plan
           Years was:

           (1)  An officer of the Employer if such individual's annual
                compensation exceeds fifty percent (50%) of the dollar
                limitation under section 415(b)(1)(A) of the Code (provided that
                the number of employees treated as officers shall be no more
                than fifty (50) or, if fewer, the greater of three (3) employees
                or ten percent (10%) of all employees);

           (2)  An owner (or considered an owner under section 318 of the Code)
                of at least a one-half of one percent (.5%) interest and one of
                the ten (10) largest interests in the Employer if such
                individual's annual compensation exceeds one hundred percent
                (100%) of the dollar limitation under section 415(c)(1)(A) of
                the Code;

           (3)  A five percent (5%) owner of the Employer; or

           (4)  A one percent (1%) owner of the Employer who has an annual
                compensation of more than one hundred fifty thousand dollars
                ($150,000).

           For this purpose, annual compensation means compensation as defined
           in section 415(c)(3) of the Code, but including amounts excludible
           from the Employee's gross income by reason of sections 125,
           402(a)(8), 402(h) or 403(b) of the Code.  The determination of who
           is a Key Employee will be made in accordance with section 416(i)(1)
           of the Code and the regulations thereunder.

     (d)   "Non-Key Employee" shall mean any Employee who is not a Key Employee.

     (e)   "Permissive Aggregation Group" shall mean the Required Aggregation
           Group of plans plus any other plan or plans of the Employer which,
           when considered as a group with the Required Aggregation Group, would
           continue to satisfy the requirements of sections 401(a)(4) and 410
           of the Code.

     (f)   "Present Value" shall be based on the interest and mortality table
           specified in the Employer's qualified defined benefit plan for
           Top-Heavy purposes, or if such assumptions are not specified in the
           Employer's qualified defined benefit plan, Present Value shall be
           based on the assumptions specified in the Adoption Agreement.

     (g)   "Required Aggregation Group" shall mean (1) each qualified plan of
           the Employer in which at least one Key Employee participates or
           participated at any time during the determination period (regardless
           of whether the Plan has terminated), and (2) any other qualified plan
           of the Employer which enables a plan described in (1) to meet the
           requirements of Sections 401(a)(4) or 410 of the Code.

     (h)   "Super Top-Heavy Plan":  For any Plan Year after 1983, this Plan is
           Super Top-Heavy if the Top-Heavy Ratio for the Plan, the Required
           Aggregation Group or the Permissive Aggregation Group, as applicable,
           exceeds ninety percent (90%).

     (i)   "Top-Heavy":  For any Plan Year beginning after 1983, this Plan is
           Top-Heavy if any of the following conditions exist:

           (1)  If the Top-Heavy Ratio for this Plan exceeds sixty percent (60%)
                and this Plan is not part of any Required Aggregation Group or
                Permissive Aggregation Group of plans.

           (2)  If this Plan is a part of a Required Aggregation Group of plans,
                but not part of a Permissive Aggregation Group and the Top-Heavy
                Ratio for the group of plans exceeds sixty percent (60%).

           (3)  If this Plan is a part of a Required Aggregation Group and part
                of a Permissive Aggregation Group of plans and the Top-Heavy
                Ratio for the Permissive Aggregation Group exceeds sixty percent
                (60%).

     (j)   "Top-Heavy Ratio":

           (1)  If the Employer maintains one or more defined contribution plans
                (including any Simplified Employee Pension Plan) and the
                Employer has not maintained any defined benefit plan which
                during the five (5) year period ending on the Determination Date
                has or has had accrued benefits, the Top-Heavy Ratio for this
                Plan alone or for the Required or Permissive Aggregation Group
                as appropriate is a fraction, the numerator of which is the sum
                of the account balances of all Key Employees as of the
                Determination Date (including any part of any account balance
                distributed in the five (5) year period ending on the
                Determination Date, and the denominator of which is the sum of
                all account balances (including any part of any account balance
                distributed in the five (5) year period ending on the
                Determination Date, both computed in accordance with section 416
                of the Code and the regulations thereunder.  Both the numerator
                and denominator of the Top-Heavy Ratio are increased to reflect
                any contribution not actually made as of the Determination Date,
                but which is required to be taken into account on that date
                under section 416 of the Code and the regulations thereunder.

           (2)  If the Employer maintains one or more defined contribution plans
                (including any Simplified Employee Pension Plan) and the
                Employer maintains or has maintained one or more defined benefit
                plans which during the five (5) year period ending on the
                Determination Date has or has had any accrued benefits, the
                Top-Heavy Ratio for any Required or Permissive Aggregation Group
                as appropriate is a fraction, the numerator of which is the sum
                of account balances under the aggregated defined contribution
                plan or plans for all Key Employees determined in accordance
                with (d) above, and the Present Value of accrued benefits under
                the aggregated defined benefit plan or plans for all employees
                as of the Determination Date, and the denominator of which is
                the sum of the account balances under the aggregated defined
                contribution plan or plans for all participants, determined in
                accordance with (j)(1) above, and the Present Value of accrued
                benefits under the defined benefit plan or plans for all
                Participants as of the Determination Date, all determined in
                accordance with section 416 of the Code and the regulations
                thereunder.  The accrued benefits under a defined benefit plan
                in both the numerator and denominator of the Top-Heavy Ratio are
                increased for any distribution of an accrued benefit made in the
                five (5) year period ending on the Determination Date.

           (3)  For purposes of (1) and (2) above, the value of account balances
                and the Present Value of accrued benefits will be determined as
                of the most recent Valuation Date that falls within or ends with
                the twelve (12) month period ending on the Determination Date,
                except as provided in section 416 of the Code and the
                regulations thereunder for the first and second Plan years of
                a defined benefit plan.  The account balances and accrued
                benefits of a participant who is not a Key Employee but who was
                a Key Employee in a prior year, or has not been credited with
                at least one Hour of Service for any Employer maintaining the
                Plan at any time during the five (5) year period ending on the
                Determination Date will be disregarded.  The calculation of the
                Top-Heavy Ratio, and the extent to which distributions,
                rollovers, and transfers are taken into account will be made in
                accordance with section 416 of the Code and the regulations
                thereunder.  Deductible Employee contributions will not be taken
                into account for purposes of computing the Top-Heavy Ratio.
                When aggregating plans the value of account balances and accrued
                benefits will be calculated with references to the Determination
                Date that falls within the same calendar year.

           (4)  Solely for the purpose of determining if the Plan, or any other
                plan included in a Required Aggregation Group of which this Plan
                is a part, is Top-Heavy (within the meaning of section 416(g)
                of the Code) the accrued benefit of a Non-Key Employee shall be
                determined under (a) the method, if any, that uniformly applies
                for accrual purposes under all plans maintained by the Employer,
                or (b) if there is no such method, as if such benefit accrued
                not more rapidly than the slowest accrual rate permitted under
                the fractional accrual rate of section 411(b)(1)(C) of the Code.

     (k)   "Valuation Date" shall mean the last day of the Plan Year and is the
           day on which account balances and accrued benefits are valued for
           purposes of calculating the Top-Heavy Ratio.

13.2 Vesting Schedules

     For any Plan Year in which this Plan is Top-Heavy, one of the Top Heavy
     minimum vesting schedules as elected by the Employer in the Adoption
     Agreement will automatically apply to the Plan.  The Top Heavy Minimum
     vesting schedule applies to all benefits within the meaning of section
     411(a)(7) of the Code except those attributable to Employee contributions,
     including benefits accrued before the effective date of section 416 of the
     Code and benefits accrued before the Plan became Top-Heavy.  Further, no
     reduction in a vested benefit may occur in the event the Plan's status as
     Top-Heavy changes for any Plan Year.  However, this Section does not apply
     to the account balance of any Employee who does not have an Hour of
     Service after the Plan has initially become Top-Heavy and such Employee's
     account balance attributable to Employer contributions and forfeitures
     will be determined without regard to this Section.

13.3 Minimum Allocation

     (a)   Except as otherwise provided in (b), (c) and (d) below, when the Plan
           is Top-Heavy the Employer contributions and forfeitures allocated on
           behalf of any Participant who is a Non-Key Employee shall not be less
           than the lesser of three percent (3%) of such Participant's
           Compensation or, if neither the Employer nor an Affiliated Employer
           maintains a defined benefit plan which designates this Plan to
           satisfy sections 401(a)(4) or 410 of the Code, the largest percentage
           of Employer contributions and forfeitures, as a percentage of the Key
           Employee's Compensation, as limited by section 401(a)(17) of the Code
           allocated on behalf of any Key Employee for that year.  For purposes
           of determining whether a Plan is Top-Heavy, Elective Deferrals are
           considered Employer contributions.  However, neither Elective
           Deferrals nor Matching Contributions may be taken into account for
           purposes of satisfying the three percent (3%) minimum Top-Heavy
           contributions requirements for Plan Years beginning on or after
           January 1, 1989.

           The Minimum Allocation is determined without regard to a Social
           Security contribution.  This Minimum Allocation shall be made even
           though, under other Plan provisions, the Participant would not
           otherwise be entitled to receive an allocation, or would have
           received a lesser allocation for the year because of (1) the
           Participant's failure to complete one thousand (1,000) Hours of
           Service (or any equivalent provided in the Plan), (2) the
           Participant's failure to make mandatory employee contributions, or
           (3) the Participant's Compensation is less than a stated amount.

     (b)   The provision in (a) above shall not apply to any Participant who was
           not employed by the Employer on the last day of the Plan Year.

     (c)   If the Employer maintains a qualified defined benefit plan and this
           Plan is Top-Heavy, but is not Super Top-Heavy, each Participant who
           is a Non-Key Employee and is not covered by the defined benefit plan
           shall receive the Minimum Allocation under (a) above, except that
           "four percent (4%) "shall be substituted for "three percent (3%)".

     (d)   The provision in (a) above shall not apply with respect to any
           Participant covered under any other qualified plan or plans of the
           Employer other than a paired plan of the Sponsor and the adopting
           Employer has elected in the Adoption Agreement that the minimum Top
           Heavy allocation or benefit will be met in the other plan or plans.

           If the Employer maintains a qualified defined benefit plan, other
           than Sponsor's paired defined benefit plan 02001, and the adopting
           Employer has elected in the Adoption Agreement to provide the Top
           Heavy minimum allocation or benefit under this Plan, then with
           respect to participants covered under both plans, "five percent (5%)"
           shall be substituted for "three percent (3%)" in (a) above if the
           Plan is Super Top Heavy and "seven and one-half percent (7-1/2%)"
           shall be substituted for "three percent (3%)" in (a) above if the
           Plan is Top Heavy, but not Super Top Heavy.

     (e)   The Minimum Allocation required (to the extent nonforfeitable under
           section 416(b) of the Code) may not be forfeited under section
           411(a)(3)(B) or 411(a)(3)(D) of the Code.

13.4 Adjustment to Defined Benefit Fraction and Defined Contribution Fraction
     under section 6.4.

     If the Plan is Super Top-Heavy, then "one-hundred percent (100%)" shall
     be substituted for "one hundred twenty-five percent (125%)" in the
     denominator of the Defined Benefit Fraction and the Defined Contribution
     Fraction under Section 6.4.



                                 ARTICLE XIV.
                                 THE COMMITTEE

14.1 Creation of a Committee

     The Employer may appoint a person or persons to act as the Committee and
     serve at its pleasure.  If no such Committee is appointed, the Employer
     shall act as the Committee.  The Employer shall notify the Trustee of the
     appointment of the original members of the Committee and of each change
     in the membership of the Committee.  Vacancies in the Committee shall be
     filled by the Employer.

14.2 Committee Action

     In the event that the Employer appoints such person or persons to act as
     the Committee, such Committee shall act by a majority of its members at
     a meeting (which can be by telephone) or in writing without a meeting.
     A member of the Committee who is also a Participant of the Plan shall not
     vote or act as a member of the Committee upon any matter relating solely
     to his rights or benefits under the Plan.

14.3 Authorized Signatory

     Except as otherwise provided in Section 14.10, the Committee may designate
     a person or persons who shall be authorized to sign any document in the
     name of the Committee.  The Trustee shall be fully protected in relying
     upon any notice, instruction or certification from the Committee or
     executed pursuant to the provisions of this Section.

14.4 Powers and Duties

     The Committee shall have such powers and duties as are necessary for the
     proper administration of the Plan, including but not limited to the power
     to make decisions with respect to the application and interpretation of
     the Plan.  The Committee shall be empowered to establish rules and
     regulations for the transactions of its business and for the
     administration of the Plan.  The determinations of the Committee with
     respect to the interpretation, application, or administration of the Plan
     shall be final, binding, and conclusive upon each person or party
     interested or concerned.

14.5 Nondiscrimination

     Where provisions of this Plan are at the discretion of the Committee, all
     Participants shall be treated in a uniform and nondiscriminatory manner.

14.6 Records and Reports

     The Committee shall maintain such records as may be necessary for proper
     administration of the Plan and shall be responsible for supplying all
     information and reports to the Internal Revenue Service, Department of
     Labor, Participants, Beneficiaries and others as required by law.
     Employees may examine records pertaining directing to them.

14.7 Reliance on Professional Advice

     The Committee shall be entitled to rely conclusively on the advice or
     opinion of any consultant, accountant, or attorney and such persons may
     also act in their respective professional capacities as advisors to the
     Employer.

14.8 Payment of Expenses

     All expenses of administration may be paid out of the Trust Fund unless
     paid by the Employer.  Such expenses shall include any expenses incident
     to the duties of the Committee, including, but not limited to, fees of
     consultants, accountants, and attorneys, and other costs of administering
     the Plan.  Until paid, the expenses shall constitute a liability of the
     Trust Fund.  However, the Employer may reimburse the Trust Fund for any
     administration expense incurred.  Any administration expense paid to the
     Trust Fund as a reimbursement shall not be considered an Employer
     contribution.

14.9 Limitation of Liability

     The Committee must discharge its duties solely in the interest of the
     Participants and their Beneficiaries.  The Committee must carry out its
     duties with the care, skill, prudence and diligence under circumstances
     then prevailing that a prudent man acting in a like capacity and familiar
     with such matters would use in the conduct of an enterprise of like
     character and with like aims.  The Committee, however, shall not be liable
     for any acts or decisions based on the advice or opinion of any
     consultant, accountant or attorney employed by the Committee in their
     respective professional capacities as advisors to the Employer, provided,
     however, that the Committee did not violate its general fiduciary duty in
     selecting or retaining such advisor.

14.10      Payment Certification to Trustee

     The Committee shall provide written instruction to the Trustee with
     respect to all payments which become due under the terms of the Plan and
     shall direct the Trustee to make such payments from the Trust Fund.  All
     orders, requests and instructions by the Committee to the Trustee shall
     be in writing and signed by an authorized member of the Committee.

     The Trustee shall act and shall be fully protected in acting in accordance
     with such orders, requests and instructions.

14.11      Claims Procedure

     A Participant or Beneficiary ("Claimant") may file a written claim for
      benefits with the Committee.  If the Committee decides that a Claimant
      is not entitled to all or any part of the benefits claimed, it shall
      within ninety (90) days of receipt of such claim, inform the Claimant in
      writing of its determination; the reasons for its determination,
     including specific references to the pertinent Plan provisions; and the
     Plan's review procedures.  The Claimant or his authorized personal
     representative shall be permitted to review pertinent documents and within
     sixty (60) days after receipt of the notice of denial of claim to request
     to appear personally before it or to submit such further information or
     comments to the Committee as will, in the Claimant's opinion establish his
     right to such benefits.  The Committee will render its final decision with
     the specific reason therefore in writing and will transmit it to the
     claimant by certified mail within sixty (60) days (or one hundred twenty
     (120) days, if special circumstances require an extension of time and the
     claimant is given written notice within the initial sixty (60) day period)
     of any such appearance.  If the final decision is not made within such
     period, it will be considered denied.  If, upon review of a request for
     benefits hereunder, the Committee finds the Participant ineligible for
     such benefits, it shall inform the Participant in writing the reason or
     reasons for such denial.  In the event any Participant or Beneficiary
     disagrees with the conclusions of the Committee, the Committee must
     reconsider their decision based on the facts and evidence presented to
     them by the Participant or Beneficiary.  Further, the Committee must
     substantiate in writing to any Participant or Beneficiary who disagrees
     with the amount of his benefit the method under which the benefit
     computations were made.


                                  ARTICLE XV.
                              GENERAL PROVISIONS

15.1 No Right of Continued Employment

     No Employee or Participant shall have any right or claim to any benefit
     under the Plan except in accordance with the provisions of the Plan.  The
     adoption of the Plan shall not be construed as creating any contract of
     employment between the Employer and any Employee or otherwise conferring
     upon any Employee or other person any legal right to continuation of
     employment, nor as limiting or qualifying the right of the Employer to
     discharge any Employee without regard to the effect that such discharge
     might have upon his rights under the Plan.

15.2 Nonalienation of Interest

     No benefit or interest available hereunder will be subject to assignment
     or alienation, either voluntarily or involuntarily.  The preceding
     sentence shall not apply to loans made to the Participant under the Plan,
     or domestic relations orders which are determined by the Committee to be
     qualified domestic relations orders, as defined in section 414(p) of the
     Code and section 206(d)(3) of the Act, or were entered before January 1,
     1985.  Notwithstanding any provision in the Plan to the contrary, payments
     pursuant to a qualified domestic relations order may be made to an
     alternate payee prior to the time that the Plan may make payments to the
     affected Participant.

15.3 Incompetence of Participants and Beneficiaries

     If the Committee deems any person incapable of receiving benefits to which
     he is entitled by reason of minority, illness, infirmity, or other
     incapacity, it may direct the Trustee to make payment directly for the
     benefit of such person to a legal representative of such person.  Such
     payment shall, to the extent thereof, discharge all liability of the
     Employer, the Committee, the Trustee and the Fund.

15.4 Unclaimed Benefits

     If any benefit hereunder has been payable and unclaimed for four (4) years
     since the whereabouts or continued existence of the person entitled
     thereto was last known to the Committee, such benefit shall be placed in
     a segregated, interest-bearing suspense account with no further attempts
     to uncover the whereabouts of the person entitled thereto.  The Committee
     shall rely upon notification from the Department of Health, Education and
     Welfare as to the whereabouts of such person when he applies for benefits
     under the Social Security Act.  The four (4) year period may be extended
     by the Committee whenever, in its discretion, special circumstances
     justify such action.  The Committee shall make a reasonable and diligent
     search for the Participant before any benefit is segregated.  If a benefit
     is forfeited because the Participant or Beneficiary cannot be found, such
     benefit will be reinstated if a claim is made by the Participant or
     Beneficiary.

15.5 Separate Employer Trusts Maintained

     Except as provided in Section 16.5, the Plan of each Employer which adopts
     this Prototype Plan and corresponding Trust Agreement as part of its Plan
     shall be administered separately from those of any other Employer.

15.6

     The Plan shall be administered, construed and enforced to the state
     wherein the Trustee maintains its principal place of business, except to
     the extent preempted by the Act.

15.7 Severability

     Should any provision of the Plan or rules and regulations adopted
     thereunder be deemed or held to be unlawful or invalid for any reason,
     such fact shall not adversely affect the other provisions unless such
     invalidity shall render impossible or impractical the functioning of the
     Plan.  In such case, the appropriate parties shall immediately adopt a new
     provision to take the place of the illegal or invalid provision.

15.8 Gender and Number

     The masculine pronoun wherever used shall include the feminine pronoun and
     the singular shall include the plural and the plural shall include the
     singular, wherever appropriate to the context.

15.9 Titles and Headings

     The titles or headings of the respective Articles and Sections are
     inserted merely for convenience and shall be given no legal effect.

15.10      Failure of Employer's Plan to Qualify

     The use of this Prototype Plan and corresponding Trust Agreement shall be
     available only to the Plans of Employers which meet the requirements of
     section 401(a) of the Code.  If the Employer's Plan fails to attain or
     retain qualification, such Plan will no longer participate in this
     Prototype Plan and will be considered an individually designed plan.

15.11      Exclusive Benefit

     Except as provided in Section 6.3, at no time shall any part of the corpus
     or income of the Fund be used for or diverted to purposes other than for
     the exclusive benefit of the Participants and their Beneficiaries and
     defraying reasonable expenses of the Plan.

15.12      Action by Employer

     Any action, including the amendment or termination of the Plan as provided
     in Sections 16.1 and 16.2 of the Plan, by an Employer which is a
     corporation shall be taken by the board of directors of the corporation
     or any person or persons duly empowered to exercise the powers of the
     corporation with respect to the Plan.  In the case of an Employer which
     is a partnership, any action, including the amendment or termination of
     the Plan as provided in Sections 16.1 and 16.2 of the Plan, shall be taken
     by any general partner or the partnership.  In the case of an Employer
     which is a sole proprietorship, any action, including the amendment or
     termination of the Plan as provided in Sections 16.1 and 16.2 of the Plan,
     shall be taken by the sole proprietor.



                                  ARTICLE XVI
                           AMENDMENT AND TERMINATION

16.1 Amendment

     (a)   The Employer expressly recognizes the authority of the Sponsor to
           amend the Plan and the Trust Agreement or Custodial Agreement from
           time to time, and the Employer shall be deemed to have consented to
           any such amendment.  The Employer shall receive a written instrument
           indicating the amendment of the Plan and Trust Agreement and such
           amendment shall become effective as of the effective date of such
           instrument.

     (b)   The Employer reserves the right to amend the Plan at any time.
           Except for (1) changes to the choice of options in the Adoption
           Agreement, (2) amendments stated in the Adoption Agreement which
           allow the Plan to satisfy section 415 of the Code or to avoid
           duplication of minimums under section 416 of the Code because of the
           required aggregation of multiple plans, or (3) amendments published
           by the Internal Revenue Service which specifically provide that their
           adoption will not cause the Plan to be treated as individually
           designed, an Employer will no longer participate in the Prototype
           Plan and will be considered to have an individually designed plan if
           it amends the Plan or obtains a waiver of the minimum funding
           requirement under Section 412(d) of the Code.

     (c)   Notwithstanding anything in this Plan to the contrary, no amendment
           shall:

           (1)  Increase the responsibility of the Trustee without the Trustee's
                written consent;

           (2)  Have the effect of decreasing a Participant's account balance
                or eliminating an optional form of benefit with respect to
                accrued benefits, except to the extent permitted by section
                412(c)(8) of the Code;

           (3)  In the case of an Employee who is a Participant as of the later
                of the date such amendment is adopted or the date it becomes
                effective, decrease the nonforfeitable percentage (determined
                as of such date) of such Employee's right to his
                Employer-derived account balance below his non-forfeitable
                percentage computed under the Plan without regard to such
                amendment;

           (4)  Violate the exclusive benefit rule of Section 15.11.

16.2 Termination and Partial Termination

     The adopting Employer may, at any time, by written notice to the Trustee
     in such form as is acceptable to the Trustee, terminate the Plan and
     discontinue all further contributions hereunder.  Upon termination or
     partial termination of the Plan or upon complete discontinuance of
     contributions to a Profit Sharing Plan, each affected Employee shall have
     a one hundred percent (100%) vested and nonforfeitable interest in his
     account balance.  Upon a termination or partial termination of the Plan
     (and subject to the limitations of section 4.10 in the case of a cash or
     deferred arrangement qualified under section 401(k) of the Code), each
     affected Participant's account balance may be distributed in accordance
     with the provisions of Article VIII or, at the option of the Employer and
     with the Trustee's consent, shall continue to be held by the Trustee for
     distribution as authorized by Articles VIII and IX.  Notwithstanding the
     preceding sentence, a Profit Sharing Plan which does not offer an annuity
     form of benefit (purchased from a commercial provider) may distribute each
     affected Participant's account balance immediately in a single sum without
     Participant consent, provided that neither the Employer nor any Affiliated
     Employer maintains another defined contribution plan, other than an
     employee stock ownership plan (as defined in section 4975(e)(7) of the
     Code).  If either the Employer or any Affiliated Employer maintains
     another such defined contribution plan, then a Participant's account
     balance may be transferred to such plan without his consent if the
     Participant does not consent to the single sum distribution from this
     Plan.

16.3 Plan Merger and Consolidation or Transfer of Plan Assets

     In the event of any merger or consolidation with, or transfer of assets
     or liabilities to, any other plan, each Participant of this Plan would (if
     the Plan then terminated) receive an amount immediately after such merger,
     consolidation or transfer which is equal to or greater than the amount he
     would have been entitled to receive immediately before the merger,
     consolidation, or transfer (if the Plan had then terminated).

16.4 Amended and Restated Plans

     If this Plan is an amendment and restatement of an existing plan
     ("Existing Plan"), the following provisions shall apply:

     (a)   Each Employee who was a participant in the Existing Plan immediately
           prior to the Effective Date shall become a Participant in this Plan
           on the Effective Date.

     (b)   The balance of such Employee's accounts under the Existing Plan
           attributable to employer or employee contributions shall be allocated
           to the corresponding Accounts under this Plan or accounted for
           separately.

     (c)   All years of service credited for vesting service under the Existing
           Plan shall be credited as years of Service under this Plan.  The
           amendment and restatement shall not reduce the vested interest of a
           participant in the Existing Plan, and any change in the vesting
           schedule shall be subject to the provisions of Section 7.3.

     (d)   The amendment and restatement shall not reduce a Participant's
           account balance and shall not eliminate any optional form of benefit.

     (e)   Any beneficiary designation in effect under the Existing Plan
           immediately before the amendment and restatement shall be deemed to
           be a valid Beneficiary designation under this Plan, to the extent
           consistent with Article VIII.

16.5 Participating Employers

     (a)   With the consent of the Employer and Trustee, and by duly authorized
           action, any Affiliated Employer may adopt this Plan and become a
           Participating Employer.

     (b)   Each such Participating Employer shall be bound by the same Adoption
           Agreement provisions as those selected by the Employer, and to use
           the same Trustee as the Employer.  If the Employer does not make a
           contribution to the Plan, the Participating Employer shall be
           obligated to do so.

     (c)   The Trustee may, but shall not be required to commingle, hold and
           invest as one Trust Fund all contributions made by Participating
           Employers, as well as all increments thereof.

     (d)   With respect to its relations with the Trustee and Committee for the
           purposes of this Plan, each Participating Employer shall be deemed
           to have irrevocably designated the adopting Employer as its agent.
           Amendment of this Plan by the adopting Employer at any time when
           there shall be a Participating Employer hereunder shall only be by
           the written action of the adopting Employer, with the consent of the
           Trustee where such consent is necessary in accordance with the terms
           of this Plan.

     (e)   A Participating Employer may, at any time, by written notice to the
           Employer and Trustee in such form as is acceptable to the Employer
           and Trustee, discontinue its participation in the plan and
           discontinue all further contributions hereunder.  The Employer shall
           direct the Trustee to transfer, deliver and assign Fund assets
           attributable to the Participants of such Participating Employer to
           such successor trustee as shall have been designated by such
           Participating Employer, in the event that it has established a
           separate plan for its Employees.  If no successor trustee is
           designated, the Trustee shall retain such assets for the
           Employees of said Participating Employer pursuant to the provisions
           of Articles VIII and IX hereof.

                                  ARTICLE XVII.
                            PAIRED PLAN PROVISIONS

The provisions of this Article are applicable only if the Employer adopts a set
of Dreyfus paired plans.  Paired plans are a combination of standardized form
plans offered by the Sponsor, so designed that if any single plan or
combination of plans is adopted by an Employer each plan by itself, or the
plans together, will meet the anti-discrimination rules set forth in section
401(a)(4) of the Code, the contribution and benefit limits set forth in section
415 of the Code and the Top-Heavy provisions set forth in section 416 of the
Code.

17.1 Compliance With Section 415(e) of the Code

     If the Employer adopts one or two of Sponsor's paired defined contribution
     plans and Sponsor's paired defined benefit plan, the "1.0" aggregate
     limitation of section 415(e) of the Code on contributions and benefits
     will be met by freezing or reducing the rate of benefit accruals under the
     paired defined benefit plan.

17.2 Adjustment of Combined Plan Fractions Under Section 415 of the Code for
     Top-Heavy Ratio in Excess of Ninety Percent (90%)

     In any Plan Year in which the Plan becomes Super Top-Heavy, the
     denominators of the Defined Benefit Fraction (as defined in Section 6.4
     of the Plan) and the Defined Contribution Fraction (as defined in Section
     6.4 of the Plan) shall be computed using one hundred percent (100%) of the
     dollar limitation instead of one hundred twenty-five percent (125%).

17.3 Top-Heavy Minimum Benefits and Contributions

     (a)   When the paired plans maintained by the Employer are Top-Heavy, but
           are not Super Top-Heavy, each Non-Key Employee who participates in
           paired defined contribution plan number 01001, 01003, 01004, 01005
           or 01006, but does not participate in paired defined benefit plan
           number 02001, will receive the Minimum Allocation provided for in
           Section 13.3.  Each Non-Key Employee who participates in two of the
           paired defined contribution plans, but not the paired defined benefit
           plan, shall receive the minimum Top-Heavy allocation under the paired
           defined contribution plan specified in the Adoption Agreement.  Each
           Non-Key Employee who is a participant in this Plan and the paired
           defined benefit plan shall receive the minimum top-heavy benefit
           accrual under such plan and shall not receive any top-heavy minimum
           contribution under the paired defined contribution plan or plans.

     (b)   When the paired plans maintained by the Employer are Super Top-Heavy,
           each Non-Key Employee who participates in paired defined contribution
           plan number 01001, 01003, 01004, 01005 or 01006 but who does not
           participate in paired defined benefit plan number 02001, will receive
           the Minimum Allocation provided for in Section 13.3.  Each Non-Key
           Employee who participates in two of the paired defined contribution
           plans, but not the defined benefit plan, shall receive the minimum
           top-heavy allocation under the paired defined contribution plan
           specified in the Adoption Agreement.  Each Non-Key Employee who is
           a Participant in this Plan and the paired defined benefit plan shall
           receive the minimum top heavy benefit accrual under such plan and
           shall not receive any top heavy minimum contribution under the paired
           defined contribution plan or plans.

17.4 Integration of Paired Plans

     If the Employer adopts paired plans, only one plan may allocate
     contributions or determine benefits on an integrated basis.




                            DREYFUS TRUST AGREEMENT


THIS TRUST AGREEMENT is made by and between the Employer whose name is set
forth on the attached adoption agreement (the "Adoption Agreement") and the
person designated as Trustee in the Adoption Agreement (the "Trustee").

                             W I T N E S S E T H:

WHEREAS, the Employer has adopted the qualified employee retirement plan
described in the Adoption Agreement (the "Plan") for the exclusive benefit
of its employees who are participants in such Plan (collectively the
"Participants" and individually a "Participant") and their beneficiaries;
and

WHEREAS, the Employer desires to appoint the Trustee as a "nondiscretionary
trustee" (within the meaning of Section VI(g) of Prohibited Transaction
Class Exemption 77-9 under Section 408(a) of the Employee Retirement Income
Security Act of 1974, as amended ("ERISA")) for the limited purposes
hereinafter set forth; and

WHEREAS, the Trustee desires to act as such a nondiscretionary trustee of
the Plan for the limited purposes hereinafter set forth;

NOW, THEREFORE, the Employer hereby establishes a fund with the Trustee that
shall be held, managed and controlled by the Trustee without distinction
between principal and income (the "Trust Fund") upon the terms and
conditions hereinafter set forth:


                                   ARTICLE 1
                           CONCERNING THE TRUST FUND

Section 1.1.  The Plan, this Trust Agreement and the Trust Fund created
hereunder are intended to meet all the applicable requirements of Sections
401(a) and 501(a) of the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended (the
"Code") and ERISA.  The Employer assumes full responsibility to establish
and maintain the Plan as a plan meeting the qualification requirements of
Section 401(a) of the Code and hereby agrees to notify the Trustee promptly
in the event of any change in such qualified status.  Copies of all
documents related to the Plan including, without limitation, the Plan,
amendments to the Plan and the most recent determination letter received
from the Internal Revenue Service with respect to the Plan (or an opinion of
counsel satisfactory to the Trustee as to the plan's qualified status), upon
request will be provided to the Trustee by the Employer.

 Section 1.2.  The Employer certifies and represents to the Trustee that
there are no duties imposed on the Trustee under the terms of the Plan that
are not consistent with the provisions of this Trust Agreement.

Section 1.3.  The Trustee agrees to accept contributions that are paid to it
by the Employer (as well as rollover contributions and transfers from other
qualified retirement plans) in accordance with the terms of the Plan.  The
Trustee shall be entitled to rely upon the determination of the fiduciary
named in the Plan as having the authority to control and manage the
administration of the Plan and its delegates, designees, agents and
employees (the "Committee") that all assets received by the Trustee are
properly contributed or transferred in accordance with the terms of the
Plan.  Such contributions shall be in cash or in such other form that may be
acceptable to the Trustee.  All contributions received by the Trustee and
all other receipts of the Trustee, whether by way of dividends, interest or
otherwise, for the account of the Trust Fund shall be held, managed and
controlled by the Trustee pursuant to the terms of this Trust Agreement
without distinction between principal and income and may be commingled, and
held and invested and, with all disbursements therefrom, accounted for by
the Trustee, as a single fund.  The Employer hereby agrees that the Employer
and the Committee shall have the exclusive responsibility, and the Trustee
shall not have any responsibility or duty under this Trust Agreement, to
determine whether the amount, timing and type of any contribution by the
Employer or any Participant is in accordance with the terms of the Plan or
applicable law, or for the collection of any contributions under the Plan.

Section 1.4  The Trustee, solely from assets held in the Trust Fund, shall
make payments in such amounts and for such proper purposes as may be
specified in the Committee's Directions (as defined in Section 2.1 herein).
The Employer hereby agrees that the Committee shall have the exclusive
responsibility, and the Trustee shall not have any responsibility or duty,
under this Trust Agreement for determining that the Committee's Directions
are in accordance with the terms of the Plan and applicable law, including
without limitation, determining the amount, timing or method of payment or
the identity of each person to whom such payments shall be made.  The
Trustee shall have no responsibility or duty to determine the tax effect of
any payment or to see to the application of any payment, but shall be
responsible for the proper application of amounts withheld from
distributions for payment of taxes to the appropriate authorities.

Section 1.5.  The Trustee shall have no duties or obligations with respect
to the Trust Fund unless such duties or obligations have been specifically
undertaken by the Trustee by the express terms of the Trust Agreement or
except to the extent such duties or obligations are required under
applicable laws.


                                   ARTICLE II
                   INVESTMENT AND ADMINISTRATION OF THE FUND

Section 2.1.1.  In accordance with the provisions of ERISA, the Trustee
shall have exclusive authority and discretion to manage and control the
Trust Fund; provided, however, that the Trustee's authority and discretion
with respect to the Trust Fund shall at all times, except to the extent that
an Investment Manager has been appointed pursuant to Section 2.5, be subject
to the proper, written directions of the Committee which are made in
accordance with the terms of the Plan and which are not contrary to ERISA
(the "Committee's Directions").  The Trustee shall be entitled to rely
entirely on the Committee's Directions, shall be under no duty to determine
or make inquiry whether the Committee's Directions received by it are in
accordance with the provisions of the Plan or applicable law, and shall have
no liability and shall be fully indemnified by the Employer for any action
taken in accordance with, or any failure to act in the absence of, the
Committee's Directions.

Section 2.1.2.  If the Committee advises the Trustee that the Plan provides
for individual accounts and permits each Participant to direct the
investment of the assets in the Participant's account, then, pursuant to the
Committee's Directions, the Trustee shall invest the assets in such account
among the investment options established pursuant to Section 2.3 as directed
by each such Participant in accordance with such procedures as are
acceptable to the Trustee.  If such procedures include the effecting of
exchanges among the investment options established pursuant to Section 2.3
or otherwise directing the investment of the assets allocated to a
Participant's account by use of the telephone system maintained for such
purpose by the trustee or its agent, the Trustee shall be entitled to rely
on any telephonic direction reasonably believed by it to be genuine from any
person representing himself or herself to be a Participant directing the
investment of assets in his or her account, provided that the Trustee
employs reasonable procedures for processing such directions, such as
requiring a form of personal identification, to confirm that telephonic
directions are genuine.  If the Trustee does not follow such procedures, it
may be liable for any losses due to processing unauthorized or fraudulent
directions.  Subject to the foregoing, the Trustee shall be entitled to rely
entirely on Participants' directions, shall be under no duty to determine or
make inquiry whether Participants' directions are in accordance with the
provisions of the Plan or applicable law, and shall have no liability and
shall be fully indemnified by the Employer for any action taken in
accordance with, or any failure to act in the absence of, Participants'
directions.

Section 2.2  Except to the extent an Investment Manager has been appointed
pursuant to Section 2.5, the Committee shall have authority and discretion
to select the nature and amount of the investments to be made under the
Plan.  Subject to Section 2.5, the Trustee shall invest, reinvest and
dispose of the assets comprising the Trust Fund in accordance with the
Committee's Directions.  The Committee shall exercise such authority and
discretion solely in the interest of the Participants and their
beneficiaries and (1) for the exclusive purpose of (a) providing benefits to
the Participants and their beneficiaries and (b) defraying reasonable
expenses of administering the Plan, (2) with the care, skill, prudence and
diligence under the circumstances then prevailing that a prudent person
acting in a like capacity and familiar with such matters would use in the
conduct of an enterprise of a like character and with like aims, (3) by
diversifying the investments of the Plan so as to minimize the risk of large
losses, unless under the circumstances it is clearly prudent not to do so
and (4) in accordance with the terms of the Plan and with applicable law.
The Trustee shall have no duty hereunder to review the investments held in
the Trust Fund.  The Trustee shall not make suggestions or otherwise render
investment advice to the Committee or any Participant with respect to
investment, reinvestment, or disposition of assets held in the Trust Fund.

Section 2.3.  Except to the extent required under applicable law, the
authority and discretion of the Trustee with respect to the Trust Fund shall
be limited to the following nondiscretionary powers which, with the
exception of those powers set forth in Section 2.3(0), shall be exercised
solely in accordance with the Committee's Directions or, to the extent
provided in Section 2.1.2, the directions of Participants or, to the extent
provided in Section 2.5, the directions of an Investment Manager:

     (a)   To open and maintain accounts for the Plan, and to the extent that
           the Plan is a "defined contribution plan" (within the meaning of
           Section 3(34) of ERISA), individual accounts for each of the
           Participants.

     (b)   To receive contributions from the Employer and to credit
           contributions made by the Employer to the individual accounts of
           Participants established    pursuant to paragraph (a) above.


     (c)   To invest contributions made by the Employer and other assets of
           the Plan in shares of any investment company sponsored, managed,
           advised, administered or distributed by The Dreyfus Corporation or
           any of its affiliates (the "Dreyfus Funds"), in equity securities
           issued by the Employer or an affiliate which are publicly traded
           and which are "qualifying employer securities" within the meaning
           of Section 407(d)(5) of ERISA ("Employer Stock"), in any
           collective investment fund maintained by a bank or trust company
           as a "group trust" for the collective investment of employee
           benefit plans qualified under Section 401(a) of the Code, and such
           other investments as may be acceptable to the Trustee and as
           agreed to in writing by The Dreyfus Corporation ("Sponsor") and
           the Committee (the Dreyfus Funds and such other investments shall
           be collectively referred to as the "Investments"); and to reinvest
           dividends and other distributions in the Dreyfus Funds or other
           Investments provided, however, that if the Plan is established
           pursuant to one of the Sponsor's prototype plan documents,
           investments shall be subject to such investment limitations or
           minimum requirements for investments in Dreyfus Funds as may be
           imposed by the Sponsor.  The Employer hereby agrees that the
           Trustee shall not be restricted in making such investments to
           investments that are authorized by governing state laws (as
           determined under Section 9.5) for the investment of trust funds.
           If Plan assets are invested in any group trust, the terms of the
           group trust agreement or other governing document are hereby
           incorporated by reference and made a part of the Trust Agreement
           as long as the group trust remains exempt from taxation under
           Section 501(a) of the Code.  The Trustee shall not be responsible
           in any way respecting the form, terms, payment provisions or
           issuer of any insurance contract which it is directed to purchase
           and/or hold to provide for the payment of benefits, or for
           performing any functions under any such insurance contract which
           it may be directed to purchase and/or hold as contract holder
           thereunder (other than the execution of any documents incidental
           thereto and transfer or receipt of funds thereunder in accordance
           with the Committee's Directions).

     (d)   To redeem, transfer or exchange shares of the Dreyfus Funds, to
           sell, exchange, convey, transfer or otherwise dispose of any other
           Investments; and to make, execute and deliver to the purchasers
           thereof good and sufficient legal documents of conveyance
           therefor, and all assignments, transfers and other legal
           instruments, either necessary or convenient for passing the title
           and ownership of the Investments, and no person dealing with the
           Trustee shall be bound to see to the application of the purchase
           money or to inquire into the validity, expediency or propriety of
           any such sale or disposition.

     (e)   To make distributions from the Trust Fund to Participants and
           their beneficiaries.

     (f)   To deliver notices, prospectuses and proxy statements to
           Participants or to the Employer, and to vote in person or by proxy
           with respect to any securities held by the Trust Fund in
           accordance with the written directions of the Committee or of the
           Participants, as the case may be; and in accordance with such
           power, to exercise subscription, conversion and other rights and
           options and to take action or refrain from taking any action with
           respect to any reorganization, consolidation, merger, dissolution
           or other recapitalization or refinancing to the extent that the
           exercise of such rights and options or the taking or refraining
           from such actions may be deemed by the Trustee to be necessary or
           proper to protect the best interests of the Trust Fund.

     (g)   To maintain records of contributions, investments, distributions
           and other transactions, and to report such transactions to the
           Employer or such other persons as may be designated by the
           Employer.

     (h)   To make necessary filings with the Internal Revenue Service, the
           Department of Labor and other governmental agencies.

     (i)   To hold any part of the Trust Fund in cash or cash balances.

     (j)   To hold custody of the assets of the Plan; and with respect to any
           such assets held in custody by the Trustee, to cause any
           investment of the Trust Fund to be registered in the name of the
           Trustee or the name of its nominee or nominees or to retain such
           investment unregistered or in a form permitting transfer by
           delivery, provided that the books and records of the Trustee shall
           at all times show that all such investments are part of the Trust
           Fund.

     (k)   To apply for, purchase, hold or transfer any life insurance,
           retirement income, endowment or annuity contract.

     (l)   To consult and employ any suitable agent(s) to act on behalf of
           the Trustee and to contract for legal, accounting, clerical and
           other services deemed necessary by the Trustee to administer the
           Trust Fund according to the terms of this Trust Agreement and the
           instructions of the Committee.

     (m)   To make loans from the Trust Fund to Participants in amounts and
           on terms approved by the Committee; and Employer hereby agrees
           that the Committee shall have the sole responsibility, and the
           Trustee shall not have any duty or responsibility, for computing
           and collecting any loan repayments required to be made under the
           Plan.

     (n)   To pay from the Trust Fund all taxes imposed or levied with
           respect to the Trust Fund or any part thereof under existing or
           future laws, and to contest the validity or amount of any tax,
           assessment, claim or demand respecting the Trust Fund or any part
           thereof.

     (o)   To pay out of the Trust Fund (i) all brokerage fees and transfer
           tax expenses and other expenses incurred in connection with the
           sale or purchase of investments, (ii) the Trustee's compensation
           and (iii) all other expenses of administering the Plan and the
           Trust Fund including, without limitation, any payments authorized
           by Section 1.4 of this Agreement, unless promptly paid to the
           Trustee, or otherwise, by the Employer.  The Trustee shall have
           the authority to pay all fees and expenses described in this
           Section 2.3(0) out of the Trust Fund in the event such fees and
           expenses are not promptly paid by the Employer and the Trustee is
           not in receipt of Committee Direction to make such payments.

     (p)   To do all such acts, and to exercise all such rights and
           privileges, although not specifically mentioned herein, as the
           Trustee may deem necessary or proper to carry out any of the
           nondiscretionary powers set forth herein or otherwise in the best
           interests of the Trust Fund and required by applicable law.

Section 2.4.  Investments in Employer Stock shall be subject to the
following notwithstanding any other provision in this Trust Agreement:

     (a)   In accordance with the Committee's Directions, the Trust Fund may
           be invested in Employer Stock without regard to the ten percent
           (10%) limitation with respect to the acquisition and holding of
           employer securities set forth in Section 407(a)(2) of ERISA if the
           Plan qualifies as an "eligible individual account plan" under
           Section 407(d)(3) of ERISA.

     (b)   The Committee shall be responsible for determining the
           appropriateness under the fiduciary responsibility and other
           applicable provisions of ERISA of acquiring and holding Employer
           Stock.  The Trustee shall not be liable for any loss, or by reason
           of any breach, which arises from following directions with respect
           to the acquisition and holding of Employer Stock.

     (c)   Subject to the provisions of Section 2.4(d), the Trustee shall
           purchase and sell Employer Stock in accordance with such
           procedures and guidelines as annexed hereto as Schedule A.

     (d)   At the Committee's Directions, the Trustee shall purchase or sell
           Employer Stock on the open market or from or to the Employer.  In
           addition, the Employer may contribute Employer Stock in lieu of
           cash to the Trust Fund.  In the event the Trustee uses one of its
           affiliates to effect the purchase or sale of Employer Stock, the
           Trustee and such affiliate shall comply with the provisions of
           Prohibited Transaction Class Exemption 86-128.  In the event that
           the Committee directs the Trustee to use a particular broker or
           dealer to effect the purchase or sale of Employer Stock, the
           Committee shall represent to the Trustee that such direction (i)
           is for the exclusive benefit of Participants and Beneficiaries of
           the Plan, and (ii) shall not constitute, or cause the Trust Fund
           to be engaged in, a "prohibited transaction" as defined in Section
           406 of ERISA.  In the event the Trustee purchases or sells
           Employer Stock from or to the Employer, such purchase or sale
           shall be for "adequate consideration" as defined in Section 3(18)
           of ERISA and no commission shall be charged.  In the event that
           the Employer contributes Employer Stock in lieu of cash to the
           Trust Fund, such transfer shall be for "adequate consideration" as
           defined in Section 3(18) of ERISA and no commission shall be
           charged.

     (e)   The Employer represents and warrants that it has filed and will
           file with the Securities and Exchange Commission and with all
           applicable state agencies or authorities all required registration
           statements relating to shares of Employer Stock and other
           interests which may be issued under the Plan.  The Employer
           acknowledges that it is and shall be responsible for, and that the
           Trustee shall not be responsible for, preparing or filing such
           registration statements or for the accuracy of statements
           contained therein, or for preparing or filing any other reports,
           statements or filings required under federal or state securities
           laws with respect to the Trust Fund's investment in Employer
           Stock.

     (f)   The Employer shall provide the Trustee with a copy of all proxy
           solicitation materials proposed to be sent to stockholders at
           least (7) days before the materials are sent to stockholders or if
           the issuer of Employer Stock held in the Trust Fund files
           preliminary proxy solicitation materials with the Securities and
           Exchange Commission, the Employer shall cause a copy of all
           materials to be simultaneously sent the Trustee.  The Trustee, in
           its discretion, may prepare or amend any proxy voting form sent to
           Participants.  The Trustee shall determine which of the procedures
           set forth in subparagraph (f)(i) or subparagraph (f)(ii) are to be
           followed in sending proxy solicitation materials, including any
           amended or supplemental materials, to Participants.

           (i)  The Trustee shall provide the Employer or its designee with
                mailing labels and proxy labels for each Participant to whose
                account shares of Employer Stock (both vested and non-vested)
                are credited.  Proxy labels so provided shall indicate the
                number of shares (including fractional interests in shares)
                of Employer Stock credited to each Participant's account
                (both vested and non-vested).  At the time of mailing of
                notice of each annual or special stockholders' meeting of the
                issuer of Employer Stock, the Employer or its designee shall
                cause a copy of the notice, all proxy solicitation materials,
                and all other materials to be sent to stockholders to be sent
                to each affected Participant.  The Employer shall provide the
                Trustee with a copy of all materials provided to Participants
                and shall certify to the Trustee that the materials have been
                mailed or otherwise sent to each affected Participant.

           (ii) The Employer shall provide the Trustee with such quantities
                of the notice of meeting, all proxy solicitation materials
                and all other materials to be sent to stockholders as may be
                requested by the Trustee.  At the time of mailing of notice
                of each annual or special stockholders' meeting of the issuer
                of the Employer Stock, the Trustee or its designee shall send
                a copy of such materials and a voting instruction form
                prepared by the Trustee to each affected Participant.

           The proxy voting form shall be returnable to the Trustee or its
           designee.  Each Participant shall be entitled to direct the
           Trustee by means of the proxy voting form as to the voting of
           shares (including fractional interests in shares) of Employer
           Stock credited to such Participant's account (both vested and non-
           vested).  Upon timely receipt of the proxy voting form, the
           Trustee shall vote the shares of Employer Stock as instructed.
           Instructions received by the Trustee from Participants shall be
           held by the Trustee in strict confidence and shall not, except as
           may be required by law, be divulged or released to any person
           including officers or employees of the Employer or members of the
           Committee; provided, however, that the Trustee may advise the
           Employer, upon request, of the total number of votes that have
           been cast with respect to a particular issue.  The Trustee shall
           not make recommendations to Participants on whether to vote or how
           to vote shares of Employer Stock.  The Trustee shall not vote
           shares of Employer Stock credited to a Participant's account for
           which it has not received instructions from the Participant.  The
           Trustee shall not be obligated to solicit a response from
           Participants from whom it has not received instructions.  The
           Trustee shall vote shares of Employer Stock not credited to
           Participants' accounts in the same proportion on each issue as it
           votes those shares credited to Participants' accounts for which it
           received voting instructions from Participants.

     (g)   In the event of a tender or exchange offer for any Employer Stock
           held in the Trust Fund, the Trustee shall use its best efforts to
           distribute or cause to be distributed to each affected Participant
           in a timely manner all information and materials that are
           distributed to the stockholders of the issuer of the Employer
           Stock in connection with the offer and directions as to how the
           Participant may instruct the Trustee whether or not to tender or
           exchange the Employer Stock credited to the Participant's account
           (both vested and non-vested).  Alternatively, the Trustee may
           agree that the notification of Participants and distribution of
           the information, materials and directions described above are to
           be effected by the Employer or its designee.  In such event, the
           Employer shall provide the Trustee with a copy of all information,
           materials and directions provided to Participants and shall
           certify to the Trustee that the information, materials and
           directions have been mailed or otherwise sent to each affected
           Participant.  The Trustee, in its discretion, may prepare or amend
           any instruction form sent to Participants.  Instructions shall be
           returnable to the Trustee or its designee.  Each Participant shall
           be entitled to direct the Trustee to tender or exchange shares
           (including fractional interest in shares) of Employer Stock
           credited to such Participant's account (both vested and non-
           vested).  Upon timely receipt of instructions, the Trustee shall
           act with respect to Employer Stock as instructed.  Instructions
           received by the Trustee from Participants shall be held by the
           Trustee in strict confidence and shall not, except as may be
           required by law, be divulged or released to any person including
           officers or employees of the Employer or members of the Committee;
           provided, however, that the Trustee may advise the Employer, upon
           request, of the total number of shares of Employer Stock that have
           been tendered or exchanged.  The Trustee shall not make
           recommendations to Participants on whether to tender or exchange.
           The Trustee shall not tender or exchange shares of Employer Stock
           credited to a Participant's account for which it has not received
           instructions from the Participant.  The Trustee shall not be
           obligated to solicit a response from Participants from whom it has
           not received instructions.  The Trustee shall tender or exchange
           that number of shares of Employer Stock not credited to
           Participants' accounts which is determined (after giving effect to
           the withdrawal of any shares of Employer Stock before the
           expiration of the offer or any earlier date set by the Trustee) by
           multiplying the total number of shares of Employer Stock not
           credited to Participants' accounts by a fraction of which the
           numerator is the number of shares of Employer Stock credited to
           Participants' accounts for which the Trustee has received
           instructions from Participants to tender or exchange and of which
           the denominator is the total number of shares of Employer Stock
           credited to Participants' accounts.  A Participant who has
           instructed the Trustee to tender or exchange shares of Employer
           Stock credited to such Participant's account may, at any time
           prior to the expiration of the offer or any earlier date set by
           the Trustee, instruct the Trustee to withdraw a specified number
           of shares from the offer.  A Participant shall not be limited as
           to the number of instructions that the Participant may give to the
           Trustee.  If a Participant instructs the Trustee to tender or
           exchange shares of Employer Stock credited to the Participant's
           account, the Trustee shall credit to each account of such
           Participant from which the shares were taken the consideration
           received by the Trustee for the shares of Employer Stock tendered
           or exchanged from that account.  Pending receipt of Committee
           Directions or, to the extent provided in Section 2.1.2 of the
           Trust Agreement, instructions from the Participant as to the
           investment of such proceeds, the Trustee shall invest any cash
           consideration in such money market mutual fund as is designated in
           writing by the Committee.

     (h)   For purposes of this Section 2.4, the number of shares of Employer
           Stock deemed "credited" to a Participant's account shall be
           determined as of the last preceding valuation date for which an
           allocation has been completed and Employer Stock has actually been
           credited to Participants' accounts.  The Trustee may, in its
           discretion, require a special valuation of Participant accounts
           and crediting of Employer Stock.

     (i)   In the event that the Trustee, in its discretion, determines that
           time constraints make it unlikely that Participant voting or
           tender or exchange instructions can be received in a timely
           fashion, the Trustee shall notify the Committee and the Committee
           or its designee shall be responsible for such matter, and the
           Trustee shall vote proxies or respond to a tender or exchange
           offer in accordance with the Committee's Directions.

     (j)   All costs incurred by the Trustee in handling proxy and tender or
           exchange offer matters, including without limitation all costs
           associated with the printing and mailing of Participant
           instruction forms and other materials and attorneys' fees, shall
           be expenses of the Trust Fund within the meaning of Section 6.1 of
           the Trust Agreement.

Section 2.5. If permitted by the Plan, the Employer or the Committee may
appoint one or more investment managers within the meaning of Section 3(38)
of ERISA ("Investment Manager") to direct investments with respect to all or
part of the Trust Fund.  Any Investment Manager so appointed shall be (i) an
investment adviser registered as such under the Investment Advisers Act of
1940, or (ii) a bank, as defined in that Act, or (iii) any insurance company
qualified to perform investment management services under the laws of more
than one state.  Any Investment Manager so appointed shall, in writing,
certify to the Employer that it is qualified to act in such capacity under
clause (i), (ii) or (iii) of the preceding sentence, accept its appointment
as Investment Manager, acknowledge that it is a fiduciary with respect to
the Plan, and certify the identity of the person or persons authorized to
give instructions or directions on its behalf.  The Employer shall certify
to the Trustee that it has appointed each Investment Manager in accordance
with the provisions of the Plan and ERISA, and instruct the Trustee as to
the portion of the Plan that is to be managed by each Investment Manager.
The Trustee may continue to rely upon all certifications and agreements made
under this Section 2.5 unless otherwise notified in writing by the Employer
or the Investment Manager, as the case may be.  The Trustee shall be
entitled to rely entirely on an Investment Manager's directions, shall be
under no duty to determine or make inquiry whether an Investment Manager's
directions received by it are in accordance with the provisions of the Plan
or applicable law, and shall have no duty to review or recommend the sale,
retention, or other disposition of any asset purchased or retained in
accordance with an Investment Manager's directions.  The Trustee shall have
no liability for any loss to the Trust Fund resulting from the purchase,
sale, or retention of any asset in accordance with an Investment Manager's
directions, or resulting from not having sold such assets so purchased or
retained in the absence of an Investment Manager's directions, to make such
sale or take any other action.  The Trustee shall be fully indemnified by
the Employer for any action taken in accordance with, or any failure to act
in the absence of, an Investment Manager's directions.


                                  ARTICLE III
                          DUTIES AND RESPONSIBILITIES

Section 3.1.1.  The Trustee shall discharge its duties and responsibilities
under this Trust Agreement solely in the interest of Participants and their
beneficiaries, and

     (a)   for the exclusive purpose of providing benefits to the
           Participants and their beneficiaries and defraying the reasonable
           expenses of administering the Plan;

     (b)   with the care, skill, prudence, and diligence under the
           circumstances then prevailing that a prudent person acting in a
           like capacity and familiar with such matters would use in the
           conduct of an enterprise of a like character and with like aims.

Section 3.1.2.  In the event that the Employer designates The Dreyfus Trust
Company ("The Trust Company") as the Trustee in the Adoption Agreement
hereto, and the Trustee has been designated as an additional Trustee for the
Plan, The Trust Company as Trustee shall have no responsibilities other than
as set forth herein, and this Trust Agreement shall constitute a
supplemental trust agreement.  The duties of The Trust Company shall be
limited to assets held in the Trust Fund, and The Trust Company shall have
no duties with respect to assets held by any other person including, without
limitation, any other trustee for the Plan.  The Employer hereby agrees that
The Trust Company shall not serve as, and shall not be deemed to be, a
co-trustee under any circumstances.

Section 3.1.3.  Subject to the limitations set forth in Section 3.1.2
herein, in the event that more than one individual Trustee has been
designated in the Adoption Agreement, the action of such individual Trustees
shall be determined by vote of the majority of such individual Trustees;
provided, however, that any one of such individual Trustees may execute any
applications for insurance or annuity contracts provided for herein and
documents necessary for the exercise of ownership rights thereunder and may
perform other such ministerial acts; and further provided, that the Trustees
may enter into an agreement allocating among themselves specific
responsibilities, obligations and duties.

Section 3.1.4.  The Trustee shall be solely responsible for its own acts and
omissions.  The Trustee shall have no duty to question, or otherwise inquire
into, the performance of another fiduciary with respect to duties allocated
to such other fiduciary under the Plan.  The Trustee shall not be
responsible for the breach of any other such fiduciary unless the Trustee
(i) participates knowingly in, or knowingly undertakes to conceal, an act or
omission of such other fiduciary, knowing such act or omission is a breach,
(ii) has actual knowledge of a breach by such other fiduciary and fails to
make reasonable effort under the circumstances to remedy the breach or (iii)
has failed to perform its own specific fiduciary duties and thereby has
enabled another fiduciary to commit a breach.

Section 3.2.  The Trustee shall keep full and accurate records of all
receipts, investments, disbursements and other transactions hereunder,
including such specific records as may be agreed upon in writing between the
Company, the Committee and the Trustee.  All such records shall be open to
inspection during the Trustee's normal business hours by any authorized
representative of the Employer or the Committee upon reasonable prior notice
to the Trustee.

Section 3.3.  Within 90 days after the end of each Plan Year, as that term
is defined in the Plan, or within 90 days after its removal or resignation,
or the termination of the Plan or this Trust Agreement, the Trustee shall
file with the Committee a written account of the administration of the Trust
Fund showing all transactions effected by the Trustee subsequent to the
period covered by the last such accounting, if any, to the end of such Plan
Year or date of such removal or resignation, or the termination of the Plan
or this Trust Agreement, and all property held at its fair market value at
the end of the accounting period.  Upon approval of such accounting by the
Committee, neither the Employer nor the Committee shall be entitled to any
further accounting by the Trustee.  The Committee shall approve such
accounting by written notice of approval delivered to the Trustee or by
failure to express objection to such accounting in writing delivered to the
Trustee within 60 days from the date on which the accounting is mailed to
the Committee and, in either case, the Trustee shall be forever released and
discharged from all liability and accountability with respect to the
propriety of its acts and transactions as to which the Committee shall
within such 60 day period file with the Trustee no such written objections.

Section 3.4.  The Trustee may from time to time consult with counsel and
shall be entitled to rely entirely upon the advice of counsel with respect
to any act or omission.

Section 3.5.  In the event of any disagreement resulting in conflicting
instructions to, or adverse claims or demands upon, the Trustee with respect
to payments or instructions, the Trustee shall be entitled, at its option,
to refuse to comply with any such instruction, claim or demand so long as
such disagreement shall continue, and in the exercise of such refusal, the
Trustee may elect not to make any payment or other disposition of assets
held pursuant to this Trust Agreement.  The Trustee shall not be or become
liable in any way for its failure or refusal to comply with any such
conflicting instructions or adverse claims or demands, and it shall be
entitled to continue to refrain from acting until such conflicting or
adverse instructions, claims or demands (a) shall have been adjusted by
agreement and it shall have been notified in writing therefor or (b) shall
have been finally determined in a court of competent jurisdiction.

Section 3.6.  The Trustee shall not, by act, delay, omission or otherwise,
be deemed to have waived any right or remedy it may have either under this
Trust Agreement or generally, and no waiver shall be valid unless it is
contained in a written instrument signed by the Trustee and only to the
extent expressly set forth therein.  A waiver by the Trustee under the terms
of this Trust Agreement shall not be construed as a bar to, or waiver of,
the same or any other such right or remedy that it would otherwise have on
any other occasion.

Section 3.7.  The Trustee will not be compelled to do any act under this
Trust Agreement or to take any action toward the execution or enforcement of
the Trust Fund created hereunder or to prosecute or defend any suit in
respect thereof, unless
indemnified by the Employer to its satisfaction against any loss, costs,
liability and expense; and the Trustee will be fully indemnified by the
Employer for any liability or obligation to any person that results from any
failure on the part of the Employer or the Committee to perform any of their
respective obligations under the Plan or under the terms of this Trust
Agreement, or for any error or omission whatsoever on the part of the
Committee or the Employer.

Section 3.8.  Unless resulting from the Trustee's own gross negligence or
willful misconduct, the Employer shall indemnify the Trustee and save it
harmless from, against, for and in respect of any and all damages, losses,
obligations, liabilities, liens, deficiencies, costs and expenses
(including, without limitation, attorney's fees and other costs and expenses
incident to any suit, action, investigation, claim or proceedings) suffered,
sustained, incurred or required to be paid by the Trustee in connection with
the Plan or this Trust Agreement.  The provisions of this Section 3.8 shall
survive termination of this Trust Agreement.


                                  ARTICLE IV
                           PROHIBITION OF DIVERSION

Section 4.1.  Except as provided in Section 4.2 herein, at no time prior to
the satisfaction of all liabilities with respect to Participants and their
beneficiaries under the Plan shall any part of the corpus or income of the
Fund be used for, or diverted to, purposes other than for the exclusive
benefit of Participants or their beneficiaries, or for defraying reasonable
expenses of administering the Plan.

Section 4.2.1.  Notwithstanding the provisions of Section 4.1, but subject
to the provisions of Section 4.2.2 herein, contributions made by the
Employer under the Plan shall be returned to the Employer under the
following conditions and only as the Trustee is instructed in writing by the
Committee:

     (a)   If a contribution is made by mistake of fact, such contribution
           shall be returned to the Employer within one year of the payment
           of such contributions;

     (b)   To the extent that contributions to the Plan are specifically
           conditioned upon their deductibility under the Code, and a
           deduction is disallowed for any such contribution, it shall be
           returned to the Employer within one year after the disallowance of
           the deduction; and

     (c)   To the extent that contributions to the Plan are specifically
           conditioned on initial qualification of the Plan under the Code,
           and the Plan is determined to be disqualified, contributions and
           the earnings thereon made in respect of any period subsequent to
           the effective date of such disqualification shall be returned to
           the Employer within one year after the date of denial of
           qualification, provided that the Employer makes timely application
           to the Internal Revenue Service for a determination of the
           qualified status of the Plan.

Section 4.2.2 Earnings attributable to any contributions returned to the
Employer under Sections 4.2.1(a) and 4.2.1 (b) shall not be returned to the
Employer.  Losses attributable to any contributions returned to Employer
under Section 4.2.1 shall reduce the amount to be so returned.


                                   ARTICLE V
                 COMMUNICATION WITH COMMITTEE AND THE EMPLOYER

Section 5.1.  Except as otherwise specifically provided herein, any action
by an Employer that is a corporation pursuant to any of the provisions of
this Trust Agreement shall be evidenced by (1) a resolution of its board of
directors (the "Board") certified to the Trustee over the signature of its
Secretary or Assistant Secretary or other duly authorized agent under the
corporate seal, if any, or (2) by appropriate written authorization of any
person or committee to which the Board has delegated the authority to take
such action.  Any action by an Employer that is a partnership or a sole
proprietorship shall be evidenced by a written certification of a general
partner of the partnership or the sole proprietor, as the case may be.  The
Trustee shall be entitled to rely entirely on, and shall be fully
indemnified by the Employer for acting in accordance with, any such
resolution, certification or other authorization.

Section 5.2.  The Employer shall provide to the Trustee a certificate,
signed by an authorized officer of the Employer, that contains (a) the name,
(b) specimen signature and (c) a description of the specific powers and
duties, of each member of the Committee.  The Employer shall give prompt
written notice of any change in the identity, powers or duties of any member
of the Committee, and the Trustee shall be entitled to rely entirely on its
failure to receive such notice as a certification of the Employer that a
designated member of the Committee and such member's duties and powers have
not been changed.  The Trustee shall have no duty to inquire into the
qualifications of any member of the Committee.

Section 5.3.  The Committee's Directions shall be communicated to the
Trustee in a certificate that sets forth the action of the Committee, signed
by the person then acting as Chairman or Secretary of the Committee, or in a
written statement signed by any two or more members of the Committee or any
person or agent designated to act on behalf of the Committee.  Such person
or agent shall be so designated either under the provisions of the Plan or
in a certificate by the Committee that contains (a) the name, (b) specimen
signature and (c) a description of the specific powers and duties of each
such person or agent.  The Committee shall give prompt written notice of any
change in the identity, powers and duties of any such person or agent, and
the Trustee shall be entitled to rely entirely on its failure to receive
such notice as a certification of the Committee that the identity, powers
and duties of such person or agent have not been changed.

Section 5.4.  The Trustee shall have no liability hereunder for any action
taken in good faith in reliance upon any instructions, directions,
certifications and communications believed by the Trustee to be genuine and
to have been signed or communicated by the proper person.


                                  ARTICLE VI
                       TRUSTEE'S COMPENSATION; EXPENSES

Section 6.1.  The Trustee shall receive reasonable compensation for its
services in accordance with its schedule of compensation in effect when such
services are rendered.  The Trustee may amend the schedule from time to
time, which amendment shall become effective no earlier than 30 days after
written notice is sent to the Employer.  The Trustee shall also be entitled
to reimbursement for all reasonable expenses incurred by it in the
performance of its duties hereunder including, without limitation, any
expenses incurred in the consultation or employment of any agent pursuant to
Section 2.3(l).  Any such compensation or expenses and any income or other
taxes which may be levied against the Trust Fund shall be paid out of the
Trust Fund, unless paid directly by the Employer.


                                  ARTICLE VII
                      RESIGNATION AND REMOVAL OF TRUSTEE

Section 7.1.  The Trustee may resign at any time by written notice to the
Employer which shall be effective 30 days after delivery to the Employer of
such notice, provided that a successor Trustee shall have been appointed by
the Employer; provided, however, that such notice may be waived by the
Employer.

Section 7.2.  The Trustee may be removed by the Employer at any time upon 30
days' prior written notice to the Trustee, provided that a successor Trustee
shall have been appointed by the Employer; provided, however, that such
notice may be waived by the Trustee.

Section 7.3.  The appointment of a successor Trustee hereunder shall be
accomplished by and shall take effect upon the delivery to the resigning or
removed Trustee, as the case may be, of written notice from the Employer
appointing such successor Trustee, and an acceptance in writing of the
successor Trustee.  Any successor Trustee may be either a corporation
authorized and empowered to exercise trust powers or one or more
individuals.  All of the provisions set forth herein with respect to the
Trustee shall relate to each successor Trustee so appointed with the same
force and effect as if such successor Trustee had been originally named
herein as the Trustee hereunder.  If a successor Trustee shall not have been
appointed within 30 days after delivery to the Employer of notice of the
Trustee's resignation pursuant to Section 7.1, the resigning Trustee may
apply to a court of competent jurisdiction for the appointment of a
successor Trustee.

Section 7.4.  Upon the appointment of a successor Trustee, the resigning or
removed Trustee shall transfer and deliver the Trust Fund to such successor
Trustee, after reserving such reasonable amounts as are necessary to provide
for its reasonable expenses in the settlement of its account, the amount of
any compensation due to it and any sums chargeable against the Trust Fund
for which it may be liable.  If the sums so reserved are not sufficient for
such purposes, the resigning or removed Trustee shall be entitled to
reimbursement for any deficiency from the Employer or out of the Trust Fund.

Section 7.5.  At the time the Trust Fund shall have been transferred and
delivered to a successor trustee and the accounts of the Trustee have been
approved pursuant to Section 3.3 herein, the Trustee shall be released and
discharged from all further accountability or liability for the Trust Fund
and shall not be responsible in any way for the further disposition of the
Trust Fund or any part thereof.


                                 ARTICLE VIII
                AMENDMENT AND TERMINATION OF THE TRUST AND PLAN

Section 8.1.  The Employer may terminate this Agreement at any time upon 30
days' prior written notice delivered to the Trustee; provided that such
termination by the Employer is subject to the condition that a new trustee
assumes the responsibilities and functions of the Trustee as set forth
herein; and provided, further, that the trusteeship shall, if terminated by
the Employer, continue thereafter for such period as may be necessary for
the complete divestiture to a newly appointed trustee of all assets held in
the Trust Fund.

Section 8.2.  If the Plan is terminated in whole or in part, or if the
Employer permanently discontinues its contributions to the Plan, the Trustee
shall distribute the Fund or any part thereof in accordance with the
Committee's Directions.  Upon the Employer's termination of the Plan in
whole or in part or the revocation or termination of this Trust Agreement,
the Trustee shall have the right to have its accounts approved.  When the
Trust Fund shall have been so applied or distributed, and the accounts of
the Trustee shall have been approved pursuant to Section 3.3 herein, the
Trustee shall not be responsible in any way for the further disposition of
the Trust Fund (or that part thereof so applied or distributed, if the Plan
is terminated only in part).  The Trustee shall have the right to withhold
distribution or application of any part of the Trust Fund unless and until
written approval of any such termination has been granted by the Internal
Revenue Service and, if the Plan is subject to the jurisdiction of the
Pension Benefit Guaranty Corporation (the "PBGC"), (a) the period of time
set forth in Section 4041(b)(2)(C) of ERISA has elapsed and the PBGC has not
issued any notice of noncompliance or (b) the PBGC has notified the Plan
Administrator that the requirements or a distress termination have been met
pursuant to Section 4041(c)(3)(A) of ERISA.  Assets of the Trust Fund shall
not be returned to the Employer unless and until the Employer has delivered
to the Trustee (a) a certification of an enrolled actuary stating that there
is an amount remaining in the Trust Fund that is not required for the
payment of the benefits provided under the Plan for participants or their
beneficiaries and (b) an opinion of counsel satisfactory to the Trustee,
stating that such return of assets is permitted under the terms of the Plan
and applicable law.

Section 8.3.  This Trust Agreement may be amended or modified by a written
agreement signed by the parties hereto or by the Trustee upon 60 days' prior
written notice to the Employer.


                                  ARTICLE XI
                           MISCELLANEOUS PROVISIONS

Section 9.1.  This Trust Agreement shall be adopted by execution of the
Adoption Agreement.

Section 9.2.  In the event that any provision of this Trust Agreement is
deemed or held to be unlawful or invalid for any reason, such event shall
not adversely affect any other provision contained herein unless such
illegality shall make impossible or impracticable the functioning of this
Trust Agreement, and in such case, the appropriate parties shall immediately
amend this Trust Agreement.

Section 9.3.  The titles and headings of the Sections in this instrument are
placed herein for convenience of reference only.  In the event of any
conflict, the text of this instrument, rather than such titles or headings,
shall control the interpretation of any of the terms and provisions
contained herein.

Section 9.4.  Except as otherwise specifically provided herein, all notices
or other communications required or permitted to be given pursuant to this
Agreement shall be given in writing and delivered by personal delivery or
sent by U.S. first class mail, postage prepaid, addressed to their last
respective address of record.

Section 9.5.  The construction, validity and administration of this Trust
Agreement shall be governed by the laws of the state where the Trustee has
its principal place of business, except to the extent that such laws are
preempted by ERISA.




This Dreyfus 403(b)(7) Retirement Plan (the "Plan") is intended for the
use of eligible persons who may wish to have Employer contributions
invested in shares of any regulated investment company under the
Investment Company Act of 1940, as amended (a "Fund"), which is approved
by Dreyfus Service Corporation (the "Sponsor") upon the following terms
and conditions and in accordance with the provisions of the Internal
Revenue Code of 1986, as amended (the "Code").

I. Eligibility

Any person who performs services as an Employee (the "Employee") for an
Employer (the "Employer"), which is an organization described in Section
501(c)(3) of the Code and is exempt from tax under Section 510(a) of the
Code, or who performs services as an Employee for an educational institution
(as defined in Section 170(b)(1)(A)(ii) of the Code), which is a State or a
political subdivision of a State or an agency or instrumentality thereof,
and who obtains the consent of such Employer to participate herein, is
eligible to adopt this Plan.

II. Participation

An eligible person may adopt this Plan by signing and mailing the
Custodial Account Application (the "Application") to The Dreyfus Trust
Company, as Custodian (the "Custodian"). The Application and the Salary
Reduction Agreement entered into between the Employee and the Employer, if
applicable, are incorporated herein by reference and are made a part of
this Plan. This Plan and the Dreyfus 403(b)(7) Retirement Plan Custodial
Agreement (the "Custodial Agreement") will be deemed to be adopted when
the Custodian shall have indicated its written acceptance of the
Application and its appointment as Custodian on the Application.

III. Contributions

The Employee may direct the Employer to contribute cash to the Employee's
account established and maintained pursuant to the Custodial Agreement
(the "Custodial Account") in accordance with the Salary Reduction
Agreement entered into between the Employee and the Employer.  Such
contributions may be made to the extent they do not exceed $9,500 or any
greater amount permitted by Section 402(g) of the Code.  The Employer may
also make non-elective cash contributions to the Custodial Account on
behalf of the Employee.  Contributions in accordance with a Salary
Reduction Agreement and non-elective Employer contributions may be made to
the extent that they do not constitute "excess contributions" as that term
is defined in Section 4973(c) of the Code (an "Excess Contribution").  In
addition, the Employee or Employer may, in accordance with the Code,
transfer or cause to be transferred in cash the Employee's balance in any
other 403(b) plan, and the Employee may make a rollover contribution of
any qualifying distribution from a 403(b) plan.

The Sponsor, the Fund(s) and the Custodian shall not be responsible for
determining the amount that may be contributed to the Custodial Account on
behalf of the Employee, nor shall any of them be responsible to recommend
or compel an Employer to make contributions to the Custodial Account.  If
during any taxable year the Employer contributed an amount that is an
Excess Contribution, such Excess Contribution and any income attributable
thereto shall, upon the written request of the Employee, be paid to the
Employee by the Custodian or, at the Employee's election, be applied
toward a contribution for the current or subsequent taxable year.  If the
amount of contributions made to the Custodial Account for any taxable year
pursuant to a Salary Reduction Agreement exceeds the applicable dollar
limitation of Section 402(g) of the Code, and is designated by the
Employee, in writing, no later than March 1 of the following year, then
the amount of contributions in excess of such limitation plus allocable
earnings through the date of distribution shall be distributed by the
Custodian no later than April 15 of the following year.

The interest of the Employee in the Custodial Account shall be non-
forfeitable at all times, may not be assigned, and shall not be subject to
alienation, assignment, trustee process, garnishment, attachment,
execution or levy of any kind, except with regard to payment of the
expenses of the custodian as authorized by the provision of this Plan and
the Custodial Agreement, and except as required by law.

IV. Investment of Contributions

All contributions made or caused to be made to the Custodial Account by
the Employer on behalf of the Employee shall be applied by the Custodian
to purchase shares of the Fund(s) designated in writing by the Employee on
the Application or such other form as may be acceptable to the Custodian.
The Employee may direct the transfer of assets held in the Custodial
Account from one Fund to another Fund at any time and from time to time,
subject to the terms and conditions set forth in the then current
Prospectus of the applicable Fund.

All income dividends and capital gains distributions shall be reinvested
in additional shares of the Fund(s) so designated by the Employee.

The Employee may, however, authorize and direct the Custodian in writing
to exchange any or all shares of any Fund held in the Custodial Account
for shares of any other Fund subject to, and in accordance with, the terms
and conditions of any exchange privilege, including the telephone exchange
privilege, offered with respect to Fund Shares as described in the then
current Prospectus of the applicable Fund.

In addition, and where allowed by the Sponsor, the Employee may authorize
an investment advisor to make exchanges for all amounts maintained in the
Custodial Account under the Plan, subject to, and in accordance with, such
terms and conditions as may be agreed upon in writing from time to time by
the Sponsor and the Custodian.

If the Employee elects the telephone exchange privilege on the Application
or on another form acceptable to the Custodian, or if the Employee
authorizes an investment advisor to make exchanges as described above, the
Custodian shall be entitled to rely and act upon telephonic instructions
received from any person directing the exchange of any or all Fund Shares
held by the Custodian for the benefit of the Employee, and shall be fully
protected by the Employee in acting in accordance with any such telephonic
instructions.

V. Distributions

   A. The Employee, or the beneficiary or estate of the Employee in
      the event of the Employee's death, shall be entitled to distribution
      of the assets in the Custodial Account in a form provided in Section
      V. B. below as follows:

      l.   upon termination of employment before attaining age 55;
      2.   upon becoming disabled;
      3.   upon retirement;
      4.   upon attaining age 59-1/2;
      5.   upon encountering financial hardship.

      For the purposes of this Plan, retirement shall mean termination of
      employment on or after attaining age 55. For purposes of this Plan,
      the Employee shall be considered disabled if the Employee is unable
      to engage in any substantial gainful activity by reason of any
      medically determinable physical or mental impairment that can be
      expected to result in death or to be of long, continued and
      indefinite duration.

      Only contributions that are made on behalf of the Employee pursuant
      to the Salary Reduction Agreement entered into between the Employee
      and the Employer may be distributed on account of financial hardship.
      Non-elective Employer contributons and earnings on assets in the
      Custodial Account may not be distributed on account of financial
      hardship.  For purposes of this Plan the term "financial hardship"
      shall mean, but shall not be limited to, the purchase of a residence,
      expenses incurred for the higher education of dependent children, and
      illness sustained by the Employee or the Employee's dependents.

   B. The Employee may elect a form of distribution from among the following
      alternatives:

      1.     a single payment, in cash or kind;
      2.     equal or substantially equal monthly, quarterly or annual
             installments over a period not to exceed the life
             expectancy of such Employee or the joint life and survivor
             expectancy of such Employee and his beneficiary; or
      3.     an immediate or deferred annuity contract purchased by the
             Custodian, which provides for payments over the life of the
             Employee or, if the Employee so elects, for payments over
             the lives of the Employee and the Employee's beneficiary.

      Such election shall be made at least sixty (60) days prior to the
      date on which distribution is expected to be made or to begin. Such
      an election shall be made in writing in such form as shall be
      acceptable to the Custodian.  If the Plan and Custodial Agreement are
      determined to constitute an "employee pension benefit plan" subject
      to the Employee Retirement Income Security Act of 1974, as amended
      ("ERISA"), then all distributions shall be subject to the qualified
      joint and survivor annuity and qualified preretirement survivor
      annuity rules of Section 205 of ERISA.

   C. The Employee may designate a beneficiary(ies) of the Employee's
      choosing and may, in addition, name a contingent beneficiary.  Such
      designation shall be made in writing in a form acceptable to the
      Custodian. The Employee may at any time revoke the Employee's
      designation of a beneficiary by filing with the Custodian a written
      notice of such revocation or change in a form acceptable to the
      Custodian. If no designation of a beneficiary shall have been made,
      distribution shall be made to the estate of the Employee. A
      beneficiary designation shall not be effective until received by the
      Custodian while the Employee is alive.

   D. Notwithstanding any other provision of this Section V, the Employee's
      entire interest in the Custodial Account must be or begin to be,
      distributed by the Employee's required beginning date, which is the
      April 1 following the calendar year in which the Employee reaches age
      70-1/2. Notwithstanding the preceding sentence, if the Employee had
      attained age 70-1/2 prior to January 1, 1988, the required beginning
      date is the later of age 70-1/2 or termination of employment.  By the
      applicable required beginning date, the Employee may elect in a manner
      acceptable to the Custodian to have the balance in the Custodial
      Account distributed in any of the methods described in section V.B.
      above.

      If the Employee does not choose any of the methods of distribution
      described in Section V.B. above before the required beginning date,
      distribution to the Employee will be made by that date in accordance
      with Section V.B.2 above based on the Employee's life expectancy only,
      without recalculation, and distribution will be made on an annual
      basis. If the Employee elects a means of distribution described in
      Section V.B.3 above,  the annuity contract must satisfy the
      requirements of Section 72 or 403(b)(1) of the Code. If the Employee
      elects a means of distribution described in Section V.B.2 above, the
      annual payment required to be made by the Employee's required
      beginning date is for the calendar year the Employee reached age
      70-1/2.  Annual payments for subsequent years, including the year the
      Employee's required beginning date occurs, must be made by December 31
      of that year.

   E. If the Employee dies before the Employee's entire interest is
      distributed to the Employee, the entire remaining interest will
      be distributed as follows:

      1.    If the Employee dies on or after the Employee's required
            beginning date, and after distributions have commenced, the
            entire remaining interest will continue to be distributed in the
            same manner as before the Employee's death. The preceding
            sentence shall not apply if the beneficiary(ies) elect otherwise
            to have the remaining interest distributed in some other form
            pursuant to Section V.B. above.

      2.    If the Employee dies before the Employee's required beginning
            date, the entire remaining interest will, at the election of the
            beneficiary(ies), either (a) be distributed by December 31 of
            the year in which the 5th anniversary of the Employee's death
            occurs, or (b) be distributed in equal or substantially equal
            payments over the life or life expectancy of the designated
            beneficiary(ies).

      The election of either Subsections E.2(a) or E.2(b) above must be made
      by December 31 of the year following the year of the Employee's death.
      If the beneficiary(ies) do not elect either of the distribution
      options described in Subsections E.2(a) and E.2(b) above, distribution
      will be made in accordance with Subsection E.2(b) if the beneficiary
      is the Employee's surviving spouse and in accordance with Subsections
      E.2(a) if the beneficiary(ies) are or include anyone other than the
      surviving spouse. In the case of distributions under Subsection
      E.2(b), distributions must commence by December 31 of the year
      following the year of the Employee's death. If the Employee's spouse
      is the beneficiary, distributions need not commence until December 31
      of the year the Employee would have attained age 70-1/2, if later.

      3.    In the case of distributions over life expectancy in equal or
            substantially equal annual payments, to determine the minimum
            annual payment for each year, the Employee's entire interest in
            the Custodial Account as of the close of business on December 31
            of the preceding year, will be divided by the life expectancy of
            the Employee (or the joint life and last survivor expectancy of
            the Employee and the Employee's beneficiary, or the life
            expectancy of the beneficiary, whichever applies). In the case
            of distributions over the joint life and survivor expectancy of
            the Employee, the initial life expectancy (or joint life and
            last survivor expectancy) will be determined using the attained
            ages of the Employee and the beneficiary as of their birthdays
            in the year the Employee reaches age 70-1/2. In the case of
            distribution in accordance with Section E.2(a), life expectancy
            will be determined using the attained age of the beneficiary as
            of the beneficiary's birthday in the year distributions are
            required to commence. Except as otherwise provided in Section
            V.B., unless the Employee (or spouse) elects to have life
            expectancy recalculated, the Employee's life expectancy (and the
            life expectancy of the Employee's spouse, if applicable) will
            not be recalculated annually using their attained ages as of
            their birthdays in the year for which the minimum annual payment
            is being determined. The life expectancy of the beneficiary
            (other than the spouse) will not be recalculated. The minimum
            annual payment may be made in a series of installments (e.g.,
            monthly, quarterly, etc.) as long as the total payments for the
            year made by the date required are not less than the minimum
            amounts required.

VI. Sponsor

The Employee delegates to the Sponsor the following powers with respect to
the Plan: (a) to remove the Custodian and select a successor Custodian;
and (b) to amend this Plan (including retroactive amendment).

The powers herein delegated to the Sponsor shall be exercised by such
officer thereof as the Sponsor may designate from time to time, and shall
be exercised only when similarly exercised with respect to all other
Employees adopting the Plan.

The Sponsor, The Dreyfus Corporation, and each of the Funds, and each of
their respective officers, directors, trustees, general partners,
affiliates, agents and employees shall have no responsibility or liability
of any kind and shall be fully protected by the Employee with regard to
the administration of the Plan except as provided in this Section VI of
the Plan, and none of them shall incur any liability of any nature to the
Employee or any beneficiary or other person in connection with any act
done or omitted to be done in good faith in the exercise of any power or
authority herein delegated to the Sponsor.

The Employee agrees to indemnify and hold the Sponsor, The Dreyfus
Corporation and each of the Funds, and each of their respective officers,
directors, trustees, general partners, affiliates, agents and employees
harmless from and against any and all claims, liabilities, losses, damages
and expenses, including attorneys' and accountants' fees, incurred in
connection with the exercise of, or omission to exercise, any of the
powers delegated to the Sponsor under this Section VI, except such
liabilities and expenses as may arise from the Sponsor's own negligence or
willful misconduct.

VII. Amendment and Termination

The Employee delegates to the Sponsor the power to amend this Plan
(including retroactive amendment) upon written notice to the Employee. Any
such amendment shall become effective upon mailing notice of such
amendment to the Custodian and the Employee.

No amendment shall be effective if it would cause or permit: (a) any part
of the Custodial Account to be diverted to any purpose that is not for the
exclusive benefit of the Employee and the Employee's beneficiaries; (b)
the Employee to be deprived of any portion of the Employee's interest in
the Custodial Account; or (c) the imposition of an additional duty on the
Custodian without its prior written consent.

The Employee reserves the right to terminate further contributions to the
Custodial Account established under this Plan by agreement with the
Employer provided that the Employee shall file with the Custodian an
executed copy of such agreement. The Employee also reserves the right to
transfer the assets of the Custodial Account to such other form of Section
403(b)(7) Retirement Plan as the Employee may determine, upon written
instructions to the Custodian in such form as the Custodian may reasonably
require.

VIII. Construction

The Plan shall be administered, construed and enforced according to the
laws of the State of New York, except to the extent preempted by the Act.
It is intended that this Plan qualify under Section 403(b)(7) of the Code,
and no provision of the Plan shall be construed to conflict with any
requirement of Section 403(b)(7) of the Code.

The Employer shall be solely responsible for compliance with the
nondiscrimination rules of Section 403(b)(12) of the Code, if applicable.
If the Plan and Custodial Agreement are determined to constitute an
"employee pension benefit plan" subject to the Employee Retirement Income
Security Act of 1974, as amended ("ERISA"), then the Employer shall comply
with all applicable requirements of ERISA.

The Employer may maintain a separate 403(b) plan document in addition to
the Plan and Custodial Agreement.  Such plan document shall be
administered and maintained by the Employer in a manner consistent with
the Plan and Custodial Agreement, and neither the Custodial nor the
Sponsor shall have any duties or responsibilities with respect to such
separate document.




                                   Dreyfus
                                  403(b)(7)
                               Retirement Plan
                             Custodial Agreement

By signing the Dreyfus 403(b)(7) Retirement Plan Custodial Account
Application (the "Application") for the Employee named thereon ("the
Employee"), the Employer named thereon ("the Employer") adopts the Dreyfus
403(b)(7) Retirement Plan ("the Plan") and establishes a Custodial Account
("the Custodial Account"), and The Dreyfus Trust Company ("the
Custodian"), by countersigning the Application, accepts the Custodianship
thereof upon the terms and conditions set forth below.

1. Employer

   The Employer represents that it is an organization described in Section
   501(c)(3) of the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended (the "Code")
   and is exempt from tax under Section 501(a) of the Code, or that it is
   an educational institution (as defined in Section 170(b)(1)(A)(ii) of
   the Code, which is a State, a political subdivision thereof, or an
   agency or instrumentality thereof.

2. Custodial Account

   This Custodial Agreement is established for the purpose of establishing
   and maintaining a Custodial Account for the Employee and for investing
   such contributions as described in Paragraph 8 hereof. The Employer
   intends that this account qualify as a "Custodial Account for regulated
   investment company stock" within the meaning of Section 403(b)(7) of
   the Code.

3. Contributions

   All contributions must be made in cash. The Custodian will accept only
   contributions received from the Employer with the exception of
   rollovers as defined in Section 403(b)(8) of the Code, and transfers
   from other retirement plans established under Section 403(b) of the
   Code. All contributions hereafter made to the Custodial Account shall
   be in accordance with the provisions of this Agreement. The Custodian
   shall have no obligation to verify the allowability of such
   contributions and may rely solely on the representations of the
   Employer or the Employee with respect thereto.

4. Fully-Vested Interest

   The Employee's interest in the balance in his Custodial Account shall
   at all times be nonforfeitable.

5. Exclusive Benefit

   The Custodial Account is established for the exclusive benefit of the
   Employee and the Employee's beneficiary(ies) and for the purpose of
   holding in the Custodial Account such contributions of money made on
   behalf of the Employee as the Custodian may receive from time to time
   from the Employer and of the shares purchased therewith pursuant to
   Paragraph 8 hereof.

6. Distributions

   At no time shall it be possible for any part of the assets of the
   Custodial Account to be used for, or diverted to, purposes other than
   for the exclusive benefit of the Employee and the Employee's
   beneficiary(ies). In connection with the making of any distributions,
   the Custodian may rely solely on the accuracy of all facts supplied at
   any time by the Employee, including any written designation of a
   beneficiary. The Employee's interest in the Account shall be
   distributed to the Employee or will begin to be distributed upon
   receipt by the Custodian of written instructions as to the method of
   distribution. The Employee may elect a form of distribution from among
   the following alternatives:

   (a) a single payment, in cash of kind;
   (b) equal or substantially equal monthly, quarterly or annual
       installments over a period not to exceed a period measured by the
       life expectancy of such Employee or the joint life and survivor
       expectancy of such Employee and the Employee's beneficiary; or
   (c) the purchase and distribution of an immediate or deferred annuity
       policy purchased by the Custodian, which provides for payments over
       the life of the Employee or, if the Employee so elects over the
       lives of the Employee and the Employee's beneficiary.

7. Beneficiary

   The Employee may, by notice in writing delivered to the Custodian while
   the Employee is alive, designate or change a beneficiary(ies) who will
   receive any undistributed interest in the Custodial Account in the
   event of the Employee's death. In the absence of any such designation,
   any undistributed interest of the Employee shall be paid to the legal
   representative of the Employee's estate.

8. Fund Shares

   The amount of each contribution to the Custodial Account shall be
   applied to the purchase of shares of ownership in one or more
   investment companies registered under the Investment Company Act of
   1940, as amended (hereinafter referred to individually as a "Fund",
   which is approved by Dreyfus Service Corporation (the "Sponsor") and
   which the Custodian has agreed to hold, in accordance with the Fund's
   then current Prospectus. Such shares are referred to herein as "Fund
   Shares." The Custodian shall credit such Fund Shares to the separate
   Custodial Account of the Employee who shall be the beneficial owner of
   such shares. A confirmation for each contribution received showing the
   investment thereof and current status of the Custodial Account shall be
   prepared by the Custodian and sent to the Employee. All dividends and
   capital gains distributions received on the Fund Shares held by the
   Custodian in the Custodial Account shall be reinvested in accordance
   with the respective Fund's then current Prospectus in additional Fund
   Shares, which shall be credited to the Custodial Account. A
   confirmation showing the current status of the Custodial Account shall
   be prepared by the Custodian and sent to the Employee with respect to
   each such reinvestment. At least once each year the Custodian shall
   furnish the Employee with an annual report of all activity in the
   Custodial Account during the preceding calendar year, which shall be
   deemed to be the sole accounting required to be provided by the
   Custodian necessary under this Agreement. If the Custodian does not
   receive a written objection to such accounting from the Employee within
   one hundred eighty (180) days after the date the accounting is sent by
   the Custodian, the Employee shall be considered to have fully approved
   the accounting and the Custodian shall be relieved from all liabilities
   and responsibilities that may arise in connection with any matters
   covered by the accounting.

   The Employee may authorize and direct the Custodian in writing to
   exchange any or all Fund Shares held in the Custodial Account for any
   other Fund Shares, subject to, and in accordance with, the terms and
   conditions of any exchange privilege, including the telephone exchange
   privilege, offered with respect to Fund Shares as described in the then
   current Prospectus of the applicable Fund. The Sponsor may allow the
   Employee to authorize an investment advisor to make such exchanges
   subject to, and in accordance with, such terms and conditions as may be
   agreed upon in writing from time to time by the Sponsor and the
   Custodian.

   If the Employee elects, either in the Application or other form
   acceptable to the Custodian, the telephone exchange privilege or
   authorizes an investment advisor to make exchanges as described above,
   the Custodian shall be entitled to reply and act on telephone
   instructions from any person representing himself or herself to be the
   Employee directing the exchange of any or all shares of a Fund held in
   the Custodial Account for shares of any other Fund(s) as specified in
   such telephonic instructions, provided that such Fund is available for
   sale in the state of residence of the Employee. It is understood and
   agreed that the telephone exchange privilege is subject to the
   limitations specified above. The Employee affirms that, prior to
   requesting any exchange, the Employee shall obtain a copy of the then
   current Prospectus of each Fund into which any exchange is requested to
   be made.

   The Employee authorizes and directs the Custodian to respond to any
   telephonic inquiries relating to the status of shares owned, including,
   but not limited to, the number of shares held.

   The Employee and the Employee's beneficiary(ies), assignees and
   successors understand and agree that the Sponsor, the Custodian, each
   Fund and The Dreyfus Corporation, and each of their respective
   officers, directors, trustees, general partners, affiliates, agents and
   employees, will not be held liable and will be fully protected by the
   Employee against any and all claims, liabilities, losses, damages and
   expenses (including attorneys' and accountants' fees) arising out of
   any exchange request effected in accordance with any telephone
   instructions. The Employee certifies and agrees that the
   certifications, authorizations, directions and restrictions contained
   herein or otherwise provided to the Custodian will continue in effect
   until the Custodian receives written notice of any change or
   revocation. The Employee understands that each of the Funds and the
   Custodian reserves the right to refuse any telephonic instructions. All
   Fund Shares acquired by the Custodian for the benefit of the Employee
   shall be registered in the name of the Custodian or its nominee.

9. Charges Against Account-Taxes, Expenses, and Custodian's Compensation

   Any income taxes or other taxes of any kind whatsoever that may be
   levied or assessed upon, or in respect of, the Custodial Account shall
   be paid from the assets of the Custodial Account. Any transfer taxes
   incurred in connection to the investment and reinvestment of the assets
   of the Custodial Account, all other administrative expenses incurred by
   the Custodian in the performance of its duties hereunder (including
   without limitation, any expenses incurred by the Custodian in the
   preparation and filing of extraordinary returns or reports including
   unrelated business income tax return), including fees for legal
   services rendered to the Custodial Account, and such compensation to
   the Custodian as set forth in the Custodian's fee schedule as amended
   by the Custodian from time to time, shall be paid of the Custodial
   Account.

10. Custodian-Resignation, Removal

   (a) The Sponsor shall at any time have the right to remove the
       Custodian by delivering to it a notice in writing to that effect,
       which notice shall also designate a successor custodian. Upon
       receipt by the Custodian of written acceptance by the successor
       custodian of its appointment, the Custodian shall forthwith
       transfer and pay over to such successor custodian the assets of the
       Custodial Account and all records pertaining thereto. Upon receipt
       of such assets and records by the successor Custodian, the removal
       of the Custodian shall be effective.

       The Custodian may, however, reserve such Fund Shares as may be
       required for the payment of all its fees, compensation, costs and
       expenses and for the payment of all liabilities of, or against the
       assets of, the Custodial Account or Custodian and where necessary
       may liquidate such reserved Fund Shares. Any balance of such
       reserve remaining after the payment of all such expenses and
       liabilities shall be paid over to the successor custodian. Any
       successor custodian must meet the requirements in Section 401(f)(2)
       of the Code.

   (b) The Custodian shall at any time have the right to resign as
       Custodian under this Agreement by delivering to the Sponsor and the
       Employee a notice in writing to that effect. Upon receiving such
       notice of resignation, the Sponsor shall forthwith appoint a
       successor custodian and upon receipt by the Custodian of written
       acceptance by the successor custodian of such appointment, the
       Custodian is authorized to act in the same manner as provided in
       the preceding paragraph. In the event the Sponsor fails to appoint
       a successor Custodian within ninety (90) days of receiving notice
       of the Custodian's resignation, the Custodian may distribute to the
       Employee the assets of the Custodial Account, reserving such Fund
       Shares as may be required for the payment of all its fees,
       compensation, costs and expenses and for the payment of all
       liabilities of or against the assets of the Custodial Account or
       the Custodian, so that it may, where necessary, liquidate such
       shares with any balance remaining after payment of all such
       expenses and liabilities to be paid to the Employee.

11. Records

   The Custodian shall keep accurate and detailed accounts of all
   contributions, receipts, investments, distributions, disbursements and
   all other transactions. The Custodian shall prepare and file any
   returns required to be filed by it as Custodian of a plan under Section
   403(b) of the Code, and supply to the Internal Revenue Service any
   other information as may be required from a Custodial Account
   qualifying under Section 501(a) of the Code.

12. Voting Proxies

   The Custodian shall deliver to the Employee all notices, prospectuses,
   financial statements, proxies and proxy soliciting material relating to
   the Fund Shares held by it in the Custodial Account. The Custodian
   shall not vote any of the Fund Shares held hereunder except in
   accordance with the written instructions of the Employee.

13. Reports to Department of Labor

   Any reports or filings required to be made with the Department of Labor
   under the Employee Retirement Income Security Act of 1974 with respect
   to a Custodial Account established under this Agreement, shall be made
   by the Employer.

14. Duties of Custodian

   The Custodian shall be under no duties whatsoever except such duties as
   are specifically set forth as such in this Custodial Agreement, and no
   implied covenant or obligation shall he read into this Custodial
   Agreement against the Custodian. In the performance of its duties the
   Custodian shall be liable only for its own gross negligence and willful
   misconduct. The Employee shall have the sole authority and
   responsibility for the enforcement or defense of the terms and
   conditions of the Custodial Agreement against, or on behalf of, any
   person(s) claiming any interest in the Custodial Account. The Custodian
   shall not he required to prosecute, defend or respond to any action
   and/or judicial proceeding relating to the Custodial Account unless it
   has previously received indemnification satisfactory to it in form and
   in substance.

15. Amendments

   The Custodian reserves the right to amend all or any part of the terms
   of this Custodial Agreement in any manner that would not disqualify the
   Custodial Account from complying with Sections 403(b) and 501 of the
   (Code upon written notice to the Employee. The Employee hereby grants
   Dreyfus Service Corporation the right to amend the terms of this
   Agreement in order that the Custodial Account might qualify as a
   Custodial Account for regulated investment company stock within the
   meaning of Section 403(b)(7) of the Code, provided, however, that no
   such amendment which increases the duties or responsibilities of the
   Custodian shall become effective unless the Custodian has consented to
   such amendment. Any such amendment by Dreyfus Service Corporation shall
   become effective upon mailing notice of such amendment to the Custodian
   and the Employee.

16. Liability of Custodian

   The Custodian shall not be liable for any action it shall take when
   such action or failure to act is in accordance with the written
   instructions of the Employer or the Employee or is due to the absence
   of such instructions. The Custodian shall not be required to give bond
   or security for the performance of its duties hereunder. The Employee
   shall at all times fully indemnify and save harmless the Custodian from
   any liability that may arise in connection with this Agreement, except
   liability from the negligence or willful misconduct of the Custodian.

17. Inalienability of Benefits

   The benefits provided hereunder shall not be subject to alienation,
   assignment, garnishment, attachment, execution or levy of any kind, and
   any attempt to cause such benefits to be so subjected shall not be
   recognized except to such extent as may be required by law.

   This Custodial Agreement shall be construed, administered and enforced
   according to the laws of the State of New York.

18. Construction

   The Plan shall be administered, construed and enforced according to the
   laws of the State of New York, except to the extent preempted by the
   Act.  It is intended that this Plan qualify under Section 403(b)(7) of
   the Code, and no provision of this Plan shall be construed to conflict
   with any requirement of Section 403(b)(7) of the Code.

   The Employer shall be solely responsible for compliance with the
   nondiscrimination rules of Section 403(b)(12) of the Code, if
   applicable.  If the Plan and Custodial Agreement are determined to
   constitute an "employee pension benefit plan" subject to the Employee
   Retirement Income Security Act of 1974, as amended ("ERISA"), then the
   Employer shall comply with all applicable requirements of ERISA.

   The Employer may maintain a separate 403(b) plan document in addition
   to the Plan and Custodial Agreement.  Such plan document shall be
   administered and maintained by the Employer in a manner consistent with
   the Plan and Custodial Agreement, and neither the Custodian nor the
   Sponsor shall have any duties or responsibilities with respect to such
   separate document.


Dreyfus Group Retirement Plans is a division of Dreyfus Service Corporation.
1992, Dreyfus Service Corporation                           NP/EMPYcust3-925



                          Dreyfus 403(b)(7) Retirement Plan
                       Custodial Account Application - Form #1

1. a. Name of Employee:  _______________________________________________________

   b. Employee's Social Security Number:  ______________________________________

   c. Date of Birth:  __________________________________________________________

   d. Telephone Number:  (       )                 (       )
                         _______________________________________________________
                          (Home)                   (Office)

2. Employee's Address:  ________________________________________________________
                        (Street)
  ______________________________________________________________________________
   (City)                    (State)                            (Zip Code)

3. Employer's Name, Address and Telephone Number:             (       )
                                                  ______________________________
                                                  (Name)      (Telephone Number)
   _____________________________________________________________________________
     (Address)

4. Please indicate below the name of each fund in which all contributions
   shall be invested and the percentage of each contribution to be
   allocated to each fund:

       Fund Name          % of Contribution (no less than 10% in any one fund)
   __________________    ____________________________________________________
   __________________    ____________________________________________________
   __________________    ____________________________________________________
                                   (must total 100%)

  If no selection is indicated, your money will be invested in Dreyfus
  Liquid Assets, Inc. This Application must be accompanied or preceded by
  a Dreyfus Liquid Assets, Inc. Prospectus.

5.[] If you wish to transfer assets from an existing 403(b) plan, check
  here and complete the enclosed Transfer Request Form-Form #3 .

EMPLOYEE'S ACCEPTANCE By signing this Application, the Employee acknowledges
that the Employee has received and agrees to be bound by the terms and
conditions of the current Prospectus of each fund specified in paragraph 4
above, the Dreyfus 403(b)(7) Retirement Plan (the "Plan") and the Dreyfus
403(b)(7) Retirement Plan Custodial Agreement (the "Custodial Agreement"), and
hereby appoints The Dreyfus Trust Company as Custodian under the Custodial
Agreement.  The Employee also designates the beneficiary(ies) specified on the
Beneficiary Designation Form se forth on the reverse side of this Application
and agrees to be bound by the terms and conditions set forth therein. The
Employee agrees that the Custodian shall be entitled to deduct its fees and
administration expenses as set forth in the Custodian's current fee schedule, a
copy of which has been received by the Employee, and which may be amended by the
Custodian in the future upon written notice to the Employee.

By signing this Application, the Employee accepts the privilege to make
exchanges, including telephone exchanges, among select Dreyfus funds pursuant to
Section IV of the Plan and Section 8 of the Custodial Agreement. Prior to any
exchange, a current Prospectus of the fund(s) into which exchanges are to be
affected must be obtained. Exchanges can be made only between Dreyfus mutual
fund accounts having identical registrations.  The current exchange privilege is
subject to certain other limitations, as described in the current Prospectus of
each fund. A person wishing to make a telephone exchange should call The Dreyfus
Trust Company at the appropriate number listed below:

       In the Continental US., as well as Alaska, Hawaii, Puerto Rico and the
                U.S. Virgin Islands, call toll free: 1-800-221-4060.
                            Overseas, call: 401-455-3306.




_________________________________________________        _______________________
             Employee's Signature                                  Date

EMPLOYER'S ACCEPTANCE By signing this Application, the Employer named above
agrees to the terms and conditions of the Plan, the Custodial Agreement and this
Application, and certifies that the Employer is an organization described in
Section 501(c)(3) of the Code, which is exempt from tax under Section 501(a) of
the Code, or is another qualifying organization described in Section 403(b) of
the Code.

____________________________________  ____________________________ _____________
     Authorized Signature                       Title                   Date

CUSTODIAN'S ACCEPTANCE By signing this Application, The Dreyfus Trust Company
accepts this Application and its appointment as Custodian of the Employee's
Custodial Account under the terms and conditions set forth in the Plan and the
Custodial Agreement. This Application will be maintained by The Dreyfus Trust
Company, as Custodian.

By  ______________________________________________________  ____________________
          The Dreyfus Trust Company, as Custodian                  Date


                      Dreyfus 403(b)(7) Retirement Plan
                    Salary Reduction Agreement - Form #2


Complete this form to indicate the amount of money to be deferred from your
salary and contributed to your account each pay period. This amount may be
changed only once during a calendar year. Both you and your Employer must sign
where indicated. This form should be retained by the Employer; you should keep a
copy for your records.

AGREEMENT made this ___________ day of ______________, 19___, by and between
_____________________________ (the "Employee") and __________________________
(the "Employer"), whereby the Employer and Employee agree as follows:

1. The salary of the Employee will be reduced by $__________; or by _________%
   (minimum of $___________ per pay period).
2. The amount of such reduction shall be contributed by the Employer to: The
   Dreyfus Trust Company, as Custodian (or any successor custodian) of the
   Employee's Custodial Account in accordance with the Dreyfus 403(b)(7)
   Retirement Plan (the "Plan"), the Dreyfus 403(b)(7) Retirement Plan Custodial
   Agreement (the "Custodial Agreement"), and Section 403(b)(7) of the Internal
   Revenue Code of 1986, as amended (the "Code").
3. The foregoing arrangement shall be subject to the limitations on the maximum
   amount(s) that can be contributed under a plan described in Section 403(b)(7)
   of the Code. The limitations are found in Sections 402, 403(b) and 415 of the
   Code. The Employee shall be solely responsible for ensuring that these limits
   are not violated.
4. All contributions made to the Employee's Custodial Account shall be
   administered in accordance with the terms and conditions of the Plan, the
   Custodial Agreement and the Custodial Account Application completed by the
   Employee and the Employer.
5. This Salary Reduction Agreement is legally binding and irrevocable with
   respect to all amounts earned by the Employee while this Agreement is in
   effect, provided, however, that the Employer may terminate this Agreement
   with respect to amounts not earned at the time of termination. It is further
   understood and agreed that the Employee will not be permitted to make more
   than one Salary Reduction Agreement, or to make more than one change in the
   amount or percentage of the salary reduction specified in the Employee's
   Salary Reduction Agreement, during any one taxable year of the Employee,
   except for any change required to comply with the limitations described in
   Paragraph 3 above.

EXECUTED as of the date first written above.

___________________________________________  ___________________________________
     (Print Name of Employer)                      (Signature of Employee)

By:________________________________________
          (Authorized Signature)

___________________________________________
          (Print Name and Title)


                   Dreyfus 403(b)(7) Retirement Plan
                    Transfer Request Form - Form #3

This form should be completed if you wish to transfer assets from an
existing 403(b) plan. Simply enter the information requested. Both you and
your Employer must sign where indicated.

IF YOU WISH TO TRANSFER ASSETS FROM YOUR EXISTING 403(b) PLAN, COMPLETE
THIS FORM AND FORWARD IT TO: THE DREYFUS TRUST COMPANY, as Custodian,
Dreyfus Mutual Funds, P.0. Box 6427, Providence, RI 02940-9808, Attn:
Benefit Plans Department.(1)

            TO:___________________________________________________
               (Name of Present Custodian or Insurance Carrier)
               ___________________________________________________
               Address
               ___________________________________________________
               City                State                Zip Code
            RE: A/C ______________________________________________
                      (Account Number)
                A/C ______________________________________________
                      (Account Number)

To Whom it May Concern:

It is my intention to effect a tax-free transfer of:
[] all assets; or [] a portion of assets: $____________ in the above-referenced
Tax Sheltered Annuity Contract(s)(2)(1)/ Tax Sheltered Custodial Account(s) to a
Dreyfus 403(b)(7) Retirement Plan sponsored by Dreyfus Service Corporation.

     This letter represents my formal request to transfer all or a portion of
such assets (cash or fund shares only(1)) to The Dreyfus Trust Company, as
Custodian, for investment in certain mutual fund shares designated by me through
a Custodial Account that conforms to Section 403(b)(7) of the Internal Revenue
Code of 1986, as amended. Please make your check payable to The Dreyfus Trust
Company, as Custodian, and forward it to:

                           The Dreyfus Trust Company
                           P.O. Box 6427
                           Providence, Rl 02940-9808
                           Attn: Benefit Plans Department

I confirm that I have entered into a binding agreement with my new Custodian and
in the event that I receive a check for the proceeds of the above-referenced
account(s), I will immediately endorse the check to The Dreyfus Trust Company,
as Custodian, for deposit into my Dreyfus 403(b)(7) Retirement Plan Custodial
Account (please indicate existing Dreyfus plan account number, if any:
_____________________________________).

Date ___________________________         _______________________________________
                                           Print Name of Employer

                                         _______________________________________
                                                Print Name of Employee

                                         _______________________________________
                                                Signature of Employee

The Dreyfus Trust Company accepts its appointment as Custodian and confirms the
above. Please send the amount requested (check(s) made payable to The Dreyfus
Trust Company, as Custodian).
                    Acceptance by The Dreyfus Trust Company

________________________________________________      ________________________
                  Signature                                     Date




         If you have any questions, call our Benefit Plans Division toll free:
1-800-358-5566. In New York City call: (718) 895-1397. In N.Y.  State, call
collect.


1.   Special requirements apply if you are over the age of 70-1/2 and have a
     different beneficiary listed in your old plan. Contact the Custodian.

2.   In Revenue Ruling 90-24, the Internal Revenue Service ("IRS") stated that a
     tax-free transfer can be made from a 403(b) annuity contract or a 403(b)(7)
     custodial account to a 403(b)(7) custodial account so long as the
     transferred assets continue to be subject to any restriction on early
     withdrawals found in the original investment.

3.   In cash or, if shares, then only shares of ownership in an investment
     company registered under the Investment Company Act of 1940, as amended,
     the shares of which are underwritten and distributed by the Dreyfus Service
     Corporation, or shares in any other investment company as may, from time to
     time, be offered by Dreyfus Service Corporation, which the Custodian has
     agreed to hold in the Custodial Account.


                               Beneficiary Designation Form
Naming more than one beneficiary

 You can name one or more persons as a beneficiary and you can designate each of
them as a primary or secondary beneficiary. To name more than one primary or
secondary beneficiary, include all information requested below on a separate
piece of paper. Sign and date each additional page and attach it to this
Application.

 If you name more than one primary beneficiary, or one secondary beneficiary,
 you can specify if they are to receive equal or unequal shares. If you do not
 specify, they will be paid in equal shares.

 Any secondary beneficiary or beneficiaries you name will receive all or a
 portion of your Dreyfus 403(b)(7) Custodial Account balance only if all primary
 beneficiaries die before you.

 It will also be assumed that you want your entire Dreyfus 403(b)(7) Custodial
 Account balance to be paid to the beneficiaries who survive you. Thus, if you
 name two primary beneficiaries but one of them dies before you, the entire
 balance will be paid to the surviving beneficiary.

Naming a trust as beneficiary

 To name a trust as a primary or secondary beneficiary, write the name and
 address of the trustee, then give the date of the trust agreement and the name
 of each trust beneficiary.

Other important points to remember

 By naming a beneficiary on this Application, you revoke any prior designation
 of beneficiary you may have made with respect to the assets in your Dreyfus
 403(b)(7) Custodial Account.

 You have the right to change your beneficiaries at any time by filing a proper
 written request with the Custodian, which is received by the Custodian during
 your lifetime.

 If no beneficiary survives you, if no beneficiary designation is in effect at
 your death, or if your beneficiary is your estate, the balance in your Dreyfus
 403(b)(7) Custodial Account will be paid to your estate.

Primary Beneficiary*

 _______________________________________   ____________________________________
 Name                                      Relationship, if any
 _________________________  ________________________  _________________________
 Date of Birth              Social Security #         Percent of Share
 ______________________________________________________________________________
 Address

Secondary Beneficiary (in case of death of primary beneficiary(ies)

 _______________________________________   ____________________________________
 Name                                      Relationship, if any
 _________________________  ________________________  _________________________
 Date of Birth              Social Security #         Percent of Share
 ______________________________________________________________________________
 Address

*Spousal Consent

 If your Employer makes contributions to your Dreyfus 403(b)(7) Custodial
 Account, the Custodial Account is subject to the provisions of the Employee
 Retirement Income Security Act of 1974, as amended ("ERISA"), and you are
 married and designate a primary beneficiary other than your spouse, you must
 have your spouse sign the below consent:

      I hereby consent to the above beneficiary designations and limit my
      consent to the beneficiaries indicated above.  In addition, I waive my
      right to limit my consent to a specific form of benefit and consent to any
      form of benefit which may be elected under the Custodial Account.  I
      understand that my spouse must execute a new Beneficiary Designation Form
      if he or she wants to designate another beneficiary.

 ______________________________________________        ________________________
 Spouse's Signature                                    Date


                                                       Plan Respresentative
 ______________________________________________
 Witness                                                    or

                                                       Notary Public

                                                       State:__________________

                                                       Commission Expires: ____



                        FOR DEALERS AND ADVISORS ONLY

 _______________________________________________________________________________
 Name                    Address                City           State     Zip
 _______________________________________________________________________________
 Salesman's Name             Salesman's #                 Branch & Dealer Code

  []  CHECK ONLY IF COPY OF CONFIRM SHOULD BE SENT TO BRANCH OFFICE
  INSTEAD OF HOME OFFICE.
 _______________________________________________________________________________
 BRANCH ADDRESS (IF BOX ABOVE IS CHECKED)-ALSO BRANCH CODE MUST BE FILLED
 IN ABOVE.


                              Adoption Agreement
                 Dreyfus Prototype Simplified Employee Pension

The Employer named in Section I.A. below hereby establishes or restates a
Simplified Employee Pension ("SEP").  The terms of the SEP are set forth
in this Adoption Agreement and the applicable provisions of the Dreyfus
Prototype Simplified Employee Pension Basic Plan Document, as amended from
time to time, which is hereby adopted and incorporated herein by
reference.

I.      Basic Provisions

    A.     Employer's Name:  ________________________________________________
           Address:  ________________________________________________________
                   __________________________________________________________


    B.     Employer is a [] corporation; [] S Corporation; [] partnership; []
           sole proprietor; [] other.
    C.     Employer's Tax ID Number:  _____________________________
    D.     Employer's Fiscal Year:  ___________________________________
    E.     Effective Date of Plan:  ____________________________________
           If this is an amendment and restatement of an existing SEP, enter
           the date originally adopted ______________________________
           The Effective Date of this amended SEP __________________________.
    F.     Plan Year shall mean: [] the calendar year.  [] the Employer's
           fiscal year.


II.     Eligible Employees

    All Employees shall be Eligible Employees, except:
    []     Employees who have not attained age __________________ (not to
           exceed age 21).
    []     Employees who have not performed service for the Employer during
           at least _____________________ (not to exceed 3) of the 5 calendar
           years immediately preceding such calendar year.
    []     Employees with total compensation (within the meaning of section
           414(q)(7) of the Code) from the Employer for the calendar year of
           less than $300 (adjusted in accordance with section 408(k)(8) of
           the Code).
    []     Employees included in a unit of Employees covered by a collective
           bargaining agreement between the Employer and employee
           representatives, if retirement benefits were the subject of good
           faith bargaining ("Collectively Bargained Employees").  For this
           purpose, the term "employee representatives" does not include any
           organization more than half of whose members are Employees who are
           owners, officers or executives of the Employer.  The determination
           of who is a Collectively Bargained Employee shall be made taking
           into consideration the special rules set forth in IRS Regulation
           Section 1.410(b)-6(d)(2).
    []     Employees who are nonresident aliens and who receive no earned
           income from the Employer which constitutes income from sources
           within the United States ("Nonresident Aliens").  The
           determination of who is a Nonresident Alien shall be made taking
           into consideration the special rules set forth in IRS Regulation
           Section 1.410(b)-6(c).


III.    Compensation

    Compensation shall mean all of each Participant's:
    []     Information required to be reported under sections 6041, 6051 and
           6052 of the Code.  Wages as defined in section 3401(a) and all
           other payments of compensation to the Employee by the Employer (in
           the course of the Employer's trade or business) for which the
           Employer is required to furnish the Employee a written statement
           under sections 6041(d), 6051(a)(3) and 6052 but determined without
           regard to any rules that limit the remuneration included in wages
           based on the nature or location of the employment or services
           performed (such as the exception for agricultural labor in section
           3401(a)(2) of the Code).
    []     Section 3401(a) wages.  Wages as defined in section 3401(a) of the
           Code for purposes of income tax withholding at the source but
           determined without regard to any rules that limit the remuneration
           included in wages based on the nature or location of the
           employment or the services performed (such as the exception for
           agricultural labor in section 3401(a)(2) of the Code).
    []     Section 415 safe-harbor compensation.  Wages, salaries, and fees
           for professional services and other amounts received (without
           regard to whether or not an amount is paid in cash) for personal
           services actually rendered in the course of employment with the
           Employer to the extent that the amounts are includible in gross
           income (including, but not limited to, commissions paid salesmen,
           compensation for services on the basis of a percentage of profits,
           commissions on insurance premiums, tips, bonuses, fringe benefits,
           and reimbursements or expense allowances under a nonaccountable
           plan (as described in Section 1.62-2(c)), excluding the following:

           (a)     Employer contributions to a plan of deferred compensation to
                   the extent that, before the application of the section 415
                   limitations to that plan, the contributions are not
                   includible in the Employee's gross income for the taxable
                   year in which contributed, or Employer contributions under a
                   simplified employee pension plan described in section 408(k),
                   or any distributions from a plan of deferred compensation
                   regardless of whether such amounts are includible in the
                   gross income of the Employee;
           (b)     Amounts realized from the exercise of a nonqualified stock
                   option, or when restricted stock (or property) held by the
                   Employee either becomes freely transferable or is no longer
                   subject to a substantial risk of forfeiture;
           (c)     Amount realized from the sale, exchange or other disposition
                   of stock acquired under a qualified stock option; and
           (d)     Other amounts which receive special tax benefits, such as
                   premiums for group-term life insurance (but only to the
                   extent that the premiums are not includible in the gross
                   income of the Employee), or contributions made by the
                   Employer (whether or not under a salary reduction agreement)
                   towards the purchase of any annuity described in section
                   403(b) of the Code (whether or not the amounts are excludable
                   from the gross income of the Employee).

                   Note:  Section 415 safe-harbor compensation is determined
                   without regard to the exclusions from gross income in
                   sections 931 and 933 of the Code.  A similar rule is to be
                   applied in determining the compensation of Self-Employed
                   Individuals.

           which is actually paid or made available to the Participant
           during:
           []      The Plan Year.
           []      The taxable year ending with or within the Plan Year.

    For any Self-Employed Individual covered under the Plan, Compensation
    will mean Earned Income.

    []     Compensation shall be reduced by all of the following items (even
           if includible in gross income): reimbursements or other expense
           allowances, fringe benefits (cash and noncash), moving expenses,
           deferred compensation and welfare benefits.

    []     Compensation shall include any amount which is contributed by the
           Employer pursuant to a salary reduction agreement and which is not
           includible in the gross income of the Employee under sections 125,
           402(e)(3), 402(h)(1)(B) or 403(b) of the Code.


IV.     Employer and Employee Contributions

    A.     Types of Contributions
           1.      Employer Discretionary Contributions
                   [] Not provided.
                   [] An amount fixed by appropriate action of the Employer.
                   [] ________________% of Compensation of Participants for the
                   Plan Year (not to exceed 15%).
                   Employer Discretionary Contributions [] shall; [] shall not
                   be integrated with Social Security.
                   a. [] The Permitted Disparity Percentage shall be
                   _________________%.
                   b. [] The Permitted Disparity Percentage shall be determined
                   annually by appropriate action of the Employer.
                   c. [] The Integration Level shall be:
                   [] The Taxable Wage Base
                   [] $__________________ (a dollar amount less than the Taxable
                   Wage Base).
                   [] ________________% (not to exceed 100%) of the Taxable Wage
                   Base.
               Note:  If a Plan Year has fewer than twelve (12) months and
               Compensation is limited to compensation paid during the Plan
               Year, the Integration Level shall be prorated in accordance with
               IRS Regulation Section 1.401(1)-2(d)(5).  The Permitted
               Disparity Percentage cannot exceed the lesser of: (i) the rate
               at which Employer contributions are allocated to the account of
               Employees with respect to the Compensation of Employees at or
               below the integration level (expressed as a percentage of
               Compensation), or (ii) the greater of 5.7% or the tax rate under
               section 3111(a) of the Code attributable to the old age
               insurance portion of the Old Age, Survivors and Disability
               Income provisions of the Social Security Act (as in effect on
               the first day of the Plan Year).  If the Integration Level
               selected above is other than the Taxable Wage Base ("TWB"), the
               5.7% factor in the preceding sentence must be replaced by the
               applicable percentage determined from the following table.

                   If the Integration Level is:

 more than               but not more than      The Applicable Factor is
      $0                     X*                           5.7%
      X*                     80% of TWB                  4.3%
  80% of TWB                 Y**                         5.4%

             *X = the greater of $10,000 or 20% of TWB

            **Y = any amount more than 80% of TWB, but less than 100% of TWB

        2.     Elective Deferrals:
           []      Shall not be permitted
           []      Shall be permitted

           A Participant may elect to have his or her Compensation reduced by
           the following percentage or amount per pay period:
           []      An amount not excess of __________________% of Compensation
           [cannot exceed the lesser of 15% of Compensation (determined
           without regard to the Employer contributions made under this Plan)
           or the dollar limitation of section 402(g) of the Code for the
           calendar year ($9,240 for 1995, as indexed)].
           []      An amount not in excess of $ ________________ of Compensation
           [cannot exceed the lesser of 15% of Compensation (determined
           without regard to the Employer contributions made under this Plan)
           or the dollar limitation of section 402(g) of the Code for the
           calendar year ($9,240 for 1995, as indexed)].

           A Participant may elect to commence Elective Deferrals the next
           pay period following:
           ________________ (enter date or period -- at least once each
           calendar year).

           A Participant may modify the amount of Elective Deferrals as of
           ________________________________ (enter date or period -- at least
           once each calendar year).

           A Participant [] may; [] may not base Elective Deferrals on cash
           bonuses that, at the Participant's election, may be contributed to
           the CODA or received by the Participant in cash. Such election
           shall be effective as of the next pay period following
           _____________________ or as soon as administratively feasible
           thereafter.

    B.     Contributions Not Limited by Net Profits
           Indicate whether Employer Discretionary Contributions are to be
           limited to Net Profits of the Employer for the taxable year of the
           Employer ending with or within the Plan Year.    [] Yes    [] No


V.      Top-Heavy Provisions

        A.     Top-Heavy Status
               [] The provisions of Article V of the Plan shall always apply.
               [] The provisions of Article V of the Plan shall only apply in
               Plan Years during which the Plan is or becomes Top-Heavy.
        B.     Indicate whether the determination of Top-Heavy status is to be
               determined by comparing the aggregate contributions that have
               been made to the SEP on behalf of Key and Non-Key Employees
               rather than by comparing the account balances of Key and Non-Key
               Employees.   [] Yes    [] No
        C.     Minimum Allocations
               If a Participant in this Plan who is a Non-Key Employee is
               covered under another qualified plan maintained by the Employer,
               the minimum Top-Heavy allocation or benefit required under
               section 416 of the Code shall be provided to such Non-Key
               Employee under:
               [] This Plan.
               [] The Employer's other qualified defined contribution plan.
               [] The Employer's qualified defined benefit plan.
        D.     Determination of Present Value
               If the Employer maintains a defined benefit plan in addition to
               this Plan, and such plan fails to specify the interest rate and
               mortality table to be used for purposes of establishing present
               value to compute the Top-Heavy Ratio, then the following
               assumptions shall be used:
               Interest Rate:       _________________%
               Mortality Table: _____________________________
               Note:  If the Employer maintains or has ever maintained a
               defined benefit plan, the Plan may not permit Elective Deferrals
               to be made to the Plan.


VI.     Notice to Adopting Employers

        If Elective Deferrals are permitted, the "Notice to Adopting
        Employers" attached hereto is hereby made a part of this Plan.


VII.    Employer Representations and Covenants

        The Employer hereby represents and covenants that:
        a. It is aware of, and agrees to be bound by, the terms of the SEP.
        b. It understands that the Sponsor will not furnish legal or tax
        advice in connection with the adoption or operation of     the SEP
        and has consulted legal and tax counsel to the extent necessary.
        c. The failure to properly fill out this Adoption Agreement may
        result in disqualification of the Plan.
        d. It understands that it may not rely upon the opinion letter
        received for the SEP by the Sponsor in the event that it
        maintains or has ever maintained a defined benefit pension plan.
        e. It will provide each Participant with a current copy of the
        Adoption Agreement, the Basic Plan Document, the         Questions
        and Answers attached hereto, and, if Elective Deferrals are permitted
        under the SEP, the "Notice to         Employees" attached hereto.
        f.  It will notify each Participant in the SEP in writing of any
        Employer Discretionary Contributions or contributions on account of
        such Participant's Elective Deferrals made under the SEP to the
        Participant's IRA not later than the later of: (i) January 31 of the
        year following the Plan Year for which a contribution is made, or
        (ii) 30 days after such contribution is made.
        g.  It will furnish each Participant with a copy of any amendment to
        the terms of the SEP and a clear explanation in writing of its effect
        within 30 days of the effective date of such amendment.


VIII.      Prototype Plan Documents

           This Adoption Agreement may be used only in conjunction with the
           Dreyfus Prototype Simplified Employee Pension Basic Plan Document,
           as amended from time to time.  In the event the Sponsor amends the
           plan document or this Adoption Agreement or discontinues this type
           of plan, it will inform the Employer.  The Sponsor, The Dreyfus
           Corporation, is available to answer questions regarding the
           intended meaning of any SEP provisions, or the adoption of the
           Plan at 144 Glenn Curtiss Boulevard, Uniondale, New York
           11556-0144 [(800) 358-0910].

IN WITNESS WHEREOF, the Employer has executed this instrument the
______________ day of _______________________, 19_________.  If
applicable, the appropriate corporate seal has been affixed and attested
to.



                       ______________________________________________
                        Name of Business Entity
                       ______________________________________________
                        Signature (Sole Proprietors only)

                       By:  _________________________________________
Attest:                     Name and Title (Corporations or Partnerships)


_____________________________________________________
Secretary (Corporations only)





Notice to Adopting Employer

A Simplified Employee Pension Plan ("SEP") is a plan that provides you
with a simplified way to enhance your employee's retirement income.  Under
an elective SEP, employees may choose whether to make elective deferrals
to the SEP or to receive the amounts in cash.  If elective deferrals are
made, you contribute the amounts deferred by employees directly into an
individual retirement arrangement ("IRA") set up by or on behalf of the
employee with a bank, insurance company, or other qualified financial
institution.  The IRA must be one for which the Internal Revenue Service
has issued a favorable  opinion letter or a model IRA published by the
Service as Form 5305-Individual Retirement Trust  Account or Form
5305-A-Individual Retirement Custodial Account.

The information provided below is intended to assist you in understanding
and administering the elective deferral provisions of your SEP.  This
Notice to Adopting Employer is a part of the Dreyfus Prototype Simplified
Employee Pension.

I.      Employers Who May Not Use This SEP

    This elective SEP may not be used if you are an employer who:
    A.     Has any leased employees as defined in section 414(n)(2) of the
           Code;
    B.     Maintains or has maintained a defined benefit plan, even if now
           terminated;
    C.     Had more than 25 employees eligible to participate in the SEP at
           any time during the prior plan year.  (If you are a member of one
           of the groups described in section VIII. B. below, you may use
           this SEP, provided that in the prior plan year there never were
           more than 25 employees eligible to participate in this SEP, in
           total, of all the members of such groups, trades, or businesses.
           In addition, all eligible employees of all the members of such
           groups, trades, or businesses must be eligible to make elective
           deferrals to this SEP.)
    D.     Is a state or local government or a tax-exempt organization.


II.     Making the Agreement

        This SEP agreement is considered made when:
        A.     You have completed all blanks on the form; and
        B.     You have given all eligible employees copies of this SEP
               agreement and the "Notice to Employees" and, upon request  by
               any eligible employee, this "Notice to Adopting Employer."  (Any
               individual who, in the future, becomes eligible to participate
               in this SEP must be given the "Notice to Employees" upon
               becoming an eligible employee.)


III.Effective Date

    This SEP agreement is effective upon adoption.  No elective deferrals
    may be made by an employee on the basis of compensation that the
    employee received or had a right to receive before adoption of this
    agreement and execution by the employee of the deferral election.


IV.Deductibility of Contributions

    You may deduct, subject to the otherwise applicable limits, those
    contributions made to a SEP.  Contributions to the SEP are deductible
    for your taxable year with or within which the plan year of the SEP
    ends.  Contributions made for a  particular taxable year and
    contributed by the due date of your income tax return, including
    extensions, are deemed made in that taxable year.





V.      Elective Deferrals

    You may permit your employees to make elective deferrals through salary
    reduction or on the basis of bonuses that, at the employee's option,
    may be contributed to the SEP or received by the employee in cash
    during the year.
    You are responsible for telling your employees how they may make,
    change, or terminate elective deferrals based on either salary
    reduction or cash bonuses.  You must also provide a form on which they
    may make their deferrals.  This requirement may be satisfied by use of
    the "Model SEP Deferral Form" provided for this purpose at the end of
    these instructions.  You may instead use a form that sets forth, in a
    manner calculated to be understood by the average plan participant, the
    information contained in the Model SEP Deferral Form.  Remember that no
    deferral election may be made with respect to  compensation already
    received.


VI. SEP  Requirements

    A.     Beginning January 1, 1994, elective deferrals may not be based on
           more than $150,000 of compensation, as adjusted in accordance with
           section 408(k)(8) of the Code for cost-of-living changes.
           Compensation is the employee's  total compensation from the
           employer (determined without including the SEP-IRA contributions)
           and include:
           1.      Amounts received for personal services actually performed
                   (see section 1.219-1(c) of the Income Tax Regulations),
                   and
           2.      Earned income defined under section 401(c)(2).
    B.     The maximum limit on the amount of compensation an employee may
           elect to  defer under a SEP for a year is the lesser of 15% of the
           employee's compensation or the limitation under section 402(g) of
           the Code, as explained below.
           Note: The deferral limit is 15 percent of compensation (less
           employer SEP-IRA contributions).  Compute this amount using the
           following formula: compensation (before subtracting employer
           SEP-IRA contributions) x 13.0435%.
    C.     If you make nonelective contributions to this SEP for a plan year,
           or maintain any other SEP or qualified plan to which contributions
           are made for such plan year, then contributions to all such SEPs
           and qualified plans may not exceed the lesser of $30,000 or 15% of
           compensation for any employee.  If these limits are exceeded on
           behalf of any employee for a particular plan year, that employee's
           elective deferrals for that year must be reduced to the extent of
           the excess.
    D.     If you are a new employer who had no employees during the prior
           plan year, you will meet the limitation in section 408(k)(6)(B) of
           the Code (regarding no more than 25 eligible employees during the
           preceding year) if you had 25 or fewer employees throughout the
           first 30 days that you were in existence.


VII.Excess Elective Deferrals -- 402(g) Limit

    Section 402(g) of the Code limits the maximum amount of compensation an
    employee may elect to defer under a SEP (and certain other
    arrangements) during the calendar year.  This limit, which originally
    was $7,000, is indexed according to the cost of living.  (The section
    402(g) limit for 1995, is $9,240, as indexed.)  In addition, the limit
    may be increased if the employee makes elective deferrals to a salary
    reduction arrangement under section 403(b) of  the Code.  Amounts
    deferred for a year in excess of this limit are considered "excess
    elective deferrals" and are subject to the consequences described
    below.

    The section 402(g) limit applies to the total elective deferrals the
    employee makes for the calendar year, from all employers, under the
    following arrangements:
    A.     Elective SEPs under section 408(k)(6) of the Code;
    B.     Cash or deferred arrangements under section 401(k) of the Code;
           and
    C.     Salary reduction arrangements under section 403(b) of the Code.
           Thus, an employee may have excess elective deferrals even if the
           amount deferred under this SEP alone does not exceed the section
           402(g) limit.

    If an employee elects to defer compensation under this SEP and any
    other SEP or arrangement has made excess elective deferrals for a
    calendar year, he or she must withdraw those excess elective deferrals
    by April 15 following the calendar year to which the deferrals relate.
    Those excess deferrals not withdrawn by April 15 will be subject to the
    IRA contribution limitations of sections 219 and 408 of the Code and
    thus may be considered an excess contribution to the employee's IRA.
    Such excess elective deferrals therefore may be subject to the six
    percent tax on excess contributions under section 4973.

    Income on excess elective deferrals is includible in gross income in
    the year withdrawn from the IRA and must be withdrawn by April 15
    following the calendar year to which the deferrals relate.  Income
    withdrawn from the IRA after that date may be subject to the ten
    percent tax on early distributions under section 72(t) of the Code if
    the recipient is not 59-1/2.


VIII.Excess SEP  Contributions -- Deferral Percentage Limitation

    The amount each of your highly compensated employees may contribute to
    this elective deferral SEP is also restricted by the "deferral
    percentage limitation."  This is a limitation based on the amount of
    money deferred, on average, by your non-highly compensated employees.
    Deferrals made by a highly compensated employee that exceed this
    deferral percentage limitation for a plan year are considered "excess
    SEP contributions" and must be removed from the employee's SEP-IRA, as
    discussed in more detail below.

    The deferral percentage limitation for your highly compensated
    employees is computed by first averaging the "deferral percentages" (as
    defined below) for each eligible non-highly compensated employee for
    the plan year and then multiplying this result by 1.25.  The deferral
    percentage for a plan year of any highly compensated employee eligible
    to participate in this SEP may not be more than the resulting product,
    the "deferral percentage limitation."
    Only elective deferrals are included in this computation.  Nonelective
    SEP contributions may not be included.  The determination of the
    deferral percentage for any employee is to be made in accordance with
    section 408(k)(6) of the Code and should satisfy such other
    requirements as may be provided by the Secretary of the Treasury.

    For purposes of making this computation, the calculation of the number
    and identity of highly compensated employees, and their deferral
    percentages, is made on the basis of the entire "affiliated employer."

    In addition, for purposes of determining the deferral percentage of a
    highly compensated employee, the elective deferrals and compensation of
    the employee will also include the elective deferrals and compensation
    of any "family member."  This special rule applies, however, only if
    the highly compensated employee is a 5% owner or is one of a group of
    the ten most highly compensated employees.  The elective deferrals and
    compensation of family members used in this special rule do not count
    in computing the deferral percentages of individuals who do not fall
    into this group.

    The following definitions apply for purposes of the deferral percentage
    computation:
    A.     "Deferral percentage" shall mean the ratio (expressed as a
           percentage) of an employee's elective deferrals for a year to the
           employee's compensation for that year.  The deferral percentage of
           an employee who is eligible to make an elective deferral, but who
           does not make a deferral during the year, is zero.
    B.     "Affiliated employer" shall mean any corporation that is a member
           of a controlled group of corporations (as described in section
           414(b) of the Code) that includes the employer; any trade or
           business (whether or not incorporated) that is under common
           control (as defined in section 414(c)) with the employer; any
           organization (whether or not incorporated) which is a member of an
           affiliated service group (as defined in section 414(m)) that
           includes the employer; and any other entity required to be
           aggregated with the employer pursuant to regulations under section
           414(o).
    C.     "Family member" shall mean an individual who is related to a
           highly compensated employee as a spouse, or as a lineal ascendant
           (such as a parent or grandparent) or descendant (such as a child
           or grandchild) or spouse of either of those, in accordance with
           section 414(q) of the Code and the regulations thereunder.
    D.     "Highly compensated individual" shall mean an individual described
           in section 414(q) of the Code who, during the current or preceding
           year:
           1.      Was a 5% owner as defined in section 416(i)(1)(B)(i) of the
                   Code;
           2.      Received compensation in excess of $50,000, as indexed
                   according to the cost of living in accordance with section
                   414(q)(1), and was in the top-paid group (the top 20% of
                   employees, by compensation);
           3.      Received compensation in excess of $75,000, as indexed
                   according to the cost of living in accordance with section
                   414(q)(1); or
           4.      Was an officer and received compensation in excess of 50% of
                   the dollar limit under section 415 of the Code for defined
                   benefit plans.  (No more than three employees need be taken
                   into account under this rule.  At least one officer, the
                   highest-paid officer if no one else meets this test, however,
                   must be taken into account.)
IX. Excess SEP  Contributions -- Tax Consequences and Notification of
Employees

    You are responsible for notifying each affected employee, if any,
    within 2 1/2 months following the end of the plan year, of the amount
    of excess SEP contributions to that employee's SEP-IRA.  Such excess
    SEP contributions are includible in the employee's gross income in the
    calendar year as of the earliest date that any elective deferrals by
    the employee during the plan year would have been received by the
    employee had he or she originally elected to receive the amounts in
    cash.  However, if the excess SEP contributions (not including
    allocable income) total less than $100, then the excess contributions
    are includible in the employee's gross income in the calendar year of
    notification.  Income allocable to the excess SEP contributions is
    includible in gross income in the year of withdrawal from the IRA.

    If you fail to notify any of your affected employees within 2 1/2
    months following the end of the plan year of an excess SEP
    contribution, you must pay a tax equal to 10% of the excess SEP
    contribution.  If you fail to notify your employees by the end of the
    plan year following the plan year in which the excess SEP contributions
    arose, the SEP no longer will be considered to meet the requirements of
    section 408(k)(6) of the Code.  If the SEP no longer meets the
    requirements of section 408(k)(6), then any contribution to an
    employee's IRA will be subject to the IRA contribution limitations of
    sections 219 and 408 and thus may be considered an excess contribution
    to the employee's IRA.

    Your notification to each affected employee of the excess SEP
    contributions must specifically state in a manner calculated to be
    understood by the average employee:
    A.     The amount of the excess SEP contributions attributable to that
           employee's elective deferrals;
    B.     That the excess SEP contributions are includible in the employee's
           gross income for the calendar year or years in which the amounts
           deferred would have been received by the employee in cash had he
           or she not made an election to defer and that the income allocable
           to such excess SEP contributions is includible in the year
           withdrawn from SEP-IRA; and
    C.     That the employee must withdraw the excess SEP contributions (and
           allocable income) from the SEP-IRA by April 15 following the
           calendar year of notification by the employer.  Those excess
           contributions not withdrawn by April 15 following the year of
           notification will be subject to the IRA contribution limitations
           of sections 219 and 408 of the Code for the preceding calendar
           year and thus may be considered an excess contribution to the
           employee's IRA.  Such excess contributions may be subject to the
           six percent tax on excess contributions under section 4973.  If
           income allocable to an excess SEP contribution is not withdrawn by
           April 15 following the calendar year of notification by the
           employer, the income may be subject to the ten percent tax on
           early distributions under section 72(t) when withdrawn.

    For information on reporting excess SEP contributions, see Notice
    87-77, 1987-2 C.B. 385, and Notice 88-33, 1988-1 C.B. 513, as modified
    by Notice 89-32, 1989-1 C.B. 671.


X.      Failure to Satisfy the 50% Test

    If you discover, as of the end of any plan year, that more than half of
    your eligible employees have chosen not to make elective deferrals for
    that year, then all elective deferrals made by your employees for that
    plan year shall be considered "disallowed deferrals," i.e., IRA
    contributions that are not SEP-IRA contributions.

    You must notify each affected employee, within 2 1/2 months following
    the end of the plan year to which the disallowed deferrals relate, that
    his or her deferrals are no longer considered SEP-IRA contributions.
    Such disallowed deferrals are includible in the employee's gross income
    in the calendar year as of the earliest date that any elective
    deferrals by the employee during the plan year would have been received
    by the employee had he or she originally elected to receive the amounts
    in cash.  Income allocable to the disallowed deferrals is includible in
    the employee's gross income in the year of withdrawal from the IRA.

    Your notification to each affected employee of the disallowed deferrals
    must specifically state in a manner calculated to be understood by the
    average employee:
    A.     The amount of the disallowed deferrals:
    B.     The calendar year in which the disallowed deferrals are includible
           in gross income; and
    C.     That the employee must withdraw the disallowed deferrals ( and
           allocable income) from the SEP-IRA by April 15 following the
           calendar year of notification by the employer.  Those disallowed
           deferrals not withdrawn by April 15 following the year of
           notification will be subject to the IRA contribution limitations
           of sections 219 and 408 of the Code and thus may be considered an
           excess contribution to the employee's IRA.  These disallowed
           deferrals thus may be subject to the six percent tax on excess
           contributions under section 4973.  If income allocable to a
           disallowed deferral is not withdrawn by April 15 following the
           calendar year of notification by the employer, the income may be
           subject to the ten percent tax on early distributions under
           section 72(t) when withdrawn.

    Disallowed deferrals should be reported in the same manner as are
    excess SEP contributions.


XI.Restrictions on Withdrawal

    Your employees may not withdraw or transfer from their SEP-IRA any SEP
    contributions (or income on these contributions) attributable to
    elective deferrals made during a particular plan year until 2 1/2
    months after the end of that plan year.  If you choose to do so before
    this 2 1/2 month period has expired, however, you may notify your
    employees when the deferral percentage limitation test has been
    completed for a particular plan year and that this withdrawal
    restriction is thus no longer applicable.  In general, any transfer or
    distribution made before expiration of the applicable 2 1/2 month
    period (or notification, if sooner) will be includible in the
    employee's gross income and may also be subject to a ten percent
    penalty tax for early withdrawal.  This restriction does not apply to
    an employee's excess elective deferrals.


XII.For More Information

    To obtain more information concerning the rules governing this SEP,
    please contact The Dreyfus Corporation at 144 Glenn Curtiss Boulevard,
    Uniondale, NY 11556-0144 [(800) 358-0910].

    IF YOU ARE ESTABLISHING A SEP, A SAR-SEP, OR A SEP/SAR-SEP, THIS MUST
    BE DISTRIBUTED TO EMPLOYEES.  THESE QUESTIONS AND ANSWERS MUST BE
    PROVIDED TO ALL EMPLOYEES WHEN YOU ADOPT YOUR SEP OR, IF LATER, AT THE
    TIME THEY ARE EMPLOYED.




Questions and Answers

    A Simplified Employee Pension, or SEP, is an arrangement through which
    employers can make contributions toward their employees' retirement
    income without becoming involved in more complex retirement plans.
    Under a SEP an employer makes contributions directly to each employee's
    Individual Retirement Account or Annuity (IRA).  The IRA to which the
    employer contributes is referred to as a SEP-IRA.

    An employer who signs a SEP agreement is not statutorily required to
    make any contribution to the SEP-IRAs of eligible employees.  However,
    if any contribution is made, the contribution may not discriminate in
    favor of officers, shareholders, or highly compensated employees.

    The participation requirements that the employer may impose cannot be
    more restrictive than the law provides, but can be less restrictive.
    The law provides that all employees who are at least 21 years old and
    have worked for the employer for some period of time (however short) in
    any three of the immediately preceding five calendar years, are
    eligible to receive SEP contributions.  Certain nonresident aliens, and
    certain union employees who have already negotiated with respect to
    retirement benefits, may be excluded from participation.  Employees who
    earn less than $300 (adjusted for the cost of living) may also be
    excluded.

    This information and the following "Questions and Answers" should
    provide a basic understanding of what a SEP is and how it works.  If
    your employer's SEP permits you to make elective deferral
    contributions, you should read these Questions and Answers in
    conjunction with the "Notice to Employees" which will be provided to
    you.  An employee who has unresolved questions concerning SEPs should
    call the Federal tax information number, or the toll free number shown
    in the white pages of the local telephone directory.


1.    Q.   Who controls my SEP-IRA?
      A.   You own and control your SEP-IRA.  You may invest your SEP-IRA
           assets in such manner as is permitted by applicable law and the
           terms of your SEP-IRA.  Your employer sends SEP contributions to
           the financial institution in which your IRA is maintained, but SEP
           contributions become your property when they are deposited in your
           IRA.  However, you may incur a tax penalty if you withdraw funds
           from your IRA earlier than allowed by law without penalty.  See
           Question 7.


2.    Q.   Must my employer contribute to my IRA under the SEP?
      A.   There is no statutory requirement that an employer make or
           maintain a particular level of contributions and it is possible
           for the contributions to be discretionary.  Therefore, whether or
           not your employer must make a SEP contribution depends on the SEP
           contribution agreement your employer adopts.  However, if a
           contribution is made under the SEP, it must be allocated to all
           eligible employees according to the SEP agreement.


3.    Q.   May I also contribute to an IRA if my employer has signed a SEP
           Agreement?
      A.   You may be entitled to make regular IRA contributions to the
           SEP-IRA to which your employer contributes.  In addition to
           belonging to the SEP-IRA Plan, you as an employee can open a
           regular IRA and contribute up to the limit -- $2000 or 100% of
           compensation, whichever is less.  These contributions will be
           subject to the regular IRA deduction rules.


4.    Q.   Can SEP contributions be deposited in any IRA?
      A.   No.  Under your employer's SEP, contributions must be deposited
           into a Dreyfus Individual Retirement Account (a prototype IRA upon
           which a favorable opinion letter has been issued by the Internal
           Revenue Service).  Other IRAs may provide different rates of
           return and may have different terms concerning, among other
           things, transfers and withdrawals.


5.    Q.   What happens if I don't want a SEP-IRA?
      A.   Your employer may require that you become a participant in such an
           arrangement as a condition of employment.  However, if the
           employer does not require all eligible employees to become
           participants and an eligible employee elects not to participate,
           all other employees of the same employer are prohibited from
           entering into a SEP-IRA arrangement with that employer.


6.    Q.   Can I move funds from my SEP-IRA to another ta-sheltered IRA?
      A.   You may find it to your advantage to move contributions made to
           your SEP-IRA to another IRA.  Other IRAs may provide different
           rates of return, or may have different or more beneficial terms
           (such as favorable transfers and  withdrawal provisions).
           Depending on the contractual terms of the IRA to which you
           employer contributes, you may be able to move your funds to
           another IRA.  Even if contractually permitted, for tax purposes
           there are only two permissible ways for you to move funds from the
           SEP-IRA to another IRA.  First, it is permissible for you to
           withdraw or receive funds from your SEP-IRA, and no more than 60
           days later, place such funds in another IRA or SEP-IRA. This is
           called a "rollover" and may not be done more frequently than at
           one year intervals without penalty.  Second, you can make a
           transfer of funds between trustees.  There are no restrictions on
           the number of times you may make "transfers" if you arrange to
           have such funds transferred between the trustees, so that you
           never have possession.


7.    Q.   What happens if I withdraw my employer's SEP contribution from my
           IRA?
      A.   If you don't want to leave the employer's SEP contribution in your
           IRA you may withdraw it at any time, but any amount withdrawn (and
           not rolled over) is includible in your income.  Also, if
           withdrawals occur before you reach age 59 1/2, and are not on
           account of death, disability, or a current year excess
           contribution, you may be subject to the imposition of an extra
           penalty tax.

8.    Q.   May I participate in a SEP even though I'm covered by another
           plan?
      A.   Yes. You can participate in a SEP (other than a model SEP) even
           though you participate in another plan of the same employer.
           However, the combined contribution limits are subject to certain
           limitations described in section 415 of the Internal Revenue Code.
           Also, if you work for several employers, you may be covered by the
           SEP of one employer and a pension or profit-sharing plan of
           another employer.


9.    Q.  What is the maximum amount that may be contributed to my SEP-IRA
           by employer?
      A.   Your employer contributions to your SEP-IRA may not exceed the
           lesser of:
           (a) 15% of your compensation (determined without regard to any
           contributions made to your SEP-IRA); and
           (b) $22,500.
           If your employer's SEP is integrated with Social Security and you
           are a highly compensated employee, the $22,500 figure is reduced
           by the amount of contributions made on your behalf based on
           compensation over the integration level.  Any elective deferral
           contributions you may make to the plan are considered employer
           contributions for purposes of this limitation.


10.   Q.   What happens if too much is contributed to my SEP-IRA in any one
           year?
      A.   If the contributions by your employer to your SEP-IRA exceed the
           lesser of 15% of your compensation or $22,500, the excess amount
           will be included in your income and treated as a contribution by
           you to your IRA subject to the IRA contribution limitations of
           sections 219 and 408 of the Code.  As a result, you likely will
           have excess contributions made to your IRA for the taxable year,
           subject to the 6% excise tax set forth in section 4973 of the
           Code.  You may avoid the 6% excise tax by withdrawing the excess
           contribution, and any allocable income, by April 15 following the
           year to which the deferrals relate


11.   Q.   Do I need to file any additional forms with IR because I
           participate in a SEP?
      A.   No.


12.   Q.   Are the contributions my employer makes subject to Social Security
           tax?
      A.   No.  Your employer's contributions are not included as income on
           the W-2, and are not considered wages for the purpose of
           determining Social Security taxes.


13.   Q.   Is my employer required to provide me with information about
           SEP-IRA and the SEP agreement?
      A.   Yes.  In addition to the SEP Disclosure Information contained in
           this document, your employer or plan administrator must provide
           you with the following information:
           (a) At the time you become eligible to participate in the SEP your
           employer or plan administrator must inform you in writing that a
           SEP agreement has been adopted and state which employees may
           participate, how employer contributions are allocated, and who can
           provide you with additional information.
           (b) Your employer or plan administrator must inform you in writing
           of all employer contributions to your SEP-IRA (this information
           must be supplied by January 31st of the year following the year
           the contribution is made or 30 days after the contribution is
           made, whichever is later).
           (c) If your employer amends the SEP, or replaces it with another
           SEP, the employer or plan administrator must furnish a copy of the
           amendment or new SEP (with a clear written explanation of its
           terms and effects) to each participant within 30 days of the date
           the SEP or amendment becomes effective.
           (d) If your employer selects or recommends the IRAs into which the
           SEP contribution will be deposited (or substantially influences
           you or other employees to choose them) your employer or plan
           administrator must ensure that a clear written explanation of the
           terms of those IRAs is provided at the time each employee becomes
           eligible to participate.  The explanation must include information
           about the terms of those IRAs, such as rates of return, and any
           restrictions on a participant's ability to roll over, transfer, or
           withdraw funds from the IRAs (including restrictions that allow
           rollovers or withdrawal but reduce earnings of the IRAs or impose
           other penalties).
           (e) If your employer selects, recommends, or substantially
           influences you to choose a specific IRA and the IRA prohibits the
           withdrawal of funds, your employer or plan administrator may be
           required to provide you with additional information.  Regulations
           promulgated by the Department of Labor under Title I of ERISA
           should be consulted in this regard.


14.   Q.  Is the financial institution where I establish my IRA also
          required to provide me with information?
      A.  Yes.  It must provide you with a disclosure statement which
          contains the following items of information in plain,
          nontechnical language:
          (a)     the statutory requirements which relate to your IRA;
          (b)     the tax consequences which follow the exercise of various
                  options and what those options are:
          (c)     participation eligibility rules, and rules on deductions for
                  retirement savings;
          (d)     the circumstances and procedures under which you may revoke
                  your IRA, including the name, address, and telephone number
                  of the person designated to receive your notice of revocation
                  (this explanation must be prominently displayed at the
                  beginning of the disclosure statement);
          (e)     explanations of when penalties may be assessed against you
                  because of specified prohibited or penalized activities
                  concerning your IRA; and
          (f)     financial disclosure information which:
                  (1)   either projects value growth rates of your IRA under
                        various contribution and retirement schedules, or
                        describes the method of computing and allocating annual
                        earnings and charges which may be assessed;
                  (2)   describes whether, and for what period, the growth
                        projections for the plan are guaranteed, or a statement
                        of the earnings rate and terms on which the projection
                        is based;
                  (3)   stipulates the sales commission to be charged in each
                        year expressed as a percentage of $1,000.00; and
                  (4)   shows the proportional amount of any nondeductible life
                        insurance which may be a feature of your IRA.

    See Publication 590 available at any IRS office, for a more complete
    explanation of the disclosure requirements.  In addition to this
    disclosure statement, the financial institution is required to provide
    you with a financial statement each year.  It may be necessary to
    retain and refer to statements for more than one year in order to
    evaluate the investment performance of the IRA.


15.   Q.   Can SEP contributions be reduced by employer contributions to
           Social Security?
      A.   Although employer contributions under the SEP agreement must bear
           a uniform relationship to employee's compensation, your employer
           is entitled to offset or reduce its contribution by certain
           amounts already paid by your employer on your account as social
           security taxes.  This reduction may substantially reduce the
           allocation you would otherwise receive.  This is called
           "integration" with social security, and is permissible only if
           statutory requirements are satisfied.  If your employer chooses to
           integrate with social security, the SEP allocation information
           your employer provides you must clearly show the integration
           formula.




IF YOU ARE ESTABLISHING A SAR-SEP OR A SEP/SAR-SEP, THIS MUST BE
DISTRIBUTED TO EMPLOYEES.  IF YOUR SEP PERMITS EMPLOYEES TO MAKE ELECTIVE
DEFERRALS, THIS NOTICE MUST BE PROVIDED TO ALL EMPLOYEES WHO ARE ELIGIBLE
TO PARTICIPATE IN THE SEP AND TO ALL EMPLOYEES WHO, IN THE FUTURE, BECOME
ELIGIBLE TO PARTICIPATE IN THE SEP.

Notice to Employees

The following information explains what a simplified employee pension plan
("SEP") is, how contributions are made, and how to treat these
contributions for tax purposes.  For more specific information, refer to
the SEP agreement itself and the accompanying "Notice to Adopting
Employer."


I.       Simplified Employee Pension -- Defined

         A SEP is a retirement income arrangement.  In this "elective" SEP,
         you may choose to defer compensation to your own Individual
         Retirement Account or Annuity ("IRA").  You may base these
         "elective deferrals" either on a salary reduction arrangement or on
         bonuses that, at your election, may be contributed to an IRA or
         received in cash.  This type of elective SEP is available only to
         an employer with 25 or fewer eligible employees.

         Your employer must provide you with a copy of the SEP agreement
         containing eligibility requirements and a description of the basis
         upon which contributions may be made.

         All amounts contributed to your IRA belong to you, even after you
         quit working for your employer.


II.      Elective Deferrals -- May Be Disallowed

         You are not required to make elective deferrals to this SEP-IRA.
         However, if more than half of your employer's eligible employees
         choose not to make elective deferrals in a particular year, then no
         employee may participate in your employer's elective SEP for that
         year.  If you make elective deferrals during a year in which this
         happens, then your deferrals for that year will be "disallowed,"
         and the deferrals will be considered ordinary IRA contributions
         (which may be excess IRA contributions) rather than SEP-IRA
         contributions.

         "Disallowed deferrals" and allocable income may be withdrawn,
         without penalty, until April 15 following the calendar year in
         which you are notified of the "disallowed deferrals."  Amounts left
         in the IRA after that date will be subject to the same penalties
         discussed in Section VII below applicable to excess SEP
         contributions.


III.     Elective Deferrals -- Annual Limitation

         The maximum amount that you may defer to this SEP for any calendar
         year is limited to the lesser of fifteen percent of compensation
         (determined without including the SEP-IRA contribution) or a dollar
         limit under section 402(g) of the Internal Revenue Code that
         originally was $7,000 (and is now subject to cost-of-living
         increases).

         The fifteen percent limit may be reduced if your employer also
         maintains a SEP to which nonelective contributions are made for a
         plan year, or any qualified plan to which contributions are made
         for such plan year.  In that case, total contributions on your
         behalf to all such SEPs and qualified plans may not exceed the
         lesser of $22,500 or fifteen percent of your compensation.  If
         these limits are exceeded, the amount you may elect to contribute
         to this SEP for the year will be correspondingly reduced.

         The dollar limit under section 402(g) of the Code is an overall
         limit on the maximum amount that you may defer in each calendar
         year to all elective SEPs and cash or deferred arrangements under
         section 401(k) of the Code, regardless of how many employers you
         may have worked for during the year.

         The section 402(g) limit is indexed according to the cost of
         living.  In addition, the section 402(g) limit may be increased to
         $9,500 if you make salary reduction contributions under a section
         403(b) tax-sheltered annuity arrangement.

         If you are a highly compensated employee, there may be a further
         limit on the amount that you may contribute to a SEP-IRA for a
         particular year.  This limit is calculated by your employer and is
         known as the "deferral percentage limitation."  This deferral
         percentage limitation is based on a mathematical formula that
         limits the percentage of pay that highly compensated employees may
         elect to defer to a SEP-IRA.  As discussed below, your employer
         will notify each highly compensated employee who has exceeded the
         deferral percentage limitation.


IV.      Elective Deferrals -- Tax Treatment

         The amount that you may elect to contribute to your SEP-IRA is
         excludable from gross income, subject to the limitations discussed
         above, and is not includible as taxable wages on Form W-2.
         However, these amounts are subject to FICA taxes.


V.       Additional Top-Heavy Contributions

         If you are not a "key employee," your employer must make an
         additional contribution to your SEP-IRA for a year in which the SEP
         is considered "top-heavy."  (Your employer will be able to tell you
         whether you are a key employee.)  This additional contribution will
         not exceed three percent of your compensation.  It may be less if
         your employer has already made a contribution to your account, and
         for certain other reasons.


VI.      Elective Deferrals -- Excess Amounts Contributed

         There are three different situations in which impermissible excess
         amounts arise under the SEP-IRA.

         The first way is when "excess elective deferrals" (i.e., amounts in
         excess of the section 402(g) limit) are made.  You are responsible
         for calculating whether you have exceeded the section 402(g) limit
         in the calendar year.  For 1995, the section 402(g) limit for
         contributions made to an elective SEP is $9,240, as indexed.

         The second way is when "excess SEP contributions" (i.e., amounts in
         excess of the deferral percentage limitation referred to above) are
         made by highly compensated employees.  The employer is responsible
         for determining whether such an employee has made excess
         contributions.

         The third way is when more than half of an employer's eligible
         employees choose not to make elective deferrals for a plan year.
         In that case, any elective deferrals made by any employees for that
         year are considered "disallowed deferrals" as discussed above.
         Your employer is also responsible for determining whether deferrals
         must be disallowed on this basis.

         Excess elective deferrals are calculated on the basis of the
         calendar year.  Excess SEP contributions and disallowed deferrals,
         however, are calculated on the basis of the SEP plan year, which
         may or may not be a calendar year.


VII.     Excess Elective Deferrals -- How To Avoid Adverse Tax Consequences

         Excess elective deferrals are includible in your gross income in
         the calendar year of deferral.  Income on the excess elective
         deferrals is includible in the year of withdrawal from the IRA.
         You should withdraw excess elective deferrals under this SEP, and
         any allocable income, from your SEP-IRA by April 15 following the
         year to which the deferrals relate.  These amounts may not be
         transferred or rolled over tax-free to another SEP-IRA.

         If you fail to withdraw excess elective deferrals, and any
         allocable income, by April 15, the excess elective  deferrals will
         be subject to the IRA contribution limitations of sections 219 and
         408 of the Code and thus may be considered an excess contribution
         to your IRA.  Such excess deferrals may be subject to a six percent
         excise tax for each year they remain in the SEP-IRA.

         Income on excess elective deferrals is includible in your gross
         income in the year you withdraw it from your IRA and must be
         withdrawn by April 15 following the calendar year to which the
         deferrals relate.  Income withdrawn from the IRA after that date
         may be subject to a ten percent tax on early distributions if you
         are not 59 1/2.

         If you have both excess elective deferrals and excess SEP
         contributions (as described below), the amount of excess elective
         deferrals that you withdraw by April 15 will reduce any excess SEP
         contributions that must be withdrawn for the corresponding plan
         year.


VIII.    Excess SEP Contributions -- How To Avoid Adverse Tax Consequences

         If you are a "highly compensated employee," your employer is
         responsible for notifying you if you have made any excess SEP
         contributions for a particular plan year.  This notification should
         tell you the amount of the excess SEP contributions, the calendar
         year in which you must include these contributions in income, and
         that the contributions may be subject to penalties if you do not
         withdraw them from your IRA within the applicable time period.

         Your employer should notify you of the excess SEP contributions
         within 2 1/2 months of the end of the plan year.  Generally you
         must include the excess SEP contributions in income for the
         calendar year in which the original deferrals were made.  This may
         require you to file an amended individual income tax return.
         However, an excess SEP contribution of less than $100 (not
         including earnings) is includible in the calendar year of
         notification.  Income on these excess contributions is includible
         in your gross income when you withdraw it from your IRA.

         You are responsible for withdrawing these excess SEP contributions
         (and earnings) from your IRA.  You may withdraw these amounts,
         without penalty, until April 15 following the calendar year in
         which you were notified by your employer of the excess SEP
         contributions.

         If you fail to withdraw the excess SEP contributions by April 15
         following the calendar year of notification, the excess SEP
         contributions will be subject to the IRA contribution limitations
         of sections 219 and 408 of the Code and thus may be considered an
         excess contribution to your IRA.  Thus, such excess SEP
         contributions may be subject to a six percent excise tax each year
         they remain in your IRA.

         If you do not withdraw the income on these excess SEP contributions
         by April 15 following the calendar year of notification by your
         employer, the income may be subject to a ten percent tax on early
         distributions if you are not 59 1/2 when you withdraw it.


IX.      Income Allocable to Excess Amounts

         The rules for determining and allocating income to excess elective
         deferrals, excess SEP contributions, and disallowed deferrals are
         the same as those governing regular IRA contributions.  The trustee
         or custodian of your SEP-IRA will inform you of the income
         allocable to excess amounts.


X.       Availability of IRA Contribution Deduction to SEP Participants

         In addition to any SEP amounts, you may contribute the lesser of
         $2,000 or 100% of compensation to an IRA.  However, the amount that
         you may deduct is subject to various limitations.  See Publication
         590, "Individual Retirement Arrangements," for more specific
         information.


XI.      SEP-IRA Amounts -- Rollover or Transfer to Another IRA

         You may not withdraw or transfer from your SEP-IRA any SEP
         contributions (or income on these contributions) attributable to
         elective deferrals made during the plan year until 2 1/2 months
         after the end of the plan year or, if sooner, when your employer
         notifies you that the deferral percentage limitation test
         (described above) has been completed for that year.  In general,
         any transfer or distribution made before this time will be
         includible in your gross income and may also be subject to a ten
         percent penalty tax for early withdrawal.  You may, however, remove
         excess elective deferrals from your SEP-IRA before this time, but
         you may not roll over or transfer these amounts to another IRA.

         After the restriction described in the preceding paragraph no
         longer applies, and with respect to contributions for a previous
         plan year, you may withdraw, or receive, funds from your SEP-IRA,
         and no more than 60 days later, place such funds in another IRA or
         SEP-IRA.  This is called a "rollover" and may not be done without
         penalty more frequently than at one-year intervals.  However, there
         are no restrictions on the number of times that you may make
         "transfers" if you arrange to have such funds transferred between
         the trustees so that you never have possession of the funds.

         You may not, however, roll over or transfer excess elective
         deferrals, excess SEP contributions, or disallowed deferrals from
         your SEP-IRA to another IRA.  These excess amounts may be reduced
         only by a distribution to you.


XII.     Filing Requirements

         You do not need to file any additional forms with the IRS because
         of participation in the SEP.


XIII.    Employer To Provide Information on SEP-IRAs and the SEP Agreement

         Your employer must provide you with a copy of the executed SEP
         agreement, this Notice to Employees, the form you should use to
         defer amounts to the SEP, the notice of excess SEP contributions or
         disallowed deferrals (if applicable) and a statement for each
         taxable year showing any contribution to your SEP-IRA.  Your
         employer must also notify you, if you are a highly compensated
         employee, when the deferral percentage limitation test ha been
         completed for a plan year.


XIV.     Financial Institution Where IRA Is Established To Provide
         Information

         The financial institution must provide you with a disclosure
         statement that contains the following items of information in plain
         nontechnical language:
         1.    The statutory requirements that relate to the IRA;
         2.    The tax consequences that follow the exercise of various options
               and what those options are;
         3.    Participation eligibility rules, and rules on the deductibility
               and nondeductibility of retirement savings;
         4.    The circumstances and procedures under which you may revoke the
               IRA, including the name, address, and telephone number of the
               person designated to receive notice of revocation (this
               explanation must be prominently displayed at the beginning of
               the disclosure statement);
         5.    Explanations of when penalties may be assessed against you
               because of specified prohibited or penalized activities
               concerning the IRA; and
         6.    Financial disclosure information which:
               (a)   Either projects value growth rates of the IRA under various
                     contribution and retirement schedules, or describes the
                     method of computing and allocating annual earnings and
                     charges which may be assessed;
               (b)   Describes whether, and for what period, the growth
                     projections for the plan are guaranteed, or a statement of
                     earnings rate and terms on which these projections are
                     based; and
               (c)   States the sales commission to be charged in each year
                     expressed as a percentage of $1,000.

                     See Publication 590, "Individual Retirement Arrangements,"
                     which is available at most IRS offices, for a more complete
                     explanation of the disclosure requirements.

         In addition to the disclosure statement, the financial institution
         is required to provide you with a financial statement each year.
         It may be necessary to retain and refer to statements for more than
         one year in order to evaluate the investment performance of your
         IRA and in order that you will know how to report IRA distributions
         for tax purposes.


                                Individual
                                Retirement
                                 Custodial
                                  Account
                                 Agreement
                    IRS Approval Serial Number D110849b

By signing the Application, you establish an Individual Retirement
Custodial Account sponsored by The Dreyfus Corporation ("we" or "us") and
The Dreyfus Trust Company (the "Custodian"), by countersigning the
Application, accepts the Custodianship upon the following conditions. You
intend this account ("Account") be administered and this Agreement be
interpreted to qualify at all times as an Individual Retirement Account
("IRA") under section 408 of the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended
(the "Code"). The Account is established for the exclusive benefit of you
and your designated beneficiary ("Beneficiary"), and solely for the
purpose stated in this Agreement. Your interest in the Account shall at
all times be nonforfeitable.

(1)  Contributions.
      (a)   Except for rollover contributions described in sections
            402(c), 403(a)(4), 403(b)(8), or 408(d)(3) of the Code, you
            may contribute for any tax year to the Account the lesser of
            $2,000 or 100% of your compensation. Rollover contributions
            may be in cash or in property acceptable to the Custodian. All
            other contributions must be in cash. Employer contributions to
            a SEP-IRA may not exceed the lesser of 15% of your
            compensation or $30,000. Contributions must be made no later
            than the due date for filing your income tax return (excluding
            extensions).
      (b)   Excess contributions shall be distributed to you upon receipt
            of a written request. If a distribution of an excess
            contribution is to be made on or before the due date of your
            tax return (including extensions), it shall include the net
            income attributable to such excess contribution. "Excess
            Contribution" means the excess of (i) the amount contributed
            for the tax year (other than a rollover contribution) over
            (ii) the amount allowable as a contribution.
      (c)   Contributions shall be in accordance with this Agreement, but
            the Custodian will have no obligation to verify the
            allowability or amount of contributions and may rely solely on
            your representations with respect thereto.

(2)  Distributions.
      (a)   If you are totally disabled or have reached age 59 1/2, you
            may make withdrawals from the Account. Withdrawals prior to
            such time will be subject to a penalty tax of 10% of the
            amount withdrawn which is includible in your gross income,
            over and above the regular income tax. A withdrawal from a
            time deposit before maturity may result in other penalties as
            required or permitted by law. In connection with making any
            distributions, the Custodian may rely solely on the accuracy
            of all facts you supply at any time, including a Beneficiary
            designation described in paragraph 2(e).
      (b)   "Total Disability" is the inability to engage in any
            substantial gainful activity by reason of any medically
            determinable physical or mental impairment which can be
            expected to result in death or to be of long, continued and
            indefinite duration, as certified to the Custodian by a
            physician.
      (c)   Distributions will begin when you provide the Custodian with
            written instructions, in a form acceptable to it, as to the
            method and reason (if it is to be made before reaching age 59
            1/2) for the distribution; but in all events, distribution of
            your entire interest shall be made or commence in cash or in
            kind (at your option), by April 1st following the year in
            which you reach age 70 1/2 (this is your required beginning
            date). For each succeeding year, a distribution must be made
            on or before December 31st. By your required beginning date,
            you may elect, in a form and at such time as may be acceptable
            to the Custodian, to have the balance in the Account
            distributed:
            (i)       in a single sum payment;
            (ii)      in equal or substantially equal monthly, quarterly or
                      annual payments over a specified period that may not be
                      longer than your life expectancy or the joint life and
                      last survivor expectancy of you and your Beneficiary; or
            (iii)     by the purchase and prompt distribution of an immediate
                      annuity policy from an insurance company that
                      provides for equal or substantially equal payments for
                      your life, or for the joint lives of you and your
                      Beneficiary.

                      You may also elect, in a form and at such time as may be
                      acceptable to the Custodian, to have only a part of the
                      balance in the Account distributed to you. If a
                      distribution option is not selected by the time
                      distribution must begin, distribution will be made under
                      option (ii) based on your life expectancy only, without
                      recalculation, and distribution will be made on an annual
                      basis. Even though distributions have commenced, you may
                      receive a distribution of the balance in the Account (or
                      any portion) at any time upon written notice to the
                      Custodian. The amount to be distributed each year,
                      beginning with the first calendar year for which
                      distributions are required and then for each succeeding
                      calendar year, shall not be less than the quotient
                      obtained by dividing your entire interest by the lesser
                      of (1) the applicable life expectancy or (2) if your
                      spouse is not your designated Beneficiary, the applicable
                      divisor determined from the table set forth in Q&A-4 or
                      Q&A-5, as applicable, of section 1.401(a) (9)-2 or the
                      Proposed Income Tax Regulations. Distributions after your
                      death shall be distributed using the applicable life
                      expectancy as the relevant divisor without regard to
                      proposed regulations section 1.401(a) (9)-2. Life
                      expectancy and joint life and last survivor expectancy
                      are computed by use of the return multiples contained in
                      section 1.72-9 of the Federal Income Tax Regulations.
                      Unless otherwise elected by you prior to the commencement
                      of distributions pursuant to this paragraph (2)(c), your
                      life expectancy and that of your spouse will not be
                      recalculated for purposes of this paragraph (2)(c). An
                      election to recalculate shall be irrevocable and shall
                      apply to all subsequent years. The life expectancy of a
                      non-spouse Beneficiary may not be recalculated. Instead,
                      life expectancy will be calculated using the attained age
                      of such Beneficiary during the calendar year in which the
                      individual attains age 70 1/2, and payments for
                      subsequent years shall be calculated based on such life
                      expectancy reduced by one for each calendar year which
                      has elapsed since the calendar year life expectancy was
                      first calculated.
      (d)   If your death occurs after your required beginning date, then,
            upon your death, te balance in the Account shall be
            distributed at least as rapidly as under the method of
            distribution before your death. After your death, the
            Beneficiary shall provide the Custodian with written
            instructions, in a form acceptable to the Custodian, regarding
            the method of distribution. If your death occurs before your
            required beginning date, your entire Account balance must be
            distributed as you have elected or, if you have not so
            elected, as elected by your Beneficiary, as follows: (i) by
            December 31st of the year containing the fifth anniversary of
            your death, or (ii) in equal or substantially equal payments
            over a period certain not to exceed your Beneficiary's life
            expectancy starting by December 31st of the year following the
            year of your death. If the Beneficiary is your surviving
            spouse, however, distribution may be made over a period
            certain not to exceed the life expectancy of your surviving
            spouse and need not commence until December 31st of the year
            in which you would have reached age 70 1/2 had you lived.
            After your death, if your surviving spouse dies before
            distributions begin, the five-year rule shall be applied as if
            the surviving spouse were you. A surviving spouse Beneficiary
            has the right to elect to treat the IRA as his or her own,
            subject to the normal IRA distribution rules. This election
            will be deemed to have been made if such surviving spouse
            makes a regular IRA contribution to the Account, makes a
            rollover to or from such Account, or fails to elect one of the
            options set forth in this paragraph (2)(d). Only a surviving
            spouse Beneficiary may make additional cash or rollover
            contributions to the Account. For purposes of the above,
            payments will be calculated by use of the tables described in
            paragraph 2)(c) above. Unless otherwise elected by a surviving
            spouse Beneficiary when you die before your required beginning
            date, the life expectancy of your surviving spouse Beneficiary
            will not be recalculated for purposes of this paragraph
            (2)(d). An election to recalculate shall be irrevocable and
            shall apply to all subsequent years. In the case of any other
            designated Beneficiary, life expectancies shall be calculated
            using the attained age of such Beneficiary during the calendar
            year in which distributions are required to begin pursuant to
            this section, and payments for any subsequent calendar year
            shall be calculated based on such life expectancy reduced by
            one for each calendar year which has elapsed since the
            calendar year life expectancy was first calculated.
            Distributions under this section are considered to have begun
            if the distributions are made on account of your reaching your
            required beginning date. If you receive distributions prior to
            the required beginning date and die, distributions will not be
            considered to have begun.
      (e)   You may designate or change a Beneficiary who is to receive
            your Account. To be effective, such designation or change must
            be in writing and must be received by the Custodian prior to
            your death. Absent such designation, any undistributed
            interest of yours shall be paid to the legal representative of
            your estate.
      (f)   You may satisfy the minimum distribution requirements under
            sections 408(a)(6) and 408(b)(3) of the Code by receiving a
            distribution from one IRA (such as this IRA or another IRA)
            that is equal to the amount required to satisfy the minimum
            distribution requirements for two or more IRAs. For this
            purpose, the owner of two or more IRAs may use the
            "alternative method" described in Notice 88-38, 1988-1 C.B.
            524, to satisfy the minimum distribution requirements
            described above.
      (g)   Notwithstanding any provisions of this Agreement to the
            contrary, the distribution of your interest shall be made in
            accordance with the minimum distribution requirements of
            section 408(a)(6) or section 408(b)(3) of the Code and the
            regulations thereunder, including the incidental death benefit
            provisions of section 1.401(a)(9)-2 of the proposed
            regulations, all of which are herein incorporated by
            reference.

(3)  Investments. Contributions to your Account shall be applied to the
          investments described below ("Investments") which you select. No
          part of the Account shall be invested in life insurance contracts,
          or in collectibles as defined in section 408(m) of the Code, nor
          may the assets of the Account be commingled with other property
          except in a common trust fund or common investment fund (within the
          meaning of section 408(a)(5) of the Code).
      (a) Shares of ownership in an investment company registered under
          the Investment Company Act of 1940, as amended, which are
          managed, advised, sub-advised or administered by us or any of
          our affiliates, or shares in any other investment company as
          may from time to time be offered by us, which the Custodian
          has agreed with us in writing to hold in the Account ("Fund
          Shares").
      (b) Other investments as allowed by law, offered by us and which
          the Custodian has agreed with us in writing to hold in the
          Account.
      (c) All dividends and capital gains distributions received on the
          Fund Shares (whether or not there is an election to receive
          them in other property) shall be reinvested in accordance with
          the respective Fund's current Prospectus in such Shares and
          credited to such Account. The Custodian shall furnish you with
          statements of the Account at least once a calendar year which
          shall be deemed to be the sole accounting by the Custodian
          necessary under this Agreement. If within one hundred and
          eighty (180) days of the mailing of such accounting you do not
          deliver a written objection or exception to any specific item
          set forth therein, such accounting shall be deemed to be
          settled and approved and the Custodian shall be released and
          discharged with respect to all matters set forth therein. The
          Custodian, upon receipt of your written instructions or those
          of your duly authorized investment advisor, may exchange Fund
          Shares for any other Fund Shares or Investments subject to and
          in accordance with the terms and conditions of the exchange
          privilege, including the telephone exchange privilege, as
          outlined in the current Fund Prospectuses. The ability to
          exchange Fund Shares for other Fund Shares or Investments
          shall be subject to the prior written agreement of the
          Custodian and us. A telephone exchange may not be made from an
          Investment in a time deposit account unless we have otherwise
          agreed in writing with the Custodian. If you elect the
          telephone exchange privilege in the Application or authorize
          an investment advisor to make exchanges, the Custodian shall
          be entitled to rely and act upon telephonic instructions,
          deemed by it to be in proper form and reasonably believed by
          it to be genuine, directing the exchange of Investments for
          other Investments allowed to be exchanged, provided that such
          Investments are available for sale in your state of residence,
          and shall not be liable for any liability, cost or expense
          arising out of any telephonic exchange request effected
          pursuant to such telephonic instructions. The Custodian will
          employ reasonable procedures, such as requiring a form of
          personal identification, to confirm that telephonic
          instructions are genuine and, if it does not follow such
          procedures, it may be liable for any losses due to
          unauthorized or fraudulent instructions. All Investments
          acquired on your behalf by the Custodian shall be registered
          in the name of the Custodian or its nominee, but you shall be
          the beneficial owner of such investments. You will be solely
          responsible for the consequences of any exchange including any
          penalty for an early withdrawal from a time deposit
          investment, if applicable. It is understood and agreed that
          the telephone exchange privilege is subject to the limitations
          specified above. You authorize and direct the Custodian to
          respond to any telephonic inquiries relating to the status of
          Investments in the Account. You agree that the certifications,
          authorizations, directions and restrictions contained herein
          will continue until the Custodian receives written notice of
          any change or revocation. You understand that the Custodian
          reserves the right to refuse any telephonic instructions.

(4)  Expenses and Other Charges. Except for any excise taxes that may be
          required by the Code to be paid by you, any income taxes or other
          taxes of any kind whatsoever that may be levied or assessed upon or
          in respect of the Account, including any penalty for the early
          withdrawal from a time deposit investment, any transfer taxes
          incurred in connection with the investment and reinvestment of the
          assets of the Account, all other administrative expenses incurred
          by the Custodian in the performance of its duties, such
          compensation to the Custodian as set forth in the fee schedule as
          from time to time amended by the Custodian in writing, and, to the
          extent directed by you in writing, the fees of an investment
          advisor authorized to direct the investment of the Account, shall
          be paid from the Account assets.

(5)  Custodian - Removal, Resignation.
          (a)   You shall at any time have the right to remove the Custodian
                on thirty days' notice in writing in a form acceptable to it,
                designating a successor custodian. Removal of the Custodian
                shall be effective upon receipt by it of written acceptance by
                the successor custodian of its appointment. The Custodian
                shall forthwith transfer and pay over to such successor the
                assets of the Account and all records pertaining thereto. The
                Custodian may reserve such assets as may be required for the
                payment of all its fees, compensation, costs and expenses, and
                for the payment of all liabilities of or against the assets of
                the Account or of the Custodian, and where necessary may
                liquidate such reserved assets. Any balance of such reserve
                remaining after the payment of all such fees, compensation,
                costs, expenses and liabilities shall be paid over to the
                successor custodian. Any successor custodian must be a bank as
                defined in section 408(n) of the Code, or any person who
                demonstrates to the satisfaction of the Secretary of the
                Department of the Treasury that the manner in which it will
                administer the Account will be consistent with the
                requirements of section 408 of the Code.
          (b)   The Custodian shall, at any time, have the right to resign as
                Custodian under this Agreement by delivering a written
                resignation notice to you and us. Upon receipt of such notice
                of resignation, we shall forthwith appoint a successor
                custodian and upon receipt by the Custodian of written
                acceptance by the successor custodian of such appointment, the
                Custodian is authorized to act in the same manner as provided
                in paragraph 5(a). If we fail to appoint a successor custodian
                within 90 days of receiving the Custodian's resignation, the
                Custodian may distribute to you the assets of the Account,
                reserving such Fund Shares as may be required for the payment
                of all the Custodian's fees, compensation, costs and expenses
                and for the payment of all liabilities of or against the
                assets of the Account or the Custodian, so that the Custodian
                may, where necessary, liquidate such shares with any balance
                remaining after payment of all such fees, compensation, costs,
                expenses and liabilities to be paid to you. Upon completion of
                such distribution, the Custodian shall be relieved of any
                liability with respect to the Account assets.

(6)  Duties and Liabilities of Custodian. The Custodian shall deliver to
          you all notices, prospectuses, financial statements, proxies, and
          proxy soliciting materials relating to the Fund Shares held by it,
          and shall not vote any of the Fund Shares held except in accordance
          with your written instructions. The Custodian shall keep accurate
          and detailed accounts of all contributions, receipts, investments,
          distributions, disbursements and all other transactions, and shall
          prepare and file any returns required to be filed by it as
          Custodian of an Individual Retirement Account under the Code. The
          Custodian shall be under no duties whatsoever except such duties as
          are specifically set forth as such in this Custodial Agreement, and
          no implied covenant or obligation shall be read into the Custodial
          Agreement against the Custodian. In the performance of its duties,
          the Custodian shall be liable only for its own gross negligence or
          willful misconduct. In performing its duties under this Agreement,
          the Custodian may hire agents, experts and attorneys and delegate
          discretionary powers to, and rely upon, information and advice
          furnished by such agents, experts and attorneys. You shall have the
          sole authority and responsibility for the enforcement or defense of
          the terms and conditions of the Custodial Agreement against or on
          behalf of any person or persons claiming any interest in the
          Account. The Custodian shall not be required to prosecute, defend
          or respond to any action or any judicial proceeding relating to the
          Account unless it has previously received indemnification
          satisfactory to it in form and in substance. The Custodian shall be
          liable only for its gross negligence or willful misconduct in
          failing to perform the terms of this Agreement and shall not be
          liable for any action or failure to act when such action or failure
          to act is in accordance with your written authorization or
          instructions or is due to the absence of written instructions. The
          Custodian shall not be required to give bond or security for the
          performance of its duties. You shall at all times fully indemnify
          and save harmless the Custodian from any liability, cost, or
          expense which may arise in connection with this Agreement, except
          any liability, cost, or expenses arising from the gross negligence
          or willful misconduct of the Custodian.

(7)  Amendments. The Custodian reserves the right to amend all or any part
          of the terms of this Custodial Agreement, upon written notice to
          you, in any manner which would not disqualify the Custodial
          Agreement from complying with section 408 of the Code. You agree
          that the Custodian may amend its fee schedule from time to time on
          written notice. In addition, you and the Custodian delegate to us
          the power to amend all or any part of the terms of this Agreement,
          including the removal of the Custodian and the appointment of a
          successor custodian. Such amendment must be submitted to you and to
          the Custodian and shall be effective at such time provided that: a)
          we shall not have power to amend or terminate this Custodial
          Account in such manner as would cause or permit any part of the
          assets in the Custodial Account to be diverted to purposes other
          than for the exclusive benefit of you or your Beneficiaries, (b) we
          shall not have the right to modify or amend the Account
          retroactively in such manner as to deprive you, or your
          Beneficiary, of any benefit to which you were entitled unless such
          modification or amendment is necessary to conform this Agreement
          to, or satisfy the conditions of, any law, governmental regulation
          or ruling, and to permit this Agreement to meet the requirements of
          section 408 of the Code, or any similar statute enacted in lieu
          thereof and (c) no such amendment which increases the Custodian's
          duties or responsibilities or affects its fees shall become
          effective unless the Custodian has consented to such amendment in
          writing. You shall be deemed to have consented to any such
          amendment.


(8)  Termination. Upon termination of the Account, any and all assets
             remaining in the Account together with any earnings shall be
             distributed to you in cash or kind in one or more ways provided by
             paragraph 2(c), as directed by you (or in the absence of such
             direction, in a lump sum). Upon the completion of such
             distribution, the Custodian shall be relieved from all further
             liability with respect to all amounts so paid.

(9)  Miscellaneous.
        (a)  The Custodian may rely on your or your Beneficiary's
             representations on matters relating to this Agreement and shall
             be under no duty to make any further investigations.
        (b)  Neither the establishment of the Account nor the creation of any
             fund or account, nor the payment of any benefits, shall be
             construed as giving you or any other person any legal or
             equitable right against he Custodian except as herein provided.
        (c)  It is a condition of this Custodial Agreement, and you expressly
             agree, that you shall look solely to the assets of the Account
             for the payment of any benefit to which you are entitled under
             this Agreement.
        (d)  This Custodial Agreement shall be construed, administered and
             enforced according to the laws of the State of New York.

(10)         Inalienability of Benefits. The benefits provided hereunder shall
             not be subject to alienation, assignment, garnishment, attachment,
             execution or levy of any kind, and any attempt to cause such
             benefits to be so subjected shall not be recognized except to such
             extent as may be required by law.





IRA Disclosure Statement
This Disclosure Statement explains the rules governing your Individual
Retirement Account ("IRA").

Your Right to Cancel. If you have received this Disclosure Statement
within seven days of opening your IRA, you have seven days to cancel and
get back the full amount paid for your IRA by mailing or delivering a
written request to cancel no later than the seventh day after opening to:
                      The Dreyfus Trust Company
                            P.O. Box 6427
                        Providence, RI 02940
                      Attn.: IRA Administrator
After seven days following receipt of this Disclosure Statement, you
cannot cancel. The Disclosure Statement is deemed to be received as of the
date of your check or transfer instructions. The notice will be considered
mailed on the date of the postmark (or, if sent by certified or registered
mail, the date of certification or registration) if properly addressed and
mailed in the U.S., first class postage prepaid.

Contributions. You can contribute in any tax year before the year in which
you reach age 70 1/2 up to the lesser of $2,000 in cash (except for
rollovers) or 100% of your compensation. Contributions made for a taxable
year must be made no later than the due date for filing your Federal
income tax return (not including extensions). Compensation includes
amounts received as payment for personal services and alimony or separate
maintenance payments, but not interest, dividends, other earnings from
property or other amounts not included in your gross income. The funds in
your IRA are always yours; they are not subject to forfeiture other than
penalties required or permitted by law. IRA earnings generally are not
taxable until distribution begins.
- -   Deductible Contributions. Contributions made for the tax year are fully
    deductible if neither you nor your spouse (if married) is an active
    participant in a pension, profit sharing or stock bonus plan under
    section 401(a) of the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended (the
    "Code"), an annuity plan under section 403(a) of the Code, an annuity
    contract or plan under section 403(b) of the Code, a simplified employee
    pension plan under section 408(k) of the Code ("SEP-IRA"), or a trust
    under section 401(c)(18) of the Code. Active participant status can be
    determined if you refer to your or your spouse's year-end "Wage and Tax
    Statement," IRS Form W-2.

    If considered an active participant, the deduction for your IRA
    contribution is reduced if (a) you are single and your adjusted gross
    income ("AGI") exceeds the threshold level of $25,000, (b) you are
    married filing a joint return and your and your spouse's AGI exceeds he
    threshold level of $40,000, or (c) you are married filing a separate
    return and your AGI exceeds the threshold level of $0. The deductible
    amount of your IRA contribution is reduced by an amount that bears the
    same ratio to the regular limit as your AGI, in excess of the threshold
    level, bears to $10,000. When AGI levels reach $35,000 (if single),
    $50,000 (if married filing joint return), and $10,000 (if married filing
    separate return), no deduction is allowed.
    Until the deductible amount equals zero, as determined above, the amount
    you can contribute and deduct will not be lower than $200.
- -   Nondeductible Contributions. You may make nondeductible IRA
    contributions not to exceed the lesser of $2,000 ($2,250 for Spousal
    IRA) or 100% of your compensation, minus the amount of any allowable
    deductible contribution. Earnings on nondeductible contributions
    generally are tax deferred until distributed to you.

    You must indicate on your tax return the extent to which your IRA
    contributions are nondeductible. If you overstate the amount of your
    nondeductible contributions, a penalty of $100 will be assessed unless
    it was due to reasonable cause.

Spousal IRAs. If you file a joint return and have not reached age 70 1/2,
you can set up two accounts - one IRA for yourself and one for your spouse
("Spousal IRA"). You can contribute in the aggregate up to the lesser of
100% of your compensation or $2,250 to the accounts, but no more than
$2,000 to either one. You can still contribute to your IRA even if your
spouse has reached age 70 1/2, provided you have not reached age 70 1/2
during the tax year.

Simplified Employee Pension (SEP)-IRA. Your employer can make
contributions to a SEP-IRA on your behalf in an amount not to exceed the
lesser of 15% of your compensation or $30,000. Contributions must be made
under a written allocation formula which cannot discriminate in favor of
key or highly compensated employees. Contributions are considered
discriminatory unless they bear a uniform relationship to the first
$200,000 of each participating employee's total compensation. If your
employer does not maintain an integrated plan (i.e., a plan integrated
with Social Security benefits) at any time during the taxable year, Old
Age and Survivor Disability Insurance ("OASDI") contributions may be taken
into account as contributions to your SEP-IRA, but only if such OASDI
contributions are taken into account for each employee maintaining a
SEP-IRA. If the SEP-IRA is part of a top-heavy plan as defined in the
Code, your employer must make a minimum contribution required to each
non-key employee's SEP-IRA for each year that the plan is top-heavy.
Generally, a plan is top-heavy if the sum of the accounts of key employees
as defined in Code section 416 exceeds 60% of the sum of the accounts of
all employees. If your employer maintains more than one plan, such plans
may, or under certain circumstances must, be combined to determine whether
the SEP-IRA is top-heavy. Generally, the minimum contribution required to
be made to the SEP-IRA of each non-key employee in a top-heavy year is 3%
of that employee's compensation. Your employer must cover each employee
who has attained age 21 and has performed service during at least 3 of the
immediately preceding 5 calendar years. Employees who earn less than $300
a year, employees covered by certain collective bargaining agreements and
certain nonresident aliens may be excluded from the plan. "Leased
employees" as defined in Code section 414(n) must be treated as regular
employees for the purposes of making SEP-IRA contributions, unless the
leasing organization provides prescribed minimum pension benefits to the
leased employees. Any SEP-IRA contribution made by the leasing
organization attributable to services performed for your employer may be
used to reduce your employer's contribution to a leased employee's
SEP-IRA. Contributions made by your employer to your SEP-IRA for a taxable
year are excludable from your gross income and deductible by your
employer. In addition, you may contribute on your own behalf an amount up
to the lesser of 100% of your compensation or $2,000; however, the amount
you can deduct is dependent on your AGI level (see "Contributions -
Deductible Contributions" above). Except as provided above, your SEP-IRA
generally is subject to the rules governing a Regular IRA. Your rights to
withdraw amounts held in a SEP-IRA cannot be restricted by your employer.

If your employer has 25 employees or less, your employer may choose to
accept "elective" tax-deferred contributions not to exceed $7,000 (as
adjusted for cost of living increases) through a salary reduction
arrangement. For such an arrangement, at least 50% of all employees must
elect to contribute to the SEP-IRA, and a certain deferral percentage is
applied to highly compensated employees.

Penalty for Excess Contributions. Excess contributions are nondeductible
and are subject to an annual nondeductible excise tax of 6% of the excess
for each year the excess is not withdrawn or eliminated. The tax is paid
by the person for whose benefit the IRA was opened. If no deduction is
taken for the excess contribution and the excess plus the net earnings on
the excess are withdrawn on or before the due date (including extensions)
for filing the Federal tax return for the contribution year, the 6% excise
tax will not apply; but the earnings on the excess will be includible in
your gross income and the 10% tax on premature distributions will be
applied to such earnings, unless you are age 59 1/2 or disabled. If the
excess contribution is withdrawn after such time, the excess will be
subject to the 6% excise tax and will be includible in your gross income
and subject to the 10% tax on premature distributions (if applicable).
However, if an IRA contribution for a year does not exceed $2,250
(excluding rollover amounts), an excess contribution which was not claimed
as a deduction may be withdrawn (without the net income attributable
thereto) at any time without incurring the 10% tax on premature
distributions or including it in income. The 6% excise tax will be imposed
each year until the excess is withdrawn or eliminated. Instead of
withdrawing the excess contribution, it may be eliminated by making
reduced contributions in later years. The 6% excise tax will apply until
the excess is eliminated in a later year in which the maximum contribution
has not been made. You may withdraw tax-free and without penalty any
excess rollover contribution if it occurred because you reasonably relied
on erroneous information required to be supplied by the entity making the
distribution that was rolled over. If your IRA is invested in a time
deposit, a withdrawal (including a withdrawal of any excess contributions)
may be subject to early withdrawal penalties in addition to tax penalties.


The rules discussed above generally apply to SEP-IRAs as well.

Rollovers (Direct and Regular). All or a portion of certain distributions
from your or your deceased spouse's qualified retirement plan, annuity or
another IRA may be eligible to be rolled over into a tax-deferred IRA.
Distributions from another IRA may be rolled over within 60 days after
receipt. If a distribution from your or your deceased spouse's qualified
retirement plan or 403(b) annuity is eligible for rollover treatment, you
must arrange to have the trustee or custodian of such plan directly
transfer the distribution to the trustee or custodian of your Rollover IRA
if you wish to avoid 20% Federal income tax withholding on the
distribution. This is known as a "direct rollover." If you receive a
distribution that is eligible for rollover (and thus have 20% of your
distribution withheld), you may still effect a rollover into a
tax-deferred IRA within 60 days after receipt of the distribution. This is
known as a "regular rollover." If you plan on rolling over the proceeds of
a distribution from a qualified plan or 403(b) annuity, you generally will
be better off effecting a direct rollover so as to avoid mandatory 20%
withholding on your distribution. When you receive a distribution from
your or your deceased spouse's qualified retirement plan or 403(b)
annuity, you should receive a detailed tax notice describing the various
rules applicable to your distribution, including your rollover options.
Rollover contributions to your IRA are not deductible. Accumulated
voluntary deductible contributions to a qualified retirement plan or
governmental plan may be eligible for rollover treatment when distributed.
Rollovers from an employer's qualified plan to your Rollover IRA may later
be rolled over to another qualified retirement plan only if funds from
other sources were not contributed to such IRA and no part is attributable
to contributions made for you as a self-employed individual to a
self-employed (HR-10 or Keogh) retirement plan. A rollover distribution
from an IRA may be made only once in any twelve month period. There is no
limit on direct transfers of IRA assets from one IRA custodian or trustee
to another.

Inherited IRAs. An inherited IRA is an IRA which is acquired by a
Beneficiary who is not your spouse on your death. Such a Beneficiary
cannot make cash or rollover contributions to that IRA or treat it as his
or her own.

Withdrawal Restrictions. A taxable distribution before age 59 1/2 will be
included in your gross income and will be subject to a nondeductible 10%
tax penalty, any early withdrawal penalties on time deposits and other
penalties required or permitted by law. There is no 10% tax penalty for
distributions made because of death, permanent disability, rollovers or
timely removal of an excess contribution or for distributions made in the
form of substantially equal periodic payments over your life expectancy
(or the joint life expectancies of you and your Beneficiary).

Prohibited Transactions. If you engage in a "prohibited transaction," as
defined in section 4975 of the Code, the IRA loses its tax exemption and
the total value of your IRA must be included in your gross income. If you
pledge any portion of your IRA as security for a loan, the amount pledged
must be included in your gross income. Prior to disability or age 59 1/2,
the additional 10% penalty tax on premature distributions will be imposed
on amounts included in your gross income by reason of a prohibited
transaction. The same rules apply to a spouse's use of his or her Spousal
IRA.

Distributions During Your Life. No tax penalty is imposed on distributions
from your IRA after you reach age 59 1/2 or become permanently disabled.
Distributions must begin no later than the first day of April following
the calendar year in which you reach age 70 1/2. Generally, you are
permitted to receive your IRA in a lump sum or installments over a period
not extending beyond your life expectancy or the joint life and last
survivor expectancy of you and your Beneficiary. You may also request a
distribution of any part of your IRA balance. Life expectancies are
determined in accordance with the IRS tables. Unless otherwise elected by
you prior to the required commencement of your distributions, your life
expectancy and that of your spouse will not be recalculated annually. An
election by you to recalculate shall be irrevocable and shall apply to all
subsequent years. The life expectancy of a nonspousal Beneficiary cannot
be recalculated. All distributions are taxed at ordinary income tax rates
and are not eligible for capital gains treatment or five-year averaging.
If you direct distributions to be made over your life or the joint lives
of you and your designated Beneficiary, the Custodian will purchase with
your IRA an immediate annuity contract from an insurance company you
choose and your payments will be made under the annuity.

You must provide a completed annuity application from the insurance
company of your choosing.
When requesting a distribution, you must specify the reason for the
distribution. Examples are: premature distributions (i.e., distributions
before age 59 1/2), rollovers, disability, death, normal (at or after age
59 1/2), excess contribution returns and other.

Distributions On and After Your Death. If you die after you are required
to begin receiving distributions, your designated Beneficiary must receive
the balance of your IRA at least as rapidly as under your method of
distribution. If you die before you are required to begin receiving
distributions, distribution must be made to your Beneficiary in one of the
following ways:
    (i)      by December 31st of the year containing the fifth anniversary of
             your death (if a distribution option is not selected, this option
             will apply);
    (ii)     in equal or substantially equal installments over a set period
             not extending beyond your Beneficiary's life expectancy,
             beginning no later than December 31st of the year following the
             year of your death;
    (iii)    in the case of a spousal Beneficiary who so elects within the
             five-year period following your death, installment payments over
             a set period not extending beyond your spousal Beneficiary's life
             expectancy commencing at any date prior to December 31st of the
             year in which you would have reached age 70 1/2; or
    (iv)     unless you direct the Custodian otherwise in writing, and if your
             spouse is your Beneficiary, then notwithstanding the foregoing,
             he or she may elect to treat the account as his or her own IRA,
             in which case the normal IRA distribution rules will apply.

Election (iv) is considered to have been made if your spouse makes a
regular IRA contribution to this IRA, makes a rollover to or from this IRA
or fails to elect any of the above distribution provisions. Payments will
be calculated by the use of the IRS tables. Unless otherwise elected by
your surviving spouse Beneficiary when you die before you are required to
begin receiving distributions, the life expectancy of your surviving
spouse Beneficiary will not be recalculated. An election to recalculate
shall be irrevocable and shall apply to all subsequent years. The life
expectancy of a nonspousal Beneficiary cannot be recalculated. You may
designate a change of Beneficiary on a form provided by the Sponsor or the
Custodian. The change will not be effective unless the Custodian receives
a properly completed form prior to your death. If after your death your
designated Beneficiary is receiving (or entitled to receive) payments over
a set period, he or she may designate a Beneficiary to receive the balance
of the IRA (if any) on his or her death in accordance with the above
rules. A written authorization filed with the Custodian (which can be on
your Beneficiary designation form) permits a designated Beneficiary
receiving installment payments, from time to time, to choose to increase
the frequency or amount of payments and/or withdraw all or any portion of
the IRA.

Distribution After Age 70 1/2. Minimum Distribution Requirements. If the
amount distributed to you for any tax year after you reach age 70 1/2 is
less than the minimum amount required by law, the IRS may impose a penalty
tax equal to 50% of any such deficiency unless it is satisfied that
reasonable steps are being taken to remedy the deficiency. The amount
required to be distributed in any year is generally based on your life
expectancy or the joint life expectancies of you and your designated
Beneficiary. However, if your Beneficiary is not your spouse, the law
imposes an additional requirement which is called the minimum distribution
incidental benefit requirement. In general, this requirement is designed
to prevent you from naming a Beneficiary who is much younger than yourself
in order to extend your payout period. You may wish to consult your tax
advisor to determine your minimum distribution. These rules on
distribution apply equally to Spousal IRAs.
        Distribution of Nondeductible Contributions. Withdrawals which include
        nondeductible contributions will be treated as part taxable and part
        nontaxable. The amount considered nontaxable is the portion which
        bears the same ratio to the total distribution that your aggregate
        nondeductible contributions bear to your Account balance at the end of
        the year for all of your IRAs, plus adding back any distributions for
        the year. The 10% tax penalty on distributions prior to age 59 1/2
        will apply for the taxable portion of the distribution.
        Penalty for Excess Distributions. A 15% tax penalty is imposed on the
        sum of all annual distributions received during the calendar year in
        excess of $150,000 (or $112,500 adjusted for cost of living increases,
        if higher). Please consult with your tax advisor for more complete
        information, including the availability of favorable elections. The
        excess distribution penalty tax will not apply to a distribution of
        nondeductible contributions, or a distribution to an alternate payee
        under a qualified domestic relations order.

Estate and Gift Tax Exemption. Generally, your IRA will be included in
your estate for Federal estate tax purposes. Your IRA may qualify for a
deduction for purposes of that tax if the Beneficiary is your spouse.
Designation of a Beneficiary to receive your IRA on your death is not
treated as a gift subject to the Federal gift tax.

Fees and Charges; Commissions. The Custodian of your IRA will charge
against your Account an annual maintenance fee for each mutual fund
account, bank deposit account and other investment in your IRA. The
Custodian may also charge against your Account any taxes assessed on it,
administrative expenses incurred by it (including, without limitation,
attorneys' fees), and penalties required or permitted by law (including
penalties for early withdrawals of time deposits). The Custodian may
liquidate assets held in your IRA and apply the proceeds to pay such fees
and expenses. In lieu of charging such fees and expenses against your
Account, the Custodian may, in its sole discretion, allow you to pay such
fees and expenses directly by separate check. To the extent directed by
you in writing, the Custodian of your IRA will also charge against your
Account the fees of an investment advisor authorized to direct the
investment of your Account. The Custodian will liquidate assets held in
your IRA and apply the proceeds to pay such advisory fees in accordance
with your written instructions. The payment of advisory fees out of your
Account will not be reported to the IRS as a taxable distribution provided
that you certify to the Custodian that your IRA is solely liable for the
payment of such fees. The Custodian's current fee schedule is set forth in
the Application and may be amended from time to time upon written notice
to you. In the case of a mutual fund that charges a sales commission on
the purchase of shares, a sales commission will also be charged against
each investment in such mutual fund as described in the mutual fund's
prospectus.

Federal Income Tax Withholding and Filing Requirements. Distributions from
your IRA are subject to Federal income tax withholding unless you (or your
Beneficiary) elect not to have withholding apply. The current withholding
rate set by law is 10%. When you want to receive a distribution from your
IRA, contact the Custodian which will supply you with additional
information and election forms. Form 5329 must be filed with the IRS for
each tax year you owe tax penalties, such as taxes on excess contribution,
early distribution or underdistributions over age 70 1/2.

Form Approved by IRS. A form of your Dreyfus IRA has been approved by the
IRS.

Questions About Your IRA. You can obtain further information about IRAs
from any IRS district office or from Dreyfus Service Corporation.

Investment and Holding of Contributions. Contributions to your IRA and any
earnings on such contributions are invested in shares of mutual funds
managed by The Dreyfus Corporation and such other investments as may be
authorized from time to time by The Dreyfus Corporation and approved by
the Custodian. Your IRA assets are held in a Custodial Account exclusively
for your benefit and the benefit of such Beneficiaries as you may
designate in writing delivered to the Custodian. Your right to the entire
balance in your IRA is nonforfeitable. No part of your IRA assets may be
invested in life insurance contracts or in collectibles such as works of
art, antiques or stamps; however, investments in gold and silver coins
issued by the United States are permitted, if permitted as investments by
the Custodian.

Financial Information. The growth in the value of mutual fund investments
held in your IRA can neither be guaranteed nor projected.


Table of Contents
<TABLE>
<CAPTION>
<S>  <C>                                         <S>                                      <C>
Article I:  Definitions                          Article III: Contributions
1.1  Actual Deferral Percentage ......... 1      3.1  Limit on Employer Contributions ..... 3
1.2  Adoption Agreement ................. 1      3.2  402(h) Limit ........................ 3
1.3  Average Actual Deferral Percentage . 1      3.3  Employer Discretionary Contributions. 3
1.4  Code ............................... 1      3.4  Elective Deferrals .................. 4
1.5  Committee .......................... 1
1.6  Compensation ....................... 1      Article IV: Participants' Rights to Benefits
1.7  Earned Income ...................... 1      4.1  Nonforfeitability ................... 5
1.8  Elective Deferrals ................. 1      4.2  Withdrawals and Distributions ....... 5
1.9  Eligible Employee .................. 1      4.3  Death ............................... 5
1.10 Employee ........................... 1
1.11 Employer ........................... 2      Article V: Top-Heavy Provision
1.12 Family Member ...................... 2      5.1  Definitions ......................... 5
1.13 Highly Compensated Employee ........ 2      5.2  Top-Heavy Determination ............. 7
1.14 IRA or SEP-IRA ..................... 2      5.3  Minimum Allocation .................. 7
1.15 Integration Level .................. 2
1.16 Net Profits ........................ 2      Article VI: Plan Administration
1.17 Non-Highly Compensated Employee .... 2      6.1  Appointment of Committee ............ 8
1.18 Participant ........................ 2      6.2  Claims Procedure .................... 8
1.19 Plan ............................... 2      6.3  Records and Reports ................. 8
1.20 Plan Year .......................... 2      6.4  Powers and Duties ................... 8
1.21 SEP ................................ 2      6.5  Committee Action .................... 8
1.22 Sponsor ............................ 3      6.6  Reliance on Professional Advice ..... 8
1.23 Taxable Wage Base .................. 3      6.7  Participant Information ............. 8
                                                 6.8  Standard of Care .................... 9

Article II:  Participation                       Article VII: Miscellaneous Provisions
2.1  Commencement of Participation ...... 3      7.1  No Right of Continued Employment .... 9
                                                 7.2  Amendments .......................... 9
                                                 7.3  Termination ......................... 9
                                                 7.4  Governing Law ....................... 9
</TABLE>


Article I:  Definitions
1.1    "Actual Deferral Percentage" shall mean the ratio (expressed as a
       percentage) of Elective Deferrals (including excess elective
       deferrals) contributed on behalf of an Eligible Employee for the Plan
       Year to the Eligible Employee's Compensation for the Plan Year.  The
       Actual Deferral Percentage of an Eligible Employee who does not make
       an Elective Deferral is zero.
1.2    "Adoption Agreement" shall mean the document executed by the adopting
       Employer which contains all the options which may be selected and
       which incorporates this basic plan document by reference.
1.3    "Average Actual Deferral Percentage" shall mean the average
       (expressed as a percentage) of the Actual Deferral Percentages of the
       Eligible Employees in a group.
1.4    "Code" shall mean the Internal Revenue Code of 1986, as amended.
1.5    "Committee" shall mean the person or persons appointed by the
       Employer to administer the Plan in accordance with Section 6.1.  If
       no such Committee is appointed by the Employer, the Employer shall
       act as the Committee.
1.6    "Compensation" shall mean, unless otherwise specified in the Adoption
       Agreement, in the case of an Employee other than a Self-Employed
       Individual, his or her section 3401(a) wages, which are actually paid
       during the applicable period.  In the case of a Self-Employed
       Individual, Compensation shall mean his or her Earned Income.  Unless
       otherwise specified in the Adoption Agreement, the applicable period
       shall be the Plan Year.  If elected by the Employer in the Adoption
       Agreement, Compensation shall also include Employer contributions
       made pursuant to a salary reduction agreement with an Employee which
       are not currently includible in the gross income of the Employee by
       reason of the application of sections 125, 402(e)(3), 402(h)(1)(B) or
       403(b) of the Code.  Compensation shall not include amounts in excess
       of $150,000, as adjusted by the Secretary of the Treasury at the same
       time and in the same manner as under section 415(d) of the Code.  In
       determining Compensation for purposes of the adjusted $150,000
       limitation, the family member rules of section 414(q)(6) of the Code
       shall apply except that in applying such rules, the term "family"
       shall include only the Employee's spouse and any lineal descendants
       who have not attained age 19 before the close of the Plan Year.  If,
       as a result of the application of such family member rules, the
       adjusted $150,000 limitation is exceeded, then (except for purposes
       of determining the portion of Compensation up to the Integration
       Level if this Plan is integrated with Social Security), the adjusted
       $150,000 limitation shall be prorated among the affected individuals
       in proportion to each such individual's Compensation as determined
       under this Section prior to the application of the adjusted $150,000
       limitation.
1.7    "Earned Income" shall mean the annual net earnings from
       self-employment in the trade or business with respect to which the
       Plan is established, provided that personal services of the
       individual are a material income-producing factor.  Net earnings will
       be determined without regard to items not included in gross income
       and the deductions allocable to such items.  Net earnings are reduced
       by contributions by the Employer to a qualified plan to the extent
       deductible under section 404 of the Code.  Net earnings shall be
       determined with regard to the deduction allowed to the taxpayer by
       section 164(f) of the Code.
1.8    "Elective Deferrals" shall mean any Employer contributions made to
       the Plan at the election of the Participant, in lieu of cash
       compensation, pursuant to a salary reduction agreement or other
       deferral mechanism.
1.9    "Eligible Employee" shall mean, for a particular Plan Year, each
       Employee who is not excluded from eligibility to participate in the
       Plan under the Adoption Agreement.  The determination of eligibility
       shall be made on the last day of the Plan Year.
1.10   "Employee" shall mean any person employed by the Employer and any
       person treated as an employee under section 401(c) of the Code.

       A "leased employee" shall also be treated as an Employee.  The term
       "leased employee" means any person (other than an employee of the
       recipient employer) who pursuant to an agreement between the
       recipient employer and any other person ("leasing organization") has
       performed services for the recipient employer (or for the recipient
       employer and related persons determined in accordance with section
       414(n)(6) of the Code) on a substantially full-time basis for a
       period of at least one year, and such services are of a type
       historically performed by employees in the business field of the
       recipient employer. Contributions or benefits provided a leased
       employee by the leasing organization which are attributable to
       services performed for the recipient employer shall be treated as
       provided by the recipient employer.

       Notwithstanding the preceding paragraph, a leased employee shall not
       be considered an employee of the recipient employer if:  (i) such
       employee is covered by a money purchase pension plan providing (1) a
       nonintegrated employer contribution rate of at least ten percent
       (10%) of Compensation, as defined in section 415(c)(3) of the Code,
       but including amounts contributed pursuant to a salary reduction
       agreement which are excludable from the employee's gross income under
       section 125, section 402(a)(8), section 402(h) or section 403(b) of
       the Code,(2) immediate participation and (3) full and immediate
       vesting; and (ii) leased employees do not constitute more than twenty
       percent (20%) of the recipient employer's non-highly compensated
       workforce.

1.11   "Employer" shall mean the corporation, partnership, proprietorship or
       other business entity which shall adopt the Plan or any successor
       thereof and any employer required to be aggregated with such entity
       under section 414(b), (c), (m) or (o) of the Code.
1.12   "Family Member" shall, with respect to a five percent (5%) owner or
       top-ten Highly Compensated Employee described in section 414(q)(6)(A)
       of the Code, include the spouse and lineal ascendants and descendants
       of an Employee and the spouses of such lineal ascendants and
       descendants.  The determination of who is a Family Member will be
       made in accordance with section 414(q) of the Code.
1.13   "Highly Compensated Employee" shall include any Employee who performs
       services for the Employer during the Determination Year and who,
       during the Look-Back Year:  (i) received Compensation from the
       Employer in excess of $75,000 (as adjusted pursuant to section 415(d)
       of the Code); (ii) received Compensation from the Employer in excess
       of $50,000 (as adjusted pursuant to section 415(d) of the Code), and
       was a member of the top-paid group for such year; or (iii) was an
       officer of the Employer and received Compensation during such year
       that is greater than fifty percent (50%) of the dollar limitation in
       effect under section 415(b)(1)(A) of the Code. The term "Highly
       Compensated Employee" also includes: (i) an Employee who is described
       in the preceding sentence if the term "Determination Year" is
       substituted for the term "Look-Back Year" and the Employee is one of
       the 100 most highly compensated Employees of the Employer during the
       Plan Year; and (ii) an Employee who is a five percent (5%) owner of
       the Employer at any time during the Look-Back or Determination Year.


       For this purpose, the Determination Year shall be the Plan Year, and
       the Look-Back Year shall be the twelve (12) month period immediately
       preceding the Determination Year unless the Employer has elected to
       use the calendar year ending with or within the Determination Year as
       the Look-Back Year for purposes of its employee benefit plans.  If
       the Employer has so elected to use such calendar year as the
       Look-Back Year for its employee benefit plans, the Determination Year
       shall be the "lag period," if any, by which the applicable
       Determination Year extends beyond such calendar year.

       The determination of who is a Highly Compensated Employee, including
       the determinations of the number and identity of employees in the
       top-paid group, the top 100 employees, the number of employees
       treated as officers and the compensation that is considered, will be
       made in accordance with section 414(q) of the Code and the
       regulations thereunder.

1.14   "IRA" or "SEP-IRA" shall mean the Dreyfus Individual Retirement
       Account (a prototype IRA upon which a favorable opinion letter has
       been issued by the Internal Revenue Service).
1.15   "Integration Level" shall mean the Taxable Wage Base or such lesser
       amount elected by the Employer in the Adoption Agreement.
1.16   "Net Profits" shall mean the current and accumulated earnings of the
       Employer before Federal and State taxes and contributions to this and
       any other qualified plan.
1.17   "Non-Highly Compensated Employee" shall mean an Employee of the
       Employer who is neither a Highly Compensated Employee nor a Family
       Member.
1.18   "Participant" shall mean an Eligible Employee participating in the
       Plan in accordance with Section 2.1.
1.19   "Plan" shall mean this Prototype Simplified Employee Pension and the
       Adoption Agreement of the Adopting Employer, as from time to time
       amended.
1.20   "Plan Year" shall mean the calendar year, unless the Employer's
       fiscal year is specified as the Plan Year in the Adoption Agreement.
1.21   "SEP" shall mean a Simplified Employee Pension within the meaning of
       section 408(k) of the Code.
1.22   "Sponsor" shall mean The Dreyfus Corporation.
1.23   "Taxable Wage Base" shall mean the contribution and benefit base in
       effect under Section 230 of the Social Security Act at the beginning
       of the Plan Year.


Article II:  Participation

2.1    Commencement of Participation
       The Employer shall promptly notify each Employee that satisfies the
       Plan's eligibility requirements set forth in the Adoption Agreement
       that he/she may take the necessary steps to commence participation
       in the Plan.  If an Eligible Employee cannot be located or refuses
       to establish an IRA to receive contributions made to the Plan, the
       Employer may execute the necessary documents to establish an IRA on
       such Eligible Employee's behalf.

       An Eligible Employee shall commence participation in the Plan by
       establishing an IRA to receive contributions made to the Plan,
       notifying the Committee of the establishment of the IRA, and, if
       applicable, entering into a "salary reduction agreement" as
       described in Section 3.4 with the Employer.


Article III:  Contributions

3.1    Limit on Employer Contributions
       Employer contributions for each Plan Year (including, if
       applicable, Elective Deferrals) shall be determined in accordance
       with the Adoption Agreement, but shall not exceed the maximum
       amount which shall constitute an allowable deduction under section
       404(h) of the Code.  Unless otherwise specified in the Adoption
       Agreement, Employer contributions may only be made out of Net
       Profits.

3.2    402(h) Limit
       In no event shall Employer contributions (including Elective
       Deferrals made pursuant to Section 3.4) made on behalf of any
       Participant exceed the lesser of 15% of the Participant's
       Compensation includible in the Participant's gross income for the
       year (determined without regard to the Employer contributions made
       under this Plan), or the limitation in effect under Section
       415(c)(1)(A) of the Code (currently $30,000).  In the case of a
       Participant who is a Highly Compensated Employee, the limitation in
       effect under Section 415 (c)(1)(A) of the Code (currently $30,000)
       shall be reduced, if the Plan is integrated with Social Security,
       by the amount of contributions made on behalf of the Participant
       based on Compensation over the Integration level.  [Note:  The Plan
       may not be integrated with Social Security if the Plan permits only
       Elective Deferrals.]  All businesses of a Self-Employed Individual
       shall be aggregated for purposes of applying the 15% of
       Compensation described in this Section 3.2.

3.3    Employer Discretionary Contributions
       The following provisions shall apply if the Employer has elected in
       the Adoption Agreement to make Employer Discretionary
       Contributions.

       (a)     If the Plan is not integrated with Social Security, the
               Employer Discretionary Contribution for any Plan Year shall be
               allocated to the IRA established for each Participant in the
               ratio which each Participant's Compensation for the Plan Year
               bears to that of all Participants for such Plan Year.
       (b)     If the Plan is integrated with Social Security, the Employer
               Discretionary Contribution shall be allocated as follows:
               (i)  If under Article V, the Plan is Top-Heavy for the Plan Year
                    and the minimum Top-Heavy contribution is made under the
                    Plan, then contributions shall be allocated to each
                    Participant's IRA in the ratio that each Participant's
                    aggregate Compensation bears to that of all Participants
                    for the Plan Year, up to three percent (3%) of each
                    Participant's aggregate Compensation for the Plan Year.
                    Any remaining contributions shall be allocated to each
                    Participant's IRA in the ratio that each Participant's
                    Compensation in excess of the Integration Level bears to
                    the sum of all Participant's Compensation in excess of the
                    Integration Level for the Plan Year, up to three V (3%) of
                    each Participant's Compensation for the Plan Year in excess
                    of the Integration Level.
          (ii)      If the Plan is not Top-Heavy for the Plan Year,
                    contributions (or if the Plan is Top-Heavy, contributions
                    remaining after step (i) above) shall be allocated to each
                    Participant's IRA in the ratio that the sum of each
                    Participant's aggregate Compensation and Compensation in
                    excess of the Integration Level bears to the sum of all
                    Participants' aggregate Compensation and Compensation in
                    excess of the Integration Level for the Plan Year, up to
                    the product of (a) the Permitted Disparity Percentage as
                    specified in the Adoption Agreement (reduced by three
                    percent (3%) if the Plan is Top-Heavy) times (b) each
                    Participant's aggregate Compensation plus Compensation in
                    excess of the Integration Level for the Plan Year.  Any
                    remaining contributions will be allocated to all
                    Participants in the ratio that each Participant's aggregate
                    Compensation bears to all Participants' aggregate
                    Compensation for the Plan Year.
       (c)     Employer Discretionary Contributions will be paid by the
               Employer to Participants' IRA within the time period prescribed
               in Section 404(h) of the Code.

 3.4  Elective Deferrals
      The following provisions shall apply if the Employer has elected in the
      Adoption Agreement to permit Elective Deferrals.
        (a)     Elective Deferrals shall be permitted for a Plan Year only if:
                (i)  Not less than 50% of Eligible Employees elect, or have an
                     election in effect, to have Elective Deferrals made to the
                     Plan; and
               (ii)  The Employer had no more than 25 Eligible Employees at any
                     time during the prior Plan Year.
        (b)     In the event that the 50% requirement of Section 3.4(a)(i) is
                not satisfied as of the end of any Plan Year, then all Elective
                Deferrals made by Participants for that Plan Year shall be
                considered "disallowed deferrals," i.e., IRA contributions that
                are not SEP-IRA contributions.  The Employer shall notify each
                affected Participant, within 2 1/2 months following the end of
                the Plan Year to which the disallowed deferrals relate, that
                the Elective Deferrals are no longer considered SEP-IRA
                contributions.  Such notification shall specify the amount of
                the disallowed deferrals and the calendar year in which they
                are includible in income and must provide an explanation of
                applicable penalties if the disallowed deferrals are not
                withdrawn in a timely fashion.
        (c)     The Employer shall contribute and allocate to each
                Participant's IRA an amount equal to the amount of the
                Employee's Elective Deferrals.  Elective Deferrals will be paid
                by the Employer to the Participant's IRA trustee or custodian
                as soon as practicable in compliance with Department of Labor
                Regulation Section 2510.3-102.
        (d)     An Eligible Employee may elect to have Elective Deferrals made
                under this Plan by entering into a salary reduction arrangement
                with his Employer.  A salary reduction arrangement is an
                agreement whereby the Employee accepts a reduction in
                Compensation in consideration of a contribution by the Employer
                on such Employee's behalf in the same amount to the Employee's
                IRA established under the Plan.  A salary reduction arrangement
                may also include an agreement whereby the Employee elects to
                have all or part of a cash bonus contributed to his/her IRA
                rather than paid to him/her in cash.  An Eligible Employee may
                elect to enter into such an agreement with the Employer by
                filing a written election with the Committee, on a form
                supplied by the Committee, specifying a dollar amount or a
                whole percentage of his/her Compensation or cash bonus he/she
                wishes to be contributed by the Employer to the IRA he/she has
                established pursuant to the Plan.  No Elective Deferrals may be
                based on Compensation an Employee received, or had a right to
                receive, before execution of the salary reduction agreement.
                An election shall remain in force until changed or canceled in
                writing by a Participant in accordance with rules established
                by the Committee on a form supplied by the Committee.
        (e)     Under no circumstances may a Participant's Elective Deferrals
                in any calendar year exceed the limitation under section 402
                (g) of the Code based on all of the plans of the Employer.
                Each Participant shall be solely responsible for determining
                whether such Participant's Elective Deferrals have exceeded
                such limitation.
        (f)     If the Employer contributes nonelective employer contributions
                to this Plan or any other SEP for a Plan Year, or contributes
                to any qualified defined contribution plan for such Plan Year,
                then an Employee's Elective Deferrals may be limited to the
                extent necessary to satisfy the maximum contribution
                limitations under section 415(c)(1)(A) of the Code.
        (g)     In no event shall the percentage of Compensation deferred by a
                Highly Compensated Employee in a Plan Year exceed the Average
                Actual Deferral Percentage of all Eligible Employees who are
                Non-Highly Compensated Employees in such Plan Year multiplied
                by 1.25.  The Compensation and Elective Deferrals of Family
                Members shall be attributed to Highly Compensated Employees in
                computing the percentage of compensation deferred by a Highly
                Compensated Employee in any Plan Year, and Family Members shall
                be disregarded as separate employees.  In computing the Average
                Actual Deferral Percentage of all Eligible Employees who are
                not Highly Compensated Employees, Eligible Employees not
                participating in the Plan shall be counted as contributing 0%
                of Compensation.  Amounts in excess of the deferral percentage
                limitation will be deemed excess SEP contributions on behalf of
                the affected Highly Compensated Employee or Employees.
        (h)     The Employer shall notify each affected Highly Compensated
                Employee, within 2 1/2 months following the end of the Plan
                Year to which the excess SEP contributions relate, of any
                excess SEP contributions to the Highly Compensated Employee's
                SEP-IRA for the applicable year.  Such notification shall
                specify the amount of the excess SEP contributions and the
                calendar year in which the contributions are includible in
                income and must provide an explanation of applicable penalties
                if the excess SEP  contributions are not withdrawn in a timely
                fashion.
        (i)     The Employer shall notify each Participant who makes an
                Elective Deferral to the Plan that, until 2 1/2 months after
                the end of a particular Plan Year, any transfer or distribution
                from that Participant's SEP-IRA of SEP contributions (or income
                on these contributions) attributable to Elective Deferrals made
                during that Plan Year will be includible in income for purposes
                of sections 72(t) and 408(d)(1) of the Code.
        (j)     The Committee shall have the right to monitor and limit a
                Highly Compensated Employee's Elective Deferrals to prevent
                such Highly Compensated Employee from making Elective Deferrals
                in excess of the limitations set forth in Sections 3.4(e),
                3.4(f), and 3.4(g) of the Plan.


Article IV:  Participants' Rights to Benefits

4.1   Nonforfeitability
      All contributions made to this Plan by the Employer on behalf of a
      Participant shall be fully vested and nonforfeitable at all times.

4.2   Withdrawals and Distributions
      The right of a Participant to withdraw amounts or to otherwise
      receive distributions from the IRA selected by the Participant upon
      commencement of participation in the Plan shall be determined by
      reference to the terms of such IRA,  subject to such rules as may
      be issued by the Internal Revenue Service relating to excess
      contributions.  Except as provided in the preceding sentence,
      Employer contributions are not conditioned on the retention in the
      Plan of any portion of the amount contributed and there is no
      prohibition imposed on withdrawals from the Plan.

4.3   Death
              In the event of a Participant's death, disposition of the
      Participant's IRA shall be determined by reference to the terms of
      such IRA and any designation of beneficiary(ies) made by
      Participants pursuant thereto.


Article V:  Top-Heavy Provisions

5.1   Definitions
      For purposes of this Article, the following words shall have the
      following meaning:
      (a)     "Determination Date" shall mean (i) the last day of the
              preceding Plan Year, or (ii) in the case of the first Plan Year
              of any Plan, the last day of such Plan Year.
      (b)     "Key Employee" shall mean any Employee or former Employee (and
              the Beneficiaries of such Employee) who at any time during the
              Plan Year containing the Determination Date and the four (4)
              preceding Plan Years was:
              (1)  An officer of the Employer if such individual's annual
                   Compensation exceeds fifty percent (50%) of the dollar
                   limitation under section 415(b)(1)(A) of the Code (provided
                   that the number of Employees treated as officers shall be
                   no more than fifty (50) or, if fewer, the greater of three
                   (3) Employees or ten percent (10%) of all Employees);
              (2)  An owner (or considered an owner under section 318 of the
                   Code) of at least a one-half of one percent (.5%) interest
                   and one of the ten (10) largest interests in the Employer
                   if such individual's annual Compensation exceeds one
                   hundred percent (100%) of the dollar limitation under
                   section 415(c)(1)(A) of the Code;
              (3)  A five percent (5%) owner of the Employer; or
              (4)  A one percent (1%) owner of the Employer who has an annual
                   Compensation of more than one hundred fifty thousand
                   dollars ($150,000).
      For this purpose, annual Compensation means Compensation as defined
      in section 415(c)(3) of the Code, but including amounts excludable
      rom the Employee's gross income by reason of sections 125,
      401(a)(8), 402(h) or 403(b) of the Code.  The determination of who
      is a Key Employee will be made in accordance with section 416(i)(1)
      of the Code and the regulations thereunder.
      (c)     "Non-Key Employee" shall mean any Employee who is not a Key
              Employee.
      (d)     "Permissive Aggregation Group" shall mean the Required
              Aggregation Group of plans plus any other plan or plans of the
              Employer which, when considered as a group with the Required
              Aggregation Group, would continue to satisfy the requirements
              of sections 401(a)(4) and 410 of the Code.
      (e)     "Present Value" shall be based on the interest and mortality
              table specified in the Employer's qualified defined benefit
              plan for Top-Heavy purposes, or if such assumptions are not
              specified in the Employer's qualified defined benefit plan,
              Present Value shall be based on the assumptions specified in
              the Adoption Agreement.
      (f)     "Required Aggregation Group" shall mean (1) each qualified
              defined contribution plan of the Employer in which at least one
              Key Employee participates or participated at any time during
              the determination period (regardless of whether the Plan has
              terminated), and (2) any other qualified defined contribution
              plan of the Employer which enables a plan described in (1) to
              meet the requirements of sections 401(a)(4) or 410 of the Code.
      (g)     "Top-Heavy Ratio."
              (1) If the Employer maintains one or more defined contribution
                  plans (including this or any other SEP) and the Employer
                  has not maintained any defined benefit plan which during
                  the five (5) year period ending on the Determination Date
                  has or has had accrued benefits, the Top-Heavy Ratio for
                  this Plan alone or for the Required or Permissive
                  Aggregation Group as appropriate is a fraction, the
                  numerator of which is the sum of the account balances of
                  all Key Employees as of the Determination Date (including
                  any part of any account balance distributed in the five (5)
                  year period ending on the Determination Date), and the
                  denominator of which is the sum of all account balances
                  (including any part of any account balance distributed in
                  the five (5) year period ending on the Determination Date),
                  both computed in accordance with Section 416 of the Code
                  and the regulations thereunder.  The Employer may elect in
                  the Adoption Agreement to consider the contributions that
                  have been made to this Plan on behalf of Key Employees and
                  all Employees rather than the account balances of Key
                  Employees and all Employees under this Plan in computing
                  the Top-Heavy Ratio.  Both the numerator and denominator of
                  the Top-Heavy Ratio are increased to reflect any
                  contribution not actually made as of the Determination
                  Date, but which is required to be taken into account on
                  that date under Section 416 of the Code and the regulations
                  thereunder.
              (2) If the Employer maintains one or more defined contribution
                  plans (including this or any other Simplified Employee
                  Pension) and the Employer maintains or has maintained one
                  or more defined benefit plans which during the five (5)
                  year period ending on the Determination Date has or has had
                  any accrued benefits, the Top-Heavy Ratio for any Required
                  or Permissive Aggressive Group as appropriate is a
                  fraction, the numerator of which is the sum of account
                  balances under the aggregated defined contribution plan or
                  plans for all Key Employees determined in accordance with
                  the above rules, and the Present Value of accrued benefits
                  under the aggregated defined benefit plan or plans for all
                  Employees as of the Determination Date, and the denominator
                  of which is the sum of the account balances under the
                  aggregated defined contribution plan or plans for all
                  Participants, determined in accordance with the rules
                  above, and the Present Value of accrued benefits under the
                  defined benefit plan or plans for all Participants as of
                  the Determination Date, all determined in accordance with
                  section 416 of the Code and the regulations thereunder. The
                  Employer may elect in the Adoption Agreement to consider
                  the contributions that have been made to this Plan on
                  behalf of Key Employees and all Employees rather than the
                  account balances of Key Employees and all Employees under
                  this Plan in computing the Top-Heavy Ratio.  The accrued
                  benefits under a defined benefit plan in both the numerator
                  and denominator of the Top-Heavy Ratio are increased for
                  any distribution of an accrued benefit made in the five (5)
                  year period ending on the Determination Date.
              (3) For purposes of (1) and (2) above, the value of account
                  balances and the Present Value of accrued benefits will be
                  determined as of the most recent Valuation Date that falls
                  within or ends with the twelve (12) month period ending on
                  the Determination Date, except as provided in section 416
                  of the Code and the regulations thereunder for the first
                  and second Plan Years of a defined benefit plan.  The
                  account balances and accrued benefits of a Participant who
                  is not a Key Employee but who was a Key Employee in a prior
                  year, or has not been credited with at least one hour of
                  service for the Employer maintaining the Plan at any time
                  during the five (5) year period ending on the Determination
                  Date, will be disregarded.  The calculation of the
                  Top-Heavy Ratio, and the extent to which distributions,
                  rollovers, and transfers are taken into account, will be
                  made in accordance with section 416 of the Code and the
                  regulations thereunder. Deductible Employee contributions
                  will not be taken into account for purposes of computing
                  the Top-Heavy Ratio.  When aggregating plans, the value of
                  account balances and accrued benefits will be calculated
                  with reference to the Determination Date that falls within
                  the same calendar year.
              (4) Solely for the purpose of determining if the Plan, or any
                  other plan included in a Required Aggregation Group of
                  which this Plan is a part, is Top-Heavy (within the meaning
                  of section 416(g) of the Code) the accrued benefit of a
                  Non-Key Employee shall be determined under (a) the method,
                  if any, that uniformly applies for accrual purposes under
                  all plans maintained by the Employer, or (b) if there is no
                  such method, as if such benefit accrued not more rapidly
                  than the slowest accrual rate of section 411(b)(1)(C) of
                  the Code.
      (h)     "Valuation Date" shall mean the last day of the Plan Year and
              is the day on which account balances are valued for purposes of
              determining whether the Plan is Top-Heavy.

5.2   Top-Heavy Determination
      The Plan shall be Top-Heavy for any Plan Year if any of the
      following conditions exist:
      (a)     If the Top-Heavy Ratio for this Plan exceeds sixty percent
              (60%) and this Plan is not part of any Required Group or
              Permissive Group of plans.
      (b)     If this Plan is a part of a Required Aggregation Group of
              plans, but not part of a Permissive Aggregation Group and the
              Top-Heavy Ratio for the group of plans exceeds sixty percent
              (60%).
      (c)     If this Plan is a part of a Required Aggregation Group and part
              of a Permissive Aggregation Group of plans and the Top-Heavy
              Ratio for the Permissive Aggregation Group exceeds sixty
              percent (60%).

5.3   Minimum Allocation
      If the Plan is determined to be Top-Heavy for any Plan Year
      pursuant to Section 5.2, a minimum nonelective Employer
      contribution shall be made to the Plan on behalf of each Eligible
      Employee who is Non-Key Employee.  Such minimum contribution shall
      be in an amount equal to the lesser of (i) 3% of the Non-Key
      Employee's Compensation, or (ii) the highest Employer contribution
      as a percentage of Compensation allocated on behalf of any Key
      Employee in such Plan Year.  The minimum contribution will not be
      required under this Plan (assuming the Plan is Top-Heavy) with
      respect to any Participant covered under any other qualified plan
      or plans of the Employer if the adopting Employer has elected in
      the Adoption Agreement that the minimum Top-Heavy allocation will
      be met in such plan.  For purposes of determining whether a Plan is
      Top-Heavy, Elective Deferrals are considered Employer
      contributions.  However,  Elective Deferrals may not be used to
      satisfy this 3% minimum contribution requirement.  Such minimum
      contribution shall be determined without regard to a Social
      Security contribution.




Article VI:  Plan Administration

6.1   Appointment of Committee
      The Employer may appoint a person or persons to act as the
      Committee and serve at its pleasure.  If no Committee is appointed,
      the Employer shall act as the Committee.  The Committee shall have
      the sole responsibility for the administration of the Plan.

6.2   Claims Procedure
      A Participant or beneficiary ("Claimant") may file a written claim
      for benefits under the Plan with the Committee.  If the Committee
      decides that a Claimant is not entitled to all or any part of the
      benefits claimed, it shall, within ninety (90) days of receipt of
      such claim, inform the Claimant in writing of its determination;
      the reasons for its determination, including specific references to
      the pertinent Plan provisions; and the Plan's review procedures.
      The Claimant or his authorized personal representative shall be
      permitted to review pertinent documents and within sixty (60) days
      after receipt of the notice of denial of claim to request to appear
      personally before it or to submit such further information or
      comments to the Committee as will, in the Claimant's opinion,
      establish his right to such benefits.

      The Committee will render its final decision with the specific
      reason therefore in writing and will transmit it to the claimant by
      certified mail within 60 days (or 120 days, if special
      circumstances require an extension of time and the Claimant is
      given written notice within the initial 60 day period) of any such
      appearance.  If the final decision is not made within such period,
      it will be considered  denied.  If, upon review of a request for
      benefits hereunder, the Committee finds the Participant ineligible
      for such benefits, it shall inform the Participant in writing of
      the reason or reasons for such denial.  In the event any
      Participant disagrees with the conclusions of the Committee, the
      Committee must reconsider their decision based on the facts and
      evidence presented to them by the Participant.  Further, the
      Committee must substantiate in writing to any Participant who
      disagrees with the amount of his benefit the method under which the
      benefit computations were made.

6.3   Records and Reports
      The Committee shall maintain such records as may be necessary for
      proper administration of the Plan and shall be responsible for
      supplying all information and reports to the Internal Revenue
      Service, Department of Labor, Participants, Beneficiaries and
      others as required by law.  Employees may examine records
      pertaining directly to them.

6.4   Powers and Duties
      The Committee shall have such powers and duties as are necessary
      for the proper administration of the Plan, including but not
      limited to the power to make decisions with respect to the
      application and interpretation of the Plan.  The Committee shall be
      empowered to establish rules and regulations for the transactions
      of its business and for the administration of the Plan.  The
      determinations of the Committee with respect to the interpretation,
      application, or administration of the Plan shall be final, binding,
      and conclusive upon each person or party interested or concerned.

6.5   Committee Action
      In the event that the Employer appoints a person or persons to act
      as the Committee, such Committee shall act by a majority of its
      members at a meeting or in writing without a meeting.  A member of
      the Committee ho is also a Participant of the Plan shall not vote
      or act as a member of the Committee upon any matter relating solely
      to his rights or benefits under the Plan.

6.6   Reliance on Professional Advice
      The Committee shall be entitled to rely conclusively on the advice
      or opinion of any consultant, accountant, or attorney and such
      persons may also act in their respective professional capacities as
      advisors to the Employer.

6.7   Participant Information
      The Committee may require a Participant to complete and file with
      the Committee any and all forms approved by the Committee, and to
      furnish all pertinent information requested by the Committee.  The
      Committee shall be entitled to rely upon all such information.
6.8   Standard of Care
      The Committee must discharge its duties solely in the interest of
      the Participants.  The Committee must carry out its duties with the
      care, skill, prudence and diligence under circumstances then
      prevailing that a prudent man acting in a like capacity and
      familiar with such matters would use in the conduct of an
      enterprise of like character and with like aims.  The Committee,
      however, shall not be liable for any acts or decisions based on the
      advice or opinion of any consultant, accountant or attorney
      employed by the Committee in their respective professional
      capacities as advisors to the Employer, provided, however, that the
      Committee did not violate its general fiduciary duty in selecting
      or retaining such advisor.


Article VII:  Miscellaneous Provisions

7.1   No Right of Continued Employment
      No Employee or Participant shall have any right or claim to any
      benefit under the Plan except in accordance with the provisions of
      the Plan.  The adoption of the Plan shall not he construed as
      creating any contract of employment between the Employer and any
      Employee or otherwise conferring upon any Employee or other person
      any legal right to continuation of employment, nor as limiting or
      qualifying the right of the Employer to discharge any Employee
      without regard to the effect that such discharge might have upon
      his rights under the Plan.

7.2   Amendments
      (a)     The Employer expressly recognizes the authority of the Sponsor
              to amend the Plan from time to time, and the Employer shall be
              deemed to have consented to any such amendment.  The Employer
              shall receive a written instrument indicating the amendment of
              the Plan and such amendment shall become effective as of the
              effective date of such amendment.
      (b)     The Employer reserves the right to make from time to time any
              amendments to this Plan which do not cause any part of
              contributions hereunder to be used for any purpose other than
              the exclusive benefit of Participants.  Participants will be
              provided with a copy of any such amendment within thirty days
              of the later of: (i) such amendment's effective date, or (ii)
              the date such amendment is adopted.  If the Employer amends the
              Plan, the Employer shall be deemed to have an individually
              designed SEP and shall not be entitled to rely on the opinion
              letter obtained by the Sponsor with respect to the Plan.

7.3   Termination
      The Plan has been established with the intent that it be permanent,
      but the Employer reserves the right to terminate the Plan at any
      time.

7.4   Governing Law
      The Plan shall be administered, construed and enforced in
      accordance with the laws of the state wherein the Employer
      maintains its principal place of business,  except to the extent
      preempted by the Employee Retirement Income Security Act of 1974,
      as amended.

 

<TABLE> <S> <C>

<ARTICLE> 6
<CIK> 0000885408
<NAME> DREYFUS BASIC U.S. GOVERNMENT MONEY MARKET FUND
<MULTIPLIER> 1000
       
<S>                             <C>
<PERIOD-TYPE>                   YEAR
<FISCAL-YEAR-END>                          FEB-29-1996
<PERIOD-END>                               FEB-29-1996
<INVESTMENTS-AT-COST>                        1,413,061
<INVESTMENTS-AT-VALUE>                       1,413,061
<RECEIVABLES>                                   11,233
<ASSETS-OTHER>                                   6,439
<OTHER-ITEMS-ASSETS>                                 0
<TOTAL-ASSETS>                               1,430,733
<PAYABLE-FOR-SECURITIES>                        63,979
<SENIOR-LONG-TERM-DEBT>                              0
<OTHER-ITEMS-LIABILITIES>                          698
<TOTAL-LIABILITIES>                             64,677
<SENIOR-EQUITY>                                      0
<PAID-IN-CAPITAL-COMMON>                     1,366,056
<SHARES-COMMON-STOCK>                        1,366,056
<SHARES-COMMON-PRIOR>                        1,041,823
<ACCUMULATED-NII-CURRENT>                            0
<OVERDISTRIBUTION-NII>                               0
<ACCUMULATED-NET-GAINS>                              0
<OVERDISTRIBUTION-GAINS>                             0
<ACCUM-APPREC-OR-DEPREC>                             0
<NET-ASSETS>                                 1,366,056
<DIVIDEND-INCOME>                                    0
<INTEREST-INCOME>                               76,467
<OTHER-INCOME>                                       0
<EXPENSES-NET>                                   3,844
<NET-INVESTMENT-INCOME>                         72,623
<REALIZED-GAINS-CURRENT>                           100
<APPREC-INCREASE-CURRENT>                            0
<NET-CHANGE-FROM-OPS>                           72,723
<EQUALIZATION>                                       0
<DISTRIBUTIONS-OF-INCOME>                     (72,623)
<DISTRIBUTIONS-OF-GAINS>                             0
<DISTRIBUTIONS-OTHER>                                0
<NUMBER-OF-SHARES-SOLD>                      1,786,038
<NUMBER-OF-SHARES-REDEEMED>                (1,529,919)
<SHARES-REINVESTED>                             68,115
<NET-CHANGE-IN-ASSETS>                         324,334
<ACCUMULATED-NII-PRIOR>                              0
<ACCUMULATED-GAINS-PRIOR>                        (101)
<OVERDISTRIB-NII-PRIOR>                              0
<OVERDIST-NET-GAINS-PRIOR>                           0
<GROSS-ADVISORY-FEES>                            6,267
<INTEREST-EXPENSE>                                   0
<GROSS-EXPENSE>                                  8,329
<AVERAGE-NET-ASSETS>                         1,253,379
<PER-SHARE-NAV-BEGIN>                             1.00
<PER-SHARE-NII>                                   .058
<PER-SHARE-GAIN-APPREC>                              0
<PER-SHARE-DIVIDEND>                            (.058)
<PER-SHARE-DISTRIBUTIONS>                            0
<RETURNS-OF-CAPITAL>                                 0
<PER-SHARE-NAV-END>                               1.00
<EXPENSE-RATIO>                                   .003
<AVG-DEBT-OUTSTANDING>                               0
<AVG-DEBT-PER-SHARE>                                 0
        

</TABLE>


© 2022 IncJournal is not affiliated with or endorsed by the U.S. Securities and Exchange Commission